[Title 26 CFR ]
[Code of Federal Regulations (annual edition) - April 1, 2014 Edition]
[From the U.S. Government Publishing Office]
[[Page i]]
Title 26
Internal Revenue
________________________
Part 1 (Sec. Sec. 1.501 to 1.640)
Revised as of April 1, 2013
Containing a codification of documents of general
applicability and future effect
As of April 1, 2013
Published by the Office of the Federal Register
National Archives and Records Administration as a
Special Edition of the Federal Register
[[Page ii]]
U.S. GOVERNMENT OFFICIAL EDITION NOTICE
Legal Status and Use of Seals and Logos
The seal of the National Archives and Records Administration
(NARA) authenticates the Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) as
the official codification of Federal regulations established
under the Federal Register Act. Under the provisions of 44
U.S.C. 1507, the contents of the CFR, a special edition of the
Federal Register, shall be judicially noticed. The CFR is
prima facie evidence of the original documents published in
the Federal Register (44 U.S.C. 1510).
It is prohibited to use NARA's official seal and the stylized Code
of Federal Regulations logo on any republication of this
material without the express, written permission of the
Archivist of the United States or the Archivist's designee.
Any person using NARA's official seals and logos in a manner
inconsistent with the provisions of 36 CFR part 1200 is
subject to the penalties specified in 18 U.S.C. 506, 701, and
1017.
Use of ISBN Prefix
This is the Official U.S. Government edition of this publication
and is herein identified to certify its authenticity. Use of
the 0-16 ISBN prefix is for U.S. Government Printing Office
Official Editions only. The Superintendent of Documents of the
U.S. Government Printing Office requests that any reprinted
edition clearly be labeled as a copy of the authentic work
with a new ISBN.
U . S . G O V E R N M E N T P R I N T I N G O F F I C E
------------------------------------------------------------------
U.S. Superintendent of Documents Washington, DC
20402-0001
http://bookstore.gpo.gov
Phone: toll-free (866) 512-1800; DC area (202) 512-1800
[[Page iii]]
Table of Contents
Page
Explanation................................................. v
Title 26:
Chapter I--Internal Revenue Service, Department of
the Treasury (Continued) 3
Finding Aids:
Table of CFR Titles and Chapters........................ 563
Alphabetical List of Agencies Appearing in the CFR...... 583
Table of OMB Control Numbers............................ 593
List of CFR Sections Affected........................... 611
[[Page iv]]
----------------------------
Cite this Code: CFR
To cite the regulations in
this volume use title,
part and section number.
Thus, 26 CFR 1.501(a)-1
refers to title 26, part
1, section 501(a)-1.
----------------------------
[[Page v]]
EXPLANATION
The Code of Federal Regulations is a codification of the general and
permanent rules published in the Federal Register by the Executive
departments and agencies of the Federal Government. The Code is divided
into 50 titles which represent broad areas subject to Federal
regulation. Each title is divided into chapters which usually bear the
name of the issuing agency. Each chapter is further subdivided into
parts covering specific regulatory areas.
Each volume of the Code is revised at least once each calendar year
and issued on a quarterly basis approximately as follows:
Title 1 through Title 16.................................as of January 1
Title 17 through Title 27..................................as of April 1
Title 28 through Title 41...................................as of July 1
Title 42 through Title 50................................as of October 1
The appropriate revision date is printed on the cover of each
volume.
LEGAL STATUS
The contents of the Federal Register are required to be judicially
noticed (44 U.S.C. 1507). The Code of Federal Regulations is prima facie
evidence of the text of the original documents (44 U.S.C. 1510).
HOW TO USE THE CODE OF FEDERAL REGULATIONS
The Code of Federal Regulations is kept up to date by the individual
issues of the Federal Register. These two publications must be used
together to determine the latest version of any given rule.
To determine whether a Code volume has been amended since its
revision date (in this case, April 1, 2013), consult the ``List of CFR
Sections Affected (LSA),'' which is issued monthly, and the ``Cumulative
List of Parts Affected,'' which appears in the Reader Aids section of
the daily Federal Register. These two lists will identify the Federal
Register page number of the latest amendment of any given rule.
EFFECTIVE AND EXPIRATION DATES
Each volume of the Code contains amendments published in the Federal
Register since the last revision of that volume of the Code. Source
citations for the regulations are referred to by volume number and page
number of the Federal Register and date of publication. Publication
dates and effective dates are usually not the same and care must be
exercised by the user in determining the actual effective date. In
instances where the effective date is beyond the cut-off date for the
Code a note has been inserted to reflect the future effective date. In
those instances where a regulation published in the Federal Register
states a date certain for expiration, an appropriate note will be
inserted following the text.
OMB CONTROL NUMBERS
The Paperwork Reduction Act of 1980 (Pub. L. 96-511) requires
Federal agencies to display an OMB control number with their information
collection request.
[[Page vi]]
Many agencies have begun publishing numerous OMB control numbers as
amendments to existing regulations in the CFR. These OMB numbers are
placed as close as possible to the applicable recordkeeping or reporting
requirements.
PAST PROVISIONS OF THE CODE
Provisions of the Code that are no longer in force and effect as of
the revision date stated on the cover of each volume are not carried.
Code users may find the text of provisions in effect on any given date
in the past by using the appropriate List of CFR Sections Affected
(LSA). For the convenience of the reader, a ``List of CFR Sections
Affected'' is published at the end of each CFR volume. For changes to
the Code prior to the LSA listings at the end of the volume, consult
previous annual editions of the LSA. For changes to the Code prior to
2001, consult the List of CFR Sections Affected compilations, published
for 1949-1963, 1964-1972, 1973-1985, and 1986-2000.
``[RESERVED]'' TERMINOLOGY
The term ``[Reserved]'' is used as a place holder within the Code of
Federal Regulations. An agency may add regulatory information at a
``[Reserved]'' location at any time. Occasionally ``[Reserved]'' is used
editorially to indicate that a portion of the CFR was left vacant and
not accidentally dropped due to a printing or computer error.
INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE
What is incorporation by reference? Incorporation by reference was
established by statute and allows Federal agencies to meet the
requirement to publish regulations in the Federal Register by referring
to materials already published elsewhere. For an incorporation to be
valid, the Director of the Federal Register must approve it. The legal
effect of incorporation by reference is that the material is treated as
if it were published in full in the Federal Register (5 U.S.C. 552(a)).
This material, like any other properly issued regulation, has the force
of law.
What is a proper incorporation by reference? The Director of the
Federal Register will approve an incorporation by reference only when
the requirements of 1 CFR part 51 are met. Some of the elements on which
approval is based are:
(a) The incorporation will substantially reduce the volume of
material published in the Federal Register.
(b) The matter incorporated is in fact available to the extent
necessary to afford fairness and uniformity in the administrative
process.
(c) The incorporating document is drafted and submitted for
publication in accordance with 1 CFR part 51.
What if the material incorporated by reference cannot be found? If
you have any problem locating or obtaining a copy of material listed as
an approved incorporation by reference, please contact the agency that
issued the regulation containing that incorporation. If, after
contacting the agency, you find the material is not available, please
notify the Director of the Federal Register, National Archives and
Records Administration, 8601 Adelphi Road, College Park, MD 20740-6001,
or call 202-741-6010.
CFR INDEXES AND TABULAR GUIDES
A subject index to the Code of Federal Regulations is contained in a
separate volume, revised annually as of January 1, entitled CFR Index
and Finding Aids. This volume contains the Parallel Table of Authorities
and Rules. A list of CFR titles, chapters, subchapters, and parts and an
alphabetical list of agencies publishing in the CFR are also included in
this volume.
[[Page vii]]
An index to the text of ``Title 3--The President'' is carried within
that volume.
The Federal Register Index is issued monthly in cumulative form.
This index is based on a consolidation of the ``Contents'' entries in
the daily Federal Register.
A List of CFR Sections Affected (LSA) is published monthly, keyed to
the revision dates of the 50 CFR titles.
REPUBLICATION OF MATERIAL
There are no restrictions on the republication of material appearing
in the Code of Federal Regulations.
INQUIRIES
For a legal interpretation or explanation of any regulation in this
volume, contact the issuing agency. The issuing agency's name appears at
the top of odd-numbered pages.
For inquiries concerning CFR reference assistance, call 202-741-6000
or write to the Director, Office of the Federal Register, National
Archives and Records Administration, 8601 Adelphi Road, College Park, MD
20740-6001 or e-mail [email protected].
SALES
The Government Printing Office (GPO) processes all sales and
distribution of the CFR. For payment by credit card, call toll-free,
866-512-1800, or DC area, 202-512-1800, M-F 8 a.m. to 4 p.m. e.s.t. or
fax your order to 202-512-2104, 24 hours a day. For payment by check,
write to: US Government Printing Office - New Orders, P.O. Box 979050,
St. Louis, MO 63197-9000.
ELECTRONIC SERVICES
The full text of the Code of Federal Regulations, the LSA (List of
CFR Sections Affected), The United States Government Manual, the Federal
Register, Public Laws, Public Papers of the Presidents of the United
States, Compilation of Presidential Documents and the Privacy Act
Compilation are available in electronic format via www.ofr.gov. For more
information, contact the GPO Customer Contact Center, U.S. Government
Printing Office. Phone 202-512-1800, or 866-512-1800 (toll-free). E-
mail, [email protected].
The Office of the Federal Register also offers a free service on the
National Archives and Records Administration's (NARA) World Wide Web
site for public law numbers, Federal Register finding aids, and related
information. Connect to NARA's web site at www.archives.gov/federal-
register.
The e-CFR is a regularly updated, unofficial editorial compilation
of CFR material and Federal Register amendments, produced by the Office
of the Federal Register and the Government Printing Office. It is
available at www.ecfr.gov.
Charles A. Barth,
Director,
Office of the Federal Register.
April 1, 2013.
[[Page ix]]
THIS TITLE
Title 26--Internal Revenue is composed of twenty volumes. The
contents of these volumes represent all current regulations issued by
the Internal Revenue Service, Department of the Treasury, as of April 1,
2013. The first thirteen volumes comprise part 1 (Subchapter A--Income
Tax) and are arranged by sections as follows: Sec. Sec. 1.0-1.60;
Sec. Sec. 1.61-1.169; Sec. Sec. 1.170-1.300; Sec. Sec. 1.301-1.400;
Sec. Sec. 1.401-1.440; Sec. Sec. 1.441-1.500; Sec. Sec. 1.501-1.640;
Sec. Sec. 1.641-1.850; Sec. Sec. 1.851-1.907; Sec. Sec. 1.908-1.1000;
Sec. Sec. 1.1001-1.1400; Sec. Sec. 1.1401-1.1550; and Sec. 1.1551 to
end of part 1. The fourteenth volume containing parts 2-29, includes the
remainder of subchapter A and all of Subchapter B--Estate and Gift
Taxes. The last six volumes contain parts 30-39 (Subchapter C--
Employment Taxes and Collection of Income Tax at Source); parts 40-49;
parts 50-299 (Subchapter D--Miscellaneous Excise Taxes); parts 300-499
(Subchapter F--Procedure and Administration); parts 500-599 (Subchapter
G--Regulations under Tax Conventions); and part 600 to end (Subchapter
H--Internal Revenue Practice).
The OMB control numbers for Title 26 appear in Sec. 602.101 of this
chapter. For the convenience of the user, Sec. 602.101 appears in the
Finding Aids section of the volumes containing parts 1 to 599.
For this volume, Jonn V. Lilyea was Chief Editor. The Code of
Federal Regulations publication program is under the direction of
Michael L. White, assisted by Ann Worley.
[[Page 1]]
TITLE 26--INTERNAL REVENUE
(This book contains part 1, Sec. Sec. 1.501 to 1.640)
--------------------------------------------------------------------
Part
chapter i--Internal Revenue Service, Department of the
Treasury (Continued)...................................... 1
[[Page 3]]
CHAPTER I--INTERNAL REVENUE SERVICE, DEPARTMENT OF THE TREASURY
(CONTINUED)
--------------------------------------------------------------------
Editorial Note: IRS published a document at 45 FR 6088, Jan. 25, 1980,
deleting statutory sections from their regulations. In chapter I, cross
references to the deleted material have been changed to the
corresponding sections of the IRS Code of 1954 or to the appropriate
regulations sections. When either such change produced a redundancy, the
cross reference has been deleted. For further explanation, see 45 FR
20795, Mar. 31, 1980.
SUBCHAPTER A--INCOME TAX (CONTINUED)
Part Page
1 Income taxes (Continued).................... 5
Supplementary Publications: Internal Revenue Service Looseleaf
Regulations System.
Additional supplementary publications are issued covering Alcohol and
Tobacco Tax Regulations, and Regulations Under Tax Conventions.
[[Page 5]]
SUBCHAPTER A_INCOME TAX (CONTINUED)
PART 1_INCOME TAXES (CONTINUED)--Table of Contents
Normal Taxes and Surtaxes (Continued)
Exempt Organizations
General Rule
Sec.
1.501(a)-1 Exemption from taxation.
1.501(c)(2)-1 Corporations organized to hold title to property for
exempt organizations.
1.501(c)(3)-1 Organizations organized and operated for religious,
charitable, scientific, testing for public safety, literary,
or educational purposes, or for the prevention of cruelty to
children or animals.
1.501(c)(4)-1 Civic organizations and local associations of employees.
1.501(c)(5)-1 Labor, agricultural, and horticultural organizations.
1.501(c)(6)-1 Business leagues, chambers of commerce, real estate
boards, and boards of trade.
1.501(c)(7)-1 Social clubs.
1.501(c)(8)-1 Fraternal beneficiary societies.
1.501(c)(9)-1 Voluntary employees' beneficiary associations, in general.
1.501(c)(9)-2 Membership in a voluntary employees' beneficiary
association; employees; voluntary association of employees.
1.501(c)(9)-3 Voluntary employees' beneficiary associations; life, sick,
accident, or other benefits.
1.501(c)(9)-4 Voluntary employees' beneficiary associations; inurement.
1.501(c)(9)-5 Voluntary employees' beneficiary associations;
recordkeeping requirements.
1.501(c)(9)-6 Voluntary employees' beneficiary associations; benefits
includible in gross income.
1.501(c)(9)-7 Voluntary employees' beneficiary associations; section
3(4) of ERISA.
1.501(c)(9)-8 Voluntary employees' beneficiary associations; effective
date.
1.501(c)(10)-1 Certain fraternal beneficiary societies.
1.501(c)(12)-1 Local benevolent life insurance associations, mutual
irrigation and telephone companies, and like organizations.
1.501(c)(13)-1 Cemetery companies and crematoria.
1.501(c)(14)-1 Credit unions and mutual insurance funds.
1.501(c)(15)-1 Mutual insurance companies or associations.
1.501(c)(16)-1 Corporations organized to finance crop operations.
1.501(c)(17)-1 Supplemental unemployment benefit trusts.
1.501(c)(17)-2 General rules.
1.501(c)(17)-3 Relation to other sections of the Code.
1.501(c)(18)-1 Certain funded pension trusts.
1.501(c)(19)-1 War veterans organizations.
1.501(c)(21)-1 Black lung trusts--certain terms.
1.501(c)(21)-2 Same--trust instrument.
1.501(c)(29)-1T CO-OP Health Insurance Issuers (temporary).
1.501(d)-1 Religious and apostolic associations or corporations.
1.501(e)-1 Cooperative hospital service organizations.
1.501(h)-1 Application of the expenditure test to expenditures to
influence legislation; introduction.
1.501(h)-2 Electing the expenditure test.
1.501(h)-3 Lobbying or grass roots expenditures normally in excess of
ceiling amount.
1.501(k)-1 Communist-controlled organizations.
1.502-1 Feeder organizations.
1.503(a)-1 Denial of exemption to certain organizations engaged in
prohibited transactions.
1.503(b)-1 Prohibited transactions.
1.503(c)-1 Future status of organizations denied exemption.
1.503(d)-1 Cross references.
1.503(e)-1 Special rules.
1.503(e)-2 Requirements.
1.503(e)-3 Effective dates.
1.503(e)-4 Disallowance of charitable deductions for certain gifts made
before January 1, 1970.
1.503(f)-1 Loans by employers who are prohibited from pledging assets.
1.504-1 Attempts to influence legislation; certain organizations
formerly described in section 501(c)(3) denied exemption.
1.504-2 Certain transfers made to avoid section 504(a).
1.505(c)-1T Questions and answers relating to the notification
requirement for recognition of exemption under paragraphs (9),
(17) and (20) of Section 501(c) (temporary).
Private Foundations
1.507-1 General rule.
1.507-2 Special rules; transfer to, or operation as, public charity.
1.507-3 Special rules; transferee foundations.
1.507-4 Imposition of tax.
1.507-5 Aggregate tax benefit; in general.
1.507-6 Substantial contributor defined.
1.507-7 Value of assets.
1.507-8 Liability in case of transfers.
[[Page 6]]
1.507-9 Abatement of taxes.
1.508-1 Notices.
1.508-2 Disallowance of certain charitable, etc., deductions.
1.508-3 Governing instruments.
1.508-4 Effective date.
1.509(a)-1 Definition of private foundation.
1.509(a)-2 Exclusion for certain organizations described in section
170(b)(1)(A).
1.509(a)-3 Broadly, publicly supported organizations.
1.509(a)-4 Supporting organizations.
1.509(a)-4T Supporting organizations (temporary).
1.509(a)-5 Special rules of attribution.
1.509(a)-6 Classification under section 509(a).
1.509(a)-7 Reliance by grantors and contributors to section 509(a) (1),
(2), and (3) organizations.
1.509(b)-1 Continuation of private foundation status.
1.509(c)-1 Status of organization after termination of private
foundation status.
1.509(d)-1 Definition of support.
1.509(e)-1 Definition of gross investment income.
Taxation of Business Income of Certain Exempt Organizations
1.511-1 Imposition and rates of tax.
1.511-2 Organizations subject to tax.
1.511-3 Provisions generally applicable to the tax on unrelated business
income.
1.511-4 Minimum tax for tax preferences.
1.512(a)-1 Definition.
1.512(a)-2 Definition applicable to taxable years beginning before
December 13, 1967.
1.512(a)-3 [Reserved]
1.512(a)-4 Special rules applicable to war veterans organizations.
1.512(a)-5T Questions and answers relating to the unrelated business
taxable income of organizations described in paragraphs (9),
(17) or (20) of Section 501(c) (temporary).
1.512(b)-1 Modifications.
1.512(c)-1 Special rules applicable to partnerships; in general.
1.513-1 Definition of unrelated trade or business.
1.513-2 Definition of unrelated trade or business applicable to taxable
years beginning before December 13, 1967.
1.513-3 Qualified convention and trade show activity.
1.513-4 Certain sponsorship not unrelated trade or business.
1.513-5 Certain bingo games not unrelated trade or business.
1.513-6 Certain hospital services not unrelated trade or business.
1.513-7 Travel and tour activities of tax exempt organizations.
1.514(a)-1 Unrelated debt-financed income and deductions.
1.514(a)-2 Business lease rents and deductions for taxable years
beginning before January 1, 1970.
1.514(b)-1 Definition of debt-financed property.
1.514(c)-1 Acquisition indebtedness.
1.514(c)-2 Permitted allocations under section 514(c)(9)(E).
1.514(d)-1 Basis of debt-financed property acquired in corporate
liquidation.
1.514(e)-1 Allocation rules.
1.514(f)-1 Definition of business lease.
1.514(g)-1 Business lease indebtedness.
Farmers' Cooperatives
1.521-1 Farmers' cooperative marketing and purchasing associations;
requirements for exemption under section 521.
1.522-1 Tax treatment of farmers' cooperative marketing and purchasing
associations exempt under section 521.
1.522-2 Manner of taxation of cooperative associations subject to
section 522.
1.522-3 Patronage dividends, rebates, or refunds; treatment as to
cooperative associations entitled to tax treatment under
section 522.
1.522-4 Taxable years affected.
1.527-1 Political organizations; generally.
1.527-2 Definitions.
1.527-3 Exempt function income.
1.527-4 Special rules for computation of political organization taxable
income.
1.527-5 Activities resulting in gross income to an individual or
political organization.
1.527-6 Inclusion of certain amounts in the gross income of an exempt
organization which is not a political organization.
1.527-7 Newsletter funds.
1.527-8 Effective date; filing requirements; and miscellaneous
provisions.
1.527-9 Special rule for principal campaign committees.
Homeowners Associations
1.528-1 Homeowners associations.
1.528-2 Organized and operated to provide for the acquisition,
construction, management, maintenance and care of association
property.
1.528-3 Association property.
1.528-4 Substantiality test.
1.528-5 Source of income test.
1.528-6 Expenditure test.
1.528-7 Inurement.
1.528-8 Election to be treated as a homeowners association.
1.528-9 Exempt function income.
1.528-10 Special rules for computation of homeowners association taxable
income and tax.
[[Page 7]]
Corporations Used To Avoid Income Tax on Shareholders
Corporations Improperly Accumulating Surplus
1.531-1 Imposition of tax.
1.532-1 Corporations subject to accumulated earnings tax.
1.533-1 Evidence of purpose to avoid income tax.
1.533-2 Statement required.
1.534-1 Burden of proof as to unreasonable accumulations generally.
1.534-2 Burden of proof as to unreasonable accumulations in cases before
the Tax Court.
1.534-3 Jeopardy assessments in Tax Court cases.
1.535-1 Definition.
1.535-2 Adjustments to taxable income.
1.535-3 Accumulated earnings credit.
1.536-1 Short taxable years.
1.537-1 Reasonable needs of the business.
1.537-2 Grounds for accumulation of earnings and profits.
1.537-3 Business of the corporation.
Personal Holding Companies
1.541-1 Imposition of tax.
1.542-1 General rule.
1.542-2 Gross income requirement.
1.542-3 Stock ownership requirement.
1.542-4 Corporations filing consolidated returns.
1.543-1 Personal holding company income.
1.543-2 Limitation on gross income and personal holding company income
in transactions involving stocks, securities, and commodities.
1.544-1 Constructive ownership.
1.544-2 Constructive ownership by reason of indirect ownership.
1.544-3 Constructive ownership by reason of family and partnership
ownership.
1.544-4 Options.
1.544-5 Convertible securities.
1.544-6 Constructive ownership as actual ownership.
1.544-7 Option rule in lieu of family and partnership rule.
1.545-1 Definition.
1.545-2 Adjustments to taxable income.
1.545-3 Special adjustment to taxable income.
1.547-1 General rule.
1.547-2 Requirements for deficiency dividends.
1.547-3 Claim for credit or refund.
1.547-4 Effect on dividends paid deduction.
1.547-5 Deduction denied in case of fraud or wilful failure to file
timely return.
1.547-6 Suspension of statute of limitations and stay of collection.
1.547-7 Effective date.
Foreign Personal Holding Companies
1.551-1 General rule.
1.551-2 Amount included in gross income.
1.551-3 Deduction for obligations of the United States and its
instrumentalities.
1.551-4 Information in return.
1.551-5 Effect on capital account of foreign personal holding company
and basis of stock in hands of shareholders.
1.552-1 Definition of foreign personal holding company.
1.552-2 Gross income requirement.
1.552-3 Stock ownership requirement.
1.552-4 Certain excluded banks.
1.552-5 United States shareholder of excluded bank.
1.553-1 Foreign personal holding company income.
1.554-1 Stock ownership.
1.555-1 General rule.
1.555-2 Additions to gross income.
1.556-1 Definition.
1.556-2 Adjustments to taxable income.
1.556-3 Illustration of computation of undistributed foreign personal
holding company income.
Deduction for Dividends Paid
1.561-1 Deduction for dividends paid.
1.561-2 When dividends are considered paid.
1.562-1 Dividends for which the dividends paid deduction is allowable.
1.562-2 Preferential dividends.
1.562-3 Distributions by a member of an affiliated group.
1.563-1 Accumulated earnings tax.
1.563-2 Personal holding company tax.
1.563-3 Dividends considered as paid on last day of taxable year.
1.564-1 Dividend carryover.
1.565-1 General rule.
1.565-2 Limitations.
1.565-3 Effect of consent.
1.565-4 Consent dividends and other distributions.
1.565-5 Nonresident aliens and foreign corporations.
1.565-6 Definitions.
Banking Institutions
Rules of General Application to Banking Institutions
1.581-1 Banks.
1.581-2 Mutual savings banks, building and loan associations, and
cooperative banks.
1.581-3 Definition of bank prior to September 28, 1962.
1.582-1 Bad debts, losses, and gains with respect to securities held by
financial institutions.
1.584-1 Common trust funds.
1.584-2 Income of participants in common trust fund.
1.584-3 Computation of common trust fund income.
1.584-4 Admission and withdrawal of participants in the common trust
fund.
[[Page 8]]
1.584-5 Returns of banks with respect to common trust funds.
1.584-6 Net operating loss deduction.
1.585-1 Reserve for losses on loans of banks.
1.585-2 Addition to reserve.
1.585-3 Special rules.
1.585-4 Reorganizations and asset acquisitions.
1.585-5 Denial of bad debt reserves for large banks.
1.585-6 Recapture method of changing from the reserve method of section
585.
1.585-7 Elective cut-off method of changing from the reserve method of
section 585.
1.585-8 Rules for making and revoking elections under Sec. Sec. 1.585-6
and 1.585-7.
1.586-1 Reserve for losses on loans of small business investment
companies, etc.
1.586-2 Addition to reserve.
Mutual Savings Banks, Etc.
1.591-1 Deduction for dividends paid on deposits.
1.592-1 Repayment of certain loans by mutual savings banks, building and
loan associations, and cooperative banks.
1.593-1 Additions to reserve for bad debts.
1.593-2 Additions to reserve for bad debts where surplus, reserves, and
undivided profits equal or exceed 12 percent of deposits or
withdrawable accounts.
1.593-3 Taxable years affected.
1.593-4 Organizations to which section 593 applies.
1.593-5 Addition to reserves for bad debts.
1.593-6 Pre-1970 addition to reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans.
1.593-6A Post-1969 addition to reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans.
1.593-7 Establishment and treatment of reserves for bad debts.
1.593-8 Allocation of pre-1952 surplus to opening balance of reserve for
losses on qualifying real property loans.
1.593-10 Certain distributions to shareholders by a domestic building
and loan association.
1.593-11 Qualifying real property loan and nonqualifying loan defined.
1.594-1 Mutual savings banks conducting life insurance business.
1.595-1 Treatment of foreclosed property by certain creditors.
1.596-1 Limitation on dividends received deduction.
1.597-1 Definitions.
1.597-2 Taxation of Federal financial assistance.
1.597-3 Other rules.
1.597-4 Bridge Banks and Agency Control.
1.597-5 Taxable Transfers.
1.597-6 Limitation on collection of income tax.
1.597-7 Effective date.
1.597-8 Transitional rules for Federal financial assistance.
Bank Affiliates
1.601-1 Special deduction for bank affiliates.
Natural Resources
Deductions
1.611-0 Regulatory authority.
1.611-1 Allowance of deduction for depletion.
1.611-2 Rules applicable to mines, oil and gas wells, and other natural
deposits.
1.611-3 Rules applicable to timber.
1.611-4 Depletion as a factor in computing earnings and profits for
dividend purposes.
1.611-5 Depreciation of improvements.
1.612-1 Basis for allowance of cost depletion.
1.612-2 Allowable capital additions in case of mines.
1.612-3 Depletion; treatment of bonus and advanced royalty.
1.612-4 Charges to capital and to expense in case of oil and gas wells.
1.612-5 Charges to capital and to expense in case of geothermal wells.
1.613-1 Percentage depletion; general rule.
1.613-2 Percentage depletion rates.
1.613-3 Gross income from the property.
1.613-4 Gross income from the property in the case of minerals other
than oil and gas.
1.613-5 Taxable income from the property.
1.613-6 Statement to be attached to return when depletion is claimed on
percentage basis.
1.613-7 Application of percentage depletion rates provided in section
613(b) to certain taxable years ending in 1954.
1.613A-0 Limitations on percentage depletion in the case of oil and gas
wells; table of contents.
1.613A-1 Post-1974 limitations on percentage depletion in case of oil
and gas wells; general rule.
1.613A-2 Exemption for certain domestic gas wells.
1.613A-3 Exemption for independent producers and royalty owners.
1.613A-4 Limitations on application of Sec. 1.613A-3 exemption.
1.613A-5 Election under section 613A(c)(4).
1.613A-6 Recordkeeping requirements.
1.613A-7 Definitions.
1.614-0 Introduction.
1.614-1 Definition of property.
1.614-2 Election to aggregate separate operating mineral interests under
section 614(b) prior to its amendment by Revenue Act of 1964.
1.614-3 Rules relating to separate operating mineral interests in the
case of mines.
1.614-4 Treatment under the Internal Revenue Code of 1939 with respect
to separate operating mineral interests for taxable years
beginning before January 1, 1964, in the case of oil and gas
wells.
[[Page 9]]
1.614-5 Special rules as to aggregating nonoperating mineral interests.
1.614-6 Rules applicable to basis, holding period, and abandonment
losses where mineral interests have been aggregated or
combined.
1.614-7 Extension of time for performing certain acts.
1.614-8 Elections with respect to separate operating mineral interests
for taxable years beginning after December 31, 1963, in the
case of oil and gas wells.
1.615-1 Pre-1970 exploration expenditures.
1.615-2 Deduction of pre-1970 exploration expenditures in the year paid
or incurred.
1.615-3 Election to defer pre-1970 exploration expenditures.
1.615-4 Limitation of amount deductible.
1.615-5 Time for making election with respect to returns due on or
before May 2, 1960.
1.615-6 Election to deduct under section 615.
1.615-7 Effect of transfer of mineral property.
1.615-8 Termination of section 615.
1.615-9 Notification under Tax Reform Act of 1969.
1.616-1 Development expenditures.
1.616-2 Election to defer.
1.616-3 Time for making election with respect to returns due on or
before May 2, 1960.
1.617-1 Exploration expenditures.
1.617-2 Limitation on amount deductible.
1.617-3 Recapture of exploration expenditures.
1.617-4 Treatment of gain from disposition of certain mining property.
Exclusions From Gross Income
1.621-1 Payments to encourage exploration, development, and mining for
defense purposes.
Sales and Exchanges
1.631-1 Election to consider cutting as sale or exchange.
1.631-2 Gain or loss upon the disposal of timber under cutting contract.
1.631-3 Gain or loss upon the disposal of coal or domestic iron ore with
a retained economic interest.
1.632-1 Tax on sale of oil or gas properties.
Mineral Production Payments
1.636-1 Treatment of production payments as loans.
1.636-2 Production payments retained in leasing transactions.
1.636-3 Definitions.
1.636-4 Effective dates of section 636.
Continental Shelf Areas
1.638-1 Continental Shelf areas.
1.638-2 Effective date.
1.639-1.640 [Reserved]
Authority: 26 U.S.C. 7805, unless otherwise noted.
Section 1.501(c)(29)-1T also issued under 26 U.S.C.
501(c)(29)(B)(i).
Sections 1.504-1 and 1.504-2 also issued under 26 U.S.C. 504(b).
Section1.514(c)-2 also issued under 26 U.S.C. 514(c)(9)(E)(iii).
Section1.527-9 also issued under 26 U.S.C. 527(h)(2)(B)(i).
Section1.585-5 through 1.585-8 also issued under 26 U.S.C.
585(b)(3).
Section1.597-1 through 1.597-7 also issued under 26 U.S.C. 597 and
1502.
Section1.597-8 also issued under 26 U.S.C. 597.
Source: T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960; 25 FR 14021, Dec. 31,
1960, unless otherwise noted.
Exempt Organizations
General Rule--Table of Contents
Sec. 1.501(a)-1 Exemption from taxation.
(a) In general; proof of exemption. (1) Section 501(a) provides an
exemption from income taxes for organizations which are described in
section 501 (c) or (d) and section 401(a), unless such organization is a
feeder organization (see section 502), or unless it engages in a
transaction described in section 503. However, the exemption does not
extend to unrelated business taxable income of such an organization (see
part III (Section 511 and following), subchapter F, chapter 1 of the
Code).
(2) An organization, other than an employees' trust described in
section 401(a), is not exempt from tax merely because it is not
organized and operated for profit. In order to establish its exemption,
it is necessary that every such organization claiming exemption file an
application form as set forth below with the district director for the
internal revenue district in which is located the principal place of
business or principal office of the organization. Subject only to the
Commissioner's inherent power to revoke rulings because of a change in
the law or regulations or for other good cause, an organization that has
been determined by the Commissioner or the district director to be
exempt under section 501(a) or the corresponding provision of prior law
may rely upon such determination so long as there are no substantial
changes in the organization's character, purposes,
[[Page 10]]
or methods of operation. An organization which has been determined to be
exempt under the provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1939 or
prior law is not required to secure a new determination of exemption
merely because of the enactment of the Internal Revenue Code of 1954
unless affected by substantive changes in law made by such Code.
(3) An organization claiming exemption under section 501(a) and
described in any paragraph of section 501(c) (other than section
501(c)(1) shall file the form of application prescribed by the
Commissioner and shall include thereon such information as required by
such form and the instructions issued with respect thereto. For rules
relating to the obtaining of a determination of exempt status by an
employees' trust described in section 401(a), see the regulations under
section 401.
(b) Additional proof by particular classes of organizations. (1)
Organizations mentioned below shall submit with and as a part of their
applications the following information:
(i) Mutual insurance companies shall submit copies of the policies
or certificates of membership issued by them.
(ii) In the case of title holding companies described in section
501(c)(2), if the organization for which title is held has not been
specifically notified in writing by the Internal Revenue Service that it
is held to be exempt under section 501(a), the title holding company
shall submit the information indicated herein as necessary for a
determination of the status of the organization for which title is held.
(iii) An organization described in section 501(c)(3) shall submit
with, and as a part of, an application filed after July 26, 1959, a
detailed statement of its proposed activities.
(2) In addition to the information specifically called for by this
section, the Commissioner may require any additional information deemed
necessary for a proper determination of whether a particular
organization is exempt under section 501(a), and when deemed advisable
in the interest of an efficient administration of the internal revenue
laws, he may in the cases of particular types of organizations prescribe
the form in which the proof of exemption shall be furnished.
(3) An organization claiming to be specifically exempted by section
6033(a) from filing annual returns shall submit with and as a part of
its application a statement of all the facts on which it bases its
claim.
(c) Private shareholder or individual defined. The words private
shareholder or individual in section 501 refer to persons having a
personal and private interest in the activities of the organization.
(d) Requirement of annual returns. For the annual return
requirements of organizations exempt under section 501(a), see section
6033 and Sec. 1.6033-1.
(e) Certain Puerto Rican pension, etc., trusts. Effective for
taxable years beginning after December 31, 1973, section 1022(i)(1) of
the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (ERISA) (88 Stat.
942) provides that trusts under certain Puerto Rican pension, etc.,
plans (as defined under P.R. Laws Ann. tit. 13, section 3165, and the
articles thereunder), all of the participants of which are residents of
the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico, are to be treated only for purposes of
section 501(a) as trusts described in section 401(a). The practical
effect of section 1022(i)(1) is to exempt these trusts from U.S. income
tax on income from their U.S. investments. For purposes of section
1022(i)(1), the term residents of the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico means
bona fide residents of Puerto Rico, and persons who perform labor or
services primarily within the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico, regardless of
residence for other purposes, and the term participants is restricted to
current employees who are not excluded under the eligibility provisions
of the plan.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 7428, 41 FR
34619, Aug. 16, 1976; T.D. 7859, 47 FR 54298, Dec. 2, 1982]
Sec. 1.501(c)(2)-1 Corporations organized to hold title to property
for exempt organizations.
(a) A corporation described in section 501(c)(2) and otherwise
exempt from tax under section 501(a) is taxable upon its unrelated
business taxable income. For taxable years beginning before January
[[Page 11]]
1, 1970, see Sec. 1.511-2(c)(4). Since a corporation described in
section 501(c)(2) cannot be exempt under section 501(a) if it engages in
any business other than that of holding title to property and collecting
income therefrom, it cannot have unrelated business taxable income as
defined in section 512 other than income which is treated as unrelated
business taxable income solely because of the applicability of section
512(a)(3)(C); or debt financed income which is treated as unrelated
business taxable income solely because of section 514; or certain
interest, annuities, royalties, or rents which are treated as unrelated
business taxable income solely because of section 512(b) (3)(B)(ii) or
(13). Similarly, exempt status under section 501(c)(2) shall not be
affected where certain rents from personal property leased with real
property are treated as unrelated business taxable income under section
512(b)(3)(A)(ii) solely because such rents attributable to such personal
property are more than incidental when compared to the total rents
received or accrued under the lease, or under section 512(b)(3)(B)(i)
solely because such rents attributable to such personal property exceed
50 percent of the total rents received or accrued under the lease.
(b) A corporation described in section 501(c)(2) cannot accumulate
income and retain its exemption, but it must turn over the entire amount
of such income, less expenses, to an organization which is itself exempt
from tax under section 501(a).
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 7658, 45 FR
33972, May 21, 1980]
Sec. 1.501(c)(3)-1 Organizations organized and operated for religious,
charitable, scientific, testing for public safety, literary, or
educational purposes, or for the prevention of cruelty to children
or animals.
(a) Organizational and operational tests. (1) In order to be exempt
as an organization described in section 501(c)(3), an organization must
be both organized and operated exclusively for one or more of the
purposes specified in such section. If an organization fails to meet
either the organizational test or the operational test, it is not
exempt.
(2) The term exempt purpose or purposes, as used in this section,
means any purpose or purposes specified in section 501(c)(3), as defined
and elaborated in paragraph (d) of this section.
(b) Organizational test--(1) In general. (i) An organization is
organized exclusively for one or more exempt purposes only if its
articles of organization (referred to in this section as its articles)
as defined in subparagraph (2) of this paragraph:
(a) Limit the purposes of such organization to one or more exempt
purposes; and
(b) Do not expressly empower the organization to engage, otherwise
than as an insubstantial part of its activities, in activities which in
themselves are not in furtherance of one or more exempt purposes.
(ii) In meeting the organizational test, the organization's
purposes, as stated in its articles, may be as broad as, or more
specific than, the purposes stated in section 501(c)(3). Therefore, an
organization which, by the terms of its articles, is formed for literary
and scientific purposes within the meaning of section 501(c)(3) of the
Code shall, if it otherwise meets the requirements in this paragraph, be
considered to have met the organizational test. Similarly, articles
stating that the organization is created solely to receive contributions
and pay them over to organizations which are described in section
501(c)(3) and exempt from taxation under section 501(a)) are sufficient
for purposes of the organizational test. Moreover, it is sufficient if
the articles set for the purpose of the organization to be the operation
of a school for adult education and describe in detail the manner of the
operation of such school. In addition, if the articles state that the
organization is formed for charitable purposes, such articles ordinarily
shall be sufficient for purposes of the organizational test (see
subparagraph (5) of this paragraph for rules relating to construction of
terms).
(iii) An organization is not organized exclusively for one or more
exempt purposes if its articles expressly empower it to carry on,
otherwise than as an insubstantial part of its activities,
[[Page 12]]
activities which are not in furtherance of one or more exempt purposes,
even though such organization is, by the terms of such articles, created
for a purpose that is no broader than the purposes specified in section
501(c)(3). Thus, an organization that is empowered by its articles to
engage in a manufacturing business, or to engage in the operation of a
social club does not meet the organizational test regardless of the fact
that its articles may state that such organization is created for
charitable purposes within the meaning of section 501(c)(3) of the Code.
(iv) In no case shall an organization be considered to be organized
exclusively for one or more exempt purposes, if, by the terms of its
articles, the purposes for which such organization is created are
broader than the purposes specified in section 501(c)(3). The fact that
the actual operations of such an organization have been exclusively in
furtherance of one or more exempt purposes shall not be sufficient to
permit the organization to meet the organizational test. Similarly, such
an organization will not meet the organizational test as a result of
statements or other evidence that the members thereof intend to operate
only in furtherance of one or more exempt purposes.
(v) An organization must, in order to establish its exemption,
submit a detailed statement of its proposed activities with and as a
part of its application for exemption (see paragraph (b) of Sec.
1.501(a)-1).
(2) Articles of organization. For purposes of this section, the term
articles of organization or articles includes the trust instrument, the
corporate charter, the articles of association, or any other written
instrument by which an organization is created.
(3) Authorization of legislative or political activities. An
organization is not organized exclusively for one or more exempt
purposes if its articles expressly empower it:
(i) To devote more than an insubstantial part of its activities to
attempting to influence legislation by propaganda or otherwise; or
(ii) Directly or indirectly to participate in, or intervene in
(including the publishing or distributing of statements), any political
campaign on behalf of or in opposition to any candidate for public
office; or
(iii) To have objectives and to engage in activities which
characterize it as an action organization as defined in paragraph (c)(3)
of this section.
The terms used in subdivisions (i), (ii), and (iii) of this subparagraph
shall have the meanings provided in paragraph (c)(3) of this section. An
organization's articles will not violate the provisions of paragraph
(b)(3)(i) of this section even though the organization's articles
expressly empower it to make the election provided for in section 501(h)
with respect to influencing legislation and, only if it so elects, to
make lobbying or grass roots expenditures that do not normally exceed
the ceiling amounts prescribed by section 501(h)(2) (B) and (D).
(4) Distribution of assets on dissolution. An organization is not
organized exclusively for one or more exempt purposes unless its assets
are dedicated to an exempt purpose. An organization's assets will be
considered dedicated to an exempt purpose, for example, if, upon
dissolution, such assets would, by reason of a provision in the
organization's articles or by operation of law, be distributed for one
or more exempt purposes, or to the Federal Government, or to a State or
local government, for a public purpose, or would be distributed by a
court to another organization to be used in such manner as in the
judgment of the court will best accomplish the general purposes for
which the dissolved organization was organized. However, an organization
does not meet the organizational test if its articles or the law of the
State in which it was created provide that its assets would, upon
dissolution, be distributed to its members or shareholders.
(5) Construction of terms. The law of the State in which an
organization is created shall be controlling in construing the terms of
its articles. However, any organization which contends that such terms
have under State law a different meaning from their generally accepted
meaning must establish such special meaning by clear and convincing
reference to relevant court decisions, opinions of the State attorney-
[[Page 13]]
general, or other evidence of applicable State law.
(6) Applicability of the organizational test. A determination by the
Commissioner or a district director that an organization is described in
section 501(c)(3) and exempt under section 501(a) will not be granted
after July 26, 1959 (regardless of when the application is filed),
unless such organization meets the organizational test prescribed by
this paragraph. If, before July 27, 1959, an organization has been
determined by the Commissioner or district director to be exempt as an
organization described in section 501(c)(3) or in a corresponding
provision of prior law and such determination has not been revoked
before such date, the fact that such organization does not meet the
organizational test prescribed by this paragraph shall not be a basis
for revoking such determination. Accordingly, an organization which has
been determined to be exempt before July 27, 1959, and which does not
seek a new determination of exemption is not required to amend its
articles of organization to conform to the rules of this paragraph, but
any organization which seeks a determination of exemption after July 26,
1959, must have articles of organization which meet the rules of this
paragraph. For the rules relating to whether an organization determined
to be exempt before July 27, 1959, is organized exclusively for one or
more exempt purposes, see 26 CFR (1939) 39.101(6)-1 (Regulations 118) as
made applicable to the Code by Treasury Decision 6091, approved August
16, 1954 (19 FR 5167; C.B. 1954-2, 47).
(c) Operational test--(1) Primary activities. An organization will
be regarded as operated exclusively for one or more exempt purposes only
if it engages primarily in activities which accomplish one or more of
such exempt purposes specified in section 501(c)(3). An organization
will not be so regarded if more than an insubstantial part of its
activities is not in furtherance of an exempt purpose.
(2) Distribution of earnings. An organization is not operated
exclusively for one or more exempt purposes if its net earnings inure in
whole or in part to the benefit of private shareholders or individuals.
For the definition of the words private shareholder or individual, see
paragraph (c) of Sec. 1.501(a)-1.
(3) Action organizations. (i) An organization is not operated
exclusively for one or more exempt purposes if it is an action
organization as defined in subdivisions (ii), (iii), or (iv) of this
subparagraph.
(ii) An organization is an action organization if a substantial part
of its activities is attempting to influence legislation by propaganda
or otherwise. For this purpose, an organization will be regarded as
attempting to influence legislation if the organization:
(a) Contacts, or urges the public to contact, members of a
legislative body for the purpose of proposing, supporting, or opposing
legislation; or
(b) Advocates the adoption or rejection of legislation.
The term legislation, as used in this subdivision, includes action by
the Congress, by any State legislature, by any local council or similar
governing body, or by the public in a referendum, initiative,
constitutional amendment, or similar procedure. An organization will not
fail to meet the operational test merely because it advocates, as an
insubstantial part of its activities, the adoption or rejection of
legislation. An organization for which the expenditure test election of
section 501(h) is in effect for a taxable year will not be considered an
action organization by reason of this paragraph (c)(3)(ii) for that year
if it is not denied exemption from taxation under section 501(a) by
reason of section 501(h).
(iii) An organization is an action organization if it participates
or intervenes, directly or indirectly, in any political campaign on
behalf of or in opposition to any candidate for public office.
The term candidate for public office means an individual who offers
himself, or is proposed by others, as a contestant for an elective
public office, whether such office be national, State, or local.
Activities which constitute participation or intervention in a political
campaign on behalf of or in opposition to a candidate include, but are
not limited to, the publication or distribution of written or printed
statements or the making of oral statements on
[[Page 14]]
behalf of or in opposition to such a candidate.
(iv) An organization is an action organization if it has the
following two characteristics: (a) Its main or primary objective or
objectives (as distinguished from its incidental or secondary
objectives) may be attained only by legislation or a defeat of proposed
legislation; and (b) it advocates, or campaigns for, the attainment of
such main or primary objective or objectives as distinguished from
engaging in nonpartisan analysis, study, or research and making the
results thereof available to the public. In determining whether an
organization has such characteristics, all the surrounding facts and
circumstances, including the articles and all activities of the
organization, are to be considered.
(v) An action organization, described in subdivisions (ii) or (iv)
of this subparagraph, though it cannot qualify under section 501(c)(3),
may nevertheless qualify as a social welfare organization under section
501(c)(4) if it meets the requirements set out in paragraph (a) of Sec.
1.501(c)(4)-1.
(d) Exempt purposes--(1) In general. (i) An organization may be
exempt as an organization described in section 501(c)(3) if it is
organized and operated exclusively for one or more of the following
purposes:
(a) Religious,
(b) Charitable,
(c) Scientific,
(d) Testing for public safety,
(e) Literary,
(f) Educational, or
(g) Prevention of cruelty to children or animals.
(ii) An organization is not organized or operated exclusively for
one or more of the purposes specified in subdivision (i) of this
subparagraph unless it serves a public rather than a private interest.
Thus, to meet the requirement of this subdivision, it is necessary for
an organization to establish that it is not organized or operated for
the benefit of private interests such as designated individuals, the
creator or his family, shareholders of the organization, or persons
controlled, directly or indirectly, by such private interests.
(iii) Examples. The following examples illustrate the requirement of
paragraph (d)(1)(ii) of this section that an organization serve a public
rather than a private interest:
Example 1. (i) O is an educational organization the purpose of which
is to study history and immigration. O's educational activities include
sponsoring lectures and publishing a journal. The focus of O's
historical studies is the genealogy of one family, tracing the descent
of its present members. O actively solicits for membership only
individuals who are members of that one family. O's research is directed
toward publishing a history of that family that will document the
pedigrees of family members. A major objective of O's research is to
identify and locate living descendants of that family to enable those
descendants to become acquainted with each other.
(ii) O's educational activities primarily serve the private
interests of members of a single family rather than a public interest.
Therefore, O is operated for the benefit of private interests in
violation of the restriction on private benefit in paragraph (d)(1)(ii)
of this section. Based on these facts and circumstances, O is not
operated exclusively for exempt purposes and, therefore, is not
described in section 501(c)(3).
Example 2. (i) O is an art museum. O's principal activity is
exhibiting art created by a group of unknown but promising local
artists. O's activity, including organized tours of its art collection,
promotes the arts. O is governed by a board of trustees unrelated to the
artists whose work O exhibits. All of the art exhibited is offered for
sale at prices set by the artist. Each artist whose work is exhibited
has a consignment arrangement with O. Under this arrangement, when art
is sold, the museum retains 10 percent of the selling price to cover the
costs of operating the museum and gives the artist 90 percent.
(ii) The artists in this situation directly benefit from the
exhibition and sale of their art. As a result, the principal activity of
O serves the private interests of these artists. Because O gives 90
percent of the proceeds from its sole activity to the individual
artists, the direct benefits to the artists are substantial and O's
provision of these benefits to the artists is more than incidental to
its other purposes and activities. This arrangement causes O to be
operated for the benefit of private interests in violation of the
restriction on private benefit in paragraph (d)(1)(ii) of this section.
Based on these facts and circumstances, O is not operated exclusively
for exempt purposes and, therefore, is not described in section
501(c)(3).
Example 3. (i) O is an educational organization the purpose of which
is to train individuals in a program developed by P, O's president. The
program is of interest to academics and professionals, representatives
of whom serve on an advisory panel to O. All of
[[Page 15]]
the rights to the program are owned by Company K, a for-profit
corporation owned by P. Prior to the existence of O, the teaching of the
program was conducted by Company K. O licenses, from Company K, the
right to conduct seminars and lectures on the program and to use the
name of the program as part of O's name, in exchange for specified
royalty payments. Under the license agreement, Company K provides O with
the services of trainers and with course materials on the program. O may
develop and copyright new course materials on the program but all such
materials must be assigned to Company K without consideration if and
when the license agreement is terminated. Company K sets the tuition for
the seminars and lectures on the program conducted by O. O has agreed
not to become involved in any activity resembling the program or its
implementation for 2 years after the termination of O's license
agreement.
(ii) O's sole activity is conducting seminars and lectures on the
program. This arrangement causes O to be operated for the benefit of P
and Company K in violation of the restriction on private benefit in
paragraph (d)(1)(ii) of this section, regardless of whether the royalty
payments from O to Company K for the right to teach the program are
reasonable. Based on these facts and circumstances, O is not operated
exclusively for exempt purposes and, therefore, is not described in
section 501(c)(3).
(iv) Since each of the purposes specified in subdivision (i) of this
subparagraph is an exempt purpose in itself, an organization may be
exempt if it is organized and operated exclusively for any one or more
of such purposes. If, in fact, an organization is organized and operated
exclusively for an exempt purpose or purposes, exemption will be granted
to such an organization regardless of the purpose or purposes specified
in its application for exemption. For example, if an organization claims
exemption on the ground that it is educational, exemption will not be
denied if, in fact, it is charitable.
(2) Charitable defined. The term charitable is used in section
501(c)(3) in its generally accepted legal sense and is, therefore, not
to be construed as limited by the separate enumeration in section
501(c)(3) of other tax-exempt purposes which may fall within the broad
outlines of charity as developed by judicial decisions. Such term
includes: Relief of the poor and distressed or of the underprivileged;
advancement of religion; advancement of education or science; erection
or maintenance of public buildings, monuments, or works; lessening of
the burdens of Government; and promotion of social welfare by
organizations designed to accomplish any of the above purposes, or (i)
to lessen neighborhood tensions; (ii) to eliminate prejudice and
discrimination; (iii) to defend human and civil rights secured by law;
or (iv) to combat community deterioration and juvenile delinquency. The
fact that an organization which is organized and operated for the relief
of indigent persons may receive voluntary contributions from the persons
intended to be relieved will not necessarily prevent such organization
from being exempt as an organization organized and operated exclusively
for charitable purposes. The fact that an organization, in carrying out
its primary purpose, advocates social or civic changes or presents
opinion on controversial issues with the intention of molding public
opinion or creating public sentiment to an acceptance of its views does
not preclude such organization from qualifying under section 501(c)(3)
so long as it is not an action organization of any one of the types
described in paragraph (c)(3) of this section.
(3) Educational defined--(i) In general. The term educational, as
used in section 501(c)(3), relates to:
(a) The instruction or training of the individual for the purpose of
improving or developing his capabilities; or
(b) The instruction of the public on subjects useful to the
individual and beneficial to the community.
An organization may be educational even though it advocates a particular
position or viewpoint so long as it presents a sufficiently full and
fair exposition of the pertinent facts as to permit an individual or the
public to form an independent opinion or conclusion. On the other hand,
an organization is not educational if its principal function is the mere
presentation of unsupported opinion.
(ii) Examples of educational organizations. The following are
examples of organizations which, if they otherwise meet the requirements
of this section, are educational:
Example 1. An organization, such as a primary or secondary school, a
college, or a
[[Page 16]]
professional or trade school, which has a regularly scheduled
curriculum, a regular faculty, and a regularly enrolled body of students
in attendance at a place where the educational activities are regularly
carried on.
Example 2. An organization whose activities consist of presenting
public discussion groups, forums, panels, lectures, or other similar
programs. Such programs may be on radio or television.
Example 3. An organization which presents a course of instruction by
means of correspondence or through the utilization of television or
radio.
Example 4. useums, zoos, planetariums, symphony orchestras, and
other similar organizations.
(4) Testing for public safety defined. The term testing for public
safety, as used in section 501(c)(3), includes the testing of consumer
products, such as electrical products, to determine whether they are
safe for use by the general public.
(5) Scientific defined. (i) Since an organization may meet the
requirements of section 501(c)(3) only if it serves a public rather than
a private interest, a scientific organization must be organized and
operated in the public interest (see subparagraph (1)(ii) of this
paragraph). Therefore, the term scientific, as used in section
501(c)(3), includes the carrying on of scientific research in the public
interest. Research when taken alone is a word with various meanings; it
is not synonymous with scientific; and the nature of particular research
depends upon the purpose which it serves. For research to be scientific,
within the meaning of section 501(c)(3), it must be carried on in
furtherance of a scientific purpose. The determination as to whether
research is scientific does not depend on whether such research is
classified as fundamental or basic as contrasted with applied or
practical. On the other hand, for purposes of the exclusion from
unrelated business taxable income provided by section 512(b)(9), it is
necessary to determine whether the organization is operated primarily
for purposes of carrying on fundamental, as contrasted with applied,
research.
(ii) Scientific research does not include activities of a type
ordinarily carried on as an incident to commercial or industrial
operations, as, for example, the ordinary testing or inspection of
materials or products or the designing or construction of equipment,
buildings, etc.
(iii) Scientific research will be regarded as carried on in the
public interest:
(a) If the results of such research (including any patents,
copyrights, processes, or formulae resulting from such research) are
made available to the public on a nondiscriminatory basis;
(b) If such research is performed for the United States, or any of
its agencies or instrumentalities, or for a State or political
subdivision thereof; or
(c) If such research is directed toward benefiting the public. The
following are examples of scientific research which will be considered
as directed toward benefiting the public, and, therefore, which will be
regarded as carried on in the public interest: (1) Scientific research
carried on for the purpose of aiding in the scientific education of
college or university students; (2) scientific research carried on for
the purpose of obtaining scientific information, which is published in a
treatise, thesis, trade publication, or in any other form that is
available to the interested public; (3) scientific research carried on
for the purpose of discovering a cure for a disease; or (4) scientific
research carried on for the purpose of aiding a community or
geographical area by attracting new industry to the community or area or
by encouraging the development of, or retention of, an industry in the
community or area. Scientific research described in this subdivision
will be regarded as carried on in the public interest even though such
research is performed pursuant to a contract or agreement under which
the sponsor or sponsors of the research have the right to obtain
ownership or control of any patents, copyrights, processes, or formulae
resulting from such research.
(iv) An organization will not be regarded as organized and operated
for the purpose of carrying on scientific research in the public
interest and, consequently, will not qualify under section 501(c)(3) as
a scientific organization, if:
(a) Such organization will perform research only for persons which
are (directly or indirectly) its creators and
[[Page 17]]
which are not described in section 501(c)(3), or
(b) Such organization retains (directly or indirectly) the ownership
or control of more than an insubstantial portion of the patents,
copyrights, processes, or formulae resulting from its research and does
not make such patents, copyrights, processes, or formulae available to
the public. For purposes of this subdivision, a patent, copyright,
process, or formula shall be considered as made available to the public
if such patent, copyright, process, or formula is made available to the
public on a nondiscriminatory basis. In addition, although one person is
granted the exclusive right to the use of a patent, copyright, process,
or formula, such patent, copyright, process, or formula shall be
considered as made available to the public if the granting of such
exclusive right is the only practicable manner in which the patent,
copyright, process, or formula can be utilized to benefit the public. In
such a case, however, the research from which the patent, copyright,
process, or formula resulted will be regarded as carried on in the
public interest (within the meaning of subdivision (iii) of this
subparagraph) only if it is carried on for a person described in
subdivision (iii)(b) of this subparagraph or if it is scientific
research described in subdivision (iii)(c) of this subparagraph.
(v) The fact that any organization (including a college, university,
or hospital) carries on research which is not in furtherance of an
exempt purpose described in section 501(c)(3) will not preclude such
organization from meeting the requirements of section 501(c)(3) so long
as the organization meets the organizational test and is not operated
for the primary purpose of carrying on such research (see paragraph (e)
of this section, relating to organizations carrying on a trade or
business). See paragraph (a)(5) of Sec. 1.513-2, with respect to
research which constitutes an unrelated trade or business, and section
512(b) (7), (8), and (9), with respect to income derived from research
which is excludable from the tax on unrelated business income.
(vi) The regulations in this subparagraph are applicable with
respect to taxable years beginning after December 31, 1960.
(e) Organizations carrying on trade or business--(1) In general. An
organization may meet the requirements of section 501(c)(3) although it
operates a trade or business as a substantial part of its activities, if
the operation of such trade or business is in furtherance of the
organization's exempt purpose or purposes and if the organization is not
organized or operated for the primary purpose of carrying on an
unrelated trade or business, as defined in section 513. In determining
the existence or nonexistence of such primary purpose, all the
circumstances must be considered, including the size and extent of the
trade or business and the size and extent of the activities which are in
furtherance of one or more exempt purposes. An organization which is
organized and operated for the primary purpose of carrying on an
unrelated trade or business is not exempt under section 501(c)(3) even
though it has certain religious purposes, its property is held in
common, and its profits do not inure to the benefit of individual
members of the organization. See, however, section 501(d) and Sec.
1.501(d)-1, relating to religious and apostolic organizations.
(2) Taxation of unrelated business income. For provisions relating
to the taxation of unrelated business income of certain organizations
described in section 501(c)(3), see sections 511 to 515, inclusive, and
the regulations thereunder.
(f) Interaction with section 4958--(1) Application process. An
organization that applies for recognition of exemption under section
501(a) as an organization described in section 501(c)(3) must establish
its eligibility under this section. The Commissioner may deny an
application for exemption for failure to establish any of section
501(c)(3)'s requirements for exemption. Section 4958 does not apply to
transactions with an organization that has failed to establish that it
satisfies all of the requirements for exemption under section 501(c)(3).
See Sec. 53.4958-2.
(2) Substantive requirements for exemption still apply to applicable
tax-exempt organizations described in section 501(c)(3)--(i) In general.
Regardless of whether a particular transaction is
[[Page 18]]
subject to excise taxes under section 4958, the substantive requirements
for tax exemption under section 501(c)(3) still apply to an applicable
tax-exempt organization (as defined in section 4958(e) and Sec.
53.4958-2) described in section 501(c)(3) whose disqualified persons or
organization managers are subject to excise taxes under section 4958.
Accordingly, an organization will no longer meet the requirements for
tax-exempt status under section 501(c)(3) if the organization fails to
satisfy the requirements of paragraph (b), (c) or (d) of this section.
See Sec. 53.4958-8(a).
(ii) Determination of whether revocation of tax-exempt status is
appropriate when section 4958 excise taxes also apply. In determining
whether to continue to recognize the tax-exempt status of an applicable
tax-exempt organization (as defined in section 4958(e) and Sec.
53.4958-2) described in section 501(c)(3) that engages in one or more
excess benefit transactions (as defined in section 4958(c) and Sec.
53.4958-4) that violate the prohibition on inurement under section
501(c)(3), the Commissioner will consider all relevant facts and
circumstances, including, but not limited to, the following--
(A) The size and scope of the organization's regular and ongoing
activities that further exempt purposes before and after the excess
benefit transaction or transactions occurred;
(B) The size and scope of the excess benefit transaction or
transactions (collectively, if more than one) in relation to the size
and scope of the organization's regular and ongoing activities that
further exempt purposes;
(C) Whether the organization has been involved in multiple excess
benefit transactions with one or more persons;
(D) Whether the organization has implemented safeguards that are
reasonably calculated to prevent excess benefit transactions; and
(E) Whether the excess benefit transaction has been corrected
(within the meaning of section 4958(f)(6) and Sec. 53.4958-7), or the
organization has made good faith efforts to seek correction from the
disqualified person(s) who benefited from the excess benefit
transaction.
(iii) All factors will be considered in combination with each other.
Depending on the particular situation, the Commissioner may assign
greater or lesser weight to some factors than to others. The factors
listed in paragraphs (f)(2)(ii)(D) and (E) of this section will weigh
more heavily in favor of continuing to recognize exemption where the
organization discovers the excess benefit transaction or transactions
and takes action before the Commissioner discovers the excess benefit
transaction or transactions. Further, with respect to the factor listed
in paragraph (f)(2)(ii)(E) of this section, correction after the excess
benefit transaction or transactions are discovered by the Commissioner,
by itself, is never a sufficient basis for continuing to recognize
exemption.
(iv) Examples. The following examples illustrate the principles of
paragraph (f)(2)(ii) of this section. For purposes of each example,
assume that O is an applicable tax-exempt organization (as defined in
section 4958(e) and Sec. 53.4958-2) described in section 501(c)(3). The
examples read as follows:
Example 1. (i) O was created as a museum for the purpose of
exhibiting art to the general public. In Years 1 and 2, O engages in
fundraising and in selecting, leasing, and preparing an appropriate
facility for a museum. In Year 3, a new board of trustees is elected.
All of the new trustees are local art dealers. Beginning in Year 3 and
continuing to the present, O uses a substantial portion of its revenues
to purchase art solely from its trustees at prices that exceed fair
market value. O exhibits and offers for sale all of the art it
purchases. O's Form 1023, ``Application for Recognition of Exemption,''
did not disclose the possibility that O would purchase art from its
trustees.
(ii) O's purchases of art from its trustees at more than fair market
value constitute excess benefit transactions between an applicable tax-
exempt organization and disqualified persons under section 4958.
Therefore, these transactions are subject to the applicable excise taxes
provided in that section. In addition, O's purchases of art from its
trustees at more than fair market value violate the proscription against
inurement under section 501(c)(3) and paragraph (c)(2) of this section.
(iii) The application of the factors in paragraph (f)(2)(ii) of this
section to these facts is as follows. Beginning in Year 3, O does not
engage primarily in regular and ongoing activities that further exempt
purposes because a substantial portion of O's activities
[[Page 19]]
consists of purchasing art from its trustees and dealing in such art in
a manner similar to a commercial art gallery. The size and scope of the
excess benefit transactions collectively are significant in relation to
the size and scope of any of O's ongoing activities that further exempt
purposes. O has been involved in multiple excess benefit transactions,
namely, purchases of art from its trustees at more than fair market
value. O has not implemented safeguards that are reasonably calculated
to prevent such improper purchases in the future. The excess benefit
transactions have not been corrected, nor has O made good faith efforts
to seek correction from the disqualified persons who benefited from the
excess benefit transactions (the trustees). The trustees continue to
control O's Board. Based on the application of the factors to these
facts, O is no longer described in section 501(c)(3) effective in Year
3.
Example 2. (i) The facts are the same as in Example 1, except that
in Year 4, O's entire board of trustees resigns, and O no longer offers
all exhibited art for sale. The former board is replaced with members of
the community who are not in the business of buying or selling art and
who have skills and experience running charitable and educational
programs and institutions. O promptly discontinues the practice of
purchasing art from current or former trustees, adopts a written
conflicts of interest policy, adopts written art valuation guidelines,
hires legal counsel to recover the excess amounts O had paid its former
trustees, and implements a new program of activities to further the
public's appreciation of the arts.
(ii) O's purchases of art from its former trustees at more than fair
market value constitute excess benefit transactions between an
applicable tax-exempt organization and disqualified persons under
section 4958. Therefore, these transactions are subject to the
applicable excise taxes provided in that section. In addition, O's
purchases of art from its trustees at more than fair market value
violate the proscription against inurement under section 501(c)(3) and
paragraph (c)(2) of this section.
(iii) The application of the factors in paragraph (f)(2)(ii) of this
section to these facts is as follows. In Year 3, O does not engage
primarily in regular and ongoing activities that further exempt
purposes. However, in Year 4, O elects a new board of trustees comprised
of individuals who have skills and experience running charitable and
educational programs and implements a new program of activities to
further the public's appreciation of the arts. As a result of these
actions, beginning in Year 4, O engages in regular and ongoing
activities that further exempt purposes. The size and scope of the
excess benefit transactions that occurred in Year 3, taken collectively,
are significant in relation to the size and scope of O's regular and
ongoing exempt function activities that were conducted in Year 3.
Beginning in Year 4, however, as O's exempt function activities grow,
the size and scope of the excess benefit transactions that occurred in
Year 3 become less and less significant as compared to the size and
scope of O's regular and ongoing exempt function activities. O was
involved in multiple excess benefit transactions in Year 3. However, by
discontinuing its practice of purchasing art from its current and former
trustees, by replacing its former board with independent members of the
community, and by adopting a conflicts of interest policy and art
valuation guidelines, O has implemented safeguards that are reasonably
calculated to prevent future violations. In addition, O has made a good
faith effort to seek correction from the disqualified persons who
benefited from the excess benefit transactions (its former trustees).
Based on the application of the factors to these facts, O continues to
meet the requirements for tax exemption under section 501(c)(3).
Example 3. (i) O conducts educational programs for the benefit of
the general public. Since its formation, O has employed its founder, C,
as its Chief Executive Officer. Beginning in Year 5 of O's operations
and continuing to the present, C caused O to divert significant portions
of O's funds to pay C's personal expenses. The diversions by C
significantly reduced the funds available to conduct O's ongoing
educational programs. The board of trustees never authorized C to cause
O to pay C's personal expenses from O's funds. Certain members of the
board were aware that O was paying C's personal expenses. However, the
board did not terminate C's employment and did not take any action to
seek repayment from C or to prevent C from continuing to divert O's
funds to pay C's personal expenses. C claimed that O's payments of C's
personal expenses represented loans from O to C. However, no
contemporaneous loan documentation exists, and C never made any payments
of principal or interest.
(ii) The diversions of O's funds to pay C's personal expenses
constitute excess benefit transactions between an applicable tax-exempt
organization and a disqualified person under section 4958. Therefore,
these transactions are subject to the applicable excise taxes provided
in that section. In addition, these transactions violate the
proscription against inurement under section 501(c)(3) and paragraph
(c)(2) of this section.
(iii) The application of the factors in paragraph (f)(2)(ii) of this
section to these facts is as follows. O has engaged in regular and
ongoing activities that further exempt purposes both before and after
the excess benefit transactions occurred. However, the size and
[[Page 20]]
scope of the excess benefit transactions engaged in by O beginning in
Year 5, collectively, are significant in relation to the size and scope
of O's activities that further exempt purposes. Moreover, O has been
involved in multiple excess benefit transactions. O has not implemented
any safeguards that are reasonably calculated to prevent future
diversions. The excess benefit transactions have not been corrected, nor
has O made good faith efforts to seek correction from C, the
disqualified person who benefited from the excess benefit transactions.
Based on the application of the factors to these facts, O is no longer
described in section 501(c)(3) effective in Year 5.
Example 4. (i) O conducts activities that further exempt purposes. O
uses several buildings in the conduct of its exempt activities. In Year
1, O sold one of the buildings to Company K for an amount that was
substantially below fair market value. The sale was a significant event
in relation to O's other activities. C, O's Chief Executive Officer,
owns all of the voting stock of Company K. When O's board of trustees
approved the transaction with Company K, the board did not perform due
diligence that could have made it aware that the price paid by Company K
to acquire the building was below fair market value. Subsequently, but
before the IRS commences an examination of O, O's board of trustees
determines that Company K paid less than the fair market value for the
building. Thus, O concludes that an excess benefit transaction occurred.
After the board makes this determination, it promptly removes C as Chief
Executive Officer, terminates C's employment with O, and hires legal
counsel to recover the excess benefit from Company K. In addition, O
promptly adopts a conflicts of interest policy and new contract review
procedures designed to prevent future recurrences of this problem.
(ii) The sale of the building by O to Company K at less than fair
market value constitutes an excess benefit transaction between an
applicable tax-exempt organization and a disqualified person under
section 4958 in Year 1. Therefore, this transaction is subject to the
applicable excise taxes provided in that section. In addition, this
transaction violates the proscription against inurement under section
501(c)(3) and paragraph (c)(2) of this section.
(iii) The application of the factors in paragraph (f)(2)(ii) of this
section to these facts is as follows. O has engaged in regular and
ongoing activities that further exempt purposes both before and after
the excess benefit transaction occurred. Although the size and scope of
the excess benefit transaction were significant in relation to the size
and scope of O's activities that further exempt purposes, the
transaction with Company K was a one-time occurrence. By adopting a
conflicts of interest policy and new contract review procedures and by
terminating C, O has implemented safeguards that are reasonably
calculated to prevent future violations. Moreover, O took corrective
actions before the IRS commenced an examination of O. In addition, O has
made a good faith effort to seek correction from Company K, the
disqualified person who benefited from the excess benefit transaction.
Based on the application of the factors to these facts, O continues to
be described in section 501(c)(3).
Example 5. (i) O is a large organization with substantial assets and
revenues. O conducts activities that further its exempt purposes. O
employs C as its Chief Financial Officer. During Year 1, O pays $2,500
of C's personal expenses. O does not make these payments pursuant to an
accountable plan, as described in Sec. 53.4958-4(a)(4)(ii). In
addition, O does not report any of these payments on C's Form W-2,
``Wage and Tax Statement,'' or on a Form 1099-MISC, ``Miscellaneous
Income,'' for C for Year 1, and O does not report these payments as
compensation on its Form 990, ``Return of Organization Exempt From
Income Tax,'' for Year 1. Moreover, none of these payments can be
disregarded as nontaxable fringe benefits under Sec. 53.4958-4(c)(2)
and none consisted of fixed payments under an initial contract under
Sec. 53.4958-4(a)(3). C does not report the $2,500 of payments as
income on his individual Federal income tax return for Year 1. O does
not repeat this reporting omission in subsequent years and, instead,
reports all payments of C's personal expenses not made under an
accountable plan as income to C.
(ii) O's payment in Year 1 of $2,500 of C's personal expenses
constitutes an excess benefit transaction between an applicable tax-
exempt organization and a disqualified person under section 4958.
Therefore, this transaction is subject to the applicable excise taxes
provided in that section. In addition, this transaction violates the
proscription against inurement in section 501(c)(3) and paragraph (c)(2)
of this section.
(iii) The application of the factors in paragraph (f)(2)(ii) of this
section to these facts is as follows. O engages in regular and ongoing
activities that further exempt purposes. The payment of $2,500 of C's
personal expenses represented only a de minimis portion of O's assets
and revenues; thus, the size and scope of the excess benefit transaction
were not significant in relation to the size and scope of O's activities
that further exempt purposes. The reporting omission that resulted in
the excess benefit transaction in Year 1 occurred only once and is not
repeated in subsequent years. Based on the application of the factors to
these facts, O continues to be described in section 501(c)(3).
Example 6. (i) O is a large organization with substantial assets and
revenues. O furthers
[[Page 21]]
its exempt purposes by providing social services to the population of a
specific geographic area. O has a sizeable workforce of employees and
volunteers to conduct its work. In Year 1, O's board of directors
adopted written procedures for setting executive compensation at O. O's
executive compensation procedures were modeled on the procedures for
establishing a rebuttable presumption of reasonableness under Sec.
53.4958-6. In accordance with these procedures, the board appointed a
compensation committee to gather data on compensation levels paid by
similarly situated organizations for functionally comparable positions.
The members of the compensation committee were disinterested within the
meaning of Sec. 53.4958-6(c)(1)(iii). Based on its research, the
compensation committee recommended a range of reasonable compensation
for several of O's existing top executives (the Top Executives). On the
basis of the committee's recommendations, the board approved new
compensation packages for the Top Executives and timely documented the
basis for its decision in board minutes. The board members were all
disinterested within the meaning of Sec. 53.4958-6(c)(1)(iii). The Top
Executives were not involved in setting their own compensation. In Year
1, even though payroll expenses represented a significant portion of O's
total operating expenses, the total compensation paid to O's Top
Executives represented only an insubstantial portion of O's total
payroll expenses. During a subsequent examination, the IRS found that
the compensation committee relied exclusively on compensation data from
organizations that perform similar social services to O. The IRS
concluded, however, that the organizations were not similarly situated
because they served substantially larger geographic regions with more
diverse populations and were larger than O in terms of annual revenues,
total operating budget, number of employees, and number of beneficiaries
served. Accordingly, the IRS concluded that the compensation committee
did not rely on ``appropriate data as to comparability'' within the
meaning of Sec. 53.4958-6(c)(2) and, thus, failed to establish the
rebuttable presumption of reasonableness under Sec. 53.4958-6. Taking
O's size and the nature of the geographic area and population it serves
into account, the IRS concluded that the Top Executives' compensation
packages for Year 1 were excessive. As a result of the examination, O's
board added new members to the compensation committee who have expertise
in compensation matters and also amended its written procedures to
require the compensation committee to evaluate a number of specific
factors, including size, geographic area, and population covered by the
organization, in assessing the comparability of compensation data. O's
board renegotiated the Top Executives' contracts in accordance with the
recommendations of the newly constituted compensation committee on a
going forward basis. To avoid potential liability for damages under
state contract law, O did not seek to void the Top Executives'
employment contracts retroactively to Year 1 and did not seek correction
of the excess benefit amounts from the Top Executives. O did not
terminate any of the Top Executives.
(ii) O's payments of excessive compensation to the Top Executives in
Year 1 constituted excess benefit transactions between an applicable
tax-exempt organization and disqualified persons under section 4958.
Therefore, these payments are subject to the applicable excise taxes
provided under that section, including second-tier taxes if there is no
correction by the disqualified persons. In addition, these payments
violate the proscription against inurement under section 501(c)(3) and
paragraph (c)(2) of this section.
(iii) The application of the factors in paragraph (f)(2)(ii) of this
section to these facts is as follows. O has engaged in regular and
ongoing activities that further exempt purposes both before and after
the excess benefit transactions occurred. The size and scope of the
excess benefit transactions, in the aggregate, were not significant in
relation to the size and scope of O's activities that further exempt
purposes. O engaged in multiple excess benefit transactions.
Nevertheless, prior to entering into these excess benefit transactions,
O had implemented written procedures for setting the compensation of its
top management that were reasonably calculated to prevent the occurrence
of excess benefit transactions. O followed these written procedures in
setting the compensation of the Top Executives for Year 1. Despite the
board's failure to rely on appropriate comparability data, the fact that
O implemented and followed these written procedures in setting the
compensation of the Top Executives for Year 1 is a factor favoring
continued exemption. The fact that O amended its written procedures to
ensure the use of appropriate comparability data and renegotiated the
Top Executives' compensation packages on a going-forward basis are also
factors favoring continued exemption, even though O did not void the Top
Executives' existing contracts and did not seek correction from the Top
Executives. Based on the application of the factors to these facts, O
continues to be described in section 501(c)(3).
(3) Applicability. The rules in paragraph (f) of this section will
apply with respect to excess benefit transactions occurring after March
28, 2008.
(g) Applicability of regulations in this section. The regulations in
this section are, except as otherwise expressly provided, applicable
with respect to taxable years beginning after July 26, 1959. For the
rules applicable with respect to
[[Page 22]]
taxable years beginning before July 27, 1959, see 26 CFR (1939)
39.101(6)-1 (Regulations 118) as made applicable to the Code by Treasury
Decision 6091, approved August 16, 1954 (19 FR 5167; C.B. 1954-2, 47).
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6525, 26 FR
189, Jan. 11, 1961; T.D. 6939, 32 FR 17661, Dec. 12, 1967; T.D. 7428, 41
FR 34620, Aug. 16, 1976; T.D. 8308, 55 FR 35587, Aug. 31, 1990; T.D.
9390, 73 FR 16521, Mar. 28, 2008; T.D. 9390, 73 FR 23069, Apr. 29, 2008]
Sec. 1.501(c)(4)-1 Civic organizations and local associations of
employees.
(a) Civic organizations--(1) In general. A civic league or
organization may be exempt as an organization described in section
501(c)(4) if--
(i) It is not organized or operated for profit; and
(ii) It is operated exclusively for the promotion of social welfare.
(2) Promotion of social welfare--(i) In general. An organization is
operated exclusively for the promotion of social welfare if it is
primarily engaged in promoting in some way the common good and general
welfare of the people of the community. An organization embraced within
this section is one which is operated primarily for the purpose of
bringing about civic betterments and social improvements. A social
welfare organization will qualify for exemption as a charitable
organization if it falls within the definition of charitable set forth
in paragraph (d)(2) of Sec. 1.501(c)(3)-1 and is not an action
organization as set forth in paragraph (c)(3) of Sec. 1.501(c)(3)-1.
(ii) Political or social activities. The promotion of social welfare
does not include direct or indirect participation or intervention in
political campaigns on behalf of or in opposition to any candidate for
public office. Nor is an organization operated primarily for the
promotion of social welfare if its primary activity is operating a
social club for the benefit, pleasure, or recreation of its members, or
is carrying on a business with the general public in a manner similar to
organizations which are operated for profit. See, however, section
501(c)(6) and Sec. 1.501(c)(6)-1, relating to business leagues and
similar organizations. A social welfare organization that is not, at any
time after October 4, 1976, exempt from taxation as an organization
described in section 501(c)(3) may qualify under section 501(c)(4) even
though it is an action organization described in Sec. 1.501(c)(3)-
1(c)(3)(ii) or (iv), if it otherwise qualifies under this section. For
rules relating to an organization that is, after October 4, 1976, exempt
from taxation as an organization described in section 501(c)(3), see
section 504 and Sec. 1.504-1.
(b) Local associations of employees. Local associations of employees
described in section 501(c)(4) are expressly entitled to exemption under
section 501(a). As conditions to exemption, it is required (1) that the
membership of such an association be limited to the employees of a
designated person or persons in a particular municipality, and (2) that
the net earnings of the association be devoted exclusively to
charitable, educational, or recreational purposes. The word local is
defined in paragraph (b) of Sec. 1.501(c)(12)-1. See paragraph (d) (2)
and (3) of Sec. 1.501(c)(3)-1 with reference to the meaning of
charitable and educational as used in this section.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960; 25 FR 14021, Dec. 31, 1960, as
amended by T.D. 8308, 55 FR 35588, Aug. 31, 1990]
Sec. 1.501(c)(5)-1 Labor, agricultural, and horticultural organizations.
(a) The organizations contemplated by section 501(c)(5) as entitled
to exemption from income taxation are those which:
(1) Have no net earnings inuring to the benefit of any member, and
(2) Have as their objects the betterment of the conditions of those
engaged in such pursuits, the improvement of the grade of their
products, and the development of a higher degree of efficiency in their
respective occupations.
(b)(1) General rule. An organization is not an organization
described in section 501(c)(5) if the principal activity of the
organization is to receive, hold, invest, disburse or otherwise manage
funds associated with savings or investment plans or programs, including
pension or other retirement savings plans or programs.
[[Page 23]]
(2) Exception. Paragraph (b)(1) of this section shall not apply to
an organization which--
(i) Is established and maintained by another labor organization
described in section 501(c)(5) (determined without regard to this
paragraph (b)(2));
(ii) Is not directly or indirectly established or maintained in
whole or in part by one or more--
(A) Employers;
(B) Governments or agencies or instrumentalities thereof; or
(C) Government controlled entities;
(iii) Is funded by membership dues from members of the labor
organization described in this paragraph (b)(2) and earnings thereon;
and
(iv) Has not at any time after September 2, 1974 (the date of
enactment of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, Pub.
L. 93-406, 88 Stat. 829) provided for, permitted or accepted employer
contributions.
(3) Example. The principles of this paragraph (b) are illustrated by
the following example:
Example. Trust A is organized in accordance with a collective
bargaining agreement between labor union K and multiple employers. Trust
A forms part of a plan that is established and maintained pursuant to
the agreement and which covers employees of the signatory employers who
are members of K. Representatives of both the employers and K serve as
trustees. A receives contributions from the employers who are subject to
the agreement. Retirement benefits paid to K's members as specified in
the agreement are funded exclusively by the employers' contributions and
accumulated earnings. A also provides information to union members about
their retirement benefits and assists them with administrative tasks
associated with the benefits. Most of A's activities are devoted to
these functions. From time to time, A also participates in the
renegotiation of the collective bargaining agreement. A's principal
activity is to receive, hold, invest, disburse, or otherwise manage
funds associated with a retirement savings plan. In addition, A does not
satisfy all the requirements of the exception described in paragraph
(b)(2) of this section. (For example, A accepts contributions from
employers.) Therefore, A is not a labor organization described in
section 501(c)(5).
(c) Organizations described in section 501(c)(5) and otherwise
exempt from tax under section 501(a) are taxable upon their unrelated
business taxable income. See part II (section 511 and following),
subchapter F, chapter 1 of the Code, and the regulations thereunder.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960; 25 FR 14021, Dec. 31, 1960, as
amended by T.D. 8726, 62 FR 40449, July 29, 1997]
Sec. 1.501(c)(6)-1 Business leagues, chambers of commerce, real estate
boards, and boards of trade.
A business league is an association of persons having some common
business interest, the purpose of which is to promote such common
interest and not to engage in a regular business of a kind ordinarily
carried on for profit. It is an organization of the same general class
as a chamber of commerce or board of trade. Thus, its activities should
be directed to the improvement of business conditions of one or more
lines of business as distinguished from the performance of particular
services for individual persons. An organization whose purpose is to
engage in a regular business of a kind ordinarily carried on for profit,
even though the business is conducted on a cooperative basis or produces
only sufficient income to be self-sustaining, is not a business league.
An association engaged in furnishing information to prospective
investors, to enable them to make sound investments, is not a business
league, since its activities do not further any common business
interest, even though all of its income is devoted to the purpose
stated. A stock or commodity exchange is not a business league, a
chamber of commerce, or a board of trade within the meaning of section
501(c)(6) and is not exempt from tax. Organizations otherwise exempt
from tax under this section are taxable upon their unrelated business
taxable income. See part II (section 511 and following), subchapter F,
chapter 1 of the Code, and the regulations thereunder.
Sec. 1.501(c)(7)-1 Social clubs.
(a) The exemption provided by section 501(a) for organizations
described in section 501(c)(7) applies only to clubs which are organized
and operated exclusively for pleasure, recreation, and other
nonprofitable purposes, but does not apply to any club if any part of
its net earnings inures to the benefit of any private shareholder. In
general, this exemption extends to social and
[[Page 24]]
recreation clubs which are supported solely by membership fees, dues,
and assessments. However, a club otherwise entitled to exemption will
not be disqualified because it raises revenue from members through the
use of club facilities or in connection with club activities.
(b) A club which engages in business, such as making its social and
recreational facilities available to the general public or by selling
real estate, timber, or other products, is not organized and operated
exclusively for pleasure, recreation, and other nonprofitable purposes,
and is not exempt under section 501(a). Solicitation by advertisement or
otherwise for public patronage of its facilities is prima facie evidence
that the club is engaging in business and is not being operated
exclusively for pleasure, recreation, or social purposes. However, an
incidental sale of property will not deprive a club of its exemption.
Sec. 1.501(c)(8)-1 Fraternal beneficiary societies.
(a) A fraternal beneficiary society is exempt from tax only if
operated under the lodge system or for the exclusive benefit of the
members so operating. Operating under the lodge system means carrying on
its activities under a form of organization that comprises local
branches, chartered by a parent organization and largely self-governing,
called lodges, chapters, or the like. In order to be exempt it is also
necessary that the society have an established system for the payment to
its members or their dependents of life, sick, accident, or other
benefits.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 7061, 35 FR
14770, Sept. 23, 1970]
Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-1 Voluntary employees' beneficiary associations, in
general.
To be described in section 501(c)(9) an organization must meet all
of the following requirements:
(a) The organization is an employees' association,
(b) Membership in the association is voluntary,
(c) The organization provides for the payment of life, sick,
accident, or other benefits to its members or their dependents or
designated beneficiaries, and substantially all of its operations are in
furtherance of providing such benefits, and
(d) No part of the net earnings of the organization inures, other
than by payment of the benefits referred to in paragraph (c) of this
section, to the benefit of any private shareholder or individual.
[T.D. 7750, 45 FR 1721, Jan. 7, 1981]
Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-2 Membership in a voluntary employees' beneficiary
association; employees; voluntary association of employees.
(a) Membership--(1) In general. The membership of an organization
described in section 501(c)(9) must consist of individuals who become
entitled to participate by reason of their being employees and whose
eligibility for membership is defined by reference to objective
standards that constitute an employment-related common bond among such
individuals. Typically, those eligible for membership in an organization
described in section 501(c)(9) are defined by reference to a common
employer (or affiliated employers), to coverage under one or more
collective bargaining agreements (with respect to benefits provided by
reason of such agreement(s)), to membership in a labor union, or to
membership in one or more locals of a national or international labor
union. For example, membership in an association might be open to all
employees of a particular employer, or to employees in specified job
classifications working for certain employers at specified locations and
who are entitled to benefits by reason of one or more collective
bargaining agreements. In addition, employees of one or more employers
engaged in the same line of business in the same geographic locale will
be considered to share an employment-related bond for purposes of an
organization through which their employers provide benefits. Employees
of a labor union also will be considered to share an employment-related
common bond with members of the union, and employees of an association
will be considered to share an employment-related common bond with
members of the association. Whether a
[[Page 25]]
group of individuals is defined by reference to a permissible standard
or standards is a question to be determined with regard to all the facts
and circumstances, taking into account the guidelines set forth in this
paragraph. Exemption will not be denied merely because the membership of
an association includes some individuals who are not employees (within
the meaning of paragraph (b) of this section), provided that such
individuals share an employment-related bond with the employee-members.
Such individuals may include, for example, the proprietor of a business
whose employees are members of the association. For purposes of the
preceding two sentences, an association will be considered to be
composed of employees if 90 percent of the total membership of the
association on one day of each quarter of the association's taxable year
consists of employees (within the meaning of paragraph (b) of this
section).
(2) Restrictions--(i) In general. Eligibility for membership may be
restricted by geographic proximity, or by objective conditions or
limitations reasonably related to employment, such as a limitation to a
reasonable classification of workers, a limitation based on a reasonable
minimum period of service, a limitation based on maximum compensation,
or a requirement that a member be employed on a full-time basis.
Similarly, eligibility for benefits may be restricted by objective
conditions relating to the type or amount of benefits offered. Any
objective criteria used to restrict eligibility for membership or
benefits may not, however, be selected or administered in a manner that
limits membership or benefits to officers, shareholders, or highly
compensated employees of an employer contributing to or otherwise
funding the employees' association. Similarly, eligibility for benefits
may not be subject to conditions or limitations that have the effect of
entitling officers, shareholders, or highly compensated employees of an
employer contributing to or otherwise funding the employees' association
to benefits that are disproportionate in relation to benefits to which
other members of the association are entitled. See Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-
4(b). Whether the selection or administration of objective conditions
has the effect of providing disproportionate benefits to officers,
shareholders, or highly compensated employees generally is to be
determined on the basis of all the facts and circumstances.
(ii) Generally permissible restrictions or conditions. In general
the following restrictions will not be considered to be inconsistent
with Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-2(a)(2)(i) or Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-4(b):
(A) In the case of an employer-funded organization, a provision that
excludes or has the effect of excluding from membership in the
organization or participation in a particular benefit plan employees who
are members of another organization or covered by a different plan,
funded or contributed to by the employer, to the extent that such other
organization or plan offers similar benefits on comparable terms to the
excluded employees.
(B) In the case of an employer funded-organization, a provision that
excludes from membership, or limits the type or amount of benefits
provided to, individuals who are included in a unit of employees covered
by an agreement which the Secretary of Labor finds to be a collective
bargaining agreement between employee representatives and one or more
employers, if there is evidence that the benefit or benefits provided by
the organization were the subject of good faith bargaining between such
employee representatives and such employer or employers.
(C) Restrictions or conditions on eligibility for membership or
benefits that are determined through collective bargaining, by trustees
designated pursuant to a collective bargaining agreement, or by the
collective bargaining agents of the members of an association or
trustees named by such agent or agents.
(D) The allowance of benefits only on condition that a member or
recipient contribute to the cost of such benefits, or the allowance of
different benefits based solely on differences in contributions,
provided that those making equal contributions are entitled to
comparable benefits.
[[Page 26]]
(E) A requirement that a member (or a member's dependents) meet a
reasonable health standard related to eligibility for a particular
benefit.
(F) The provision of life benefits in amounts that are a uniform
percentage of the compensation received by the individual whose life is
covered.
(G) The provision of benefits in the nature of wage replacement in
the event of disability in amounts that are a uniform percentage of the
compensation of the covered individuals (either before or after taking
into account any disability benefits provided through social security or
any similar plan providing for wage replacement in the event of
disability).
(3) Examples. The provisions of this section may be illustrated by
the following examples:
Example 1. Pursuant to a collective bargaining agreement entered
into by X Corporation and W, a labor union which represents all of X
Corporation's hourly-paid employees, the X Corporation Union Benefit
Plan is established to provide life insurance benefits to employees of X
represented by W. The Plan is funded by contributions from X, and is
jointly administered by X and W. In order to provide its non-unionized
employees with comparable life insurance benefits, X also establishes
and funds the X Corporation Life Insurance Trust. The Trust will not be
ineligible for exemption as an organization described in section
501(c)(9) solely because membership is restricted to those employees of
X who are not members of W.
Example 2. The facts are the same as in Example 1 except that the
life insurance benefit provided to the non-unionized employees of X
differs from the life insurance benefit provided to the unionized
employees of X pursuant to the collective bargaining agreement. The
trust will not be ineligible for exemption as an organization described
in section 501(c)(9) solely because the life insurance benefit provided
to X's nonunionized employees is not same as the life insurance benefit
provided to X's unionized employees.
Example 3. S corporation established a plan to provide health
benefits to all its employees. In accordance with the provisions of the
plan each employee may secure insurance coverage by making an election
under which the employee agrees to contribute periodically to the plan
an amount which is determined solely by whether the employee elects a
high option coverage or a low option coverage and on whether the
employee is unmarried or has a family. As an alternative, the employee
may elect high or low options, self only or self and family, coverage
through a local prepaid group medical plan. The contributions required
of those electing the prepaid group medical plan also vary with the type
of coverage selected, and differ from those required of employees
electing insurance. The difference between the amount contributed by
employees electing the various coverages and the actual cost of
purchasing the coverage is made up through contributions by S to the
plan, and under the plan, S provides approximately the same proportion
of the cost for each coverage. To fund the plan, S established an
arrangement in the nature of a trust under applicable local law and
contributes all employee contributions, and all amounts which by the
terms of the plan it is required to contribute, to the trust. The terms
of the plan do not provide for disproportionate benefits to the
employees of S and will not be considered inconsistent with Sec.
1.501(c)(9)-2(a)(2)(i).
Example 4. The facts are the same as in Example 3 except that, for
those employees or former employees covered by Medicare, the plan
provides a distinct coverage which supplements Medicare benefits.
Eligibility for Medicare is an objective condition relating to a type of
benefit offered, and the provision of separate coverage for those
eligible for Medicare will not be considered inconsistent with Sec.
1.501(c)(9)-2(a)(2)(i).
(b) Meaning of employee. Whether an individual is an employee is
determined by reference to the legal and bona fide relationship of
employer and employee. The term employee includes the following:
(1) An individual who is considered an employee:
(i) For employment tax purposes under subtitle C of the Internal
Revenue Code and the regulations thereunder, or
(ii) For purposes of a collective bargaining agreement,
whether or not the individual could qualify as an employee under
applicable common law rules. This would include any person who is
considered an employee for purposes of the Labor Management Relations
Act of 1947, 61 Stat. 136, as amended, 29 U.S.C. 141 (1979).
(2) An individual who became entitled to membership in the
association by reason of being or having been an employee. Thus, an
individual who would otherwise qualify under this paragraph will
continue to qualify as an employee even though such individual is on
leave of absence, works temporarily for another employer or as
[[Page 27]]
an independent contractor, or has been terminated by reason of
retirement, disability or layoff. For example, an individual who in the
normal course of employment is employed intermittently by more than one
employer in an industry characterized by short-term employment by
several different employers will not, by reason of temporary
unemployment, cease to be an employee within the meaning of this
paragraph.
(3) The surviving spouse and dependents of an employee (if, for
purposes of the 90-percent test of Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-2(a)(1) they are
considered to be members of the association).
(c) Description of voluntary association of employees--(1)
Association. To be described in section 501(c)(9) and this section there
must be an entity, such as a corporation or trust established under
applicable local law, having an existence independent of the member-
employees or their employer.
(2) Voluntary. Generally, membership in an association is voluntary
if an affirmative act is required on the part of an employee to become a
member rather than the designation as a member due to employee status.
However, an association shall be considered voluntary although
membership is required of all employees, provided that the employees do
not incur a detriment (for example, in the form of deductions from pay)
as the result of membership in the association. An employer is not
deemed to have imposed involuntary membership on the employee if
membership is required as the result of a collective bargaining
agreement or as an incident of membership in a labor organization.
(3) Of employees. To be described in this section, an organization
must be controlled--
(i) By its membership,
(ii) By independent trustee(s) (such as a bank), or
(iii) By trustees or other fiduciaries at least some of whom are
designated by, or on behalf of, the membership. Whether control by or on
behalf of the membership exists is a question to be determined with
regard to all of the facts and circumstances, but generally such control
will be deemed to be present when the membership (either directly or
through its representative) elects, appoints or otherwise designates a
person or persons to serve as chief operating officer(s),
administrator(s), or trustee(s) of the organization. For purposes of
this paragraph an organization will be considered to be controlled by
independent trustees if it is an employee welfare benefit plan, as
defined in section 3(1) of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act
of 1974 (ERISA), and, as such, is subject to the requirements of parts 1
and 4 of subtitle B, title I of ERISA. Similarly, a plan will be
considered to be controlled by its membership if it is controlled by one
or more trustees designated pursuant to a collective bargaining
agreement (whether or not the bargaining agent of the represented
employees bargained for and obtained the right to participate in
selecting the trustees).
(4) Examples. The provisions of this section may be illustrated by
the following examples:
Example 1. X, a labor union, represents all the hourly-paid
employees of Y Corporation. A health insurance benefit plan was
established by X and Y as the result of a collective bargaining
agreement entered into by them. The plan established the terms and
conditions of membership in, and the benefits to be provided by, the
plan. In accordance with the terms of the agreement, Y Corporation is
obligated to establish a trust fund and make contributions thereto at
specified rates. The trustees, some of whom are designated by X and some
by Y, are authorized to hold and invest the assets of the trust and to
make payments on instructions issued by Y Corporation in accordance with
the conditions contained in the plan. The interdependent benefit plan
agreement and trust indenture together create a voluntary employees'
beneficiary association over which the employees posses the requisite
control through the trustees designated by their representative, X.
Example 2. Z Corporation unilaterally established an educational
benefit plan for its employees. The purpose of the plan is to provide
payments for job-related educational or training courses, such as
apprenticeship training programs, for Z Corporation employees, according
to objective criteria set forth in the plan. Z establishes a separate
bank account which it uses to fund payments to the plan. Contributions
to the account are to be made at the discretion of and solely by Z
Corporation, which also administers the plan and retains control over
the assets in the fund. Z Corporation's educational benefit
[[Page 28]]
plan and the related account do not constitute an association having an
existence independent of Z Corporation and therefore do not constitute a
voluntary employees' beneficiary association.
Example 3. A, an individual, is the incorporator and chief operating
officer of Lawyers' Beneficiary Association (LBA). LBA is engaged in the
business of providing medical benefits to members of the Association and
their families. Membership is open only to practicing lawyers located in
a particular metropolitan area who are neither self-employed nor
partners in a law firm. Membership in LBA is solicited by insurance
agents under the control of X Corporation (owned by A) which, by
contract with LBA, is the exclusive sales agent. Medical benefits are
paid from a trust account containing periodic contributions paid by the
members, together with proceeds from the investment of those
contributions. Contribution and benefit levels are set by LBA. The
members of LBA do not hold meetings, have no right to elect officers or
directors of the Association, and no right to replace trustees.
Collectively, the subscribers for medical benefits from LBA cannot be
said to control the association and membership is neither more than nor
different from the purchase of an insurance policy from a stock
insurance company. LBA is not a voluntary employees' beneficiary
association.
Example 4. U corporation unilaterally established a plan to provide
benefits to its employees. In accordance with the provisions of the
plan, each employee may secure insurance or benefit coverage by making
an election under which the employee agrees to contribute to the plan an
amount which is determined solely by whether the employee elects a high
option coverage or a low option coverage and on whether the employee
elects self only or self and family coverage. The difference between the
amount contributed by employees electing the various coverages and the
actual cost of the coverage is made up through contributions by U to the
plan. To fund the plan, U established an arrangement in the nature of a
trust under applicable local law and contributed all employee
contributions, and all amounts which by the term of the plan it was
required to provide to the plan, to the trust. The trust constitutes an
employee welfare benefit plan within the meaning of, and subject to
relevant requirements of, ERISA. It will be considered to meet the
requirements of Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-2(c)(3).
[T.D. 7750, 46 FR 1723, Jan. 7, 1981]
Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-3 Voluntary employees' beneficiary associations;
life, sick, accident, or other benefits.
(a) In general. The life, sick, accident, or other benefits provided
by a voluntary employees' beneficiary association must be payable to its
members, their dependents, or their designated beneficiaries. For
purposes of section 501(c)(9), dependent means the member's spouse; any
child of the member or the member's spouse who is a minor or a student
(within the meaning of section 151(e)(4)); any other minor child
residing with the member; and any other individual who an association,
relying on information furnished to it by a member, in good faith
believes is a person described in section 152(a). Life, sick, accident,
or other benefits may take the form of cash or noncash benefits. A
voluntary employees' beneficiary association is not operated for the
purpose of providing life, sick, accident, or other benefits unless
substantially all of its operations are in furtherance of the provision
of such benefits. Further, an organization is not described in this
section if it systematically and knowingly provides benefits (of more
than a de minimis amount) that are not permitted by paragraphs (b), (c),
(d), or (e) of this section.
(b) Life benefits. The term life benefits means a benefit (including
a burial benefit or a wreath) payable by reason of the death of a member
or dependent. A life benefit may be provided directly or through
insurance. It generally must consist of current protection, but also may
include a right to convert to individual coverage on termination of
eligibility for coverage through the association, or a permanent benefit
as defined in, and subject to the conditions in, the regulations under
section 79. A life benefit also includes the benefit provided under any
life insurance contract purchased directly from an employee-funded
association by a member or provided by such an association to a member.
The term life benefit does not include a pension, annuity or similar
benefit, except that a benefit payable by reason of the death of an
insured may be settled in the form of an annuity to the beneficiary in
lieu of a lump-sum death benefit (whether or not the contract provides
for settlement in a lump sum).
(c) Sick and accident benefits. The term sick and accident benefits
means amounts furnished to or on behalf of a member or a member's
dependents in
[[Page 29]]
the event of illness or personal injury to a member or dependent. Such
benefits may be provided through reimbursement to a member or a member's
dependents for amounts expended because of illness or personal injury,
or through the payment of premiums to a medical benefit or health
insurance program. Similarly, a sick and accident benefit includes an
amount paid to a member in lieu of income during a period in which the
member is unable to work due to sickness or injury. Sick benefits also
include benefits designed to safeguard or improve the health of members
and their dependents. Sick and accident benefits may be provided
directly by an association to or on behalf of members and their
dependents, or may be provided indirectly by an association through the
payment of premiums or fees to an insurance company, medical clinic, or
other program under which members and their dependents are entitled to
medical services or to other sick and accident benefits. Sick and
accident benefits may also be furnished in noncash form, such as, for
example, benefits in the nature of clinical care services by visiting
nurses, and transportation furnished for medical care.
(d) Other benefits. The term other benefits includes only benefits
that are similar to life, sick, or accident benefits. A benefit is
similar to a life, sick, or accident benefit if:
(1) It is intended to safeguard or improve the health of a member or
a member's dependents, or
(2) It protects against a contingency that interrupts or impairs a
member's earning power.
(e) Examples of other benefits. Paying vacation benefits, providing
vacation facilities, reimbursing vacation expenses, and subsidizing
recreational activities such as athletic leagues are considered other
benefits. The provision of child-care facilities for preschool and
school-age dependents are also considered other benefits. The provision
of job readjustment allowances, income maintenance payments in the event
of economic dislocation, temporary living expense loans and grants at
times of disaster (such as fire or flood), supplemental unemployment
compensation benefits (as defined in section 501(c)(17)(D)(i) of the
Code), severance benefits (under a severance pay plan within the meaning
of 29 CFR 2510.3-2(b)) and education or training benefits or courses
(such as apprentice training programs) for members, are considered other
benefits because they protect against a contingency that interrupts
earning power. Personal legal service benefits which consist of payments
or credits to one or more organizations or trusts described in section
501(c)(20) are considered other benefits. Except to the extent otherwise
provided in these regulations, as amended from time to time, other
benefits also include any benefit provided in the manner permitted by
paragraphs (5) et seq. of section 302(c) of the Labor Management
Relations Act of 1947, 61 Stat. 136, as amended, 29 U.S.C. 186(c)
(1979).
(f) Examples of nonqualifying benefits. Benefits that are not
described in paragraphs (d) or (e) of this section are not other
benefits. Thus, other benefits do not include the payment of commuting
expenses, such as bridge tolls or train fares, the provision of accident
or homeowner's insurance benefits for damage to property, the provision
of malpractice insurance, or the provision of loans to members except in
times of distress (as permitted by Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-3(e)). Other
benefits also do not include the provision of savings facilities for
members. The term other benefits does not include any benefit that is
similar to a pension or annuity payable at the time of mandatory or
voluntary retirement, or a benefit that is similar to the benefit
provided under a stock bonus or profit-sharing plan. For purposes of
section 501(c)(9) and these regulations, a benefit will be considered
similar to that provided under a pension, annuity, stock bonus or
profit-sharing plan if it provides for deferred compensation that
becomes payable by reason of the passage of time, rather than as the
result of an unanticipated event. Thus, for example, supplemental
unemployment benefits, which generally become payable by reason of
unanticipated layoff, are not, for purposes of these regulations,
considered similar to the benefit provided under a pension, annuity,
stock bonus or profit-sharing plan.
[[Page 30]]
(g) Examples. The provisions of this section may be further
illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. V was organized in connection with a vacation plan
created pursuant to a collective bargaining agreement between M, a labor
union, which represents certain hourly paid employees of T corporation,
and T. The agreement calls for the payment by T to V of a specified sum
per hour worked by T employees who are covered by the collective
bargaining agreement. T includes the amounts in the covered employees'
wages and withholds income and FICA taxes. The amounts are paid by T to
V to provide vacation benefits provided under the collective bargaining
agreement. Generally, each covered employee receives a check in payment
of his or her vacation benefit during the year following the year in
which contributions were made by T to V. The amount of the vacation
benefit is determined by reference to the contributions during the prior
year to V by T on behalf of each employee, and is distributed in cash to
each such employee. If the earnings on investments by V during the year
preceding distribution are sufficient after deducting the expenses of
administering the plan, each recipient of a vacation benefit is paid an
amount, in addition to the contributions on his or her behalf, equal to
his/her ratable share of the net earnings of V during such year. The
plan provides a vacation benefit that constitutes an eligible other
benefit described in section 501(c)(9) and Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-3(e).
Example 2. The facts are the same as in Example 1, except that each
covered employee of T is entitled, at his or her discretion, to
contribute up to an additional $1,000 each year to V, which agrees in
respect of such sum to pay interest at a stated rate from the time of
contribution until the time at which the contributing employee's
vacation benefit is distributed. In addition, each employee may elect to
leave all or a portion of his/her distributable benefit on deposit past
the time of distribution, in which case interest will continue to
accrue. Because the plan more closely resembles a savings arrangement
than a vacation plan, the benefit payable to the covered employees of T
is not a vacation benefit and is not an eligible other benefit described
in section 501(c)(9) and Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-3 (d) or (e).
[T.D. 7750, 46 FR 1724, Jan. 7, 1981]
Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-4 Voluntary employees' beneficiary associations;
inurement.
(a) General rule. No part of the net earnings of an employees'
association may inure to the benefit of any private shareholder or
individual other than through the payment of benefits permitted by Sec.
1.501(c)(9)-3. The disposition of property to, or the performance of
services for, a person for less than the greater of fair market value or
cost (including indirect costs) to the association, other than as a
life, sick, accident or other permissible benefit, constitutes
prohibited inurement. Generally, the payment of unreasonable
compensation to the trustees or employees of the association, or the
purchase of insurance or services for amounts in excess of their fair
market value from a company in which one or more of the association's
trustees, officers or fiduciaries has an interest, will constitute
prohibited inurement. Whether prohibited inurement has occurred is a
question to be determined with regard to all of the facts and
circumstances, taking into account the guidelines set forth in this
section. The guidelines and examples contained in this section are not
an exhaustive list of the activities that may constitute prohibited
inurement, or the persons to whom the association's earnings could
impermissibly inure. See Sec. 1.501(a)-1(c).
(b) Disproportionate benefits. For purposes of subsection (a), the
payment to any member of disproportionate benefits, where such payment
is not pursuant to objective and nondiscriminatory standards, will not
be considered a benefit within the meaning of Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-3 even
though the benefit otherwise is one of the type permitted by that
section. For example, the payment to highly compensated personnel of
benefits that are disproportionate in relation to benefits received by
other members of the association will constitute prohibited inurement.
Also, the payment to similarly situated employees of benefits that
differ in kind or amount will constitute prohibited inurement unless the
difference can be justified on the basis of objective and reasonable
standards adopted by the association or on the basis of standards
adopted pursuant to the terms of a collective bargaining agreement. In
general, benefits paid pursuant to standards or subject to conditions
that do not provide for disproportionate benefits to officers,
shareholders, or highly compensated employees will not be considered
disproportionate. See Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-2(a) (2) and (3).
[[Page 31]]
(c) Rebates. The rebate of excess insurance premiums, based on the
mortality or morbidity experience of the insurer to which the premiums
were paid, to the person or persons whose contributions were applied to
such premiums, does not constitute prohibited inurement. A voluntary
employees' beneficiary association may also make administrative
adjustments strictly incidental to the provision of benefits to its
members.
(d) Termination of plan or dissolution of association. It will not
constitute prohibited inurement if, on termination of a plan established
by an employer and funded through an association described in section
501(c)(9), any assets remaining in the association, after satisfaction
of all liabilities to existing beneficiaries of the plan, are applied to
provide, either directly or through the purchase of insurance, life,
sick, accident or other benefits within the meaning of Sec.
1.501(c)(9)-3 pursuant to criteria that do not provide for
disproportionate benefits to officers, shareholders, or highly
compensated employees of the employer. See Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-2(a)(2).
Similarly, a distribution to members upon the dissolution of the
association will not constitute prohibited inurement if the amount
distributed to members are determined pursuant to the terms of a
collective bargaining agreement or on the basis of objective and
reasonable standards which do not result in either unequal payments to
similarly situated members or in disproportionate payments to officers,
shareholders, or highly compensated employees of an employer
contributing to or otherwise funding the employees' association. Except
as otherwise provided in the first sentence of this paragraph, if the
association's corporate charter, articles of association, trust
instrument, or other written instrument by which the association was
created, as amended from time to time, provides that on dissolution its
assets will be distributed to its members' contributing employers, or if
in the absence of such provision the law of the state in which the
association was created provides for such distribution to the
contributing employers, the association is not described in section
501(c)(9).
(e) Example. The provisions of this section may be illustrated by
the following example:
Example. Employees A, B and C, members of the X voluntary employees'
beneficiary association, are unemployed. They receive unemployment
benefits from X. Those to A include an amount in addition to those
provided to B and C, to provide for A's retraining. B has been found
pursuant to objective and reasonable standards not to qualify for the
retraining program. C, although eligible for retraining benefits has
declined. X's additional payment to A for retraining does not constitute
prohibited inurement.
[T.D. 7750, 46 FR 1725, Jan. 7, 1981]
Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-5 Voluntary employees' beneficiary associations;
recordkeeping requirements.
(a) Records. In addition to such other records which may be required
(for example, by section 512(a)(3) and the regulations thereunder),
every organization described in section 501(c)(9) must maintain records
indicating the amount contributed by each member and contributing
employer, and the amount and type of benefits paid by the organization
to or on behalf of each member.
(b) Cross reference. For provisions relating to annual information
returns with respect to payments, see section 6041 and the regulations
thereunder.
[T.D. 7750, 46 FR 1725, Jan. 7, 1981]
Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-6 Voluntary employees' beneficiary associations;
benefits includible in gross income.
(a) In general. Cash and noncash benefits realized by a person on
account of the activities of an organization described in section
501(c)(9) shall be included in gross income to the extent provided in
the Internal Revenue Code of 1954, including, but not limited to,
sections 61, 72, 101, 104 and 105 of the Code and regulations
thereunder.
(b) Availability of statutory exclusions from gross income. The
availability of any statutory exclusion from gross income with respect
to contributions to, or the payment of benefits from, an organization
described in section 501(c)(9) is determined by the statutory provision
conferring the exclusion, and the regulations and rulings thereunder,
not by whether an individual is eligible for
[[Page 32]]
membership in the organization or by the permissibility of the benefit
paid. Thus, for example, if a benefit is paid by an employer-funded
organization described in section 501(c)(9) to a member who is not an
employee, a statutory exclusion from gross income that is available only
for employees would be unavailable in the case of a benefit paid to such
individual. Similarly, the fact that, for example, under some
circumstances educational benefits constitute other benefits does not of
itself mean that such benefits are eligible for the exclusion of either
section 117 or section 127 of the Code.
[T.D. 7750, 46 FR 1725, Jan. 7, 1981]
Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-7 Voluntary employees' beneficiary associations;
section 3(4) of ERISA.
The term voluntary employees' beneficiary association in section
501(c)(9) of the Internal Revenue Code is not necessarily coextensive
with the term employees' beneficiary association as used in section 3(4)
of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (ERISA), 29
U.S.C. 1002(4), and the requirements which an organization must meet to
be an employees' beneficiary association within the meaning of section
3(4) of ERISA are not necessarily identical to the requirements that an
organization must meet in order to be a voluntary employees' beneficiary
association within the meaning of section 501(c)(9) of the Code.
[T.D. 7750, 46 FR 1725, Jan. 7, 1981]
Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-8 Voluntary employees' beneficiary associations;
effective date.
(a) General rule. Except as otherwise provided in this section, the
provisions of Sec. Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-1 through 1.501(c)(9)-7 shall apply
with respect to taxable years beginning after December 31, 1954.
(b) Pre-1970 taxable years. For taxable years beginning before
January 1, 1970, section 501(c)(9)(B) (relating to the requirement that
85 percent or more of the association's income consist of amounts
collected from members and contributed by employers), as in effect for
such years, shall apply.
(c) Existing associations. Except as otherwise provided in paragraph
(d), the provisions of Sec. 1.501(c)(9)-2(a)(1) and (c)(3) shall apply
with respect to taxable years beginning after December 31, 1980.
(d) Collectively-bargained plans. In the case of a voluntary
employees' beneficiary association which receives contributions from one
or more employers pursuant to one or more collective bargaining
agreements in effect on December 31, 1980, the provisions of Sec. Sec.
1.501(c)(9)-1 through 1.501(c)(9)-5 shall apply with respect to taxable
years beginning after the date on which the agreement terminates
(determined without regard to any extension thereof agreed to after
December 31, 1980).
(e) Election. Notwithstanding paragraphs (c) and (d) of this
section, an organization may choose to be subject to all or a portion of
one or more of the provisions of these regulations for any taxable year
beginning after December 31, 1954.
[T.D. 7750, 46 FR 1725, Jan. 7, 1981; 46 FR 11971, Feb. 12, 1981]
Sec. 1.501(c)(10)-1 Certain fraternal beneficiary societies.
(a) For taxable years beginning after December 31, 1969, an
organization will qualify for exemption under section 501(c)(10) if it:
(1) Is a domestic fraternal beneficiary society order, or
association, described in section 501(c)(8) and the regulations
thereunder except that it does not provide for the payment of life,
sick, accident, or other benefits to its members, and
(2) Devotes its net earnings exclusively to religious, charitable,
scientific, literary, educational, and fraternal purposes
Any organization described in section 501(c)(7), such as, for example, a
national college fraternity, is not described in section 501(c)(10) and
this section.
[T.D. 7172, 37 FR 5618, Mar. 17, 1972]
Sec. 1.501(c)(12)-1 Local benevolent life insurance associations,
mutual irrigation and telephone companies, and like organizations.
(a) An organization described in section 501(c)(12) must receive at
least 85 percent of its income from amounts
[[Page 33]]
collected from members for the sole purpose of meeting losses and
expenses. If an organization issues policies for stipulated cash
premiums, or if it requires advance deposits to cover the cost of the
insurance and maintains investments from which more than 15 percent of
its income is derived, it is not entitled to exemption. On the other
hand, an organization may be entitled to exemption, although it makes
advance assessments for the sole purpose of meeting future losses and
expenses, provided that the balance of such assessments remaining on
hand at the end of the year is retained to meet losses and expenses or
is returned to members.
(b) The phrase of a purely local character applies to benevolent
life insurance associations, and not to the other organizations
specified in section 501(c)(12). It also applies to any organization
seeking exemption on the ground that it is an organization similar to a
benevolent life insurance association. An organization of a purely local
character is one whose business activities are confined to a particular
community, place, or district, irrespective, however, of political
subdivisions. If the activities of an organization are limited only by
the borders of a State it cannot be considered to be purely local in
character.
(c) For taxable years of a mutual or cooperative telephone company
beginning after December 31, 1974, the 85 percent member-income test
described in paragraph (a) of this section is applied without taking
into account income received or accrued from another telephone company
for the performance of communication services involving the completion
of long distance calls to, from, or between members of the mutual or
cooperative telephone company. For example, if, in one year, a
cooperative telephone company receives $85x from its members for
telephone calls, $15x as interest income, and $20x as credits under long
distance interconnection agreements with other telephone companies for
the performance of communication services involving the completion of
long distance calls to, from, or between the cooperative's members
(whether or not the credits may be offset, in whole or in part, by
amounts due the other companies under the interconnection agreements),
the member-income fraction is calculated without taking into account,
either in the numerator or denominator, the $20x credits received from
the other telephone companies. In this example, the 85 percent member-
income test is satisfied because at least 85 percent
[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TC14NO91.158
of the cooperative's total income is derived from member income.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960; 25 FR 14021, Dec. 31, 1960, as
amended at 44 FR 59523, Oct. 16, 1979]
Sec. 1.501(c)(13)-1 Cemetery companies and crematoria.
(a) Nonprofit mutual cemetery companies. A nonprofit cemetery
company may be entitled to exemption if it is owned by and operated
exclusively for the benefit of its lot owners who hold such lots for
bona fide burial purposes and not for the purpose of fesale. A mutual
cemetery company which also engages in charitable activities, such as
burial of paupers, will be regarded as operating in conformity with this
standard. Further, the fact that a mutual cemetery company limits its
membership to a particular class of individuals, such as members of a
family, will not affect its status as mutual so long as all the other
requirements of section 501(c)(13) are met.
(b) Nonprofit cemetery companies and crematoria. Any nonprofit
corporation, chartered solely for the purpose of the burial, or (for
taxable years beginning after December 31, 1970) the cremation of
bodies, and not permitted by its charter to engage in any business not
necessarily incident to that purpose, is exempt from income tax,
provided that no part of its net earnings inures to the benefit of any
private shareholder or individual.
(c) Preferred stock--(1) In general. Except as provided in
subparagraph (3) of this paragraph, a cemetery company or crematorium is
not described in section 501(c)(13) if it issues preferred stock on or
after November 28, 1978.
[[Page 34]]
(2) Transitional rule for preferred stock issued prior to November
28, 1978. In the case of preferred stock issued prior to November 28,
1978, a cemetery company or crematorium which issued such stock shall
not fail to be exempt from income tax solely because it issued preferred
stock which entitled the holders to dividends at a fixed rate, not
exceeding the legal rage of interest in the State of incorporation or 8
percent per annum, whichever is greater, on the value of the
consideration for which the stock was issued, if its articles of
incorporation require:
(i) That the preferred stock be retired at par as rapidly as funds
therefor become available from operations, and
(ii) That all funds not required for the payment of dividends upon
or for the retirement of preferred stock be used by the company for the
care and inprovement of the cemetery property. The term legal rate of
interest shall mean the rate of interest prescribed by law in the State
of incorporation which prevails in the absence of an agreement between
contracting parties fixing a rate.
(3) Transitional rule for preferred stock issued on or after
November 28, 1978. In the case of preferred stok issued on or after
November 28, 1978, a cemetery company or crematorium shall not fail to
be exempt from income tax if its articles of incorporation and the
preferred stock meet the requirements of paragraph (c)(2) and if such
stock is issued pursuant to a plan which has been reduced to writing and
adopted prior to November 28, 1978. The adoption of the plan must be
shown by the acts of the duly constituted responsible officers and
appear upon the official records of the cemetery company or crematorium.
(d) Sales to exempt cemetery companies and crematoria. Except as
provided in paragraph (c)(2) or (c)(3) of this section (relating to
transitional rules for preferred stock), no person may have any interest
in the net earnings of a tax-exempt cemetery company or crematorium.
Thus, a cemetery company or crematorium is not exempt from tax if
property is transferred to such organization in exchange for an interest
in the net earnings of the organization so long as such interest remains
outstanding. An interest in a cemetery company or crematorium that
constitutes an equity interest within the meaning of section 385 will be
considered an interest in the net earnings of the cemetery. However, an
interest in a cemetery company or crematorium that does not constitute
an equity interest within the meaning of section 385 may nevertheless
constitute an interest in the net earning of the organization. Thus, for
example, a bond or other evidence of indebtedness issued by a cemetery
company or crematorium which provides for a fixed rate of interest but
which, in addition, provides for additional interest payments contingent
upon the revenues or income of the organization is considered an
interest in the net earnings of the organization. Similarly, a
convertible debt obligation issued by a cemetery company or crematorium
after July 7, 1975, is considered an interest in the net earnings of the
organization.
[T.D. 7698, 45 FR 33972, May 21, 1980]
Sec. 1.501(c)(14)-1 Credit unions and mutual insurance funds.
Credit unions (other than Federal credit unions described in section
501(c)(1)) without capital stock, organized and operated for mutual
purposes and without profit, are exempt from tax under section 501(a).
Corporations or associations without capital stock organized before
September 1, 1951 and operated for mutual purposes and without profit
for the purpose of providing reserve funds for, and insurance of, shares
or deposits in:
(a) Domestic building and loan associations as defined in section
7701(a)(19),
(b) Cooperative banks without capital stock organized and operated
for mutual purposes and without profit, or
(c) Mutual savings banks not having capital stock represented by
shares
are also exempt from tax under section 501(a). In addition, corporations
or associations of the type described in the preceding sentence which
were organized on or after September 1, 1951, but before September 1,
1957, are exempt
[[Page 35]]
from tax under section 501(a) for taxable years beginning after December
31, 1959.
[T.D. 6493, 25 FR 9219, Sept. 27, 1960]
Sec. 1.501(c)(15)-1 Mutual insurance companies or associations.
(a) Taxable years beginning after December 31, 1962. An insurance
company or association described in section 501(c)(15) is exempt under
section 501(a) if it is a mutual company or association (other than life
or marine) or if it is a mutual interinsurer or reciprocal underwriter
(other than life or marine) and if the gross amount received during the
taxable year from the sum of the following items does not exceed
$150,000:
(1) The gross amount of income during the taxable year from:
(i) Interest (including tax-exempt interest and partially tax-exempt
interest), as described in Sec. 1.61-7. Interest shall be adjusted for
amortization of premium and accrual of discount in accordance with the
rules prescribed in section 822(d)(2) and the regulations thereunder.
(ii) Dividends, as described in Sec. 1.61-9.
(iii) Rents and royalties, as described in Sec. 1.61-8.
(iv) The entering into of any lease, mortgage, or other instrument
or agreement from which the company may derive interest, rents, or
royalties.
(v) The alteration or termination of any instrument or agreement
described in subdivision (iv) of this subparagraph.
(2) The gross income from any trade or business (other than an
insurance business) carried on by the company or association, or by a
partnership of which the company or association is a partner.
(3) Premiums (including deposits and assessments).
(b) Taxable years beginning after December 31, 1954, and before
January 1, 1963. An insurance company or association described in
section 501(c)(15) and paragraph (a) of this section is exempt under
section 501(a) if the gross amount received during the taxable year from
the sum of the items described in paragraph (a) (1), (2), and (3) of
this section does not exceed $75,000.
(c) No double inclusion of income. In computing the gross income
from any trade or business (other than an insurance business) carried on
by the company or association, or by a partnership of which the company
or association is a partner, any item described in section 822(b)(1)
(A), (B), or (C) and paragraph (a)(1) of this section shall not be
considered as gross income arising from the conduct of such trade or
business, but shall be taken into account under section 822(b)(1) (A),
(B), or (C) and paragraph (a)(1) of this section.
(d) Taxable years beginning after December 31, 1953, and before
January 1, 1955. An insurance company or association described in
section 501(c)(15) is exempt under section 501(a) if it is a mutual
company or association (other than life or marine) or if it is a mutual
interinsurer or reciprocal underwriter (other than life or marine) and
if the gross amount received during the taxable year from the sum of the
following items does not exceed $75,000:
(1) The gross amount of income during the taxable year from--
(i) Interest (including tax-exempt interest and partially tax-exempt
interest), as described in Sec. 1.61-7. Interest shall be adjusted for
amortization of premium and accrual of discount in accordance with the
rules prescribed in section 822(d)(2) and Sec. 1.822-3.
(ii) Dividends, as described in Sec. 1.61-9.
(iii) Rents (but excluding royalties), as described in Sec. 1.61-8.
(2) Premiums (including deposits and assessments).
(e) Exclusion of capital gains. Gains from sales or exchanges of
capital assets to the extent provided in subchapter P (section 1201 and
following, relating to capital gains and losses), chapter 1 of the Code,
shall be excluded from the amounts described in this section.
[T.D. 6662, 28 FR 6972, July 29, 1963]
Sec. 1.501(c)(16)-1 Corporations organized to finance crop operations.
A corporation organized by a farmers' cooperative marketing or
purchasing association, or the members thereof, for the purpose of
financing the ordinary crop operations of such members or other
producers is exempt, provided the marketing or purchasing
[[Page 36]]
association is exempt under section 521 and the financing corporation is
operated in conjunction with the marketing or purchasing association.
The provisions of Sec. 1.521-1 relating to a reserve or surplus and to
capital stock shall also apply to corporations coming under this
section.
Sec. 1.501(c)(17)-1 Supplemental unemployment benefit trusts.
(a) Requirements for qualification. (1) A supplemental unemployment
benefit trust may be exempt as an organization described in section
501(c)(17) if the requirements of subparagraphs (2) through (6) of this
paragraph are satisfied.
(2) The trust is a valid, existing trust under local law and is
evidenced by an executed written document.
(3) The trust is part of a written plan established and maintained
by an employer, his employees, or both the employer and his employees,
solely for the purpose of providing supplemental unemployment
compensation benefits (as defined in section 501(c)(17)(D) and paragraph
(b)(1) of Sec. 1.501(c)(17)-1).
(4) The trust is part of a plan which provides that the corpus and
income of the trust cannot (in the taxable year, and at any time
thereafter, before the satisfaction of all liabilities to employees
covered by the plan) be used for, or diverted to, any purpose other than
the providing of supplemental unemployment compensation benefits. Thus,
if the plan provides for the payment of any benefits other than
supplemental unemployment compensation benefits as defined in paragraph
(b) of this section, the trust will not be entitled to exemption as an
organization described in section 501(c)(17). However, the payment of
any necessary or appropriate expenses in connection with the
administration of a plan providing supplemental unemployment
compensation benefits shall be considered a payment to provide such
benefits and shall not affect the qualification of the trust.
(5) The trust is part of a plan whose eligibility conditions and
benefits do not discriminate in favor of employees who are officers,
shareholders, persons whose principal duties consist of supervising the
work of other employees, or highly compensated employees. See sections
401(a)(3)(B) and 401(a)(4) and Sec. Sec. 1.401-3 and 1.401-4. However,
a plan is not discriminatory within the meaning of section
501(c)(17)(A)(iii), relating to the requirement that the benefits paid
under the plan be nondiscriminatory, merely because the benefits
received under the plan bear a uniform relationship to the total
compensation, or the basic or regular rate of compensation, of the
employees covered by the plan. Accordingly, the benefits provided for
highly paid employees may be greater than the benefits provided for
lower paid employees if the benefits are determined by reference to
their compensation; but, in such a case, the plan will not qualify if
the benefits paid to the higher paid employees bear a larger ratio to
their compensation than the benefits paid to the lower paid employees
bear to their compensation. In addition, section 501(c)(17)(B) sets
forth certain other instances in which a plan will not be considered
discriminatory (see paragraph (c) of Sec. 1.501(c)(17)-2).
(6) The trust is part of a plan which requires that benefits are to
be determined according to objective standards. Thus, a plan may provide
similarly situated employees with benefits which differ in kind and
amount, but may not permit such benefits to be determined solely in the
discretion of the trustees.
(b) Meaning of terms. The following terms are defined for purposes
of section 501(c)(17):
(1) Supplemental unemployment compensation benefits. The term
supplemental unemployment compensation benefits means only:
(i) Benefits paid to an employee because of his involuntary
separation from the employment of the employer, whether or not such
separation is temporary, but only when such separation is one resulting
directly from a reduction in force, the discontinuance of a plant or
operation, or other similar conditions; and
(ii) Sick and accident benefits subordinate to the benefits
described in subdivision (i) of this subparagraph.
(2) Employee. The term employee means an individual whose status is
that of an employee under the usual
[[Page 37]]
common-law rules applicable in determining the employer-employee
relationship. The term employee also includes an individual who
qualifies as an employee under the State or Federal unemployment
compensation law covering his employment, whether or not such an
individual could qualify as an employee under such common-law rules.
(3) Involuntary separation from the employment of the employer.
Whether a separation from the employment of the employer occurs is a
question to be decided with regard to all the facts and circumstances.
However, for purposes of section 501(c)(17), the term separation
includes both a temporary separation and a permanent severance of the
employment relationship. Thus, for example, an employee may be separated
from the employment of his employer even though at the time of
separation it is believed that he will be reemployed by the same
employer. Whether or not an employee is involuntarily separated from the
employment of the employer is a question of fact. However, normally, an
employee will not be deemed to have separated himself voluntarily from
the employment of his employer merely because his collective bargaining
agreement provides for the termination of his services upon the
happening of a condition subsequent and that condition does in fact
occur. For example, if the collective bargaining agreement provides that
the employer may automate a given department and thereby dislocate
several employees, the fact that the employees' collective bargaining
agent has consented to such a condition will not render any employee's
subsequent unemployment for such cause voluntary.
(4) Other similar conditions. Involuntary separation directly
resulting from other similar conditions includes, for example,
involuntary separation from the employment of the employer resulting
from cyclical, seasonal, or technological causes. Some causes of
involuntary separation from the employment of the employer which are not
similar to those enumerated in section 501(c)(17)(D)(i) are separation
for disciplinary reasons or separation because of age.
(5) Subordinate sick and accident benefits. In general, a sick and
accident benefit payment is an amount paid to an employee in the event
of his illness or personal injury (whether or not such illness or injury
results in the employee's separation from the service of his employer).
In addition, the phrase sick and accident benefits includes amounts
provided under the plan to reimburse an employee for amounts he expends
because of the illness or injury of his spouse or a dependent (as
defined in section 152). Sick and accident benefits may be paid by a
trust described in section 501(c)(17) only if such benefits are
subordinate to the separation payments provided under the plan of which
the trust forms a part. Whether the sick and accident benefits provided
under a supplemental unemployment compensation benefit plan are
subordinate to the separation benefits provided under such plan is a
question to be decided with regard to all the facts and circumstances.
[T.D. 6972, 33 FR 12900, Sept. 12, 1968]
Sec. 1.501(c)(17)-2 General rules.
(a) Supplemental unemployment compensation benefits. Supplemental
unemployment compensation benefits as defined in section 501(c)(17)(D)
and paragraph (b)(1) of Sec. 1.501(c)(17)-1 may be paid in a lump sum
or installments. Such benefits may be paid to an employee who has,
subsequent to his separation from the employment of the employer,
obtained other part-time, temporary, or permanent employment.
Furthermore, such payments may be made in cash, services, or property.
Thus, supplemental unemployment compensation benefits provided to
involuntarily separated employees may include, for example, the
following: Furnishing of medical care at an established clinic,
furnishing of food, job training and schooling, and job counseling. If
such benefits are furnished in services or property, the fair market
value of the benefits must satisfy the requirements of section
501(c)(17)(A)(iii), relating to nondiscrimination as to benefits.
However, supplemental unemployment compensation benefits may be provided
only to an employee and only under circumstances described in paragraph
[[Page 38]]
(b)(1) of Sec. 1.501(c)(17)-1. Thus, a trust described in section
501(c)(17) may not provide, for example, for the payment of a death,
vacation, or retirement benefit.
(b) Sick and accident benefits. If a trust described in section
501(c)(17) provides for the payment of sick and accident benefits, such
benefits may only be provided for employees who are eligible for receipt
of separation benefits under the plan of which the trust is a part.
However, the sick and accident benefits need not be provided for all the
employees who are eligible for receipt of separation benefits, so long
as the plan does not discriminate in favor of persons with respect to
whom discrimination is proscribed in section 501(c)(17)(A) (ii) and
(iii). Furthermore, the portion of the plan which provides for the
payment of sick and accident benefits must satisfy the nondiscrimination
requirements of section 501(c)(17)(A) (ii) and (iii) without regard to
the portion of the plan which provides for the payment of benefits
because of involuntary separation.
(c) Correlation with other plans. (1) In determining whether a plan
meets the requirements of section 501(c)(17)(A) (ii) and (iii), any
benefits provided under any other plan shall not be taken into
consideration except in the particular instances enumerated in section
501(c)(17)(B) (i), (ii), and (iii). In general, these three exceptions
permit a plan providing for the payment of supplemental unemployment
compensation benefits to satisfy the nondiscrimination requirements in
section 501(c)(17)(A) (ii) and (iii) if the plan is able to satisfy such
requirements when it is correlated with one or more of the plans
described in section 501(c)(17)(B).
(2) Under section 501(c)(17)(B)(i), a plan will not be considered
discriminatory merely because the benefits under the plan which are
first determined in a nondiscriminatory manner (within the meaning of
section 501(c)(17)(A)) are then reduced by any sick, accident, or
unemployment compensation benefits received under State or Federal law,
or are reduced by a portion of these benefits if determined in a
nondiscriminatory manner. Under this exception, a plan may, for example,
satisfy the requirements of section 501(c)(17)(A)(iii) if it provides
for the payment of an unemployment benefit and the amount of such
benefit is determined as a percentage of the employee's compensation
which is then reduced by any unemployment benefit which the employee
receives under a State plan. In addition, a plan could provide for the
reduction of such a plan benefit by a percentage of the State benefit.
Furthermore, a plan may also satisfy the requirements of section
501(c)(17)(A) if it provides for the payment to an employee of an amount
which when added to any State unemployment benefit equals a percentage
of the employee's compensation.
(3) Under section 501(c)(17)(B)(ii), a plan will not be considered
discriminatory merely because the plan provides benefits only for
employees who are not eligible to receive sick, accident, or
unemployment compensation benefits under State or Federal law. In such a
case, however, the benefits provided under the plan seeking to satisfy
the requirements of section 501(c)(17) must be the same benefits, or a
portion of the same benefits if determined in a nondiscriminatory
manner, which such ineligible employees would receive under State or
Federal law if they were eligible for such benefits. Under this
exception, for example, an employer may establish a plan only for
employees who have exhausted their benefits under the State law, and, if
the plan provides for such employees the same benefits which they would
receive under the State plan, the State plan and the plan of the
employer will be considered as one plan in determining whether the
requirements relating to nondiscrimination in section 501(c)(17)(A) are
satisfied. Furthermore, such a plan could also qualify even though it
does not provide all of the benefits provided under the State plan.
Thus, a plan could provide for the payment of a reduced amount of the
benefits, or for the payment of only certain of the types of benefits,
provided by the State plan. For example, if the State plan provides for
the payment of sick, accident, and separation benefits, the plan of the
employer may provide for the payment of only separation benefits, or for
the payment of an amount
[[Page 39]]
equal to only one-half of the State provided benefit. However, if a plan
provides benefits for employees who are not eligible to receive the
benefits provided under a State plan and such benefits are greater or of
a different type than those under the State plan, the plan of the
employer must satisfy the requirements of section 501(c)(17)(A) without
regard to the benefits and coverage provided by the State plan.
(4) Under section 501(c)(17)(B)(iii), a plan is not considered
discriminatory merely because the plan provides benefits only for
employees who are not eligible to receive benefits under another plan
which satisfies the requirements of section 501(c)(17)(A) and which is
funded solely by contributions of the employer. In such a case, the plan
seeking to qualify under section 501(c)(17) must provide the same
benefits, or a portion of such benefits if determined in a
nondiscriminatory manner, as are provided for the employees under the
plan funded solely by employer contributions. Furthermore, this
exception only applies if the employees eligible to receive benefits
under both plans would satisfy the requirements in section
501(c)(17)(A)(ii), relating to nondiscrimination as to coverage. The
plan of the employer which is being correlated with the plan seeking to
satisfy the requirements of section 501(c)(17) may be a plan which forms
part of a voluntary employees' beneficiary association described in
section 501(c)(9), if such plan satisfies all the requirements of
section 501(c)(17)(A). Under this exception, for example, if an employer
has established a plan providing for the payment of supplemental
unemployment compensation benefits for his hourly wage employees and
such plan satisfies the requirements of section 501(c)(17)(A) (even
though the plan forms part of a voluntary employees' beneficiary
association described in section 501(c)(9)), the salaried employees of
such employee may establish a plan for themselves, and, if such plan
provides for the same benefits as the plan covering hourly-wage
employees, both plans may be considered as one plan in determining
whether the plan covering the salaried employees satisfies the
requirement that is be nondiscriminatory as to coverage. The foregoing
example would also be applicable if the benefits provided for the
salaried employees were funded solely or in part by employer
contributions.
(d) Permanency of the plan. A plan providing for the payment of
supplemental unemployment compensation benefits contemplates a permanent
as distinguished from a temporary program. Thus, although there may be
reserved the right to change or terminate the plan, and to discontinue
contributions thereunder, the abandonment of the plan for any reason
other than business necessity within a few years after it has taken
effect will be evidence that the plan from its inception was not a bona
fide program for the purpose of providing supplemental unemployment
compensation benefits to employees. Whether or not a particular plan
constitutes a permanent arrangement will be determined by all of the
surrounding facts and circumstances. However, merely because a
collective bargaining agreement provides that a plan may be modified at
the termination of such agreement, or that particular provisions of the
plan are subject to renegotiation during the duration of such agreement,
does not necessarily imply that the plan is not a permanent arrangement.
Moreover, the fact that the plan provides that the assets remaining in
the trust after the satisfaction of all liabilities (including
contingent liabilities) under the plan may be returned to the employer
does not imply that the plan is not a permanent arrangement nor preclude
the trust from qualifying under section 501(c)(17).
(e) Portions of years. A plan must satisfy the requirements of
section 501(c)(17) throughout the entire taxable year of the trust in
order for the trust to be exempt for such year. However, section
501(c)(17)(C) provides that a plan will satisfy the nondiscrimination as
to classification requirements of section 501(c)(17)(A) if on at least
one day in each quarter of the taxable year of the trust it satisfies
such requirements.
(f) Several trusts constituting one plan. Several trusts may be
designated as constituting part of one plan which is intended to satisfy
the requirements of
[[Page 40]]
section 501(c)(17), in which case all of such trusts taken as a whole
must meet the requirements of such section. The fact that a combination
of trusts fails to satisfy the requirements of section 501(c)(17) as one
plan does not prevent such of the trusts as satisfy the requirements of
section 501(c)(17) from qualifying for exemption under that section.
(g) Plan of several employers. A trust forming part of a plan of
several employers, or the employees of several employers, will be a
supplemental unemployment benefit trust described in section 501(c)(17)
if all the requirements of that section are otherwise satisfied.
(h) Investment of trust funds. No specific limitations are provided
in section 501(c)(17) with respect to investments which may be made by
the trustees of a trust qualifying under that section. Generally, the
contributions may be used by the trustees to purchase any investments
permitted by the trust agreement to the extent allowed by local law.
However, the tax-exempt status of the trust will be forfeited if the
investments made by the trustees constitute prohibited transactions
within the meaning of section 503. See section 503 and the regulations
thereunder. In addition, such a trust will be subject to tax under
section 511 with respect to any unrelated business taxable income (as
defined in section 512) realized by it from its investments. See
sections 511 to 515, inclusive, and the regulations thereunder.
(i) Allocations. If a plan which provides sick and accident benefits
is financed solely by employer contributions to the trust, and such sick
and accident benefits are funded by payment of premiums on an accident
or health insurance policy (whether on a group or individual basis) or
by contributions to a separate fund which pays such sick and accident
benefits, the plan must specify that portion of the contributions to be
used to fund such benefits. If a plan which is financed in whole or in
part by employee contributions provides sick and accident benefits, the
plan must specify the portion, if any, of employee contributions
allocated to the cost of funding such benefits, and must allocate the
cost of funding such benefits between employer contributions and
employee contributions.
(j) Required records and returns. Every trust described in section
501(c)(17) must maintain records indicating the amount of separation
benefits and sick and accident benefits which have been provided to each
employee. If a plan is financed, in whole or in part, by employee
contributions to the trust, the trust must maintain records indicating
the amount of each employee's total contributions allocable to
separation benefits. In addition, every trust described in section
501(c)(17) which makes one or more payments totaling $600 or more in 1
year to an individual must file an annual information return in the
manner described in paragraph (b)(1) of Sec. 1.6041-2. However, if the
payments from such trust are subject to income tax withholding under
section 3402(o) and the regulations thereunder, the trust must file, in
lieu of such annual information return, the returns of income tax
withheld from wages required by section 6011 and the regulations
thereunder. In such circumstances, the trust must also furnish the
statements to the recipients of trust distributions required by section
6051 and the regulations thereunder.
[T.D. 6972, 33 FR 12901, Sept. 12, 1968, as amended by T.D. 7068, 35 FR
17328, Nov. 11, 1970]
Sec. 1.501(c)(17)-3 Relation to other sections of the Code.
(a) Taxability of benefit distributions--(1) Separation benefits. If
the separation benefits described in section 501(c)(17)(D)(i) are funded
entirely by employer contributions, then the full amount of any
separation benefit payment received by an employee is includible in his
gross income under section 61(a). If any such separation benefit is
funded by both employer and employee contributions, or solely by
employee contributions, the amount of any separation benefit payment
which is includible in the gross income of the employee is the amount by
which such distribution and any prior distributions of such separation
payments exceeds the employee's total contributions to fund such
separation benefits.
[[Page 41]]
(2) Sick and accident benefits. Any benefit payment received from
the trust under the part of the plan, if any, which provides for the
payment of sick and accident benefits must be included in gross income
under section 61(a), unless specifically excluded under section 104 or
105 and the regulations thereunder. See section 105(b) and Sec. 1.105-2
for benefit payments expended for medical care, benefit payments in
excess of actual medical expenses, and benefit payments which an
employee is entitled to receive irrespective of whether or not he incurs
expenses for medical care. See section 213 and Sec. 1.213-1(g) for
benefit payments representing reimbursement for medical expenses paid in
prior years. See Sec. 1.501(c)(17)-2(i) for the requirement that a
trust described in section 501(c)(17) which receives employee
contributions must be part of a written plan which provides for the
allocation of the cost of funding sick and accident benefits.
(b) Exemption as a voluntary employees' beneficiary association.
Section 501(c)(17)(E) contemplates that a trust forming part of a plan
providing for the payment of supplemental unemployment compensation
benefits may, if it qualifies, apply for exemption from income tax under
section 501(a) either as a voluntary employees' beneficiary association
described in section 501(c)(9) or as a trust described in section
501(c)(17).
(c) Returns. A trust which is described in section 501(c)(17) and
which is exempt from tax under section 501(a) must file a return in
accordance with section 6033 and the regulations thereunder. If such a
trust realizes any unrelated business taxable income, as defined in
section 512, the trust is also required to file a return with respect to
such income.
(d) Effective date. Section 501(c)(17) shall apply to taxable years
beginning after December 31, 1959, and shall apply to supplemental
unemployment benefit trusts regardless of when created or organized.
[T.D. 6972, 33 FR 12902, Sept. 12, 1968]
Sec. 1.501(c)(18)-1 Certain funded pension trusts.
(a) In general. Organizations described in section 501(c)(18) are
trusts created before June 25, 1959, forming part of a plan for the
payment of benefits under a pension plan funded only by contributions of
employees. In order to be exempt, such trusts must also meet the
requirements set forth in section 501(c)(18) (A), (B), and (C), and in
paragraph (b) of this section.
(b) Requirements for qualification. A trust described in section
501(c)(18) must meet the following requirements:
(1) Local law. The trust must be a valid, existing trust under local
law, and must be evidenced by an executed written document.
(2) Funding. The trust must be funded solely from contributions of
employees who are members of the plan. For purposes of this section, the
term contributions of employees shall include earnings on, and gains
derived from, the assets of the trust which were contributed by
employees.
(3) Creation before June 25, 1959--(i) In general. The trust must
have been created before June 25, 1959. A trust created before June 25,
1959 is described in section 501(c)(18) and this section even though
changes in the makeup of the trust have occurred since that time so long
as these are not fundamental changes in the character of the trust or in
the character of the beneficiaries of the trust. Increases in the
beneficiaries of the trust by the addition of employees in the same or
related industries, whether such additions are of individuals or of
units (such as local units of a union) will generally not be considered
a fundamental change in the character of the trust. A merger of a trust
created after June 25, 1959 into a trust created before such date is not
in itself a fundamental change in the character of the latter trust if
the two trusts are for the benefit of employees of the same or related
industries.
(ii) Examples. The provisions of this subparagraph may be
illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. Assume that trust C, for the benefit of members of
participating locals of National Union X, was established in 1950 and
adopted by 29 locals before June 25, 1959. The subsequent adoption of
trust C by additional locals of National Union X in 1962 will not
constitute a fundamental change in the character of trust C, since such
subsequent adoption is by employees in a related industry.
[[Page 42]]
Example 2. Assume the facts as stated in example 1, except that in
1965 National Union X merged with National Union Y, whose members are
engaged in trades related to those engaged in by X's members. Assume
further that trust D, the employee funded pension plan and fund for
employees of Y, was subsequently merged into trust C. The merger of
trust D into trust C would not in itself constitute a fundamental change
in the character of trust C, since both C and D are for the benefit of
employees of related industries.
(4) Payment of benefits. The trust must provide solely for the
payment of pension or retirement benefits to its beneficiaries. For
purposes of this section, the term retirement benefits is intended to
include customary and incidental benefits, such as death benefits within
the limits permissible under section 401.
(5) Diversion. The trust must be part of a plan which provides that,
before the satisfaction of all liabilities to employees covered by the
plan, the corpus and income of the trust cannot (within the taxable year
and at any time thereafter) be used for, or diverted to, any purpose
other than the providing of pension or retirement benefits. Payment of
expenses in connection with the administration of a plan providing
pension or retirement benefits shall be considered a payment to provide
such benefits and shall not affect the qualification of the trust.
(6) Discrimination. The trust must be part of a plan whose
eligibility conditions and benefits do not discriminate in favor of
employees who are officers, shareholders, persons whose principal duties
consist of supervising the work of other employees, or highly
compensated employees. See sections 401(a)(3)(B) and 401(a)(4) and
Sec. Sec. 1.401-3 and 1.401-4. However, a plan is not discriminatory
within the meaning of section 501(c)(18) merely because the benefits
received under the plan bear a uniform relationship to the total
compensation, or the basic or regular rate of compensation, of the
employees covered by the plan. Accordingly, the benefits provided for
highly paid employees may be greater than the benefits provided for
lower paid employees if the benefits are determined by reference to
their compensation; but, in such a case, the plan will not qualify if
the benefits paid to the higher paid employees are a larger portion of
compensation than the benefits paid to lower paid employees.
(7) Objective standards. The trust must be part of a plan which
requires that benefits be determined according to objective standards.
Thus, while a plan may provide similarly situated employees with
benefits which differ in kind and amount, these benefits may not be
determined solely in the discretion of the trustees.
(c) Effective date. The provisions of section 501(c)(18) and this
section shall apply with respect to taxable years beginning after
December 31, 1969.
[T.D. 7172, 37 FR 5618, Mar. 17, 1972]
Sec. 1.501(c)(19)-1 War veterans organizations.
(a) In general. (1) For taxable years beginning after December 31,
1969, a veterans post or organization which is organized in the United
States or any of its possessions may be exempt as an organization
described in section 501(c)(19) if the requirements of paragraphs (b)
and (c) of this section are met and if no part of its net earnings
inures to the benefit of any private shareholder or individual.
Paragraph (b) of this section contains the membership requirements such
a post or organization must meet in order to qualify under section
501(c)(19). Paragraph (c) of this section outlines the purposes, at
least one of which such a post or organization must have in order to so
qualify.
(2) In addition, an auxiliary unit or society described in paragraph
(d) of this section of such a veterans post or organization and a trust
or foundation described in paragraph (e) of this section for such post
or organization may be exempt as an organization described in section
501(c)(19).
(b) Membership requirements. (1) In order to be described in section
501(c)(19) under paragraph (a)(1) of this section, an organization must
meet the membership requirements of section 501(c)(19)(B) and this
paragraph. There are two requirements that must be met under this
paragraph. The first requirement is that at least 75 percent of the
members of the organization must be
[[Page 43]]
war veterans. For purposes of this section the term war veterans means
persons, whether or not present members of the United States Armed
Forces, who have served in the Armed Forces of the United States during
a period of war (including the Korean and Vietnam conflicts).
(2) The second requirement of this paragraph is that at least 97.5
percent of all members of the organization must be described in one or
more of the following categories:
(i) War veterans,
(ii) Present or former members of the United States Armed Forces,
(iii) Cadets (including only students in college or university ROTC
programs or at Armed Services academies), or
(iv) Spouses, widows, or widowers of individuals referred to in
paragraph (b)(2) (i), (ii) or (iii) of this section.
(c) Exempt purposes. In addition to the requirements of paragraphs
(a)(1) and (b) of this section, in order to be described in section
501(c)(19) under paragraph (a)(1) of this section an organization must
be operated exclusively for one or more of the following purposes:
(1) To promote the social welfare of the community as defined in
Sec. 1.501(c)(4)-1(a)(2).
(2) To assist disabled and needy war veterans and members of the
United States Armed Forces and their dependents, and the widows and
orphans of deceased veterans,
(3) To provide entertainment, care, and assistance to hospitalized
veterans or members of the Armed Forces of the United States,
(4) To carry on programs to perpetuate the memory of deceased
veterans and members of the Armed Forces and to comfort their survivors,
(5) To conduct programs for religious, charitable, scientific,
literary, or educational purposes,
(6) To sponsor or participate in activities of a patriotic nature,
(7) To provide insurance benefits for their members or dependents of
their members or both, or
(8) To provide social and recreational activities for their members.
(d) Auxiliary units or societies for war veterans organizations. A
unit or society may be exempt as an organization described in section
501(c)(19) and paragraph (a)(2) of this section if it is an auxiliary
unit or society of a post or organization of war veterans described in
paragraph (a)(1) of this section. A unit or society is an auxiliary unit
or society or such a post or organization if it meets the following
requirements:
(1) It is affiliated with, and organized in accordance with, the
bylaws and regulations formulated by an organization described in
paragraph (a)(1) of this section,
(2) At least 75 percent of its members are either war veterans, or
spouses of war veterans, or are related to a war veteran within two
degrees of consanguinity (i.e., grandparent, brother, sister,
grandchild, represent the most distant allowable relationships),
(3) All of its members are either members of an organization
described in paragraph (a)(1) of this section, or spouses of a member of
such an organization or are related to a member of such an organization,
within two degrees of consanguinity, and
(4) No part of its net earnings inures to the benefit of any private
shareholder or individual.
(e) Trusts or foundations. A trust or foundation may be exempt as an
organization described in section 501(c)(19) and paragraph (a)(2) of
this section if it is a trust or foundation for a post or organization
of war veterans described in paragraph (a)(1) of this section. A trust
or foundation is a trust or foundation for such a post or organization
if it meets the following requirements:
(1) The trust or foundation is in existence under local law and, if
organized for charitable purposes, has a dissolution provision described
in Sec. 1.501(c)(3)-1(b)(4).
(2) The corpus or income cannot be diverted or used other than for
the funding of a post or organization of war veterans described in
paragraph (a)(1) of this section, for section 170(c)(4) purposes, or as
an insurance set aside (as defined in Sec. 1.512(a)-4(b)).
(3) The trust income is not unreasonably accumulated and, if the
trust or foundation is not an insurance set aside, a substantial portion
of the income is in fact distributed to such post or organization or for
section 170(c)(4) charitable purposes, and
[[Page 44]]
(4) It is organized exclusively for one or more of those purposes
enumerated in paragraph (c) of this section.
[T.D. 7438, 41 FR 44392, Oct. 8, 1976]
Sec. 1.501(c)(21)-1 Black lung trusts--certain terms.
(a) Created or organized in the United States. A trust is not
created or organized in the United States unless it is maintained at all
times as a domestic trust in the United States. For this purpose,
section 7701(a)(9) limits the term United States to the District of
Columbia and States of the United States.
(b) Insurance company. The term insurance company means an
insurance, surety, bonding or other company whose liability for the
kinds of claims to which section 501(c)(21)(A)(i) applies is as an
insurer or guarantor of the liabilities of another.
(c) Black Lung Acts. The term Black Lung Acts includes any State law
providing compensation for disability or death due to pneumoconiosis
even though the State law compensates for other kinds of injuries. In
such a case, section 501(c)(21) applies only to the extent that the
liability is attributable to disability or death due to pneumoconiosis.
For this purpose, the term pneumoconiosis has the same meaning as it has
under federal law. See 30 U.S.C. 902.
(d) Insurance exclusively covering such liability. The term
insurance exclusively covering such liability includes insurance that
covers risk for liabilities in addition to the liabilities to which
section 501(c)(21)(A)(i) applies. In such a case, payment for premiums
may be made from the trust only to the extent of that portion of the
premiums that has been separately allocated and stated by the insurer as
attributable solely to coverage of the liabilities to which section
501(c)(21)(A)(i) applies.
(e) Administrative and other incidental expenses. The term
administrative and other incidental expenses means expenditures that are
appropriate and helpful to the trust making them in carrying out the
purposes for which its assets may be used under section 501(c)(21)(B).
The term includes any exicse tax imposed on the trust under section 4952
(relating to taxes on taxable expenditures) and reasonable expenses,
such as legal expenses, incurred by the trust in connection with an
assertion against the trust of liability for a taxable expenditure. The
term does not include an excise tax imposed on the trustee or on other
disqualified persons under section 4951 (relating to taxes on self-
dealing) or under section 4953 (relating to tax on excess contributions
to black lung benefit trusts) or any expenses incurred in connection
with the assertion of these taxes other than expenses that are treated
as part of reasonable compensation under section 4951(d)(2)(C). See
Sec. Sec. 53.4941 (d)-2(f)(3) and (d)-3(c) for interpretations of
similar provisions under section 4941(d)(2)(E), relating to reasonable
compensation for private foundation disqualified persons.
(f) Public debt securities of the United States. The term public
debt securities of the United States means obligations that are taken
into consideration for purposes of the public debt limit. See, for
example 31 U.S.C. 757b.
(g) Obligations of a State or local government. The term obligations
of a State or local government means the obligations of a State or local
governmental unit the interest on which is exempt from tax under section
103(a). See Sec. 1.103-1(a).
(h) Time or demand deposits. The term time or demand deposits
includes checking accounts, savings accounts, certificates of deposit or
other time or demand deposits. The term does not include common or
collective trust funds such as a common trust fund as defined in section
584.
[44 FR 52197, Sept. 7, 1979]
Sec. 1.501(c)(21)-2 Same--trust instrument.
As trust does not meet the requirements of section 501(c)(21) if it
is not established and maintained pursuant to a written instrument. The
trust instrument must definitely and affirmatively prohibit a diversion
or use of trust assets that is not permitted under section 501(c)(21)(B)
or section 4953(c), whether by operation or natural termination of the
trust, by power of revocation or amendment by the happening of a
contingency by collateral arrangement, or by any other means. No
particular form for the trust
[[Page 45]]
instrument is required. A trust may meet the requirements of section
501(c)921) although the trust instrument fails to contain provisions the
effects of which are to prohibit acts that are subject to section 4951
(relating to taxes on self-dealing), section 4952 (relating to taxes on
taxable expenditures) or the retention of contributions subject to
section 4953 (relating to tax on excess contributions to black lung
benefit trusts).
[44 FR 52197, Sept. 7, 1979]
Sec. 1.501(c)(29)-1T CO-OP Health Insurance Issuers (temporary).
(a) Organizations must notify the Commissioner that they are
applying for recognition of section 501(c)(29) status. An organization
will not be treated as described in section 501(c)(29) unless the
organization has given notice to the Commissioner that it is applying
for recognition as an organization described in section 501(c)(29) in
the manner prescribed by the Commissioner in published guidance.
(b) Effective date of recognition of section 501(c)(29) status. An
organization may be recognized as an organization described in section
501(c)(29) as of a date prior to the date of the notice required by
paragraph (a) of this section if the notice is given in the manner and
within the time prescribed by the Commissioner and the organization's
purposes and activities prior to giving such notice were consistent with
the requirements for exempt status under section 501(c)(29). However, an
organization may not be recognized as an organization described in
section 501(c)(29) before the later of its formation or March 23, 2010.
(c) Effective/applicability date. Paragraphs (a) and (b) of this
section are effective on February 7, 2012.
(d) Expiration date. The applicability of this section expires on
February 6, 2015.
[T.D. 9574, 77 FR 6006, Feb. 7, 2012]
Sec. 1.501(d)-1 Religious and apostolic associations or corporations.
(a) Religious or apostolic associations or corporations are
described in section 501(d) and are exempt from taxation under section
501(a) if they have a common treasury or community treasury, even though
they engage in business for the common benefit of the members, provided
each of the members includes (at the time of filing his return) in his
gross income his entire pro rata share, whether distributed or not, of
the net income of the association or corporation for the taxable year of
the association or corporation ending with or during his taxable year.
Any amount so included in the gross income of a member shall be treated
as a dividend received.
(b) For annual return requirements of organizations described in
section 501(d), see section 6033 and paragraph (a)(5) of Sec. 1.6033-1.
Sec. 1.501(e)-1 Cooperative hospital service organizations.
(a) General rule. Section 501(e) is the exclusive and controlling
section under which a cooperative hospital service organization can
qualify as a charitable organization. A cooperative hospital service
organization which meets the requirements of section 501(e) and this
section shall be treated as an organization described in section
501(c)(3), exempt from taxation under section 501(a), and referred to in
section 170(b)(1)(A) (iii) (relating to percentage limitations on
charitable contributions). In order to qualify for tax exempt status, a
cooperative hospital service organization must--
(1) Be organized and operated on a cooperative basis,
(2) Perform, on a centralized basis, only one or more specifically
enumerated services which, if performed directly by a tax exempt
hospital, would constitute activities in the exercise or performance of
the purpose or function constituting the basis for its exemption, and
(3) Perform such service or services solely for two or more patron-
hospitals as described in paragraph (d) of this section.
(b) Organized and operated on a cooperative basis--(1) In general.
In order to meet the requirements of section 501(e), the organization
must be organized and operated on a cooperative basis (whether or not
under a specific
[[Page 46]]
statute on cooperatives) and must allocate or pay all of its net
earnings within 8\1/2\ months after the close of the taxable year to its
patron-hospitals on the basis of the percentage of its services
performed for each patron. To allocate its net earnings to its patron-
hospitals, the organization must make appropriate bookkeeping entries
and provide timely written notice to each patron-hospital disclosing to
the patron-hospital the amount allocated to it on the books of the
organization. For the recordkeeping requirements of a section 501(e)
organization, see Sec. 1.521-1(a)(1).
(2) Percentage of services defined. The percentage of services
performed for each patron-hospital may be determined on the basis of
either the value or the quantity of the services provided by the
organization to the patron-hospital, provided such basis is realistic in
terms of the actual cost of the services to the organization.
(3) Retention of net earnings. Exemption will not be denied a
cooperative hospital service organization solely because the
organization, instead of paying all net earnings to its patron-
hospitals, retains an amount for such purposes as retiring indebtedness,
expanding the services of the organization, or for any other necessary
purpose and allocates such amounts to its patrons. However, such funds
may not be accumulated beyond the reasonably anticipated needs of the
organization. See, Sec. 1.537-1(b). Whether there is an improper
accumulation of funds depends upon the particular circumstances of each
case. Moreover, where an organization retains net earnings for necessary
purposes, the organization's records must show each patron's rights and
interests in the funds retained. For purposes of this paragraph, the
term net earnings does not include capital contributions to the
organization and such contributions need not satisfy the allocation or
payment requirements.
(4) Nonpatronage and other income. An organization described in
section 501(e) may, in addition to net earnings, receive membership dues
and related membership assessment fees, gifts, grants and income from
nonpatronage sources such as investment of retained earnings. However,
such an organization cannot be exempt if it engages in any business
other than that of providing the specified services, described in
paragraph (c), for the specified patron-hospitals, described in
paragraph (d). Thus, an organization described in section 501(e)
generally cannot have unrelated business taxable income as defined in
section 512, although it may earn certain interest, annuities,
royalties, and rents which are excluded from unrelated business taxable
income because of the modifications contained in sections 512(b) (1),
(2) or (3). An organization described in section 501(e) may, however,
have debt-financed income which is treated as unrelated business taxable
income solely because of the applicability of section 514. In addition,
exempt status under section 501(e) will not be affected where rent from
personal property leased with real property is treated as unrelated
business taxable income under section 512(b)(3)(A)(ii) solely because
the rent attributable to the personal property is more than incidental
or under section 512(b)(3)(B)(i) solely because the rent attributable to
the personal property exceeds 50 percent of the total rent received or
accrued under the lease. Exemption will not be affected solely because
the determination of the amount of rent depends in whole or in part on
the income or profits derived from the property leased. See, section
512(b)(3)(B)(ii). An organization described in section 501(e) may also
derive nonpatronage income from sources that are incidental to the
conduct of its exempt purposes or functions. For example, income derived
from the operation of a cafeteria or vending machines primarily for the
convenience of its employees or the disposition of by-products in
substantially the same state they were in on completion of the exempt
function (e.g., the sale of silver waste produced in the processing of
x-ray film) will not be considered unrelated business taxable income.
See, section 513(a)(2) and Sec. 1.513-1(d)(4)(ii). The nonpatronage and
other income permitted under this subparagraph (4) must be allocated or
paid as provided in subparagraph (1) or retained as provided in
subparagraph (3).
(5) Stock ownership--(i) Capital stock of organization. An
organization does not meet the requirements of section 501(e)
[[Page 47]]
unless all of the organization's outstanding capital stock, if there is
such stock, is held solely by its patron-hospitals. However, no amount
may be paid as dividends on the capital stock of the organization. For
purposes of the preceding sentence, the term capital stock includes
common stock (whether voting or nonvoting), preferred stock, or any
other form evidencing a proprietary interest in the organization.
(ii) Stock ownership as a condition for obtaining credit. If by
statutory requirement a cooperative hospital service organization must
be a shareholder in a United States or state chartered corporation as a
condition for obtaining credit from that corporate-lender, the ownership
of shares and the payment of dividends thereon will not for such reason
be a basis for the denial of exemption to the organization. See, e.g.,
National Consumer Cooperative Bank, 12 U.S.C. 3001 et seq.
(c) Scope of services--(1) Permissible services. An organization
meets the requirements of section 501(e) only if the organization
performs, on a centralized basis, one or more of the following services
and only such services: data processing, purchasing (including the
purchasing and dispensing of drugs and pharmaceuticals to patron-
hospitals), warehousing, billing and collection, food, clinical
(including radiology), industrial engineering (including the
installation, maintenance and repair of biomedical and similar
equipment), laboratory, printing, communications, record center, and
personnel (including recruitment, selection, testing, training,
education and placement of personnel) services. An organization is not
described in section 501(e) if, in addition to or instead of one or more
of these specified services, the organization performs any other service
(other than services referred to under paragraph (b)(4) that are
incidental to the conduct of exempt purposes or functions).
(2) Illustration. The provisions of this subparagraph may be
illustrated by the following example.
Example. An organization performs industrial engineering services on
a cooperative basis solely for patron-hospitals each of which is an
organization described in section 501(c)(3) and exempt from taxation
under section 501(a). However, in addition to this service, the
organization operates laundry services for its patron-hospitals. This
cooperative organization does not meet the requirements of this
paragraph because it performs laundry services not specified in this
paragraph.
(d) Patron-hospitals--(1) Defined. Section 501(e) only applies if
the organization performs its services solely for two or more patron-
hospitals each of which is--
(i) An organization described in section 501(c)(3) which is exempt
from taxation under section 501(a),
(ii) A constituent part of an organization described in section
501(c)(3) which is exempt from taxation under section 501(a) and which,
if organized and operated as a separate entity, would constitute an
organization described in section 501(c)(3), or
(iii) Owned and operated by the United States, a State, the District
of Columbia, or a possession of the United States, or a political
subdivision or an agency or instrumentality of any of the foregoing.
(2) Business with nonvoting patron-hospitals. Exemption will not be
denied a cooperative hospital service organization solely because the
organization (whether organized on a stock or membership basis)
transacts business with patron-hospitals which do not have voting rights
in the organization and therefore do not participate in the decisions
affecting the operation of the organization. Where the organization has
both patron-hospitals with voting rights and patron-hospitals without
such rights, the organization must provide at least 50 percent of its
services to patron-hospitals with voting rights in the organization.
Thus, the percentage of services provided to nonvoting patrons may not
exceed the percentage of such services provided to voting patrons. A
patron-hospital will be deemed to have voting rights in the cooperative
hospital service organization if the patron-hospital may vote directly
on matters affecting the operation of the organization or if the patron-
hospital may vote in the election of cooperative board members.
Notwithstanding that an organization may have both voting and nonvoting
patron-hospitals, patronage refunds must nevertheless be
[[Page 48]]
allocated or paid to all patron-hospitals solely on the basis specified
in paragraph (b) of this section.
(3) Services to other organizations. An organization does not meet
the requirements of section 501(e) if, in addition to performing
services for patron-hospitals (entities described in subdivisions (i),
(ii) or (iii) of subparagraph (1)), the organization performs any
service for any other organization. For example, a cooperative hospital
service organization is not exempt if it performs services for
convalescent homes for children or the aged, vocational training
facilities for the handicapped, educational institutions which do not
provide hospital care in their facilities, and proprietary hospitals.
However, the provision of the specified services between or among
cooperative hospital service organizations meeting the requirements of
section 501(e) and this section is permissible. Also permissible is the
provision of the specified services to entities which are not patron-
hospitals, but only if such services are de minimis and are mandated by
a governmental unit as, for example, a condition for licensing.
(e) Effective dates. An organization, other than an organization
performing clinical services, may meet the requirements of section
501(e) and be a tax exempt organization for taxable years ending after
June 28, 1968. An organization performing clinical services may meet the
requirements of section 501(e) and be a tax exempt organization for
taxable years ending after December 31, 1976. However, pursuant to the
authority contained in section 7805(b) of the Internal Revenue Code,
these regulations shall not become effective with respect to an
organization which has received a ruling or determination letter from
the Internal Revenue Service recognizing its exemption under section
501(e) until January 2, 1987.
[T.D. 8100, 51 FR 31615, Sept. 4, 1986; 51 FR 33593, Sept. 22, 1986]
Sec. 1.501(h)-1 Application of the expenditure test to expenditures
to influence legislation; introduction.
(a) Scope. (1) There are certain requirements an organization must
meet in order to be a charity described in section 501(c)(3). Among
other things, section 501(c)(3) states that ``no substantial part of the
activities of [a charity may consist of] carrying on propaganda, or
otherwise attempting to influence legislation, (except as otherwise
provided in subsection (h)).'' This requirement is called the
substantial part test.
(2) Under section 501(h), many public charities may elect the
expenditure test as a substitute for the substantial part test. The
expenditure test is described in section 501(h) and this Sec. 1.501(h).
A public charity is any charity that is not a private foundation under
section 509(a). (Unlike a public charity, a private foundation may not
make any lobbying expenditures: If a private foundation does make a
lobbying expenditure, it is subject to an excise tax under section
4945). Section 1.501(h)-2 lists which public charities are eligible to
make the expenditure test election. Section 1.501(h)-2 also provides
information about how a public charity makes and revokes the election to
be covered by the expenditure test.
(3) A public charity that makes the election may make lobbying
expenditures within specified dollar limits. If an electing public
charity's lobbying expenditures are within the dollar limits determined
under section 4911(c), the electing public charity will not owe tax
under section 4911 nor will it lose its tax exempt status as a charity
by virtue of section 501(h). If, however, that electing public charity's
lobbying expenditures exceed its section 4911 lobbying limit, the
organization is subject to an excise tax on the excess lobbying
expenditures. Further, under section 501(h), if an electing public
charity's lobbying expenditures normally are more than 150 percent of
its section 4911 lobbying limit, the organization will cease to be a
charity described in section 501(c)(3).
(4) A public charity that elects the expenditure test may
nevertheless lose its tax exempt status if it is an action organization
under Sec. 1.501(c)(3)-1(c)(3)(iii) or (iv). A public charity that does
not elect the expenditure test remains subject to the substantial part
test. The substantial part test is applied without regard to the
provisions of section 501(h) and 4911 and the related regulations.
[[Page 49]]
(b) Effective date. The provisions of Sec. 1.501(h)-1 through Sec.
1.501(h)-3, are effective for taxable years beginning after August 31,
1990. An election made before August 31, 1990, under the provisions of
Sec. 7.0(c)(4) or the instructions to Form 5768, will be effective
under these regulations without again filing Form 5768.
[T.D. 8308, 55 FR 35588, Aug. 31, 1990]
Sec. 1.501(h)-2 Electing the expenditure test.
(a) In general. The election to be governed by section 501(h) may be
made by an eligible organization (as described in paragraph (b) of this
section) for any taxable year of the organization beginning after
December 31, 1976, other than the first taxable year for which a
voluntary revocation of the election is effective (see paragraph (d) of
this section). The election is made by filing a completed Form 5768,
Election/Revocation of Election by an Eligible Section 501(c)(3)
Organization to Make Expenditures to Influence Legislation, with the
appropriate Internal Revenue Service Center listed on that form. Under
section 501(h)(6), the election is effective with the beginning of the
taxable year in which the form is filed. For example, if an eligible
organization whose taxable year is the calendar year files Form 5768 on
December 31, 1979, the organization is governed by section 501(h) for
its taxable year beginning January 1, 1979. Once made, the expenditure
test election is effective (without again filing Form 5768) for each
succeeding taxable year for which the organization is an eligible
organization and which begins before a notice of revocation is filed
under paragraph (d) of this section.
(b) Organizations eligible to elect the expenditure test--(1) In
general. For purposes of section 501(h) and the regulations thereunder,
an organization is an eligible organization for a taxable year if, for
that taxable year, it is--
(i) Described in section 501(c)(3) (determined, in any year for
which an election is in effect, without regard to the substantial part
test of section 501(c)(3)),
(ii) Described in section 501(h)(4) and paragraph (b)(2) of this
section, and
(iii) Not a disqualified organization described in section 501(h)(5)
and paragraph (b)(3) of this section.
(2) Certain organizations listed. An organization is described in
section 501(h)(4) and this paragraph (b)(2) if it is an organization
described in--
(i) Section 170(b)(1)(A)(ii) (relating to educational institutions),
(ii) Section 170(b)(1)(A)(iii) (relating to hospitals and medical
research organizations),
(iii) Section 170(b)(1)(A)(iv) (relating to organizations supporting
government schools),
(iv) Section 170(b)(1)(A)(vi) (relating to organizations publicly
supported by charitable contributions),
(v) Section 509(a)(2) (relating to organizations publicly supported
by admissions, sales, etc.), or
(vi) Section 509(a)(3) (relating to organizations supporting public
charities), except that for purposes of this paragraph (b)(2), section
509(a)(3) shall be applied without regard to the last sentence of
section 509(a).
(3) Disqualified organizations. An organization is a disqualified
organization described in section 501(h)(5) and this paragraph (b)(3) if
the organization is--
(i) Described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(i) (relating to churches),
(ii) An integrated auxiliary of a church or of a convention or
association of churches see (Sec. 1.6033-2(g)(5)), or
(iii) Described in section 501(c)(3) and affiliated (within the
meaning of Sec. 56.4911-7) with one or more organizations described in
paragraph (b)(3) (i) or (ii) of this section.
(4) Other organizations ineligible to elect. Under section
501(h)(4), certain organizations, although not disqualified
organizations, are not eligible to elect the expenditure test. For
example, organizations described in section 509(a)(4) are not listed in
section 501(h)(4) and therefore are not eligible to elect. Similarly,
private foundations (within the meaning of section 509(a)) are not
eligible to elect. For the treatment of expenditures by a private
foundation for the purpose of carrying on propaganda, or otherwise
attempting, to influence legislation, see Sec. 53.4945-2.
(c) New organizations. A newly created organization may submit Form
5768 to elect the expenditure test under
[[Page 50]]
section 501(h) before it is determined to be an eligible organization
and may submit Form 5768 at the time it submits its application for
recognition of exemption (Form 1023). If the newly created organization
is determined to be an eligible organization, the election will be
effective under the provisions of paragraph (a) of this section, that
is, with the beginning of the taxable year in which the Form 5768 is
filed by the eligible organization. However, if a newly created
organization is determined by the Service not to be an eligible
organization, the organization's election will not be effective and the
substantial part test will apply from the effective date of its section
501(c)(3) classification.
(d) Voluntary revocation of expenditure test election--(1)
Revocation effective. An organization may voluntarily revoke an
expenditure test election by filing a notice of voluntary revocation
with the appropriate Internal Revenue Service Center listed on Form
5768. Under section 501(h)(6)(B), a voluntary revocation is effective
with the beginning of the first taxable year after the taxable year in
which the notice is filed. If an organization voluntarily revokes its
election, the substantial part test of section 501(c)(3) will apply with
respect to the organization's activities in attempting to influence
legislation beginning with the taxable year for which the voluntary
revocation is effective.
(2) Re-election of expenditure test. If an organization's
expenditure test election is voluntarily revoked, the organization may
again make the expenditure test election, effective no earlier than for
the taxable year following the first taxable year for which the
revocation is effective.
(3) Example. X, an organization whose taxable year is the calendar
year, plans to voluntarily revoke its expenditure test election
effective beginning with its taxable year 1985. X must file its notice
of voluntary revocation on Form 5768 after December 31, 1983, and before
January 1, 1985. If X files a notice of voluntary revocation on December
31, 1984, the revocation is effective beginning with its taxable year
1985. The organization may again elect the expenditure test by filing
Form 5768. Under paragraph (d)(2) of this section, the election may not
be made for taxable year 1985. Under paragraph (a) of this section, a
new expenditure test election will be effective for taxable years
beginning with taxable year 1986, if the Form 5768 is filed after
December 31, 1985, and before January 1, 1987.
(e) Involuntary revocation of expenditure test election. If, while
an election by an eligible organization is in effect, the organization
ceases to be an eligible organization, its election is automatically
revoked. The revocation is effective with the beginning of the first
full taxable year for which it is determined that the organization is
not an eligible organization. If an organization's expenditure test
election is involuntarily revoked under this paragraph (e) but the
organization continues to be described in section 501(c)(3), the
substantial part test of section 501(c)(3) will apply with respect to
the organization's activities in attempting to influence legislation
beginning with the first taxable year for which the involuntary
revocation is effective.
(f) Supersession. This section supersedes Sec. 7.0(c)(4) of the
Temporary Income Tax Regulations under the Tax Reform Act of 1976,
effective August 31, 1990.
[T.D. 8308, 55 FR 35588, Aug. 31, 1990]
Sec. 1.501(h)-3 Lobbying or grass roots expenditures normally in
excess of ceiling amount.
(a) Scope. This section provides rules under section 501(h) for
determining whether an organization that has elected the expenditure
test and that is not a member of an affiliated group of organizations
(as defined in Sec. 56.4911-7(e)) either normally makes lobbying
expenditures in excess of its lobbying ceiling amount or normally makes
grass roots expenditures in excess of its grass roots ceiling amount.
Under section 501(h) and this section, an organization that has elected
the expenditure test and that normally makes expenditures in excess of
the corresponding ceiling amount will cease to be exempt from tax under
section 501(a) as an organization described in section 501(c)(3). For
similar rules relating to
[[Page 51]]
members of an affiliated group of organizations, see Sec. 56.4911-9.
(b) Loss of exemption--(1) In general. Under section 501(h)(1), an
organization that has elected the expenditure test shall be denied
exemption from taxation under section 501(a) as an organization
described in section 501(c)(3) for the taxable year following a
determination year if--
(i) The sum of the organization's lobbying expenditures for the base
years exceeds 150 percent of the sum of its lobbying nontaxable amounts
for the base years, or (ii) The sum of the organization's grass roots
expenditures for its base years exceeds 150 percent of the sum of its
grass roots nontaxable amounts for the base years.
The organization thereafter shall not be exempt from tax under section
501(a) as an organization described in section 501(c)(3) unless,
pursuant to paragraph (d) of this section, the organization reapplies
for recognition of exemption and is recognized as exempt.
(2) Special exception for organization's first election. For the
first, second, or third consecutive determination year for which an
organization's first expenditure test election is in effect, no
determination is required under paragraph (b)(1) of this section, and
the organization will not be denied exemption from tax by reason of
section 501(h) and this section if, taking into account as base years
only those years for which the expenditure test election is in effect--
(i) The sum of the organization's lobbying expenditures for such
base years does not exceed 150 percent of the sum of its lobbying
nontaxable amounts for the same base years, and
(ii) The sum of the organization's grass roots expenditure for those
base years does not exceed 150 percent of the sum of its grass roots
nontaxable amounts for such base years. If an organization does not
satisfy the requirements of this paragraph (b)(2), paragraph (b)(1) of
this section will apply.
(c) Definitions. For purposes of this section--
(1) The term lobbying expenditures means lobbying expenditures as
defined in section 4911(c)(1) or section 4911(f)(4)(A) and Sec.
56.4911-2(a).
(2) The term lobbying nontaxable amount is defined in Sec. 56.4911-
1(c)(1).
(3) An organization's lobbying ceiling amount is 150 percent of the
organization's lobbying nontaxable amount for a taxable year.
(4) The term grass roots expenditures means expenditures for grass
roots lobbying communications as defined in section 4911(c)(3) or
section 4911(f)(4)(A) and Sec. Sec. 56.4911-2 and 56.4911-3.
(5) The term grass roots nontaxable amount is defined in Sec.
56.4911-1(c)(2).
(6) An organization's grass roots ceiling amount is 150 percent of
the organization's grass roots nontaxable amount for a taxable year.
(7) In general, the term base years means the determination year and
the three taxable years immediately preceding the determination year.
The base years, however, do not include any taxable year preceding the
taxable year for which the organization is first treated as described in
section 501(c)(3).
(8) A taxable year is a determination year if it is a year for which
the expenditure test election is in effect, other than the taxable year
for which the organization is first treated as described in section
501(c)(3).
(d) Reapplication for recognition of exemption--(1) Time of
application. An organization that is denied exemption from taxation
under section 501(a) by reason of section 501(h) and this section may
apply on Form 1023 for recognition of exemption as an organization
described in section 501(c)(3) for any taxable year following the first
taxable year for which exemption is so denied. See paragraphs (d)(2) and
(d)(3) of this section for material to be included with an application
described in the preceding sentence.
(2) Section 501(h) calculation. An application described in
paragraph (d)(1) of this section must demonstrate that the organization
would not be denied exemption from taxation under section 501(a) by
reason of section 501(h) if the expenditure test election has been in
effect for all of its last taxable year ending before the application is
made by providing the calculations, described either in paragraphs
(b)(1) (i) and (ii) of this section or in Sec. 56.4911-9(b), that would
have applied to the organization for that year.
[[Page 52]]
(3) Operations not disqualifying. An application described in
paragraph (d)(1) of this section must include information that
demonstrates to the satisfaction of the Commissioner that the
organization will not knowingly operate in a manner that would
disqualify the organization for tax exemption under section 501(c)(3) by
reason of attempting to influence legislation.
(4) Reelection of expenditure test. If an organization is denied
exemption from tax for a taxable year by reason of section 501(h) and
this section, and thereafter is again recognized as an organization
described in section 501(c)(3) pursuant to this paragraph (d), it may
again elect the expenditure test under section 501(h) in accordance with
Sec. 1.501(h)-2(a).
(e) Examples. The provisions of this section are illustrated by the
following examples, which also illustrate the operation of the tax
imposed by section 4911.
Example 1. (1) The following table contains information used in this
example concerning organization X.
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Lobbying
Exempt purpose -------------------------------
Year expenditures Calculation Lobbying
(EPE) Nontaxable expenditures
amount (LNTA) (LE)
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1979.......................... $400,000 (20% of $400,000=).............. $80,000 $100,000
1980.......................... 300,000 (20% of $300,000=).............. 60,000 100,000
1981.......................... 600,000 (20% of $500,000+15% of 115,000 120,000
$100,000=).
1982.......................... 500,000 (20% of $500,000=).............. 100,000 100,000
----------------------------------------------- -------------------------------
Totals...................... 1,800,000 ................................ 355,000 420,000
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(2) Organization X, whose taxable year is the calendar year, was
organized in 1971. X first made the expenditure test election under
section 501(h) effective for taxable years beginning with 1979 and has
not revoked the election. None of X's lobbying expenditures for its
taxable years 1979 through 1982 are grass roots expenditures. Under
section 4911(a) and Sec. 56.4911-1(a), X must determine for each year
for which the expenditure test election is effective whether it is
liable for the 25 percent excise tax imposed by section 4911(a) on
excess lobbying expenditures. X is liable for this tax for each of its
taxable years 1979, 1980, and 1981, because in each year its lobbying
expenditures exceeded its lobbying nontaxable amount for the year. For
1979, the tax imposed by section 4911(a) is $5,000 {25%x($100,000-
$80,000)=$5,000{time} . For 1980, the tax is $10,000. For 1981, the tax
is $1,250.
(3) The taxable years 1979 through 1981 are all determination years
under paragraph (c)(8) of this section. On its annual return for
determination year 1979, the first year of its first election, X can
demonstrate, under paragraph (b)(2) of this section, that its lobbying
expenditures during 1979 ($100,000) do not exceed 150 percent of its
lobbying nontaxable amount for 1979 ($120,000). For determination year
1980, under paragraph (b)(2), X can demonstrate that the sum of its
lobbying expenditures for 1979 and 1980 ($200,000) does not exceed 150
percent of the sum of its lobbying nontaxable amounts for 1979 and 1980
($210,000). For 1981, under paragraph (b)(2), X can demonstrate that the
sum of its lobbying expenditures for 1979, 1980, and 1981 ($320,000)
does not exceed 150 percent of the sum of its lobbying nontaxable
amounts for 1979, 1980, and 1981 ($382,500). For each of the
determination years 1979, 1980, and 1981, the first three years of its
first election, X satisfies the requirements of paragraph (b)(2).
Accordingly, no determination under paragraph (b)(1) of this section is
required for those years, and X is not denied tax exemption by reason of
section 501(h).
(4) Under paragraph (b)(1) of this section, X must determine for its
determination year 1982 whether it has normally made lobbying
expenditures in excess of the lobbying ceiling amount. This
determination takes into account expenditures in base years 1979 through
1982. The sum of X's lobbying expenditures for the base years ($420,000)
does not exceed 150 percent of the sum of the lobbying nontaxable
amounts for the base years (150%x$355,000=$532,500). Accordingly, X is
not denied tax exemption by reason of section 501(h).
Example 2. (1) The following table contains information used in this
example concerning W.
[[Page 53]]
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Grass roots
Exempt purpose Lobbying nontaxable
expenditures nontaxable Lobbying amount (25 Grass roots
Year (EPE) Calculation amount (LNTA) expenditures percent of expenditures
(dollars) (dollars) (LE) (dollars) LNTA) (dollars)
(dollars)
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1979................................ 700,000 (20% of $500,000+15% of $200,000=) 130,000 120,000 32,500 30,000
1980................................ 800,000 (20% of $500,000+15% of $300,000=) 145,000 100,000 36,250 60,000
1981................................ 800,000 (20% of $500,000+15% of $300,000=) 145,000 100,000 36,250 65,000
1982................................ 900,000 (20% of $500,000+15% of $400,000=) 160,000 150,000 40,000 65,000
---------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------
Total............................. 3,200,000 .................................. 580,000 470,000 145,000 220,000
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(2) Organization W, whose taxable year is the calendar year, made
the expenditure test election under section 501(h) effective for taxable
years beginning with 1979 and has not revoked the election. W has been
treated as an organization described in section 501(c)(3) for each of
its taxable years beginning within its taxable year 1974.
(3) Under section 4911(a) and Sec. 56.4911-1(a), W must determine
for each year for which the expenditure test election is effective
whether it is liable for the 25 percent excise tax imposed by section
4911(a) on excess lobbying expenditures. In 1980, 1981, and 1982, W has
excess lobbying expenditures because its grass roots expenditures in
each of those years exceeded its grass roots nontaxable amount for the
year. Therefore, W is liable for the excise tax under section 4911(a)
for those years. The tax imposed by section 4911(a) for 1980 is
$5,937.50 {25%x($60,000-$36,250)= $5,937.50{time} . For 1981, the tax is
$7,187.50. For 1982, the tax is $6,250.
(4) On its annual return for its determination years 1979, 1980, and
1981, the first three years of its first election, W demonstrates that
it satisfies the requirements of paragraph (b)(2) of this section.
Accordingly, no determination under paragraph (b)(1) of this section is
required for those years, and W is not denied tax exemption by reason of
section 501(h).
(5) On its annual return for its determination year 1982, W must
determine under paragraph (b)(1) whether it has normally made lobbying
expenditures or grass roots expenditures in excess of the corresponding
ceiling amount. This determination takes into account expenditures in
base years 1979 through 1982. The sum of W's lobbying expenditures for
the base years ($470,000) does not exceed 150% of the sum of W's
lobbying nontaxable amounts for those years (150%x$580,000=$870,000).
However, the sum of W's grass roots expenditures for the base years
($220,000) does exceed 150% of the sum of W's grass roots nontaxable
amonts for those years (150%x$145,000=$217,500). Under section 501(h), W
is denied tax exemption under section 501(a) as an organization
described in section 501(c)(3) for its taxable year 1983. For its
taxable year 1984 and any taxable year thereafter, W is exempt from tax
as an organization described in section 501(c)(3) only if W applies for
recognition of its exempt status under paragraph (d) of this section and
is recognized as exempt from tax.
Example 3. (1) The following table contains information used in this
example concerning organization Y.
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Grass roots
Exempt purpose Lobbying Lobbying nontaxable Grass roots
Taxable Year expenditures Calculation nontaxable expenditures amount (25 expenditures
(EPE) amount (LNTA) (LE)(dollars) percent of (dollars)
(dollars) (dollars) LNTA)(dollars)
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1977................................ 700,000 (20% of $500,000+15% of $200,000=) 130,000 182,000 32,500 30,000
1978................................ 800,000 (20% of $500,000+15% of $300,000=) 145,000 224,750 36,250 35,000
---------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------
Subtotal.......................... 1,500,000 .................................. 275,000 406,750 68,750 65,000
[[Page 54]]
1979................................ 900,000 (20% of $500,000+15% of $400,000=) 160,000 264,000 40,000 50,000
---------------- ---------------------------------------------------------------
Totals:........................... 2,400,000 .................................. 435,000 670,750 108,750 115,000
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(2) Organization Y, whose taxable year is the calendar year, was
first treated as an organization described in section 501(c)(3) on
February 1, 1977. Y made the expenditure test election under section
501(h) effective for taxable years beginning with 1977 and has not
revoked the election.
(3) For 1977, Y has excess lobbying expenditures of $52,000 because
its lobbying expenditures ($182,000) exceed its lobbying nontaxable
amount ($130,000) for the taxable year. Accordingly, Y is liable for the
25 percent excise tax imposed by section 4911(a). The amount of the tax
is $13,000 [25%x($182,000-$130,000)=$13,000].
(4) For 1978, Y again has excess lobbying expenditures and is again
liable for the 25 percent excise tax imposed by section 4911(a). The
amount of the tax is $19,937.50 [25%x($224,750-$145,000)=$19,937.50].
(5) For 1979, Y's lobbying expenditures ($264,000) exceed its
lobbying nontaxable amount ($160,000) by $104,000, and its grass roots
expenditures ($50,000) exceed its grass roots nontaxable amount
($40,000) by $10,000. Under Sec. 56.4911-1(b), Y's excess lobbying
expenditures are the greater of $104,000 or $10,000. The amount of the
tax, therefore, is $26,000 [25%x$104,000=$26,000].
(6) Under paragraph (c)(8) of this section, 1977 is not a
determination year because it is the first year for which the
organization is treated as described in section 501(c)(3). For 1977, Y
need not determine whether it has normally made lobbying expenditures or
grass roots expenditures in excess of the corresponding ceiling amount
for purposes of determining whether it is denied exemption under section
501(h) for its taxable year 1978.
(7) For determination year 1978, Y must determine whether it has
normally made lobbying or grass roots expenditures in excess of the
corresponding ceiling amount, taking into account expenditures for the
base years 1977 and 1978. For Y, the determination under paragraph
(b)(2) of this section considers the same base years as the
determination under paragraph (b)(1) of this section and is, therefore,
redundant. Accordingly, Y proceeds to determine, under (b)(1), whether
it is denied exemption. Y's grass roots expenditures for 1977 and 1978
($65,000) did not exceed 150 percent of the sum of its grass roots
nontaxable amounts for those years ($103,125). Y's lobbying expenditures
for 1977 and 1978 ($406,750) did not exceed 150% of its lobbying
nontaxable amount for those years (150%x$275,000=$412,500). Therefore, Y
is not denied tax exemption under section 501(h) for its taxable year
1979.
(8) For determination year 1979, the sum of Y's grass roots
expenditures in base years 1977, 1978, and 1979 does not exceed 150
percent of its grass roots nontaxable amount (calculation omitted).
However, the sum of Y's lobbying expenditures for the base years
($670,750) does exceed 150% of the sum of the lobbying nontaxable
amounts for those years (150%x$435,000=$652,500). Since Y was not
described in section 501(c)(3) prior to 1977, only the years 1977, 1978,
and 1979 may be considered in determining whether Y has normally made
lobbying expenditures in excess of its lobbying ceiling. Therefore, Y
determines that it has normally made lobbying expenditures in excess of
its lobbying ceiling. Under section 501(h), Y is denied tax exemption
under section 501(a) as an organization described in section 501(c)(3)
for its taxable year 1980. For its taxable year 1981, and any taxable
year thereafter, Y is exempt from tax as an organization described in
section 501(c)(3) only if Y applies for recognition of its exempt status
under paragraph (d) of this section and is recognized as exempt from
tax.
Example 4. Organization M made the expenditure test election under
section 501(h) effective for taxable years beginning with 1977 and has
not revoked the election. M has $500,000 of exempt purpose expenditures
during each of the years 1981 through 1984. In addition, during each of
those years, M spends $75,000 for direct lobbying and $25,000 for grass
roots lobbying. Since the amount expended for M's lobbying (both total
lobbying and grass roots lobbying) is within the respective nontaxable
expenditure limitations, M is not liable for the 25 percent excise tax
imposed under section 4911(a) upon excess lobbying expenditures, nor is
M denied tax-exempt status by reason of section 501 (h).
Example 5. Assume the same facts as in Example 4, except that, on
behalf of M, numerous unpaid volunteers conduct substantial lobbying
activities with no reimbursement. Since the substantial lobbying
activities of the unpaid volunteers are not counted towards the
expenditure limitations and the amount expended for M's lobbying is
within
[[Page 55]]
the respective nontaxable expenditure limitations, M is not liable for
the 25 percent excise tax under section 4911, nor is M denied tax-exempt
status by reason of section 501(h).
[T.D. 8308, 55 FR 35589, Aug. 31, 1990]
Sec. 1.501(k)-1 Communist-controlled organizations.
Under section 11(b) of the Internal Security Act of 1950 (50 U.S.C.
790(b)), as amended, which is made applicable to the Code by section
7852(b) of that Code, no organization is entitled to exemption under
sections 501(a) or 521(a) for any taxable year if at any time during
such year such organization is registered under section 7 of such Act or
if there is in effect a final order of the Subversive Activities Control
Board established by section 12 of such Act requiring such organization
to register under section 7 of such Act, or determining that it is a
Communist-infiltrated organization.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960; redesignated by T.D. 8100, 51 FR
31615, Sept. 4, 1986]
Sec. 1.502-1 Feeder organizations.
(a) In the case of an organization operated for the primary purpose
of carrying on a trade or business for profit, exemption is not allowed
under section 501 on the ground that all the profits of such
organization are payable to one or more organizations exempt from
taxation under section 501. In determining the primary purpose of an
organization, all the circumstances must be considered, including the
size and extent of the trade or business and the size and extent of
those activities of such organization which are specified in the
applicable paragraph of section 501.
(b) If a subsidiary organization of a tax-exempt organization would
itself be exempt on the ground that its activities are an integral part
of the exempt activities of the parent organization, its exemption will
not be lost because, as a matter of accounting between the two
organizations, the subsidiary derives a profit from its dealings with
its parent organization, for example, a subsidiary organization which is
operated for the sole purpose of furnishing electric power used by its
parent organization, a tax-exempt educational organization, in carrying
on its educational activities. However, the subsidiary organization is
not exempt from tax if it is operated for the primary purpose of
carrying on a trade or business which would be an unrelated trade or
business (that is, unrelated to exempt activities) if regularly carried
on by the parent organization. For example, if a subsidiary organization
is operated primarily for the purpose of furnishing electric power to
consumers other than its parent organization (and the parent's tax-
exempt subsidiary organizations), it is not exempt since such business
would be an unrelated trade or business if regularly carried on by the
parent organization. Similarly, if the organization is owned by several
unrelated exempt organizations, and is operated for the purpose of
furnishing electric power to each of them, it is not exempt since such
business would be an unrelated trade or business if regularly carried on
by any one of the tax-exempt organizations. For purposes of this
paragraph, organizations are related only if they consist of:
(1) A parent organization and one or more of its subsidiary
organizations; or
(2) Subsidiary organizations having a common parent organization
An exempt organization is not related to another exempt organization
merely because they both engage in the same type of exempt activities.
(c) In certain cases an organization which carries on a trade or
business for profit but is not operated for the primary purpose of
carrying on such trade or business is subject to the tax imposed under
section 511 on its unrelated business taxable income.
(d) Exception--(1) Taxable years beginning before January 1, 1970.
For purposes of section 502 and this section, for taxable years
beginning before January 1, 1970, the term trade or business does not
include the rental by an organization of its real property (including
personal property leased with the real property).
(2) Taxable years beginning after December 31, 1969. For purposes of
section 502 and this section, for taxable years beginning after December
31, 1969, the term trade or business does not include:
(i) The deriving of rents described in section 512(b)(3)(A),
[[Page 56]]
(ii) Any trade or business in which substantially all the work in
carrying on such trade or business is performed for the organization
without compensation, or
(iii) Any trade or business (such as a thrift shop) which consists
of the selling of merchandise, substantially all of which has been
received by the organization as gifts or contributions
For purposes of the exception described in subdivision (i) of this
subparagraph, if the rents derived by an organization would not be
excluded from unrelated business income pursuant to section 512(b)(3)
and the regulations thereunder, the deriving of such rents shall be
considered a trade or business.
(3) Cross references and special rules. (i) For determination of
when rents are excluded from the tax on unrelated business income see
section 512(b)(3) and the regulations thereunder.
(ii) The rules contained in Sec. 1.513-1(e)(1) shall apply in
determining whether a trade or business is described in section
502(b)(2) and subparagraph (2)(ii) of this paragraph.
(iii) The rules contained in Sec. 1.513-1(e)(3) shall apply in
determining whether a trade or business is described in section
502(b)(3) and subparagraph (2)(iii) of this paragraph.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, No. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6662, 28 FR
6973, July 29, 1963; T.D. 7033, 35 FR 19997, Dec. 31, 1970]
Sec. 1.503(a)-1 Denial of exemption to certain organizations engaged
in prohibited transactions.
(a)(1) Prior to January 1, 1970, section 503 applies to those
organizations described in sections 501(c)(3), 501(c)(17), and section
401(a) except:
(i) A religious organization (other than a trust);
(ii) An educational organization which normally maintains a regular
faculty and curriculum and normally has a regularly enrolled body of
pupils or students in attendance at the place where its educational
activities are regularly carried on;
(iii) An organization which normally receives a substantial part of
its support (exclusive or income received in the exercise or performance
by such organization of its charitable, educational, or other purpose or
function constituting the basis for its exemption under section 501(a))
from the United States or any State or political subdivision thereof or
from direct of indirect contributions from the general public,
(iv) An organization which is operated, supervised, controlled or
principally supported by a religious organization (other than a trust)
which is itself not subject to the provisions of this section; and
(v) An organization the principal purposes or functions of which are
the providing of medical or hospital care or medical education or
medical research or agricultural research.
(2) Effective January 1, 1907, and prior to January 1, 1975, section
503 shall apply only to organizations described in section 501(c) (17)
or (18) or section 401(a).
(3) Effective January 1, 1975, section 503 shall apply only to
organization described in section 501(c) (17) or (18) or described in
section 401(a) and referred to in section 4975(g) (2) or (3).
(b) The prohibited transactions enumerated in section 503(b) are in
addition to and not in limitation of the restrictions contained in
section 501(c) (3), (17), or (18) or section 401(a). Even though an
organization has not engaged in any of the prohibited transactions
referred to in section 503(b), it still may not qualify for tax
exemptions in view of the general provisions of section 501(c) (3),
(17), or (18) or section 401(a). Thus, if a trustee or other fiduciary
of the organization (whether or not he is also a creater or such
organization) enters into a transaction with the organization, such
transaction will be closely scrutinized in the light of the fiduciary
principle requiring undivided loyalty to ascertain whether the
organization is in fact being operated for the stated exempt purpose.
(c) An organization--(1) Described in section 501(c)(3) which after
July 1, 1950, but before January 1, 1970, has engaged in any prohibited
transaction as defined in section 503(b), unless it is excepted by the
provisions of paragraph (a)(1) of this section;
(2) Described in section 401(a) and referred to in section 4975(g)
(2) or (3) which after March 1, 1954, has engaged
[[Page 57]]
in any prohibited transaction as defined in section 503(b);
(3) Described in section 401(a) and not referred to in section
4975(g) (2) or (3) which after March 1, 1954, but before January 1,
1975, has engaged in any prohibited transaction as defined in section
503(b) or which after December 31, 1962, but before January 1, 1975, has
engaged in any prohibited transaction as defined in section 503(g) prior
to its repeal by section 2003(b)(5) of the Employee Retirement Income
Security Act of 1974 (88 Stat. 978);
(4) Described in section 501(c)(17) which after December 31, 1959,
has engaged in any prohibited transaction as defined in section 503(b);
or
(5) Described in section 501(c)(18) which after December 31, 1969,
has engaged in any prohibited transaction described in section 503(b)
Shall not be exempt from taxation under section 501(a) for any taxable
year subsequent to the taxable year in which there is mailed to it a
notice in writing by the Commissioner that it has engaged in such
prohibited transactions. Such notification by the Commissioner shall be
by registered or certified mail to the last known name and address of
the organization. However, notwithstanding the requirement of
notification by the Commissioner, the exemption shall be denied with
respect to any taxable year if such organization during or prior to such
taxable year commenced the prohibited transaction with the purpose of
diverting income or corpus from its exempt purposes and such transaction
involved a substantial party of the income or corpus of such
organization. For the purpose of this section, the term taxable year
means the established annual accounting period of the organization; or,
if the organization has no such established annual accounting period,
the taxable year of the organizations means a calendar year. See 26 CFR
Sec. 1.503(j)-1 (rev. as of Apr. 1, 1974) for provisions relating to
the definition of prohibited transactions in the case of trusts
benefitting certain owner-employees after December 31, 1962, but prior
to January 1, 1975. See also section 2003 (c)(1)(B) of the Employee
Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (88 Stat. 978) in the case of an
organization described in section 401(a) with respect to which a
disqualified person elects to pay a tax in the amount and manner
provided with respect to the tax imposed by section 4975 of the Code so
that the organization may avoid denial of exemption under section 503.
For further guidance regarding the definition of last known address, see
Sec. 301.6212-2 of this chapter.
(d) The application of section 503(b) may be illustrated by the
following examples:
Example 1. A creates a foundation in 1954 ostensibly for educational
purposes. B, a trustee, accumulates the foundation's income from 1957
until 1959 and then uses a substantial part of this accumulated income
to send A's children to college. The foundation would lose its exemption
for the taxable years 1957 through 1959 and for subsequent taxable years
until it regains its exempt status.
Example 2. If under the facts in Example 1 such private benefit was
the purpose of the foundation from its inception, such foundation is not
exempt by reason of the general provisions of section 501(c)(3), without
regard to the provisions of section 503, for all years since its
inception, that is, for the taxable years 1954 through 1959 and
subsequent taxable years, since under section 501(c)(3) the organization
must be organized and operated exclusively for exempt purposes. See
Sec. 1.501(c)(3)-1.
[T.D. 7428, 41 FR 34621, Aug. 16, 1976, as amended by T.D. 8939, 66 FR
2819, Jan. 12, 2001]
Sec. 1.503(b)-1 Prohibited transactions.
(a) In general. The term prohibited transaction means any
transaction set forth in section 503(b) engaged in by any organization
described in paragraph (a) of Sec. 1.503(a)-1. Whether a transaction is
a prohibited transaction depends on the facts and circumstances of the
particular case. This section is intended to deny tax-exempt status to
such organizations which engage in certain transactions which inure to
the private advantage of (1) the creator of such organization (if it is
a trust); (2) any substantial contributor to such organization; (3) a
member of the family (as defined in section 267(c)(4) of an individual
who is such creator of or such substantial contributor to such
organization; or (4) a corporation controlled, as set forth in section
503(b), by such creator or substantial contributor.
[[Page 58]]
(b) Loans as prohibited transactions under section 503(b)(1)--(1)
Adequate security. For the purposes of section 503(b)(1), which treats
as prohibited transactions certain loans by an organization without
receipt of adequate security and a reasonable rate of interest, the term
adequate security means something in addition to and supporting a
promise to pay, which is so pledged to the organization that it may be
sold, foreclosed upon, or otherwise disposed of in default of repayment
of the loan, the value and liquidity of which security is such that it
may reasonably be anticipated that loss of principal or interest will
not result from the loan. Mortgages or liens on property, accommodation
endorsements of those financially capable of meeting the indebtedness,
and stock or securities issued by corporations other than the borrower
may constitute security for a loan to the persons or organizations
described in section 503(b). Stock of a borrowing corporation does not
constitute adequate security. A borrower's evidence of indebtedness,
irrespective of its name, is not security for a loan, whether or not it
was issued directly to the exempt organization. However, if any such
evidence of indebtedness provides for security that may be sold,
foreclosed upon, or otherwise disposed of in default of repayment of the
loan, there may be adequate security for such loan. If an organization
subject to section 503(b) purchases debentures issued by a person
specified in section 503(b), the purchase is considered, for purposes of
section 503(b)(1), as a loan made by the purchaser to the issuer on the
date of such purchase. For example, if an exempt organization subject to
section 503(b) makes a purchase through a registered security exchange
of debentures issued by a person described in section 503(b), and owned
by an unknown third party, the purchase will be considered as a loan to
the issuer by the purchaser. For rules relating to loan of funds to, or
investment of funds in stock or securities of, persons described in
section 503(b) by an organization described in section 401(a), see
paragraph (b)(5) of Sec. 1.401-1.
(2) Effective dates. The effective dates for the application of the
definition of adequate security in paragraph (b)(1) of this paragraph
are:
(i) March 15, 1956, for loans (other than debentures) made after
March 15, 1956;
(ii) January 31, 1957, for loans (other than debentures) made before
March 16, 1956, and continued after January 31, 1957;
(iii) November 8, 1956, for debentures which were purchased after
November 8, 1956;
(iv) December 1, 1958, for debentures which were purchased before
November 9, 1956, and held after December 1, 1958;
(v) If an employees' pension, stock bonus, or profit-sharing trust
described in section 401(a) made a loan before March 1, 1954, repayable
by its terms after December 31, 1955, and which would constitute a
prohibited transaction if made on or after March 1, 1954, the loan shall
not constitute a prohibited transaction if held until maturity
(determined without regard to any extension or renewal thereof);
(vi) January 1, 1960, for loans (including the purchase of
debentures) made by supplemental unemployment benefit trusts, described
in section 501 (c)(17);
(vii) January 1, 1970, for loans (including the purchase of
debentures) made by employees' contribution pension plan trusts
described in section 501(c)(18).
(3) Certain exceptions to section 503(b)(1). See section 503(e) and
Sec. 1.503(e)-1, 1.503(e)-2, and 1.503(e)-3 for special rules providing
that certain obligations acquired by trusts described in section 401(a)
or section 501(c) (17) or (18) shall not be treated as loans made
without the receipt of adequate security for purposes of section
503(b)(1). See section 503(f) and Sec. 1.503(f)-1 for an exception to
the application of sections 503(b)(1) for certain loans made by
employees' trusts described in section 401(a).
(c) Examples. The principles of this section are illustrated by the
following examples: (Assume that section 503 (e) and (f) are not
applicable.)
Example 1. A, creator of an exempt trust subject to section 503,
borrows $100,000 from such trust in 1960, giving his unsecured
promissory note. The net worth of A is $1,000,000. The net worth of A is
not security
[[Page 59]]
for such loan and the transaction is a prohibited transaction. If,
however, the note is secured by a mortgage on property of sufficient
value, or is accompanied by acceptable collateral of sufficient value,
or carries with it the secondary promise of repayment by an
accommodation endorser financially capable of meeting the indebtedness,
it may be adequately secured. However, subordinated debentures bonds of
a partnership which are guaranteed by the general partners are not
adequately secured since the general partners are liable for the firm's
debt and their guaranty adds no additional security.
Example 2. Assume the same facts as in example 1 except that A's
promissory note in the amount of $100,000 to the trust is secured by
property which has a fair market value of $75,000. A's promissory note
secured to the extent of $75,000 is not adequately secured within the
meaning of section 503(b)(1) since the security at the time of the
transaction must be sufficient to repay the indebtedness, interest, and
charges which may pertain thereto.
Example 3. Corporation M, a substantial contributor to an exempt
organization subject to section 503, borrows $150,000 from such
organization in 1960, giving its promissory note accompanied by stock of
the borrowing corporation with a fair market value of $200,000. Since
promissory notes and debentures have priority over stock in the event of
liquidation of the corporation, stock of a borrowing corporation is not
adequate security. Likewise, debenture bonds which are convertible on
default into voting stock of the issuing corporation do not constitute
adequate security under section 503(b)(1).
Example 4. B, creator of an exempt trust subject to section 503,
borrows $100,000 from such trust in 1960, giving his secured promissory
note at the rate of 3 percent interest. The prevailing rate of interest
charged by financial institutions in the community where the transaction
takes place is 5 percent for a loan of the same duration and similarly
secured. The loan by the trust to the grantor is a prohibited
transaction since section 503(b)(1) requires both adequate security and
a reasonable rate of interest. Further, a promise to repay the loan plus
a percentage of future profits which may be greater than the prevailing
rate of interest does not meet the reasonable rate of interest
requirement.
Example 5. N Corporation, a substantial contributor to an exempt
organization subject to section 503 borrows $50,000 on or after March
16, 1956, from the organization. If the loan is not adequately secured,
the organization has committed a prohibited transaction at the time the
loan was made. If the loan had been made on or before March 15, 1956,
and is continued after January 31, 1957, it must be adequately secured
on February 1, 1957, or it will be considered a prohibited transaction
on that date. However, if the exempt organization were an employees'
trust, described in section 401(a), and the loan were made before March
1, 1954, repayable by its terms after December 31, 1955, it would not
have to be adequately secured on February 1, 1957. Moreover, if the
exempt organization were a supplemental unemployment benefit trust,
described in section 501(c)(17), and the loan were made before January
1, 1960, repayable by its terms after December 31, 1959, it would not
have to be adequately secured on January 1, 1960.
Example 6. An exempt organization subject to section 503 purchases a
debenture issued by O Corporation, which is a substantial contributor to
the organization. The organization purchases the debenture in an arm's
length transaction from a third person on or after November 9, 1956. The
purchase is considered as a loan by the organization to O Corporation.
The loan must be adequately secured when it is made, or it is considered
as a prohibited transaction at that time. If the organization purchased
the debenture before November 9, 1956, and holds it after December 1,
1958, the debenture must be adequately secured on December 2, 1958, or
it will then be considered as a prohibited transaction. However, if the
organization were an employees' trust described in section 401(a), and
if the debenture were purchased before March 1, 1954, and its maturity
date is after December 31, 1955, the debenture does not have to be
adequately secured. Moreover, if the organization were an employees'
contribution pension plan trust described in section 501(c)(18), and if
the debenture were purchased before January 1, 1970, and its maturity
date is after December 31, 1969, the debenture does not have to be
adequately secured.
[T.D. 7428, 41 FR 34621, Aug. 16, 1976]
Sec. 1.503(c)-1 Future status of organizations denied exemption.
(a) Any organization described in section 501(c) (3), (17), or (18),
or an employees' trust described in section 401(a), which is denied
exemption under section 501(a) by reason of the provisions of section
503(a), may file, in any taxable year following the taxable year in
which notice of denial was issued, a claim for exemption. In the case of
organizations described in section 501(c) (3), (17), or (18), the
appropriate exemption application shall be used for this purpose, and
shall be filed with the district director. In the case of an enmployees'
trust described in section 401(a), the information described in Sec.
1.404(a)-2 shall be submitted with a
[[Page 60]]
letter claiming exemption. All employees' trust described in section
401(a) shall submit this information to the district director with whom
a request for a determination as to its qualification under section 401
and exemption under section 501 may be submitted under paragraph (s) of
Sec. 601.201 of this chapter (Statement of Procedural Rules). A claim
for exemption must contain or have attached to it, in addition to the
information generally required of such an organization claiming
exemption as an organization described in section 501(c) (17), or (18),
or section 401(a) (or section 501(c)(3) prior to January 1, 1970), a
written declaration made under the penalities of perjury by principal
officer of such organization authorized to make such declaration that
the organization will not knowingly again engage in a prohibited
transaction, (as defined in section 503(b) (or 4975(c) if such section
applies to such organization)). In the case of section 501(c)(3)
organizations which have lost their exemption after December 31, 1969,
pursuant to section 503, a claim for exemption must contain or have
attached to it a written agreement made under penalities of perjury by a
principal officer of such organization authorized to make such agreement
that the organization will not violate the provisions of chapter 42. In
addition, such organization must comply with the rules for governing
instruments as prescribed in Sec. 1.508-3. See Sec. 1.501(a)-1 for
proof of exemption requirements in general.
(b) If the Commissioner is satisfied that such organization will not
knowingly again engage in a prohibited transaction (as defined under
section 503(b) or 4975(c), as applicable to such organization) or in the
case of a section 501(c)(3) organization, will not violate the
provisions of chapter 42, and the organization also satisfied all the
other requirements under section 501(c) (3), (17), or (18), or section
401(a), the organization will be so notified in writing. In such case
the organization will be exempt (subject to the provisions of section
501(c)(3), or sections 501(c) (17), (18) or 401(a), and 503, and 504
when applicable) with respect to the taxable years subsequent to the
taxable year in which the claim described in section 503(c) is filed.
Section 503 contemplates that an organization denied exemption because
of the terms of such section will be subject to taxation for at least
one full taxable year. For the purpose of this section, the term taxable
year means the established annual accounting period of the organization;
or, if the organization has no such established annual accounting
period, the taxable year of the organization means the calendar year.
(c) For taxable years beginning after December 31, 1969, the denial
of an exemption pursuant to this section, for a taxable year prior to
January 1, 1970, of an organization described in section 501(c)(3) shall
not cause such organization to cease to be described in section
501(c)(3) for purposes of part II of subchapter F, chapter 1 and for
purposes of the application of chapter 42 taxes.
(d) In the case of an organization described in section 501(c)(3),
which has lost its exemption pursuant to section 503, and which has not
notified the Commissioner that it is applying for recognition of its
exempt status under section 508(a) and this section, no gift or
contribution made after December 31, 1969, which would otherwise be
deductible under section 170, 642(c), or 545(b)(2) shall be allowed as a
deduction. For rules relating to the denial of deductions with respect
to gifts or contributions made before January 1, 1970, see, Sec.
1.503(e)-4.
[T.D. 7428, 41 FR 34622, Aug. 16, 1976, as amended by T.D. 7896, 48 FR
23817, May 27, 1983]
Sec. 1.503(d)-1 Cross references.
For provisions relating to loans described in section 503(b)(1) by a
trust described in section 401(a), see Sec. 1.503(b)-1 and section 503
(e) and (f) and the regulations thereunder.
[T.D. 7428, 41 FR 34623, Aug. 16, 1976]
Sec. 1.503(e)-1 Special rules.
(a) In general. (1) Section 503(e) provides that for purposes of
section 503(b)(1) (relating to loans made without the receipt of
adequate security and a reasonable rate of interest) the acquisition of
a bond, debenture, note, or certificate or other evidence of
indebtedness shall not be treated as a
[[Page 61]]
loan made without the receipt of adequate security if certain
requirements are met. Those requirements are described in Sec.
1.503(e)-2.
(2) Section 503(e) does not affect the requirement in section
503(b)(1) of a reasonable rate of interest. Thus, although the
acquistion of a certificate of indebtedness which meets all of the
requirements of section 503(e) and of Sec. 1.503(e)-2 will not be
considered as a loan made without the receipt of adequate security, the
acquisition of such an indebtedness does consitute a prohibited
transaction if the indebtedness does not bear a reasonable rate of
interest.
(3) The provisions of section 503(e) do not limit the effect of
section 401(a) and Sec. 1.401-2, section 501(c)(17)(A)(i), or section
501(c)(18)(A), all relating to the use of diversion of corpus or incopme
of the respective employee trusts. Furthermore, the provisions of
section 503(e) do not limit the effect of any of the provisions of
section 503 other than section 503(b)(1). Thus, for example, although a
loan made by employees' trust described in section 503(a)(1)(B) meets
all the requirements of section 503(e) and therefore is not treated as a
loan made without the receipt of adequate security, such an employees'
trust making such a loan will lose its exempt status if the loan is not
considered as made for the exclusive benefit of the employees or their
beneficiaries. Similarly, a loan which meets the requirements of section
503(e) will constitute a prohibited transaction within the meaning of
section 503(b)(6) if it results in a substantial diversion of the
trust's income or corpus to a person described in section 503(b).
(b) Definitions. For purposes of section 503(e):
(1) The term obligation means bond, debenture, note, or certificate
or other evidence of indebtedness.
(2) The term issuer includes any person described in section 503(b)
who issues an obligation.
(3)(i) The term person independent of the issuer means a person who
is not related to the issuer by blood, by marriage, or by reason of any
substantial business interests. Persons who will be considered not to be
independent of the issuer include but are not limited to:
(a) The spouse, ancestor, lineal descendant, or brother or sister
(whether by whole or half blood) of an individual who is the issuer of
an obligation;
(b) A corporation controlled directly or indirectly by an individual
who is the issuer, or directly or indirectly by the spouse, ancestor,
lineal descendant, or brother or sister (whether by whole or half blood)
of an individual who is the issuer;
(c) A corporation which directly or indirectly controls, or is
controlled by, a corporate issuer;
(d) A controlling shareholder of a corporation which is the issuer,
or which controls the issuer;
(e) An officer, director, or other employee of the issuer, of a
corporation controlled by the issuer, or of a corporation which controls
the issuer;
(f) A fiduciary of any trust created by the issuer, by a corporation
which controls the issuer, or by a corporation which is controlled by
the issuer; or
(g) A corporation controlled by a person who controls a corporate
issuer.
(ii) For purposes of paragraph (b)(3)(i) of this section, the term
control means, with respect to a corporation, direct or indirect
ownership of 50 percent or more of the total combined voting power of
all voting stock or 50 percent or more of the total value of shares of
all classes of stock. If the aggregate amount of stock in a corporation
owned by an individual and by the spouse, ancestors, lineal descendants,
brothers and sisters (whether by whole of half blood) of the individual
is 50 percent or more of the total combined voting power of all voting
stock or is 50 percent or more of the total value of all classes of
stock, then each of these persons shall be considered as the controlling
shareholder of the corporation.
(iii) In determining family relationships for purposes of paragraph
(b)(3)(i) of this section, a legally adopted child of an individual
shall be treated as a child of such individual by blood.
(4) The term issue means all the obligations of an issuer which are
offered for sale on substantially the same terms. Obligations shall be
considered offered for sale on substantially the same terms if such
obligation would, at the same time and under the same circumstances, be
traded on the market
[[Page 62]]
at the same price. On the other hand, if the terms on which obligations
are offered for sale differ in such manner as would cause such
obligations to be traded on the market at different prices, then such
obligations are not part of the same issue. The following are examples
of terms which, if different, would cause obligations to be traded on
the market at different prices: (i) Interest rate; (ii) Maturity date;
(iii) Collateral; and (iv) Conversion provisions
The fact that obligations are offered for sale on different dates will
not preclude such obligations from being part of the same issue if they
all mature on the same date and if the terms on which they are offered
for sale are otherwise the same, since such obligations would, at the
same time and under the same conditions, be traded on the market at the
same price. Obligations shall not be considered part of the same issue
merely because they are part of the same authorization or because they
are registered as part of the same issue with the Securities and
Exchange Commission.
[T.D. 7428, 41 FR 34623, Aug. 16, 1976]
Sec. 1.503(e)-2 Requirements.
(a) In general. The requirements which must be met under section
503(e) for an obligation not to be treated as a loan made without the
receipt of adequate security for purposes of section 503(b)(1) are
described in paragraphs (b), (c), and (d) of this section. For purposes
of this section, the term employee trust shall mean any of the three
kinds of organizations described in section 503(a)(1).
(b) Methods of acquisition--(1) In general. The employee trust must
acquire the obligation of the market, by purchase from an underwriter,
or by purchase from the issuer, in the manner described in subparagraph
(2), (3), or (4) of this paragraph.
(2) On the market. (i) An obligation is acquired on the market when
it is purchased through a national securities exchange which is
registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission, or when it is
purchased in an over-the-counter transaction. For purposes of the
preceding sentence, securities purchased through an exchange which is
not a national securities exchange registered with the Securities and
Exchange Commission shall be treated as securities purchased in an over-
the-counter transaction.
(ii)(a) If the obligation is listed on a national securities
exchange registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission, it must
be purchased through such an exchange or in an over-the-counter
transaction at a price not greater than the price of the obligation
prevailing on such an exchange at the time of the purchase by the
employee trust.
(b) For purposes of section 503(e), the price of the obligation
prevailing at the time of the purchase means the price which accurately
reflects the market value of the obligation. In the case of an
obligation purchased through a national securities exchange which is
registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission, the price paid
for the obligation will be considered the prevailing price of the
obligation. In the case of an obligation purchased in an over-the-
counter transaction, the prevailing price may be the price at which the
last sale of the obligation was affected on such national securities
exchange immediately before the employee trust's purchase of such
obligation on the same day or may be the mean between the highest and
lowest prices at which sales were effected on such exchange on the same
day or on the immediately preceding day or on the last day during which
there were sales of such obligation or may be a price determined by any
other method which accurately reflects the market value of the
obligation.
(iii)(a) If the obligation is not listed on a national securities
exchange which is registered with the Securities and Exchange
Commission, it must be purchased in an over-the-counter transaction at a
price not greater than the offering price for the obligation as
established by current bid and asked prices quoted by persons
independent of the issuer.
(b) For purposes of section 503(e) the offering price for the
obligation at the time of the purchase means the price which accurately
reflects the market value of the obligation. The offering
[[Page 63]]
price may be the price at which the last sale of the obligation to a
person independent of the issuer was effected immediately before the
employee trust's purchase of such obligation on the same day or may be
the mean between the highest and lowest prices at which sales to persons
independent of the issuer were effected on the same day or on the last
day during which they were sales of such obligation or may be a price
determinated by any other method which accurately reflects the market
value of the obligation. The offering price for an obligation must be a
valid price for the amount of the obligations which the trust is
purchasing. For example, if an employees' trust described in section
503(a)(1)(B) purchases 1,000 bonds of the employer corporation at the
offering price established by current prices for a lot of 10 such bonds,
such offering price may not be a valid price for 1,000 bonds and the
purchase may therefore not meet the requirements of this subdivision.
For a purchase of an obligation to qualify under this subdivision, there
must be sufficient current prices quoted by persons independent of the
issuer to establish accurately the current value of the obligation.
Thus, if there are no current prices quoted by persons independent of
the issuer, an over-the-counter transaction will not qualify under this
subparagraph even though the obligation was purchased in an arms's
length transaction from a person independent of the issuer.
(iv) For purposes of this section, an over-the-counter transaction
is one not executed on a national securities exchange which is
registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission. An over-the-
counter transaction may be made through a dealer or an exchange which is
not such a national securities exchange or may be made directly from the
seller to the purchaser.
(3) From an underwriter. An obligation may be purchased from an
underwriter if it is purchased at a price not greater than:
(i) The public offering price for the obligation as set forth in a
prospectus or offering circular filed with the Securities and Exchange
Commission, or
(ii) The price at which a substantial portion of the issue including
such obligation is acquired by persons independent of the issuer
whichever is the lesser price. For purposes of this subparagraph, a
portion of the issue will be considered substantial if the purchasers of
such portion by persons independent of the issuer are sufficient to
establish that fair market value of the obligations included in such
issue. In determining whether the purchases are sufficient to establish
the fair market value, all the surrounding facts and circumstances will
be considered, including the number of independent purchasers, the
aggregate amount purchased by each such independent purchaser, and the
number of transactions. In the case of a large issue, purchases of a
small percentage of the outstanding obligations may be considered
purchases of a substantial portion of the issue; whereas, in the case of
a small issue, purchases of a larger percentage of the outstanding
obligations will ordinarily be required. The requirement in paragraph
(b)(3)(ii) of this section contemplates purchase of the obligations by
persons independent of the issuer contemporaneously with the purchase by
the employee trust. If a substantial portion has been purchased at
different prices, the price of the portion may be based on the average
of such prices, and if several substantial portions have been sold to
persons independent of the issuer, the price of any of the substantial
portions may be used for pusposes of this subparagraph.
(4) From the issuer. An obligation may be purchased directly from
the issuer at a price not greater than the price paid currently for a
substantial portion of the same issue by persons independent of the
issuer. This requirement contemplates purchase of a substantial portion
of the same issue by persons independent of the issuer contemporaneously
with the purchase by the employee trust. For purposes of this
subparagraph, a portion of the issue will be considered substantial if
the purchases of such portion by persons independent of the issuer are
sufficient to establish the fair market value of the obligations
included in such issue. In determining whether the purchases are
sufficient to establish the fair market value, all the surrounding facts
and
[[Page 64]]
circumstances will be considered, including the number of independent
purchasers, the aggregage amount purchased by each such independent
purchaser, and the number of transactions. In the case of a large issue,
purchases of a small percentage of the outstanding obligations may be
considered purchases of a substantial portion of the issue; whereas, in
the case of a small issue, purchases of a larger percentage of the
outstanding obligations will ordinarily be required. The price paid for
a substantial portion of the issue may be determined in the manner
privided in paragraph (b)(3) of this section.
(c) Limitations on holdings of obligations. (1) Immediately
following acquisition of the obligation by the employee trust:
(i) Not more than 25 percent of the aggregate amount of the
obligations issued in such issue and outstanding immediately after
acquisition by the trust may be held by the trust, and
(ii) At least 50 percent of such aggregate amount must be held by
persons independent of the issuer.
(2)(i) For purposes of paragraph (c)(1) of this section, an
obligation is not considered as outstanding if it is held by the issuer.
For example, if an obligation which has been issued and outstanding is
repurchased and held by the issuer, without cancellation or retirement,
such an obligation is not considered outstanding.
(ii) For purposes of paragraph (c)(1) of this section, the amounts
of the obligations held by the trust and by persons independent of the
issuer shall be computed on the basis of the face amount of the
obligations.
(d) Limitation on amount invested in obligations. (1)(i) Immediately
following acquisition of the obligation, not more 25 percent of the
assets of the employee trust may be invested in all obligations of all
persons described in section 503(b). For purposes of determining the
amount of the trust's assets which are invested in obligations of
persons described in section 503(b) immediately following acquisition of
the obligation, those obligations shall be valued as follows:
(a) Those obligations included in the acquisition in respect of
which the percentage test in the first sentence of this subdivision is
being applied shall be valued at their adjusted basis, as provided in
section 1011, relating to adjusted basis for determining gain or loss;
and
(b) All other obligations of persons described in section 503(b)
which were part of the trust's assets immediately before the acquisition
of the obligations described in (d)(1)(i)(a) of this section shall be
valued at their fair market value on the day that the obligations
described in (d)(1)(i)(a) of this section were acquired. For purposes of
determining the total amount of the assets of the trust (including
obligations of persons described in section 503(b)), there shall be used
the fair market value of those assets on the day the obligation is
acquired.
(ii) The application of the rules in paragraph (d)(1)(i) of this
section may be illustrated by the following example:
Example. On February 1, 1960, an exempt employees' trust described
in section 401(a) purchases unsecured debentures issued by the employer
corporation for $1,000. At the time of this purchase, such debentures
have a fair market value of $1,200. Immediately after the purchase of
such unsecured debentures, the assets of the trust consist of the
following:
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Fair
market
Cost value on
Feb. 1,
1960
------------------------------------------------------------------------
(a) Assets other than obligations of persons $5,000 $7,800
described in sec. 503(b).......................
(b) Obligations of persons described in sec. 500 1,000
503(b) acquired before Feb. 1, 1960............
(c) Unsecured debentures of employer purchased 1,000 1,200
on Feb. 1, 1960................................
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Immediately following acquisition of the unsecured debentures by the
trust, the percent of the assets of the trust that are invested in all
obligations of all persons described in section 503(b) is computed as
follows:
(1) Obligations of persons described in section 503(b) $1,000
acquired before Feb. 1, 1960 (valued at fair market value).
(2) Unsecured debentures of employer purchased on Feb. 1, 1,000
1960 (valued at cost)......................................
-----------
(3) Total amount of trust's assets invested in obligations 2,000
of persons described in section 503(b) ((1) plus (2))......
===========
[[Page 65]]
(4) Assets of the trust other than obligations of persons 7,800
described in section 503(b) (valued at fair market value on
Feb. 1, 1960)..............................................
(5) Obligations of persons described in section 503(b) 1,000
acquired before Feb. 1, 1960 (valued at fair market value
on Feb. 1, 1960)...........................................
(6) Unsecured debentures of employer purchased on Feb. 1, $1,200
1960 (valued at fair market value on Feb. 1, 1960).........
-----------
(7) Total assets of the trust valued at fair market value on 10,000
Feb. 1, 1960 (sum of (4), (5), and (6))....................
(8) Percent of assets of the trust invested in all 20%
obligations of all persons described in section 503(b)
immediately following purchase of unsecured debentures on
Feb. 1, 1960 ((3)/(7), that is, $2,000/$10,000)............
(2) In determining for purposes of subparagraph (1) of this
paragraph the amount invested in obligations of persons described in
section 503(b), there shall be included amounts invested in any
obligations issued by any such person, irrespective of whether the
obligation is secured, and irrespective of whether the obligation meets
the conditions of section 503(e) or section 503(f). Obligations of
persons described in section 503(b) other than the issuer of the
obligation to which section 503(e) applies are also included within the
25 percent limitation. For example, if on February 19, 1959, an exempt
employees' trust described in section 401(a) purchases unsecured
debentures issued by the employer corporation in a transaction effected
on the New York Stock Exchange, and if immediately after the purchase 10
percent of the trust's assets is invested in such debentures and 20
percent of its assets is invested in a loan made with adequate security
on January 12, 1959, to the wholly-owned subsidiary of the employer
corporation, then the purchase of the employer's debentures will not
qualify under section 503(e), since 30 percent of the trust's assets are
then invested in obligations of persons described in section 503(b).
(e) Change of terms of an obligation. A change in terms of an
obligation is considered as the acquisition of a new obligation. If such
new obligation is not adequately secured, the requirements of section
503(e) must be met at the time the terms of the obligation are changed
for such section to be applicable to such new loan.
[T.D. 7428, 41 FR 34624, Aug. 16, 1976]
Sec. 1.503(e)-3 Effective dates.
(a) Section 503(e) and Sec. Sec. 1.503(e)-1 and 1.503(e)-3 are
effective in the case of an employees' trust described in section 401(a)
for taxable years ending after March 15, 1956. Thus, if during a taxable
year ending before March 16, 1956, an employees' trust made a loan which
meets the requirements of section 503(e), such loan will not be treated
as made without the receipt of adequate security and will not cause the
loss of exemption for taxable years ending after March 15, 1956,
although such loan was not considered adequately secured when made.
(However, section 503 does not apply to organizations described in
section 401(a) not referred to in section 4975(g) (2) or (3) for
transactions occurring after December 31, 1974.)
(b)(1) In the case of obligations acquired by an employees' trust
described in section 401(a) before September 2, 1958, which were held on
that date, the requirements described in paragraphs (c) and (d) of Sec.
1.503(e)-2 which were not satisfied immediately following the
acquisition shall be treated as satisfied at that time if those
requirements would have been satisfied had the obligations been acquired
on September 2, 1958. For example, on January 3, 1955, an employees'
trust described in section 401(a) purchased through the New York Stock
Exchange unsecured debentures issued by the employer corporation. Under
section 503(e) the acquisition of such debentures by the trust will not
be treated for taxable years ending after March 15, 1956, as a loan made
without the receipt of adequate security if the debentures were held by
the employees' trust on September 2, 1958, and if the requirements of
paragraphs (c) and (d) of Sec. 1.503(e)-2 which were not met on January
3, 1955, were met on September 2, 1958, as if that date were the date of
acquisition.
(2) In the case of obligations acquired before September 2, 1958,
which were not held by the employees' trust described in section 401(a)
on that date, only the requirements described in paragraph (b) of Sec.
1.503(e)-2 must be satisfied for section 503(e) to be applicable to such
acquisition. For example, if on December 5, 1956, an employees' trust
lent money to the employer corporation by purchasing a debenture issued
[[Page 66]]
by the employer and if the trust sold the debenture on August 1, 1958,
such loan would not be treated as made without the receipt of adequate
security if the requirement described in paragraph (b) of Sec.
1.503(e)-2 was met on December 5, 1956.
(c) Section 503(e) and Sec. Sec. 1.503(e)-1 and 1.503(e)-2 are
effective in the case of trusts described in section 501(c)(17) with
respect to loans made, renewed, or, in the case of demand loans,
continued after December 31, 1959, and in the case of trusts described
in section 501(c)(18) with respect to loans made, renewed or, in the
case of demand loans, continued after December 31, 1969.
(d) See paragraph (b)(2) of Sec. 1.503(b)-1 for the effective dates
for the application of the definition of adequate security.
[T.D. 7428, 41 FR 34626, Aug. 16, 1976]
Sec. 1.503(e)-4 Disallowance of charitable deductions for certain
gifts made before January 1, 1970.
Paragraphs (a), (b), and (c) of this section shall apply only to
gifts or contributions made before January 1, 1970, to an organization
described in section 501(c)(3). For rules relating to the denial of
deductions with respect to gifts or contributions made after December
31, 1969, see Sec. 1.503(c)-1(d).
(a) No gift or contribution which would otherwise be allowable as a
charitable or other deductions under section 170, 642(c), or 545(b)(2)
shall be allowed as a deduction if made to an organization described in
section 501(c)(3) which at the time the gift or contribution is made is
not exempt under section 501(a) by reason of the provisions of section
503.
(b) If an organization which is described in section 501(c)(3) is
not exempt because it engaged in a prohibited transaction involving a
substantial part of its income of corpus with the purpose of diverting
its income or corpus from its exempt purposes, and if the organization
receives a gift or contribution during, or prior to, its taxable year in
which such prohibited transaction occurred, then a deduction by the
donor with respect to the gift or contribution shall not be disallowed
under section 503(b) unless the donor (or any member of his family if
the donor is an individual) is a party to such prohibited transaction.
For the purpose of the preceding sentence family is defined in section
267(c)(4) and includes brothers and sisters, whether by whole or half
blood, spouse, ancestors, and lineal descendants. See the regulations
under section 267(c).
(c) The application of Sec. 1.503(e)-4 may be illustrated by the
following example:
Example. In 1954, Corporation M, which files its income tax returns
on the calendar year basis, creates a foundation purportedly for
charitable purposes and deducts from its gross income for that year the
amount of the gift to the foundation. Corporation M makes additional
gifts to this foundation in 1955, 1956, and 1957, and takes charitable
deductions for such years. B, an individual, also contributes to the
foundation in 1955, 1956, and 1957, and takes charitable deductions for
such years. In 1955, the foundation commences purposely to divert its
corpus to the benefit of Corporation M, and a substantial amount of such
corpus is so diverted by the close of the taxable year 1956. For 1955
and subsequent taxable years, the exemption allowed the foundation as an
organization described in section 501(c)(3) is denied by reason of the
provisions of section 503(a). Both Corporation M and individual B would
be disallowed any deduction for the contributions made during 1957 to
the foundation. Moreover, the charitable deductions taken by Corporation
M for contributions to the foundation in the years 1955 and 1956 would
also be disallowed since Corporation M was a party to the prohibited
transactions. If the facts and surrounding cuircumstances indicate that
the contribution in 1954 by Corporation M was for the purpose of the
prohibited transaction, then the charitable deduction for the year 1954
shall also be disallowed with respect to Corporation M, since the
prohibited transaction would then have commenced with the making of such
contribution and the exemption allowed the foundation would then be
denied for 1954 by reason of the provisions of Sec. 1.503(e)-4. B's
deductions for his contributions for the years 1955 and 1956 will not be
disallowed since he was not a party to the prohibited transaction.
[T.D. 7428, 41 FR 34626, Aug. 16, 1976]
Sec. 1.503(f)-1 Loans by employers who are prohibited from pledging
assets.
(a) In general. (1) Section 503(f) provides that section 503(b)(1)
shall not apply to a loan made to the employer by an employees' trust
described in
[[Page 67]]
section 401(a) if the loan bears a reasonable rate of interest and
certain conditions are met. Section 503(f) also applies to the renewal
of loans to the employer and, in the case of demand loans, to the
continuation of such loans.
(2) The provisions of section 503(f) do not limit the effect of
section 401(a) and Sec. 1.401-2, relating to use or diversion of corpus
or income of an employees' trust, or the effect of any of the provisions
of section 503 other than section 503(b)(1). Consequently, although a
loan made by an employees' trust described in section 503(a)(1)(B) meets
all the requirements of section 503(f) and therefore is not treated as a
loan made without the receipt of adequate security, an employees' trust
making such a loan will lose its exempt status if the loan is not
considered as made for the exclusive benefit of the employees or their
beneficiaries. Similarly, a loan which meets the requirements of section
503(f) will constitute a prohibited transaction within the meaning of
section 503(b)(6) if it results in a substantial diversion of the
trust's income or corpus to a person described in section 503(b).
(b) Conditions. (1) Section 503(f) applies to a loan only if, with
respect to the making or renewal of the loan, the conditions described
in paragraphs (b) (2), (3), and (4) of this section are met. For purpose
of this paragraph, the mere continuance of a demand loan is not
considered as the making or renewal of such a loan.
(2) The employer must be prohibited (at the time of the making or
renewal of the loan) by any law of the United States or regulations
thereunder from directly or indirectly pledging, as security for such a
loan, a particular class or classes of his assets the value of which (at
such time) represents more than one-half of the value of all his assets.
If a loan is made or renewed when the employer is prohibited by a law of
the United States (or the regulations thereunder) from pledging a class
of his assets, the qualification of such a loan under section 503(f)
will not be affected by a subsequent change in such law or regulations
permitting the employer to pledge such assets, unless such loan is
renewed after such change. See section 8(a) of the Securities Exchange
Act of 1934, as amended (15 U.S.C. 78h(a)), which prohibits certain
persons from pledging a class of assets as security for loans, and 12
CFR 220.5(a) (credit by brokers, dealers, and members of national
securities exchanges).
(3) The making or renewal, as the case may be, must be approved in
writing as an investment which is consistent with the exempt purposes of
the trust by a trustee who is independent of the employer, and such
written approval must not have been previously refused by any other such
trustee. A trustee is independent of the employer, for purposes of this
subparagraph, if he is entirely free of influence or controlled by the
employer. For example, if the employer is a partnership, then a partner
in such partnership, or a member of a partner's family would not be
considered independent of the employer. Similarly, an employee of the
employer would not be considered independent of the employer. For
purposes of this subparagraph, the term trustee means, with respect to
any trust for which there are two trustees who are independent of the
employer, both of such trustees and, with respect to any trust for which
there are more than two such independent trustees, a majority of the
trustees independent of the employer.
(4)(i) Immediately following the making or renewal, as the case may
be, the aggregate amount lent by the trust to the employer, without the
receipt of adequate security must not exceed 25 percent of the value of
all the assets of the trust.
(ii) For purposes of paragraph (b)(4)(i) of this section, the
determination as to whether any amount lent by the trust to the employer
is a loan made without the receipt of adequate security shall be made
without regard to section 503(e). Thus, if an employees' trust makes a
loan on January 2, 1959, to the employer without adequate security (but
which loan is not considered as made without adquate security under
section 503(e)), and if immediately after making such loan 10 percent of
the value of all its assets is invested in such loan, then the trust may
on that day invest not more than an additional 15 percent of its assets
in a loan which
[[Page 68]]
would be considered made without adequate security if it were not for
the provisions of section 503(f).
(iii) For purposes of paragraph (b)(4)(i) of this section, in
determining the value of all the assets of the trust, there shall be
used the fair market value of those assets on the day of the making or
renewal.
(c) Reasonable rate of interest. Section 503(f) only applies if, in
addition to meeting the conditions described in paragraph (b) of this
section, the loan bears a reasonable rate of interest when it is made,
renewed, or, in the case of demand loans, during the period of its
existence.
(d) Change of terms of loan. A change in the terms of a loan
(including a reduction in the security for a loan) is considered as the
making of a new loan. If such a new loan is not adequately secured, the
requirements of section 503(f) must be met at the time the terms of the
loan are changed for such section to be applicable to such new loan.
(e) Effective date. (1) This section and section 503(f) are
effective for taxable years ending after September 2, 1958, but only
with respect to periods after such date. Thus, if a loan was made on or
before September 2, 1958, without the receipt of adequate security and
if, when such loan was made, it met all of the requirements of section
503(f) and this section, then the loan is not subject to section
503(b)(1) after September 2, 1958, and would not consitite a prohibited
transaction after that date because of a lack of adequate security.
(2) See paragraph (b)(2) of Sec. 1.503(b)-1 for the effective dates
for application of the definition of adequate security.
[T.D. 7428, 41 FR 34626, Aug. 16, 1976]
Sec. 1.504-1 Attempts to influence legislation; certain organizations
formerly described in section 501(c)(3) denied exemption.
Section 504(a) and this section apply to an organization that is
exempt from taxation at any time after October 4, 1976, as an
organization described in section 501(c)(3), and that ceases to be
described in that section because it--
(a) Is an action organization within the meaning of Sec.
1.501(c)(3)-1(c)(3)(ii) or (iv), on account of activities occurring
after October 4, 1976, or
(b) Is denied exemption under the provisions of section 501(h) (see
Sec. 1.501(h)-3 or Sec. 56.4911-9).
This section does not apply, however, to an organization that was
described in section 501(h)(5) and Sec. 1.501(h)-2(b)(3) (relating
generally to churches) for its taxable year immediately preceding the
first taxable year for which it is no longer an organization described
in section 501(c)(3). An organization to which section 504(a) and this
section apply shall not be treated as described in section 501(c)(4) at
any time after the organization ceases to be described in section
501(c)(3). Further, an organization denied treatment as an organization
described in section 501(c)(4) under this section may not be treated as
an organization described in section 501(c) other than as an
organization described in section 501(c)(3). For rules relating to
recognition of exemption after exemption is denied under section 501(h),
Sec. 1.501(h)-3(d).
[T.D. 8308, 55 FR 35592, Aug. 31, 1990]
Sec. 1.504-2 Certain transfers made to avoid section 504(a).
(a) Scope. Under section 504(b), a transfer described in paragraph
(b) or (c) of this section to an organization exempt from tax under
section 501(a) may result in loss of exemption by the transferee unless
the Commissioner determines, under paragraph (e) of this section, that
the original transfer did not effect an avoidance of section 504(a). For
purposes of this section, the term transfer includes any use by, or for
the benefit of, the recipient of the transfer, but does not include any
transfer made for adequate and full consideration.
(b) Transferor and transferee commonly controlled--(1) Loss of
exemption. A transfer is described in this paragraph (b) if it is
described in paragraphs (b)(2) through (b)(6). The transferee of a
transfer described in this paragraph will cease to be exempt from tax
under section 501(a), unless the provisions of paragraph (e) of this
section apply.
(2) Transferor organization. A transfer is described in this
paragraph (b)(2) only if it is from an organization that--
[[Page 69]]
(i) Is or was described in section 501(c)(3), but not in section
501(h)(5), and
(ii) Is determined to be an ``action'' organization (as defined in
Sec. 1.501(c)(3)-1(c)(3)(ii) or (iv)), or is denied exemption from tax
by reason of section 501(h) and either Sec. 1.501(h)-3 or Sec.
56.4911-9.
(3) Transferor and transferee commonly controlled. A transfer is
described in this paragraph (b)(3) only if, at the time of the transfer
or at any time during the transferee's ten taxable years following the
year in which the transfer was made, the transferee is controlled
(directly or indirectly), as defined in paragraph (f) of this section,
by the same person or persons who control the transferor.
(4) Time of transfer. A transfer is described in this paragraph
(b)(4) only if the transfer is made--
(i) After the date that is 24 months before the earliest of the
effective date of the determination under section 501(h) that the
transferor is not exempt, the effective date of the Commissioner's
determination that the transferor is an ``action'' organization (as
defined in Sec. 1.501(c)(3)(ii) or (iv)), or the date on which the
Commissioner proposes to treat it as no longer described in section
501(c)(3), and
(ii) Before the transferor again is recognized as an organization
described in section 501(c)(3).
(5) Transferee. A transfer is described in this paragraph (b)(5)
only if the transferee is exempt from tax under section 501(a) but the
transferee is neither--
(i) An organization described in section 501(c)(3), nor
(ii) An organization described in section 401(a) to which the
transferor contributes as an employer.
(6) Amount of transfer. A transfer is described in this paragraph
(b)(6) only if the amount of the transfer exceeds the lesser of 30
percent of the net fair market value of the transferor's assets or 50
percent of the net fair market value of the transferee's assets,
computed immediately before the transfer. For purposes of this paragraph
(b)(6)--
(i) The amount of a transfer by a transferor is the sum of the
amounts transferred to any number of transferees in any number of
transfers, all of which are described in paragraphs (b)(2) through
(b)(5) of this section, and the time of the transfer is the time of the
first transfer so taken into account; and
(ii) The amount of a transfer to a transferee is the sum of the
amounts transferred by a transferor to the transferee in any number of
transfers, all of which are described in paragraphs (b)(2) through
(b)(5) of this section, and the time of the transfer is the time of the
first transfer so taken into account.
(c) Other transfers--(1) Transfers included. A transfer is described
in this paragraph (c) if it would be described in paragraph (b) of this
section except that either--
(i) The amount of the transfer is less than the amount determined in
paragraph (b)(6) of this section, or
(ii) The transferor and transferee are not commonly controlled as
described in paragraph (b)(3) of this section, or
(iii) The transferee is an organization described in sections
501(c)(3) and 501(h)(4).
(2) Loss of exemption. The transferee of a transfer described in
this paragraph (c) will cease to be exempt under section 501(a) if the
Commissioner determines on all the facts and circumstances that the
transfer effected an avoidance of section 504(a). In determining whether
a transfer effected an avoidance of section 504(a), the Commissioner may
consider whether the transferee engages, or has engaged, in attempts to
influence legislation and may also consider any factors enumerated in
paragraph (e) of this section.
(d) Date of loss of exempt status. A transferee of a transfer
described in paragraph (b), (c)(1)(ii), or (c)(1)(iii) of this section
will cease to be exempt from tax under section 501(a) on the date that
all requirements of paragraph (b), (c)(1)(ii), or (c)(1)(iii) (other
than the determination by the Commissioner) are satisfied. A transferee
of a transfer described in paragraph (c)(1)(i) of this section will
cease to be exempt from tax under section 501(a) on the date of the last
transfer preceding notification of the transferee that the Commissioner
proposes to
[[Page 70]]
treat the transferee as other than an exempt organization.
(e) Transfers not in avoidance of section 504(a). Notwithstanding
paragraph (b) of this section, if, based on all the facts and
circumstances, the Commissioner determines that a transfer described in
paragraph (b) did not effect an avoidance of section 504(a), the
transferee will not be denied exemption from tax by reason of section
504(b) and this section. In making the determination called for in the
preceding sentence, the Commissioner may consider all relevant factors
including:
(1) Whether enforceable and effective conditions on the transfer
preclude use of any of the transferred assets for any purpose that, if
it were a substantial part of an organization's activities, would be
inconsistent with exemption as an organization described in section
501(c)(3);
(2) In the absence of conditions described in paragraph (e)(1) of
this section, whether the transferred assets are used exclusively for
purposes that are consistent with the transferor's exemption as an
organization described in section 501(c)(3);
(3) Whether the assets transferred would be describe in Sec.
53.4942(a)(-2(c)(3) before, as well as after, the transfer if both the
transferor and transferee were private foundations;
(4) Whether and to what extent the transfer would satisfy the
provisions of Sec. 1.507-2(a) (7) and (8) if the transferor were a
private foundation;
(5) Whether all of the transferred assets have been expended during
a period when the transferee was not controlled (directly or indirectly)
by the same person or persons who controlled the transferor; and
(6) Whether the entire amount of the transferred assets were in turn
transferred, before the close of the transferee's taxable year following
the taxable year in which the transferred assets were received, to one
or more organizations described in section 507(b)(1)(A) none of which
are controlled (directly or indirectly) by the same persons who control
either the original transferor or transferee.
(f) Control. For purposes of section 504 and the regulations
thereunder--
(1) The transferor will be presumed to control any organization with
which it is affiliated within the meaning of Sec. 56.4911-7(a), or
would be if both organizations were described in section 501(c)(3), and
(2) The transferee will be treated as controlled (directly of
indirectly) by the same person or persons who control the transferor if
the transferee would be treated as controlled under Sec. 53.4942(a)-
3(a)(3), for which purpose the transferor shall be treated as a private
foundation.
[T.D. 8308, 55 FR 35592, Aug. 31, 1990]
Sec. 1.505(c)-1T Questions and answers relating to the notification
requirement for recognition of exemption under paragraphs (9), (17) and
(20) of Section 501(c) (temporary).
Q-1: What does section 505(c) of the Internal Revenue Code provide?
A-1: Section 505(c) provides that an organization will not be
recognized as exempt under section 501(c)(9) as a voluntary employees'
beneficiary association, under section 501(c)(17) as a trust forming
part of a plan providing for the payment of supplemental unemployment
compensation benefits, or under section 501(c)(20) as a trust forming
part of a qualified group legal services plan unless notification is
given to the Internal Revenue Service. The notification required of a
trust created pursuant to section 501(c)(20) and forming part of a
qualified group legal services plan is set forth in Q&A-2. The
notification required of an organization organized after July 18, 1984,
and applying for exempt status as an organization described in section
501(c) (9) or (17) is set forth in Q&A-3 through Q&A-8. The notification
required of an organization organized on or before July 18, 1984, and
claiming exemption as an organization described in section 501(c) (9) or
(17) is set forth in Q&A-9 through Q&A-11. However, an organization that
has previously notified the Internal Revenue Service of its claim to
exemption under section 501(c) (9), (17), or (20) or its claim to
exemption under those sections pursuant to another provision of the
Code, is not required, under section 505(c), to submit a renotification
(See Q&A-2 and Q&A-12).
Section 501(c)(20) Trusts
Q-2: What is the notice required of a trust created pursuant to
section 501(c)(20) and forming part of a qualified group legal services
plan under section 120?
A-2: (a) A trust claiming exemption as an organization described in
section 501(c)(20) will be recognized as exempt if the exclusive
[[Page 71]]
function of the trust is to form part of a qualified group legal
services plan or plans. Exemption of the trust under section 501(c)(20)
will generally be dependent upon and coextensive with recognition of the
plan as a qualified group legal services plan. Therefore, a trust
organized pursuant to section 501(c)(20) after July 18, 1984, need not
file a separate notice with the Internal Revenue Service of its claim to
exemption because the notice required by section 120(c)(4) will suffice
for purposes of section 505(c), provided a copy of the trust instrument
is filed with the Form 1024 submitted by the group legal services plan.
If the trust instrument has not been filed with the Form 1024 submitted
by the group legal services plan, the trust must comply with (and
exemption will be dependent upon) the filing applicable to a trust
organized on or before July 18, 1984. For the notice required and
effective dates of exemption of a qualified group legal services plan
under section 120, see Sec. 1.120-3.
(b) A trust organized on or before July 18, 1984, that claims exempt
status as a trust described in section 501(c)(20) and that forms part of
a qualified group legal services plan which has been recognized as
exempt under section 120, must file a copy of its trust instrument with
the Internal Revenue Service before February 4, 1987. If a copy of the
trust instrument is filed within the time provided, the trust's
exemption will be recognized retroactively to the date the qualified
group legal services plan was recognized as exempt under section 120.
However, if a copy of the trust instrument is filed after the time
provided, exemption will be recognized only for the period after the
copy of the trust instrument is filed with the Internal Revenue Service.
See Q&A-7 for a further discussion of date of filing. A trust that has
previously filed a copy of its trust instrument with the Service need
not refile that document.
Section 501(c)(9) and (17) Organizations Organized After July 18, 1984
Q-3: What is the notice required of an organization or trust,
organized after July 18, 1984, that is applying for recognition of tax
exempt status under section 501(c) (9) or (17)?
A-3: An organization or trust that is organized after July 18, 1984,
will not be treated as described in paragraphs (9) or (17) of section
501(c), unless the organization notifies the Internal Revenue Service
that it is applying for recognition of exemption. In addition, unless
the required notice is given in the manner and within the time
prescribed by these regulations, an organization will not be treated as
exempt for any period before the giving of the required notice. The
notice is filed by submitting a properly completed and executed Form
1024, ``Application for Recognition of Exemption Under Section 501(a) or
for Determination Under Section 120'' together with the additional
information required under Q&A-4 and Q&A-5. The notice is filed with the
district director for the key district in which the organization's
principal place of business or principal office is located.
The notice may be filed by either the plan administrator (as defined
in section 414(g)) or the trustee. The Internal Revenue Service will not
accept a Form 1024 for any organization or trust before such entity has
been organized.
Q-4: What information, in addition to the information required by
Form 1024, must be submitted by an organization or trust seeking
recognition of exemption under section 501(c) (9) or (17)?
A-4: A notice will not be considered complete unless, in addition to
a properly completed and executed Form 1024, the organization or trust
submits a full description of the benefits available to participants
under section 501(c) (9) or (17). Moreover, both the terms and
conditions of eligibility for membership and the terms and conditions of
eligibility for benefits must be set forth. This information may be
contained in a separate document, such as a plan document, or it may be
contained in the creating document of the entity (e.g., the articles of
incorporation or association, or a trust indenture). For benefits
provided through a policy or policies of insurance, all such policies
must be included with the notice. Where individual policies of insurance
are provided to the participants, single exemplar copies, typical of
policies generally issued to participants, are acceptable, provided they
adequately describe all forms of insurance available to participants. In
providing a full description of the benefits available, the benefits
provided must be sufficiently described so that each benefit is
definitely determinable. A benefit is definitely determinable if the
amount of the benefit, its duration, and the persons eligible to receive
it are ascertainable from the plan document or other instrument. Thus, a
benefit is not definitely determinable if the rules governing either its
amount, its duration, or its recipients are not ascertainable from the
plan document or other instrument but are instead subject to the
discretion of a person or committee. Likewise, a benefit is not
definitely determinable if the amount for any individual is based upon a
percentage share of any item that is within the discretion of the
employer. However, a disability benefit will not fail to be considered
definitely determinable merely because the determination of whether an
individual is disabled is made under established guidelines by an
authorized person or committee.
Q-5: What is the notice required of collectively bargained plans?
A-5: If an organization or trust claiming exemption under section
501(c) (9) or (17) is
[[Page 72]]
organized and maintained pursuant to a collective bargaining agreement
between employee representatives and one or more employer, only one Form
1024 is required to be filed for the organization or trust, regardless
of the number of employers originally participating in the agreement.
Moreover, once a Form 1024 is filed pursuant to a collective bargaining
areement, an additional Form 1024 is not required to be filed by an
employer who thereafter participates in that agreement. When benefits
are provided pursuant to a collective bargaining agreement, the notice
will not be considered complete unless, in addition to a properly
completed and executed Form 1024, a copy of the collective bargaining
agreement is also submitted together with the additional information
delineated in Q&A-4.
Q-6: When must the required notice be filed by an organization or
trust, organized after July 18, 1984, that seeks recognition of
exemption under section 501(c) (9) or (17)?
A-6: An organization or trust applying for exemption must file the
required notice by the later of February 4, 1987 or 15 months from the
end of the month in which the organization or trust was organized. An
extension of time for filing the required notice may be granted by the
district director if the request is submitted before the end of the
applicable period and it is demonstrated that additional time is needed.
Q-7: What is the effective date of exemption for a new organization
or trust, organized after July 18, 1984, that has submitted the required
notice?
A-7: If the required notice is filed within the time provided by
these regulations, the organization's exemption will be recognized
retroactively to the date the organization was organized, provided its
purpose, organization and operation (including compliance with the
applicable nondiscrimination requirements) during the period prior to
the date of the determination letter are in accordance with the
applicable law. However, if the required notice is filed after the time
provided by these regulations, exemption will be recognized only for the
period after the application is filed with the Internal Revenue Service.
The date of filing is the date of the United States postmark on the
cover in which an exemption application is mailed or, if no postmark
appears on the cover, the date the application is stamped as received by
the Service. If an extension for filing the required notice has been
granted to the organization, a notice filed on or before the last day
specified in the extension will be considered timely and not the
otherwise applicable date under Q&A-6.
Q-8: What is the effect on exemption of the filing of an incomplete
notice?
A-8: Although a properly completed and executed Form 1024 together
with the required additional information (See Q&A-4 and Q&A-5) must be
submitted to satisfy the notice required by section 505(c), the failure
to file, within the time specified, all of the information necessary to
complete such notice will not alone be sufficient to deny recognition of
exemption from the date of organization to the date the completed
information is submitted to the Service. If the notice which is filed
with the Service within the required time is substantially complete, and
the organization supplies the necessary additional information requested
by the Service within the additional time allowed, the original notice
will be considered timely. However, if the notice is not substantially
complete or the additional information is not provided within the
additional time allowed, exemption will be recognized only from the date
of filing of the additional information.
Section 501(c)(9) and (17) Organizations Organized on or Before July 18,
1984
Q-9: What is the notice required of an organization or trust
organized on or before July 18, 1984, that claims exempt status as an
organization described in section 501(c) (9) or (17)?
A-9: Section 505(c) provides a special rule for existing
organizations and trusts organized on or before July 18, 1984. Such an
organization or trust will not be treated as described in paragraphs (9)
or (17) of section 501(c) unless the organization or trust notifies the
Internal Revenue Service in the manner and within the time prescribed in
these regulations that it is claiming exemption under the particular
section. The type of notice, the manner for filing that notice, and the
additional information required is the same as that set forth in Q&A-3
through Q&A-5 for new organizations.
Q-10: When must the required notice be filed by an organization or
trust organized on or before July 18, 1984?
A-10: An organization or trust organized on or before July 18, 1984,
that claims exempt status as an organization described in section 501(c)
(9) or (17), must file the required notice before February 4, 1987. An
extension of time for filing the required notice may be granted by the
district director if the request is submitted before the due date of the
notice and it is demonstrated that additional time is needed.
Q-11: What is the effective date of exemption for an organization or
trust organized on or before July 18, 1984, that has submitted the
required notice?
A-11: If the required notice is filed within the time provided by
these regulations, the organization's exemption will be recognized
retroactively to the date the organization was organized, provided its
purpose, organization and operation (including compliance with the
applicable nondiscrimination requirements) during the period prior to
the
[[Page 73]]
date of the determination letter are in accordance with the applicable
law. If, on the other hand, the required notice is filed after the time
provided by these regulations, exemption will be recognized only for the
period after the notice is received by the Internal Revenue Service. See
Q&A-7 for a further discussion of date of filing. See also Q&A-8 for the
effect on exemption of a notice that has been timely filed but is
incomplete.
Exceptions to Notice Requirement
Q-12: Are any organizations or trusts claiming recognition of
exemption as an organization described in section 501(c) (9) or (17)
excepted from the notice requirement of section 505(c)?
A-12: An organization or trust that has previously notified the
Internal Revenue Service of its claim to exemption by filing Form 1024
is not required, under section 505(c), to renotify the Service. Thus, an
organization that has filed a Form 1024 that is pending with the Service
need not refile that form. Also, an organization that has received a
ruling or determination letter from the Service recognizing its
exemption from taxation need not submit the notification required by
section 505(c).
[T.D. 8073, 51 FR 4330, Feb. 4, 1986]
Private Foundations
Sec. 1.507-1 General rule.
(a) In general. Except as provided in Sec. 1.507-2, the status of
any organization as a private foundation shall be terminated only if:
(1) Such organization notifies the district director of its intent
to accomplish such termination, or
(2)(i) With respect to such organization, there have been either
willful repeated acts (or failures to act), or a willful and flagrant
act (or failure to act), giving rise to liability for tax under chapter
42, and
(ii) The Commissioner notifies such organization that, by reason of
subdivision (i) of this subparagraph, such organization is liable for
the tax imposed by section 507(c)
and either such organization pays the tax imposed by section 507(c) (or
any portion not abated under section 507(g)) or the entire amount of
such tax is abated under section 507(g).
(b) Termination under section 507(a)(1). (1) In order to terminate
its private foundation status under paragraph (a)(1) of this section, an
organization must submit a statement to the district director of its
intent to terminate its private foundation status under section
507(a)(1). Such statement must set forth in detail the computation and
amount of tax imposed under section 507(c). Unless the organization
requests abatement of such tax pursuant to section 507(g), full payment
of such tax must be made at the time the statement is filed under
section 507(a)(1). An organization may request the abatement of all of
the tax imposed under section 507(c), or may pay any part thereof and
request abatement of the unpaid portion of the amount of tax assessed.
If the organization requests abatement of the tax imposed under section
507(c) and such request is denied, the organization must pay such tax in
full upon notification by the Internal Revenue Service that such tax
will not be abated. For purposes of subtitle F of the Code, the
statement described in this subparagraph, once filed, shall be treated
as a return.
(2) Termination of private foundation status under section 507(a)(1)
does not relieve a private foundation, or any disqualified person with
respect thereto, of liability for tax under chapter 42 with respect to
acts or failures to act prior to termination or for any additional taxes
imposed for failure to correct such acts or failures to act. See
subparagraph (8) of this paragraph as to the possible imposition of
transferee liability in cases not involving termination of private
foundation status.
(3) In the case of an organization which has terminated its private
foundation status under section 507(a) and continues in operation
thereafter, if such organization wishes to be treated as described in
section 501(c)(3), then pursuant to section 509(c) and Sec. 1.509(c)-1
such organization must apply for recognition of exemption as an
organization described in section 501(c)(3) in accordance with the
provisions of section 508(a).
(4) See Sec. 53.4947-1(c)(7) of this chapter as to the application
of section 507(a) to certain split-interest trusts.
(5) For purposes of section 508(d)(1), the Internal Revenue Service
shall make notice to the public (such as by publication in the Internal
Revenue Bulletin) of any notice received from a private foundation
pursuant to section
[[Page 74]]
507(a)(1) or of any notice given to a private foundation pursuant to
section 507(a)(2).
(6) If a private foundation transfers all or part of its assets to
one or more other private foundations (or one or more private
foundations and one or more section 509(a) (1), (2), (3), or (4)
organizations) pursuant to a transfer described in section 507(b)(2) and
Sec. 1.507-3(c), such transferor foundation will not have terminated
its private foundation status under section 507(a)(1). See Sec. 1.507-
3, however, for the special rules applicable to private foundations
participating in section 507(b)(2) transfers.
(7) Neither a transfer of all of the assets of a private foundation
nor a significant disposition of assets (as defined in Sec. 1.507-
3(c)(2)) by a private foundation (whether or not any portion of such
significant disposition of assets is made to another private foundation)
shall be deemed to result in a termination of the transferor private
foundation under section 507(a) unless the transferor private foundation
elects to terminate pursuant to section 507(a)(1) or section 507(a)(2)
is applicable. Thus, if a private foundation transfers all of its assets
to one or more persons, but less than all of its net assets to one or
more organizations described in section 509(a)(1) which have been in
existence and so described for a continuous period of 60 calendar
months, for purposes of this paragraph such transferor foundation will
not be deemed by reason of such transfer to have terminated its private
foundation status under section 507 (a) or (b) unless section 507(a)(2)
is applicable. Such foundation will continue to be treated as a private
foundation for all purposes. For example, if a private foundation
transfers all of its net assets to a section 509(a)(2) organization in
1971 and receives a bequest in 1973, the bequest will be regarded as
having been made to a private foundation and the foundation will be
subject to the provisions of chapter 42 with respect to such funds. If a
private foundation makes a transfer of all of its net assets to a
section 509(a) (2) or (3) organization, for example, it must retain
sufficient income or assets to pay the tax imposed under section 4940
for that portion of its taxable year prior to such transfer. For
additional rules applicable to a transfer by a private foundation of all
of its net assets to a section 509(a)(1) organization which has not been
in existence and so described for a continuous period of 60 calendar
months, see Sec. 1.507-3(e).
(8) If a private foundation makes a transfer described in
subparagraph (7) of this paragraph and prior to, or in connection with,
such transfer, liability for any tax under chapter 42 is incurred by the
transferor foundation, transferee liability may be applied against the
transferee organization for payment of such taxes. For purposes of this
subparagraph, liability for any tax imposed under chapter 42 for failure
to correct any act or failure to act shall be deemed incurred on the
date on which the act or failure to act giving rise to the initial tax
liability occurred.
(9) A private foundation which transfers all of its net assets is
required to file the annual information return required by section 6033,
and the foundation managers are required to file the annual report of a
private foundation required by section 6056, for the taxable year in
which such transfer occurs. However, neither such foundation nor its
foundation managers will be required to file such returns for any
taxable year following the taxable year in which the last of any such
transfers occurred, if at no time during the subsequent taxable years in
question the foundation has either legal or equitable title to any
assets or engages in any activity.
(c) Involuntary termination under section 507(a)(2). (1) For
purposes of section 507(a)(2)(A), the term willful repeated acts (or
failures to act) means at least two acts or failures to act both of
which are voluntary, conscious, and intentional.
(2) For purposes of section 507(a)(2)(A), a willful and flagrant act
(or failure to act) is one which is voluntarily, consciously, and
knowingly committed in violation of any provision of chapter 42 (other
than section 4940 or 4948(a)) and which appears to a reasonable man to
be a gross violation of any such provision.
(3) An act (or failure to act) may be treated as an act (or failure
to act) by
[[Page 75]]
the private foundation for purposes of section 507(a)(2) even though tax
is imposed upon one or more foundation managers rather than upon the
foundation itself.
(4) For purposes of section 507(a)(2), the failure to correct the
act or acts (or failure or failures to act) which gave rise to liability
for tax under any section of chapter 42 by the close of the correction
period for such section may be a willful and flagrant act (or failure to
act).
(5) No motive to avoid the restrictions of the law or the incurrence
of any tax is necessary to make an act (or failure to act) willful.
However, a foundation's act (or failure to act) is not willful if the
foundation (or a foundation manager, if applicable) does not know that
it is an act of self-dealing, a taxable expenditure, or other act (or
failure to act) to which chapter 42 applies. Rules similar to the
regulations under chapter 42 (see, for example, Sec. 53.4945-
1(a)(2)(iii) of this chapter) shall apply in determining whether a
foundation or a foundation manager knows that an act (or failure to act)
is an act of self-dealing a taxable expenditure or other such act (or
failure to act).
[T.D. 7233, 37 FR 28157, Dec. 21, 1972, as amended by T.D. 7290, 38 FR
31833, Nov. 19, 1973]
Sec. 1.507-2 Special rules; transfer to, or operation as, public charity.
(a) Transfer to public charities--(1) General rule. Under section
507(b)(1)(A) a private foundation, with respect to which there have not
been either willful repeated acts (or failures to act) or a willful and
flagrant act (or failure to act) giving rise to liability for tax under
Chapter 42, may terminate its private foundation status by distributing
all of its net assets to one or more organizations described in section
170(b)(1)(A) (other than in clauses (vii) and (viii)) each of which has
been in existence and so described for a continuous period of at least
60 calendar months immediately preceding such distribution. Because
section 507(a) does not apply to such a termination, a private
foundation which makes such a termination is not required to give the
notification described in section 507(a)(1). A private foundation that
terminates its private foundation status under section 507(b)(1)(A) does
not incur tax under section 507(c) and, therefore, no abatement of such
tax under section 507(g) is required.
(2) Effect of current ruling. A private foundation seeking to
terminate its private foundation status pursuant to section 507(b)(1)(A)
may rely on a ruling or determination letter issued to a potential
distributee organization that such distributee organization is an
organization described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(i), 170(b)(1)(A)(ii),
170(b)(1)(A)(iii), 170(b)(1)(A)(iv), 170(b)(1)(A)(v), or
170(b)(1)(A)(vi) in accordance with the provisions of Sec. 1.509(a)-7.
(3) Organizations described in more than one clause of section
170(b)(1)(A). For purposes of this paragraph and section 507(b)(1)(A),
the parenthetical term ``other than in clauses (vii) and (viii)'' shall
refer only to an organization that is described only in section
170(b)(1)(A)(vii) or section 170(b)(1)(A) (viii). Thus, an organization
described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(i), 170(b)(1)(A)(ii),
170(b)(1)(A)(iii), 170(b)(1)(A)(iv), 170(b)(1)(A)(v), or
170(b)(1)(A)(vi) will not be precluded from being a distributee
described in section 507(b)(1)(A) merely because it also appears to meet
the description of an organization described in section
170(b)(1)(A)(vii) or section 170(b)(1)(A)(viii).
(4) Applicability of Chapter 42 to foundations terminating under
section 507(b)(1)(A). An organization that terminates its private
foundation status pursuant to section 507(b)(1)(A) will remain subject
to the provisions of Chapter 42 until the distribution of all of its net
assets to distributee organizations described in section 507(b)(1)(A)
has been completed.
(5) Return required from organizations terminating private
foundation status under section 507(b)(1)(A)--(i) An organization that
terminates its private foundation status under section 507(b)(1)(A) is
required to file a return under the provisions of section 6043(b).
[[Page 76]]
(ii) An organization that terminates its private foundation status
under section 507(b)(1)(A) is not required to comply with section
6104(d) for the taxable year in which such termination occurs.
(6) Distribution of net assets. A private foundation will meet the
requirement to ``distribute all of its net assets'' within the meaning
of section 507(b)(1)(A) only if it transfers all of its right, title,
and interest in and to all of its net assets to one or more
organizations referred to in section 507(b)(1)(A).
(7) Effect of restrictions and conditions upon distributions of net
assets--(i) In general. In order to effectuate a transfer of ``all of
its right, title, and interest in and to all of its net assets'' within
the meaning of paragraph (a)(6) of this section, a transferor private
foundation may not impose any material restriction or condition that
prevents the transferee organization referred to in section 507(b)(1)(A)
(herein sometimes referred to as the ``public charity'') from freely and
effectively employing the transferred assets, or the income derived
therefrom, in furtherance of its exempt purposes. Whether or not a
particular condition or restriction imposed upon a transfer of assets is
material (within the meaning of this paragraph (a)(7)) must be
determined from all of the facts and circumstances of the transfer. Some
of the more significant facts and circumstances to be considered in
making such a determination are--
(A) Whether the public charity (including a participating trustee,
custodian, or agent in the case of a community trust) is the owner in
fee of the assets it receives from the private foundation;
(B) Whether such assets are to be held and administered by the
public charity in a manner consistent with one or more of its exempt
purposes;
(C) Whether the governing body of the public charity has the
ultimate authority and control over such assets, and the income derived
therefrom; and
(D) Whether, and to what extent, the governing body of the public
charity is organized and operated so as to be independent from the
transferor.
(ii) Independent governing body. As provided in paragraph
(a)(7)(i)(D) of this section, one of the more significant facts and
circumstances to be considered in making the determination whether a
particular condition or restriction imposed upon a transfer of assets is
material within the meaning of this paragraph (a)(7) is whether, and the
extent to which, the governing body is organized and operated so as to
be independent from the transferor. In turn, the determination as to
such factor must be determined from all of the facts and circumstances.
Some of the more significant facts and circumstances to be considered in
making such a determination are--
(A) Whether, and to what extent, members of the governing body are
comprised of persons selected by the transferor private foundation or
disqualified persons with respect thereto or are themselves such
disqualified persons;
(B) Whether, and to what extent, members of the governing body are
selected by public officials acting in their capacities as such; and
(C) How long a period of time each member of the governing body may
serve in such capacity. In the case of a transfer that is to a community
trust, the community trust shall meet this paragraph (a)(7)(ii)(C) if--
(1) Its governing body is comprised of members who may serve a
period of not more than ten consecutive years; and
(2) Upon completion of a period of service (beginning before or
after the date of transfer), no member may serve again within a period
consisting of the lesser of five years or the number of consecutive
years the member has immediately completed serving.
(iii) Factors not adversely affecting determination. The presence of
some or all of the following factors will not be considered as
preventing the transferee ``from freely and effectively employing the
transferred assets, or the income derived therefrom, in furtherance of
its exempt purposes'' (within the meaning of paragraph (a)(7)(i) of this
section):
(A) Name. The fund is given a name or other designation which is the
same as or similar to that of the transferor private foundation or
otherwise memorializes the creator of the foundation or his family.
(B) Purpose. The income and assets of the fund are to be used for a
designated
[[Page 77]]
purpose or for one or more particular section 509(a)(1), section
509(a)(2), or section 509(a)(3) organization, and such use is consistent
with the charitable, educational, or other basis for the exempt status
of the public charity under section 501(c)(3).
(C) Administration. The transferred assets are administered in an
identifiable or separate fund, some or all of the principal of which is
not to be distributed for a specified period, if the public charity
(including a participating trustee, custodian, or agent in the case of a
community trust) is the legal and equitable owner of the fund and the
governing body exercises ultimate and direct authority and control over
such fund, as, for example, a fund to endow a chair at a university or a
medical research fund at a hospital. In the case of a community trust,
the transferred assets must be administered in or as a component part of
the community trust within the meaning of Sec. 1.170A-9(f)(11).
(D) Restrictions on disposition. The transferor private foundation
transfers property the continued retention of which by the transferee is
required by the transferor if such retention is important to the
achievement of charitable or other similar purposes in the community
because of the peculiar features of such property, as, for example,
where a private foundation transfers a woodland preserve which is to be
maintained by the public charity as an arboretum for the benefit of the
community. Such a restriction does not include a restriction on the
disposition of an investment asset or the distribution of income.
(iv) Adverse factors. The presence of any of the following factors
will be considered as preventing the transferee ``from freely and
effectively employing the transferred assets, or the income derived
therefrom, in furtherance of its exempt purposes'' (within the meaning
of paragraph (a)(7)(i) of this section):
(A) Distributions. (1) With respect to distributions made after
April 19, 1977, the transferor private foundation, a disqualified person
with respect thereto, or any person or committee designated by, or
pursuant to the terms of an agreement with, such a person (hereinafter
referred to as donor), reserves the right, directly or indirectly, to
name (other than by designation in the instrument of transfer of
particular section 509(a)(1), section 509(a)(2), or section 509(a)(3)
organizations) the persons to which the transferee public charity must
distribute, or to direct the timing of such distributions (other than by
direction in the instrument of transfer that some or all of the
principal, as opposed to specific assets, not be distributed for a
specified period) as, for example, by a power of appointment. The IRS
will examine carefully whether the seeking of advice by the transferee
from, or the giving of advice by, any donor after the assets have been
transferred to the transferee constitutes an indirect reservation of a
right to direct such distributions. In any such case, the reservation of
such a right will be considered to exist where the only criterion
considered by the public charity in making a distribution of income or
principal from a donor's fund is advice offered by the donor. Whether
there is a reservation of such a right will be determined from all of
the facts and circumstances, including, but not limited to, the factors
contained in paragraphs (a)(7)(iv)(A)(2) and (a)(7)(iv)(A)(3) of this
section.
(2) The presence of some or all of the following factors will
indicate that the reservation of a right to direct distributions does
not exist:
(i) There has been an independent investigation by the staff of the
public charity evaluating whether the donor's advice is consistent with
specific charitable needs most deserving of support by the public
charity (as determined by the public charity).
(ii) The public charity has promulgated guidelines enumerating
specific charitable needs consistent with the charitable purposes of the
public charity and the donor's advice is consistent with such
guidelines.
(iii) The public charity has instituted an educational program
publicizing to donors and other persons the guidelines enumerating
specific charitable needs consistent with the charitable purposes of the
public charity.
(iv) The public charity distributes funds in excess of amounts
distributed from the donor's fund to the same or
[[Page 78]]
similar types of organizations or charitable needs as those recommended
by the donor.
(v) The public charity's solicitations (written or oral) for funds
specifically state that such public charity will not be bound by advice
offered by the donor.
(3) The presence of some or all of the following factors will
indicate the reservation of a right to direct distributions does exist:
(i) The solicitations (written or oral) of funds by the public
charity state or imply, or a pattern of conduct on the part of the
public charity creates an expectation, that the donor's advice will be
followed.
(ii) The advice of a donor (whether or not restricted to a
distribution of income or principal from the donor's trust or fund) is
limited to distributions of amounts from the donor's fund, and the
factors described in paragraph (a)(7)(iv)(A)(2)(i) or paragraph
(a)(7)(iv)(A)(2)(ii) of this section are not present.
(iii) Only the advice of the donor as to distributions of such
donor's fund is solicited by the public charity and no procedure is
provided for considering advice from persons other than the donor with
respect to such fund.
(iv) For the taxable year and all prior taxable years the public
charity follows the advice of all donors with respect to their funds
substantially all of the time.
(B) Other action or withholding of action. The terms of the transfer
agreement, or any expressed or implied understanding, required the
public charity to take or withhold action with respect to the
transferred assets which is not designed to further one or more of the
exempt purposes of the public charity, and such action or withholding of
action would, if performed by the transferor private foundation with
respect to such assets, have subjected the transferor to tax under
Chapter 42 (other than with respect to the minimum investment return
requirement of section 4942(e)).
(C) Assumption of leases, contractual obligations, or liabilities.
The public charity assumes leases, contractual obligations, or
liabilities of the transferor private foundation, or takes the assets
thereof subject to such liabilities (including obligations under
commitments or pledges to donees of the transferor private foundation),
for purposes inconsistent with the purposes or best interests of the
public charity, other than the payment of the transferor's Chapter 42
taxes incurred prior to the transfer to the public charity to the extent
of the value of the assets transferred.
(D) Retention of investment assets. The transferee public charity is
required by any restriction or agreement (other than a restriction or
agreement imposed or required by law or regulatory authority), express
or implied, to retain any securities or other investment assets
transferred to it by the private foundation. In a case where such
transferred assets consistently produce a low annual return of income,
the IRS will examine carefully whether the transferee is required by any
such restriction or agreement to retain such assets.
(E) Right of first refusal. An agreement is entered into in
connection with the transfer of securities or other property which
grants directly or indirectly to the transferor private foundation or
any disqualified person with respect thereto a right of first refusal
with respect to the transferred securities or other property when and if
disposed of by the public charity, unless such securities or other
property was acquired by the transferor private foundation subject to
such right of first refusal prior to October 9, 1969.
(F) Relationships. An agreement is entered into between the
transferor private foundation and the transferee public charity which
establishes irrevocable relationships with respect to the maintenance or
management of assets transferred to the public charity, such as
continuing relationships with banks, brokerage firms, investment
counselors, or other advisors with regard to the investments or other
property transferred to the public charity (other than a relationship
with a trustee, custodian, or agent for a community trust
[[Page 79]]
acting as such). The transfer of property to a public charity subject to
contractual obligations which were established prior to November 11,
1976, between the transferor private foundation and persons other than
disqualified persons with respect to such foundation will not be treated
as prohibited under the preceding sentence, but only if such contractual
obligations were not entered into pursuant to a plan to terminate the
private foundation status of the transferor under section 507(b)(1)(A)
and if the continuation of such contractual obligations is in the best
interests of the public charity.
(G) Other conditions. Any other condition is imposed on action by
the public charity which prevents it from exercising ultimate control
over the assets received from the transferor private foundation for
purposes consistent with its exempt purposes.
(v) Examples. The provisions of this paragraph (a)(7) may be
illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. The M Private Foundation transferred all of its net
assets to the V Cancer Institute, a public charity described in section
170(b)(1)(A)(iii). Prior to the transfer, M's activities consisted of
making grants to hospitals and universities to further research into the
causes of cancer. Under the terms of the transfer, V is required to keep
M's assets in a separate fund and use the income and principal to
further cancer research. Although the assets may be used only for a
limited purpose, this purpose is consistent with and in furtherance of
V's exempt purposes, and does not prevent the transfer from being a
distribution for purposes of section 507(b)(1)(A).
Example 2. The N Private Foundation transferred all of its net
assets to W University, a public charity described in section
170(b)(1)(A)(ii). Under the terms of the transfer, W is required to use
the income and principal to endow a chair at the university to be known
as the ``John J. Doe Memorial Professorship,'' named after N's creator.
Although the transferred assets are to be used for a specified purpose
by W, this purpose is in furtherance of W's exempt educational purposes,
and there are no conditions on investment or reinvestment of the
principal or income. The use of the name of the foundation's creator for
the chair is not a restriction which would prevent the transfer from
being a distribution for purposes of section 507(b)(1)(A).
Example 3. The O Private Foundation transferred all of its net
assets to X Bank as trustee for the Q Community Trust, a community trust
that is a public charity described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(vi). Under
the terms of the transfer, X is to hold the assets in trust for Q and is
directed to distribute the income annually to the Y Church, a public
charity described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(i). The distribution of income
to Y Church is consistent with Q's exempt purposes. If the trust created
by this transfer otherwise meets the requirements of Sec. 1.170A-
9(f)(11) as a component part of the Q Community Trust, the assets
transferred by O to X will be treated as distributed to one or more
public charities within the meaning of section 507(b)(1)(A). The
direction to distribute the income to Y Church meets the conditions of
paragraph (a)(7)(iii)(B) of this section and will therefore not
disqualify the transfer under section 507(b)(1)(A).
Example 4. (i) The P Private Foundation transferred all of its net
assets to Z Bank as trustee for the R Community Trust, a community trust
that is a public charity described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(vi). Under
the terms of the transfer, Z is to hold the assets in trust for R and
distribute the income to those public charities described in section
170(b)(1)(A)(i) through (b)(1)(A)(vi) that are designated by B, the
creator of P. R's governing body has no authority during B's lifetime to
vary B's direction. Under the terms of the transfer, it is intended that
Z retain the transferred assets in their present form for a period of 20
years, or until the date of B's death if it occurs before the expiration
of such period. Upon the death of B, R will have the power to distribute
the income to such public charities as it selects and may dispose of the
corpus as it sees fit.
(ii) Under paragraph (a)(7)(iv)(A) or paragraph (a)(7)(iv)(D) of
this section, as a result of the restrictions imposed with respect to
the transferred assets, there has been no distribution of all P's net
assets within the meaning of section 507(b)(1)(A) at the time of the
transfer. In addition, P has not transferred its net assets to a
component part of R Community Trust, but rather to a separate trust
described in Sec. 1.170A-9(f)(12).
(b) Operation as a public charity--(1) In general. Under section
507(b)(1)(B), an organization can terminate its private foundation
status if the organization--
(i) Meets the requirements of section 509(a)(1), section 509(a)(2)
or section 509(a)(3) for a continuous period of 60 calendar months
beginning with the first day of any taxable year that begins after
December 31, 1969;
(ii) In compliance with section 507(b)(1)(B)(ii) and paragraph
(b)(3) of this section, properly notifies the IRS, in such manner as may
be provided by
[[Page 80]]
published guidance, publication, form or instructions, before the
commencement of such 60-month period, that it is terminating its private
foundation status; and
(iii) Properly establishes immediately after the expiration of such
60-month period that such organization has complied with the
requirements of section 509(a)(1), section 509(a)(2) or section
509(a)(3) during the 60-month period, in the manner described in
paragraph (b)(4) of this section.
(2) Relationship of section 507(b)(1)(B) to sections 507(a), 507(c),
and 507(g). Because section 507(a) does not apply to a termination
described in section 507(b)(1)(B), a private foundation's notification
that it is commencing a termination pursuant to section 507(b)(1)(B)
will not be treated as a notification described in section 507(a) even
if the private foundation does not successfully terminate its private
foundation status pursuant to section 507(b)(1)(B). A private foundation
that terminates its private foundation status under section 507(b)(1)(B)
does not incur tax under section 507(c) and, therefore, no abatement of
such tax under section 507(g) is required.
(3) Notification of termination. In order to comply with the
requirements under section 507(b)(1)(B)(ii), an organization shall
before the commencement of the 60-month period under section
507(b)(1)(B)(i) notify the IRS, in such manner as may be provided by
published guidance, publication, form or instructions, of its intention
to terminate its private foundation status. Such notification shall
contain the following information--
(i) The name and address of the private foundation;
(ii) Its intention to terminate its private foundation status;
(iii) The Code section under which it seeks classification (section
509(a)(1), section 509(a)(2) or section 509(a)(3));
(iv) If section 509(a)(1) is applicable, the clause of section
170(b)(1)(A) involved;
(v) The date its regular taxable year begins; and
(vi) The date of commencement of the 60-month period.
(4) Establishment of termination. In order to comply with the
requirements under section 507(b)(1)(B)(iii), an organization shall
within 90 days after the expiration of the 60-month period file such
information with the IRS, in such manner as may be provided by published
guidance, publication, form or instructions, as is necessary to make a
determination as to the organization's status as an organization
described under section 509(a)(1), section 509(a)(2) or section
509(a)(3) and the related regulations. See paragraph (c) of this section
as to the information required to be submitted under this paragraph
(b)(4).
(5) Incomplete information. The failure to supply, within the
required time, all of the information required by paragraph (b)(3) or
paragraph (b)(4) of this section is not alone sufficient to constitute a
failure to satisfy the requirements of section 507(b)(1)(B). If the
information that is submitted within the required time is incomplete and
the organization supplies the necessary additional information at the
request of the Commissioner within the additional time period allowed by
him, the original submission will be considered timely.
(6) Application of special rules and filing requirements. An
organization that has terminated its private foundation status under
section 507(b)(1)(B) is not required to comply with the special rules
set forth in sections 508(a) and 508(b). Such organization is also not
required to file a return under the provisions of section 6043(b) by
reason of termination of its private foundation status under the
provisions of section 507(b)(1)(B).
(7) Extension of time to assess deficiencies. If a private
foundation files a notification (described in paragraph (b)(3) of this
section) that it intends to begin a 60-month termination pursuant to
section 507(b)(1)(B) and does not file a request for an advance ruling
pursuant to paragraph (d) of this section, such private foundation may
file with the notification described in paragraph (b)(3) of this section
a consent under section 6501(c)(4) to the effect that the period of
limitation upon assessment under section 4940 for any taxable year
within the 60-month termination period shall not expire prior to one
year after the date of expiration of the time
[[Page 81]]
prescribed by law for the assessment of a deficiency for the last
taxable year within the 60-month period. Such consents, if filed, will
ordinarily be accepted by the Commissioner. See paragraph (e)(3) of this
section for an illustration of the procedure required to obtain a refund
of the tax imposed by section 4940 in a case where such a consent is not
in effect.
(c) Sixty-month terminations--(1) Method of determining normal
sources of support. (i) In order to meet the requirements of section
507(b)(1)(B) for the 60-month termination period as a section 509(a)(1)
or section 509(a)(2) organization, an organization must meet the
requirements of section 509(a)(1) or section 509(a)(2), as the case may
be, for a continuous period of at least 60 calendar months. In
determining whether an organization seeking status under section
509(a)(1) as an organization described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(iv) or
section 170(b)(1)(A)(vi) or under section 509(a)(2) normally meets the
requirements set forth under such sections, support received in taxable
years prior to the commencement of the 60-month period shall not be
taken into consideration, except as otherwise provided in this section.
(ii) For purposes of section 507(b)(1)(B), an organization will be
considered to be a section 509(a)(1) organization described in section
170(b)(1)(A)(vi) for a continuous period of 60 calendar months only if
the organization satisfies the provisions of Sec. 1.170A-9(f), other
than Sec. 1.170A-9(f)(4)(v), based upon aggregate data for such entire
period. The calculation of public support shall be made over the period
beginning with the date of the commencement of the 60-month period, and
ending with the last day of the 60-month period.
(iii) For purposes of section 507(b)(1)(B), an organization will be
considered to be a section 509(a)(2) organization only if such
organization meets the support requirements set forth in sections
509(a)(2)(A) and 509(a)(2)(B) and the related regulations, other than
Sec. 1.509(a)-3(d), for the continuous period of 60 calendar months
prescribed under section 507(b)(1)(B). The calculation of public support
shall be made over the period beginning with the date of the
commencement of the 60-month period, and ending with the last day of the
60-month period.
(2) Organizational and operational tests. In order to meet the
requirements of section 507(b)(1)(B) for the 60-month termination period
as an organization described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(i),
170(b)(1)(A)(ii), 170(b)(1)(A)(iii), 170(b)(1)(A)(iv), or
170(b)(1)(A)(v) or section 509(a)(3), as the case may be, an
organization must meet the requirements of the applicable provisions for
a continuous period of at least 60 calendar months. For purposes of
section 507(b)(1)(B), an organization will be considered to be such an
organization only if it satisfies the requirements of the applicable
provision (including with respect to section 509(a)(3), the
organizational and operational test set forth in section 509(a)(3)(A))
at the commencement of such 60-month period and continuously thereafter
during such period.
(d) Advance rulings for 60-month terminations--(1) In general. An
organization that files the notification required by section
507(b)(1)(B)(ii) that it is commencing a 60-month termination may obtain
an advance ruling from the Commissioner that it can be expected to
satisfy the requirements of section 507(b)(1)(B)(i) during the 60-month
period. Such an advance ruling may be issued if the organization can
reasonably be expected to meet the requirements of section
507(b)(1)(B)(i) during the 60-month period. The issuance of a ruling
will be discretionary with the Commissioner.
(2) Basic consideration. In determining whether an organization can
reasonably be expected (within the meaning of paragraph (d)(1) of this
section) to meet the requirements of section 507(b)(1)(B)(i) for the 60-
month period, the basic consideration is whether its organizational
structure (taking into account any revisions made prior to the beginning
of the 60-month period), current or proposed programs or activities,
actual or intended method of operation, and current or projected sources
of support are such as to indicate that the organization is likely to
satisfy the requirements of section 509(a)(1), section 509(a)(2), or
section 509(a)(3) and paragraph (c) of this section during the
[[Page 82]]
60-month period. In making such a determination, all pertinent facts and
circumstances shall be considered.
(3) Reliance by grantors and contributors. For purposes of sections
170, 545(b)(2), 642(c), 4942, 4945, 4966, 2055, 2106(a)(2), and 2522,
grants or contributions to an organization which has obtained a ruling
referred to in this paragraph will be treated as made to an organization
described in section 509(a)(1), section 509(a)(2), or section 509(a)(3),
as the case may be, until the IRS publishes notice that such advance
ruling is being revoked (such as by publication in the Internal Revenue
Bulletin). However, a grantor or contributor may not rely on such an
advance ruling if the grantor or contributor was responsible for, or
aware of, the act or failure to act that resulted in the organization's
failure to meet the requirements of section 509(a)(1), section
509(a)(2), or section 509(a)(3), or acquired knowledge that the IRS had
given notice to such organization that its advance ruling would be
revoked. Prior to the making of any grant or contribution which
allegedly will not result in the grantee's failure to meet the
requirements of section 509(a)(1), section 509(a)(2), or section
509(a)(3), a potential grantee organization may request a ruling whether
such grant or contribution may be made without such failure. A request
for such ruling may be filed by the grantee organization with the IRS.
The issuance of such ruling will be at the sole discretion of the
Commissioner. The organization must submit all information necessary to
make a determination on the factors referred to in paragraph (d)(2) of
this section. If a favorable ruling is issued, such ruling may be relied
upon by the grantor or contributor of the particular contribution in
question for purposes of sections 170, 507, 545(b)(2), 642(c), 4942,
4945, 4966, 2055, 2106(a)(2), and 2522.
(4) Reliance by organization. An organization obtaining an advance
ruling pursuant to this paragraph cannot rely on such a ruling.
Consequently, if the organization does not pay the tax imposed by
section 4940 for any taxable year or years during the 60-month period,
and it is subsequently determined that such tax is due for such year or
years (because the organization did not in fact complete a successful
termination pursuant to section 507(b)(1)(B) and was not treated as an
organization described in section 509(a)(1), section 509(a)(2), or
section 509(a)(3) for such year or years), the organization is liable
for interest in accordance with section 6601 if any amount of tax under
section 4940 has not been paid on or before the last date prescribed for
payment. However, because any failure to pay such tax during the 60-
month period (or prior to the revocation of such ruling) is due to
reasonable cause, the penalty under section 6651 with respect to the tax
imposed by section 4940 shall not apply.
(5) Extension of time to assess deficiencies. The advance ruling
described in paragraph (d)(1) of this section shall be issued only if
such organization's request for an advance ruling is filed with a
consent under section 6501(c)(4) to the effect that the period of
limitations upon assessment under section 4940 for any taxable year
within the advance ruling period shall not expire prior to one year
after the date of the expiration of the time prescribed by law for the
assessment of a deficiency for the last taxable year within the 60-month
period.
(e) Effect on grantors or contributors and on the organization
itself--(1) Effect of satisfaction of requirements for termination;
treatment during the termination period. In the event that an
organization satisfies the requirements of section 507(b)(1)(B) for
termination of its private foundation status during the continuous 60-
month period, such organization shall be treated for such entire 60-
month period in the same manner as an organization described in section
509(a)(1), section 509(a)(2), or section 509(a)(3), as the case may be.
(2) Failure to meet termination requirements--(i) In general. Except
as otherwise provided in paragraphs (d) and (e)(2)(ii) of this section,
any organization that fails to satisfy the requirements of section
507(b)(1)(B) for termination of its private foundation status during the
continuous 60-month period shall be treated as a private foundation for
the entire 60-month period, for purposes of sections 507 through 509 and
Chapter 42, and grants or contributions
[[Page 83]]
to such an organization shall be treated as made to a private foundation
for purposes of sections 170, 507(b)(1)(A), 4942, and 4945.
(ii) Certain 60-month terminations. Notwithstanding paragraph
(e)(2)(i) of this section, if an organization fails to satisfy the
requirements of section 509(a)(1), section 509(a)(2), or section
509(a)(3) for the continuous 60-month period but does satisfy the
requirements of section 509(a)(1), section 509(a)(2), or section
509(a)(3), as the case may be, for any taxable year or years during such
60-month period, the organization shall be treated as a section
509(a)(1), section 509(a)(2), or section 509(a)(3) organization for such
taxable year or years, and grants or contributions made during such
taxable year or years shall be treated as made to an organization
described in section 509(a)(1), section 509(a)(2), or section 509(a)(3).
In addition, sections 507 through 509 and Chapter 42 shall not apply to
such organization for any taxable year within such 60-month period for
which it does meet such requirements. For purposes of determining
whether an organization satisfies the requirements of section 509(a)(1),
section 509(a)(2), or section 509(a)(3) for any taxable year in the 60-
month period, the calculation of public support shall be made over the
period beginning with the date of the commencement of the 60-month
period, and ending with the last day of the taxable year being tested.
The organization shall not be treated as a section 509(a)(1) or section
509(a)(2) organization for any taxable year during the 60-month period
solely by reason of having met a public support test for the preceding
year. In addition, the transition rules in Sec. Sec. 1.170-
9(f)(14)(iii) and 1.509(a)-3(n)(iii) shall not apply.
(iii) Aggregate tax benefit. For purposes of section 507(d), the
organization's aggregate tax benefit resulting from the organization's
section 501(c)(3) status shall continue to be computed from the date
from which such computation would have been made, but for the notice
filed under section 507(b)(1)(B)(ii), except that any taxable year
within such 60-month period for which such organization meets the
requirements of section 509(a)(1), section 509(a)(2), or section
509(a)(3) shall be excluded from such computations.
(iv) Excess business holdings. See section 4943 and the related
regulations for rules relating to decreases in a private foundation's
holdings in a business enterprise which are caused by the foundation's
failure to terminate its private foundation status after giving the
notification for termination under section 507(b)(1)(B)(ii).
(3) Example. The provisions of this paragraph (e) may be illustrated
by the following example:
Example 1. Y, a calendar year private foundation, notifies the IRS
that it intends to terminate its private foundation status by converting
into a publicly supported organization described in section
170(b)(1)(A)(vi) and that its 60-month termination period will commence
on January 1, 2010. Y does not obtain a ruling described in paragraph
(d) of this section. Based upon its support for 2010, Y does not qualify
as a publicly supported organization within the meaning of Sec. 1.170A-
9(f) and this paragraph for 2010. Consequently, in order to avoid the
risks of penalties and interest if Y fails to terminate within the 60-
month period, Y files its 2010 return as a private foundation and pays
the tax imposed by section 4940. Because a consent (described in
paragraph (b)(7) of this section), which would prevent the period of
limitations for all years in the 60-month period from expiring, is not
in effect, in order to be able to file a claim for refund, Y and the IRS
must agree to extend the period of limitation for all taxes imposed
under Chapter 42 for 2010. Based on the aggregate data for the entire
60-month period (2010 through 2014), Y does qualify as a publicly-
supported organization for the entire 60-month period. Consequently, Y
is treated as a publicly-supported organization for the entire 60-month
period. Y files a claim for refund for the taxes paid under section 4940
for 2010, and such taxes are refunded.
(f) Effective/applicability date--(1) Effective date. These
regulations are effective on September 8, 2011.
(2) Applicability date. The regulations in this section shall apply
to tax years beginning on or after January 1, 2008. For taxable years
beginning after December 31, 1969, and beginning before January 1, 2008,
see Sec. 1.507-2 (as contained in 26 CFR part 1 revised April 1, 2008).
[T.D. 9549, 76 FR 55760, Sept. 8, 2011]
[[Page 84]]
Sec. 1.507-3 Special rules; transferee foundations.
(a) General rule. (1) For purposes of part II, subchapter F, chapter
1 of the Code, in the case of a transfer of assets of any private
foundation to another private foundation pursuant to any liquidation,
merger, redemption, recapitalization, or other adjustment, organization,
or reorganization, the transferee organization shall not be treated as a
newly created organization. Thus, in the case of a significant
disposition of assets to one or more private foundations within the
meaning of paragraph (c) of this section, the transferee organization
shall not be treated as a newly created organization. A transferee
organization to which this paragraph applies shall be treated as
possessing those attributes and characteristics of the transferor
organization which are described in subparagraphs (2), (3), and (4) of
this paragraph.
(2)(i) A transferee organization to which this paragraph applies
shall succeed to the aggregate tax benefit of the transferor
organization in an amount determined as follows: Such amount shall be an
amount equal to the amount of such aggregate tax benefit multiplied by a
fraction the numerator of which is the fair market value of the assets
(less encumbrances) transferred to such transferee and the denominator
of which is the fair market value of the assets of the transferor (less
encumbrances) immediately before the transfer. Fair market value shall
be determined as of the time of the transfer.
(ii) Notwithstanding subdivision (i) of this subparagraph, a
transferee organization which is not effectively controlled (within the
meaning of Sec. 1.482-1(a)(3)), directly or indirectly, by the same
person or persons who effectively control the transferor organization
shall not succeed to an aggregate tax benefit in excess of the fair
market value of the assets transferred at the time of the transfer.
(iii) This subparagraph may be illustrated by the following
examples:
Example 1. Pursuant to a transfer described in section 507(b)(2), F,
a private foundation, transfers to G, a private foundation, all of its
assets, which have a fair market value of $400,000. Immediately before
the transfer F's aggregate tax benefit was $200,000, and G's aggregate
tax benefit was $300,000. After the transfer G's aggregate tax benefit
is $500,000 ($200,000+$300,000).
Example 2. Pursuant to a transfer described in section 507(b)(2), M,
a private foundation, transfers all of its assets, which immediately
prior to the transfer have a fair market value of $100,000. The assets
were transferred to the following organizations at the following fair
market values (determined at the time of transfer) $40,000 to N, a
private foundation, $30,000 to O, a private foundation, and $30,000 to
P, an organization described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(vi). Immediately
before the transfer M's aggregate tax benefit was $50,000. Therefore, N
succeeds to M's aggregate tax benefit to the extent of $20,000
($50,000x$40,000/$100,000) and O succeeds to M's aggregate tax benefit
to the extent of $15,000 ($50,000x$30,000/$100,000). The remaining
$15,000 of M's aggregate tax benefit is retained by M as M has not
terminated under section 507.
Example 3. Assume the same facts as in Example 2 except that the
transfers were made as follows: M transferred $30,000 to N on January 1,
1972, $40,000 to P on July 1, 1972, and $30,000 to O on December 31,
1972. Further, assume that the fair market value of the assets and the
aggregate tax benefit do not change during 1972 and that O is not
effectively controlled (directly or indirectly) by the same person or
persons who effectively control M. N succeeds to M's aggregate tax
benefit to the extent of $15,000 ($50,000x$30,000/$100,000). However,
since $40,000 of the remaining $70,000 ($100,000-$30,000) of assets of M
was transferred to P on July 1, 1972, immediately before the transfer to
O, the fair market value of the assets held by M is $30,000 ($70,000-
$40,000). On the other hand, because P is not a private foundation, M's
aggregate tax benefit immediately before the transfer to O remains
$35,000 ($50,000-$15,000). Therefore, before applying subdivision (ii)
of this subparagraph, O would succeed to $35,000 ($35,000x$30,000/
$30,000) of M's aggregate tax benefit. However, applying subdivision
(ii) of this subparagraph since M transferred only $30,000 to O, O shall
succeed to only $30,000 of M's aggregate tax benefit. The remaining
$5,000 ($35,000-$30,000) of M's aggregate tax benefit is retained by M
as M has not terminated under section 507.
(3) For purposes of section 507(d)(2), in the event of a transfer of
assets described in section 507(b)(2), any person who is a substantial
contributor (within the meaning of section 507(d)(2)) with respect to
the transferor foundation shall be treated as a substantial contributor
with respect to the transferee foundation, regardless of whether such
person meets the $5,000-two percent
[[Page 85]]
test with respect to the transferee organization at any time. If a
private foundation makes a transfer described in section 507(b)(2) to
two or more transferee private foundations, any person who is a
substantial contributor with respect to the transferor foundation prior
to such transfer shall be considered a substantial contributor with
respect to each transferee private foundation.
(4) If a private foundation incurs liability for one or more of the
taxes imposed under chapter 42 (or any penalty resulting therefrom)
prior to, or as a result of, making a transfer of assets described in
section 507(b)(2) to one or more private foundations, in any case where
transferee liability applies each transferee foundation shall be treated
as receiving the transferred assets subject to such liability to the
extent that the transferor foundation does not satisfy such liability.
(5) Except as provided in subparagraph (9) of this paragraph, a
private foundation is required to meet the distribution requirements of
section 4942 for any taxable year in which it makes a section 507(b)(2)
transfer of all or part of its net assets to another private foundation.
Such transfer shall itself be counted toward satisfaction of such
requirements to the extent the amount transferred meets the requirements
of section 4942(g). However, where the transferor has disposed of all of
its assets, the recordkeeping requirements of section 4942(g)(3)(B)
shall not apply during any period in which it has no assets. Such
requirements are applicable for any taxable year other than a taxable
year during which the transferor has no assets.
(6) For purposes of section 4943(c) (4), (5), and (6), whenever a
private foundation makes a section 507(b)(2) transfer of all or part of
its net assets to another private foundation, the applicable period of
time described in section 4943(c) (4), (5), or (6) shall include both
the period during which the transferor foundation held such assets and
the period during which the transferee foundation holds such assets.
(7) Except as provided in subparagraph (9) of this paragraph, where
the transferor has disposed of all of its assets, during any period in
which the transferor has no assets, section 4945 (d)(4) and (h) shall
not apply to the transferee or the transferor with respect to any
expenditure responsibility grants made by the transferor. However, the
exception contained in this subparagraph shall not apply with respect to
any information reporting requirements imposed by section 4945 and the
regulations thereunder for any year in which any such transfer is made.
(8)(i) Except as provided in subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph
or subparagraph (6) or (9) of this paragraph or whenever a private
foundation makes a transfer of assets described in section 507(b)(2) to
one or more private foundations, the transferee foundation:
(a) Will not be treated as being in existence prior to January 1,
1970, with respect to any transferred assets;
(b) Will not be treated as holding the transferred assets prior to
January 1, 1970; and
(c) Will not be treated as having engaged in, or become subject to,
any transaction, lease, contract, or other obligation with respect to
the transferred assets prior to January 1, 1970.
(ii) Notwithstanding subdivision (i) of this subparagraph, the
provisions enumerated in (a) through (g) of this subdivision shall apply
to the transferee foundation with respect to the assets transferred to
the same extent and in the same manner that they would have applied to
the transferor foundation had the transfer described in section
507(b)(2) not been effected:
(a) Section 4940(c)(4)(B) and the regulations thereunder with
respect to basis of property,
(b) Section 4942(f)(4) and the regulations thereunder with respect
to distributions of income,
(c) Section 101(l)(2) of the Tax Reform Act of 1969 (83 Stat. 533),
as amended by sections 1301 and 1309 of the Tax Reform Act of 1976 (90
Stat. 1713, 1729), with respect to the provisions of section 4941,
(d) Section 101(l)(3)(A) of the Tax Reform Act of 1969 (83 Stat.
534) with respect to the provisions of section 4942, but only if the
transferor qualified for the application of such section immediately
before the transfer, and at least 85 percent of the fair market value of
[[Page 86]]
the net assets of the transferee immediately after the transfer was
received pursuant to the transfer,
(e) Section 101(l)(3) (B) through (E) of the Tax Reform Act of 1969
(83 Stat. 534) with respect to the provisions of section 4942,
(f) Section 101(l)(5) of the Tax Reform Act of 1969 (83 Stat. 535)
with respect to the provisions of section 4945, and
(g) Section 101(l)(6) of the Tax Reform Act of 1969 (83 Stat. 535)
with respect to the provisions of section 508(e).
(9) (i) If a private foundation transfers all of its net assets to
one or more private foundations which are effectively controlled (within
the meaning of Sec. 1.482-1(a)(3)), directly or indirectly, by the same
person or persons which effectively controlled the transferor private
foundation, for purposes of chapter 42 (section 4940 et seq.) and part
II of subchapter F of chapter 1 of the Code (sections 507 through 509)
such a transferee private foundation shall be treated as if it were the
transferor. However, where proportionality is appropriate, such a
transferee private foundation shall be treated as if it were the
transferor in the proportion which the fair market value of the assets
(less encumbrances) transferred to such transferee bears to the fair
market value of the assets (less encumbrances) of the transferor
immediately before the transfer.
(ii) Subdivision (i) of this subparagraph shall not apply to the
requirements under sections 6033, 6056, and 6104 which must be complied
with by the transferor private foundation, nor to the requirement under
section 6043 that the transferor file a return with respect to its
liquidation, dissolution, or termination.
(iii) This subparagraph may be illustrated by the following
examples:
Example 1. The trustees of X charitable trust, a private foundation,
form the Y charitable corporation, also a private foundation, in order
to facilitate the conduct of their activities. The trustees of X are
also the directors of Y. Y has the same charitable purposes as X. All of
the assets of X are transferred to Y, and Y continues to carry on X's
charitable activities. Under such circumstances, Y shall be treated as
if it were X for the purposes of subdivision (i) of this subparagraph.
Thus, for example, Y will be permitted to take advantage of any special
rules or savings provisions with respect to chapter 42 to the same
extent as X could have if X had continued in existence.
Example 2. A and B are the trustees of the P charitable trust, a
private foundation, and are the only substantial contributors to P. On
July 1, 1973, in order to facilitate accomplishment of diverse
charitable purposes, A and B create and control the R Foundation, the S
Foundation and the T Foundation and transfer the net assets of P to R,
S, and T. As of the end of 1973, P has an outstanding grant to
Foundation W and has been required to exercise expenditure
responsibility with respect to this grant under sections 4945 (d)(4) and
(h). Under these circumstances, R, S, and T shall each be treated as if
they are P in the proportion the fair market value of the assets
transferred to each bears to the fair market value of the assets of P
immediately before the transfer. Since R, S, and T are treated as P,
absent a specific provision for exercising expenditure responsibility
with respect to the grant to W, each of them is required to exercise
expenditure responsibility with respect to such grant. If, as a part of
the transfer to R, P assigned, and R assumed, P's duties with respect to
the expenditure responsibility grant to W, only R would be required to
exercise expenditure responsibility with respect to the grant to W.
Since R, S, and T are treated as P rather than as recipients of
expenditure responsibility grants, there are no expenditure
responsibility requirements which must be exercised under sections 4945
(d)(4) and (h) with respect to the transfers of assets to R, S, and T.
(10) For certain rules relating to filing requirements where a
private foundation has transferred all its net assets, see Sec. 1.507-
1(b)(9).
(b) Status of transferee organization under section 507(b)(2). Since
a transfer of assets pursuant to any liquidation, merger, redemption,
recapitalization, or other adjustment, organization or reorganization to
an organization not described in section 501(c)(3) (other than an
organization described in section 509(a)(4)) or 4947 is a taxable
expenditure under section 4945(d)(5), in order for such a transfer of
assets not to be a taxable expenditure, it must be to an organization
described in section 501(c)(3) (other than an organization described in
section 509(a)(4)) or treated as described in section 501(c)(3) under
section 4947. See Sec. 53.4945-6(c)(3) of this chapter. Consequently,
unless such a transferee is an organization described in section 509(a)
(1), (2), or (3), the transferee is a private foundation and the rules
of section 507(b)(2) and
[[Page 87]]
paragraph (a) of this section apply. On the other hand, if such a
transfer of assets is made to a transferee organization which is not
described in either section 501(c)(3) (other than an organization
described in section 509(a)(4)) or 4947, and in order to correct the
making of a taxable expenditure, such assets are transferred to a
private foundation, section 507(b)(2) and paragraph (a) of this section
shall apply as if the transfer of assets had been made directly to such
private foundation.
(c) Section 507(b)(2) transfers. (1) A transfer of assets is
described in section 507(b)(2) if it is made by a private foundation to
another private foundation pursuant to any liquidation, merger,
redemption, recapitalization, or other adjustment, organization, or
reorganization. This shall include any organization or reorganization
described in subchapter C of chapter 1. For purposes of section
507(b)(2), the terms other adjustment, organization, or reorganization
shall include any partial liquidation or any other significant
disposition of assets to one or more private foundations, other than
transfers for full and adequate consideration or distributions out of
current income. For purposes of this paragraph, a distribution out of
current income shall include any distribution described in section
4942(h)(1) (A) and (B).
(2) The term significant disposition of assets to one or more
private foundations shall include any disposition for a taxable year
where the aggregate of:
(i) The dispositions to one or more private foundations for the
taxable year, and
(ii) Where any disposition to one or more private foundations for
the taxable year is part of a series of related dispositions made during
prior taxable years, the total of the related dispositions made during
such prior taxable years, is 25 percent or more of the fair market value
of the net assets of the foundation at the beginning of the taxable year
(in the case of subdivision (i) of this subparagraph) or at the
beginning of the first taxable year in which any of the series of
related dispositions was made (in the case of subdivision (ii) of this
subparagraph). A significant disposition of assets may occur in a single
taxable year (as in subdivision (i) of this subparagraph) or over the
course of two or more taxable years (as in subdivision (ii) of this
subparagraph). The determination whether a significant disposition has
occurred through a series of related distributions (within the meaning
of subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph) will be made on the basis of
all the facts and circumstances of the particular case. However, if one
or more persons who are disqualified persons (within the meaning of
section 4946) with respect to the transferor private foundation are also
disqualified persons with respect to any of the transferee private
foundations, such fact shall be evidence that the transfer is part of a
series of related dispositions (within the meaning of subdivision (ii)
of this subparagraph). In the case of a series of related dispositions
described in subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph, each transferee
private foundation shall (on any date) be subject to the provisions of
section 507(b)(2) (with respect to all such dispositions made to it on
or before such date) to the extent described in paragraphs (a) and (b)
of this section.
(3) A private foundation which fails to meet the requirements of
section 507(b)(1)(A) for a taxable year may be required to file a return
under section 6043(b) by reason of a transfer of assets to one or more
sections 509(a) (1), (2), or (3) organizations. Hence, such filing does
not necessarily mean that a section 507(b)(2) transfer has occurred. See
Sec. 1.6043-3(f)(1).
(4) This paragraph applies to any section 507(b)(2) transfer made by
a private foundation referred to in section 170(b)(1)(E) (i), (ii), or
(iii).
(5) The provisions of this paragraph may be illustrated by the
following examples:
Example 1. M is a private foundation on the calendar year basis. It
has net assets worth $100,000 as of January 1, 1971. In 1971, in
addition to distributions out of current income, M transfers $10,000 to
N, $10,000 to O, and $10,000 to P. N, O, and P are all private
foundations. Under subparagraph (2)(i) of this paragraph, M has made a
significant disposition of its assets in 1971 since M has disposed of
more than 25 percent of its net assets (with respect to the fair market
value of such assets as of January 1, 1971). M has therefore made
section 507(b)(2) transfers within the meaning of this paragraph, and
[[Page 88]]
section 507(b)(2) applies to the transfers made to N, O, and P.
Example 2. U, a tax-exempt private foundation on the calendar year
basis, has net assets worth $100,000 as of January 1, 1971. As part of a
series of related dispositions in 1971 and 1972, U transfers in 1971, in
addition to distributions out of current income, $10,000 to private
foundation X and $10,000 to private foundation Y, and in 1972, in
addition to distributions out of current income, U transfers $10,000 to
private foundation Z. Under subparagraph (2)(ii) of this paragraph, U is
treated as having made a series of related dispositions in 1971 and
1972. The aggregate of the 1972 disposition (under subparagraph (2)(i)
of this paragraph) and the series of related dispositions (under
subparagraph (2)(ii) of this paragraph) is $30,000, which is more than
25 percent of the fair market value of U's net assets as of the
beginning of 1971 ($100,000), the first year in which any such
disposition was made. Thus, U has made a significant disposition of its
assets and has made transfers described in section 507(b)(2). The
provisions of paragraphs (a) and (b) of this section apply to each of
the transferees as of the date on which it received assets from U.
(d) Inapplicability of section 507(a) to section 507(b)(2)
transfers. Unless a private foundation voluntarily gives notice pursuant
to section 507(a)(1), a transfer of assets described in section
507(b)(2) will not constitute a termination of the transferor's private
foundation status under section 507(a)(1). Such transfer must,
nevertheless, satisfy the requirements of any pertinent provisions of
chapter 42. See subparagraphs (5) through (7) of paragraph (a) of this
section. However, if such transfer constitutes an act or failure to act
which is described in section 507(a)(2)(A), then such transfer will be
subject to the provisions of section 507(a)(2) rather than section
507(b)(2). For example, X, a private nonoperating foundation, transfers
all of its net assets to Y, a private operating foundation, in 1971. X
does not file the notice referred to in section 507(a)(1) and the
transfer does not constitute either a willful and flagrant act (or
failure to act), or one of a series of willful repeated acts (or
failures to act), giving rise to liability for tax under chapter 42.
Under these circumstances, the transfer is described in section
507(b)(2) and the provisions of paragraph (a) of this section apply with
respect to Y. The private foundation status of X has not been terminated
under section 507(a).
(e) Transfers to certain section 509(a) (1), (2), or (3)
organizations. If a private foundation transfers all or part of its
assets to one or more organizations described in section 509(a) (1),
(2), or (3) and, within a period of 3 years from the date of such
transfers, one or more of the transferee organizations lose their
section 509(a) (1), (2), or (3) status and become private foundations,
then for purposes of this section, a transfer of assets within the
meaning of paragraph (c) of this section to such an organization which
becomes a private foundation will be treated as a transfer described in
section 507(b)(2), and the provisions of paragraph (a) of this section
shall be treated as applying to such a transferee organization from the
date on which any such transfer was made to it.
(f) Certain transfers made during section 507(b)(1)(B) terminations.
If:
(1) During the course of the 12-month or 60-month period described
in section 507(b)(1)(B), a private foundation makes one or more
transfers to one or more private foundations;
(2) Such transfers are described in Sec. 1.507-3(c)(1); and
(3) Even though the transferor foundation thereafter meets the
requirements of section 507(b)(1)(B)
then for purposes of this section, the provisions of Sec. 1.507-2(e)
shall not apply with respect to such transfers, and such transfers will
be treated as transfers described in section 507(b)(2) and Sec. 1.507-3
rather than as transfers from an organization described in section
509(a) (1), (2), or (3).
[T.D. 7233, 37 FR 28158, Dec. 21, 1972; 38 FR 3189, Feb. 2, 1973, as
amended by T.D. 7678, 45 FR 12415, Feb. 26, 1980]
Sec. 1.507-4 Imposition of tax.
(a) General rule. Section 507(c) imposes on each organization the
private foundation status of which is terminated under section 507(a) a
tax equal to the lower of:
(1) The amount which such organization substantiates by adequate
records (or other corroborating evidence which may be required by the
Commissioner) as the aggregate tax benefit (as defined in section
507(d)) resulting from the
[[Page 89]]
section 501(c)(3) status of such organization, or
(2) The value of the net assets of such organization.
(b) Transfers not subject to section 507(c). Private foundations
which make transfers described in section 507(b)(1)(A) or (2) are not
subject to the tax imposed under section 507(c) with respect to such
transfers unless the provisions of section 507(a) become applicable. See
Sec. Sec. 1.507-1(b), 1.507-2(a)(6) and 1.507-3(d).
[T.D. 7233, 37 FR 28161, Dec. 21, 1972]
Sec. 1.507-5 Aggregate tax benefit; in general.
(a) General rule. For purposes of section 507(c)(1), the aggregate
tax benefit resulting from the section 501(c)(3) status of any private
foundation is the sum of:
(1) The aggregate increases in tax under chapters 1, 11, and 12 (or
the corresponding provisions of prior law) which would have been imposed
with respect to all substantial contributors to the foundation if
deductions for all contributions made by such contributors to the
foundation after February 28, 1913, had been disallowed,
(2) The aggregate increases in tax under chapter 1 (or the
corresponding provisions of prior law) which would have been imposed
with respect to the income of the private foundation for taxable years
beginning after December 31, 1912, if (i) it had not been exempt from
tax under section 501(a) (or the corresponding provisions of prior law),
and (ii) in the case of a trust, deductions under section 642(c) (or the
corresponding provisions of prior law) had been limited to 20 percent of
the taxable income of the trust (computed without the benefit of section
642(c) but with the benefit of section 170(b)(1)(A)),
(3) The amount succeeded to from transferors under Sec. 1.507-3(a)
and section 507(b)(2), and
(4) Interest on the increases in tax determined under subparagraphs
(1), (2), and (3) of this paragraph from the first date on which each
such increase would have been due and payable to the date on which the
organization ceases to be a private foundation.
(b) Contributions. In computing the amount of the aggregate
increases in tax under subparagraph (1) of this paragraph, all
deductions attributable to a particular contribution shall be included.
For example, if a substantial contributor has taken deductions under
sections 170 and 2522 (or the corresponding provisions of prior law)
with respect to the same contribution, the amount of each deduction
shall be included in the computations under section 507(d)(1)(A).
Accordingly, the aggregate tax benefit may exceed the fair market value
of the property transferred.
[T.D. 7233, 37 FR 28161, Dec. 21, 1972]
Sec. 1.507-6 Substantial contributor defined.
(a) Definition--(1) In general. Except as provided in subparagraph
(2) of this paragraph, the term substantial contributor means, with
respect to a private foundation, any person (within the meaning of
section 7701(a)(1)), whether or not exempt from taxation under section
501(a), who contributed or bequeathed an aggregate amount of more than
$5,000 to the private foundation, if such amount is more than 2 percent
of the total contributions and bequests received by the private
foundation before the close of the taxable year of the private
foundation in which a contribution or bequest is received by the
foundation from such person. In the case of a trust, the term
substantial contributor also means the creator of the trust. Such term
does not include a governmental unit described in section 170(c)(1).
(2) Special rules. For purposes of sections 170(b)(1)(E)(iii),
507(d)(1), 508(d), 509(a) (1) and (3), and chapter 42, the term
substantial contributor shall not include an organization which is
described in section 509(a) (1), (2), or (3) or any other organization
which is wholly owned by such section 509(a) (1), (2), or (3)
organization. Furthermore, taking section 4941 (relating to taxes on
self-dealing) in context, it would unduly restrict the activities of
private foundations if the term substantial contributor were to include
any section 501(c)(3) organizations. It was not intended, for
[[Page 90]]
example, that a large grant for charitable purposes from one private
foundation to another world forever preclude the latter from making any
grants to, or otherwise dealing with, the former. Accordingly, for
purposes of section 4941 only, the term substantial contributor shall
not only include any organization which is described in section
501(c)(3) (other than an organization described in section 509(a)(4)).
(b) Determination of substantial contributor--(1) In general. In
determining under paragraph (a) of this section whether the aggregate of
contributions and bequests from a person exceeds 2 percent of the total
contributions and bequests received by a private foundation, both the
total of such amounts received by the private foundation, and the
aggregate of such amounts contributed and bequeathed by such person,
shall be determined as of the last day of each taxable year commencing
with the first taxable year ending after October 9, 1969. Generally,
under section 507(d)(2) and this section, except for purposes of
valuation under section 507(d)(2)(B)(i), all contributions and bequests
made before October 9, 1969, are deemed to have been made on October 9,
1969. For purposes of section 509(a)(2) and the support test described
in Sec. 1.509(a)-3(c), contributions and bequests before October 9,
1969, will be taken into account in the year when actually made. For
example, in the case of a contribution or bequest of $6,000 in 1967,
such contribution or bequest shall be treated as made by a substantial
contributor in 1967 for purposes of section 509(a)(2) and Sec.
1.509(a)-3(c) if such person met the $5,000--2 percent test as of
December 31, 1967, and December 31, 1969 (in the case of a calendar year
accounting period). Although the determination of the percentage of
total contributions and bequests represented by a given donor's
contributions and bequests is not made until the end of the foundation's
taxable year, a donor is a substantial contributor as of the first date
when the foundation received from him an amount sufficient to make him a
substantial contributor. Except as otherwise provided in this
subparagraph, such amount is treated for all purposes as made by a
substantial contributor. Thus, the total contributions and bequests
received by the private foundation from all persons, and the aggregate
contributions and bequests made by a particular person, are to be
determined as of December 31, 1969 (in the case of a calendar year
organization which was in existence on that date), and the amounts
included in each respective total would be all contributions and
bequests received by the organization on or before that date, and all
contributions and bequests made by the person on or before that date.
Thereafter, a similar determination is to be made with respect to such
private foundation as of the end of each of its succeeding taxable
years. Status as a substantial contributor, however, will date from the
time when the donor first met the $5,000 and 2 percent test. Once a
person is a substantial contributor with respect to a private
foundation, he remains a substantial contributor even though he might
not be so classified if a determination were first made at some later
date. For instance, even though the aggregate contributions and bequests
of a person become less than 2 percent of the total received by a
private foundation (for example, because of subsequent contributions and
bequests by other persons), such person remains a substantial
contributor with respect to the foundation.
(2) Examples. The provisions of paragraph (a) of this section and
this paragraph (b) may be illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. On January 1, 1968, A, an individual, gave $4,500 to M, a
private foundation on a calendar year basis. On June 1, 1969, A gave M
the further sum of $1,500. Throughout its existence, through December
31, 1969, M has received $250,000 in contributions and bequests from all
sources. As of June 1, 1969, A is a substantial contributor to M for
purposes of section 509(a)(2).
Example 2. On September 9, 1966, B, an individual, gave $3,500 to N,
a private foundation on a calendar year basis. On March 15, 1970, B gave
N the further sum of $3,500. Throughout its existence, through December
31, 1970, N has received $200,000 in contributions and bequests from all
sources. B is a substantial contributor to N as of March 15, 1970, since
that is the first date on which his contributions met the 2 percent-
$5,000 test.
Example 3. On July 21, 1964, X, a corporation, gave $2,000 to O, a
private foundation on a calendar year basis. As of December 31,
[[Page 91]]
1969, O had received $150,000 from all sources. On September 17, 1970, X
gave O the further sum of $3,100. Through September 17, 1970, O had
received $245,000 from all sources as total contributions and bequests.
Between September 17, 1970, and December 31, 1970, however, O received
$50,000 in contributions and bequests from others. X is not a
substantial contributor to O, since X's contributions to O were not more
than 2 percent of the total contributions and bequests received by O by
December 31, 1970, the end of O's taxable year, even though X's
contributions met that test at one point during the year.
Example 4. On September 16, 1970, C, an individual, gave $10,000 to
P, a private foundation on a calendar year basis. Throughout its
existence, and through December 31, 1970, the close of its taxable year,
P had received a total of $100,000 in contributions and bequests. On
January 3, 1971, P received a bequest of $1 million. C is a substantial
contributor to P since he was a substantial contributor as of September
16, 1970, and therefore remains one even though he no longer meets the
2-percent test on a later date after the end of the taxable year of the
foundation in which he first became a substantial contributor.
(c) Special rules--(1) Contributions defined. The term contribution
shall, for purposes of section 507(d)(2), have the same meaning as such
term has under section 170(c) and also include bequests, legacies,
devises, and transfers within the meaning of section 2055 or 2106(a)(2).
Thus, for purposes of section 507(d)(2), any payment of money or
transfer of property without adequate consideration shall be considered
a contribution. Where payment is made or property transferred as
consideration for admissions, sales of merchandise, performance of
services, or furnishing of facilities to the donor, the qualification of
all or any part of such payment or transfer as a contribution under
section 170(c) shall determine whether and to what extent such payment
or transfer constitutes a contribution under section 507(d)(2).
(2) Valuation of contributions and bequests. Each contribution or
bequest to a private foundation shall be valued at fair market value
when actually received by the private foundation.
(3) Contributions and bequests by a spouse. An individual shall be
considered, for purposes of this section, to have made all contributions
and bequests made by his spouse during the period of their marriage.
Thus, for example, where W contributed $500,000 to P, a private
foundation, in 1941 and that amount exceeded 2 percent of the total
contributions received by P as of the end of P's first taxable year
ending after October 9, 1969, H (W's spouse at the time of the 1941
gift) is considered to have made such contribution (even if W died prior
to October 9, 1969, or their marriage was otherwise terminated prior to
such date). Similarly, any bequest or devise shall be treated as having
been made by the decedent's surviving spouse.
[T.D. 7241, 37 FR 28743, Dec. 29, 1972; 38 FR 24206, Sept. 6, 1973]
Sec. 1.507-7 Value of assets.
(a) In general. For purposes of section 507(c), the value of the net
assets shall be determined at whichever time such value is higher:
(1) The first day on which action is taken by the organization which
culminates in its ceasing to be a private foundation, or
(2) The date on which it ceases to be a private foundation.
(b) Valuation dates. (1) In the case of a termination under section
507(a)(1), the date referred to in paragraph (a)(1) of this section
shall be the date on which the terminating foundation gives the
notification described in section 507(a)(1).
(2) In the case of a termination under section 507(a)(2), the date
referred to in paragraph (a)(1) of this section shall be the date of
occurrence of the willful and flagrant act (or failure to act) or the
first of the series of willful repeated acts (or failures to act) giving
rise to liability for tax under chapter 42 and the imposition of tax
under section 507(a)(2).
(c) Fair market value. For purposes of this section, fair market
value shall be determined pursuant to the provisions of Sec.
53.4942(a)-2(c)(4) of this chapter.
(d) Net assets. For purposes of section 507 and the regulations
thereunder, the term net assets shall mean the gross assets of a private
foundation reduced by all liabilities of the foundation, including
appropriate estimated and contingent liabilities. Thus, a determination
of net assets may reflect reductions for any liability or contingent
liability for
[[Page 92]]
tax imposed upon the private foundation under chapter 42 with respect to
acts or failures to act prior to termination, for any liability or
contingent liability for failures to correct such acts or failures to
act, or for any liability or estimated or contingent liability with
respect to expenses associated with winding up the organization. If a
private foundation's determination of net assets reflects any reduction
for any estimated or contingent liability, such private foundation must
establish, to the satisfaction of the Commissioner, the reasonableness
of such reduction. If the amount of net assets reflects a reduction for
any estimated or contingent liability, at the earlier of the final
determination of the contingency or the termination of a reasonable
time, any excess of the amount by which the gross assets was reduced
over the amount of the liability shall be treated in the same manner as
if such excess had been considered part of the net assets.
[T.D. 7233, 37 FR 28161, Dec. 21, 1972]
Sec. 1.507-8 Liability in case of transfers.
For purposes of determining liability for the tax imposed under
section 507(c) in the case of assets transferred by the private
foundation, such tax shall be deemed to have been imposed on the first
day on which action is taken by the organization which culminates in its
ceasing to be a private foundation. If an organization's private
foundation status is terminated under section 507(a)(2), the first day
on which action is taken which culminates in its ceasing to be a private
foundation (within the meaning of section 507(f)) shall be the date
described in Sec. 1.507-7(b)(2). If an organization terminates its
private foundation status under section 507(a)(1), the first day on
which action is taken which culminates in its ceasing to be a private
foundation (within the meaning of section 507(f)) shall be the date
described in Sec. 1.507-7(b)(1).
[T.D. 7233, 37 FR 28161, Dec. 21, 1972]
Sec. 1.507-9 Abatement of taxes.
(a) General rule. The Commissioner may at his discretion abate the
unpaid portion of the assessment of any tax imposed by section 507(c),
or any liability in respect thereof, if:
(1) The private foundation distributes all of its net assets to one
or more organizations described in section 170(b)(1)(A) (other than in
clauses (vii) or (viii)) each of which has been in existence and so
described for a continuous period of at least 60 calendar months, or
(2) Effective assurance is given to the Commissioner in accordance
with paragraphs (b) and (c) of this section that the assets of the
organization which are dedicated to charitable purposes will, in fact,
be used for charitable purposes
The provisions of Sec. 1.507-2(a) (2), (3), and (7) shall apply to
distributions under subparagraph (1) of this paragraph. Since section
507(g) provides only for the abatement of tax imposed under section
507(c), no tax imposed under any provision of chapter 42 shall be abated
under section 507(g). Where the taxpayer files a petition with the Tax
Court with respect to a notice of deficiency regarding any tax under
section 507(c), such tax shall be treated as having been assessed for
the purposes of abatement of such tax under section 507(g) and the
regulations thereunder.
(b) State proceedings. (1) The Commissioner may at his discretion
abate the unpaid portion of the assessment of any tax imposed by section
507(c), or any liability in respect thereof, under the procedures
outlined in subparagraphs (2) and (3) of this paragraph. Such tax may
not be abated by the Commissioner unless he determines that corrective
action as defined in paragraph (c) of this section has been taken. The
Commissioner may not abate by reason of section 507(g) any amount of
such tax which has already been collected since only the unpaid portion
thereof can be abated.
(2) The appropriate State officer shall have 1 year from the date of
notification prescribed in section 6104(c) that a notice of deficiency
of tax imposed under section 507(c) has been issued with respect to a
foundation, to advise the Commissioner that corrective action has been
initiated pursuant
[[Page 93]]
to State law as may be ordered or approved by a court of competent
jurisdiction. Corrective action may be initiated either by the
appropriate State officer or by an organization described in section
509(a) (1), (2), or (3) which is a beneficiary of the private foundation
and has enforceable rights against such foundation under State law.
Copies of all pleadings and other documents filed with the court at the
initial stages of the proceedings shall be attached to the notification
made by the State officer to the Commissioner. Prior to notification by
the appropriate State officer that corrective action has been initiated,
the Commissioner shall follow those procedures which would apply with
respect to the assessment and collection of the tax imposed under
section 507(c) without regard to section 507(g)(2). Subsequent to
notification by the appropriate State officer that corrective action has
been initiated, the Commissioner shall suspend action with respect to
the assessment or collection of tax imposed under section 507(c) until
notified of the final determination of such corrective action, as long
as any such resulting delay does not jeopardize the collection of such
tax and does not cause collection to be barred by operation of law or
any rule of law. In any case where collection of such tax is about to be
barred by operation of section 6502 and the Commissioner has not been
advised of the final determination of corrective action, the
Commissioner should make every effort to obtain appropriate agreements
with the foundation subject to such tax to extend the period of
limitations under section 6502(a)(2). Where such agreements are
obtained, action with respect to the assessment and collection of such
tax may be suspended to the extent not inconsistent with this
subparagraph.
(3) Upon receipt of certification from the appropriate State officer
that action has been ordered or approved by a court of competent
jurisdiction, the Commissioner may abate the unpaid portion of the
assessment of tax imposed by section 507(c), or any liability in respect
thereof, if in his judgment such action is corrective action within the
meaning of paragraph (c) of this section. In the event that such action
is not corrective action, the Commissioner may in his discretion again
suspend action on the assessment and collection of such tax until
corrective action is obtained, or if in his judgment corrective action
cannot be obtained, he may resume the assessment and collection of such
tax.
(c) Corrective action. The term corrective action referred to in
paragraph (b) of this section means vigorous enforcement of State laws
sufficient to assure implementation of the provisions of chapter 42 and
insure that the assets of such private foundation are preserved for such
charitable or other purposes specified in section 501(c)(3). Except
where assets of the terminated private foundation are transferred to an
organization described in section 509(a) (1) through (4) the State is
required to take such action to assure that the provisions of section
508(e)(1) (A) and (B) are applicable to the terminated foundation (or
any transferee) with respect to such assets as if such organization were
a private foundation. Thus, the governing instrument of such
organization must include provisions with respect to such assets:
(1) Requiring its income therefrom for each taxable year to be
distributed at such time and in such manner as not to subject such
organization to tax under section 4942 (as if the organization were a
private foundation),
(2) Prohibiting such organization from engaging in any act of self-
dealing (as defined in section 4941(d) as if the organization were a
private foundation),
(3) Prohibiting such organization from retaining any excess business
holdings (as defined in section 4943(c) as if the organization were a
private foundation),
(4) Prohibiting such organization from making any investments in
such manner as to subject such organization to tax under section 4944
(as if the organization were a private foundation), and
(5) Prohibiting such organization from making any taxable
expenditures (as defined in section 4945(d) as if the organization were
a private foundation). Consequently, in cases where the preceding
sentence applies, although
[[Page 94]]
the private foundation status of an organization is terminated for tax
purposes, it is contemplated that its status under State law would
remain unchanged, because the tax under section 507(c) has been abated
solely because the Commissioner has been given effective assurance that
there is vigorous enforcement of State laws sufficient to assure
implementation of the provisions of chapter 42. Therefore, in such a
case while chapter 42 will not apply to acts occurring subsequent to
termination which previously would have resulted in the imposition of
tax under chapter 42, it is contemplated that there will be vigorous
enforcement of State laws (including laws made applicable by the
provisions in the governing instrument) with respect to such acts.
Notwithstanding the preceding three sentences, no amendment to the
organization's governing instrument is necessary where there are
provisions of State law which have the effect of requiring a terminated
private foundation to which the rules of subparagraphs (1) through (5)
of this paragraph apply to be subject to such rules whether or not there
are such provisions in such terminated private foundation's governing
instrument.
[T.D. 7233, 37 FR 28161, Dec. 21, 1972]
Sec. 1.508-1 Notices.
(a) New organizations must notify the Commissioner that they are
applying for recognition of section 501(c)(3) status--(1) In general.
Except as provided in subparagraph (3) of this paragraph, an
organization that is organized after October 9, 1969, will not be
treated as described in section 501(c)(3):
(i) Unless such organization has given the Commissioner notice in
the manner prescribed in subparagraph (2) of this paragraph; or
(ii) For any period before the giving of such notice, unless such
notice is given in the manner and within the time prescribed in
subparagraph (2) of this paragraph
No organization shall be exempt from taxation under section 501(a) by
reason of being described in section 501(c)(3) whenever such
organization is not treated as described in section 501(c)(3) by reason
of section 508(a) and this paragraph. See section 508(d)(2)(B) and Sec.
1.508-2(b) regarding the deductibility of charitable contributions to an
organization during the period such organization is not exempt under
section 501(a) as an organization described in section 501(c)(3) by
reason of failing to file a notice under section 508(a) and this
subparagraph. See also Sec. 1.508-2(b)(1)(viii) regarding the
deductibility of charitable contributions to trusts described in section
4947(a)(1).
(2) Filing of notice. (i) For purposes of subparagraph (1) of this
paragraph, except as provided in subparagraph (3) of this paragraph, an
organization seeking exemption under section 501(c)(3) must file the
notice described in section 508(a) within 15 months from the end of the
month in which the organization was organized, or before March 22, 1973,
whichever comes later. Such notice is filed by submitting a properly
completed and executed Form 1023, exemption application. Notice should
be filed with the district director. A request for extension of time for
the filing of such notice should be submitted to such district director.
Such request may be granted if it demonstrates that additional time is
required.
(ii) Although the information required by Form 1023 must be
submitted to satisfy the notice required by this section, the failure to
supply, within the required time, all of the information required to
complete such form is not alone sufficient to deny exemption from the
date of organization to the date such complete information is submitted
by the organization. If the information which is submitted within the
required time is incomplete, and the organization supplies the necessary
additional information at the request of the Commissioner within the
additional time period allowed by him, the original notice will be
considered timely.
(iii) For purposes of subdivision (i) of this subparagraph and
paragraph (b)(2)(i) of this section, an organization shall be considered
organized on the date it becomes an organization described in section
501(c)(3) (determined without regard to section 508(a)).
[[Page 95]]
(iv) Since a trust described in section 4947(a)(2) is not an
organization described in section 501(c)(3), it is not required to file
a notice described in section 508(a).
(v) For the treatment of community trusts, and the trusts or funds
comprising them, under section 508, see the special rules under Sec.
1.170A-9(e).
(vi) A foreign organization shall, for purposes of section 508, be
treated in the same manner as a domestic organization, except that
section 508 shall not apply to a foreign organization which is described
in section 4948(b).
(3) Exceptions from notice. (i) Paragraphs (a) (1) and (2) of this
section are inapplicable to the following organizations:
(a) Churches, interchurch organizations of local units of a church,
conventions or associations of churches, or integrated auxiliaries of a
church. See Sec. 1.6033-2(h) regarding the definition of integrated
auxiliary of a church;
(b) Any organization which is not a private foundation (as defined
in section 509(a)) and the gross receipts of which in each taxable year
are normally not more than $5,000 (as described in subdivision (ii) of
this subparagraph);
(c) Subordinate organizations (other than private foundations)
covered by a group exemption letter;
(d) Solely for purposes of sections 507, 508(d)(1), 508(d)(2)(A) and
508(d)(3), 508(e), 509 and chapter 42, a trust described in section
4947(a)(1). (However, a trust described in section 501(c)(3) which was
organized after October 9, 1969, shall be exempt under section 501(a) by
reason of being described in section 501(c)(3) only if it files such
notice); and
(e) Any other class of organization that the Commissioner from time
to time excludes from the requirement of filing notice under section
508(a).
(ii) For purposes of subdivision (i) (b) of this subparagraph and
paragraph (b)(7)(ii) of this section, the gross receipts (as defined in
subdivision (iii) of this subparagraph) of an organization are normally
not more than $5,000 if:
(a) During the first taxable year of the organization the
organization has received gross receipts of $7,500 or less;
(b) During its first 2 taxable years the aggregate gross receipts
received by the organization are $12,000 or less; and
(c) In the case of an organization which has been in existence for
at least 3 taxable years, the aggregate gross receipts received by the
organization during the immediately preceding 2 taxable years, plus the
current year are $15,000 or less
If an organization fails to meet the requirements of (a), (b), or (c) of
this subdivision, then with respect to the organization, such
organization shall be required to file the notices described in section
508 (a) and (b) within 90 days after the end of the period described in
(a), (b), or (c) of this subdivision or before March 22, 1973, whichever
is later, in lieu of the period prescribed in subparagraph (2)(i) of
this paragraph. Thus, for example, if an organization meets the $7,500
requirement of (a) of this subdivision for its first taxable year, but
fails to meet the $12,000 requirement of (b) of this subdivision for the
period ending with its second taxable year, then such organization shall
meet the notification requirements of section 508(a)(1) and 508(b) and
subparagraph (2)(i) of this paragraph if it files such notification
within 90 days after the close of its second taxable year. If an
organization which has been in existence at least 3 taxable years meets
the requirements of (a), (b), and (c) with respect to all prior taxable
years, but fails to meet the requirements of (c) of this subdivision
with respect to the current taxable year, then even if the organization
fails to make such notification within 90 days after the close of the
current taxable year, section 508(a)(1) and 508(b) shall not apply with
respect to its prior years. In such a case, the organization shall not
be treated as described in section 501(c)(3) for a period beginning with
such current taxable year and ending when such notice is given under
section 508(a)(2).
(iii) For a definition of gross receipts for purposes of subdivision
(i)(b) of this subparagraph and paragraph (b)(7)(ii) of this section,
see Sec. 1.6033-2(g)(4).
[[Page 96]]
(4) Voluntary filings by new organizations excepted from filing
notice. Any organization excepted from the requirement of filing notice
under section 508(a) will be exempt from taxation under section
501(c)(3) if it meets the requirements of that section, whether or not
it files such notice. However, in order to establish its exemption with
the Internal Revenue Service and receive a ruling or determination
letter recognizing its exempt status, an organization excepted from the
notice requirement by reason of subparagraph (3) of this paragraph
should file proof of its exemption in the manner prescribed in Sec.
1.501(a)-1.
(b) Presumption that old and new organizations are private
foundations--(1) In general. Except as provided in subparagraph (7) of
this paragraph, any organization (including an organization in existence
on October 9, 1969) which is described in section 501(c)(3), and which
does not notify the Commissioner within the time and in the manner
prescribed in subparagraph (2) that it is not a private foundation, will
be presumed to be a private foundation.
(2) Filing of notice. (i) Except as provided in subparagraph (7) of
this paragraph, an organization must file the notice described in
section 508(b) and subparagraph (1) of this paragraph within 15 months
from the end of the month in which such organization was organized, or
before March 22, 1973, whichever comes later. See paragraph (a)(2)(iii)
of this section, for rules pertaining to when an organization is
organized.
(ii) Any organization filing notice under this paragraph that has
received a ruling or determination letter from the Internal Revenue
Service dated on or before July 13, 1970, recognizing its exemption from
taxation under section 501(c)(3) (or the corresponding provisions of
prior law), shall file the notice described in section 508(b) by
submitting a properly completed and executed Form 4653, Notification
Concerning Foundation Status.
(iii) The financial schedule on Form 4653 need be completed only if
the organization is, or thinks it might be, described in section
170(b)(1)(A) (iv) or (vi) or section 509(a)(2).
(iv) Any organization filing notice under this paragraph that has
not received a ruling or determination letter from the Internal Revenue
Service dated on or before July 13, 1970, recognizing its exemption from
taxation under section 501(c)(3) (or the corresponding provisions of
prior law), shall file its notice by submitting a properly completed and
executed Form 1023 and providing information that it is not a private
foundation. The organization shall also submit all information required
by the regulations under section 170 or 509 (whichever is applicable)
necessary to establish recognition of its classification as an
organization described in section 509(a) (1), (2), (3), or (4). A Form
1023 submitted prior to July 14, 1970, will satisfy this requirement if
the organization submits an additional statement that it is not a
private foundation together with all pertinent additional information
required. Any statement filed under this subdivision shall be
accompanied by a written declaration by the principal officer, manager
or authorized trustee that there is a reasonable basis in law and in
fact for the statement that the organization so filing is not a private
foundation, and that to the best of the knowledge and belief of such
officer, manager or trustee, the information submitted is complete and
correct.
(v) The notice filed under subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph
should be filed in accordance with the instructions applicable to Form
4653. The notice required by subdivision (iv) of this subparagraph
should be filed with the district director. An extension of time for the
filing of such notice may be granted by the Director of the Internal
Revenue Service Center or district director upon timely request by the
organization to such person, if the organization demonstrates that
additional time is required.
(3) Effect of notice upon the filing organization. (i) The notice
filed under this paragraph may not be relied upon by the organization so
filing unless and until the Internal Revenue Service notifies the
organization that it is an organization described in paragraph (1), (2),
(3), or (4), of section 509(a). For purposes of the preceding sentence,
an organization that has filed notice under
[[Page 97]]
section 508(b), and has previously received a ruling that it is an
organization described in section 170(b)(1)(A) (other than clauses (vii)
and (viii) thereof), will be considered to have been notified by the
Internal Revenue Service that it is an organization described in
paragraph (1) of section 509(a) if (a) the facts and circumstances
forming the basis for the issuance of such ruling have not substantially
changed, and (b) the ruling issued under that section has not been
revoked expressly or by a subsequent change of the law or regulations
under which the ruling was issued.
(ii) If an organization has filed a notice under section 508(b)
stating that it is not a private foundation and designating only one
paragraph of section 509(a) under which it claims recognition of its
classification (such as an organization described in section 509(a)(2)),
and if it has received a ruling or determination letter which recognizes
that it is not a private foundation but which fails to designate the
paragraph under section 509(a) in which it is described, then such
organization will be treated as described under the paragraph designated
by it, until such ruling or determination letter is modified or revoked.
The rule in the preceding sentence shall not apply to an organization
which indicated that it does not know its status under section 509(a) or
which claimed recognition of its status under more than one paragraph of
section 509(a).
(4) Effect of notice upon grantors or contributors to the filing
organization. In the case of grants, contributions, or distributions
made prior to:
(i) In the case of community trusts, 6 months after the date on
which corrective and clarifying regulations designated as Sec. 1.170A-
9(e)(10) become final;
(ii) In the case of medical research organizations, 6 months after
the date on which corrective and clarifying regulations designated as
Sec. 1.170A-9(b)(2), become final, and
(iii) In all other cases, January 1, 1976, any organization which
has properly filed the notice described in section 508(b) prior to March
22, 1973 will not be treated as a private foundation for purposes of
making any determination under the internal revenue laws with respect to
a grantor, contributor or distributor (as for example, a private
foundation distributing all of its net assets pursuant to a section
507(b)(1)(A) termination) thereto, unless the organization is controlled
directly or indirectly by such grantor, contributor or distributor, if
by the 30th day after the day on which such notice is filed, the
organization has not been notified by the Commissioner that the notice
filed by such organization has failed to establish that such
organization is not a private foundation. See subparagraph (6) of this
paragraph for the effect of an adverse notice by the Internal Revenue
Service. For purposes of this subparagraph, an organization which has
properly filed notice described in section 508(b) prior to March 22,
1973, and which has claimed recognition of its status under only one
paragraph of section 509(a) in such notice, will be treated only for
purposes of grantors, contributors or distributors as having the
classification claimed in the notice if the provisions of this
subparagraph are otherwise satisfied.
(5) Statement that old and new organizations are operating
foundations. (i) Any organization (including an organization in
existence on October 9, 1969) which is described in section 501(c)(3)
may submit a statement, in the form and manner provided for notice in
subparagraph (2) of this paragraph, that it is an operating foundation
(as defined in section 4942(j)(3)) and include in such statement:
(a) Necessary supporting information as required by the regulations
under section 4942(j)(3) to confirm such determination (including a
statement identifying the clause of section 4942(j)(3)(B) that is
applicable); and
(b) A written declaration by the principal officer, manager, or
authorized trustee that there is a reasonable basis in law and in fact
that the organization so filing is an operating foundation, and that to
the best of the knowledge and belief of such officer, manager or
trustee, the information submitted is complete and correct.
(ii) The statement filed under this subparagraph may not be relied
upon by the organization so filing unless and
[[Page 98]]
until the Internal Revenue Service notifies the organization that it is
an operating foundation described in section 4942(j)(3).
(iii) In the case of grants, contributions, or distributions made
prior to March 22, 1973, any organization which has properly filed the
statement described in this subparagraph prior to such date will be
treated as an operating foundation for purposes of making any
determination under the internal revenue laws with respect to a grantor,
contributor, or distributor thereto, unless the organization is
controlled directly or indirectly by such grantor, contributor, or
distributor, if by the 30th day after the day on which such statement is
filed, the organization has not been notified by the Commissioner or his
delegate that its statement has failed to establish that such
organization is an operating foundation. See subparagraph (6) of this
paragraph for the effect of an adverse notice by the Internal Revenue
Service.
(6) Effect of notice by Internal Revenue Service concerning
organization's notice or statement. Subparagraph (4) and subdivision
(iii) of subparagrph (5) of this paragraph shall have no effect:
(i) With respect to a grantor, contributor, or distributor to any
organization for any period after the date on which the Internal Revenue
Service makes notice to the public (such as by publication in the
Internal Revenue Bulletin) that a grantor, contributor, or distributor
to such organization can no longer rely upon the notice or statement
submitted by such organization; and
(ii) Upon any grant, contribution, or distribution made to an
organization on or after the date on which a grantor, contributor, or
distributor acquired knowledge that the Internal Revenue Service has
given notice to such organization that its notice or statement has
failed to establish that such organization either is not a private
foundation, or is an operating foundation, as the case may be.
(7) Exceptions from notice. Subparagraphs (1) and (2) of this
paragraph are inapplicable to the following organizations:
(i) Churches, interchurch organizations of local units of a church,
conventions or associations of churches, or integrated auxiliaries of a
church, such as a men's or women's organization, religious school,
mission society, or youth group;
(ii) Any organization which is not a private foundation (as defined
in section 509(a)) and the gross receipts of which in each taxable year
are normally not more than $5,000 (as determined under paragraph
(a)(3)(ii) of this section);
(iii) Subordinate organizations (other than private foundations)
covered by a group exemption letter but only if the parent or
supervisory organization submits a notice covering the subordinates;
(iv) Trusts described in section 4947(a)(1); and
(v) Any other class of organization that the Commissioner from time
to time excludes from the notification requirements of section 508(b).
(8) Voluntary filings by organizations excepted from filing notice.
Any organization excepted from the requirement of filing notice under
section 508(b) by reason of subdivisions (i), (ii), and (v) of
subparagraph (7) of this paragraph may receive the benefits of
subparagraph (4) of this paragraph by filing such notice.
(Secs. 508 and 7805 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1954 (68A Stat. 917;
26 U.S.C. 7805))
[T.D. 7232, 37 FR 28289, Dec. 22, 1972, as amended by T.D. 7342, 40 FR
1237, Jan. 7, 1975; T.D. 7395, 41 FR 1063, Jan. 6, 1976; T.D. 8640, 60
FR 65552, Dec. 20, 1995]
Sec. 1.508-2 Disallowance of certain charitable, etc., deductions.
(a) Gift or bequest to organizations subject to section 507(c) tax--
(1) General rule. No gift or bequest made to an organization upon which
the tax provided by section 507(c) has been imposed shall be allowed as
a deduction under section 170, 545(b)(2), 556(b)(2), 642(c), 2055,
2106(a)(2), or 2522, if such gift or bequest is made:
(i) By any person after notification has been made by the
organization under section 507(a)(1) or after notification has been made
by the Commissioner under section 507(a)(2)(B), or
(ii) By a substantial contributor (as defined in section 507(d)(2))
in his taxable year which includes the first day
[[Page 99]]
on which action is taken by such organization which culminates in the
imposition of tax under section 507(c) and any subsequent taxable year
For purposes of subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph, the first day on
which action is taken by an organization which culminates in the
imposition of tax under section 507(c) shall be determined under the
rules set forth in Sec. 1.507-7(b) (1) and (2).
(2) Exception. Subparagraph (1) of this paragraph shall not apply if
the entire amount of the unpaid portion of the tax imposed by section
507(c) is abated by the Commissioner under section 507(g).
(b) Gift or bequest to taxable private foundation, section 4947
trust, etc.--(1) General rule. (i) Except as provided in subparagraph
(2) of this paragraph, no gift or bequest made to an organization shall
be allowed as a deduction under section 170, 545(b)(2), 556(b)(2),
642(c), 2055, 2106(a)(2), or 2522, if such gift or bequest is made:
(a) To a private foundation or a trust described in section
4947(a)(2) in a taxable year for which it fails to meet the requirements
of section 508(e) (determined without regard to section 508(e)(2) (B)
and (C), or
(b) To any organization in a period for which it is not treated as
an organization described in section 501(c)(3) by reason of section
508(a).
(ii) For purposes of subdivision (i)(a) of this subparagraph the
term taxable year refers to the taxable year of the donee or beneficiary
organization. In the event a bequest is made to a private foundation or
trust described in section 4947(a)(2) which is not in existence at the
date of the testator's death (but which is created under the terms of
the testator's will), the term taxable year shall mean the first taxable
year of the private foundation or trust.
(iii) For purposes of subdivision (i)(a) of this subparagraph, an
organization does not fail to meet the requirements of section 508(e)
for a taxable year, unless it fails to meet such requirements for the
entire year. Therefore, even if a donee organization fails to meet the
requirements of section 508(e) on the date it receives a grant from a
donor, the donor's grant will not be disallowed by operation of section
508(d)(2)(A) and subdivision (i)(a) of this subparagraph, if the
organization meets the requirements of section 508(e) (determined
without regard to section 508(e)(2) (B) or (C) ) by the end of its
taxable year.
(iv) No deduction will be disallowed under section 508(d)(2)(A) with
respect to a deduction under section 170, 545(b)(2), 556(b)(2), 642(c),
2055, 2106(a)(2), or 2522 if during the taxable year in question, the
private foundation or trust described in section 4947(a)(2) has
instituted a judicial proceeding which is necessary to reform its
governing instrument or other instrument in order to meet the
requirements of section 508(e)(1). This subdivision shall not apply
unless within a reasonable time such judicial proceedings succeed in so
reforming such instrument.
(v) No deduction will be disallowed under section 508(d)(2)(A) and
subdivision (i)(a) of this subparagraph for any taxable year beginning
before January 1, 1972, with respect to a private foundation or trust
described in section 4947 organized before January 1, 1970. See also
Sec. 1.508-3(g) regarding transitional rules for extending compliance
with section 508(e)(1).
(vi)(a) In the case of a contribution or bequest to a trust
described in section 4947(a)(2) other than to a trust to which
subdivision (vii) of this subparagraph applies, no deduction shall be
disallowed by reason of section 508(d)(2)(A) on the grounds that such
trust's governing instrument contains no provisions with respect to
section 4942. Similarly, if for a taxable year such trust is also a
trust described in section 4947(b)(3), no deduction for such year shall
be so disallowed on the grounds that the governing instrument contains
no provision with respect to section 4943 or 4944.
(b) This subdivision may be illustrated by the following example:
Example. H executes a will on January 1, 1977, establishing a
charitable remainder trust (as described in section 664) with income
payable to W, his wife, for life, remainder to X university, an
organization described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(ii). The will provides
that the trust is prohibited from engaging in activities which would
subject itself, its foundation manager or a disqualified person to taxes
under section 4941 or 4945 of the Code. The will is silent as to
sections 4942, 4943, and 4944. H dies February 12, 1978.
[[Page 100]]
Section 508(d)(2)(A) will not operate to disallow any deduction to H's
estate under section 2055 with respect to such trust.
(vii)(a) In the case of a trust described in section 4947(a)(2)
which by its terms will become a trust described in section 4947(a)(1)
and the governing instrument of which is executed after March 22, 1973,
the governing instrument shall not meet the requirements of section
508(e)(1) if it does not contain provisions to the effect that the trust
must comply with the provisions of section 4942, or sections 4942, 4943,
and 4944 (as the case may be) to the extent such section or sections
shall become applicable to such trust.
(b) This subdivision may be illustrated by the following example:
Example. H executes a will on January 1, 1977, establishing a
charitable remainder trust (as described in section 664) with income
payable to W, his wife, for life, remainder in trust in perpetuity for
the benefit of an organization described in section 170(c). By its terms
the trust will become a trust described in section 4947(a)(1), and will
become a private foundation. The will provides that the trust is
prohibited from engaging in activities which would subject itself, its
foundation manager or a disqualified person to taxes under sections 4941
or 4945 of the Code. The will is silent as to sections 4942, 4943, and
4944. H dies February 12, 1978. Unless the trust's governing instrument
is amended prior to the end of the trust's first taxable year, or
judicial proceedings have been instituted under subdivision (iv) of this
subparagraph, section 508(d)(2)(A) will operate to disallow any
deduction to H's estate under section 2055 with respect to such trust.
(viii) Since a charitable trust described in section 4947(a)(1) is
not required to file a notice under section 508(a), section 508(d)(2)(B)
and subdivision (i)(b) of this subparagraph are not applicable to such a
trust.
(2) Transitional rules. Any deduction which would otherwise be
allowable under section 642(c)(2), 2106(a)(2), or 2055 shall not be
disallowed under section 508(d)(2)(A) if such deduction is attributable
to:
(i) Property passing under the terms of a will executed on or before
October 9, 1969,
(a) If the decedent dies after October 9, 1969, but before October
9, 1972, without having amended any dispositive provision of the will
after October 9, 1969, by codicil or otherwise,
(b) If the decedent dies after October 9, 1969, and at no time after
that date had the right to change the portions of the will which
pertains to the passing of property to, or for the use of, an
organization described in section 170(c)(2)(B) or 2055(a), or
(c) If no dispositive provision of the will is amended by the
decedent, by codicil or otherwise, before October 9, 1972, and the
decedent is on October 9, 1972, and at all times thereafter under a
mental disability (as defined in Sec. 1.642(c)-2(b)(3)(ii)) to amend
the will by codicil or otherwise, or
(ii) Property transferred in trust on or before October 9, 1969,
(a) If the grantor dies after October 9, 1969, but before October 9,
1972, without having amended, after October 9, 1969, any dispositive
provision of the instrument governing the disposition of the property,
(b) If the property transferred was an irrevocable interest to, or
for the use of, an organization described in section 170(c)(2)(B) or
2055(a),
(c) In the case of a deduction under section 2106(a)(2) or 2055; if
no dispositive provision of the instrument governing the disposition of
the property is amended by the grantor before October 9, 1972, and the
grantor is on October 9, 1972, and at all times thereafter under a
mental disability (as defined in Sec. 1.642(c)-2(b)(3)(ii)) to change
the disposition of the property, or
(d) In the case of a deduction under section 642(c)(2)(A), if the
grantor is at all times after October 9, 1969, and up to, and including,
the last day of the taxable year for which the deduction under such
section is claimed, under a mental disability (as defined in Sec.
1.642(c)-2(b)(3)(ii)) to change the terms of the trust
See also Sec. 1.508-3(g) regarding the extension of time for compliance
with section 508(e), Sec. 1.664-1(f)(3) (ii) and (g) regarding the
special transitional rules for charitable remainder annuity and
unitrusts described in section 664 which were created prior to December
31, 1972, and Sec. 20.2055-2(e)(4) of this chapter regarding the rules
for determining if the dispositive provisions have been amended.
[T.D. 7232, 37 FR 28291, Dec. 22, 1972]
[[Page 101]]
Sec. 1.508-3 Governing instruments.
(a) General rule. A private foundation shall not be exempt from
taxation under section 501(a) for a taxable year unless by the end of
such taxable year its governing instrument includes provisions the
effects of which are:
(1) To require distributions at such times and in such manner as not
to subject the foundation to tax under section 4942, and
(2) To prohibit the foundation from engaging in any act of self-
dealing (as defined in section 4941(d)), from retaining any excess
business holdings (as defined in section 4943(c)), from making any
investments in such manner as to subject the foundation to tax under
section 4944, and from making any taxable expenditures (as defined in
section 4945(d)).
(b) Effect and nature of governing instrument--(1) In general.
Except as provided in paragraph (d) of this section, the provisions of a
foundation's governing instrument must require or prohibit, as the case
may be, the foundation to act or refrain from acting so that the
foundation, and any foundation managers or other disqualified persons
with respect thereto, shall not be liable for any of the taxes imposed
by sections 4941, 4942, 4943, 4944, and 4945 of the Code or, in the case
of a split-interest trust described in section 4947(a)(2), any of the
taxes imposed by those sections of chapter 42 made applicable under
section 4947. Specific reference to these sections of the Code will
generally be required to be included in the governing instrument, unless
equivalent language is used which is deemed by the Commissioner to have
the same full force and effect. However, a governing instrument which
contains only language sufficient to satisfy the requirements of the
organizational test under Sec. 1.501(c)(3)-1(b) will not be considered
as meeting the requirements of this subparagraph, regardless of the
interpretation placed on such language as a matter of law by a State
court in a particular jurisdiction, unless the requirements of paragraph
(d) of this section are satisfied.
(2) Corpus. A governing instrument does not meet the requirements of
paragraph (a)(1) of this section if it expressly prohibits the
distribution of capital or corpus.
(3) Savings provisions. For purposes of sections 508(d)(2) (A) and
(e), a governing instrument need not include any provision which is
inconsistent with section 101(l) (2), (3), (4), or (5) of the Tax Reform
Act of 1969 (83 Stat. 533), as amended by sections 1301 and 1309 of the
Tax Reform Act of 1976 (90 Stat. 1713, 1729), with respect to the
organization. Accordingly, a governing instrument complying with the
requirements of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph may incorporate any
savings provision contained in section 101(l) (2), (3), (4), or (5) of
the Tax Reform Act of 1969, as amended by sections 1301 and 1309 of the
Tax Reform Act of 1976, as a specific exception to the general
provisions of paragraph (a) of this section. In addition, in the absence
of any express provisions to the contrary, the exceptions contained in
such savings provisions will generally be regarded as contained in a
governing instrument meeting the requirements of subparagraph (1) of
this paragraph.
(4) Excess holdings. For purposes of paragraph (a)(2) of this
section, the prohibition against retaining any excess business holdings
(as defined in section 4943(c)) shall be deemed only to prohibit the
foundation from retaining any excess business holdings when such
holdings would subject the foundation to tax under section 4943(a).
(5) Revoked ruling on status. In the case of an organization which:
(i) Has been classified as an organization described in section
509(a) (1), (2), (3), or (4), and
(ii) Subsequently receives a ruling or determination letter stating
that it is no longer described in section 509(a) (1), (2), (3), or (4),
but is a private foundation within the meaning of section 509,
such organization shall have 1 year from the date of receipt of such
ruling or determination letter, or the final ruling or determination
letter if a protest is filed to an earlier one, to meet the requirements
of section 508(e). Section 508(d)(2)(A) shall not be applicable with
respect to gifts and bequests made during this 1-year period if such
requirements are met within the 1-year period.
[[Page 102]]
(6) Judicial proceeding. For purposes of paragraphs (a), (b)(5),
(d)(2), and (e)(3) of this section, an organization shall be deemed to
have met the requirements of section 508(e) within a year, if a judicial
proceeding which is necessary to reform its governing instrument or
other instrument is instituted within the year and within a reasonable
time the organization, in fact, meets the requirements of section
508(e). For purposes only of paragraphs (b)(5), (d)(2), and (e)(3) of
this section, if an organization organized before January 1, 1970,
institutes such a judicial proceeding within such 1-year period, section
508 (e)(2)(C) shall be applied as if such proceeding had been instituted
prior to January 1, 1972.
(c) Meaning of governing instrument. For purposes of section 508(e),
the term governing instrument shall have the same meaning as the term
articles of organization under Sec. 1.501(c)(3)-1(b)(2). The bylaws of
an organization shall not constitute its governing instrument for
purposes of section 508(e).
(d) Effect of State law--(1) In general. A private foundation's
governing instrument shall be deemed to conform with the requirements of
paragraph (a) of this section if valid provisions of State law have been
enacted which:
(i) Require it to act or refrain from acting so as not to subject
the foundation to the taxes imposed by section 4941 (relating to taxes
on self-dealing), 4942 (relating to taxes on failure to distribute
income), 4943 (relating to taxes on excess business holdings), 4944
(relating to taxes on investments which jeopardize charitable purpose),
and 4945 (relating to taxable expenditures); or
(ii) Treat the required provisions as contained in the foundation's
governing instrument.
(2) Validity. (i) Any provision of State law described in
subparagraph (1) of this paragraph shall be presumed valid as enacted,
and in the absence of State provisions to the contrary, to apply with
respect to any foundation that does not specifically disclaim coverage
under State law (either by notification to the appropriate State
official or by commencement of judicial proceedings) except as provided
in subdivisions (ii) and (iii) of this subparagraph.
(ii) If such provision is declared invalid or inapplicable with
respect to a class of foundations by the highest appellate court of the
State or by the Supreme Court of the United States, the foundations
covered by the determination must meet the requirements of section
508(e) within 1 year from the date on which the time for perfecting an
application for review by the Supreme Court expires. If such application
is filed, the requirements of section 508(e) must be met within a year
from the date on which the Supreme Court disposes of the case, whether
by denial of the application for review or decision on the merits.
(iii) In addition, if such provision of State law is declared
invalid or inapplicable with respect to a class of foundations by any
court of competent jurisdiction which decision is not reviewed by a
court referred to in subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph, and the
Commissioner makes notice to the general public (such as by publication
in the Internal Revenue Bulletin) that such provision has been so
declared invalid or inapplicable, then all foundations in such State
must meet the requirements of section 508(e), without reliance upon such
statute to the extent declared invalid or inapplicable by such decision,
within 1 year from the date such notice is made public.
(iv) This subparagraph shall not apply to any foundation that is
subject to a final judgment entered by a court of competent
jurisdiction, holding the law invalid or inapplicable with respect to
such foundation. See paragraph (b)(6) of this section for the effect of
certain judicial proceedings that are brought within 1 year.
(3) Conflicting instrument. For taxable years beginning after March
22, 1973 in order for a private foundation or trust described in section
4947(a)(2) to receive the benefit of coverage under any State statute
which makes applicable the requirements of section 508(e)(1) (A) and
(B), where the statute by its terms does not apply to a governing
instrument which contains a mandatory direction conflicting with any of
such requirements, such organization must indicate on its annual return
required
[[Page 103]]
to be filed under section 6033 (or section 6012 in the case of a trust
described in section 4947(a)) that its governing instrument contains no
mandatory directions which conflict with the requirements of section
508(e)(1) (A) or (B), as incorporated by the State statute. General
language in a governing instrument empowering the trustee to make
investments without being limited to those investments authorized by law
will not be regarded as a mandatory conflicting direction.
(4) Exclusion from statute. (i) For any taxable year beginning after
March 22, 1973 in the case of a private foundation or trust described in
section 4947(a)(2) subject to a State statute which makes applicable the
requirements of section 508(e)(1) (A) and (B) to the governing
instruments of such organizations, other than those which take action to
be excluded therefrom (such as by filing a notice of exclusion or by
instituting appropriate judicial proceedings), an organization will
receive the benefit of such State statute only if it indicates on its
annual return required to be filed under section 6033 (or section 6012
in the case of a trust described in section 4947(a)) that it has not so
taken action to be excluded.
(ii) This paragraph permits certain organizations that are subject
to the provisions of such a State law, to avoid changing their governing
instruments in order to meet the requirements of section 508(e)(1).
Since an organization which avoids the application of a provision or
provisions of State law, such as by filing a notice of exclusion, is not
entitled to the benefits of this paragraph, such an organization must
meet the requirements of section 508(e)(1) without regard to this
paragraph and except as provided in section 508(e)(2)(C) or paragraph
(g)(1)(iii) of this section must change its governing instrument to the
extent inconsistent with section 508(e)(1).
(5) Treatment of prevailing conflicting clause. If provisions of
State law are inapplicable to a clause in a governing instrument which
is contrary to the provisions of section 508(e)(1), the requirements of
section 508(e)(2)(C) and paragraph (g)(1)(iii) of this section are not
satisfied by a provision of State law which purports to eliminate the
need for litigation under such circumstances. Therefore, except as
otherwise provided in this section unless the governing instrument is
changed or litigation is commenced pursuant to section 508(e)(2)(B) by
an organization organized before January 1, 1970, or pursuant to
paragraph (g)(1)(ii) of this section, to amend the nonconforming
provision to meet the requirements of section 508(e)(1) (A) and (B),
then pursuant to section 508(e), such organization will not be exempt
from taxation.
(6) Retroactive application to grants or bequests. If valid
provisions of such a State law apply retroactively to a taxable year
within which an organization has received a grant or request, section
508(d)(2)(A) shall not apply so as to disallow such grant or bequest,
but only if such valid provisions of State law are enacted within 2
years of such grant or bequest.
(e) Effect of section 508(e) upon section 4947 trusts--(1) Section
4947(a)(1) trusts. A charitable trust described in section 4947(a)(1)
(unless also described in a paragraph of section 509(a)) is subject to
all the provisions of paragraph (a) of this section.
(2) Section 4947(a)(2) trusts. A split-interest trust described in
section 4947(a)(2), as long as it is so described, is subject to the
provisions of paragraph (a)(2) of this section, except to the extent
that section 4947 makes any such provisions inapplicable to certain
trusts and certain amounts in trust. The governing instrument of a trust
described in section 4947(a)(2) may except amounts described in section
4947(a)(2) (A), (B), and (C) from the requirements of paragraph (a)(2)
of this section. In the case of a trust having amounts transferred to it
both before May 27, 1969, and after May 26, 1969, its governing
instrument may except from the provisions of paragraph (a)(2) of this
section only those segregated amounts excluded from the application of
section 4947(a)(2) by reason of section 4947(a)(2)(C) and the
regulations thereunder. Also, the governing instrument of such a trust
may exclude the application of sections 4943 and 4944 for any period
during which such trust is described in section 4947(b)(3) (A) or (B).
See Sec. 53.4947-1(c) of this chapter for rules relating to the
applicability of
[[Page 104]]
section 4947 to split-interest trusts and Sec. 1.508-2(b)(1) (vi) and
(vii) for rules relating to the deductibility of grants or bequests to
such trusts.
(3) A section 4947(a)(2) trust becoming a section 4947(a)(1) trust.
If the governing instrument of a trust described in section 4947(a)(2)
meets the applicable requirements of paragraph (a)(2) of this section
and such trust ceases to be so described and becomes instead a trust
described in section 4947(a)(1), then such governing instrument must
meet, prior to the end of 12 months from the date such trust first
becomes described in section 4947(a)(1) (except as otherwise provided in
this section) all the requirements of paragraph (a) of this section in
order to comply with section 508(e).
(f) Special rules for existing private foundations. (1) Pursuant to
section 508(e)(2), section 508(e)(1) and paragraph (a) of this section
shall not apply in the case of any organization whose governing
instrument was executed before January 1, 1970:
(i) To any taxable year beginning before January 1, 1972;
(ii) To any period after December 31, 1971, during the pendency of
any judicial proceeding begun before January 1, 1972, by the private
foundation which is necessary to reform, or to excuse such foundation
from compliance with, its governing instrument or any other instrument
in order to meet the requirements of section 508(e)(1); and
(iii) To any period after the termination of any judicial proceeding
described in subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph during which its
governing instrument or any other instrument does not permit it to meet
the requirements of section 508(e)(1).
(2) For purposes of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph, and Sec.
1.508-2(b)(1)(vi)(a), a governing instrument will not be treated as
executed before the applicable date, if, after such date the dispositive
provisions of the instrument are amended (determined under rules similar
to the rules set forth in Sec. 20.2055-2(e)(4) of this chapter).
(3) For purposes of subparagraph (1) (ii) and (iii) of this
paragraph, a private foundation will be treated as meeting the
requirements of section 508(e)(2) (B) and (C) if it has commenced a
necessary and timely proceeding in an appropriate court of original
jurisdiction and such court has ruled that the foundation's governing
instrument or any other instrument does not permit it to meet the
requirements of section 508(e)(1). Such foundation is not required to
commence proceedings in any court of appellate jurisdiction in order to
comply with section 508(e)(2)(C). See also Sec. 1.508-2(b)(2).
(g) Extension of time for compliance with section 508(e). (1) Except
as provided in subparagraph (2) of this paragraph, section 508(e)(1)
shall not apply to any private foundation (regardless of when organized)
with respect:
(i) To any taxable year beginning before the transitional date,
(ii) To any period on or after the transitional date during the
pendency of any judicial proceeding begun before the transitional date
by the private foundation which is necessary to reform, or to excuse
such foundation from compliance with, its governing instrument or any
other instrument in order to meet the requirements of section 508(e)(1),
and
(iii) To any period after the termination of any judicial proceeding
described in subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph during which its
governing instrument or any other instrument does not permit it to meet
the requirements of section 508(e)(1).
(2) Subparagraph (1) of this paragraph shall apply only to gifts or
bequests referred to in section 508(d)(2)(A) that are made before the
transitional date.
(3) For purposes of this paragraph the term transitional dates means
the earlier of the following dates:
(i) In the case of a medical research organization, May 21, 1976 or
in the case of a community trust February 10, 1977, or
(ii) The 91st day after the date an organization receives a final
ruling or determination letter that it is a private foundation under
section 509(a).
[T.D. 7232, 37 FR 28292, Dec. 22, 1972, as amended by T.D. 7440, 41 FR
50656, Nov. 17, 1976; T.D. 7678, 45 FR 12415, Feb. 26, 1980]
[[Page 105]]
Sec. 1.508-4 Effective date.
Except as otherwise provided, Sec. Sec. 1.508-1 through 1.508-3
shall take effect on January 1, 1970.
(Sec. 7805 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1954, 68A Stat. 917; 26
U.S.C. 7805)
[T.D. 7232, 37 FR 28294, Dec. 22, 1972]
Sec. 1.509(a)-1 Definition of private foundation.
In general. Section 509(a) defines the term private foundation to
mean any domestic or foreign organization described in section 501(c)(3)
other than an organization described in section 509(a) (1), (2), (3), or
(4). Organizations which fall into the categories excluded from the
definition of private foundation are generally those which either have
broad public support or actively function in a supporting relationship
to such organizations. Organizations which test for public safety are
also excluded.
[T.D. 7212, 37 FR 21907, Oct. 17, 1972]
Sec. 1.509(a)-2 Exclusion for certain organizations described in
section 170(b)(1)(A).
(a) General rule. Organizations described in section 170(b)(1)(A)
(other than in clauses (vii) and (viii)) are excluded from the
definition of private foundation by section 509(a)(1). For the
requirements to be met by organizations described in section
170(b)(1)(A) (i) through (vi), see Sec. 1.170A-9 (a) through (e) and
paragraph (b) of this section. For purposes of this section, the
parenthetical language other than in clauses (vii) and (viii) used in
section 509(a)(1) means other than an organization which is described
only in clause (vii) or (viii). For purposes of this section, an
organization may qualify as a section 509(a)(1) organization regardless
of the fact that it does not satisfy section 170(c)(2) because:
(1) Its funds are not used within the United States or its
possessions, or
(2) It was created or organized other than in, or under the law of,
the United States, any State or territory, the District of Columbia, or
any possession of the United States.
(b) Medical research organizations. In order to qualify under
section 509(a)(1) as a medical research organization described in
section 170(b)(1)(A)(iii), an organization must meet the requirements of
section 170(b)(1)(A)(iii) and Sec. 1.170A-9(c)(2), except that, solely
for purposes of classification as a section 509(a)(1) organization, such
organization need not be committed to spend every contribution for
medical research before January 1 of the fifth calendar year which
begins after the date such contribution is made.
[T.D. 7212, 37 FR 21907, Oct. 17, 1972]
Sec. 1.509(a)-3 Broadly, publicly supported organizations.
(a) In general--(1) General rule. Section 509(a)(2) excludes certain
types of broadly, publicly supported organizations from private
foundation status. An organization will be excluded under section
509(a)(2) if it meets the one-third support test under section
509(a)(2)(A) and the not-more-than-one-third support test under section
509(a)(2)(B).
(2) One-third support test. An organization will meet the one-third
support test if it normally (within the meaning of paragraph (c) or
paragraph (d) of this section) receives from permitted sources more than
one-third of its support in each taxable year from any combination of--
(i) Gifts, grants, contributions, or membership fees; and
(ii) Gross receipts from admissions, sales of merchandise,
performance of services, or furnishing of facilities, in an activity
that is not an unrelated trade or business (within the meaning of
section 513), subject to certain limitations described in paragraph (b)
of this section. For purposes of this section, governmental units,
organizations described in section 509(a)(1), and persons other than
disqualified persons with respect to the organization shall be referred
to as permitted sources. For purposes of this section, the amount of
support received from the sources described in paragraph (a)(2)(i) of
this section and this paragraph (a)(2)(ii) (subject to the limitations
referred to in this paragraph (a)(2)) will be referred to as the
numerator of the one-third support fraction, and the total amount of
support received (as defined in section 509(d)) will be referred to as
the denominator of the one-third support
[[Page 106]]
fraction. Section 1.509(a)-3(f) distinguishes gifts and contributions
from gross receipts; Sec. 1.509(a)-3(g) distinguishes grants from gross
receipts; Sec. 1.509(a)-3(h) defines membership fees; Sec. 1.509(a)-
3(i) defines ``any bureau or similar agency of a governmental unit'';
Sec. 1.509(a)-3(j) describes the treatment of certain indirect forms of
support; paragraph (k) of this section describes the method of
accounting for support; Sec. 1.509(a)-3(l) describes the treatment of
gross receipts from section 513(a)(1), section 513(a)(2), or section
513(a)(3) activities; Sec. 1.509(a)-3(m) distinguishes gross receipts
from gross investment income; and Sec. 1.509(a)-3(n) describes
transition rules for organizations that received advance rulings that
expire on or after June 9, 2008.
(3) Not-more-than-one-third support test--(i) In general. An
organization will meet the not-more-than-one-third support test under
section 509(a)(2)(B) if it normally (within the meaning of paragraph (c)
or (d) of this section) receives not more than one-third of its support
in each taxable year from the sum of its gross investment income (as
defined in section 509(e)) and the excess (if any) of the amount of its
unrelated business taxable income (as defined in section 512) derived
from trades or businesses that were acquired by the organization after
June 30, 1975, over the amount of tax imposed on such income by section
511. For purposes of this section the amount of support received from
items described in section 509(a)(2)(B) will be referred to as the
numerator of the not-more-than-one-third support fraction, and the total
amount of support (as defined in section 509(d)) will be referred to as
the denominator of the not-more-than-one-third support fraction. For
purposes of section 509(a)(2), paragraph (m) of this section
distinguishes gross receipts from gross investment income. For purposes
of section 509(e), gross investment income includes the items of
investment income described in Sec. 1.512(b)-1(a).
(ii) Trade or business. For purposes of section 509(a)(2)(B)(ii), a
trade or business acquired after June 30, 1975, by an organization shall
include, in addition to other trades or businesses:
(A) A trade or business acquired after such date from, or as a
result of the liquidation of, an organization's subsidiary which is
described in section 502 whether or not the subsidiary was held on June
30, 1975.
(B) A new trade or business commenced by an organization after such
date.
(iii) Allocation of deductions between businesses acquired before,
and businesses acquired after, June 30, 1975. Deductions which are
allowable under section 512 but are not directly connected to a
particular trade or business, such as deductions referred to in
paragraphs (10) and (12) of section 512(b), shall be allocated in the
proportion that the unrelated trade or business taxable income derived
from trades or businesses acquired after June 30, 1975, bears to the
organization's total unrelated business taxable income, both amounts
being determined without regard to such deductions.
(iv) Allocation of tax. The tax imposed by section 511 shall be
allocated in the same proportion as in paragraph (a)(3)(iii) of this
section.
(4) Purposes. The one-third support test and the not-more-than-one-
third support test are designed to insure that an organization which is
excluded from private foundation status under section 509(a)(2) is
responsive to the general public, rather than to the private interests
of a limited number of donors or other persons.
(b) Limitation on gross receipts--(1) General rule. In computing the
amount of support received from gross receipts under section
509(a)(2)(A)(ii) for purposes of the one-third support test of section
509(a)(2)(A), gross receipts from related activities received from any
person, or from any bureau or similar agency of a governmental unit, are
includible in any taxable year only to the extent that such receipts do
not exceed the greater of $5,000 or 1 percent of the organization's
support in such taxable year.
(2) Examples. The application of this paragraph may be illustrated
by the examples set forth below. For purposes of these examples, the
term general public is defined as persons other than disqualified
persons and other than persons from whom the foundation receives gross
receipts in excess of the
[[Page 107]]
greater of $5,000 or 1 percent of its support in any taxable year, and
the term gross receipts is limited to receipts from activities which are
not unrelated trade or business (within the meaning of section 513).
Example 1. For the taxable year 1970, X, an organization described
in section 501(c)(3), received support of $10,000 from the following
sources:
Bureau M (a governmental bureau from which X received gross $25,000
receipts for services rendered)............................
Bureau N (a governmental bureau from which X received gross 25,000
receipts for services rendered)............................
General public (gross receipts for services rendered)....... 20,000
Gross investment income..................................... 15,000
Contributions from individual substantial contributors 15,000
(defined as disqualified persons under section 4946(a)(2)).
-----------
Total support........................................... 100,000
Since the $25,000 received from each bureau amounts to more than the
greater of $5,000 or 1 percent of X's support for 1970 (1% of
$100,000=$1,000) under section 509(a)(2)(A)(ii), each amount is
includible in the numerator of the one-third support fraction only to
the extent of $5,000. Thus, for the taxable year 1970, X received
support from sources which are taken into account in meeting the one-
third support test of section 509(a)(2)(A) computed as follows:
Bureau M.................................................... $5,000
Bureau N.................................................... 5,000
General public.............................................. 20,000
-----------
Total................................................... 30,000
Therefore, in making the computations required under paragraph (c), (d),
or (e) of this section, only $30,000 is includible in the aggregate
numerator and $100,000 is includible in the aggregate denominator of the
support fraction.
Example 2. For the taxable year 1970, Y, an organization described
in section 501(c)(3), received support of $600,000 from the following
sources:
Bureau O (gross receipts for services rendered)............. $10,000
Bureau P (gross receipts for services rendered)............. 10,000
General public (gross receipts for services rendered)....... 150,000
General public (contributions).............................. 40,000
Gross investment income..................................... 150,000
Contributions from substantial contributors................. 240,000
-----------
Total support........................................... 600,000
Since the $10,000 received from each bureau amounts to more than the
greater of $5,000 or 1 percent of Y's support for 1970 (1% of
$600,000=$6,000), each amount is includible in the numerator of the one-
third support fraction only to the extent of $6,000. Thus, for the
taxable year 1970, Y received support from sources required to meet the
one-third support test of section 509(a)(2)(A) computed as follows:
Bureau O.................................................... $6,000
Bureau P.................................................... 6,000
General public (gross receipts)............................. 150,000
General public (contributions).............................. 40,000
-----------
Total................................................... 202,000
Therefore, in making the computations required under paragraph (c), (d),
or (e) of this section, $202,000 is includible in the aggregate
numerator and $600,000 is includible in the aggregate denominator of the
support fraction.
(c) Normally--(1) In general--(i) Definition. The support tests set
forth in section 509(a)(2) are to be computed on the basis of the nature
of the organization's normal sources of support. An organization will be
considered as ``normally'' receiving one third of its support from any
combination of gifts, grants, contributions, membership fees, and gross
receipts from permitted sources (subject to the limitations described in
Sec. 1.509(a)-3(b)) and not more than one third of its support from
items described in section 509(a)(2)(B) for a taxable year and the
taxable year immediately succeeding such year, if, for such taxable year
and the four taxable years immediately preceding such taxable year, the
aggregate amount of the support received during the applicable period
from gifts, grants, contributions, membership fees, and gross receipts
from permitted sources (subject to the limitations described in Sec.
1.509(a)-3(b)) is more than one third, and the aggregate amount of the
support received from items described in section 509(a)(2)(B) is not
more than one third, of the total support of the organization for such
five-year period. A publicly supported organization described under
section 509(a)(2) that has failed to meet either the one-third support
test of paragraph (a)(2) of this section or the not-more-than-one-third
support test of paragraph (a)(3) of this section for two consecutive
years will be treated as a private foundation as of the first day of the
second consecutive taxable year only for purposes of sections 507, 4940,
and 6033. Such an organization must file a Form 990-PF, ``Return of
Private Foundation or Section 4947(a)(1) Nonexempt Charitable Trust
Treated as a Private Foundation,'' and will be liable for the net
investment
[[Page 108]]
tax imposed by section 4940 and, if applicable, the private foundation
termination tax imposed by section 507(c), for that second consecutive
failed year. For the succeeding years, the organization will be treated
as a private foundation for all purposes.
(ii) First five years of an organization's existence. See paragraph
(d)(1) of this section for the definition of ``normally'' for
organizations in the first five years of their existence.
(2) Terminations under section 507(b)(1)(B). For the special rules
applicable to the term normally as applied to private foundations that
elect to terminate their private foundation status pursuant to the 60-
month procedure provided in section 507(b)(1)(B), see the regulations
under such section.
(3) Exclusion of unusual grants. For purposes of applying the tests
for support set forth in paragraphs (a)(2) and (a)(3) of this section,
one or more contributions may be excluded from the numerator of the one-
third support fraction and from the denominator of both the one-third
support and not-more-than-one-third support fractions only if such a
contribution meets the requirements of this paragraph (c)(3). The
exclusion provided by this paragraph (c)(3) is generally intended to
apply to substantial contributions and bequests from disinterested
parties, which contributions or bequests--
(i) Are attracted by reason of the publicly supported nature of the
organization;
(ii) Are unusual or unexpected with respect to the amount thereof;
and
(iii) Would by reason of their size, adversely affect the status of
the organization as normally meeting the one-third support test for any
of the applicable periods described in this paragraph (c) or paragraph
(d) of this section. In the case of a grant (as defined in Sec.
1.509(a)-3(g)) that meets the requirements of this paragraph (c)(3), if
the terms of the granting instrument require that the funds be paid to
the recipient organization over a period of years, the grant amounts may
be excluded for such year or years in which they would otherwise be
includible in computing support under the method of accounting on the
basis of which the organization regularly computes its income in keeping
its books under section 446. However, no item described in section
509(a)(2)(B) may be excluded under this paragraph (c)(3). The provisions
of this paragraph (c)(3) shall apply to exclude unusual grants made
during any of the applicable periods described in this paragraph (c) or
paragraph (d) of this section. See paragraph (c)(5) of this section as
to reliance by a grantee organization upon an unusual grant ruling under
this paragraph (c)(3).
(4) Determining factors. In determining whether a particular
contribution may be excluded under paragraph (c)(3) of this section, all
pertinent facts and circumstances will be taken into consideration. No
single factor will necessarily be determinative. Among the factors to be
considered are--
(i) Whether the contribution was made by any person (or persons
standing in a relationship to such person which is described in section
4946(a)(1)(C) through 4946(a)(1)(G)) who created the organization,
previously contributed a substantial part of its support or endowment,
or stood in a position of authority, such as a foundation manager
(within the meaning of section 4946(b)), with respect to the
organization. A contribution made by a person other than those persons
described in this paragraph (c)(4)(i) will ordinarily be given more
favorable consideration than a contribution made by a person described
in this paragraph (c)(4)(i);
(ii) Whether the contribution was a bequest or an inter vivos
transfer. A bequest will ordinarily be given more favorable
consideration than an inter vivos transfer;
(iii) Whether the contribution was in the form of cash, readily
marketable securities, or assets which further the exempt purposes of
the organization, such as a gift of a painting to a museum;
(iv) Except in the case of a new organization, whether, prior to the
receipt of the particular contribution, the organization has carried on
an actual program of public solicitation and exempt activities and has
been able to attract a significant amount of public support;
[[Page 109]]
(v) Whether the organization may reasonably be expected to attract a
significant amount of public support subsequent to the particular
contribution. In this connection, continued reliance on unusual grants
to fund an organization's current operating expenses (as opposed to
providing new endowment funds) may be evidence that the organization
cannot reasonably be expected to attract future support from the general
public;
(vi) Whether, prior to the year in which the particular contribution
was received, the organization met the one-third support test described
in paragraph (a)(2) of this section without the benefit of any
exclusions of unusual grants pursuant to paragraph (c)(3) of this
section;
(vii) Whether neither the contributor nor any person standing in a
relationship to such contributor which is described in section
4946(a)(1)(C) through 4946(a)(1)(G) continues directly or indirectly to
exercise control over the organization;
(viii) Whether the organization has a representative governing body
as described in Sec. 1.509(a)-3(d)(3)(i); and
(ix) Whether material restrictions or conditions (within the meaning
of Sec. 1.507-2(a)(7)) have been imposed by the transferor upon the
transferee in connection with such transfer.
(5) Grantors and contributors. Prior to the making of any grant or
contribution expected to meet the requirements for exclusion under
paragraph (c)(3) of this section, a potential grantee organization may
request a determination whether such grant or contribution may be so
excluded. Requests for such determination may be filed by the grantee
organization in the time and manner specified by revenue procedure or
other guidance published in the Internal Revenue Bulletin. The issuance
of such determination will be at the sole discretion of the
Commissioner. The organization must submit all information necessary to
make a determination of the applicability of paragraph (c)(3) of this
section, including all information relating to the factors described in
paragraph (c)(4) of this section. If a favorable determination is
issued, such determination may be relied upon by the grantor or
contributor of the particular contribution in question for purposes of
sections 170, 507, 545(b)(2), 642(c), 4942, 4945, 4966, 2055,
2106(a)(2), and 2522 and by the grantee organization for purposes of
paragraph (c)(3) of this section.
(6) Examples. The application of the principles set forth in this
paragraph is illustrated by the examples as follows. For purposes of
these examples, the term general public is defined as persons other than
disqualified persons and other than persons from whom the foundation
received gross receipts in excess of the greater of $5,000 or 1 percent
of its support in any taxable year, the term gross investment income is
as defined in section 509(e), and the term gross receipts is limited to
receipts from activities which are not unrelated trades or businesses
(within the meaning of section 513).
Example 1. (i) For the years 2008 through 2012, X, an organization
exempt under section 501(c)(3) that makes scholarship grants to needy
students of a particular city, received support from the following
sources:
2008:
Gross receipts (general public).......................... $35,000
Contributions (substantial contributors)................. 36,000
Gross investment income.................................. 29,000
----------
Total support........................................ 100,000
2009:
Gross receipts (general public).......................... 34,000
Contributions (substantial contributors)................. 35,000
Gross investment income.................................. 31,000
----------
Total support........................................ 100,000
2010:
Gross receipts (general public).......................... 35,000
Contributions (substantial contributors)................. 30,000
[[Page 110]]
Gross investment income.................................. 35,000
----------
Total support........................................ 100,000
2011:
Gross receipts (general public).......................... 33,000
Contributions (substantial contributors)................. 32,000
Gross investment income.................................. 35,000
----------
Total support........................................ 100,000
2012:
Gross receipts (general public).......................... 31,000
Contributions (substantial contributors)................. 39,000
Gross investment income.................................. 30,000
----------
Total support........................................ 100,000
(ii) In applying section 509(a)(2) to the taxable year 2012, on the
basis of paragraph (c)(1)(i) of this section, the total amount of
support from gross receipts from the general public ($168,000) for the
period 2008 through 2012, was more than one third, and the total amount
of support from gross investment income ($160,000) was less than one
third, of X's total support for the same period ($500,000). For the
taxable years 2012 and 2013, X is therefore considered normally to
receive more than one third of its support from the public sources
described in section 509(a)(2)(A) and less than one third of its support
from items described in section 509(a)(2)(B). The fact that X received
less than one third of its support from section 509(a)(2)(A) sources in
2012 and more than one third of its support from items described in
section 509(a)(2)(B) in 2011 does not affect its status because it
normally met the applicable tests over a five-year period.
Example 2. Assume the same facts as in Example 1 except that in
2012, X also received an unexpected bequest of $50,000 from A, an
elderly widow who was interested in encouraging the work of X, but had
no other relationship to it. Solely by reason of the bequest, A became a
disqualified person. X used the bequest to create five new scholarships.
Its operations otherwise remained the same. Under these circumstances,
if A's bequest is included in X's support calculation, X could not meet
the five-year support test because the total amount received from gross
receipts from the general public ($168,000) would not be more than one-
third of its total support for the five-year period ($550,000). Because
A is a disqualified person, her bequest cannot be included in the
numerator of the one-third support test under section 509(a)(2)(A).
However, based on the factors set forth in paragraph (c)(4) of this
section, A's bequest may be excluded as an unusual grant under paragraph
(c)(3) of this section. Therefore, X will be considered to have met the
support test for the taxable years 2012 and 2013.
Example 3. Y, an organization described in section 501(c)(3), was
created by A, the holder of all the common stock in M corporation; B,
A's wife; and C, A's business associate. The purpose of Y was to sponsor
and equip athletic teams for underprivileged children in the community.
Each of the three creators makes small cash contributions to Y. A, B,
and C have been active participants in the affairs of Y since its
creation. Y regularly raises small amounts of contributions through
fundraising drives and selling admission to some of the sponsored
sporting events. The operations of Y are carried out on a small scale,
usually being restricted to the sponsorship of two to four baseball
teams of underprivileged children. In 2009, M recapitalizes and creates
a first and second class of 6 percent nonvoting preferred stock, most of
which is held by A and B. In 2010, A contributes 49 percent of his
common stock in M to Y. A's contribution of M's common stock was
substantial and constitutes 90 percent of Y's total support for 2010. A
combination of the facts and circumstances described in paragraph (c)(4)
of this section preclude A's contribution of M's common stock in 2010
from being excluded as an unusual grant under paragraph (c)(3) of this
section for purposes of determining whether Y meets the one-third
support test under section 509(a)(2).
Example 4. (i) M is organized in 2009 to promote the appreciation of
ballet in a particular region of the United States. Its principal
activities consist of erecting a theater for the performance of ballet
and the organization and operation of a ballet company. M receives a
determination letter that it is an organization described in section
501(c)(3) and that it is a public charity described in section
509(a)(2). The governing body of M consists of nine prominent unrelated
citizens residing in the region who have either an expertise in ballet
or a strong interest in encouraging appreciation of the art form.
(ii) In 2010, Z, a private foundation, proposes to makes a grant of
$500,000 in cash to
[[Page 111]]
M to provide sufficient capital for M to commence its activities.
Although A, the creator of Z, is one of the nine members of M's
governing body, was one of M's original founders, and continues to lend
his prestige to M's activities and fund raising efforts, A does not,
directly or indirectly, exercise any control over M. M also receives a
significant amount of support from a number of smaller contributions and
pledges from other members of the general public. M charges admission to
the ballet performances to the general public.
(iii) Although the support received in 2010 will not impact M's
status as a public charity for its first five taxable years, it will be
relevant to the determination of whether M meets the one-third support
test under section 509(a)(2) for the 2014 taxable year, using the
computation period 2010 through 2014. Within the appropriate timeframe,
M may submit a request for a private letter ruling that the $500,000
contribution from Z qualifies as an unusual grant.
(iv) Under the above circumstances, even though A was a founder and
member of the governing body of M, M may exclude Z's contribution of
$500,000 in 2010 as an unusual grant under paragraph (c)(3) of this
section for purposes of determining whether M meets the one-third
support test under section 509(a)(2) for 2014.
Example 5. (i) Assume the same facts as Example 4(i) except that, in
addition, in 2013, B, a widow, passes away and bequeaths $4 million to
M. During 2009 through 2013, B made small contributions to M, none
exceeding $10,000 in any year. During 2009 through 2013, M received
approximately $450,000 from receipts for admissions and contributions
from the general public. At the time of B's death, no person standing in
a relationship to B described in section 4946(a)(1)(C) through
4946(a)(1)(G) was a member of M's governing body. B's bequest was in the
form of cash and readily marketable securities. The only condition
placed upon the bequest was that it be used by M to advance the art of
ballet.
(ii) Although the support received in 2013 will not impact M's
status as a public charity for its first five taxable years, it will be
relevant to the determination of whether M meets the one-third support
test under section 509(a)(2) for future years. Within the appropriate
timeframe, M may submit a request for a private letter ruling that the
$4 million bequest from B qualifies as an unusual grant.
(iii) Under the above circumstances, M may exclude B's bequest of $4
million in 2013 as an unusual grant under paragraph (c)(3) of this
section for purposes of determining whether M meets the one-third
support test under section 509(a)(2) for 2014 and subsequent years.
Example 6. (i) N is a research organization that was created by A in
2009 for the purpose of carrying on economic studies primarily through
persons receiving grants from N and engaging in the sale of economic
publications. N received a determination letter that it is described in
section 501(c)(3) and that it is a public charity described in
509(a)(2). N's five-member governing body consists of A; A's sons, B and
C; and two unrelated economists. In 2009, A made a contribution to N of
$100,000 to help establish the organization. During 2009 through 2013, A
made annual contributions to N averaging $20,000 a year. During the same
period, N received annual contributions from members of the general
public averaging $15,000 per year and receipts from the sale of its
publications averaging $50,000 per year. In 2013, B made an inter vivos
contribution to N of $600,000 in cash and readily marketable securities.
(ii) Although the support received in 2013 will not impact N's
status as a public charity for its first five taxable years, it will be
relevant to the determination of whether N meets the one-third support
test under section 509(a)(2) for future years. In determining whether
B's contribution of $600,000 in 2013 may be excluded as an unusual
grant, the support N received in 2009 through 2013 is relevant in
considering the factor described in paragraph (c)(4)(vi) of this
section, notwithstanding that N received a determination letter that it
is described in section 509(a)(2).
(iii) Under the above circumstances, in particular the facts that B
is a disqualified person described in section 4946(a)(1)(D) and N does
not have a representative governing body as described in paragraphs
(c)(4)(viii) and (d)(3)(i) of this section, N cannot exclude B's
contribution of $600,000 in 2013 as an unusual grant under paragraph
(c)(3) of this section for purposes of determining whether N meets the
one-third support test under section 509(a)(2) for 2014 and future
years.
Example 7. (i) O is an educational organization created in 2009. O
received a determination letter that it is described in section
501(c)(3) and that it is a public charity described in section
509(a)(2). The governing body of O has 9 members, consisting of A, a
prominent civic leader, and 8 other unrelated civic leaders and
educators in the community, all of whom participated in the creation of
O. During 2009 through 2013, the principal source of income for O has
been receipts from the sale of its educational periodicals. These sales
have amounted to $200,000 for this period. Small contributions amounting
to $50,000 have also been received during the same period from members
of the governing body, including A, as well as other members of the
general public.
(ii) In 2013, A contributed $750,000 of the nonvoting stock of S, a
closely held corporation, to O. A retained a substantial portion of the
voting stock of S. By a majority vote, the governing body of O decided
to retain the S stock for a period of at least five years.
[[Page 112]]
(iii) Although the support received in 2013 will not impact O's
status as a public charity for its first five taxable years, it will be
relevant to the determination of whether O meets the one-third support
test under section 509(a)(2) for future years. In determining whether
A's contribution of the S stock in 2013 may be excluded as an unusual
grant, the support O received in 2009 through 2013 is relevant in
considering the factor described in paragraph (c)(4)(vi) of this
section, notwithstanding that O received a determination letter that it
is described in section 509(a)(2).
(iv) Under the above circumstances, in particular the facts that A
is a foundation manager within the meaning of section 4946(b) and A's
contribution is in the form of closely held stock, O cannot exclude A's
contribution of the S stock in 2013 as an unusual grant under paragraph
(c)(3) of this section for purposes of determining whether O meets the
one-third support test under section 509(a)(2) for 2014 and future
years.
(d) Definition of normally; first five years of an organization's
existence--(1) In general. An organization will ``normally'' meet the
one-third support test and the not-more-than-one-third support test
during its first five taxable years as a section 501(c)(3) organization
if the organization can reasonably be expected to meet the requirements
of the one-third support test and the not-more-than-one-third support
test during that period. With respect to an organization's sixth taxable
year, the general definition of normally in paragraph (c)(1) of this
section applies. Alternatively, the organization shall be treated as
normally meeting the one-third support test and the not-more-than-one-
third support test for its sixth taxable year (but not its seventh
taxable year) if it meets the one-third support test and the not-more-
than-one-third support test under the definition of normally set forth
in paragraph (c)(1)(i) of this section for its fifth taxable year (based
on support received in its first through fifth taxable years). If a new
publicly supported organization described under section 509(a)(2) cannot
meet the requirements of the one-third support test or the not-more-
than-one-third support test for its sixth taxable year using either the
general definition of normally in paragraph (c)(1) of this section or
the alternate rule above (effectively failing to meet a public support
test for both its fifth and sixth years), it will be reclassified as a
private foundation as of the first day of its sixth taxable year only
for purposes of sections 507, 4940, and 6033. Such an organization must
file a Form 990-PF, ``Return of Private Foundation or Section 4947(a)(1)
Nonexempt Charitable Trust Treated as a Private Foundation,'' and is
liable for the net investment tax imposed by section 4940 and, if
applicable, the private foundation termination tax imposed by section
507(c), for its sixth taxable year. Beginning the first day of its
seventh taxable year, the organization will be treated as a private
foundation for all purposes.
(2) Basic consideration. In determining whether an organization can
reasonably be expected (within the meaning of paragraph (c)(1)(i) of
this section) to meet the one-third support test under section
509(a)(2)(A) and the not-more-than-one-third support test under section
509(a)(2)(B) described in paragraph (a) of this section during its first
five taxable years, the basic consideration is whether its
organizational structure, current or proposed programs or activities,
and actual or intended method of operation are such as to attract the
type of broadly based support from the general public, public charities,
and governmental units that is necessary to meet such tests. The factors
that are relevant to this determination, and the weight accorded to each
of them, may differ from case to case, depending on the nature and
functions of the organization. An organization cannot reasonably be
expected to meet the one-third support test and the not-more-than-one-
third support test where the facts indicate that an organization is
likely during its first five taxable years to receive less than one-
third of its support from permitted sources (subject to the limitations
of paragraph (b) of this section) or to receive more than one-third of
its support from items described in section 509(a)(2)(B).
(3) Factors taken into account. All pertinent facts and
circumstances shall be taken into account under paragraph (d)(2) of this
section in determining whether the organizational structure, programs or
activities, and method of operation of an organization are such
[[Page 113]]
as to enable it to meet the tests under section 509(a)(2) during its
first five taxable years. Some of the pertinent factors are:
(i) Whether the organization has or will have a representative
governing body which is comprised of public officials, or individuals
chosen by public officials acting in their capacity as such; of persons
having special knowledge in the particular field or discipline in which
the organization is operating; of community leaders, such as elected
officials, clergymen, and educators; or, in the case of a membership
organization, of individuals elected pursuant to the organization's
governing instrument or bylaws by a broadly based membership. This
characteristic does not exist if the membership of the organization's
governing body is such as to indicate that it represents the personal or
private interests of disqualified persons, rather than the interests of
the community or the general public.
(ii) Whether a substantial portion of the organization's initial
funding is to be provided by the general public, by public charities, or
by government grants, rather than by a limited number of grantors or
contributors who are disqualified persons with respect to the
organization. The fact that the organization plans to limit its
activities to a particular community or region or to a special field
which can be expected to appeal to a limited number of persons will be
taken into consideration in determining whether those persons providing
the initial support for the organization are representative of the
general public. On the other hand, the subsequent sources of funding
which the organization can reasonably expect to receive after it has
become established and fully operational will also be taken into
account.
(iii) Whether a substantial proportion of the organization's initial
funds are placed, or will remain, in an endowment, and whether the
investment of such funds is unlikely to result in more than one third of
its total support being received from items described in section
509(a)(2)(B).
(iv) In the case of an organization that carries on fundraising
activities, whether the organization has developed a concrete plan for
solicitation of funds from the general public on a community or area-
wide basis; whether any steps have been taken to implement such plan;
whether any firm commitments of financial or other support have been
made to the organization by civic, religious, charitable, or similar
groups within the community; and whether the organization has made any
commitments to, or established any working relationships with, those
organizations or classes of persons intended as the future recipients of
its funds.
(v) In the case of an organization that carries on community
services, such as combating community deterioration in an economically
depressed area that has suffered a major loss of population and jobs,
whether the organization has a concrete program to carry out its work in
the community; whether any steps have been taken to implement that
program; whether it will receive any part of its funds from a public
charity or governmental agency to which it is in some way held
accountable as a condition of the grant or contribution; and whether it
has enlisted the sponsorship or support of other civic or community
leaders involved in community service programs similar to those of the
organization.
(vi) In the case of an organization that carries on educational or
other exempt activities for, or on behalf of, members, whether the
solicitation for dues-paying members is designed to enroll a substantial
number of persons in the community, area, profession, or field of
special interest (depending on the size of the area and the nature of
the organization's activities); whether membership dues for individual
(rather than institutional) members have been fixed at rates designed to
make membership available to a broad cross-section of the public rather
than to restrict membership to a limited number of persons; and whether
the activities of the organization will be likely to appeal to persons
having some broad common interest or purpose, such as educational
activities in the case of alumni associations, musical activities in the
case of symphony societies, or civic affairs in the case of parent-
teacher associations.
[[Page 114]]
(vii) In the case of an organization that provides goods, services,
or facilities, whether the organization is or will be required to make
its services, facilities, performances, or products available
(regardless of whether a fee is charged) to the general public, public
charities, or governmental units, rather than to a limited number of
persons or organizations; whether the organization will avoid executing
contracts to perform services for a limited number of firms or
governmental agencies or bureaus; and whether the service to be provided
is one which can be expected to meet a special or general need among a
substantial portion of the general public.
(4) Example. The application of this paragraph (d) may be
illustrated by the following example:
Example. (i) Organization X was formed in January 2008 and uses a
taxable year ending December 31. After September 9, 2008, and before
December 31, 2008, Organization X filed Form 1023 requesting recognition
of exemption as an organization described in section 501(c)(3) and in
section 509(a)(2). In its application, Organization X established that
it can reasonably be expected to operate as a publicly supported
organization under paragraph (d) of this section. Subsequently,
Organization X received a ruling or determination letter that it is an
organization described in sections 501(c)(3) and 509(a)(2) effective as
of the date of its formation.
(ii) Organization X is described in section 509(a)(2) for its first
five taxable years (for the taxable years ending December 31, 2008,
through December 31, 2012).
(iii) Organization X can qualify as a publicly supported
organization beginning with the taxable year ending December 31, 2013,
if Organization X can meet the requirements of either Sec. 1.170A-
9(f)(2) or Sec. 1.170A-9(f)(3) or paragraphs (a) and (b) of this
section for the taxable years ending December 31, 2009, through December
31, 2013, or for the taxable years ending December 31, 2008, through
December 31, 2012.
(e) Determinations on foundation classification and reliance--(1) A
ruling or determination letter that an organization is described in
section 509(a)(2) may be issued to an organization. Such determination
may be made in conjunction with the recognition of the organization's
tax-exempt status or at such other time as the organization believes it
is described in section 509(a)(2). The ruling or determination letter
that the organization is described in section 509(a)(2) may be revoked
if, upon examination, the organization has not met the requirements of
this section. The ruling or determination letter that the organization
is described in section 509(a)(2) also may be revoked if the
organization's application for a ruling or determination contained one
or more material misstatements or omissions of fact or such application
was part of a scheme or plan to avoid or evade any provision of the
Code. The revocation of the determination that an organization is
described in section 509(a)(2) does not preclude revocation of the
determination that the organization is described in section 501(c)(3).
(2) Status of grantors or contributors. (i) For purposes of sections
170, 507, 545(b)(2), 642(c), 4942, 4945, 4966, 2055, 2106(a)(2), and
2522, grantors and contributors may rely upon a determination letter or
ruling that an organization is described in section 509(a)(2) until the
IRS publishes notice of a change of status (for example, in the Internal
Revenue Bulletin or Publication 78, ``Cumulative List of Organizations
described in Section 170(c) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986,''
which can be searched at http://www.irs.gov). For this purpose, grantors
or contributors may also rely on an advance ruling that expires on or
after June 9, 2008. However, a grantor or contributor may not rely on
such an advance ruling or any determination letter or ruling if the
grantor or contributor was responsible for, or aware of, the act or
failure to act that resulted in the organization's loss of
classification under section 509(a)(2) or acquired knowledge that the
IRS had given notice to such organization that it would be deleted from
such classification.
(ii) A grantor or contributor (other than one of the organization's
founders, creators, or foundation managers (within the meaning of
section 4946(b))) will not be considered to be responsible for, or aware
of, the act or failure to act that resulted in the loss of the
organization's publicly supported classification under section 509(a)(2)
if such grantor or contributor has made such grant or contribution in
reliance upon
[[Page 115]]
a written statement by the grantee organization that such grant or
contribution will not result in the loss of such organization's
classification as not a private foundation under section 509(a). Such
statement must be signed by a responsible officer of the grantee
organization and must set forth sufficient information, including a
summary of the pertinent financial data for the five taxable years
immediately preceding the current taxable year, to assure a reasonably
prudent person that his grant or contribution will not result in the
loss of the grantee organization's classification as a publicly
supported organization under section 509(a). If a reasonable doubt
exists as to the effect of such grant or contribution, or if the grantor
or contributor is one of the organization's founders, creators, or
foundation managers, the procedure for requesting a determination letter
set forth in paragraph (c)(5) of this section may be followed by the
grantee organization for the protection of the grantor or contributor.
(3) Examples. The provisions of this paragraph (e) may be
illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. Y, a calendar year organization described in section
501(c)(3), is created in February 2008 for the purpose of displaying
African art. On its exemption application Y shows, under penalties of
perjury, that it can reasonably, in accordance with the requirements of
paragraph (d) of this section, expect to receive support from the public
in 2008 through 2012 that will satisfy the one-third support and not-
more-than-one-third support tests described in section 509(a)(2) for its
first five taxable years, 2008 through 2012. Y may therefore receive a
determination that it meets the requirements of paragraph (a) of this
section for its first five taxable years (2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, and
2012), regardless of the public support Y in fact receives during this
period.
Example 2. Z, a calendar year organization described in section
501(c)(3), is created in July 2008. On its exemption application Z
shows, under penalties of perjury, that it can reasonably, in accordance
with the requirements of paragraph (d) of this section, expect to
receive support from the public in 2008 through 2012 that will satisfy
the one-third support and not-more-than-one-third support tests
described in section 509(a)(2) for its first five taxable years, 2008
through 2012. Z receives a determination that it is described in section
509(a)(2). However, the support actually received from the public over
Z's first five taxable years (2008 through 2012) does not satisfy the
one-third support and not-more-than-one-third support tests described in
section 509(a)(2). Moreover, the support Z receives from 2009 through
2013, also does not meet the one-third support and not-more-than-one-
third support tests described in section 509(a)(2). Z is described in
section 509(a)(2) during its first five years for all purposes. However,
because Z has not met the requirements of paragraph (a) of this section
for either 2008 through 2012 or 2009 through 2013, Z is not described in
section 509(a)(2) for its taxable year 2013. If Z is not described in
section 509(a)(1), section 509(a)(3), or section 509(a)(4), then Z will
be reclassified as a private foundation as of the first day of 2013.
However, for 2013, Z will be treated as a private foundation only for
purposes of sections 507, 4940 and 6033. Z must file Form 990-PF and
will be liable for the net investment tax imposed by section 4940 and,
if applicable, the private foundation termination tax imposed by section
507(c) for 2013. For 2014 and succeeding years, Z will be treated as a
private foundation for all purposes (except as provided in paragraph
(e)(2) of this section with respect to grantors and contributors).
(f) Gifts and contributions distinguished from gross receipts--(1)
In general. In determining whether an organization normally receives
more than one-third of its support from permitted sources, all gifts and
contributions (within the meaning of section 509(a)(2)(A)(i)) received
from permitted sources, are includible in the numerator of the support
fraction in each taxable year. However, gross receipts (within the
meaning of section 509(a)(2)(A)(ii)) from admissions, sales of
merchandise, performance of services, or furnishing of facilities, in an
activity which is not an unrelated trade or business, are includible in
the numerator of the support fraction in any taxable year only to the
extent that such gross receipts do not exceed the limitation with
respect to the greater of $5,000 or 1 percent of support which is
describing paragraph (b) of this section. The terms gifts and
contributions shall, for purposes of section 509(a)(2), have the same
meaning as such terms have under section 170(c) and also include
bequests, legacies, devises, and transfers within the meaning of section
2055 or 2106(a)(2). Thus, for purposes of section 509(a)(2)(A), any
payment of money or transfer of property without adequate consideration
shall be considered a gift or contribution. Where payment is made or
property transferred
[[Page 116]]
as consideration for admissions, sales of merchandise, performance of
services, or furnishing of facilities to the donor, the status of the
payment or transfer under section 170(c) shall determine whether and to
what extent such payment or transfer constitutes a gift or contribution
under section 509(a)(2)(A)(i) as distinguished from gross receipts from
related activities under section 509(a)(2)(A)(ii). For purposes of
section 509(a)(2), the term contributions includes qualified sponsorship
payments (as defined in Sec. 1.513-4) in the form of money or property
(but not services).
(2) Valuation of property. For purposes of section 509(a)(2), the
amount includible in computing support with respect to gifts, grants or
contributions of property or use of such property shall be the fair
market or rental value of such property at the date of such gift or
contribution.
(3) Examples. The provisions of this paragraph (f) may be
illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. P is a local agricultural club described in section
501(c)(3). In order to encourage interest and proficiency by young
people in farming and raising livestock, it makes awards at its annual
fair for outstanding specimens of produce and livestock. Most of these
awards are cash or other property donated by local businessmen. When the
awards are made, the donors are given recognition for their donations by
being identified as the donor of the award. The recognition given to
donors is merely incidental to the making of the award to worthy
youngsters. For these reasons, the donations will constitute
contributions for purposes of section 509(a)(2)(A)(i). The amount
includible in computing support with respect to such contributions is
equal to the cash contributed or the fair market value of other property
on the dates contributed.
Example 2. Q, a performing arts center, enters into a contract with
a large company to be the exclusive sponsor of the center's theatrical
events. The company makes a payment of cash and products in the amount
of $100,000 to Q, and in return, Q agrees to make a broadcast
announcement thanking the company before each show and to provide $2,000
of advertising in the show's program (2% of $100,000 is $2,000). The
announcement constitutes use or acknowledgment pursuant to section
513(i)(2). Because the value of the advertising does not exceed 2% of
the total payment, the entire $100,000 is a qualified sponsorship
payment under section 513(i), and $100,000 is treated as a contribution
for purposes of section 509(a)(2)(A)(i).
Example 3. R, a charity, enters into a contract with a law firm to
be the exclusive sponsor of the charity's outreach program. Instead of
making a cash payment, the law firm agrees to perform $100,000 of legal
services for the charity. In return, R agrees to acknowledge the law
firm in all its informational materials. The total fair market value of
the legal services, or $100,000, is a qualified sponsorship payment
under section 513(i), but no amount is treated as a contribution under
section 509(a)(2)(A)(i) because the contribution is of services.
(g) Grants distinguished from gross receipts--(1) In general. In
determining whether an organization normally receives more than one-
third of its support from public sources, all grants (within the meaning
of section 509(a)(2)(A)(i)) received from permitted sources are
includible in full in the numerator of the support fraction in each
taxable year. However, gross receipts (within the meaning of section
509(a)(2)(A)(ii)) from admissions, sales of merchandise, performance of
services, or furnishing of facilities, in an activity which is not an
unrelated trade or business, are includible in the numerator of the
support fraction in any taxable year only to the extent that such gross
receipts do not exceed the limitation with respect to the greater of
$5,000 or 1 percent of support which is described in paragraph (b) of
this section. A grant is normally made to encourage the grantee
organization to carry on certain programs or activities in furtherance
of its exempt purposes. It may contain certain terms and conditions
imposed by the grantor to insure that the grantee's programs or
activities are conducted in a manner compatible with the grantor's own
programs and policies and beneficial to the public. The grantee may also
perform a service or produce a work product which incidentally benefits
the grantor. Because of the imposition of terms and conditions, the
frequent similarlity of public purposes of grantor and grantee, and the
possibility of benefit resulting to the grantor, amounts received as
grants for the carrying on of exempt activities are sometimes difficult
to distinguish from amounts received as gross receipts from the carrying
on of exempt activities.
[[Page 117]]
The fact that the agreement, pursuant to which payment is made, is
designated a contract or a grant is not controlling for purposes of
classifying the payment under section 509(a)(2).
(2) Distinguishing factors. For purposes of section
509(a)(2)(A)(ii), in distinguishing the term gross receipts from the
term grants, the term gross receipts means amounts received from an
activity which is not an unrelated trade or business, if a specific
service, facility, or product is provided to serve the direct and
immediate needs of the payor, rather than primarily to confer a direct
benefit upon the general public. In general, payments made primarily to
enable the payor to realize or receive some economic or physical benefit
as a result of the service, facility, or product obtained will be
treated as gross receipts with respect to the payee. The fact that a
profitmaking organization would, primarily for its own economic or
physical betterment, contract with a nonprofit organization for the
rendition of a comparable service, facility or product from such
organization constitutes evidence that any payments received by the
nonprofit payee organization (whether from a governmental unit, a
nonprofit or a profitmaking organization) for such services, facilities
or products are primarily for the economic or physical benefit of the
payor and would therefore be considered gross receipts, rather than
grants with respect to the payee organization. For example, if a
nonprofit hospital described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(iii) engages an
exempt research and development organization to develop a more
economical system of preparing food for its own patients and personnel,
and it can be established that a hospital operated for profit might
engage the services of such an organization to perform a similar benefit
for its economic betterment, such fact would constitute evidence that
the payments received by the research and development organization
constitute gross receipts, rather than grants. Research leading to the
development of tangible products for the use or benefit of the payor
will generally be treated as a service provided to serve the direct and
immediate needs of the payor, while basic research or studies carried on
in the physical or social sciences will generally be treated as
primarily to confer a direct benefit upon the general public.
(3) Examples. The application of this paragraph may be illustrated
by the following examples:
Example 1. M, a nonprofit research organization described in section
501(c)(3), engages in some contract research. It receives funds from the
government to develop a specific electronic device needed to perfect
articles of space equipment. The initiative for the project came solely
from the government. Furthermore, the government could have contracted
with profitmaking research organizations which carry on similar
activities. The funds received from the government for this project are
gross receipts and do not constitute grants within the meaning of
section 509(a)(2)(A)(i). M provided a specific product at the
government's request and thus was serving the direct and immediate needs
of the payor within the meaning of subparagraph (2) of this paragraph.
Example 2. N is a nonprofit educational organization described in
section 501(c)(3). Its principal activity is to operate institutes to
train employees of various industries in the principles of management
and administration. The government pays N to set up a special institute
for certain government employees and to train them over a 2-year period.
Management training is also provided by profitmaking organizations. The
funds received are included as gross receipts. The particular services
rendered were to serve the direct and immediate needs of the government
in the training of its employees within the meaning of subparagraph (2)
of this paragraph.
Example 3. The Office of Economic Opportunity makes a community
action program grant to O, an organization described in section
509(a)(1). O serves as a delegate agency of OEO for purposes of
financing a local community action program. As part of this program, O
signs an agreement with X, an educational and charitable organization
described in section 501(c)(3), to carry out a housing program for the
benefit of poor families. Pursuant to this agreement, O pays X out of
the funds provided by OEO to build or rehabilitate low income housing
and to provide advisory services to other nonprofit organizations in
order for them to meet similar housing objectives, all on a nonprofit
basis. Payments made from O to X constitute grants for purposes of
section 509(a)(2)(A) because such program is carried on primarily for
the direct benefit of the community.
Example 4. P is an educational institute described in section
501(c)(3). It carries on studies and seminars to assist institutions of
higher learning. It receives funds from the
[[Page 118]]
government to research and develop a program of black studies for
institutions of higher learning. The performance of such a service
confers a direct benefit upon the public. Because such program is
carried on primarily for the direct benefit of the public, the funds are
considered a grant.
Example 5. Q is an organization described in section 501(c)(3) which
carries on medical research. Its efforts have primarily been directed
toward cancer research. Q sought funds from the government for a
particular project being contemplated in connection with its work. In
order to encourage its activities, the government gives Q the sum of
$25,000. The research project sponsored by government funds is primarily
to provide direct benefit to the general public, rather than to serve
the direct and immediate needs of the government. The funds are
therefore considered a grant.
Example 6. R is a public service organization described in section
501(c)(3) and composed of State and local officials involved in public
works activities. The Bureau of Solid Waste, Management of the
Department of Health, Education, and Welfare paid R to study the
feasibility of a particular system for disposal of solid waste. Upon
completion of the study, R was required to prepare a final report
setting forth its findings and conclusions. Although R is providing the
Bureau of Solid Waste Management with a final report, such report is the
result of basic research and study in the physical sciences and is
primarily to provide direct benefit to the general public by serving to
further the general functions of government, rather than a direct and
immediate governmental needs. The funds paid to R are therefore a grant
within the meaning of section 509(a)(2).
Example 7. R is the public service organization referred to in
example 6. W, a municipality described in section 170(c)(1), decides to
construct a sewage disposal plant. W pays R to study a number of
possible locations for such plant and to make recommendations to W,
based upon a number of factors, as to the best location. W instructed R
that in making its recommendation, primary consideration should be given
to minimizing the costs of the project to W. Since the study
commissioned by W was primarily directed toward producing an economic
benefit to W in the form of minimizing the costs of its project, the
services rendered are treated as serving W's direct and immediate needs
and are includible as gross receipts by R.
Example 8. S in an organization described in section 501(c)(3). It
was organized and is operated to further African development and
strengthen understanding between the United States and Africa. To
further these purposes, S receives funds from the Agency for
International Development and the Department of State under which S is
required to carry out the following programs: Selection, transportation,
orientation, counseling, and language training of African students
admitted to American institutions of higher learning; payment of
tuition, other fees, and maintenance of such students; and operation of
schools and vocational training programs in underdeveloped countries for
residents of those countries. Since the programs carried on by S are
primarily to provide direct benefit to the general public, all of the
funds received by S from the Federal agencies are considered grants
within the meaning of section 509(a)(2).
(h) Definition of membership fees--(1) General rule. For purposes of
section 509(a)(2), the fact that a membership organization provides
services, admissions, facilities, or merchandise to its members as part
of its overall activities will not, in itself, result in the
classification of fees received from members as gross receipts rather
than membership fees. If an organization uses membership fees as a means
of selling admissions, merchandise, services, or the use of facilities
to members of the general public who have no common goal or interest
(other than the desire to purchase such admissions, merchandise,
services, or use of facilities), then the income received from such fees
shall not constitute membership fees under section 509(a)(2)(A)(i), but
shall, if from a related activity, constitute gross receipts under
section 509(a)(2)(A)(ii). On the other hand, to the extent the basic
purpose for making the payment is to provide support for the
organization rather than to purchase admissions, merchandise, services,
or the use of facilities, the income received from such payment shall
constitute membership fees.
(2) Examples. The provisions of this paragraph may be illustrated by
the following examples:
Example 1. M is a symphony society described in section 501(c)(3).
Its primary purpose is to support the local symphony orchestra. The
organization has three classes of membership. Contributing members pay
annual dues of $10, sustaining members pay $25, and honorary members pay
$100. The dues are placed in a maintenance fund which is used to provide
financial assistance in underwriting the orchestra's annual deficit.
Members have the privilege of purchasing subscriptions to the concerts
before they go on sale to the general public, but must pay the same
price as any other member of the public. They also are entitled to
attend a
[[Page 119]]
number of rehearsals each season without charge. Under these
circumstances, M's receipts from the members constitute membership fees
for purposes of section 509(a)(2)(A)(i).
Example 2. N is a theater association described in section
501(c)(3). Its purpose is to support a repertory company in the
community in order to make live theatrical performances available to the
public. The organization sponsors six plays each year. Members of the
organization are entitled to a season subscription to the plays. The fee
paid as dues approximates the retail price of the six plays, less a 10-
percent discount. Tickets to each performance are also sold directly to
the general public. The organization also holds a series of lectures on
the theater which members may attend. Under these circumstances, the
fees paid by members as dues will be considered gross receipts from a
related activity. Although the fees are designated as membership fees,
they are actually admissions to a series of plays.
(i) Bureau defined--(1) In general. The term any bureau or similar
agency of a governmental unit (within the meaning of section
509(a)(2)(A)(ii)), refers to a specialized operating unit of the
executive, judicial, or legislative branch of government where business
is conducted under certain rules and regulations. Since the term bureau
refers to a unit functioning at the operating, as distinct from the
policymaking, level of government, it is normally descriptive of a
subdivision of a department of government. The term bureau, for purposes
of section 509(a)(2)(A)(ii), would therefore not usually include those
levels of government which are basically policymaking or administrative,
such as the office of the Secretary or Assistant Secretary of a
department, but would consist of the highest operational level under
such policymaking or administrative levels. Each subdivision of a larger
unit within the Federal Government, which is headed by a Presidential
appointee holding a position at or above Level V of the Executive
Schedule under 5 U.S.C. 5316, will normally be considered an
administrative or policymaking, rather than an operating, unit. Amounts
received from a unit functioning at the policymaking or administrative
level of government will be treated as received from one bureau or
similar agency of such unit. Units of a governmental agency above the
operating level shall be aggregated and considered a separate bureau for
this purpose. Thus, an organization receiving gross receipts from both a
policymaking or administrative unit and an operational unit of a
department will be treated as receiving gross receipts from two bureaus
within the meaning of section 509(a)(2)(A)(ii). For purposes of this
subparagraph, the Departments of Air Force, Army, and Navy are separate
departments and each is considered as having its own policymaking,
administrative, and operating units.
(2) Examples. The provisions of this paragraph may be illustrated by
the following examples:
Example 1. The Bureau of Health Insurance is considered a bureau
within the meaning of section 509(a)(2)(A)(ii). It is a part of the
Department of Health, Education, and Welfare, whose Secretary performs a
policymaking function, and is under the Social Security Administration,
which is basically an administrative unit. The Bureau of Health
Insurance is in the first operating level within the Social Security
Administration. Similarly, the National Cancer Institute would be
considered a bureau, as it is an operating part of the National
Institutes of Health within the Department of Health, Education, and
Welfare.
Example 2. The Bureau for Africa and the Bureau for Latin America
are considered bureaus within the meaning of section 509(a)(2)(A)(ii).
Both are separate operating units under the administrator of the Agency
for International development, a policymaking official. If an
organization received gross receipts from both of these bureaus, the
amount of gross receipts received from each would be subject to the
greater of $5,000 or 1 percent limitation under section
509(a)(2)(A)(ii).
Example 3. The Bureau of International Affairs of the Civil
Aeronautics Board is considered a bureau within the meaning of section
509(a)(2)(A)(ii). It is an operating unit under the administrative
office of the Executive Director. The subdivisions of the Bureau of
International Affairs are Geographic Areas and Project Development
Staff. If an organization received gross receipts from these
subdivisions, the total gross receipts from these subdivisions would be
considered gross receipts from the same bureau, the Bureau of
International Affairs, and would be subject to the greater of $5,000 or
1 percent limitation under section 509(a)(2)(A)(ii).
[[Page 120]]
Example 4. The Department of Mental Health, a State agency which is
an operational part of State X's Department of Public Health, is
considered a bureau. The Department of Public Health is basically an
administrative agency and the Department of Mental Health is at the
first operational level within it.
Example 5. The Aeronautical Systems Division of the Air Force
Systems Command, and other units on the same level, are considered
separate bureaus with the meaning of section 509(a)(2)(A)(ii). They are
part of the Department of the Air Force which is a separate department
for this purpose, as are the Army and Navy. The Secretary and the Under
Secretary of the Air Force perform the policymaking function, the Chief
of Staff and the Air Force Systems Command are basically administrative,
having a comprehensive complement of staff functions to provide
administration for the various divisions. The Aeronautical Systems
Division and other units on the same level are thus the first operating
level, as evidenced by the fact that they are the units that let
contracts and perform the various operating functions.
Example 6. The Division of Space Nuclear Systems, the Division of
Biology and Medicine, and other units on the same level within the
Atomic Energy Commission are each separate bureaus within the meaning of
section 509(a)(2)(A)(ii). The Commissioners (which make up the
Commission) are the policymakers. The general manager and the various
assistant general managers perform the administrative function. The
various divisions perform the operating function as evidenced by the
fact that each has separate programs to pursue and contracts
specifically for these various programs.
(j) Grants from public charities--(1) General rule. For purposes of
the one-third support test in section 509(a)(2)(A), grants (as defined
in paragraph (g) of this section) received from an organization
described in section 509(a)(1) (hereinafter referred to in this
subparagraph as a public charity) are generally includible in full in
computing the numerator of the recipient's support fraction of the
taxable year in question. It is sometimes necessary to determine whether
the recipient of a grant from a public charity has received such support
from the public charity as a grant, or whether the recipient has in fact
received such support as an indirect contribution from a donor to the
public charity. If the amount received is considered a grant from the
public charity, it is fully includible in the numerator of the support
fraction under section 509(a)(2)(A). However, if the amount received is
considered to be an indirect contribution from one of the public
charity's donors which has passed through the public chairty to the
recipient organization, such amount will retain its character as a
contribution from such donor and, if, for example, the donor is a
substantial contributor (as defined in section 507(d)(2)) with respect
to the ultimate recipient, such amount shall be excluded from the
numerator of the support fraction under section 509(a)(2). If a public
charity makes both an indirect contribution from its donor and an
additional grant to the ultimate recipient, the indirect contribution
shall be treated as made first.
(2) Indirect contributions. For purposes of subparagraph (1) of this
paragraph, an indirect contribution is one which is expressly or
impliedly ear-marked by the donor as being for, or for the benefit of, a
particular recipient (rather than for a particular purpose).
(3) Examples. The provisions of this paragraph may be illustrated by
the following examples:
Example 1. M, a national foundation for the encouragement of the
musical arts, is an organization described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(vi).
A gives M a donation of $5,000 without imposing any restrictions or
conditions upon the gift. M subsequently makes a $5,000 grant to X, an
organization devoted to giving public performances of chamber music.
Since the grant to X is treated as being received from M, it is fully
includible in the numerator of X's support fraction for the taxable year
of receipt.
Example 2. Assume M is the same organization described in example 1.
B gives M a donation of $10,000, but requires that M spend the money for
the purpose of supporting organizations devoted to the advancement of
contemporary American music. M has complete discretion as to the
organizations of the type described to which it will make a grant. M
decides to make grants of $5,000 each to Y and Z, both being
organizations described in section 501(c)(3) and devoted to furthering
contemporary American music. Since the grants to Y and Z are treated as
being received from M, Y and Z may each include one of the $5,000 grants
in the numerator of its support fraction for purposes of section
509(a)(2)(A). Although the donation to M was conditioned upon the use of
the funds for a particular purpose, M was free to select the ultimate
recipient.
[[Page 121]]
Example 3. N is a national foundation for the encouragement of art
and is an organization described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(vi). Grants to
N are permitted to be earmarked for particular purposes. O, which is an
art workshop devoted to training young artists and claiming status under
section 509(a)(2), persuades C, a private foundation, to make a grant of
$25,000 to N. C is a disqualified person with respect to O. C made the
grant to N with the understanding that N would be bound to make a grant
to O in the sum of $25,000, in addition to a matching grant of N's funds
to O in the sum of $25,000. Only the $25,000 received directly from N is
considered a grant from N. The other $25,000 is deemed an indirect
contribution from C to O and is to be excluded from the numerator of O's
support fraction.
(k) Method of accounting. For purposes of section 509(a)(2), an
organization's support will be determined under the method of accounting
on the basis of which the organization regularly computes its income in
keeping its books under section 446. For example, if a grantor makes a
grant to an organization payable over a term of years, such grant will
be includible in the support fraction of the grantee organization under
the method of accounting on the basis of which it regularly computes its
income in keeping its books under section 446.
(l) Gross receipts from section 513(a) (1), (2), or (3) activities.
For purposes of section 509(a)(2)(A)(ii), gross receipts from activities
described in section 513(a) (1), (2), or (3) will be considered gross
receipts from activities which are not unrelated trade or business.
(m) Gross receipts distinguished from gross investment income. (1)
For purposes of section 509(a)(2), where the charitable purpose of an
organization described in section 501(c)(3) is accomplished through the
furnishing of facilities for a rental fee or loans to a particular class
of persons, such as aged, sick, or needy persons, the support received
from such persons will be considered gross receipts (within the meaning
of section 509(d)(2)) from an activity which is not an unrelated trade
or business, rather than gross investment income. However, if such
organization also furnishes facilities or loans to persons who are not
members of such class and such furnishing does not contribute
importantly to the accomplishment of such organization's exempt purposes
(aside from the need of such organization for income or funds or the use
it makes of the profits derived), the support received from such
furnishing will be considered rents or interest and therefore will be
treated as gross investment income within the meaning of section
509(d)(4), unless such income is included in computing the tax imposed
by section 511.
(2) The provisions of this paragraph may be illustrated by the
following example:
Example. X, an organization described in section 501(c)(3), is
organized and operated to provide living facilities for needy widows of
deceased servicemen. X charges such widows a small rental fee for the
use of such facilities. Since X is accomplishing its exempt purpose
through the rental of such facilities, the support received from the
widows is considered gross receipts within the meaning of section
509(d)(2). However, if X rents part of its facilities to persons having
no relationship to X's exempt purpose, the support received from such
rental will be considered gross investment income within the meaning of
section 509(d)(4), unless such income is included in computing the tax
imposed by section 511.
(n) Transition rules. (1) An organization that received an advance
ruling, that expires on or after June 9, 2008, that it will be treated
as an organization described in section 509(a)(2) will be treated as
meeting the requirements of paragraph (d)(1) of this section for the
first five taxable years of its existence as a section 501(c)(3)
organization unless the IRS issued to the organization a proposed
determination prior to September 9, 2008, that the organization is not
described in sections 170(b)(1)(A)(vi) and 509(a)(1) or in section
509(a)(2).
(2) Paragraph (d)(1) of this section shall not apply to an
organization that received an advance ruling that expired prior to June
9, 2008, and that did not timely file with the IRS the required
information to establish that it is an organization described in
sections 170(b)(1)(A)(vi) and 509(a)(1) or in section 509(a)(2).
(3) An organization that fails to meet a public support test for its
first taxable year beginning on or after January 1, 2008, under the
regulations in this section may use the prior test set forth in
Sec. Sec. 1.509(a)-3(a)(2) and 1.509(a)-3(a)(3) or Sec. 1.170A-9(e)(2)
or Sec. 1.170A-
[[Page 122]]
9(e)(3) as in effect before September 9, 2008, (as contained in 26 CFR
part 1 revised April 1, 2008) to determine whether the organization may
be publicly supported for its 2008 taxable year based on its
satisfaction of a public support test for taxable year 2007, computed
over the period 2003 through 2006.
(4) Examples. The application of this paragraph (n) may be
illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. (i) Organization M was formed in January 2004, and uses a
taxable year ending June 30. Organization M received an advance ruling
letter that it is recognized as an organization described in section
501(c)(3) effective as of the date of its formation and that it is
treated as a publicly supported organization under section 509(a)(2)
during the five-year advance ruling period that will end on June 30,
2008. This date is on or after June 9, 2008.
(ii) Under the transition rule, Organization M is a publicly
supported organization described in section 509(a)(2) for the taxable
years ending June 30, 2004, through June 30, 2008. Organization M does
not need to establish within 90 days after June 30, 2008, that it met a
public support test under Sec. 1.170A-9(e) or Sec. 1.509(a)-3, as in
effect prior to September 9, 2008, (as contained in 26 CFR part 1
revised April 1, 2008) for its advance ruling period.
(iii) Organization M can qualify as a public charity beginning with
the taxable year ending June 30, 2009, if Organization M can meet the
requirements of Sec. 1.170A-9(f)(2) or Sec. 1.170A-9(f)(3) or
paragraphs (a)(2) and (a)(3) of this section for the taxable years
ending June 30, 2005, through June 30, 2009, or for the taxable years
ending June 30, 2004, through June 30, 2008. In addition, for its
taxable year ending June 30, 2009, Organization M may qualify as a
publicly supported organization by availing itself of the transition
rule contained in paragraph (n)(iii) of this section, which looks to
support received by M in the taxable years ending June 30, 2004, through
June 30, 2007.
Example 2. (i) Organization N was formed in January 2000 and uses a
December 31 taxable year. Organization N received a final determination
that it was recognized as tax-exempt under section 501(c)(3) and as a
public charity prior to September 9, 2008.
(ii) For taxable year 2008, Organization N will qualify as publicly
supported if it meets the requirements under either Sec. 1.170A-9(f)(2)
or Sec. 1.170A-9(f)(3) or paragraphs (a)(2) and (a)(3) of this section
for the five-year period January 1, 2004, through December 31, 2008.
Organization N will also qualify as publicly supported for taxable year
2008 if it meets the requirements under either Sec. 1.170A-9(e)(2) or
Sec. 1.170A-9(e)(3) or Sec. Sec. 1.509(a)-3(a)(2) and 1.509(a)-3(a)(3)
as in effect prior to September 9, 2008, (as contained in 26 CFR part 1
revised April 1, 2008) for taxable year 2007, using the four-year period
from January 1, 2003, through December 31, 2006.
(o) Effective/applicability date. This section shall generally apply
to taxable years beginning after December 31, 1969 except paragraphs
(a)(2), (a)(3)(i), (c), (d), (e), (k) and (n) of this section shall
apply to tax years beginning on or after January 1, 2008. For tax years
beginning after December 31, 1969 and beginning before January 1, 2008,
Sec. Sec. 1.509(a)-3(a)(2), 1.509(a)-3(a)(3)(i), 1.509(a)-3(c),
1.509(a)-3(d), 1.509(a)-3(e), and 1.509(a)-3(k) as in effect on December
31, 2007 (as contained in 26 CFR part 1 revised April 1, 2008) shall
apply.
[T.D. 7212, 37 FR 21907, Oct. 17, 1972, as amended by T.D. 7784, 46 FR
37889, July 23, 1981; T.D. 8423, 57 FR 33443, July 29, 1992; T.D. 8991,
67 FR 20437, Apr. 25, 2002; T.D. 9423, 73 FR 52549, Sept. 9, 2008; T.D.
9549, 76 FR 55764, Sept. 8, 2011; T.D. 9549, 76 FR 61946, Oct. 6, 2011]
Sec. 1.509(a)-4 Supporting organizations.
(a) In general. (1) Section 509(a)(3) excludes from the definition
of private foundation those organizations which meet the requirements of
subparagraphs (A), (B), and (C) thereof.
(2) Section 509(a)(3)(A) provides that a section 509(a)(3)
organization must be organized, and at all times thereafter operated,
exclusively for the benefit of, to perform the functions of, or to carry
out the purposes of one or more specified organizations described in
section 509(a) (1) or (2). Section 509(a)(3)(A) describes the nature of
the support or benefit which a section 509(a)(3) organization must
provide to one or more section 509(a) (1) or (2) organizations. For
purposes of section 509(a)(3)(A), paragraph (b) of this section
generally describes the organizational and operational tests; paragraph
(c) of this section describes permissible purposes under the
organizational test; paragraph (d) of this section describes the
requirement of supporting or benefiting one or more specified publicly
supported organizations; and paragraph (e) of this section describes
permissible beneficiaries and activities under the operational test.
[[Page 123]]
(3) Section 509(a)(3)(B) provides that a section 509(a)(3)
organization must be operated, supervised, or controlled by or in
connection with one or more organizations described in section 509(a)
(1) or (2). Section 509(a)(3)(B) and paragraph (f) of this section
describe the nature of the relationship which must exist between the
section 509(a)(3) and section 509(a) (1) or (2) organizations. For
purposes of section 509(a)(3)(B), paragraph (g) of this section defines
operated, supervised, or controlled by; paragraph (h) of this section
defines supervised or controlled in connection with; and paragraph (i)
of this section defines operated in connection with.
(4) Section 509(a)(3)(C) provides that a section 509(a)(3)
organization must not be controlled directly or indirectly by
disqualified persons (other than foundation managers or organizations
described in section 509(a) (1) or (2)). Section 509(a)(3)(C) and
paragraph (j) of this section prescribe a limitation on the control over
the section 509(a)(3) organization.
(5) For purposes of this section, the term supporting organization
means either an organization described in section 509(a)(3) or an
organization seeking section 509(a)(3) status, depending upon its
context. For purposes of this section, the term publicly supported
organization means an organization described in section 509(a) (1) or
(2).
(6) For purposes of paragraph (i) of this section, the term
``supported organization'' means a specified publicly supported
organization described in paragraphs (d)(2)(iv) or (d)(4) of this
section.
(b) Organizational and operational tests. (1) Under subparagraph (A)
of section 509(a)(3), in order to qualify as a supporting organization,
an organization must be both organized and operated exclusively for the
benefit of, to perform the functions of, or to carry out the purposes of
(hereinafter referred to in this section as being organized and operated
to support or benefit) one or more specified publicly supported
organizations. If an organization fails to meet either the
organizational or the operational test, it cannot qualify as a
supporting organization.
(2) In the case of supporting organizations created prior to January
1, 1970, the organizational and operational tests shall apply as of
January 1, 1970. Therefore, even though the original articles of
organization did not limit its purposes to those required under section
509(a)(3)(A) and even though it operated before January 1, 1970, for
some purpose other than those required under section 509(a)(3)(A), an
organization will satisfy the organizational and operational tests if,
on January 1, 1970, and at all times thereafter, it is so constituted as
to comply with these tests. For the special rules pertaining to the
application of the organizational and operational tests to organizations
terminating their private foundation status under the 12-month or 60-
month termination period provided under section 507(b)(1)(B) by becoming
public under section 509(a)(3), see the regulations under section
507(b).
(c) Organizational test--(1) In general. An organization is
organized exclusively for one or more of the purposes specified in
section 509(a)(3)(A) only if its articles of organization (as defined in
Sec. 1.501(c)(3)-1(b)(2)):
(i) Limit the purposes of such organization to one or more of the
purposes set forth in section 509(a)(3)(A);
(ii) Do not expressly empower the organization to engage in
activities which are not in furtherance of the purposes referred to in
subdivision (i) of this subparagraph;
(iii) State the specified publicly supported organizations on whose
behalf such organization is to be operated (within the meaning of
paragraph (d) of this section); and
(iv) Do not expressly empower the organization to operate to support
or benefit any organization other than the specified publicly supported
organizations referred to in subdivision (iii) of this subparagraph.
(2) Purposes. In meeting the organizational test, the organization's
purposes, as stated in its articles, may be as broad as, or more
specific than, the purposes set forth in section 509(a)(3)(A).
Therefore, an organization which, by the terms of its articles, is
formed for the benefit of one or more specified publicly supported
organizations shall, if it otherwise meets the other requirements of
this paragraph,
[[Page 124]]
be considered to have met the organizational test. Similarly, articles
which state that an organization is formed to perform the publishing
functions of a specified university are sufficient to comply with the
organizational test. An organization which is operated, supervised, or
controlled by (within the meaning of paragraph (g) of this section) or
supervised or controlled in connection with (within the meaning of
paragraph (h) of this section) one or more sections 509(a) (1) or (2)
organizations to carry out the purposes of such organizations, will be
considered as meeting the requirements of this paragraph if the purposes
set forth in its articles are similar to, but no broader than, the
purposes set forth in the articles of its controlling section 509(a) (1)
or (2) organizations. If, however, the organization by which it is
operated, supervised, or controlled is a publicly supported section
501(c) (4), (5), or (6) organization (deemed to be a section 509(a)(2)
organization for purposes of section 509(a)(3) under the provisions of
section 509(a)), the supporting organization will be considered as
meeting the requirements of this paragraph if its articles require it to
carry on charitable, etc., activities within the meaning of section
170(c)(2).
(3) Limitations. An organization is not organized exclusively for
the purposes set forth in section 509(a)(3)(A) if its articles expressly
permit it to operate to support or benefit any organization other than
those specified publicly supported organizations referred to in
subparagraph (1)(iii) of this paragraph. Thus, for example, an
organization will not meet the organizational test under section
509(a)(3)(A) if its articles expressly empower it to pay over any part
of its income to, or perform any service for, any organization other
than those publicly supported organizations specified in its articles
(within the meaning of paragraph (d) of this section). The fact that the
actual operations of such organization have been exclusively for the
benefit of the specified publicly supported organizations shall not be
sufficient to permit it to meet the organizational test.
(d) Specified organizations--(1) In general. In order to meet the
requirements of section 509(a)(3)(A), an organization must be organized
and operated exclusively to support or benefit one or more specified
publicly supported organizations. The manner in which the publicly
supported organizations must be specified in the articles for purposes
of section 509(a)(3)(A) will depend upon whether the supporting
organization is operated, supervised, or controlled by or supervised or
controlled in connection with (within the meaning of paragraphs (g) and
(h) of this section) such organizations or whether it is operated in
connection with (within the meaning of paragraph (i) of this section)
such organizations.
(2) Nondesignated publicly supported organizations; requirements.
(i) Except as provided in subdivision (iv) of this subparagraph, in
order to meet the requirements of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph,
the articles of the supporting organization must designate each of the
specified organizations by name unless:
(a) The supporting organization is operated, supervised, or
controlled by (within the meaning of paragraph (g) of this section), or
is supervised or controlled in connection with (within the meaning of
paragraph (h) of this section) one or more publicly supported
organizations; and
(b) The articles of organization of the supporting organization
require that it be operated to support or benefit one or more
beneficiary organizations which are designated by class or purpose and
which include:
(1) The publicly supported organizations referred to in (a) of this
subdivision (without designating such organizations by name); or
(2) Publicly supported organizations which are closely related in
purpose or function to those publicly supported organizations referred
to in subdivision (i)(a) or this subparagraph (without designating such
organization by name).
(ii) If a supporting organization is described in subdivision (i)(a)
of this subparagraph, it will not be considered as failing to meet the
requirements of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph that the publicly
supported organizations be specified merely because its articles of
organization permit the conditions described in subparagraphs (3) (i),
(ii),
[[Page 125]]
and (iii) and (4)(i) (a) and (b) of this paragraph.
(iii) This subparagraph may be illustrated by the following
examples:
Example 1. X is an organization described in section 501(c)(3) which
operates for the benefit of institutions of higher learning in the State
of Y. X is controlled by these institutions (within the meaning of
paragraph (g) of this section) and such institutions are all section
509(a)(1) organizations. X's articles will meet the organizational test
if they require X to operate for the benefit of institutions of higher
learning or educational organizations in the State of Y (without naming
each institution). X's articles would also meet the organizational test
if they provided for the giving of scholarships to enable students to
attend institutions of higher learning but only in the State of Y.
Example 2. M is an organization described in section 501(c)(3) which
was organized and operated by representatives of N church to run a home
for the aged. M is controlled (within the meaning of paragraph (g) of
this section) by N church, a section 509(a)(1) organization. The care of
the sick and the aged are longstanding temporal functions and purposes
of organized religion. By operating a home for the aged, M is operating
to support or benefit N church in carrying out one of its temporal
purposes. Thus M's articles will meet the organizational test if they
require M to care for the aged since M is operating to support one of N
church's purposes (without designating N church by name).
(iv) A supporting organization will meet the requirements of
subparagraph (1) of this paragraph even though its articles do not
designate each of the specified organizations by name if:
(a) There has been an historic and continuing relationship between
the supporting organization and the section 509(a) (1) or (2)
organizations, and
(b) By reason of such relationship, there has developed a
substantial identity of interests between such organizations.
(3) Nondesignated publicly supported organizations; scope of rule.
If the requirements of subparagraph (2)(i) (a) of this paragraph are
met, a supporting organization will not be considered as failing the
test of being organized for the benefit of specified organizations
solely because its articles:
(i) Permit the substitution of one publicly supported organization
within a designated class for another publicly supported organization
either in the same or a different class designated in the articles;
(ii) Permit the supporting organization to operate for the benefit
of new or additional publicly supported organizations of the same or a
different class designated in the articles; or
(iii) Permit the supporting organization to vary the amount of its
support among different publicly supported organizations within the
class or classes of organizations designated by the articles
For example, X is an organization which operates for the benefit of
private colleges in the State of Y. If X is controlled by these colleges
(within the meaning of paragraph (g) of this section) and such colleges
are all section 509(a)(1) organizations, X's articles will meet the
organization test even if they permit X to operate for the benefit of
any new colleges created in State Y in addition to the existing colleges
or in lieu of one which has ceased to operate, or if they permit X to
vary its support by paying more to one college than to another in a
particular year.
(4) Designated publicly supported organizations. (i) If an
organization is organized and operated to support one or more publicly
supported organizations and it is operated in connection with such
organization or organizations, then, except as provided in subparagraph
(2)(iv) of this paragraph, its articles of organization must, for
purposes of satisfying the organizational test under section
509(a)(3)(A), designate the specified organizations by name. Under the
circumstances described in this subparagraph, a supporting organization
which has one or more specified organizations designated by name in its
articles, will not be considered as failing the test of being organized
for the benefit of specified organizations solely because its articles:
(a) Permit a publicly supported organization which is designated by
class or purpose, rather than by name, to be substituted for the
publicly supported organization or organizations designated by name in
the articles, but only if such substitution is conditioned upon the
occurrence of an event which is beyond the control of the supporting
[[Page 126]]
organization, such as loss of exemption, substantial failure or
abandonment of operations, or dissolution of the publicly supported
organization or organizations designated in the articles;
(b) Permit the supporting organization to operate for the benefit of
a beneficiary organization which is not a publicly supported
organization, but only if such supporting organization is currently
operating for the benefit of a publicly supported organization and the
possibility of its operating for the benefit of other than a publicly
supported organization is a remote contingency; or
(c) Permit the supporting organization to vary the amount of its
support between different designated organizations, so long as it meets
the requirements of the integral part test set forth in paragraph (i)(3)
of this section with respect to at least one beneficiary organization.
(ii) If the beneficiary organization referred to in subdivision
(i)(b) of this subparagraph is not a publicly supported organization,
the supporting organization will not then meet the operational test of
paragraph (e)(1) of this section. Therefore, if a supporting
organization substituted in accordance with such subdivision (i)(b) a
beneficiary other than a publicly supported organization and operated in
support of such beneficiary organization, the supporting organization
would not be described in section 509(a)(3).
(iii) This subparagraph may be illustrated by the following example:
Example. X is a charitable trust described in section 4947(a)(1)
organized in 1968. Under the terms of its trust instrument, X's trustees
are required to pay over all of X's annual income to M University
Medical School for urological research. If M University Medical School
is unable or unwilling to devote these funds to urological research, the
trustees are required to pay all of such income to N University Medical
School. However if N University Medical School is also unable or
unwilling to devote these funds to urological research, X's trustees are
directed to choose a similar organization willing to apply X's funds for
urological research. From 1968 to 1973, X pays all of its net income to
M University Medical School pursuant to the terms of the trust. M and N
are publicly supported organizations. Although the contingent
remainderman may not be a publicly supported organization, the
possibility that X may operate for the benefit of other than a publicly
supported organization is, in 1973, a remote possibility, and X will be
considered as operating for the benefit of a specified publicly
supported organization under subdivision (i)(b) of this subparagraph.
However, if, at some future date, X actually substituted a nonpublicly
supported organization as beneficiary, X would fail the requirements of
the operational test set forth in paragraph (e)(1) of this section.
(e) Operational test--(1) Permissible beneficiaries. A supporting
organization will be regarded as operated exclusively to support one or
more specified publicly supported organizations (hereinafter referred to
as the operational test) only if it engages solely in activities which
support or benefit the specified publicly supported organizations. Such
activities may include making payments to or for the use of, or
providing services or facilities for, individual members of the
charitable class benefited by the specified publicly supported
organization. A supporting organization may also, for example, make a
payment indirectly through another unrelated organization to a member of
a charitable class benefited by the specified publicly supported
organization, but only if such a payment constitutes a grant to an
individual rather than a grant to an organization. In determining
whether a grant is indirectly to an individual rather than to an
organization the same standard shall be applied as in Sec. 53.4945-
4(a)(4) of this chapter. Similarly, an organization will be regarded as
operated exclusively to support or benefit one or more specified
publicly supported organizations even if it supports or benefits an
organization, other than a private foundation, which is described in
section 501(c)(3) and is operated, supervised, or controlled directly by
or in connection with such publicly supported organizations, or which is
described in section 511(a)(2)(B). However, an organization will not be
regarded as operated exclusively if any part of its activities is in
furtherance of a purpose other than supporting or benefiting one or more
specified publicly supported organizations.
(2) Permissible activities. A supporting organization is not
required to pay
[[Page 127]]
over its income to the publicly supported organizations in order to meet
the operational test. It may satisfy the test by using its income to
carry on an independent activity or program which supports or benefits
the specified publicly supported organizations. All such support must,
however, be limited to permissible beneficiaries in accordance with
subparagraph (1) of this paragraph. The supporting organization may also
engage in fund raising activities, such as solicitations, fund raising
dinners, and unrelated trade or business to raise funds for the publicly
supported organizations, or for the permissible beneficiaries.
(3) Examples. The provisions of this paragraph may be illustrated by
the following examples:
Example 1. M is a separately incorporated alumni association of X
University and is an organization described in section 501(c)(3). X
University is designated in M's articles as the sole beneficiary of its
support. M uses all of its dues and income to support its own program of
educational activities for alumni, faculty, and students of X University
and to encourage alumni to maintain a close relationship with the
university and to make contributions to it. M does not distribute any of
its income directly to X for the latter's general purposes. M pays no
part of its funds to, or for the benefit of, any organization other than
X. Under these circumstances, M is considered as operated exclusively to
perform the functions and carry out the purpose of X. Although it does
not pay over any of its funds to X, it carries on a program which both
supports and benefits X.
Example 2. N is a separately incorporated religious and educational
organization described in section 501(c)(3). It was formed and is
operated by Y Church to provide religious training for the members of
the church. While it does not maintain a regular faculty, N conducts a
Sunday school, weekly adult education lectures on religious subjects,
and other similar activities for the benefit of the church members. All
of its funds are disbursed in furtherance of such activities and no part
of its funds is paid to, or for the benefit of, any organization other
than Y Church. N is considered as operated exclusively to perform the
educational functions of Y Church and to carry out its religious
purposes by providing various forms of religious instruction.
Example 3. P is an organization described in section 501(c)(3). Its
primary activity is providing financial assistance to S, a publicly
supported organization which aids underdeveloped nations in Central
America. P's articles of organization designate S as the principal
recipient of P's assistance. However, P also makes a small annual
general purpose grant to T, a private foundation engaged in work similar
to that carried on by S. T performs a particular function that assists
in the overall aid program carried on by S. Even though P is operating
primarily for the benefit of S, a specified publicly supported
organization, it is not considered as operated exclusively for the
purposes set forth in section 509(a)(3)(A). The grant to T, a private
foundation, prevents it from complying with the operational test under
section 509(a)(3)(A).
Example 4. Assume the same facts as example 3, except that T is a
section 501(c)(3) organization other than a private foundation and is
operated in connection with S. Under these circumstances, P will be
considered as operated exclusively to support S within the meaning of
section 509(a)(3)(A).
Example 5. Assume the same facts as example 3 except that instead of
the annual general purpose grant made to T, each grant made by P to T is
specifically earmarked for the training of social workers and teachers,
designated by name, from Central America. Under these circumstances, P's
grants to T would be treated as grants to the individual social workers
and teachers under section 4945(d)(3) and Sec. 53.4945-4(a)(4), rather
than as grants to T under section 4945(d)(4). These social workers and
teachers are part of the charitable class benefitted by S. P would thus
be considered as operating exclusively to support S within the meaning
of section 509(a)(3)(A).
(f) Nature of relationship required between organizations--(1) In
general. Section 509(a)(3)(B) describes the nature of the relationship
required between a section 501(c)(3) organization and one or more
publicly supported organizations in order for such section 501(c)(3)
organization to qualify under the provisions of section 509(a)(3). To
meet the requirements of section 509(a)(3), an organization must be
operated, supervised, or controlled by or in connection with one or more
publicly supported organizations. If an organization does not stand in
one of such relationships (as provided in this paragraph) to one or more
publicly supported organizations, it is not an organization described in
section 509(a)(3).
(2) Types of relationships. Section 509(a)(3)(B) sets forth three
different types of relationships, one of which must be met in order to
meet the requirements of subparagraph (1) of this
[[Page 128]]
paragraph. Thus, a supporting organization may be:
(i) Operated, supervised, or controlled by,
(ii) Supervised or controlled in connection with, or
(iii) Operated in connection with, one or more publicly supported
organizations.
(3) Requirements of relationships. Although more than one type of
relationship may exist in any one case, any relationship described in
section 509(a)(3)(B) must insure that:
(i) The supporting organization will be responsive to the needs of
demands of one or more publicly supported organizations; and
(ii) The supporting organization will constitute an integral part
of, or maintain a significant involvement in, the operations of one or
more publicly supported organizations.
(4) General description of relationships. In the case of supporting
organizations which are operated, supervised, or controlled by one or
more publicly supported organizations, the distinguishing feature of
this type of relationship is the presence of a substantial degree of
direction by the publicly supported organizations over the conduct of
the supporting organization, as described in paragraph (g) of this
section. In the case of supporting organizations which are supervised or
controlled in connection with one or more publicly supported
organizations, the distinguishing feature is the presence of common
supervision or control among the governing bodies of all organizations
involved, such as the presence of common directors, as described in
paragraph (h) of this section. In the case of a supporting organization
which is operated in connection with one or more publicly supported
organizations, the distinguishing feature is that the supporting
organization is responsive to, and significantly involved in the
operations of, the publicly supported organization, as described in
paragraph (i) of this section.
(5) Contributions from controlling donors--(i) In general. For any
taxable year, a supporting organization shall not be considered to be
operated, supervised, or controlled by, or operated in connection with,
one or more publicly supported organizations, if the supporting
organization accepts any gift or contribution from any person who is--
(A) A person (other than an organization described in section
509(a)(1), (2), or (4)) who directly or indirectly controls, either
alone or together with persons described in paragraphs (f)(5)(i)(B) or
(f)(5)(i)(C) of this section, the governing body of a specified publicly
supported organization supported by such supporting organization;
(B) A member of the family (determined under section 4958(f)(4)) of
an individual described in paragraph (f)(5)(i)(A) of this section; or
(C) A 35-percent controlled entity (as defined in section 4958(f)(3)
by substituting ``clause (i) or (ii) of section 509(f)(2)(B)'' for
``subparagraph (A) or (B) of paragraph (1)'' in paragraph (f)(3)(A)(i)
thereof).
(ii) Meaning of control. [Reserved]
(g) Meaning of operated, supervised, or controlled by. (1)(i) Each
of the items operated by, supervised by, and controlled by, as used in
section 509(a)(3)(B), presupposes a substantial degree of direction over
the policies, programs, and activities of a supporting organization by
one or more publicly supported organizations. The relationship required
under any one of these terms is comparable to that of a parent and
subsidiary, where the subsidiary is under the direction of, and
accountable or responsible to, the parent organization. This
relationship is established by the fact that a majority of the officers,
directors, or trustees of the supporting organization are appointed or
elected by the governing body, members of the governing body, officers
acting in their official capacity, or the membership of one or more
publicly supported organizations.
(ii) A supporting organization may be operated, supervised, or
controlled by one or more publicly supported organizations within the
meaning of section 509(a)(3)(B) even though its governing body is not
comprised of representatives of the specified publicly supported
organizations for whose benefit it is operated within the meaning of
section 509(a)(3)(A). A supporting organization may be operated,
supervised, or
[[Page 129]]
controlled by one or more publicly supported organizations (within the
meaning of section 509(a)(3)(B)) and be operated for the benefit of one
or more different publicly supported organizations (within the meaning
of section 509(a)(3)(A)) only if it can be demonstrated that the
purposes of the former organizations are carried out by benefitting the
latter organizations.
(2) The provisions of this paragraph may be illustrated by the
following examples:
Example 1. X is a university press which is organized and operated
as a nonstock educational corporation to perform the publishing and
printing for M University, a publicly supported organization. Control of
X is vested in a Board of Governors appointed by the Board of Trustees
of M University upon the recommendation of the president of the
university. X is considered to be operated, supervised, or controlled by
M University within the meaning of section 509(a)(3)(B).
Example 2. Y Council was organized under the joint sponsorship of
seven independent publicly supported organizations, each of which is
dedicated to the advancement of knowledge in a particular field of
social science. The sponsoring organizations organized Y Council as a
means of pooling their ideas and resources for the attainment of common
objectives, including the conducting of scholarly studies and formal
discussions in various fields of social science. Under Y Council's by-
laws, each of the seven sponsoring organizations elects three members to
Y's board of trustees for 3-year terms. Y's board also includes the
president of Y Council and eight other individuals elected at large by
the board. Pursuant to policies established or approved by the board, Y
Council engages in research, planning, and evaluation in the social
sciences and sponsors or arranges conferences, seminars, and similar
programs for scholars and social scientists. It carries out these
activities through its own full-time professional staff, through a part-
time committee of scholars, and through grant recipients. Under the
above circumstances, Y Council is subject to a substantial degree of
direction by the sponsoring publicly supported organizations. It is
therefore considered to be operated, supervised, or controlled by such
sponsoring organizations within the meaning of section 509(a)(3)(B).
Example 3. Z is a charitable trust created by A in 1972. It has
three trustees, all of whom are appointed by M University, a publicly
supported organization. The trust was organized and is operated to pay
over all of its net income for medical research to N, O, and P, each of
which is specified in the trust, is a hospital described in section
509(a)(1), and is located in the same city as M. Members of M's biology
department are permitted to use the research facilities of N, O, and P.
Under subparagraph (1)(ii) of this paragraph, Z is considered to be
operated, supervised, or controlled by M within the meaning of section
509(a)(3)(B), even though it is operated for the benefit of N, O, and P
within the meaning of section 509(a)(3)(A).
(h) Meaning of supervised or controlled in connection with. (1) In
order for a supporting organization to be supervised or controlled in
connection with one or more publicly supported organizations, there must
be common supervision or control by the persons supervising or
controlling both the supporting organization and the publicly supported
organizations to insure that the supporting organization will be
responsive to the needs and requirements of the publicly supported
organizations. Therefore, in order to meet such requirement, the control
or management of the supporting organization must be vested in the same
persons that control or manage the publicly supported organizations.
(2) A supporting organization will not be considered to be
supervised or controlled in connection with one or more publicly
supported organizations if such organization merely makes payments
(mandatory or discretionary) to one or more named publicly supported
organizations, even if the obligation to make payments to the named
beneficiaries is enforceable under State law by such beneficiaries and
the supporting organization's governing instrument contains provisions
whose effect is described in section 508(e)(1) (A) and (B). Such
arrangements do not provide a sufficient connection between the payor
organization and the needs and requirements of the publicly supported
organizations to constitute supervision or control in connection with
such organizations.
(3) The provisions of this paragraph may be illustrated by the
following examples:
Example 1. A, a philanthropist, founded X school for orphan boys (a
publicly supported organization). At the same time A founded X school,
he also established Y trust into which he transferred all of the
operating assets of the school, together with a substantial endowment
for it. Under the provisions
[[Page 130]]
of the trust instrument, the same persons who control and manage the
school also control and manage the trust. The sole function of Y trust
is to hold legal title to X school's operating and endowment assets, to
invest the endowment assets and to apply the income from the endowment
to the benefit of the school in accordance with direction from the
school's governing body. Under these circumstances, Y trust is organized
and operated for the benefit of X school and is supervised or controlled
in connection with such organization within the meaning of section
509(a)(3). The fact that the same persons control both X and Y insures
Y's responsiveness to X's needs.
Example 2. In 1972, B, a philanthropist, created P, a charitable
trust for the benefit of Z, a symphony orchestra described in section
509(a)(2). B transferred 100 shares of common stock to P. Under the
terms of the trust instrument, the trustees (none of whom is under the
control of B) were required to pay over all of the income produced by
the trust assets to Z. The governing instrument of P contains certain
provisions whose effect is described in section 508(e)(1) (A) and (B).
Under applicable State law, Z can enforce the provisions of the trust
instrument and compel payment to Z in a court of equity. There is no
relationship between the trustees of P and the governing body of Z.
Under these circumstances P is not supervised or controlled in
connection with a publicly supported organization. Because of the lack
of any common supervision or control by the trustees of P and the
governing body of Z, P is not supervised or controlled in connection
with Z within the meaning of section 509(a)(3)(B).
Example 3. T is a charitable trust described in section 501(c)(3)
and created under the will of D. Prior to his death, D was a leader and
very active in C church, a publicly supported organization. D created T
to perpetuate his interest in, and assistance to, C. The sole purpose of
T was to provide financial support for C and its related institutions.
All of the original named trustees of T are members of C, are leaders in
C, and hold important offices in one or more of C's related
institutions. Successor trustees of T are by the terms of the charitable
trust instrument to be chosen by the remaining trustees and are also to
be members of C. All of the original trustees have represented that any
successor trustee will be a leader in C and will hold an important
office in one or more of C's related institutions. By reason of the
foregoing relationship T and its trustees are responsive to the needs
and requirements of C and its related institutions. Under these
circumstances, T trust is organized and operated for the benefit of C
and is supervised or controlled in connection with C and its related
institutions within the meaning of section 509(a)(3)(B).
(i) Meaning of operated in connection with--(1) General rule. For
each taxable year, a supporting organization is operated in connection
with one or more supported organizations (that is, is a ``Type III
supporting organization'') only if it is not disqualified by reason of
paragraph (f)(5) (relating to acceptance of contributions from
controlling donors) or paragraph (i)(10) (relating to foreign supported
organizations) of this section, and it satisfies--
(i) The notification requirement, which is set forth in paragraph
(i)(2) of this section;
(ii) The responsiveness test, which is set forth in paragraph (i)(3)
of this section; and
(iii) The integral part test, which is satisfied by maintaining
significant involvement in the operations of one or more supported
organizations and providing support on which the supported
organization(s) are dependent; in order to satisfy this test, the
supporting organization must meet the requirements either for--
(A) Functionally integrated Type III supporting organizations set
forth in paragraph (i)(4) of this section; or
(B) Non-functionally integrated Type III supporting organizations
set forth in paragraph (i)(5) of this section.
(2) Notification requirement--(i) Annual notification. For each
taxable year, a Type III supporting organization must provide the
following documents to each of its supported organizations:
(A) A written notice addressed to a principal officer of the
supported organization describing the type and amount of all of the
support the supporting organization provided to the supported
organization during the supporting organization's taxable year
immediately preceding the taxable year in which the written notice is
provided (and during any other taxable year of the supporting
organization ending after December 28, 2012, for which such support
information has not previously been provided);
(B) A copy of the supporting organization's Form 990, ``Return of
Organization Exempt from Income Tax,'' or other annual information
return required to be filed under section 6033 (although the supporting
organization may redact from the return the name
[[Page 131]]
and address of any contributor to the organization) that was most
recently filed as of the date the notification is provided (and any such
return for any other taxable year of the supporting organization ending
after December 28, 2012, that has not previously been provided to the
supported organization); and
(C) A copy of the supporting organization's governing documents as
in effect on the date the notification is provided, including its
articles of organization and bylaws (if any) and any amendments to such
documents, unless such documents have been previously provided and not
subsequently amended.
(ii) Electronic media. The notification documents required by this
paragraph (i)(2) may be provided by electronic media.
(iii) Due date. The notification documents required by this
paragraph (i)(2) for any taxable year shall be postmarked or
electronically transmitted by the last day of the fifth calendar month
following the close of that taxable year.
(iv) Principal officer. For purposes of paragraph (i)(2)(i)(A) of
this section, a principal officer includes, but is not limited to, a
person who, regardless of title, has ultimate responsibility for--
(A) Implementing the decisions of the governing body of a supported
organization;
(B) Supervising the management, administration, or operation of the
supported organization; or
(C) Managing the finances of the supported organization.
(3) Responsiveness test--(i) General rule. A supporting organization
meets the responsiveness test if it is responsive to the needs or
demands of a supported organization. Except as provided in paragraph
(i)(3)(v) of this section, in order to meet this test, a supporting
organization must satisfy the requirements of paragraphs (i)(3)(ii) and
(i)(3)(iii) of this section.
(ii) Relationship of officers, directors, or trustees. A supporting
organization satisfies the requirements of this paragraph (i)(3)(ii)
with respect to a supported organization only if--
(A) One or more officers, directors, or trustees of the supporting
organization are elected or appointed by the officers, directors,
trustees, or membership of the supported organization;
(B) One or more members of the governing body of the supported
organization are also officers, directors, or trustees of, or hold other
important offices in, the supporting organization; or
(C) The officers, directors, or trustees of the supporting
organization maintain a close and continuous working relationship with
the officers, directors, or trustees of the supported organization.
(iii) Significant voice. A supporting organization satisfies the
requirements of this paragraph (i)(3)(iii) only if, by reason of
paragraphs (i)(3)(ii)(A), (i)(3)(ii)(B), or (i)(3)(ii)(C) of this
section, the officers, directors, or trustees of the supported
organization have a significant voice in the investment policies of the
supporting organization, the timing of grants, the manner of making
grants, and the selection of grant recipients by such supporting
organization, and in otherwise directing the use of the income or assets
of the supporting organization.
(iv) Examples. The provisions of this paragraph (i)(3) may be
illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. X, an organization described in section 501(c)(3), is a
trust created under the last will and testament of Decedent. The trustee
of X (Trustee) is a bank. Under the trust instrument, X supports M, a
private university described in section 509(a)(1). The trust instrument
provides that Trustee has discretion regarding the timing and amount of
distributions consistent with the Trustee's fiduciary duties.
Representatives of Trustee and an officer of M have quarterly face-to-
face or telephonic meetings during which they discuss M's projected
needs and ways in which M would like X to use its income and invest its
assets. Additionally, Trustee communicates regularly with that officer
of M regarding X's investments and plans for distributions from X.
Trustee provides the officer of M with quarterly investment statements,
the information required under paragraph (i)(2) of this section, and an
annual accounting statement. Based on these facts, X meets the
responsiveness test of this paragraph (i)(3) with respect to M.
Example 2. Y is an organization described in section 501(c)(3) and
is a trust under State law. The trustee of Y (Trustee) is a bank. Y
supports charities P, Q, and R, each an organization described in
section 509(a)(1). Y
[[Page 132]]
makes annual cash payments to P, Q, and R. Once a year, Trustee sends to
P, Q, and R the cash payment, the information required under paragraph
(i)(2) of this section, and an accounting statement. Trustee has no
other communication with P, Q, or R. Y does not meet the responsiveness
test of this paragraph (i)(3).
(v) Exception for pre-November 20, 1970 organizations. In the case
of a supporting organization that was supporting or benefiting a
supported organization before November 20, 1970, additional facts and
circumstances, such as a historic and continuing relationship between
the organizations, may be taken into account, in addition to the factors
described in paragraphs (i)(3)(ii) and (i)(3)(iii) of this section, to
establish compliance with the responsiveness test.
(4) Integral part test--functionally integrated Type III supporting
organization--(i) General rule. A supporting organization meets the
integral part test and will be considered functionally integrated within
the meaning of section 4943(f)(5)(B), if it--
(A) Engages in activities substantially all of which directly
further the exempt purposes of one or more supported organizations and
otherwise meets the requirements described in paragraph (i)(4)(ii) of
this section;
(B) Is the parent of each of its supported organizations, as
described in paragraph (i)(4)(iii) of this section; or
(C) Supports a governmental supported organization and otherwise
meets the requirements of paragraph (i)(4)(iv) of this section.
(ii) Substantially all activities directly further exempt purposes--
(A) In general. A supporting organization meets the requirements of this
paragraph (i)(4)(ii) if it engages in activities substantially all of
which--
(1) Directly further the exempt purposes of one or more supported
organizations to which the supporting organization is responsive by
performing the functions of, or carrying out the purposes of, such
supported organization(s); and
(2) But for the involvement of the supporting organization, would
normally be engaged in by such supported organization(s).
(B) Meaning of substantially all. For purposes of paragraph
(i)(4)(ii)(A) of this section, in determining whether substantially all
of a supporting organization's activities directly further the exempt
purposes of one or more supported organization(s) to which the
supporting organization is responsive, all pertinent facts and
circumstances will be taken into consideration.
(C) Meaning of directly further. Activities ``directly further'' the
exempt purposes of one or more supported organizations for purposes of
this paragraph (i)(4) only if they are conducted by the supporting
organization itself, rather than by a supported organization. Holding
title to and managing exempt-use assets described in Sec. 1.509(a)-
4T(i)(8)(ii) are activities that directly further the exempt purposes of
the supported organization within the meaning of this paragraph (i)(4).
Conversely, except as provided in paragraph (i)(4)(ii)(D) of this
section, fundraising, making grants (whether to the supported
organization or to third parties), and investing and managing non-
exempt-use assets are not activities that directly further the exempt
purposes of the supported organization within the meaning of this
paragraph (i)(4).
(D) Payments to individual beneficiaries. The making or awarding of
grants, scholarships, or other payments to individual beneficiaries who
are members of the charitable class benefited by a supported
organization will be treated as an activity that directly furthers the
exempt purposes of that supported organization for purposes of this
paragraph (i)(4) only if--
(1) The individual beneficiaries are selected on an objective and
nondiscriminatory basis (as described in Sec. 53.4945-4(b));
(2) The officers, directors, or trustees of the supported
organization have a significant voice in the timing of the payments, the
manner of making them, and the selection of recipients; and
(3) The making or awarding of such payments is part of an active
program of the supporting organization that directly furthers the exempt
purposes of the supported organization and in which the supporting
organization maintains significant involvement, as defined in Sec.
53.4942(b)-1(b)(2)(ii) (except
[[Page 133]]
that ``supporting organization'' shall be substituted for
``foundation'').
(iii) Parent of supported organization(s). For purposes of paragraph
(i)(4)(i)(B) of this section, a supporting organization is the parent of
a supported organization if the supporting organization exercises a
substantial degree of direction over the policies, programs, and
activities of the supported organization and a majority of the officers,
directors, or trustees of the supported organization is appointed or
elected, directly or indirectly, by the governing body, members of the
governing body, or officers (acting in their official capacity) of the
supporting organization.
(iv) Supporting a governmental entity. [Reserved]
(v) Examples. The provisions of this paragraph (i)(4) may be
illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. N, an organization described in section 501(c)(3), is the
parent organization of a healthcare system consisting of two hospitals
(Q and R) and an outpatient clinic (S), each of which is described in
section 509(a)(1), and a taxable subsidiary (T). N is the sole member of
each of Q, R, and S. Under the charter and bylaws of each of Q, R, and
S, N appoints all members of the board of directors of each corporation.
N engages in the overall coordination and supervision of the healthcare
system's exempt subsidiary corporations Q, R, and S in approval of their
budgets, strategic planning, marketing, resource allocation, securing
tax-exempt bond financing, and community education. N also manages and
invests assets that serve as endowments of Q, R, and S. Based on these
facts, N qualifies as a functionally integrated Type III supporting
organization under paragraph (i)(4)(i)(B) of this section.
Example 2. V, an organization described in section 501(c)(3), is
organized and operated as a supporting organization to L, a church
described in section 509(a)(1). V meets the responsiveness test
described in paragraph (i)(3) of this section with respect to L. L
transferred to V title to the buildings in which L conducts religious
services, Bible study, and community enrichment programs. Substantially
all of V's activities consist of holding and maintaining these
buildings, which L continues to use, free of charge, to further its
exempt purposes. But for the activities of V, L would hold and maintain
the buildings. Based on these facts, V satisfies the requirements of
paragraph (i)(4)(ii) of this section.
Example 3. O is a local nonprofit food pantry described in section
501(c)(3). O collects donated food from local growers, grocery stores,
and individuals and distributes this food free of charge to poor and
needy people in O's community. O is organized and operated as a
supporting organization to eight churches of a particular denomination
located in O's community, each of which is described in section
509(a)(1). Control of O is vested in a five-member Board of Directors,
which includes an official from one of the churches as well as four lay
members of the churches' congregations. The officers of O maintain a
close and continuing working relationship with each of the eight
churches and as a result of such relationship, each of the eight
churches has a significant voice in directing the use of the income and
assets of O. As a result, O is responsive to its supported
organizations. All of O's activities directly further the exempt
purposes of the eight supported organizations to which it is responsive.
Additionally, but for the activities of O, the churches would normally
operate food pantries themselves. Based on these facts, O satisfies the
requirements of paragraph (i)(4)(ii) of this section.
Example 4. M, an organization described in section 501(c)(3), was
created by B, an individual, to provide scholarships for students of U,
a private secondary school and an organization described in section
509(a)(1). U establishes the scholarship criteria, publicizes the
scholarship program, solicits and reviews applications, and selects the
scholarship recipients. M invests its assets and disburses the funds for
scholarships to the recipients selected by U. M does not provide the
scholarships as part of an active program in which it maintains
significant involvement, as defined in Sec. 53.4942(b)-1(b)(2)(ii).
Based on these facts, M does not satisfy the requirements of paragraph
(i)(4)(ii) of this section.
Example 5. J, an organization described in section 501(c)(3), is
organized as a supporting organization to community foundation G, an
organization described in section 509(a)(1). J meets the responsiveness
test described in paragraph (i)(3) of this section with respect to G. In
addition to maintaining field-of-interest funds, sponsoring donor
advised funds, and conducting general grantmaking activities, G also
engages in activities to beautify and maintain local parks.
Substantially all of J's activities consist of maintaining all of the
local parks in the area of community foundation G by performing
activities such as establishing and maintaining trails, planting trees,
and removing trash. But for the activities of J, G would normally engage
in these efforts to beautify and maintain the local parks. Based on
these facts, J satisfies the requirements of paragraph (i)(4)(ii) of
this section.
[[Page 134]]
(5) Integral part test--non-functionally integrated Type III
supporting organization--(i) General rule. A supporting organization
meets the integral part test and will be considered non-functionally
integrated if it satisfies either--
(A) The distribution requirement of paragraph (i)(5)(ii) of this
section and the attentiveness requirement of paragraph (i)(5)(iii) of
this section; or
(B) The pre-November 20, 1970 trust requirements of paragraph (i)(9)
of this section.
(ii) Distribution requirement--(A) Annual distribution. With respect
to each taxable year, a supporting organization must distribute to or
for the use of one or more supported organizations an amount equaling or
exceeding the supporting organization's distributable amount for the
taxable year, as defined in Sec. 1.509(a)-4T(i)(5)(ii)(B), on or before
the last day of the taxable year.
(B) Distributable amount. [Reserved] For further guidance, see Sec.
1.509(a)-4T(i)(5)(ii)(B).
(C) Minimum asset amount. [Reserved] For further guidance, see Sec.
1.509(a)-4T(i)(5)(ii)(C).
(D) First taxable year. The distributable amount for the first
taxable year an organization is treated as a non-functionally integrated
Type III supporting organization is zero. Notwithstanding the foregoing,
for purposes of determining whether an excess amount is created under
paragraph (i)(7)(ii) of this section, the distributable amount for the
first taxable year an organization is treated as a non-functionally
integrated Type III supporting organization is the distributable amount
that would apply under Sec. 1.509(a)-4T(i)(5)(ii)(B) in the absence of
this paragraph (i)(5)(ii)(D).
(E) Emergency temporary reduction. The Secretary may provide by
publication in the Internal Revenue Bulletin (see Sec.
601.601(d)(2)(ii)(b) of this chapter) for a temporary reduction in the
distributable amount in the case of a disaster or emergency.
(F) Reasonable cause exception. A non-functionally integrated Type
III supporting organization that fails to meet the distribution
requirement of this paragraph (i)(5)(ii) will not be classified as a
private foundation for the taxable year in which it fails to meet the
distribution requirement if the organization establishes to the
satisfaction of the Secretary that--
(1) The failure was due solely to unforeseen events or circumstances
that are beyond the organization's control, a clerical error, or an
incorrect valuation of assets;
(2) The failure was due to reasonable cause and not to willful
neglect; and
(3) The distribution requirement is met within 180 days after the
organization is first able to distribute its distributable amount
notwithstanding the unforeseen events or circumstances, or 180 days
after the date the incorrect valuation or clerical error was or should
have been discovered; however, no amounts paid to meet a distribution
requirement for a prior taxable year under this paragraph
(i)(5)(ii)(F)(3) may be counted toward the distribution requirement for
the taxable year in which such amounts are paid.
(iii) Attentiveness requirement--(A) General rule. With respect to
each taxable year, a non-functionally integrated Type III supporting
organization must distribute one-third or more of its distributable
amount to one or more supported organizations that are attentive to the
operations of the supporting organization (within the meaning of
paragraph (i)(5)(iii)(B) of this section) and to which the supporting
organization is responsive (within the meaning of paragraph (i)(3) of
this section).
(B) Attentiveness. A supported organization is attentive to the
operations of the supporting organization during a taxable year if, in
the taxable year, at least one of the following requirements is
satisfied:
(1) The supporting organization distributes to the supported
organization amounts equaling or exceeding 10 percent of the supported
organization's total support (or, in the case of a particular department
or school of a university, hospital, or church, the total support of the
department or school) received during the supported organization's last
taxable year ending before the beginning of the supporting
organization's taxable year.
(2) The amount of support received from the supporting organization
is necessary to avoid the interruption of
[[Page 135]]
the carrying on of a particular function or activity of the supported
organization. The support is necessary if the supporting organization or
the supported organization earmarks the support for a particular program
or activity of the supported organization, even if such program or
activity is not the supported organization's primary program or
activity, as long as such program or activity is a substantial one.
(3) Based on the consideration of all pertinent factors, including
the number of supported organizations, the length and nature of the
relationship between the supported organization and supporting
organization, and the purpose to which the funds are put, the amount of
support received from the supporting organization is a sufficient part
of a supported organization's total support (or, in the case of a
particular department or school of a university, hospital, or church,
the total support of the department or school) to ensure attentiveness.
Normally the attentiveness of a supported organization is influenced by
the amounts received from the supporting organization. Thus, the more
substantial the amount involved in terms of a percentage of the
supported organization's total support, the greater the likelihood that
the required degree of attentiveness will be present. However, in
determining whether the amount received from the supporting organization
is sufficient to ensure the attentiveness of the supported organization
to the operations of the supporting organization (including
attentiveness to the nature and yield of the supporting organization's
investments), evidence of actual attentiveness by the supported
organization is of almost equal importance. A supported organization is
not considered to be attentive solely because it has enforceable rights
against the supporting organization under state law.
(C) Distribution to donor advised fund disregarded. Notwithstanding
paragraph (i)(5)(iii)(B) of this section, in determining whether a
supported organization will be considered attentive to the operations of
a supporting organization, any amount received from the supporting
organization that is held by the supported organization in a donor
advised fund described in section 4966(d)(2) will be disregarded.
(D) Examples. This paragraph (i)(5)(iii) is illustrated by the
following examples:
Example 1. K, an organization described in section 501(c)(3),
annually pays an aggregate amount equaling or exceeding its
distributable amount described in Sec. 1.509(a)-4T(i)(5)(ii)(B) to L, a
museum described in section 509(a)(2). K meets the responsiveness test
described in paragraph (i)(3) of this section with respect to L. In
recent years, L has earmarked the income received from K to underwrite
the cost of carrying on a chamber music series consisting of 12
performances a year that are performed for the general public free of
charge at its premises. The chamber music series is not L's primary
activity but it is a substantial activity. L could not continue the
performances without K's support. Based on these facts, K meets the
requirements of paragraph (i)(5)(iii)(B)(2) of this section.
Example 2. M, an organization described in section 501(c)(3),
annually pays an aggregate amount equaling or exceeding its
distributable amount described in Sec. 1.509(a)-4T(i)(5)(ii)(B) to the
Law School of N University, an organization described in section
509(a)(1). M meets the responsiveness test described in paragraph (i)(3)
of this section with respect to N. M has earmarked the income paid over
to N's Law School to endow a chair in International Law. Without M's
continued support, N could not continue to maintain this chair. The
chair is not N's primary activity but it is a substantial activity.
Based on these facts, M meets the requirements of paragraph
(i)(5)(iii)(B)(2) of this section.
Example 3. R is a charitable trust created under the will of B, who
died in 1969. R's purpose is to hold assets as an endowment for S (a
hospital), T (a university), and U (a national medical research
organization), all organizations described in section 509(a)(1) and
specifically named in the trust instrument, and to distribute all of the
income each year in equal shares among the three named beneficiaries.
Each year, R pays to S, T, and U an aggregate amount equaling or
exceeding its distributable amount described in Sec. 1.509(a)-
4T(i)(5)(ii)(B). Such payments equal less than one percent of the total
support that each supported organization received in its most recently
completed taxable year. Based on these facts, R does not meet the
requirements of paragraph (i)(5)(iii)(B)(1) of this section. However,
because B died prior to November 20, 1970, R could meet the requirements
of paragraph (i)(5)(i)(B) of this section upon meeting all of the
requirements of paragraph (i)(9) of this section.
Example 4. O is an organization described in section 501(c)(3). O is
organized to support
[[Page 136]]
five private universities, V, W, X, Y, and Z, each of which is described
in section 509(a)(1). O meets the responsiveness test under paragraph
(i)(3) of this section only as to V. Each year, O distributes an
aggregate amount that equals its distributable amount described in Sec.
1.509(a)-4T(i)(5)(ii)(B) and distributes an equal amount to each of the
five universities. Accordingly, O distributes only one-fifth of its
distributable amount to a supported organization to which O is also
responsive (V). Because O does not distribute at least one-third of its
distributable amount to supported organizations that are both attentive
to the operations of O and to which the O is responsive, O does not meet
the attentiveness requirements of this paragraph (i)(5)(iii).
(6) Distributions that count toward distribution requirement. For
purposes of this paragraph (i)(6), the amount of a distribution made to
a supported organization is the amount of cash distributed or the fair-
market value of the property distributed as of the date the distribution
is made. The amount of a distribution will be determined solely on the
cash receipts and disbursements method of accounting described in
section 446(c)(1). Distributions by the supporting organization that
count toward the distribution requirement imposed in paragraph
(i)(5)(ii) of this section shall include, but not be limited to--
(i) Any amount paid to a supported organization to accomplish the
supported organization's exempt purposes;
(ii) Any amount paid by the supporting organization to perform an
activity that satisfies the requirements of paragraph (i)(4)(ii) of this
section, but only to the extent such amount exceeds any income derived
by the supporting organization from the activity;
(iii) Any reasonable and necessary administrative expenses paid to
accomplish the exempt purposes of the supported organization(s), which
do not include expenses incurred in the production of investment income;
(iv) Any amount paid to acquire an exempt-use asset described in
Sec. 1.509(a)-4T(i)(8)(ii); and
(v) Any amount set aside for a specific project that accomplishes
the exempt purposes of a supported organization to which the supporting
organization is responsive, with such set aside counting toward the
distribution requirement for the taxable year in which the amount is set
aside but not in the year in which it is actually paid, if at the time
of the set-aside, the supporting organization--
(A) Obtains a written statement from each supported organization
whose exempt purposes the specific project accomplishes, signed under
penalty of perjury by one of the supported organization's principal
officers, as defined in paragraph (i)(2)(iv) of this section, stating
that the supported organization approves the project as one that
accomplishes one or more of the supported organization's exempt purposes
and also approves the supporting organization's determination that the
project is one that can be better accomplished by such a set-aside than
by the immediate payment of funds;
(B) Establishes to the satisfaction of the Commissioner, by meeting
the approval and information requirements described in Sec. 53.4942(a)-
3(b)(7)(i) of this chapter and by providing the written statement
described in paragraph (i)(6)(v)(A) of this section, that the amount set
aside will be paid for the specific project within 60 months after it is
set aside and that the project is one that can better be accomplished by
the set-aside than by the immediate payment of funds; and
(C) Evidences the set-aside by the entry of a dollar amount on the
books and records of the supporting organization as a pledge or
obligation to be paid at a future date or dates within 60 months of the
set aside.
(7) Carryover of excess amounts--(i) In general. If with respect to
any taxable year, an excess amount, as defined in paragraph (i)(7)(ii)
of this section, is created, such excess amount may be used to reduce
the distributable amount in any of the five taxable years immediately
following the taxable year in which the excess amount is created. An
excess amount created in a taxable year can only be carried over for
five taxable years.
(ii) Excess amount. An excess amount is created for any taxable year
beginning after December 28, 2012, if the total distributions made in
that taxable year that count toward the distribution requirement exceed
the supporting organization's distributable amount for the taxable year,
as determined under Sec. 1.509(a)-4T(i)(5)(ii)(B).
[[Page 137]]
With respect to any taxable year to which an excess amount is carried
over, in determining whether an excess amount is created in that taxable
year, the distributable amount is first reduced by any excess amounts
carried over (with the oldest excess amounts applied first) and then by
any distributions made in that taxable year.
(8) Valuation of non-exempt-use assets. [Reserved] For further
guidance, see Sec. 1.509(a)-4T(i)(8).
(9) Alternate integral part test for certain trusts. A trust
(whether or not exempt from taxation under section 501(a)) that on
November 20, 1970, met and continues to meet the requirements of
paragraphs (i)(9)(i) through (i)(9)(v) of this section, shall be treated
as meeting the requirements of paragraph (i)(5) of this section if for
taxable years beginning after October 16, 1972, the trustee of such
trust makes annual written reports to all of the trust's supported
organizations, setting forth a description of the trust's assets,
including a detailed list of the assets and the income produced by such
assets. A trust that meets the requirements of this paragraph (i)(9) may
request a ruling that it is described in section 509(a)(3) in such
manner as the Commissioner may prescribe. The requirements of this
paragraph (i)(9) are as follows:
(i) All the unexpired interests in the trust are devoted to one or
more purposes described in section 170(c)(1) or (c)(2)(B) and a
deduction was allowed with respect to such interests under sections 170,
545(b)(2), 556(b)(2), 642(c), 2055, 2106(a)(2), 2522, or corresponding
provisions of prior law (or would have been allowed such a deduction if
the trust had not been created before 1913).
(ii) The trust was created prior to November 20, 1970, and did not
receive any grant, contribution, bequest or other transfer on or after
such date. For purposes of this paragraph (i)(9)(ii), a split-interest
trust described in section 4947(a)(2) that was created prior to November
20, 1970, was irrevocable on such date, and that becomes a charitable
trust described in section 4947(a)(1) after such date shall be treated
as having been created prior to such date.
(iii) The trust is required by its governing instrument to
distribute all of its net income currently to a designated beneficiary
supported organization. If more than one beneficiary supported
organization is designated in the governing instrument of a trust, all
of the net income must be distributable and must be distributed
currently to each of such supported organizations in fixed shares
pursuant to such governing instrument. For purposes of this paragraph
(i)(9)(iii), the governing instrument of a charitable trust shall be
treated as requiring distribution to a designated supported organization
when the trust instrument describes the charitable purpose of the trust
so completely that such description can apply to only one existing
supported organization and is of sufficient particularity as to vest in
such organization rights against the trust enforceable in a court
possessing equitable powers.
(iv) The trustee of the trust does not have discretion to vary
either the beneficiary supported organizations or the amounts payable to
the supported organizations. For purposes of this paragraph (i)(9)(iv),
a trustee shall not be treated as having such discretion if the trustee
has discretion to make payments of principal to the single supported
organization that is currently entitled to receive all of the trust's
income or if the trust instrument provides that the trustee may cease
making income payments to a particular supported organization in the
event of certain specific occurrences, such as the loss of exemption
under section 501(c)(3) or classification under section 509(a)(1) or
(a)(2) by the supported organization or the failure of the supported
organization to carry out its charitable purpose properly.
(v) None of the trustees would be disqualified persons within the
meaning of section 4946(a) (other than foundation managers under section
4946(a)(1)(B)) with respect to the trust if such trust were treated as a
private foundation.
(10) Foreign supported organizations. A supporting organization is
not operated in connection with one or more supported organizations if
it supports any supported organization organized outside of the United
States.
[[Page 138]]
(11) Transition rules--(i) Notification requirement. A Type III
supporting organization will be treated as having satisfied the
notification requirement described in paragraph (i)(2) of this section
for its taxable year that includes December 28, 2012, if the required
notification is postmarked or electronically transmitted by the later of
the last day of the fifth calendar month following the close of that
taxable year or the due date (including extensions) of the supporting
organization's annual information return described in section 6033 for
that taxable year.
(ii) Integral part test--(A) Qualification as a functionally
integrated Type III supporting organization. A Type III supporting
organization in existence on December 28, 2012, that met and continues
to meet the requirements of Treas. Reg. Sec. 1.509(a)-4(i)(3)(ii), as
in effect prior to December 28, 2012, will be treated as meeting the
requirements of paragraph (i)(4) of this section until the first day of
the organization's second taxable year beginning after December 28,
2012.
(B) Qualification as a non-functionally integrated Type III
supporting organization. A Type III supporting organization in existence
on December 28, 2012, that met and continues to meet the requirements of
Treas. Reg. Sec. 1.509(a)-4(i)(3)(iii), as in effect prior to December
28, 2012, will be treated as meeting the requirements of paragraph
(i)(5)(i)(A) of this section until the first day of its second taxable
year beginning after December 28, 2012. Notwithstanding the foregoing,
in determining whether an excess amount is created under paragraph
(i)(7)(ii) of this section in the first taxable year beginning after
December 28, 2012, the distributable amount for that taxable year of a
Type III supporting organization treated as meeting the requirements of
paragraph (i)(5)(i)(A) of this section under this paragraph
(i)(11)(ii)(B) is the amount described in Sec. 1.509(a)-
4T(i)(5)(ii)(B).
(C) Transitioning to a non-functionally integrated Type III
supporting organization in the first taxable year after effective date.
A Type III supporting organization in existence on December 28, 2012,
that meets the requirements of Treas. Reg. Sec. 1.509(a)-4(i)(3)(ii),
as in effect prior to December 28, 2012, in its taxable year including
December 28, 2012, but not in its first taxable year beginning after
December 28, 2012, is a non-functionally integrated Type III supporting
organization and will be treated as having a distributable amount of
zero for purposes of meeting the requirements of paragraph (i)(5)(i)(A)
of this section during the organization's first taxable year beginning
after December 28, 2012. Notwithstanding the foregoing, in determining
whether an excess amount is created under paragraph (i)(7)(ii) of this
section in the first taxable year beginning after December 28, 2012, the
distributable amount for that taxable year of a Type III supporting
organization described in this paragraph (i)(11)(ii)(C) is the amount
described in Sec. 1.509(a)-4T(i)(5)(ii)(B), determined without regard
to paragraph (i)(5)(ii)(D) of this section.
(D) Second taxable year after effective date. Beginning in the
second taxable year beginning after December 28, 2012, and in all
succeeding taxable years, all Type III supporting organizations
described in this paragraph (i)(11)(ii) must meet either the
requirements of paragraph (i)(4) or (i)(5) of this section. If a Type
III supporting organization described in paragraph (i)(11)(ii)(A) of
this section does not meet the requirements of paragraph (i)(4) of this
section during its second taxable year beginning after December 28,
2012, its distributable amount for that second taxable year will be
determined under Sec. 1.509(a)-4T(i)(5)(ii)(B), without regard to
paragraph (i)(5)(ii)(D) of this section. Any Type III supporting
organization intending to meet the requirements of paragraph (i)(5) of
this section in its second taxable year beginning after December 28,
2012, must value its assets in accordance with Sec. 1.509(a)-4T(i)(8)
beginning in its first taxable year beginning after December 28, 2012.
(E) Judicial proceedings to reform instruments. During any taxable
years in which there is pending a judicial proceeding that meets the
requirements of this paragraph (i)(11)(ii)(E), a non-functionally
integrated Type III supporting organization organized before September
24, 2009, will not have to comply with the distribution requirement
[[Page 139]]
under paragraph (i)(5)(ii) of this section to the extent such compliance
would be inconsistent with mandatory provisions of a governing
instrument or other instrument executed before September 24, 2009, that
prohibits distributing capital or corpus. Beginning with the first
taxable year following the taxable year in which such judicial
proceeding is terminated, such a non-functionally integrated Type III
supporting organization must satisfy the distribution requirement under
paragraph (i)(5)(ii) of this section, regardless of the outcome of the
judicial proceeding. Thus, if, during a taxable year after such a
judicial proceeding, an organization fails to comply with paragraph
(i)(5)(ii) of this section, the organization will not qualify as a non-
functionally integrated Type III supporting organization, regardless of
whether such failure to comply was a result of the organization
operating in accordance with its governing instrument or other
instrument. To meet the requirements of this paragraph (i)(11)(ii)(E), a
judicial proceeding must be--
(1) Necessary to reform, or to excuse the supporting organization
from compliance with, a governing instrument or other instrument (as in
effect on September 24, 2009, and all times thereafter) in order to
permit the organization to satisfy paragraph (i)(5)(ii) of this section;
(2) Commenced before June 26, 2013; and
(3) Not subject to any unreasonable delay for which the supporting
organization is responsible.
(j) Control by disqualified persons--(1) In general. Under the
provisions of section 509(a)(3)(C) a supporting organization may not be
controlled directly or indirectly by one or more disqualified persons
(as defined in section 4946) other than foundation managers and other
than one or more publicly supported organizations. If a person who is a
disqualified person with respect to a supporting organization, such as a
substantial contributor to the supporting organization, is appointed or
designated as a foundation manager of the supporting organization by a
publicly supported beneficiary organization to serve as the
representative of such publicly supported organization, then for
purposes of this paragraph such person will be regarded as a
disqualified person, rather than as a representative of the publicly
supported organization. An organization will be considered controlled,
for purposes of section 509(a)(3)(C), if the disqualified persons, by
aggregating their votes or positions of authority, may require such
organization to perform any act which significantly affects its
operation or may prevent such organization from performing such act.
This includes, but is not limited to, the right of any substantial
contributor or his spouse to designate annually the recipients, from
among the publicly supported organizations of the income attributable to
his contribution to the supporting organization. Except as provided in
subparagraph (2) of this paragraph, a supporting organization will be
considered to be controlled directly or indirectly by one or more
disqualified persons if the voting power of such persons is 50 percent
or more of the total voting power of the organization's governing body
or if one or more of such persons have the right to exercise veto power
over the actions of the organization. Thus, if the governing body of a
foundation is composed of five trustees, none of whom has a veto power
over the actions of the foundation, and no more than two trustees are at
any time disqualified persons, such foundation will not be considered to
be controlled directly or indirectly by one or more disqualified persons
by reason of this fact alone. However, all pertinent facts and
circumstances including the nature, diversity, and income yield of an
organization's holdings, the length of time particular stocks,
securities, or other assets are retained, and its manner of exercising
its voting rights with respect to stocks in which members of its
governing body also have some interest, will be taken into consideration
in determining whether a disqualified person does in fact indirectly
control an organization.
(2) Proof of independent control. Notwithstanding subparagraph (1)
of this paragraph, an organization shall be permitted to establish to
the satisfaction of the Commissioner that disqualified persons do not
directly or indirectly control it. For example, in the
[[Page 140]]
case of a religious organization operated in connection with a church,
the fact that the majority of the organization's governing body is
composed of lay persons who are substantial contributors to the
organization will not disqualify the organization under section
509(a)(3)(C) if a representative of the church, such as a bishop or
other official, has control over the policies and decisions of the
organization.
(k) Organizations operated in conjunction with certain section
501(c) (4), (5), or (6) organizations. (1) For purposes of section
509(a)(3), an organization which is operated in conjunction with an
organization described in section 501(c) (4), (5), or (6) (such as a
social welfare organization, labor or agricultural organization,
business league, or real estate board) shall, if it otherwise meets the
requirements of section 509(a)(3), be considered an organization
described in section 509(a)(3) if such section 501(c) (4), (5), or (6)
organization would be described in section 509(a)(2) if it were an
organization described in section 501(c)(3). The section 501(c) (4),
(5), or (6) organization, which the supporting organization is operating
in conjunction with, must therefore meet the one-third tests of a
publicly supported organization set forth in section 509(a)(2).
(2) This paragraph may be illustrated by the following example:
Example. X medical association, described in section 501(c)(6), is
supported by membership dues and funds resulting from the performance of
its exempt activities. This support, which is entirely from permitted
sources, constitutes more than one-third of X's support. X does not
normally receive more than one-third of its support from items described
in section 509(a)(2)(B). X organized and operated an endowment fund for
the sole purpose of furthering medical education. The fund is an
organization described in section 501(c)(3). Since more than one-third
of X's support is derived from membership dues and from funds resulting
from the performance of exempt purposes (all of which are from permitted
sources) and not more than one-third of its support is from items
described in section 509(a)(2)(B), it would be a publicly supported
organization described in section 509(a)(2) if it were described in
section 501(c)(3) rather than section 501(c)(6). Accordingly, if the
fund otherwise meets the requirements of section 509(a)(3) with respect
to X, it will be considered an organization described in section
509(a)(3).
(l) Effective/applicability date. Paragraphs (a)(6), (f)(5), and (i)
of this section are effective on December 28, 2012.
[T.D. 7212, 37 FR 21916, Oct. 17, 1972, as amended by T.D. 7784, 46 FR
37890, July 23, 1981; 77 FR 76394, Dec. 28, 2012]
Sec. 1.509(a)-4T Supporting organizations (temporary).
(a) through (i)(5)(ii)(A) [Reserved] For further guidance, see Sec.
1.509(a)-4(a) through (i)(5)(ii)(A).
(B) Distributable amount. Except as provided in Sec. Sec. 1.509(a)-
4(i)(5)(ii)(D) and 1.509(a)-4(i)(5)(ii)(E), the distributable amount for
a taxable year is an amount equal to the greater of 85 percent of the
supporting organization's adjusted net income (as determined by applying
the principles of section 4942(f) and Sec. 53.4942(a)-2(d) of this
chapter) for the taxable year immediately preceding the taxable year of
the required distribution (``immediately preceding taxable year'') or
its minimum asset amount (as defined in paragraph (i)(5)(ii)(C) of this
section) for the immediately preceding taxable year, reduced by the
amount of taxes imposed on the supporting organization under subtitle A
of the Internal Revenue Code during the immediately preceding taxable
year.
(C) Minimum asset amount. For purposes of this paragraph (i)(5), a
supporting organization's minimum asset amount for the immediately
preceding taxable year is 3.5 percent of the excess of the aggregate
fair market value of all of the supporting organization's non-exempt-use
assets (determined under paragraph (i)(8) of this section) in that
immediately preceding taxable year over the acquisition indebtedness
with respect to such non-exempt-use assets (determined under section
514(c)(1) without regard to the taxable year in which the indebtedness
was incurred), increased by--
(1) Amounts received or accrued during the immediately preceding
taxable year as repayments of amounts which were taken into account by
the organization to meet the distribution requirement imposed in Sec.
1.509(a)-4(i)(5)(ii)(A) for any taxable year;
(2) Amounts received or accrued during the immediately preceding
taxable year from the sale or other disposition
[[Page 141]]
of property to the extent that the acquisition of such property was
taken into account by the organization to meet the distribution
requirement imposed in Sec. 1.509(a)-4(i)(5)(ii)(A) for any taxable
year; and
(3) Any amount set aside under Sec. 1.509(a)-4(i)(6)(v) to the
extent it is determined during the immediately preceding taxable year
that such amount is not necessary for the purposes for which it was set
aside and such amount was taken into account by the organization to meet
the distribution requirement imposed in Sec. 1.509(a)-4(i)(5)(ii)(A)
for any taxable year.
(i)(5)(ii)(D) through (i)(7) [Reserved] For further guidance, see
Sec. 1.509(a)-4(i)(5)(ii)(D) through (i)(7).
(8) Valuation of non-exempt-use assets. For purposes of determining
its distributable amount for a taxable year, a supporting organization
determines its minimum asset amount, as defined in paragraph
(i)(5)(ii)(C) of this section, by determining the aggregate fair market
value of all of its non-exempt-use assets in the immediately preceding
taxable year. For these purposes, the determination of the aggregate
fair market value of all non-exempt-use assets shall be made using the
valuation methods described in Sec. 53.4942(a)-2(c) of this chapter.
The aggregate fair market value of the supporting organization's non-
exempt-use assets shall not be reduced by any amount that is set aside
under Sec. 1.509(a)-4(i)(6)(v). For these purposes, the non-exempt-use
assets of the supporting organization are all assets of the supporting
organization other than--
(i) Assets described in Sec. 53.4942(a)-2(c)(2)(i) through (iv) of
this chapter (with ``supporting organization'' being substituted for
``foundation'' or ``private foundation'' and ``August 17, 2006'' being
substituted for ``December 31, 1969''); and
(ii) Exempt-use assets, which are assets that are used (or held for
use) to carry out the exempt purposes of the supporting organization's
supported organization(s) (determined by applying the principles
described in Sec. 53.4942(a)-2(c)(3) of this chapter) by either--
(A) The supporting organization; or
(B) One or more supported organizations, but only if the supporting
organization makes the asset available to the supported organization(s)
at no cost (or nominal rent) to the supported organization(s).
(i)(9) through (l) [Reserved] For further guidance, see Sec.
1.509(a)-4(i)(9) through (l).
(m) Effective/applicability date. This section is effective on
December 28, 2012. The applicability of this section expires on or
before December 21, 2015.
[77 FR 76399, Dec. 28, 2012]
Sec. 1.509(a)-5 Special rules of attribution.
(a) Retained character of gross investment income. (1) For purposes
of determining whether an organization meets the not-more-than-one-third
support test set forth in section 509(a)(2)(B), amounts received by such
organization from:
(i) An organization which seeks to be described in section 509(a)(3)
by reason of its support of such organization; or
(ii) A charitable trust, corporation, fund, or association described
in section 501(c)(3) (including a charitable trust described in section
4947(a)(1)) or a split interest trust described in section 4947(a)(2),
which is required by its governing instrument or otherwise to
distribute, or which normally does distribute, at least 25 percent of
its adjusted net income (within the meaning of section 4942(f)) to such
organization, and such distribution normally comprises at least 5
percent of such distributee organization's adjusted net income
will retain their character as gross investment income (rather than
gifts or contributions) to the extent that such amounts are
characterized as gross investment income in the possession of the
distributing organization described in subdivision (i) or (ii) of this
subparagraph or, if the distributing organization is a split interest
trust described in section 4947(a)(2), to the extent that such amounts
would be characterized as gross investment income attributable to
transfers in trust after May 26, 1969, if such trust were a private
foundation. For purposes of this section, all income which is
characterized as gross investment income in the possession of the
distributing organization
[[Page 142]]
shall be deemed to be distributed first by such organization and shall
retain its character as such in the possession of the recipient of
amounts described in this paragraph. If an organization described in
subdivision (i) or (ii) of this subparagraph makes distributions to more
than one organization, the amount of gross investment income deemed
distributed shall be prorated among the distributees.
(2) For purposes of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph, amounts paid
by an organization to provide goods, services, or facilities for the
direct benefit of an organization seeking section 509(a)(2) status
(rather than for the direct benefit of the general public) shall be
treated in the same manner as amounts received by the latter
organization. Such amounts will be treated as gross investment income to
the extent that such amounts are characterized as gross investment
income in the possession of the organization spending such amounts. For
example, X is an organization described in subparagraph (1)(i) of this
paragraph. It uses part of its funds to provide Y, an organization
seeking section 509(a)(2) status, with certain services which Y would
otherwise be required to purchase on its own. To the extent that the
funds used by X to provide such services for Y are characterized as
gross investment income in the possession of X, such funds will be
treated as gross investment income received by Y.
(3) An organization seeking section 509(a)(2) status shall file a
separate statement with its return required by section 6033, setting
forth all amounts received from organizations described in paragraph
(a)(1) (i) or (ii) of this section.
(b) Relationships created for avoidance purposes. (1) If a
relationship between an organization seeking section 509(a)(3) status
and an organization seeking section 509(a)(2) status:
(i) Is established or availed of after October 9, 1969, and
(ii) One of the purposes of establishing or utilizing such
relationship is to avoid classification as a private foundation with
respect to either organization, the character and amount of support
received by the section 509(a)(3) organization will be attributed to the
section 509(a)(2) organization for purposes of determining whether the
latter meets the one-third support test and the not-more-than-one-third
support test under section 509(a)(2). If a relationship described in
this subparagraph is established or utilized by an organization seeking
section 509(a)(3) status and two or more organizations seeking section
509(a)(2) status, the amount of support received by the former
organization will be prorated among the latter organizations and the
character of each class of support (as defined in section 509(d)) will
be attributed pro rata to each such organization. The provisions of this
paragraph and of paragraph (a) of this section are not mutually
exclusive.
(2) In determining whether a relationship between one or more
organizations seeking section 509(a)(2) status (hereinafter referred to
as beneficiary organizations) and an organization seeking section
509(a)(3) status (hereinafter referred to as the supporting
organization) has been established or availed of to avoid classification
as a private foundation (within the meaning of subparagraph (1) of this
paragraph), all pertinent facts and circumstances, including the
following, shall be taken into account as evidence that a relationship
was not established or availed of to avoid classification as a private
foundation:
(i) The supporting organization is operated to support or benefit
several specified beneficiary organizations.
(ii) The beneficiary organization has a substantial number of dues-
paying members (in relation to the public it serves and the nature of
its activities) and such members have an effective voice in the
management of both the supporting and beneficiary organizations.
(iii) The beneficiary organization is composed of several membership
organizations, each of which has a substantial number of members (in
relation to the public it serves and the nature of its activities), and
such membership organizations have an effective voice in the management
of the supporting and beneficiary organizations.
(iv) The beneficiary organization receives a substantial amount of
support
[[Page 143]]
from the general public, public charities, or governmental grants.
(v) The supporting organization uses its funds to carry on a
meaningful program of activities to support or benefit the beneficiary
organization and such use would, if such supporting organization were a
private foundation, be sufficient to avoid the imposition of any tax
upon such organization under section 4942.
vi) The supporting organization is not able to exercise substantial
control or influence over the beneficiary organization by reason of the
former's receiving support or holding assets which are
disproportionately large in comparison with the support received or the
assets held by the latter.
(vii) Different persons manage the operations of the beneficiary and
supporting organizations and each organization performs a different
function.
(3) The provisions of this paragraph may be illustrated by the
following examples:
Example 1. M, an organization described in section 509(a)(2), is a
council composed of 10 learned societies. Each member society has a
large membership of scholars interested in a particular academic area.
In 1970 M established N, an organization seeking section 509(a)(3)
status, for the purpose of carrying on research and study projects of
interest to the member societies. The principal source of funds for N's
activities is from foundation and government grants and contracts. The
principal source of funds for M's activities after the creation of N is
membership dues. M continued to maintain a wide variety of activities
for its members, such as publishing periodicals and carrying on seminars
and conferences. N is subject to complete control by the governing body
of M. Under these circumstances, the relationship between these
organizations is not one which is described in subparagraph (1) of this
paragraph.
Example 2. Q is a local medical research organization described in
section 509(a)(2). Its fixed assets are negligible and it carries on
research activities on a limited scale. It also makes a limited number
of grants to scientists and doctors who are engaged in medical research
of interest to Q. It receives support through small government grants
and a few research contracts from private foundations. R is an
organization described in section 501(c)(3). As of January 1, 1970, R
was classified as a private foundation under section 509. It has a
substantial endowment which it uses to make grants to various charitable
and scientific organizations described in section 501(c)(3). During
1970, R agrees to subsidize the research activities of Q. R amends its
governing instrument to provide specifically that all of R's support
will be used for research activities which are approved and supervised
by Q. R also amends its bylaws to permit a minority of Q's board of
directors to be members of R's governing body. R then gives timely
notification under section 507(b)(1)(B)(ii) that R is terminating its
private foundation status by meeting the requirements of section
509(a)(3) by the end of the 12-month period described in section
507(b)(1)(B)(i). For purposes of determining whether R has met the
requirements of section 509(a)(3) by the end of the 12-month period, as
well as determining Q's status under section 509(a)(2), the character
and amount of support received by R will be attributed to Q.
(c) Effect on organizations claiming section 509(a)(3) status. If an
organization claiming section 509(a)(2) status fails to meet either the
one-third support test or the not-more-than-one-third support test under
section 509(a)(2) by reason of the application of the provisions of
paragraph (a) or (b) of this section, and such organization is one of
the specified organizations (within the meaning of section 509(a)(3)(A))
for whose support or benefit an organization claiming section 509(a)(3)
status is operated, the organization claiming section 509(a)(3) status
will not be considered to be operated exclusively to support or benefit
one or more section 509(a) (1) or (2) organizations.
[T.D. 7212, 37 FR 21922, Oct. 17, 1972, as amended by T.D. 7290, 38 FR
31834, Nov. 19, 1973; T.D. 7784, 46 FR 37890, July 23, 1981]
Sec. 1.509(a)-6 Classification under section 509(a).
If an organization is described in section 509(a)(1) and also in
another paragraph of section 509(a), it will be treated as described in
section 509(a)(1). For purposes of this section, the parenthetical
language other than in clauses (vii) and (viii) used in section
509(a)(1) shall be construed to mean other than an organization which is
described only in clause (vii) or (viii). For example, X is an
organization which is described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(vi), but could
also meet the description of section 170(b)(1)(A)(viii) as an
organization described in section 509(a)(2). For purposes of the one-
third support test in section 509(a)(2)(A), contributions from
[[Page 144]]
X to other organizations will be treated as support from an organization
described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(vi) rather than from an organization
described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(viii).
[T.D. 7212, 37 FR 21923, Oct. 17, 1972]
Sec. 1.509(a)-7 Reliance by grantors and contributors to section
509(a) (1), (2), and (3) organizations.
(a) General rule. Once an organization has received a final ruling
or determination letter classifying it as an organization described in
section 509(a) (1), (2), or (3), the treatment of grants and
contributions and the status of grantors and contributors to such
organization under sections 170, 507, 545(b)(2), 556(b)(2), 642(c),
4942, 4945, 2055, 2106(a)(2), and 2522 will not be affected by reason of
a subsequent revocation by the service of the organization's
classification as described in section 509(a) (1), (2), or (3) until the
date on which notice of change of status is made to the public (such as
by publication in the Internal Revenue Bulletin) or another applicable
date, if any, specified in such public notice. In appropriate cases,
however, the treatment of grants and contributions and the status of
grantors and contributors to an organization described in section 509(a)
(1), (2), or (3) may be affected pending verification of the continued
classification of such organization under section 509(a) (1), (2), or
(3). Notice to this affect will be made in a public announcement by the
service. In such cases the effect of grants and contributions made after
the date of the announcement will depend upon the statutory
qualification of the organization as an organization described in
section 509(a) (1), (2), or (3).
(b) Exceptions. (1) Paragraph (a) of this section shall not apply if
the grantor or contributor:
(i) Had knowledge of the revocation of the ruling or determination
letter classifying the organization as an organization described in
section 509(a) (1), (2), or (3), or
(ii) Was in part responsible for, or was aware of, the act, the
failure to act, or the substantial and material change on the part of
the organization which gave rise to the revocation of the ruling or
determination letter classifying the organization as an organization
described in section 509(a) (1), (2), or (3).
(2) Paragraph (a) of this section shall not apply where a different
rule is otherwise expressly provided in the regulations under sections
170(b)(1)(A), 507(b)(1)(B), or 509.
[T.D. 7212, 37 FR 21923, Oct. 17, 1972]
Sec. 1.509(b)-1 Continuation of private foundation status.
(a) In general. If an organization is a private foundation (within
the meaning of section 509(a)) on October 9, 1969, or becomes a private
foundation on any subsequent date, such organization shall be treated as
a private foundation for all periods after October 9, 1969, or after
such subsequent date, unless its status as such is terminated under
section 507. Therefore, if an organization was described in section
501(c)(3) and was a private foundation within the meaning of section
509(a) on October 9, 1969, it shall be treated as a private foundation
for all periods thereafter, even though it may also satisfy the
requirements of an organization described in some other paragraph of
section 501(c). For example, if on October 9, 1969, an organization was
described in section 501(c)(3), but because of its activities, it could
also have qualified as an organization described in section 501(c)(4),
such organization will continue to be treated as a private foundation,
if it was a private foundation within the meaning of section 509(a) on
October 9, 1969.
(b) Taxable private foundations. If an organization is a private
foundation on October 9, 1969, and it is determined that it is not
exempt under section 501(a) as an organization described in section
501(c)(3) as of any date after October 9, 1969, such organization, even
though it may operate thereafter as a taxable entity, will continue to
be treated as a private foundation unless its status as such is
terminated under section 507. For example, X organization is a private
foundation on October 9, 1969. It is subsequently determined that, as of
July 1, 1972, X is no longer exempt under section 501(a) as an
organization described in section 501(c)(3)
[[Page 145]]
because, for example, it has not conformed its governing instrument
pursuant to section 508(e). X will continue to be treated as a private
foundation after July 1, 1972, unless its status as such is terminated
under section 507. However, if an organization is not exempt under
section 501(a) as an organization described in section 501(c)(3) on
October 9, 1969, then it will not be treated as a private foundation
within the meaning of section 509(a) by reason of section 509(b), unless
it becomes a private foundation on a subsequent date.
[T.D. 7212, 37 FR 21924, Oct. 17, 1972]
Sec. 1.509(c)-1 Status of organization after termination of private
foundation status.
(a) In general. For purposes of part II of subchapter F of this
chapter, an organization whose status as a private foundation is
terminated under section 507 shall be treated as an organization created
on the day after the date of such termination. An organization whose
private foundation status has been terminated under the provisions of
section 507(a) will, if it continues to operate, be treated as a new
organization and must, if it desires to be classified under section
501(c)(3), give notification that it is applying for recognition of
section 501(c)(3) status pursuant to the provisions of section 508(a).
(b) Effect upon section 507(d)(1). If the private foundation status
of an organization has been terminated under section 507(b)(1)(B) and
the regulations thereunder, and:
(1) Such organization does not continue at all times thereafter to
meet the requirements of section 509(a) (1), (2), or (3) (and is
therefore no longer excluded from the definition of a private
foundation); and
(2) The status of such organization as a private foundation is
thereafter terminated under section 507(a)
then the tax imposed under section 507(c)(1) upon the aggregate tax
benefit (described in section 507(d)(1)) resulting from section
501(c)(3) status shall be computed only upon the aggregate tax benefit
resulting after the date on which the organization again becomes a
private foundation under subparagraph (1) of this paragraph.
[T.D. 7212, 37 FR 21924, Oct. 17, 1972]
Sec. 1.509(d)-1 Definition of support
For purposes of section 509(a)(2), the term support does not include
amounts received in repayment of the principal of a loan or other
indebtedness. See, however, section 509(e) as to amounts received as
interest on a loan or other indebtedness.
[T.D. 7212, 37 FR 21924, Oct. 17, 1972]
Sec. 1.509(e)-1 Definition of gross investment income.
For the distinction between gross receipts and gross investment
income, see Sec. 1.509(a)-3(m).
(Sec. 7805, Internal Revenue Code of 1954, 68A Stat. 917; 26 U.S.C.
7805)
[T.D. 7212, 37 FR 21925, Oct. 17, 1972]
Taxation of Business Income of Certain Exempt Organizations
Sec. 1.511-1 Imposition and rates of tax.
Section 511(a) imposes a tax upon the unrelated business taxable
income of certain organizations otherwise exempt from Federal income
tax. Under section 511(a)(1), organizations described in section
511(a)(2)(A) and in paragraph (a) of Sec. 1.511-2 and organizations
described in section 511(a)(2)(B) are subject to normal tax and surtax
at the corporate rates provided by section 11. Under section 511(b)(1),
trusts described in section 511(b)(2) are subject to tax at the
individual rates prescribed in section 1(d) of the Code as amended by
the Tax Reform Act of 1969 (section 1 for taxable years ending before
Jan. 1, 1971). The deduction for personal exemption provided in section
642(b) in the case of a trust taxable under subchapter J, chapter 1 of
the Code, is not allowed in computing unrelated business taxable income.
[T.D. 7117, 36 FR 9421, May 25, 1971]
Sec. 1.511-2 Organizations subject to tax.
(a) Organizations other than trusts and title holding companies.
(1)(i) The taxes imposed by section 511(a)(1) apply in the case of any
organization (other than a trust described in section
[[Page 146]]
511(b)(2) or an organization described in section 501(c)(1)) which is
exempt from taxation under section 501(a) (except as provided in
sections 507 through 515). For special rules concerning corporations
described in section 501(c)(2), see paragraph (c) of this section.
(ii) In the case of an organization described in section 501(c)(4),
(7), (8), (9), (10), (11), (12), (13), (14)(A), (15), (16), or (18), the
taxes imposed by section 511(a)(1) apply only for taxable years
beginning after December 31, 1969. In the case of an organization
described in section 501(c)(14) (B) or (C), the taxes imposed by section
511(a)(1) apply only for taxable years beginning after February 2, 1966.
(2) The taxes imposed by section 511(a) apply in the case of any
college or university which is an agency or instrumentality of any
government or any political subdivision thereof, or which is owned or
operated by a government or any political subdivision thereof or by any
agency or instrumentality of any one or more governments or political
subdivisions. Such taxes also apply in the case of any corporation
wholly owned by one or more such colleges or universities. As here used,
the word government includes any foreign government (to the extent not
contrary to any treaty obligation of the United States) and all domestic
governments (the United States and any of its Territories or
possessions, any State, and the District of Columbia). Elementary and
secondary schools operated by such governments are not subject to the
tax on unrelated business income.
(3)(i) For taxable years beginning before January 1, 1970, churches
and associations or conventions of churches are exempt from the taxes
imposed by section 511. The exemption is applicable only to an
organization which itself is a church or an association or convention of
churches. Subject to the provisions of subdivision (ii) of this
subparagraph, religious organizations, including religious orders, if
not themselves churches or associations or conventions of churches, and
all other organizations which are organized or operated under church
auspices, are subject to the tax imposed by section 511, whether or not
they engage in religious, educational, or charitable activities approved
by a church.
(ii) The term church includes a religious order or a religious
organization if such order or organization (a) is an integral part of a
church, and (b) is engaged in carrying out the functions of a church,
whether as a civil law corporation or otherwise. In determining whether
a religious order or organization is an integral part of a church,
consideration will be given to the degree to which it is connected with,
and controlled by, such church. A religious order or organization shall
be considered to be engaged in carrying out the functions of a church if
its duties include the ministration of sacerdotal functions and the
conduct of religious worship. If a religious order or organization is
not an integral part of a church, or if such an order or organization is
not authorized to carry out the functions of a church (ministration of
sacerdotal functions and conduct of religious worship) then it is
subject to the tax imposed by section 511 whether or not it engages in
religious, educational, or charitable activities approved by a church.
What constitutes the conduct of religious worship or the ministration of
sacerdotal functions depends on the tenets and practices of a particular
religious body constituting a church. If a religious order or
organization can fully meet the requirements stated in this subdivision,
exemption from the tax imposed by section 511 will apply to all its
activities, including those which it conducts through a separate
corporation (other than a corporation described in section 501(c)(2)) or
other separate entity which it wholly owns and which is not operated for
the primary purpose of carrying on a trade or business for profit. Such
exemption from tax will also apply to activities conducted through a
separate corporation (other than a corporation described in section
501(c)(2)) or other separate entity which is wholly owned by more than
one religious order or organization, if all such orders or organizations
fully meet the requirements stated in this subdivision and if such
corporation or other entity is not operated for the primary purpose of
carrying on a trade or business for profit.
[[Page 147]]
(iii) For taxable years beginning after December 31, 1969, churches
and conventions or associations of churches are subject to the taxes
imposed by section 511, unless otherwise entitled to the benefit of the
transitional rules of section 512(b)(14) and Sec. 1.512(b)-1(i).
(b) Trusts--(1) In general. The taxes imposed by section 511(b)
apply in the case of any trust which is exempt from taxation under
section 501(a) (except as provided in sections 507 through 515), and
which, if it were not for such exemption, would be subject to the
provisions of subchapter J, chapter 1, of the Code. An organization
which is considered as trustee of a stock bonus, pension, or profit-
sharing plan described in section 401(a), a supplemental unemployment
benefit trust described in section 501(c)(17), or a pension plan
described in section 501(c)(18) (regardless of the form of such
organization) is subject to the taxes imposed by section 511(b)(1) on
its unrelated business income. However, if such an organization conducts
a business which is a separate taxable entity on the basis of all the
facts and circumstances, for example, an association taxable as a
corporation, the business will be taxable as a feeder organization
described in section 502.
(2) Effective dates. In the case of a trust described in section
501(c)(3), the taxes imposed by section 511(b) apply for taxable years
beginning after December 31, 1953. In the case of a trust described in
section 401(a), the taxes imposed by section 511(b) apply for taxable
years beginning after June 30, 1954. In the case of a trust described in
section 501(c)(17), the taxes imposed by section 511(b) apply for
taxable years beginning after December 31, 1959. In the case of any
other trust described in subparagraph (1) of this paragraph, the taxes
imposed by section 511(b) apply for taxable years beginning after
December 31, 1969.
(c) Title Holding Companies--(1) In general. If a corporation
described in section 501(c)(2) pays any amount of its net income for a
taxable year to an organization exempt from taxation under section
501(a) (or would pay such an amount but for the fact that the expenses
of collecting its income exceed its income), and if such corporation and
such organization file a consolidated income tax return for such taxable
year, then such corporation shall be treated, for purposes of the tax
imposed by section 511(a), as being organized and operated for the same
purposes as such organization, as well as for its title-holding purpose.
Therefore, if an item of income of the section 501(c)(2) corporation is
derived from a source which is related to the exempt function of the
exempt organization to which such income is payable and with which such
corporation files a consolidated return, such item is, together with all
deductions directly connected therewith, excluded from the determination
of unrelated business taxable income under section 512 and shall not be
subject to the tax imposed by section 511(a). If, however, such item of
income is derived from a source which is not so related, then such item,
less all deductions directly connected therewith, is, subject to the
modifications provided in section 512(b), unrelated business taxable
income subject to the tax imposed by section 511(a).
(2) The provisions of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph may be
illustrated by the following example:
Example. The income of X, a section 501(c)(2) corporation, is
required to be distributed to exempt organization A. During the taxable
year X realizes net income of $900,000 from source M and $100,000 from
source N. Source M is related to A's exempt function, while source N is
not so related. X and A file a consolidated return for such taxable
year. X has net unrelated business income of $100,000, subject to the
modifications in section 512(b).
(3) Cross reference. For rules relating generally to the filing of
consolidated returns by certain organizations exempt from taxation under
section 501(a), see section 1504(e) of the Code and Sec. 1.1502-100.
(4) Effective dates. Subparagraphs (1) through (3) of this paragraph
apply with respect to taxable years beginning after December 31, 1969.
For taxable years beginning before January 1, 1970, a corporation
described in section 501(c)(2) and otherwise exempt from taxation under
section 501(a) is taxable upon its unrelated business taxable income
only if such income is payable either:
[[Page 148]]
(i) To a church or convention or association of churches, or
(ii) To any organization subject, for taxable years beginning before
January 1, 1970, to the tax imposed by section 511(a)(1).
(d) The fact that any class of organizations exempt from taxation
under section 501(a) is subject to the unrelated business income tax
under section 511 and this section does not in any way enlarge the
permissible scope of business activities of such class for purposes of
the continued qualification of such class under section 501(a).
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 7183, 37 FR
7884, Apr. 21, 1972; T.D. 7632, 44 FR 42681, July 20, 1979]
Sec. 1.511-3 Provisions generally applicable to the tax on unrelated
business income.
(a) Assessment and collections. Since the taxes imposed by section
511 are taxes imposed by subtitle A of the Code, all provisions of law
and of the regulations applicable to the taxes imposed by subtitle A are
applicable to the assessment and collection of the taxes imposed by
section 511. Organizations subject to the tax imposed by section
511(a)(1) are subject to the same provisions, including penalties, as
are provided in the case of the income tax of other corporations. In the
case of a trust subject to the tax imposed by section 511(b)(1), the
fiduciaries for such trust are subject to the same provisions, including
penalties, as are applicable to fiduciaries in the case of the income
tax of other trusts. See section 6151, et seq., and the regulations
prescribed thereunder, for provisions relating to payment of tax.
(b) Returns. For requirements of filing annual returns with respect
to unrelated business taxable income by organizations subject to the tax
on such income, see section 6012, paragraph (e) of Sec. 1.6012-2, and
paragraph (a)(5) of Sec. 1.6012-3.
(c) Taxable years, method of accounting, etc. The taxable year
(fiscal year or calendar year, as the case may be) of an organization
shall be determined without regard to the fact that such organization
may have been exempt from tax during any prior period. See sections 441
and 446, and the regulations thereunder in this part, and section 7701
and the regulations in part 301 of this chapter (Regulations on
Procedure and Administration). Similarly, in computing unrelated
business taxable income, the determination of the taxable year for which
an item of income or expense is taken into account shall be made under
the provisions of sections 441, 446, 451, and 461, and the regulations
thereunder, whether or not the item arose during a taxable year
beginning before, on, or after the effective date of the provisions
imposing a tax upon unrelated business taxable income. If a method for
treating bad debts was selected in a return of income (other than an
information return) for a previous taxable year, the taxpayer must
follow such method in its returns under section 511, unless such method
is changed in accordance with the provisions of Sec. 1.166-1. A
taxpayer which has not previously selected a method for treating bad
debts may, in its first return under section 511, exercise the option
granted in Sec. 1.166-1.
(d) Foreign tax credit. See section 515 for provisions applicable to
the credit for foreign taxes provided in section 901.
Sec. 1.511-4 Minimum tax for tax preferences.
The tax imposed by section 56 applies to an organization subject to
tax under section 511 with respect to items of tax preference which
enter into the computation of unrelated business taxable income. For
this purpose, only those items of income and those deductions entering
into the determination of the tax imposed by this section are considered
in the determination of the items of tax preference under section 57.
For rules relating to the minimum tax for tax preferences, see sections
56 through 58 and the regulations thereunder.
[T.D. 7564, 43 FR 40494, Sept. 12, 1978]
Sec. 1.512(a)-1 Definition.
(a) In general. Except as otherwise provided in Sec. 1.512(a)-3,
Sec. 1.512(a)-4, or paragraph (f) of this section, section 512(a)(1)
defines unrelated business taxable income as the gross income derived
from any unrelated trade or business
[[Page 149]]
regularly carried on, less those deductions allowed by chapter 1 of the
Code which are directly connected with the carrying on of such trade or
business, subject to certain modifications referred to in Sec.
1.512(b)-1. To be deductible in computing unrelated business taxable
income, therefore, expenses, depreciation, and similar items not only
must qualify as deductions allowed by chapter 1 of the Code, but also
must be directly connected with the carrying on of unrelated trade or
business. Except as provided in paragraph (d)(2) of this section, to be
directly connected with the conduct of unrelated business for purposes
of section 512, an item of deduction must have proximate and primary
relationship to the carrying on of that business. In the case of an
organization which derives gross income from the regular conduct of two
or more unrelated business activities, unrelated business taxable income
is the aggregate of gross income from all such unrelated business
activities less the aggregate of the deductions allowed with respect to
all such unrelated business activities. For the treatment of amounts of
income or loss of common trust funds, see Sec. 1.584-2(c)(3).
(b) Expenses attributable solely to unrelated business activities.
Expenses, depreciation, and similar items attributable solely to the
conduct of unrelated business activities are proximately and primarily
related to that business activity, and therefore qualify for deduction
to the extent that they meet the requirements of section 162, section
167, or other relevant provisions of the Code, connected with the
conduct of that activity and are deductible in computing unrelated
business activities are directly connected with the conduct of that
activity and are deductible in computing unrelated business taxable
income if they otherwise qualify for deduction under the requirements of
section 162. Similarly, depreciation of a building used entirely in the
conduct of unrelated business activities would be an allowable deduction
to the extent otherwise permitted by section 167.
(c) Dual use of facilities or personnel. Where facilities are used
both to carry on exempt activities and to conduct unrelated trade or
business activities, expenses, depreciation and similar items
attributable to such facilities (as, for example, items of overhead),
shall be allocated between the two uses on a reasonable basis.
Similarly, where personnel are used both to carry on exempt activities
and to conduct unrelated trade or business activities, expenses and
similar items attributable to such personnel (as, for example, items of
salary) shall be allocated between the two uses on a reasonable basis.
The portion of any such item so allocated to the unrelated trade or
business activity is proximately and primarily related to that business
activity, and shall be allowable as a deduction in computing unrelated
business taxable income in the manner and to the extent permitted by
section 162, section 167, or other relevant provisions of the Code.
Thus, for example, assume that X, an exempt organization subject to the
provisions of section 511, pays its president a salary of $20,000 a
year. X derives gross income from the conduct of unrelated trade or
business activities. The president devotes approximately 10 percent of
his time during the year to the unrelated business activity. For
purposes of computing X's unrelated business taxable income, a deduction
of $2,000 (10 percent of $20,000), would be allowable for the salary
paid to its president.
(d) Exploitation of exempt activities--(1) In general. In certain
cases, gross income is derived from an unrelated trade or business
activity which exploits an exempt activity. One example of such
exploitation is the sale of advertising in a periodical of an exempt
organization which contains editorial material related to the
accomplishment of the organization's exempt purpose. Except as specified
in subparagraph (2) of this paragraph and paragraph (f) of this section,
in such cases, expenses, depreciation and similar items attributable to
the conduct of the exempt activities are not deductible in computing
unrelated business taxable income. Since such items are incident to an
activity which is carried on in furtherance of the exempt purpose of the
organization, they do not possess the necessary proximate and primary
relationship to the unrelated trade or business activity and are
[[Page 150]]
therefore not directly connected with that business activity.
(2) Allowable deductions. Where an unrelated trade or business
activity is of a kind carried on for profit by taxable organizations and
where the exempt activity exploited by the business is a type of
activity normally conducted by taxable organizations in pursuance of
such business, expenses, depreciation, and similar items which are
attributable to the exempt activity qualify as directly connected with
the carrying on of the unrelated trade or business activity to the
extent that:
(i) The aggregate of such items exceeds the income (if any) derived
from or attributable to the exempt activity; and
(ii) The allocation of such excess to the unrelated trade or
business activity does not result in a loss from such unrelated trade or
business activity
Under the rule of the preceding sentence, expenses, depreciation and
similar items paid or incurred in the performance of an exempt activity
must be allocated first to the exempt activity to the extent of the
income derived from or attributable to the performance of that activity.
Furthermore, such items are in no event allocable to the unrelated trade
or business activity exploiting such exempt activity to the extent that
their deduction would result in a loss carryover or carryback with
respect to that trade or business activity. Similarly, they may not be
taken into account in computing unrelated business taxable income
attributable to any unrelated trade or business activity not exploiting
the same exempt activity. See paragraph (f) of this section for the
application of these rules to periodicals published by exempt
organizations.
(e) Examples. This section is illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. W is an exempt business league with a large membership.
Under an arrangement with an advertising agency W regularly mails
brochures, pamphlets and other advertising materials to its members,
charging the agency an agreed amount per enclosure. The distribution of
the advertising materials does not contribute importantly to the
accomplishment of the purpose for which W is granted exemption.
Accordingly, the payments made to W by the advertising agency constitute
gross income from an unrelated trade or business activity. In computing
W's unrelated business taxable income, the expenses attributable solely
to the conduct of the business, or allocable to such business under the
rule of paragraph (c) of this section, are allowable as deductions in
accordance with the provisions of section 162. Such deductions include
the costs of handling and mailing, the salaries of personnel used full-
time in the unrelated business activity and an allocable portion of the
salaries of personnel used both to carry on exempt activities and to
conduct the unrelated business activity. However, costs of developing
W's membership and carrying on its exempt activities are not deductible.
Those costs are necessary to the maintenance of the intangible asset
exploited in the unrelated business activity--W's membership--but are
incurred primarily in connection with W's fundamental purpose as an
exempt organization. As a consequence, they do not have proximate and
primary relationship to the conduct of the unrelated business activity
and do not qualify as directly connected with it.
Example 2. (i) P, a manufacturer of photographic equipment,
underwrites a photography exhibition organized by M, an art museum
described in section 501(c)(3). In return for a payment of $100,000, M
agrees that the exhibition catalog sold by M in connection with the
exhibit will advertise P's product. The exhibition catalog will also
include educational material, such as copies of photographs included in
the exhibition, interviews with photographers, and an essay by the
curator of M's department of photography. For purposes of this example,
assume that none of the $100,000 is a qualified sponsorship payment
within the meaning of section 513(i) and Sec. 1.513-4, that M's
advertising activity is regularly carried on, and that the entire amount
of the payment is unrelated business taxable income to M. Expenses
directly connected with generating the unrelated business taxable income
(i.e., direct advertising costs) total $25,000. Expenses directly
connected with the preparation and publication of the exhibition catalog
(other than direct advertising costs) total $110,000. M receives $60,000
of gross revenue from sales of the exhibition catalog. Expenses directly
connected with the conduct of the exhibition total $500,000.
(ii) The computation of unrelated business taxable income is as
follows:
(A) Unrelated trade or business (sale of
advertising):
Income....................................... $100,000 .........
Directly-connected expenses.................. (25,000) .........
----------------------
Subtotal................................... 75,000 $75,000
======================
(B) Exempt function (publication of exhibition
catalog):
Income (from catalog sales).................. 60,000 .........
[[Page 151]]
Directly-connected expenses.................. (110,000) .........
----------------------
Net exempt function income (loss).......... (50,000) (50,000)
======================
Unrelated business taxable income.......... .......... 25,000
(iii) Expenses related to publication of the exhibition catalog
exceed revenues by $50,000. Because the unrelated business activity (the
sale of advertising) exploits an exempt activity (the publication of the
exhibition catalog), and because the publication of editorial material
is an activity normally conducted by taxable entities that sell
advertising, the net loss from the exempt publication activity is
allowed as a deduction from unrelated business income under paragraph
(d)(2) of this section. In contrast, the presentation of an exhibition
is not an activity normally conducted by taxable entities engaged in
advertising and publication activity for purposes of paragraph (d)(2) of
this section. Consequently, the $500,000 cost of presenting the
exhibition is not directly connected with the conduct of the unrelated
advertising activity and does not have a proximate and primary
relationship to that activity. Accordingly, M has unrelated business
taxable income of $25,000.
(f) Determination of unrelated business taxable income derived from
sale of advertising in exempt organization periodicals--(1) In general.
Under section 513 (relating to the definition of unrelated trade or
business) and Sec. 1.513-1, amounts realized by an exempt organization
from the sale of advertising in a periodical constitute gross income
from an unrelated trade or business activity involving the exploitation
of an exempt activity; namely, the circulation and readership of the
periodical developed through the production and distribution of the
readership content of the periodical. Paragraph (d) of this section
provides for the allowance of deductions attributable to the production
and distribution of the readership content of the periodical. Thus,
subject to the limitations of paragraph (d)(2) of this section, where
the circulation and readership of an exempt organization periodical are
utilized in connection with the sale of advertising in the periodical,
expenses, depreciation, and similar items of deductions attributable to
the production and distribution of the editorial or readership content
of the periodical shall qualify as items of deductions directly
connected with the unrelated advertising activity. Subparagraphs (2)
through (6) of this paragraph provide rules for determining the amount
of unrelated business taxable income attributable to the sale of
advertising in exempt organization periodicals. Subparagraph (7) of this
paragraph provides rules for determining when the unrelated business
taxable income of two or more exempt organization periodicals may be
determined on a consolidated basis.
(2) Computation of unrelated business taxable income attributable to
sale of advertising--(i) Excess advertising costs. If the direct
advertising costs of an exempt organization periodical (determined under
subparagraph (6)(ii) of this paragraph) exceed gross advertising income
(determined under subparagraph (3)(ii) of this paragraph), such excess
shall be allowable as a deduction in determining unrelated business
taxable income from any unrelated trade or business activity carried on
by the organization.
(ii) Excess advertising income. If the gross advertising income of
an exempt organization periodical exceeds direct advertising costs,
paragraph (d)(2) of this section provides that items of deduction
attributable to the production and distribution of the readership
content of an exempt organization periodical shall qualify as items of
deduction directly connected with unrelated advertising activity in
computing the amount of unrelated business taxable income derived from
the advertising activity to the extent that such items exceed the income
derived from or attributable to such production and distribution, but
only to the extent that such items do not result in a loss from such
advertising activity. Furthermore, such items of deduction shall not
qualify as directly connected with such advertising activity to the
extent that their deduction would result in a loss carryback or
carryover with respect to such advertising activity. Similarly, such
items of deduction shall not be taken into account in computing
unrelated business taxable income attributable to any unrelated trade or
business activity other than such advertising activity. Thus:
(a) If the circulation income of the periodical (determined under
subparagraph (3)(iii) of this paragraph) equals
[[Page 152]]
or exceeds the readership costs of such periodical (determined under
subparagraph (6)(iii) of this paragraph), the unrelated business taxable
income attributable to the periodical is the excess of the gross
advertising income of the periodical over direct advertising costs; but
(b) If the readership costs of an exempt organization periodical
exceed the circulation income of the periodical, the unrelated business
taxable income is the excess, if any, of the total income attributable
to the periodical (determined under subparagraph (3) of this paragraph)
over the total periodical costs (as defined in subparagraph (6)(i) of
this paragraph)
See subparagraph (7) of this paragraph for rules relating to the
consolidation of two or more periodicals.
(iii) Examples. The application of this paragraph may be illustrated
by the following examples. For purposes of these examples it is assumed
that the production and distribution of the readership content of the
periodical is related to the organization's exempt purpose.
Example 1. X, an exempt trade association, publishes a single
periodical which carries advertising. During 1971, X realizes a total of
$40,000 from the sale of advertising in the periodical (gross
advertising income) and $60,000 from the sales of the periodical to
members and nonmembers (circulation income). The total periodical costs
are $90,000 of which $50,000 is directly connected with the sale and
publication of advertising (direct advertising costs) and $40,000 is
attributable to the production and distribution of the readership
content (readership costs). Since the direct advertising costs of the
periodical ($50,000) exceed gross advertising income ($40,000), pursuant
to subdivision (i) of this subparagraph, the unrelated business taxable
income attributable to advertising is determined solely on the basis of
the income and deductions directly connected with the production and
sale of the advertising:
Gross advertising revenue.................................. $40,000
Direct advertising costs................................... (50,000)
------------
Loss attributable to advertising........................... (10,000)
============
X has realized a loss of $10,000 from its advertising activity. This
loss is an allowable deduction in computing X's unrelated business
taxable income derived from any other unrelated trade or business
activity.
Example 2. Assume the facts as stated in example 1, except that the
circulation income of X periodical is $100,000 instead of $60,000, and
that of the total periodical costs, $25,000 are direct advertising
costs, and $65,000 are readership costs. Since the circulation income
($100,000) exceeds the total readership costs ($65,000), pursuant to
subdivision (ii)(a) of this subparagraph the unrelated business taxable
income attributable to the advertising activity is $15,000, the excess
of gross advertising income ($40,000) over direct advertising costs
($25,000).
Example 3. Assume the facts as stated in example 1, except that of
the total periodical costs, $20,000 are direct advertising costs and
$70,000 are readership costs. Since the readership costs of the
periodical ($70,000), exceed the circulation income ($60,000), pursuant
to subdivision (ii) (b) of this subparagraph the unrelated business
taxable income attributable to advertising is the excess of the total
income attributable to the periodical over the total periodical costs.
Thus, X has unrelated business taxable income attributable to the
advertising activity of $10,000 ($100,000 total income attributable to
the periodical less $90,000 total periodical costs).
Example 4. Assume the facts as stated in example 1, except that the
total periodical costs are $120,000 of which $30,000 are direct
advertising costs and $90,000 are readership costs. Since the readership
costs of the periodical ($90,000), exceed the circulation income
($60,000), pursuant to subdivision (ii) (b) of this subparagraph the
unrelated business taxable income attributable to advertising is the
excess, if any, of the total income attributable to the periodical over
the total periodical costs. Since the total income of the periodical
($100,000) does not exceed the total periodical costs ($120,000), X has
not derived any unrelated business taxable income from the advertising
activity. Further, only $70,000 of the $90,000 of readership costs may
be deducted in computing unrelated business taxable income since as
provided in subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph, such costs may be
deducted, to the extent they exceed circulation income, only to the
extent they do not result in a loss from the advertising activity. Thus,
there is no loss from such activity, and no amount may be deducted on
this account in computing X's unrelated trade or business income derived
from any other unrelated trade or business activity.
(3) Income attributable to exempt organization periodicals--(i) In
general. For purposes of this paragraph the total income attributable to
an exempt organization periodical is the sum of its gross advertising
income and its circulation income.
(ii) Gross advertising income. The term gross advertising income
means all amounts derived from the unrelated
[[Page 153]]
advertising activities of an exempt organization periodical (or for
purposes of this paragraph in the case of a taxable organization, all
amounts derived from the advertising activities of the taxable
organization).
(iii) Circulation income. The term circulation income means the
income attributable to the production, distribution or circulation of a
periodical (other than gross advertising income) including all amounts
realized from or attributable to the sale or distribution of the
readership content of the periodical, such as amounts realized from
charges made for reprinting or republishing articles and special items
in the periodical and amounts realized from sales of back issues. Where
the right to receive an exempt organization periodical is associated
with membership or similar status in such organization for which dues,
fees or other charges are received (hereinafter referred to as
membership receipts), circulation income includes the portion of such
membership receipts allocable to the periodical (hereinafter referred to
as allocable membership receipts). Allocable membership receipts is the
amount which would have been charged and paid if:
(a) The periodical was that of a taxable organization.
(b) The periodical was published for profit, and
(c) The member was an unrelated party dealing with the taxable
organization at arm's length
See subparagraph (4) of this paragraph for a discussion of the factors
to be considered in determining allocable membership receipts of an
exempt organization periodical under the standard described in the
preceding sentence.
(4) Allocable membership receipts. The allocable membership receipts
of an exempt organization periodical shall be determined in accordance
with the following rules:
(i) Subscription price charged to nonmembers. If 20 percent or more
of the total circulation of a periodical consist of sales to nonmembers,
the subscription price charged to such nonmembers shall determine the
price of the periodical for purposes of allocating membership receipts
to the periodical.
(ii) Subscription price to nonmembers. If paragraph (f)(4)(i) of
this section does not apply and if the membership dues from 20 percent
or more of the members of an exempt organization are less than those
received from the other members because the former members do not
receive the periodical, the amount of the reduction in membership dues
for a member not receiving the periodical shall determine the price of
the periodical for purposes of allocating membership receipts to the
periodical.
(iii) Pro rata allocation of membership receipts. Since it may
generally be assumed that membership receipts and gross advertising
income are equally available for all the exempt activities (including
the periodical) of the organization, the share of membership receipts
allocated to the periodical, where paragraphs (f)(4) (i) and (ii) of
this section do not apply, shall be an amount equal to the
organization's membership receipts multiplied by a fraction the
numerator of which is the total periodical costs and the denominator of
which is such costs plus the cost of other exempt activities of the
organization. For example, assume that an exempt organization has total
periodical costs of $30,000 and other exempt costs of $70,000. Further
assume that the membership receipts of the organization are $60,000 and
that paragraphs (f)(4) (i) and (ii) of this section do not apply. Under
these circumstances $18,000 ($60,000 times $30,000/$100,000) is
allocated to the periodical's circulation income.
(5) Examples. The rules set forth in paragraph (f)(4) of this
section may be illustrated by the following examples. For purposes of
these examples it is assumed that the exempt organization periodical
contains advertising, and that the production and distribution of the
readership content of the periodical is related to the organization's
exempt purpose.
Example 1. U is an exempt scientific organization with 10,000
members who pay annual dues of $15 per year. One of U's activities is
the publication of a monthly periodical which is distributed to all of
its members. U also distributes 5,000 additional copies of its
periodical to nonmember subscribers at a cost of $10 per year. Pursuant
to paragraph (f)(4)(i) of this section, since the nonmember
[[Page 154]]
circulation of U's periodical represents 33\1/3\ percent of its total
circulation the subscription price charged to nonmembers will be used to
determine the portion of U's membership receipts allocable to the
periodical. Thus, U's allocable membership receipts will be $100,000
($10 times 10,000 members), and U's total circulation income for the
periodical will be $150,000 ($100,000 from members plus $50,000 from
sales to nonmembers).
Example 2. Assume the facts as stated in example 1, except that U
sells only 500 copies of its periodical to nonmembers, at a price of $10
per year. Assume further that U's members may elect not to receive the
periodical, in which case their annual dues are reduced from $15 per
year to $6 per year, and that only 3,000 members elect to receive the
periodical and pay the full dues of $15 per year. U's stated
subscription price to members of $9 consistently results in an excess of
total income (including gross advertising income) attributable to the
periodical over total costs of the periodical. Since the 500 copies of
the periodical distributed to nonmembers represents only 14 percent of
the 3,500 copies distributed, pursuant to paragraph (f)(4)(i) of this
section, the $10 subscription price charged to nonmembers will not be
used in determining the portion of membership receipts allocable to the
periodical. On the other hand, since 70 percent of the members elect not
to receive the periodical and pay $9 less per year in dues, pursuant to
paragraph (f)(4)(ii) of this section, such $9 price will be used in
determining the subscription price charged to members. Thus, the
allocable membership receipts will be $9 per member, or $27,000 ($9
times 3,000 copies) and U's total circulation income will be $32,000
($27,000 plus $5,000).
Example 3. (a) W, an exempt trade association, has 800 members who
pay annual dues of $50 per year. W publishes a monthly journal the
editorial content and advertising of which are directed to the business
interests of its own members. The journal is distributed to all of W's
members and no receipts are derived from nonmembers.
(b) W has total receipts of $100,000 of which $40,000 ($50x800) are
membership receipts and $60,000 are gross advertising income. W's total
costs for the journal and other exempt activities is $100,000. W has
total periodical costs of $76,000 of which $41,000 are direct
advertising costs and $35,000 are readership costs.
(c) Paragraph (f)(4)(i) of this section will not apply since no
copies are available to nonmembers. Therefore, the allocation of
membership receipts shall be made in accordance with paragraph
(f)(4)(iii) of this section. Based upon pro rata allocation of
membership receipts (40,000) by a fraction the numerator of which is
total periodical costs ($76,000) and the denominator of which is the
total costs of the journal and the other exempt activities ($100,000),
$30,400 ($76,000/$100,000 times $40,000) of membership receipts is
circulation income.
(6) Deductions attributable to exempt organization periodicals--(i)
In general. For purposes of this paragraph the term total periodical
costs means the total deductions attributable to the periodical. For
purposes of this paragraph the total periodical costs of an exempt
organization periodical are the sum of the direct advertising costs of
the periodical (determined under subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph)
and the readership costs of the periodical (determined under subdivision
(iii) of this subparagraph). Items of deduction properly attributable to
exempt activities other than the publication of an exempt organization
periodical may not be allocated to such periodical. Where items are
attributable both to an exempt organization periodical and to other
activities of an exempt organization, the allocation of such items must
be made on a reasonable basis which fairly reflects the portion of such
item properly attributable to each such activity. The method of
allocation will vary with the nature of the item, but once adopted, a
reasonable method of allocation with respect to an item must be used
consistently. Thus, for example, salaries may generally be allocated
among various activities on the basis of the time devoted to each
activity; occupancy costs such as rent, heat and electricity may be
allocated on the basis of the portion of space devoted to each activity;
and depreciation may be allocated on the basis of space occupied and the
portion of the particular asset utilized in each activity. Allocations
based on dollar receipts from various exempt activities will generally
not be reasonable since such receipts are usually not an accurate
reflection of the costs associated with activities carried on by exempt
organizations.
(ii) Direct advertising costs. (a) The direct advertising costs of
an exempt organization periodical include all expenses, depreciation,
and similar items of deduction which are directly connected with the
sale and publication of advertising as determined in accordance with
paragraphs (a), (b), and (c) of this section. These items are allowable
as deductions in the computation of
[[Page 155]]
unrelated business income of the organization for the taxable year to
the extent they meet the requirements of section 162, section 167, or
other relevant provisions of the Code. The items allowable as deductions
under this subdivision do not include any items of deduction
attributable to the production or distribution of the readership content
of the periodical.
(b) The items allowable as deductions under this subdivision would
include agency commissions and other direct selling costs, such as
transportation and travel expenses, office salaries, promotion and
research expenses, and direct office overhead directly connected with
the sale of advertising lineage in the periodical. Also included would
be other items of deduction commonly classified as advertising costs
under standard account classification, such as art work and copy
preparation, telephone, telegraph, postage, and similar costs directly
connected with advertising.
(c) In addition to the items of deduction normally included in
standard account classifications relating to advertising costs, it is
also necessary to ascertain the portion of mechanical and distribution
costs attributable to advertising lineage. For this purpose, the general
account classifications of items includible in mechanical and
distribution costs ordinarily employed in business-paper and consumer
publication accounting provide a guide for the computation. Thus, the
mechanical and distribution costs in such cases would include the
portion of the costs and other expenses of composition, presswork,
binding, mailing (including paper and wrappers used for mailing), and
the bulk postage attributable to the advertising lineage of the
publication. The portion of mechanical and distribution costs
attributable to advertising lineage of the periodical will be determined
on the basis of the ratio of advertising lineage to total lineage of the
periodical, and the application of that ratio to the total mechanical
and distribution costs of the periodical, where records are not kept in
such a manner as to reflect more accurately the allocation of mechanical
and distributions costs to advertising lineage of the periodical, and
where there is no factor in the character of the periodical to indicate
that such an allocation would be unreasonable.
(iii) Readership costs. The readership costs of an exempt
organization periodical include expenses, depreciation or similar items
which are directly connected with the production and distribution of the
readership content of the periodical and which would otherwise be
allowable as deductions in determining unrelated business taxable income
under section 512 and the regulations thereunder if such production and
distribution constituted an unrelated trade or business activity. Thus,
readership costs include all the items of deduction attributable to an
exempt organization periodical which are not allocated to direct
advertising costs under subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph, including
the portion of such items attributable to the readership content of the
periodical, as opposed to the advertising content, and the portion of
mechanical and distribution costs which is not attributable to
advertising lineage in the periodical.
(7) Consolidation--(i) In general. Where an exempt organization
subject to unrelated business income tax under section 511 publishes two
or more periodicals for the production of income, it may treat the gross
income from all (but not less than all) of such periodicals and the
items of deduction directly connected with such periodicals (including
readership costs of such periodicals), on a consolidated basis as if
such periodicals were one periodical in determining the amount of
unrelated business taxable income derived from the sale of advertising
in such periodical. Such treatment must, however, be followed
consistently and once adopted shall be binding unless the consent of the
Commissioner is obtained as provided in sections 446(e) and Sec. 1.446-
1(e).
(ii) Production of income. For purposes of this subparagraph, an
exempt organization periodical is published for the production of income
if:
(a) The organization generally receives gross advertising income
from the periodical equal to at least 25 percent of the readership costs
of such periodical, and
[[Page 156]]
(b) The publication of such periodical is an activity engaged in for
profit
For purposes of the preceding sentence, the determination whether the
publication of a periodical is an activity engaged in for profit is to
be made by reference to objective standards taking into account all the
facts and circumstances involved in each case. The facts and
circumstances must indicate that the organization carries on the
activity with the objective that the publication of the periodical will
result in economic profit (without regard to tax consequences), although
not necessarily in a particular year. Thus, an exempt organization
periodical may be treated as having been published with such an
objective even though in a particular year its total periodical costs
exceed its total income. Similarly, if an exempt organization begins
publishing a new periodical, the fact that the total periodical costs
exceed the total income for the startup years because of a lack of
advertising sales does not mean that the periodical was published
without an objective of economic profit. The organization may establish
that the activity was carried on with such an objective. This might be
established by showing, for example, that there is a reasonable
expectation that the total income, by reason of an increase in
advertising sales, will exceed costs within a reasonable time. See Sec.
1.183-2 for additional factors bearing on this determination.
(iii) Example. This subparagraph may be illustrated by the following
example:
Example. Y, an exempt trade association, publishes three periodicals
which it distributes to its members: a weekly newsletter, a monthly
magazine, and quarterly journal. Both the monthly magazine and the
quarterly journal contain advertising which accounts for gross
advertising income equal to more than 25 percent of their respective
readership costs. Similarly, the total income attributable to each such
periodical has exceeded the total deductions attributable to each such
periodical for substantially all the years they have been published. The
newsletter carries no advertising and its annual subscription price is
not intended to cover the cost of publication. The newsletter is a
service of Y distributed to all of its members in an effort to keep them
informed of changes occurring in the business world and is not engaged
in for profit. Under these circumstances, Y may consolidate the income
and deductions from the monthly and quarterly journals in computing its
unrelated business taxable income, but may not consolidate the income
and deductions attributable to the publication of the newsletter with
the income and deductions of its other periodicals since the newsletter
is not published for the production of income.
(g) Foreign organizations--(1) In general. The unrelated business
taxable income of a foreign organization exempt from taxation under
section 501(a) consists of:
(i) The organization's unrelated business taxable income which is
derived from sources within the United States but which is not
effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business within the
United States, plus
(ii) The organization's unrelated business taxable income
effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business within the
United States (whether or not such income is derived from sources within
the United States)
To determine whether income realized by a foreign organization is
derived from sources within the United States or is effectively
connected with the conduct of a trade or business within the United
States, see part 1, subchapter N, chapter 1 of the Code (section 861 and
following) and the regulations thereunder.
(2) Effective dates. Subparagraph (1) of this paragraph applies to
taxable years beginning after December 31, 1969. For taxable years
beginning on or before December 31, 1969, the unrelated business taxable
income of a foreign organization exempt from taxation under section
501(a) consists of the organization's unrelated business taxable income
which:
(i) For taxable years beginning after December 31, 1966, is
effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business within the
United States, whether or not such income is derived from sources within
the United States;
(ii) For taxable years beginning on or before December 31, 1966, is
derived from sources within the United States.
(h) Effective date. Paragraphs (a) through (f) of this section are
applicable with respect to taxable years beginning after December 12,
1967. However,
[[Page 157]]
if a taxpayer wishes to rely on the rules stated therein for taxable
years beginning before December 13, 1967, he may do so.
[T.D. 7392, 40 FR 58638, Dec. 18, 1975, as amended by T.D. 7438, 41 FR
44392, Oct. 8, 1976; T.D. 7935, 49 FR 1694, Jan. 13, 1984; T.D. 8991, 67
FR 20437, Apr. 25, 2002]
Sec. 1.512(a)-2 Definition applicable to taxable years beginning before
December 13, 1967.
(a) In general. The unrelated business taxable income which is
subject to the tax imposed by section 511 is the gross income, derived
by any organization to which section 511 applies, from any unrelated
trade or business regularly carried on by it, less the deductions
allowed by chapter 1 of the Code which are directly connected with the
carrying on of such trade or business, subject to certain exceptions,
additions, and limitations referred to below. In the case of an
organization which regularly carries on two or more unrelated
businesses, its unrelated business taxable income is the aggregate of
its gross income from all such unrelated businesses, less the aggregate
of the deductions allowed with respect to all such unrelated businesses.
For provisions generally applicable to the unrelated business tax, see
Sec. 1.511-3, and for rules applicable to the determination of the
adjusted basis of property, see paragraph (a)(2) of Sec. 1.514(a)-1.
(b) Effective date. Except as provided in paragraph (f) of Sec.
1.512(a)-1, this section is applicable with respect to taxable years
beginning before December 13, 1967.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6939, 32 FR
17660, Dec. 12, 1967]
Sec. 1.512(a)-3 [Reserved]
Sec. 1.512(a)-4 Special rules applicable to war veterans organizations.
(a) In general. For taxable years beginning after December 31, 1969,
this section provides special rules for the determination of the
unrelated business taxable income of an organization described in
section 501(c)(19). In general, the rules contained in sections 511
through 514 which are applicable to any organization listed in section
501(c) apply in determining the unrelated business taxable income of an
organization described in section 501(c)(19). However, that amount which
is paid by members to the organization for the purpose described in
paragraph (b)(1) of this section, if set aside from other organizational
monies and accounts in an insurance set aside, may be excluded from the
unrelated business taxable income of the organization. The insurance set
aside shall be used exclusively for providing insurance benefits, for
the purposes specified in section 170(c)(4) of the Code, for the
reasonable costs of administering the insurance program that are
directly related to such set aside, or for the reasonable costs of
distributing funds for section 170(c)(4) purposes. If an amount so set
aside is used for any purposes other than those described in the
preceding sentence, it shall be included in unrelated business taxable
income without regard to any modifications provided by section 512(b),
in the taxable year in which it is withdrawn from such set aside.
Amounts will be considered to have been withdrawn from an insurance set
aside if they are used in any manner inconsistent with providing
insurance benefits, paying the reasonable costs of administering the
insurance program for section 170(c)(4) purposes and for costs of
distributing funds for section 170(c)(4) purposes. An example of a use
of funds which would be considered a withdrawal would be the use of such
funds as security for a loan.
(b) Insurance set aside--(1) Purpose of payments by members.
Payments by members (including commissions on such payments earned by
the set aside as agent for an insurance company) into an insurance set
aside must be for the sole purpose of obtaining life, sick, accident or
health insurance benefits from the organization or for the reasonable
costs of administration of the insurance program, except that such
purpose is not violated when excess funds from an experience gain are
utilized for those purposes specified in section 170(c)(4) or the
reasonable costs of distributing funds for such purposes. Funds for any
other purpose may not be set aside in the insurance set aside.
(2) Income from set aside. In addition to the payments by members
described
[[Page 158]]
in paragraph (b)(1) of this section, only income from amounts in the
insurance set aside (including commissions earned as agent for an
insurance company) may be so set aside. Moreover unless such income is
used for providing insurance benefits, for those purposes specified in
section 170(c)(4), or for reasonable costs of administration, such
income must be set aside within the period described in paragraph (b)(3)
of this section in order to avoid being included as an item of unrelated
business taxable income under section 512(a)(4).
(3) Time within which income must be set aside. Income from amounts
in the insurance set aside generally must be set aside in the taxable
year in which it would be includible in gross income but for this
section. However, income set aside on or before the date prescribed for
filing the organization's return of unrelated business taxable income
(whether or not it had such income) for the taxable year (including any
extension of time) may, at the election of the organization, be treated
as having been set aside in such taxable year.
(4) Computation of income from set aside. Income from amounts in the
insurance set aside shall consist solely of items of investment income
from, and other gains derived from dealings in, property in the set
aside. The deductions allowed against such items of income or other
gains are those amounts which are related to the production of such
income or other gains. Only the amounts of income or other gain which
are in excess of such deductions may be set aside in the insurance set
aside.
(5) Requirements for set aside. An amount is not properly set aside
if the organization commingles it with any amount which is not to be set
aside. However, adequate records describing the amount set aside and
indicating that it is to be used for the designated purpose are
sufficient. Amounts that are set aside need not be permanently committed
to such use either under state law or by contract. Thus, for example, it
is not necessary that the organization place these funds in an
irrevocable trust. Although set aside income may be accumulated, any
accumulation which is unreasonable in amount or duration is evidence
that the income was not accumulated for the purposes set forth. For
purposes of the preceding sentence, accumulations which are reasonably
necessary for the purpose of providing life, sick, health, or accident
insurance benefits on the basis of recognized mortality or morbidity
tables and assumed rates of interest under an actuarially acceptable
method would not be unreasonable even though such accumulations are
quite large and the time between the receipt by the organization of such
amounts and the date of payment of the benefits is quite long. For
example, an accumulation of income for 20 years or longer which is
determined to be reasonable necessary to pay life insurance benefits to
members, their dependents or designated beneficiaries, generally would
not be an unreasonable accumulation. Income which has been set aside may
be invested, pending the action contemplated by the set aside, without
being regarded as having been used for other purposes.
[T.D. 7438, 41 FR 44393, Oct. 8, 1976]
Sec. 1.512(a)-5T Questions and answers relating to the unrelated
business taxable income of organizations described in paragraphs (9),
(17) or (20) of Section 501(c) (temporary).
Q-1: What does section 512(a)(3), as amended by the Tax Reform Act
of 1984 (Act), provide with respect to organizations described in
paragraphs (9), (17) or (20) of section 501(c)?
A-1: In general, section 512(a)(3), as amended by section 511 of the
Act, extends the rules for determining the unrelated business income tax
of voluntary employees' beneficiary associations (VEBAs) to supplemental
unemployment compensation benefit trusts (SUBs) and group legal service
organizations (GLSOs). The section also restricts the amount of income
that may be set aside by such organizations for exempt purposes.
Q-2: What is the effective date of the amendments to section
512(a)(3)?
A-2: The amendments to section 512(a)(3) will apply to income earned
by VEBAs, SUBs or GLSOs after December 31, 1985, in the taxable years of
such organizations ending after such date. For purposes of applying
section 512(a)(3) to the first taxable year of such an organization
ending after December 31, 1985, the income of the VEBA, SUB or GLSO
earned after December 31, 1985, will be determined by allocating the
total income earned
[[Page 159]]
for such taxable year on the basis of the calendar year 1985 and 1986
months in such taxable year. However, if a VEBA, SUB or GLSO is part of
a plan that is maintained pursuant to one or more collective bargaining
agreements (a) between employee representatives and one or more
employers, and (b) which are in effect on July 1, 1985 (or ratified on
or before that date), the amendments do not apply to income earned in a
taxable year of a VEBA, SUB or GLSO beginning before the termination of
the last of the collective bargaining agreements pursuant to which the
plan is maintained (determined without regard to any extension of the
contract agreed to after July 1, 1985). For purposes of the preceding
sentence, any plan amendment made pursuant to a collective bargaining
agreement relating to the plan which amends the plan solely to conform
to any requirement added under section 511 of the Tax Reform Act 1984
(i.e., requirements under section 419, 419A, 512(a)(3)(E), and 4976)
shall not be treated as a termination of such collective bargaining
agreements.
Q-3: What amount of income may a VEBA, SUB or GLSO set aside for
exempt purposes?
A-3: (a) Pursuant to section 512(a)(3)(E)(i), the amounts set aside
in a VEBA, SUB, or GLSO (including a VEBA, SUB, or GLSO that is part of
a 10 or more employer plan, as defined in section 419A(f)(6)(B)) as of
the close of a taxable year of such VEBA, SUB, or GLSO to provide for
the payment of life, sick, accident, or other benefits may not be taken
into account for purposes of determining exempt function income to the
extent that such amounts exceed the qualified asset account limit,
determined under sections 419A(c) and 419A(f)(7), for such taxable year
of the VEBA, SUB, or GLSO. In calculating the qualified asset account
limit for this purpose, a reserve for post-retirement medical benefits
under section 419A(c)(2)(A) is not to be taken into account.
(b) The exempt function income of a VEBA, SUB, or GLSO for a taxable
year of such an organization, under section 512(a)(3)(B), includes: (1)
Certain amounts paid by members of the VEBA, SUB, or GLSO within the
meaning of the first sentence of section 512(a)(3)(B) (member
contributions); and (2) other income of the VEBA, SUB, or GLSO
(including earnings on member contributions) that is set aside for the
payment of life, sick, accident, or other benefits to the extent that
the total amount set aside in the VEBA, SUB or GLSO as of the close of
the taxable year for any purpose (including member contributions and
other income set aside in the VEBA, SUB, or GLSO as of the close of the
year) does not exceed the qualified asset account limit for such taxable
year of the organization. For purposes of section 512(a)(3)(B), member
contributions include both employee contributions and employer
contributions to the VEBA, SUB, or GLSO. In calculating the total amount
set aside in a VEBA, SUB, or GLSO as of the close of a taxable year,
certain assets with useful lives extending substantially beyond the end
of the taxable year (e.g., buildings, and licenses) are not to be taken
into account to the extent they are used in the provision of life, sick,
accident, or other benefits. For example, cash and securities (and
similar investments) held by a VEBA, SUB or GLSO are not disregarded in
calculating the total amount set aside for this purpose because they are
used to pay welfare benefits, rather than merely used in the provision
of such benefits. Accordingly, the unrelated business taxable income of
a VEBA, SUB, or GLSO for a taxable year of such an organization
generally will equal the lesser of two amounts: the income of the VEBA,
SUB, or GLSO for the taxable year (excluding member contributions); or,
the excess of the total amount set aside as of the close of the taxable
year (including member contributions, and excluding certain assets with
a useful life extending substantially beyond the end of the taxable year
to the extent they are used in the provision of welfare benefits) over
the qualified asset account limit (calculated without regard to the
otherwise permitted reserve for post-retirement medical benefits) for
the taxable year. See Sec. 1.419A-2T for special rules relating to
collectively bargained welfare benefit funds.
(c) The income of a VEBA, SUB, or GLSO for any taxable year includes
gain realized by the organization on the sale or disposition of any
asset during such year. The gain realized by a VEBA, SUB, or GLSO on the
sale or disposition of an asset is equal to the amount realized by the
organization over the basis of such asset (in the hands of the
organization), reduced by any qualified direct costs attributable to
such asset (under paragraphs (b), (c), and (d) of Q&A-6 of Sec. 1.419-
1T).
Q-4: What transition rules apply to existing reserves for post-
retirement medical or life insurance benefits?
A-4: (a) Section 512(a)(3)(E)(iii)(I) provides that income that is
either directly or indirectly attributable to existing reserves for
post-retirement medical or life insurance benefits will not be treated
as unrelated business taxable income. An existing reserve for post-
retirement medical or life insurance benefits (as defined in section
512(a)(3)(E)(iii)(II)) is the total amount of assets actually set aside
in a VEBA, SUB, or GLSO on July 18, 1984 (calculated in the manner set
forth in Q&A-3 of the regulation, and adjusted under paragraph (c) of
Q&A-11 of Sec. 1.419-1T), reduced by employer contributions to the fund
on or before such date to the extent such contributions are not
deductible for the taxable year of the employer containing July 18,
1984, and for any prior taxable year of the employer, for purposes of
providing such post-retirement
[[Page 160]]
benefits. For purposes of the preceding sentence only, an amount that
was not actually set aside on July 18, 1984, will be treated as having
been actually set aside on such date if (1) such amount was incurred by
the employer (without regard to section 461(h)) as of the close of the
last taxable year of the VEBA, SUB, or GLSO ending before July 18, 1984,
and (2) such amount was actually contributed to the VEBA, SUB, or GLSO
within 8\1/2\ months following the close of such taxable year.
(b) In addition, section 512(a)(3)(E)(iii)(I) applies to existing
reserves for such post-retirement benefits only to the extent that such
existing reserves do not exceed the amount that could be accumulated
under the principles set forth in Revenue Rulings 69-382, 1969-2, C.B.
28; 69-478, 1969-2 C.B. 29; and 73-599, 1973-2 C.B. 40. Thus, amounts
attributable to such excess existing reserves are not within this
transition rule eventhough they were actually set aside on July 18,
1984.
(c) All post-retirement medical or life insurance benefits (or other
benefits to the extent paid with amounts set aside to provide post-
retirement medical or life insurance benefits) provided after July 18,
1984 (whether or not the employer has maintained a reserve or fund for
such benefits) are to be charged, first, against the existing reserves
within this transition rule (including amounts attributable to existing
reserves within this transition rule) for post-retirement medical
benefits or for post-retirement life insurance benefits (as the case may
be) and, second, against all other amounts. For this purpose, the
qualified direct cost of an asset with a useful life extending
substantially beyond the end of the taxable year (as determined under
Q&A-6 of Sec. 1.419-1T) will be treated as a benefit provided and thus
charged against the existing reserve based on the extent to which such
asset is used in the provision of post-retirement medical benefits or
post-retirement life insurance benefits (as the case may be). All plans
of an employer providing post-retirement medical benefits are to be
treated as one plan for purposes of section 512(a)(3)(E)(iii)(III), and
all plans of an employer providing post-retirement life insurance
benefits are to be treated as one plan for purposes of section
512(a)(3)(E)(iii)(III).
(d) In calculating the unrelated business taxable income of a VEBA,
SUB, or GLSO for a taxable year of such organization, the total income
of the VEBA, SUB, or GLSO for the taxable year is reduced by the income
attributable to existing reserves within the transition rule before such
income is compared to the excess of the total amount set aside as of the
close of the taxable year over the qualified asset account limit for the
taxable year. Thus, for example, assume that the total income of a VEBA
for a taxable year is $1,000, and that the excess of the total amount of
the VEBA set aside as of the close of the taxable year over the
applicable qualified asset account limit is $600. Assume also that of
the $1,000 of total income, $500 is attributable to existing reserves
within the transition rule of section 512(a)(3)(E)(iii)(I). The
unrelated business income of this VEBA for the taxable year is equal to
the lesser of the following two amounts: (1) the total income of the
VEBA for the taxable year ($1,000), reduced to the extent that such
income is attributable to existing reserves within the transition rule
($500); or (2) the excess of the total amount set aside as of the close
of the taxable year over the applicable qualified asset account limit
($600). Thus, the unrelated business income of this VEBA for the taxable
year is $500.
[T.D. 8073, 51 FR 4332, Feb. 4, 1986; 51 FR 7262, Mar. 3, 1986; 51 FR
11303, Apr. 2, 1986; T.D. 8073, 73 FR 59501, Oct. 9, 2008]
Sec. 1.512(b)-1 Modifications.
Whether a particular item of income falls within any of the
modifications provided in section 512(b) shall be determined by all the
facts and circumstances of each case. For example, if a payment termed
rent by the parties is in fact a return of profits by a person operating
the property for the benefit of the tax-exempt organization or is a
share of the profits retained by such organization as a partner or joint
venturer, such payment is not within the modification for rents. The
modifications provided in section 512(b) are as follows:
(a) Certain Investment Income--(1) In general. Dividends, interest,
payments with respect to securities loans (as defined in section
512(a)(5)), annuities, income from notional principal contracts (as
defined in Treasury Regulations 26 CFR 1.863-7 or regulations issued
under section 446), other substantially similar income from ordinary and
routine investments to the extent determined by the Commissioner, and
all deductions directly connected with any of the foregoing items of
income shall be excluded in computing unrelated business taxable income.
(2) Limitations. The exclusions under paragraph (a)(1) of this
section do not apply to income derived from and deductions in connection
with debt-financed property (as defined in section 514(b)). Moreover,
the exclusions under paragraph (a)(1) of this section do not apply to
gains or losses from the sale,
[[Page 161]]
exchange, or other disposition of any property, or to gains or losses
from the lapse or termination of options to buy or sell securities. For
rules regarding the treatment of these gains and losses, see section
512(b)(5) and Sec. 1.512(b)-1(d). Furthermore, the exclusions under
paragraph (a)(1) of this section do not apply to interest and annuities
derived from and deductions in connection with controlled organizations.
For rules regarding the treatment of such amounts, see section
512(b)(13) and Sec. 1.512(b)-1(l). Finally, the exclusions under
paragraph (a)(1) of this section of income from notional principal
contracts and income that the Commissioner determines to be
substantially similar income from ordinary and routine investments do
not apply to income earned by brokers or dealers (including
organizations that make a market in derivative financial products, as
described in Treasury Regulations 26 CFR 1.954-2T(a)(4)(iii)(B)).
(3) Effective dates. The effective dates of the rules of paragraphs
(a)(1) and (a)(2) of this section that were in effect prior to August
30, 1991, remain the same. The exclusion under paragraph (a)(1) of this
section of income from notional principal contracts is effective for
amounts received after August 30, 1991. However, an organization may
apply the exclusion under paragraph (a)(1) of this section of income
from notional principal contracts prior to that date, provided that such
amounts are treated consistently for all open taxable years. Unless
otherwise provided by the Commissioner, the exclusion under paragraph
(a)(1) of this section of income that the Commissioner determines to be
substantially similar income from ordinary and routine investments is
effective for amounts received after the date of the Commissioner's
determination.
(b) Royalties. Royalties, including overriding royalties, and all
deductions directly connected with such income shall be excluded in
computing unrelated business taxable income. However, for taxable years
beginning after December 31, 1969, certain royalties from and certain
deductions in connection with either, debt-financed property (as defined
in section 514(b)) or controlled organizations (as defined in paragraph
(l) of this section) shall be included in computing unrelated business
taxable income. Mineral royalties shall be excluded whether measured by
production or by gross or taxable income from the mineral property.
However, where an organization owns a working interest in a mineral
property, and is not relieved of its share of the development costs by
the terms of any agreement with an operator, income received from such
an interest shall not be excluded. To the extent not treated as a loan
under section 636, payments in discharge of mineral production payments
shall be treated in the same manner as royalty payments for the purpose
of computing unrelated business taxable income. To the extent treated as
a loan under section 636, the amount of any payment in discharge of a
production payment which is the equivalent of interest shall be treated
as interest for purposes of section 512(b)(1) and paragraph (a) of this
section.
(c) Rents--(1) Taxable years beginning before January 1, 1970. For
taxable years beginning before January 1, 1970, rents from real property
(including personal property leased with the real property) and the
deductions directly connected therewith shall be excluded in computing
unrelated business taxable income, except that certain rents from, and
certain deductions in connection with, a business lease (as defined in
section 514(f)) shall be included in computing unrelated business
taxable income. See subparagraph (5) of this paragraph for rules
governing amounts received for the rendering of services.
(2) Taxable years beginning after December 31, 1969--(i) In general.
For taxable years beginning after December 31, 1969, except as provided
in subdivision (iii) of this subparagraph, rents from property described
in subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph, and the deductions directly
connected therewith, shall be excluded in computing unrelated business
taxable income. However, notwithstanding subdivision (ii) of this
subparagraph, certain rents from and certain deductions in connection
with either debt-financed property (as defined in section 514(b)) or
property rented to controlled organizations (as defined in paragraph (l)
of this section)
[[Page 162]]
shall be included in computing unrelated business taxable income.
(ii) Excluded rents. The rents which are excluded from unrelated
business income under section 512(b)(3)(A) and this paragraph are:
(a) Real property. All rents from real property; and
(b) Personal property. All rents from personal property leased with
real property if the rents attributable to such personal property are an
incidental amount of the total rents received or accrued under the
lease, determined at the time sonal property are an incidental amount
service by the lessee
For purposes of the preceding sentence, rents attributable to personal
property generally are not an incidental amount of the total rents if
such rents exceed 10 percent of the total rents from all the property
leased. For example, if the rents attributable to the personal property
leased are determined to be $3,000 per year, and the total rents from
all property leased are $10,000 per year, then such $3,000 amount is not
to be excluded from the computation of unrelated business taxable income
by operation of section 512(b)(3)(A)(ii) and this paragraph, since such
amount is not an incidental portion of the total rents.
(iii) Exception. Subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph shall not
apply, if either:
(a) Excess personal property rents. More than 50 percent of the
total rents are attributable to personal property, determined at the
time such personal property is first placed in service by the lessee; or
(b) Net profits. The determination of the amount of such rents
depends in whole or in part on the income or profits derived by any
person from the property leased, other than an amount based on a fixed
percentage or percentages of the gross receipts or sales. For purposes
of the preceding sentence, the rules contained in paragraph (b) (3) and
(6) (other than paragraph (b)(6)(ii)) of Sec. 1.856-4 shall apply.
(iv) Illustration. This subparagraph may be illustrated by the
following example:
Example. A, an exempt organization, owns a printing factory which
consists of a building housing two printing presses and other equipment
necessary for printing. On January 1, 1971, A rents the building and the
printing equipment to B for $10,000 a year. The lease states that $9,000
of such rent is for the building and $1,000 for the printing equipment.
However, it is determined that notwithstanding the terms of the lease
$4,000, or 40 percent ($4,000/$10,000), of the rent is actually
attributable to the printing equipment. During 1971, A has $3,000 of
deductions, all of which are properly allocable to the land and
building. Under these circumstances, A shall not take into account in
computing its unrelated business taxable income the $6,000 of rent
attributable to the building and the $3,000 of deductions directly
connected with such rent. However, the $4,000 of rent attributable to
the printing equipment is not excluded from the computation of A's
unrelated business taxable income by operation of section
512(b)(3)(A)(ii) or this paragraph since such rent represents more than
an incidental portion of the total rents.
(3) Definitions and special rules. For purposes of subparagraph (2)
of this paragraph:
(i) Real property defined. The term real property means all real
property, including any property described in sections 1245(a)(3)(C) and
1250(c) and the regulations thereunder.
(ii) Personal property defined. The term personal property means all
personal property, including any property described in section
1245(a)(3)(B) and the regulations thereunder.
(iii) Multiple leases. If separate leases are entered into with
respect to real and personal property, and such properties have an
integrated use (e.g., one or more leases for real property and another
lease or leases for personal property to be used upon such real
property), all such leases shall be considered as one lease.
(iv) Placed in service. Property is placed in service by the lessee
when it is first subject to his use in accordance with the terms of the
lease. For example, property subject to a lease entered into on November
1, 1971, for a term commencing on January 1, 1972, shall be considered
as placed in service on January 1, 1972, regardless of when the property
is first actually used by the lessee.
(v) Changes in rent charged or personal property rented. If:
(a) By reason of the placing of additional or substitute personal
property in service, there is an increase of 100
[[Page 163]]
percent or more in the rent attributable to all the personal property
leased, or
(b) There is a modification of the lease by which there is a change
in the rent charged (whether or not there is a change in the amount of
personal property rented), the rent attributable to personal property
shall be recomputed to determine whether the exclusion under
subparagraph (2)(ii)(b) of this paragraph or the exception under
subparagraph (2)(iii)(a) of this paragraph applies. Any change in the
treatment of rents, attributable to a recomputation under this
subdivision, shall be effective only with respect to rents for the
period beginning with the event which occasioned the recomputation.
(4) Examples. Subparagraphs (2) and (3) of this paragraph may be
illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. On January 1, 1971, A, an exempt organization, executes
two leases with B. One is for the rental of a computer, with a stated
annual rent of $750. The other is for the rental of office space in
which to use the computer, at a stated annual rent of $7,250. The total
annual rent under both leases for 1971 is $8,000. At the time the
computer is first placed in service, however, taking both leases into
consideration, it is determined that notwithstanding the terms of the
leases $3,000, or 37.5 percent ($3,000/$8,000), of the rent is actually
attributable to the computer. Therefore, for 1971, only the $5,000
($8,000-$3,000) attributable to the rental of the office space is
excluded from the computation of A's unrelated business taxable income
by operation of section 512(b)(3).
Example 2. Assume the facts as stated in example 1. Assume further
that the leases to which the computer and office space are subject in
example 1 provide that the rent may be increased or decreased, depending
upon the prevailing rental value for similar computers and office space.
On January 1, 1972, the total annual rent is increased in the computer
lease to $2,000, and in the office space lease to $9,000. For 1972, it
is determined that notwithstanding the terms of the leases $6,000, or
54.5 percent ($6,000/$11,000), of the total rent is actually
attributable to the computer as of that time. Even though the rent
attributable to personal property now exceeds 50 percent of the total
rent, the rent attributable to real property will continue to be
excluded, since there was no modification of the terms of the leases and
since the increase in the rent was not attributable to the placing of
new personal property in service. See subparagraph (3)(v) of this
paragraph. Thus, for 1972 the $5,000 of rent attributable to the office
space continues to be excluded from the computation of A's unrelated
business taxable income by operation of section 512(b)(3).
Example 3. Assume the facts as stated in example 1, except that on
January 1, 1973, B rents a second computer from A, which is placed in
service on that date. The total rent is increased to $2,000 for the
computer lease and to $10,000 for the office space lease. It is
determined at the time the second computer is first placed in service
that notwithstanding the terms of the leases $7,000 of the rent is
actually attributable to the computers. Since the rent attributable to
personal property has increased by more than 100 percent ($4,000/
$3,000=133 percent), a redetermination must be made pursuant to
subparagraph (3)(v) (a) of this paragraph. As a result, 58.3 percent
($7,000/$12,000) of the total rent is determined to be attributable to
personal property. Accordingly, since more than 50 percent of the total
rent A receives is attributable to the personal property leased, none of
the rents are excluded from the computation of A's unrelated business
taxable income by operation of section 512(b)(3).
Example 4. Assume the facts as stated in example 3, except that on
June 30, 1975, the lease between B and A is modified. The total rent for
the computer lease is reduced to $1,500 and the total rent for the
office space lease is reduced to $7,500. Pursuant to subdivision
(3)(v)(b) of this paragraph, a redetermination is made as of June 30,
1975. As of the modification date, it is determined that notwithstanding
the terms of the leases, the rent actually attributable to the computers
is $4,000, or 44.4 percent ($4,000/$9,000), of the total rent. Since
less than 50 percent of the total rent is now attributable to personal
property, the rent attributable to real property ($5,000), for periods
after June 30, 1975, is excluded from the computation of A's unrelated
business taxable income by operation of section 512(b)(3). However, the
rent attributable to personal property ($4,000) is not excluded from
unrelated business taxable income for such periods by operation of
section 512(b)(3), since it represents more than an incidental portion
of the total rent.
(5) Rendering of services. For purposes of this paragraph, payments
for the use or occupancy of rooms and other space where services are
also rendered to the occupant, such as for the use or occupancy of rooms
or other quarters in hotels, boarding houses, or apartment houses
furnishing hotel services, or in tourist camps or tourist homes, motor
courts, or motels, or for the use of occupancy of space in parking lots,
warehouses, or storage garages, does not constitute rent from real
property.
[[Page 164]]
Generally, services are considered rendered to the occupant if they are
primarily for his convenience and are other than those usually or
customarily rendered in connection with the rental of rooms or other
space for occupancy only. The supplying of maid service, for example,
constitutes such service; whereas the furnishing of heat and light, the
cleaning of public entrances, exists, stairways, and lobbies, the
collection of trash, etc., are not considered as services rendered to
the occupant. Payments for the use or occupancy of entire private
residences or living quarters in duplex or multiple housing units, of
offices in any office building, etc., are generally treated as rent from
real property.
(d)(1) Gains and losses from the sale, etc. of property. There shall
also be excluded from the computation of unrelated business taxable
income gains or losses from the sale, exchange, or other disposition of
property other than (i) stock in trade or other property of a kind which
would properly be included in the inventory of the organization if on
hand at the close of the taxable year, or (ii) property held primarily
for sale to customers in the ordinary course of the trade or business.
This exclusion does not apply with respect to the cutting of timber
which is considered, upon the application of section 631(a), as a sale
or exchange of such timber. In addition, for taxable years beginning
after December 31, 1969, this exclusion does not apply to the gain
derived from the sale or other disposition of debt-financed property (as
defined in section 514(b)). Otherwise, the exclusion under section
512(b)(5) applies with respect to gains and losses from involuntary
conversions, casualties, etc.
(2) There shall be excluded from the computation of unrelated
business taxable income any gain from the lapse or termination after
December 31, 1975, of options to buy or sell securities (as that term is
defined in section 1236(c)). An option is considered terminated when the
organization's obligation under the option ceases by any means other
than by reason of the exercise or lapse of such option. If the exclusion
is otherwise available it will apply whether or not the organization
owns the securities upon which the option is written, that is, whether
or not the option is covered. However, income from the lapse or
termination of an option is excludable only if the option is written in
connection with the organization's investment activities. Thus, for
example, if the securities upon which the options are written are held
by the organization as inventory or for sale to customers in the
ordinary course of a trade or business, the income from the lapse or
termination will not be excludable under the provisions of this
paragraph. Similarly, if an organization is engaged in the trade or
business of writing options (whether or not such options are covered)
the exclusion will not be available.
(e) Net operating losses. (1) The net operating loss deduction
provided in section 172 shall be allowed in computing unrelated business
taxable income. However, the net operating loss carryback or carryover
(from a taxable year for which the taxpayer is subject to the provisions
of section 511) shall be determined under section 172 without taking
into account any amount of income or deduction which is not included
under section 511 in computing unrelated business taxable income. For
example, a loss attributable to an unrelated trade or business shall not
be diminished by reason of the receipt of dividend income.
(2) For the purpose of computing the net operating loss deduction
provided by section 172, any prior taxable year for which an
organization was not subject to the provisions of section 511, or a
corresponding provision of prior law, shall not be taken into account.
Thus, if the organization was not subject to the provisions of section
511 or supplement U of the Internal Revenue Code of 1939 for a preceding
taxable year, the net operating loss is not a carryback to such
preceding taxable year, and the net operating loss carryover to
succeeding taxable years is not reduced by the taxable income for such
preceding taxable year.
(3) A net operating loss carryback or carryover shall be allowed
only from a taxable year for which the taxpayer is subject to the
provisions of section 511, or a corresponding provision of prior law.
[[Page 165]]
(4) In determining the span of years for which a net operating loss
may be carried for purposes of section 172, taxable years in which an
organization was not subject to the provisions of section 511 or a
corresponding provision of prior law shall be taken into account. Thus,
for example, if an organization is subject to the provisions of section
511 for the taxable year 1955 and has a net operating loss for that
year, the last taxable year to which any part thereof may be carried
over is the year 1960 regardless of whether the organization is subject
to the provisions of section 511 in any of the intervening taxable
years.
(f) Research. (1) Income derived from research for the United States
or any of its agencies or instrumentalities or a State or political
subdivision thereof, and all deductions directly connected with such
income, shall be excluded in computing unrelated business taxable
income.
(2) In the case of a college, university, or hospital, all income
derived from research performed for any person and all deductions
directly connected with such income, shall be excluded in computing
unrelated business taxable income.
(3) In the case of an organization operated primarily for the
purpose of carrying on fundamental research (as distinguished from
applied research) the results of which are freely available to the
general public, all income derived from research performed for any
person and all deductions directly connected with such income shall be
excluded in computing unrelated business taxable income.
(4) For the purpose of Sec. Sec. 1.512(a)-1, 1.512(a)-2, and this
section, the term research does not include activities of a type
ordinarily carried on as an incident to commercial or industrial
operations, for example, the ordinary testing or inspection of materials
or products or the designing or construction of equipment, buildings,
etc. The term fundamental research does not include research carried on
for the primary purpose of commercial or industrial application.
(g) Charitable, etc., contributions. (1) In computing the unrelated
business taxable income of an organization described in section
511(a)(2) the deduction from gross income allowed by section 170
(relating to charitable contributions and gifts) shall be allowed,
whether or not the contribution is directly connected with the carrying
on of the trade or business. Section 512(b)(10) provides that this
deduction shall not exceed 5 percent of the organization's unrelated
business taxable income computed without regard to that deduction. The
provisions of section 170(b)(2) are not applicable to contributions by
the organizations described in section 511(a)(2).
(2) In computing the unrelated business taxable income of a trust
described in section 511(b)(2), the deduction allowed by section 170
(relating to charitable contributions and gifts) shall be allowed
whether or not the contribution is directly connected with the carrying
on of the trade or business. The deduction is limited as provided in
section 170(b)(1) (A) and (B), except that the amounts so allowed are
determined on the basis of unrelated business taxable income computed
without regard to this deduction (rather than on the basis of adjusted
gross income). For purposes of this deduction, a distribution by a trust
described in section 511(b)(2) made pursuant to the trust instrument to
a beneficiary described in section 170 shall be treated in the same
manner as gifts or contributions.
(3) The contribution, whether made by a trust or other exempt
organization, must be paid to another organization to be allowable. For
example, a university described in section 501(c)(3) which is exempt
from tax and which operates an unrelated business, shall be allowed a
deduction, not in excess of 5 percent of its unrelated business taxable
income, for gifts or contributions to another university described in
section 501(c)(3) for educational work but shall not be allowed any
deduction for amounts expended in administering its own educational
program.
(h) Specific deduction--(1) In general. In computing unrelated
business taxable income a specific deduction from gross income of $1,000
is allowed. However, for taxable years beginning after December 31,
1969, such specific deduction is not allowed in computing the
[[Page 166]]
net operating loss under section 172 and paragraph (6) of section
512(b).
(2) Special rule for a diocese, province of a religious order, or a
convention or association of churches. (i) In the case of a diocese,
province of a religious order, or a convention or association of
churches, there shall be allowed with respect to each parish, individual
church, district, or other local unit a specific deduction equal to the
lower of $1,000 or the gross income derived from an unrelated trade or
business regularly conducted by such local unit. However, a diocese,
province of a religious order, or a convention or association of
churches shall not be entitled to a specific deduction for a local unit
which, for a taxable year, files a separate return. In the case of a
local unit which, for a taxable year, files a separate return, such
local unit may claim a specific deduction equal to the lower of $1,000
or the gross income derived from any unrelated trade or business which
it regularly conducts.
(ii) The provisions of this subparagraph may be illustrated by the
following example:
Example. X is an association of churches on the calendar year basis.
X is divided into local units A, B, C, and D. During 1973, A, B, C, and
D derive gross income of, respectively, $1,200, $800, $1,500, and $700
from unrelated businesses which they regularly conduct. Furthermore, for
such taxable year, D files a separate return. X may claim a specific
deduction of $1,000 with respect to A, $800 with respect to B, and
$1,000 with respect to C. X may not claim a specific deduction with
respect to D. D, however, may claim a specific deduction of $700 on its
return.
(i) Transitional period for churches. (1)(i) In the case of an
unrelated trade or business (as defined in section 513) carried on
before May 27, 1969, by a church or convention or association of
churches (as defined in Sec. 1.511-2(a)(3)(ii)), or by the predecessor
of a church or convention or association of churches which predecessor
was itself a church or convention or association of churches, all gross
income derived from such unrelated trade or business and all deductions
directly connected with the carrying on of such unrelated trade or
business shall be excluded from the determination of unrelated business
taxable income under section 512(a) for all taxable years beginning
before January 1, 1976. Notwithstanding the preceding sentence, in the
case of income from debt-financed property (and the deductions
attributable thereto), as defined in section 514, of a church or
convention or association of churches or by the predecessor of a church
or convention or association of churches, the provisions of paragraphs
(a) through (e) of section 514 and paragraph (4) of section 512(b) shall
apply for taxable years beginning after December 31, 1969.
(ii) The provisions of subdivision (i) may be illustrated by the
following example:
Example. X, a church as defined in Sec. 1.511-2(a)(3)(ii), realizes
gross income from an unrelated business (as defined in section 513) of
$100,000 for calendar year 1972. X's predecessor church, Y, began
conducting such unrelated business in January 1, 1968. Of the $100,000
realized for calendar year 1972, $40,000 is attributable to debt-
financed property (as defined in section 514). Since the unrelated
business was conducted by Y prior to May 27, 1969, and since X's taxable
year begins before January 1, 1976, that amount of the income realized
from such business (and all deductions directly connected therewith)
which is not attributable to debt-financed property shall be excluded
from the determination of unrelated business taxable income under
section 512(a). Therefore, of the $100,000 realized, $60,000 ($100,000
less $40,000 attributable to debt-financed property), and all deductions
directly connected therewith shall be excluded from the determination of
such unrelated business taxable income for purposes of imposition of the
tax under section 511(a). The remaining $40,000 and the deductions
attributable thereto shall be subject to the provisions of paragraphs
(a) through (e) of section 514 and paragraph (4) of section 512(b).
(2) This paragraph shall not apply in the case of income from
property, or deductions directly connected with such income, if title to
the property is held by a corporation described in section 501(c)(2) for
a church or convention or association of churches. Thus, if such income
is derived from an unrelated trade or business, the corporation shall be
liable for tax imposed by section 511(a) on such income.
(j) Special rule for certain unrelated trades or businesses carried
on by a religious order or by an educational institution maintained by
such order. (1) Except as provided in subparagraph (2) of this
[[Page 167]]
paragraph, gross income realized by a religious order (or an educational
organization described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(ii) maintained by such
order) from an unrelated trade or business, together with all deductions
directly connected therewith, shall be excluded from the determination
of unrelated business taxable income under section 512(a), if:
(i) The trade or business has been operated by such order or by such
institution since before May 27, 1959,
(ii) The trade or business consists of providing services under a
license issued by a Federal regulatory agency,
(iii) More than 90 percent of the net income from the business is,
for each taxable year for which gross income from such business is so
excluded by reason of section 512(b)(15) and this paragraph, devoted to
religious, charitable, or educational purposes, and
(iv) It is established to the satisfaction of an officer no lower
than the Regional Commissioner that the rates or other charges for such
services are fully competitive with rates or other charges charged for
such services by persons not exempt from taxation. Rates or other
charges for such services shall be considered as fully competitive with
rates or other charges charged for such services by persons not exempt
from taxation if the rates charged by such unrelated trade or business
are neither materially higher nor materially lower than the rates
charged by similar businesses operating in the same general area.
(2) The provisions of this paragraph shall not apply with respect to
income from debt-financed property (as defined in section 514) and the
deductions attributable thereto. For taxable years beginning after
December 31, 1969, such income and deductions are subject to the
provisions of paragraphs (a) through (e) of section 514 and paragraph
(4) of section 512(b).
(k) Income and deductions from debt-financed property. For taxable
years beginning after December 31, 1969, in the case of debt-financed
property (as defined in section 514(b)), there shall be included in the
unrelated business taxable income of an exempt organization, as an item
of gross income derived from an unrelated trade or business, the amount
of unrelated debt-financed income determined under section 514(a)(1) and
Sec. 1.514(a)-1(a), and there shall be allowed, as a deduction with
respect to such income, the amount determined under section 514(a)(2)
and Sec. 1.514(a)-1(b).
(l) Interest, annuities, royalties, and rents from controlled
organizations--(1) In general. For taxable years beginning after
December 31, 1969, if an exempt organization (hereinafter referred to as
the controlling organization) has control (as defined in subparagraph
(4) of this paragraph) of another organization (hereinafter referred to
as the controlled organization), the controlling organization shall
include as an item of gross income in computing its unrelated business
taxable income, the amount of interest, annuities, royalties, and rents
derived from the controlled organization determined under subparagraph
(2) or (3) of this paragraph. The preceding sentence shall apply whether
or not the activity conducted by the controlling organization to derive
such amounts represents a trade or business or is regularly carried on.
Thus, amounts received by a controlling organization from the rental of
its real property to a controlled organization may be included in the
unrelated business taxable income of the controlling organization, even
though the rental of such property is not an activity regularly carried
on by the controlling organization.
(2) Exempt controlled organization--(i) In general. If the
controlled organization is exempt from taxation under section 501(a),
the amount referred to in subparagraph (1) of this paragraph is an
amount which bears the same ratio to the interest, annuities, royalties,
and rents received by the controlling organization from the controlled
organization as the unrelated business taxable income of the controlled
organization bears to whichever of the following amounts is the greater:
(a) The taxable income of the controlled organization, computed as
though the controlled organization were not exempt from taxation under
section 501(a), or
(b) The unrelated business taxable income of the controlled
organization
[[Page 168]]
both determined without regard to any amounts paid directly or
indirectly to the controlling organization. The controlling organization
shall be allowed all deductions directly connected with amounts included
in gross income under the preceding sentence.
(ii) Examples. This subparagraph may be illustrated by the following
examples:
Example 1. A, an exempt scientific organization described in section
501(c)(3), owns all the stock of B, another exempt scientific
organization described in section 501(c)(3). During 1971, A rents space
for a laboratory to B for $15,000 a year. A's total deductions for 1971
with respect to the leased property are $3,000: $1,000 for maintenance
and $2,000 for depreciation. If B were not an exempt organization, its
total taxable income would be $300,000, disregarding rent paid to A. B's
unrelated business taxable income, disregarding rent paid to A, is
$100,000. Under these circumstances, $4,000 of the rent paid by B will
be included by A as net rental income in determining its unrelated
business taxable income, computed as follows:
B's unrelated business taxable income (disregarding rent $100,000
paid to A)................................................
B's taxable income (computed as though B were not exempt 300,000
and disregarding rent paid to A)..........................
Ratio ($100,000/$300,000).................................. \1/3\
Total rent................................................. 15,000
Total deductions........................................... 3,000
Rental income treated as gross income from an unrelated 5,000
trade or business (\1/3\ of $15,000)......................
Less deductions directly connected with such income (\1/3\ 1,000
of $3,000)................................................
------------
Net rental income included by A in computing its unrelated $4,000
business taxable income...................................
Example 2. Assume the facts as stated in example 1, except that B's
taxable income is $90,000 (computed as though B were not an exempt
organization, and disregarding rents paid to A). B's unrelated business
taxable income ($100,000) is therefore greater than its taxable income
($90,000). Thus, the ratio used to determine the portion of rent
received by A which is to be taken into account is one since both the
numerator and denominator of such ratio is B's unrelated business
taxable income. Consequently, all the rent received by A from B
($15,000), and all the deductions directly connected therewith ($3,000),
are included by A in computing its unrelated business taxable income.
(3) Nonexempt controlled organization--(i) In general. If the
controlled organization is not exempt from taxation under section
501(a), the amount referred to in subparagraph (1) of this paragraph is
an amount which bears the same ratio to the interest, annuities,
royalties, and rents received by the controlling organization from the
controlled organization as the excess taxable income (as defined in
subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph) of the controlled organization
bears to whichever of the following amounts is the greater:
(a) The taxable income of the controlled organization, or
(b) The excess taxable income of the controlled organization
both determined without regard to any amount paid directly or indirectly
to the controlling organization. The controlling organization shall be
allowed all deductions which are directly connected with amounts
included in gross income under the preceding sentence.
(ii) Excess taxable income. For purposes of this paragraph, the term
excess taxable income means the excess of the controlled organization's
taxable income over the amount of such taxable income which, if derived
directly by the controlling organization, would not be unrelated
business taxable income.
(iii) Examples. This subparagraph may be illustrated by the
following examples:
Example 1. A, an exempt university described in section 501(c)(3),
owns all the stock of M, a nonexempt organization. During 1971, M leases
a factory and a dormitory from A for a total annual rent of $100,000.
During the taxable year, M has $500,000 of taxable income, disregarding
the rent paid to A: $150,000 from a dormitory for students of A
university, and $350,000 from the operation of a factory which is a
business unrelated to A's exempt purpose. A's deductions for 1971 with
respect to the leased property are $4,000 for the dormitory and $16,000
for the factory. Under these circumstances, $56,000 of the rent paid by
M will be included by A as net rental income in determining its
unrelated business taxable income, computed as follows:
M's taxable income (disregarding rent paid to A)........... $500,000
Less taxable income from dormitory......................... 150,000
------------
Excess taxable income...................................... $350,000
============
Ratio ($350,000/$500,000).................................. \7/10\
Total rent paid to A....................................... $100,000
Total deductions ($4,000+$16,000).......................... 20,000
Rental income treated as gross income from an unrelated 70,000
trade or business (\7/10\ of $100,000)....................
Less deductions directly connected with such income (\7/10\ 14,000
of $20,000)...............................................
------------
[[Page 169]]
Net rental income included by A in computing its unrelated $56,000
business taxable income...................................
Example 2. Assume the facts as stated in example 1, except that M's
taxable income (disregarding rent paid to A) is $300,000, consisting of
$350,000 from the operation of the factory and a $50,000 loss from the
operation of the dormitory. Thus, M's excess taxable income is also
$300,000, since none of M's taxable income would be excluded from the
computation of A's unrelated business taxable income if received
directly by A. The ratio of M's excess taxable income to its taxable
income is therefore one ($300,000/$300,000). Thus, all the rent received
by A from M ($100,000), and all the deductions directly connected
therewith ($20,000), are included in the computation of A's unrelated
business taxable income.
(4) Control--(i) In general. For purposes of this paragraph--
(a) Stock corporation. In the case of an organization which is a
stock corporation, the term control means ownership by an exempt
organization of stock possessing at least 80 percent of the total
combined voting power of all classes of stock entitled to vote and at
least 80 percent of the total number of shares of all other classes of
stock of such corporation.
(b) Nonstock organization. In the case of a nonstock organization,
the term control means that at least 80 percent of the directors or
trustees of such organization are either representatives of or directly
or indirectly controlled by an exempt organization. A trustee or
director is a representative of an exempt organization if he is a
trustee, director, agent, or employee of such exempt organization. A
trustee or director is controlled by an exempt organization if such
organization has the power to remove such trustee or director and
designate a new trustee or director.
(ii) Gain or loss of control. If control of an organization (as
defined in subdivision (i) of this subparagraph) is acquired or
relinquished during the taxable year, only the interest, annuities,
royalties, and rents paid or accrued to the controlling organization in
accordance with its method of accounting for that portion of the taxable
year it has control shall be subject to the tax on unrelated business
income.
(5) Amounts taxable under other provisions of the Code--(i) In
general. Except as provided in subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph,
section 512(b)(13) and this paragraph do not apply to amounts which are
included in the computation of unrelated business taxable income by
operation of any other provision of the Code. However, amounts which are
not included in unrelated business taxable income by operation of
section 512(a)(1), or which are excluded by operation of section 512(b)
(1), (2), or (3), may be included in unrelated business taxable income
by operation of section 512(b)(13) and this paragraph.
(ii) Debt-financed property. Rents deprived from the lease of debt-
financed property by a controlling organization to a controlled
organization are subject to the rules contained in section 512(b)(13)
and this paragraph. Thus, if a controlling organization leases debt-
financed property to a controlled organization, the amount of rents
includible in the controlling organization's unrelated business taxable
income shall first be determined under section 512(b)(13) and this
paragraph, and only the portion of such rents not taken into account by
operation of section 512(b)(13) are taken into account by operation of
section 514. See example 3 of Sec. 1.514(b)-1(b)(3).
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6939, 32 FR
17661, Dec. 12, 1967; T.D. 7177, 37 FR 7089, Apr. 8, 1972; T.D. 7183, 37
FR 7885, Apr. 21, 1972; T.D. 7261, 38 FR 5466, Mar. 1, 1973; 38 FR 6387,
Mar. 9, 1973; T.D. 7632, 44 FR 42681, July 20, 1979; T.D. 7767, 46 FR
11265, Feb. 6, 1981; T.D. 8423, 57 FR 33443, July 29, 1992; 57 FR 42490,
Sept. 15, 1992]
Sec. 1.512(c)-1 Special rules applicable to partnerships; in general.
In the event an organization to which section 511 applies is a
member of a partnership regularly engaged in a trade or business which
is an unrelated trade or business with respect to such organization, the
organization shall include in computing its unrelated business taxable
income so much of its share (whether or not distributed) of the
partnership gross income as is derived from that unrelated business and
its share of the deductions attributable thereto. For this purpose, both
the gross income and the deductions shall be computed with the necessary
adjustments for the exceptions, additions, and limitations referred to
in section
[[Page 170]]
512(b) and in Sec. 1.512(b)-1. For example, if an exempt educational
institution is a partner in a partnership which operates a factory and
if such partnership also holds stock in a corporation, the exempt
organization shall include in computing its unrelated business taxable
income its share of the gross income from the operation of the factory,
but not its share of any dividends received by the partnership from the
corporation. If the taxable year of the organization differs from that
of the partnership, the amounts included or deducted in computing
unrelated business taxable income shall be based upon the income and
deductions of the partnership for each taxable year of the partnership
ending within or with the taxable year of the organization.
Sec. 1.513-1 Definition of unrelated trade or business.
(a) In general. As used in section 512 the term unrelated business
taxable income means the gross income derived by an organization from
any unrelated trade or business regularly carried on by it, less the
deductions and subject to the modifications provided in section 512.
Section 513 specifies with certain exceptions that the phrase unrelated
trade or business means, in the case of an organization subject to the
tax imposed by section 511, any trade or business the conduct of which
is not substantially related (aside from the need of such organization
for income or funds or the use it makes of the profits derived) to the
exercise or performance by such organization of its charitable,
educational, or other purpose or function constituting the basis for its
exemption under section 501 (or, in the case of an organization
described in section 511(a)(2)(B), to the exercise or performance of any
purpose or function described in section 501(c)(3)). (For certain
exceptions from this definition, see paragraph (e) of this section. For
a special definition of unrelated trade or business applicable to
certain trusts, see section 513(b).) Therefore, unless one of the
specific exceptions of section 512 or 513 is applicable, gross income of
an exempt organization subject to the tax imposed by section 511 is
includible in the computation of unrelated business taxable income if:
(1) It is income from trade or business; (2) such trade or business is
regularly carried on by the organization; and (3) the conduct of such
trade or business is not substantially related (other than through the
production of funds) to the organization's performance of its exempt
functions.
(b) Trade or business. The primary objective of adoption of the
unrelated business income tax was to eliminate a source of unfair
competition by placing the unrelated business activities of certain
exempt organizations upon the same tax basis as the nonexempt business
endeavors with which they compete. On the other hand, where an activity
does not possess the characteristics of a trade or business within the
meaning of section 162, such as when an organization sends out low-cost
articles incidental to the solicitation of charitable contributions, the
unrelated business income tax does not apply since the organization is
not in competition with taxable organizations. However, in general, any
activity of a section 511 organization which is carried on for the
production of income and which otherwise possesses the characteristics
required to constitute trade or business within the meaning of section
162--and which, in addition, is notsubstantially related to the
performance of exempt functions--presents sufficient likelihood of
unfair competition to be within the policy of the tax. Accordingly, for
purposes of section 513 the term trade or business has the same meaning
it has in section 162, and generally includes any activity carried on
for the production of income from the sale of goods or performance of
services. Thus, the term trade or business in section 513 is not limited
to integrated aggregates of assets, activities and good will which
comprise businesses for the purposes of certain other provisions of the
Internal Revenue Code. Activities of producing or distributing goods or
performing services from which a particular amount of gross income is
derived do not lose identity as trade or business merely because they
are carried on within a larger aggregate of similar activities or
[[Page 171]]
within a larger complex of other endeavors which may, or may not, be
related to the exempt purposes of the organization. Thus, for example,
the regular sale of pharmaceutical supplies to the general public by a
hospital pharmacydoes not lose identity as trade or business merely
because the pharmacy also furnishes supplies to the hospital and
patients of the hospital in accordance with its exempt purposes or in
compliance with the terms of section 513(a)(2). Similarly, activities of
soliciting, selling, and publishing commercial advertising do not lose
identity as a trade or business even though the advertising is published
in an exempt organization periodical which contains editorial matter
related to the exempt purposes of the organization. However, where an
activity carried on for the production of income constitutes an
unrelated trade or business, no part of such trade or business shall be
excluded from such classification merely because it does not result in
profit.
(c) Regularly carried on--(1) General principles. In determining
whether trade or business from which a particular amount of gross income
derives is regularly carried on, within the meaning of section 512,
regard must be had to the frequency and continuity with which the
activities productive of the income are conducted and the manner in
which they are pursued. This requirement must be applied in light of the
purpose of the unrelated business income tax to place exempt
organization business activities upon the same tax basis as the
nonexempt business endeavors with which they compete. Hence, for
example, specific business activities of an exempt organization will
ordinarily be deemed to be regularly carried on if they manifest a
frequency and continuity, and are pursued in a manner, generally similar
to comparable commercial activities of nonexempt organizations.
(2) Application of principles in certain cases--(i) Normal time span
of activities. Where income producing activities are of a kind normally
conducted by nonexempt commercial organizations on a year-round basis,
the conduct of such activities by an exempt organization over a period
of only a few weeks does not constitute the regular carrying on of trade
or business. For example, the operation of a sandwich stand by a
hospital auxiliary for only 2 weeks at a state fair would not be the
regular conduct of trade or business. However, the conduct of year-round
business activities for one day each week would constitute the regular
carrying on of trade or business. Thus, the operation of a commercial
parking lot on Saturday of each week would be the regular conduct of
trade or business. Where income producing activities are of a kind
normally undertaken by nonexempt commercial organizations only on a
seasonal basis, the conduct of such activities by an exempt organization
during a significant portion of the season ordinarilyconstitutes the
regular conduct of trade or business. For example, the operation of a
track for horse racing for several weeks of a year would be considered
the regular conduct of trade or business because it is usual to carry on
such trade or business only during a particular season.
(ii) Intermittent activities; in general. In determining whether or
not intermittently conducted activities are regularly carried on, the
manner of conduct of the activities must be compared with the manner in
which commercial activities are normally pursued by nonexempt
organizations. In general, exempt organization business activities which
are engaged in only discontinuously or periodically will not be
considered regularly carried on if they are conducted without the
competitive and promotional efforts typical of commercial endeavors. For
example, the publication of advertising in programs for sports events or
music or drama performances will not ordinarily be deemed to be the
regular carrying on of business. Similarly, where an organization sells
certain types of goods or services to a particular class of persons in
pursuance of its exempt functions or primarily for the convenience of
such persons within the meaning of section 513(a)(2) (as, for example,
the sale of books by a college bookstore to students or the sale of
pharmaceutical supplies by a hospital pharmacy to patients of the
hospital), casual sales in the course of such activity which do not
qualify as related to the
[[Page 172]]
exempt function involved or as described in section 513(a)(2) will not
be treated as regular. On the other hand, where the nonqualifyingsales
are not merely casual, but are systematically and consistently promoted
and carried on by the organization, they meet the section 512
requirement of regularity.
(iii) Intermittent activities; special rule in certain cases of
infrequent conduct. Certain intermittent income producing activities
occur so infrequently that neither their recurrence nor the manner of
their conduct will cause them to be regarded as trade or business
regularly carried on. For example, income producing or fund raising
activities lasting only a short period of time will not ordinarily be
treated as regularly carried on if they recur only occasionally or
sporadically. Furthermore, such activities will not be regarded as
regularly carried on merely because they are conducted on an annually
recurrent basis. Accordingly, income derived from the conduct of an
annual dance or similar fund raising event for charity would not be
income from trade or business regularly carried on.
(d) Substantially related--(1) In general. Gross income derives from
unrelated trade or business, within the meaning of section 513(a), if
the conduct of the trade or business which produces the income is not
substantially related (other than through the production of funds) to
the purposes for which exemption is granted. The presence of this
requirement necessitates an examination of the relationship between the
business activities which generate the particular income in question--
the activities, that is, of producing or distributing the goods or
performing the services involved--and the accomplishment of the
organization's exempt purposes.
(2) Type of relationship required. Trade or business is related to
exempt purposes, in the relevant sense, only where the conduct of the
business activities has causal relationship to the achievement of exempt
purposes (other than through the production of income); and it is
substantially related, for purposes of section 513, only if the causal
relationship is a substantial one. Thus, for the conduct of trade or
business from which a particular amount of gross income is derived to be
substantially related to purposes for which exemption is granted, the
production or distribution of the goods or the performance of the
services from which the gross income is derived must contribute
importantly to the accomplishment of those purposes. Where the
production or distribution of the goods or the performance of the
services does not contribute importantly to the accomplishment of the
exempt purposes of an organization, the income from the sale of the
goods or the performance of the services does not derive from the
conduct of related trade or business. Whether activities productive of
gross income contribute importantly to the accomplishment of any purpose
for which an organization is granted exemption depends in each case upon
the facts and circumstances involved.
(3) Size and extent of activities. In determining whether activities
contribute importantly to the accomplishment of an exempt purpose, the
size and extent of the activities involved must be considered in
relation to the nature and extent of the exempt function which they
purport to serve. Thus, where income is realized by an exempt
organization from activities which are in part related to the
performance of its exempt functions, but which are conducted on a larger
scale than is reasonably necessary for performance of such functions,
the gross income attributable to that portion of the activities in
excess of the needs of exempt functions constitutes gross income from
the conduct of unrelated trade or business. Such income is not derived
from the production or distribution of goods or the performance of
services which contribute importantly to the accomplishment of any
exempt purpose of the organization.
(4) Application of principles--(i) Income from performance of exempt
functions. Gross income derived from charges for the performance of
exempt functions does not constitute gross income from the conduct of
unrelated trade or business. The following examples illustrate the
application of this principle:
Example 1. M, an organization described in section 501(c)(3),
operates a school for training children in the performing arts, such as
acting, singing, and dancing. It presents performances by its students
and derives gross
[[Page 173]]
income from admission charges for the performances. The students'
participation in performances before audiences is an essential part of
their training. Since the income realized from the performances derives
from activities which contribute importantly to the accomplishment of
M's exempt purposes, it does not constitute gross income from unrelated
trade or business. (For specific exclusion applicable in certain cases
of contributed services, see section 513(a)(1) and paragraph (e)(1) of
this section.)
Example 2. N is a trade union qualified for exemption under section
501(c)(5). To improve the trade skills of its members, N conducts
refresher training courses and supplies handbooks and technical manuals.
N receives payments from its members for these services and materials.
However, the development and improvement of the skills of its members is
one of the purposes for which exemption is granted N; and the activities
described contribute importantly to that purpose. Therefore, the income
derived from these activities does not constitute gross income from
unrelated trade or business.
Example 3. O is an industry trade association qualified for
exemption under section 501(c)(6). It presents a trade show in which
members of its industry join in an exhibition of industry products. O
derives income from charges made to exhibitors for exhibit space and
admission fees charged patrons or viewers of the show. The show is not a
sales facility for individual exhibitors; its purpose is the promotion
and stimulation of interest in, and demand for, the industry's products
in general, and it is conducted in a manner reasonably calculated to
achieve that purpose. The stimulation of demand for the industry's
products in general is one of the purposes for which exemption is
granted O. Consequently, the activities productive of O's gross income
from the show--that is, the promotion, organization and conduct of the
exhibition--contribute importantly to the achievement of an exempt
purpose, and the income does not constitute gross income from unrelated
trade or business. See also section 513(d) and regulations thereunder
regarding sales activity.
(ii) Disposition of product of exempt functions. Ordinarily, gross
income from the sale of products which result from the performance of
exempt functions does not constitute gross income from the conduct of
unrelated trade or business if the product is sold in substantially the
same state it is in on completion of the exempt functions. Thus, in the
case of an organization described in section 501(c)(3) and engaged in a
program of rehabilitation of handicapped persons, income from sale of
articles made by such persons as a part of their rehabilitation training
would not be gross income from conduct of unrelated trade or business.
The income in such case would be from sale of products, the production
of which contributed importantly to the accomplishment of purposes for
which exemption is granted the organization--namely, rehabilitation of
the handicapped. On the other hand, if a product resulting from an
exempt function is utilized or exploitedin further business endeavor
beyond that reasonably appropriate or necessary for disposition in the
state it is in upon completion of exempt functions, the gross income
derived therefrom would be from conduct of unrelated trade or business.
Thus, in the case of an experimental dairy herd maintained for
scientific purposes by a research organization described in section
501(c)(3), income from sale of milk and cream produced in the ordinary
course of operation of the project would not be gross income from
conduct of unrelated trade or business. On the other hand, if the
organization were to utilize the milk and cream in the further
manufacture of food items such as ice cream, pastries, etc., the gross
income from the sale of such products would be from the conduct of
unrelated trade or business unless the manufacturing activities
themselves contribute importantly to the accomplishment of an exempt
purpose of the organization.
(iii) Dual use of assets or facilities. In certain cases, an asset
or facility necessary to the conduct of exempt functions may also be
employed in a commercial endeavor. In such cases, the mere fact of the
use of the asset or facility in exempt functions does not, by itself,
make the income from the commercial endeavor gross income from related
trade or business. The test, instead, is whether the activities
productive of the income in question contribute importantly to the
accomplishment of exempt purposes. Assume, for example, that a museum
exempt under section 501(c)(3) has a theater auditorium which is
specially designed and equipped for showing of educational films in
connection with its program of public education in the arts and
[[Page 174]]
sciences. The theater is a principal feature of the museum and is in
continuous operation during the hours the museum is open to the public.
If the organization were to operate the theater as an ordinary motion
picture theater for public entertainment during the evening hours when
the museum was closed, gross income from such operation would be gross
income from conduct of unrelated trade or business.
(iv) Exploitation of exempt functions. In certain cases, activities
carried on by an organization in the performance of exempt functions may
generate good will or other intangibles which are capable of being
exploited in commercial endeavors. Where an organization exploits such
an intangible in commercial activities, the mere fact that the resultant
income depends in part upon an exempt function of the organization does
not make it gross income from related trade or business. In such cases,
unless the commercial activities themselves contribute importantly to
the accomplishment of an exempt purpose, the income which they produce
is gross income from the conduct of unrelated trade or business. The
application of this subdivision is illustrated in the following
examples:
Example 1. U, an exempt scientific organization, enjoys an excellent
reputation in the field of biological research. It exploits this
reputation regularly by selling endorsements of various items of
laboratory equipment to manufacturers. The endorsing of laboratory
equipment does not contribute importantly to the accomplishment of any
purpose for which exemption is granted U. Accordingly, the income
derived from the sale of endorsements is gross income from unrelated
trade or business.
Example 2. V, an exempt university, has a regular faculty and a
regularly enrolled student body. During the school year, V sponsors the
appearance of professional theater companies and symphony orchestras
which present drama and musical performances for the students and
faculty members. Members of the general public are also admitted. V
advertises these performances and supervises advance ticket sales at
various places, including such university facilities as the cafeteria
and the university bookstore. V derives gross income from the conduct of
the performances. However, while the presentation of the performances
makes use of an intangible generated by V's exempt educational
functions--the presence of the student body and faculty--the
presentation of such drama and music events contributes importantly to
the overall educational and cultural function of the university.
Therefore, the income which V receives does not constitute gross income
from the conduct of unrelated trade or business.
Example 3. W is an exempt business league with a large membership.
Under an arrangement with an advertising agency, W regularly mails
brochures, pamphlets and other commercial advertising materials to its
members, for which service W charges the agency an agreed amount per
enclosure. The distribution of the advertising materials does not
contribute importantly to the accomplishment of any purpose for which W
is granted exemption. Accordingly, the payments made to W by the
advertising agency constitute gross income from unrelated trade or
business.
Example 4. X, an exempt organization for the advancement of public
interest in classical music, owns a radio station and operates it in a
manner which contributes importantly to the accomplishment of the
purposes for which the organization is granted exemption. However, in
the course of the operation of the station the organization derives
gross income from the regular sale of advertising time and services to
commercial advertisers in the manner of an ordinary commercial station.
Neither the sale of such time nor the performance of such services
contributes importantly to the accomplishment of any purpose for which
the organization is granted exemption. Notwithstanding the fact that the
production of the advertising income depends upon the existence of the
listening audience resulting from performance of exempt functions, such
income is gross income from unrelated trade or business.
Example 5. Y, an exempt university, provides facilities, instruction
and faculty supervision for a campus newspaper operated by its students.
In addition to news items and editorial commentary, the newspaper
publishes paid advertising. The solicitation, sale, and publication of
the advertising are conducted by students, under the supervision and
instruction of the university. Although the services rendered to
advertisers are of a commercial character, the advertising business
contributes importantly to the university's educational program through
the training of the students involved. Hence, none of the income derived
from publication of the newspaper constitutes gross income from
unrelated trade or business. The same result would follow even though
the newspaper is published by a separately incorporated section
501(c)(3) organization, qualified under the university rules for
recognition of student activities, and even though such organization
utilizes its own facilities and is independent of faculty supervision,
but carries out its educational purposes by
[[Page 175]]
means of student instruction of other students in the editorial and
advertising activities and student participation in those activities.
Example 6. Z is an association exempt under section 501(c)(6),
formed to advance the interests of a particular profession and drawing
its membership from the members of that profession. Z publishes a
monthly journal containing articles and other editorial material which
contribute importantly to the accomplishment of purposes for which
exemption is granted the organization. Income from the sale of
subscriptions to members and others in accordance with the
organization's exempt purposes, therefore, does not constitute gross
income from unrelated trade or business. In connection with the
publication of the journal, Z also derives income from the regular sale
of space and services for general consumer advertising,including
advertising of such products as soft drinks, automobiles, articles of
apparel, and home appliances. Neither the publication of such
advertisements nor the performance of services for such commercial
advertisers contributes importantly to the accomplishment of any purpose
for which exemption is granted. Therefore, notwithstanding the fact that
the production of income from advertising utilizes the circulation
developed and maintained in performance of exempt functions, such income
is gross income from unrelated trade or business.
Example 7. The facts are as described in the preceding example,
except that the advertising in Z's journal promotes only products which
are within the general area of professional interest of its members.
Following a practice common among taxable magazines which publish
advertising, Z requires its advertising to comply with certain general
standards of taste, fairness, and accuracy; but within those limits the
form, content, and manner of presentation of the advertising messages
are governed by the basic objective of the advertisers to promote the
sale of the advertised products. While the advertisements contain
certain information, the informational function of the advertising is
incidental to the controlling aim of stimulating demand for the
advertised products and differs in no essential respect from the
informational function of any commercial advertising. Like taxable
publishers of advertising, Z accepts advertising only from those who are
willing to pay its prescribed rates. Although continuing education of
itsmembers in matters pertaining to their profession is one of the
purposes for which Z is granted exemption, the publication of
advertising designed and selected in the manner of ordinary commercial
advertising is not an educational activity of the kind contemplated by
the exemption statute; it differs fundamentally from such an activity
both in its governing objective and in its method. Accordingly, Z's
publication of advertising does not contribute importantly to the
accomplishment of its exempt purposes; and the income which it derives
from advertising constitutes gross income from unrelated trade or
business.
(e) Exceptions. Section 513(a) specifically states that the term
unrelated trade or business does not include:
(1) Any trade or business in which substantially all the work in
carrying on such trade or business is performed for the organization
without compensation; or
(2) Any trade or business carried on by an organization described in
section 501(c)(3) or by a governmental college or university described
in section 511(a)(2)(B), primarily for the convenience of its members,
students, patients, officers, or employees; or, any trade or business
carried on by a local association of employees described in section
501(c)(4) organized before May 27, 1969, which consists of the selling
by the organization of items of work-related clothes and equipment and
items normally sold through vending machines, through food dispensing
facilities, or by snack bars, for the convenience of its members at
their usual places of employment; or
(3) Any trade or business which consists of selling merchandise,
substantially all of which has been received by the organization as
gifts or contributions
An example of the operation of the first of the exceptions mentioned
above would be an exempt orphanage operating a retail store and selling
to the general public, where substantially all the work in carrying on
such business is performed for the organization by volunteers without
compensation. An example of the first part of the second exception,
relating to an organization described in section 501(c)(3) or a
governmental college or university described in section 511(a)(2)(B),
would be a laundry operated by a college for the purpose of laundering
dormitory linens and the clothing of students. The latter part of the
second exception, dealing with certain sales by local employee
associations, will not apply to sales of these items at locations other
than the
[[Page 176]]
usual place of employment of the employees; therefore sales at such
other locations will continue to be treated as unrelated trade or
business. The third exception applies to so-called thrift shops operated
by a tax-exempt organization where those desiring to benefit such
organization contribute old clothes, books, furniture, et cetera, to be
sold to the general public with the proceeds going to the exempt
organization.
(f) Special rule respecting publishing businesses prior to 1970. For
a special rule for taxable years beginning before January 1, 1970, with
respect to publishing businesses carried on by an organization, see
section 513(c) of the Code prior to its amendment by section 121(c) of
the Tax Reform Act of 1969 (83 Stat. 542).
(g) Effective date. This section is applicable with respect to
taxable years beginning after December 12, 1967. However, if a taxpayer
wishes to rely on the rules stated in this section for taxable years
beginning before December 13, 1967, it may do so.
[T.D. 6939, 32 FR 17657, Dec. 12, 1967; 32 FR 17890, Dec. 14, 1967; 32
FR 17938, Dec. 15, 1967; T.D. 7107, 36 FR 6421, Apr. 3, 1971; T.D. 7392,
40 FR 58642, Dec. 18, 1975; T.D. 7896, 48 FR 23817, May 27, 1983]
Sec. 1.513-2 Definition of unrelated trade or business applicable to
taxable years beginning before December 13, 1967.
(a) In general. (1) As used in section 512(a), the term unrelated
business taxable income includes only income from an unrelated trade or
business regularly carried on, and the term trade or business has the
same meaning as it has in section 162.
(2) The income of an exempt organization is subject to the tax on
unrelated business income only if two conditions are present with
respect to such income. The first condition is that the income must be
from a trade or business which is regularly carried on by the
organization. The second condition is that the trade or business must
not be substantially related (aside from the need of the organization
for income or funds or the use it makes of the profits derived) to the
exercise or performance by such organization of its charitable,
educational, or other purpose or function constituting the basis for its
exemption under section 501, or in the case ofan organization described
in section 511(a)(2)(B) (governmental colleges, etc.) to the exercise or
performance of any purpose or function described in section 501(c)(3).
Whether or not an organization is subject to the tax imposed by section
511 shall be determined by the application of these tests to the
particular circumstances involved in each individual case. For certain
exceptions from the term unrelated trade or business, see paragraph (b)
of this section.
(3) A trade or business is regularly carried on when the activity is
conducted with sufficient consistency to indicate a continuing purpose
of the organization to derive some of its income from such activity. An
activity may be regularly carried on even though its performance is
infrequent or seasonal.
(4) Ordinarily, a trade or business is substantially related to the
activities for which an organization is granted exemption if the
principal purpose of such trade or business is to further (other than
through the production of income) the purpose for which the organization
is granted exemption. In the usual case the nature and size of the trade
or business must be compared with the nature and extent of the
activities for which the organization is granted exemption in order to
determine whether the principal purpose of such trade or business is to
further (other than through the production of income) the purpose for
which the organization is granted exemption. For example, the operation
of a wheat farm is substantially related to the exempt activity of an
agricultural college if the wheat farm isoperated as a part of the
educational program of the college, and is not operated on a scale
disproportionately large when compared with the educational program of
the college. Similarly, a university radio station or press is
considered a related trade or business if operated primarily as an
integral part of the educational program of the university, but is
considered an unrelated trade or business if operated in substantially
the same manner as a commercial radio station
[[Page 177]]
or publishing house. A trade or business not otherwise related does not
become substantially related to an organization's exempt purpose merely
because incidental use is made of the trade or business in order to
further the exempt purpose. For example, the manufacture and sale of a
product by an exempt college would not become substantially related
merely because students as part of their educational program perform
clerical or bookkeeping functions in the business. In some cases, the
business may be substantially related because it is a necessary part of
the exempt activity. For example, in the case of an organization
described in section 501(c)(3) and engaged in the rehabilitation of
handicapped persons, the business of selling articles made by such
persons as a part of their rehabilitation training would not be
considered an unrelated business since such business is a necessary part
of the rehabilitation program.
(5) If an organization receives a payment pursuant to a contract or
agreement under which such organization is to perform research which
constitutes an unrelated trade or business, the entire amount of such
payment is income from an unrelated trade or business. See, however,
section 512(b), (7), (8), and (9), relating to the exclusion from
unrelated business taxable income of income derived from research for
the United States, or any State, and of income derived from research
performed for any person by a college, university, hospital, or
organization operated primarily for the purpose of carrying on
fundamental research the results of which are freely available to the
general public.
(b) Exceptions. Section 513(a) specifically states that the term
unrelated trade or business does not include:
(1) Any trade or business in which substantially all the work in
carrying on such trade or business is performed for the organization
without compensation; or
(2) Any trade or business carried on by an organization described in
section 501(c)(3) or by a governmental college or university described
in section 511(a)(2)(B), primarily for the convenience of its members,
students, patients, officers, or employees; or
(3) Any trade or business which consists of selling merchandise,
substantially all of which has been received by the organization as
gifts or contributions
An example of the operation of the first of the exceptions mentioned
above would be an exempt orphanage operating a retail store and selling
to the general public, where substantially all the work in carrying on
such business is performed for the organization by volunteers without
compensation. An example of the second exception would be a laundry
operated by a college for the purpose of laundering dormitory linens and
the clothing of students. The third exception applies to so-called
thrift shops operated by a tax-exempt organization where those desiring
to benefit such organization contribute old clothes, books, furniture,
etc., to be sold to the general public with the proceeds going to the
exempt organization.
(c) Special rules respecting publishing businesses. For a special
rule with respect to publishing businesses carried on by an
organization, see section 513(c) of the Code prior to its amendment by
section 121(c) of the Tax Reform Act of 1969 (83 Stat. 542).
(d) Effective date. Except as provided in paragraph (g) of Sec.
1.513-1, this section is applicable with respect to taxable years
beginning before December 13, 1967.
(Sec. 513 as amended by sec. 4, Act of July 14, 1960 (P.L. 86-667, 74
Stat. 536); secs. 121 (b)(4) and (c), Tax Reform Act of 1969 (83 Stat.
536, 542))
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6525, 26 FR
190, Jan. 11, 1961; T.D. 6939, 32 FR 17657, Dec. 12, 1967; T.D. 7392, 40
FR 58643, Dec. 18, 1975; 40 FR 60053, Dec. 31, 1975]
Sec. 1.513-3 Qualified convention and trade show activity.
(a) Introduction--(1) In general. Section 513(d) and Sec. 1.513-
3(b) provide that convention and trade show activities carried on by a
qualifying organization in connection with a qualified convention or
trade show will not be treated as unrelated trade or business.
Consequently, income from qualified convention and trade show
activities, derived by a qualifying organization that
[[Page 178]]
sponsors the qualified convention or trade show, will not be subject to
the tax imposed by section 511. Section 1.513-3(c) defines qualifying
organizations and qualified conventions or trade shows. Section 1.513-
3(d) concerns the treatment of income derived from certain activities,
including rental of exhibition space at a qualified convention or trade
show where sales activity is permitted, and the treatment of supplier
exhibits at qualified conventions and trade shows.
(2) Effective date. This section is effective for taxable years
beginning after October 4, 1976.
(b) Qualified activities not unrelated. A convention or trade show
activity, as defined in section 513(d)(3)(A) and Sec. 1.513-3(c)(4),
will not be considered unrelated trade or business if it is conducted by
a qualifying organization described in section 513(d)(3)(C) and Sec.
1.513-3(c)(1), in conjunction with a qualified convention or trade show,
as defined in section 513(d)(3)(B) and Sec. 1.513-3(c)(2), sponsored by
the qualifying organization. Such an activity is a qualified convention
or trade show activity. A convention or trade show activity which is
conducted by an organization described in section 501(c) (5) or (6), but
which otherwise is not so qualified under this section, will be
considered unrelated trade or business.
(c) Definitions--(1) Qualifying organization. Under section
513(d)(3)(C), a qualifying organization is one which:
(i) Is described in either section 501(c) (5) or (6), and
(ii) Regularly conducts as one of its substantial exempt purposes a
qualified convention or trade show.
(2) Qualified convention or trade show. For purposes of this
section, the term qualified convention or trade show means a show that
meets the following requirements:
(i) It is conducted by a qualifying organization described in
section 513(d)(3)(C);
(ii) At least one purpose of the sponsoring organization in
conducting the show is the education of its members, or the promotion
and stimulation of interest in, and demand for, the products or services
of the industry (or segment thereof) of the members of the qualifying
organization; and
(iii) The show is designed to achieve that purpose through the
character of a significant portion of the exhibits or the character of
conferences and seminars held at a convention or meeting.
(3) Show. For purposes of this section, the term show includes an
international, national, state, regional, or local convention, annual
meeting or show.
(4) Convention and trade show activity. For purposes of this
section, convention and trade show activity means any activity of a kind
traditionally carried on at shows. It includes, but is not limited to--
(i) Activities designed to attract to the show members of the
sponsoring organization, members of an industry in general, and members
of the public, to view industry products or services and to stimulate
interest in, and demand for such products or services;
(ii) Activities designed to educate persons in the industry about
new products or services or about new rules and regulations affecting
the industry; and
(iii) Incidental activities, such as furnishing refreshments, of a
kind traditionally carried on at such shows.
(d) Certain activities--(1) Rental of exhibition space. The rental
of display space to exhibitors (including exhibitors who are suppliers)
at a qualified trade show or at a qualified convention and trade show
will not be considered unrelated trade or business even though the
exhibitors who rent the space are permitted to sell or solicit orders.
(2) Suppliers defined. For purposes of subparagraph (1), a
supplier's exhibit is one in which the exhibitor displays goods or
services that are supplied to, rather than by, the members of the
qualifying organization in the conduct of such members' own trades or
businesses.
(e) Example. The provisions of this section may be illustrated by
the following examples:
Example 1. X, an organization described in section 501(c)(6), was
formed to promote the construction industry. Its membership is made up
of manufacturers of heavy construction machinery many of whom own, rent,
or lease one or more digital computers produced by various computer
manufacturers. X is a qualifying organization under section
[[Page 179]]
513(d)(3)(C) that regularly holds an annual meeting. At this meeting a
national industry sales campaign and methods of consumer financing for
heavy construction machinery are discussed. In addition, new
construction machinery developed for use in the industry is on display
with representatives of the various manufacturers present to promote
their machinery. Both members and nonmembers attend this portion of the
conference. In addition, manufacturers of computers are present to
educate X's members. While this aspect of the conference is a supplier
exhibit (as defined in paragraph (d) of this section), income earned
from such activity by X will not constitute unrelated business taxable
income to X because the activity is conducted as part of a qualified
trade show described in Sec. 1.513-3(c).
Example 2. Assume the same facts as in Example 1, but the only goods
or services displayed are those of suppliers, the computer
manufacturers. Selling and order taking are permitted. No member
exhibits are maintained. Standing alone, this supplier exhibit (as
defined in paragraph (d)(2) of this section) would constitute a supplier
show and not a qualified convention or trade show. In this situation,
however, the rental of exhibition space to suppliers is not unrelated
trade or business. It is conducted by a qualifying organization in
conjunction with a qualified convention or trade show. The show (the
annual meeting) is a qualified convention or trade show because one of
its purposes is the promotion and stimulation of interest in, and demand
for, the products or services of the industry through the character of
the annual meeting.
Example 3. Y is an organization described in section 501(c)(6). The
organization conducts an annual show at which its members exhibit their
products and services in order to promote public interest in the line of
business. Potential customers are invited to the show, and sales and
order taking are permitted. The organization secures the exhibition
facility, undertakes the planning and direction of the show, and
maintains exhibits designed to promote the line of business in general.
The show is a qualified convention or trade show described in paragraph
(c)(2) of this section. The provision of exhibition space to individual
members is a qualified trade show activity, and is not unrelated trade
or business.
Example 4. Z is an organization described in section 501(c)(6) that
sponsors an annual show. As the sole activity at the show, suppliers to
the members of Z exhibit their products and services for the purpose of
stimulating the sale of their products. Selling and order taking are
permitted. The show is a supplier show and does not meet the definition
of a qualified convention show as it does not satisfy any of the three
alternative bases for qualification. First, the show does not stimulate
interest in the members' products through the character of product
exhibits as the only products exhibited are those of suppliers rather
than members. Second, the show does not stimulate interest in members'
products through conferences or seminars as no such conferences are held
at the show. Third, the show does not meet the definition of a qualified
show on the basis of educational activities as the exhibition of
suppliers' products is designed primarily to stimulate interest in, and
sale of, suppliers' products. Thus, the organization's provision of
exhibition space is not a qualified convention or trade show activity.
Income derived from rentals of exhibition space to suppliers will be
unrelated business taxable income under section 512.
[T.D. 7896, 48 FR 23817, May 27, 1983]
Sec. 1.513-4 Certain sponsorship not unrelated trade or business.
(a) In general. Under section 513(i), the receipt of qualified
sponsorship payments by an exempt organization which is subject to the
tax imposed by section 511 does not constitute receipt of income from an
unrelated trade or business.
(b) Exception. The provisions of this section do not apply with
respect to payments made in connection with qualified convention and
trade show activities. For rules governing qualified convention and
trade show activity, see Sec. 1.513-3. The provisions of this section
also do not apply to income derived from the sale of advertising or
acknowledgments in exempt organization periodicals. For this purpose,
the term periodical means regularly scheduled and printed material
published by or on behalf of the exempt organization that is not related
to and primarily distributed in connection with a specific event
conducted by the exempt organization. For this purpose, printed material
includes material that is published electronically. For rules governing
the sale of advertising in exempt organization periodicals, see Sec.
1.512(a)-1(f).
(c) Qualified sponsorship payment--(1) Definition. The term
qualified sponsorship payment means any payment by any person engaged in
a trade or business with respect to which there is no arrangement or
expectation that the person will receive any substantial return benefit.
In determining whether a
[[Page 180]]
payment is a qualified sponsorship payment, it is irrelevant whether the
sponsored activity is related or unrelated to the recipient
organization's exempt purpose. It is also irrelevant whether the
sponsored activity is temporary or permanent. For purposes of this
section, payment means the payment of money, transfer of property, or
performance of services.
(2) Substantial return benefit--(i) In general. For purposes of this
section, a substantial return benefit means any benefit other than a use
or acknowledgment described in paragraph (c)(2)(iv) of this section, or
disregarded benefits described in paragraph (c)(2)(ii) of this section.
(ii) Certain benefits disregarded. For purposes of paragraph
(c)(2)(i) of this section, benefits are disregarded if the aggregate
fair market value of all the benefits provided to the payor or persons
designated by the payor in connection with the payment during the
organization's taxable year is not more than 2% of the amount of the
payment. If the aggregate fair market value of the benefits exceeds 2%
of the amount of the payment, then (except as provided in paragraph
(c)(2)(iv) of this section) the entire fair market value of such
benefits, not merely the excess amount, is a substantial return benefit.
Fair market value is determined as provided in paragraph (d)(1) of this
section.
(iii) Benefits defined. For purposes of this section, benefits
provided to the payor or persons designated by the payor may include:
(A) Advertising as defined in paragraph (c)(2)(v) of this section.
(B) Exclusive provider arrangements as defined in paragraph
(c)(2)(vi)(B) of this section.
(C) Goods, facilities, services or other privileges.
(D) Exclusive or nonexclusive rights to use an intangible asset
(e.g., trademark, patent, logo, or designation) of the exempt
organization.
(iv) Use or acknowledgment. For purposes of this section, a
substantial return benefit does not include the use or acknowledgment of
the name or logo (or product lines) of the payor's trade or business in
connection with the activities of the exempt organization. Use or
acknowledgment does not include advertising as described in paragraph
(c)(2)(v) of this section, but may include the following: exclusive
sponsorship arrangements; logos and slogans that do not contain
qualitative or comparative descriptions of the payor's products,
services, facilities or company; a list of the payor's locations,
telephone numbers, or Internet address; value-neutral descriptions,
including displays or visual depictions, of the payor's product-line or
services; and the payor's brand or trade names and product or service
listings. Logos or slogans that are an established part of a payor's
identity are not considered to contain qualitative or comparative
descriptions. Mere display or distribution, whether for free or
remuneration, of a payor's product by the payor or the exempt
organization to the general public at the sponsored activity is not
considered an inducement to purchase, sell or use the payor's product
for purposes of this section and, thus, will not affect the
determination of whether a payment is a qualified sponsorship payment.
(v) Advertising. For purposes of this section, the term advertising
means any message or other programming material which is broadcast or
otherwise transmitted, published, displayed or distributed, and which
promotes or markets any trade or business, or any service, facility or
product. Advertising includes messages containing qualitative or
comparative language, price information or other indications of savings
or value, an endorsement, or an inducement to purchase, sell, or use any
company, service, facility or product. A single message that contains
both advertising and an acknowledgment is advertising. This section does
not apply to activities conducted by a payor on its own. For example, if
a payor purchases broadcast time from a television station to advertise
its product during commercial breaks in a sponsored program, the exempt
organization's activities are not thereby converted to advertising.
(vi) Exclusivity arrangements--(A) Exclusive sponsor. An arrangement
that acknowledges the payor as the exclusive sponsor of an exempt
organization's activity, or the exclusive sponsor
[[Page 181]]
representing a particular trade, business or industry, generally does
not, by itself, result in a substantial return benefit. For example, if
in exchange for a payment, an organization announces that its event is
sponsored exclusively by the payor (and does not provide any advertising
or other substantial return benefit to the payor), the payor has not
received a substantial return benefit.
(B) Exclusive provider. An arrangement that limits the sale,
distribution, availability, or use of competing products, services, or
facilities in connection with an exempt organization's activity
generally results in a substantial return benefit. For example, if in
exchange for a payment, the exempt organization agrees to allow only the
payor's products to be sold in connection with an activity, the payor
has received a substantial return benefit.
(d) Allocation of payment--(1) In general. If there is an
arrangement or expectation that the payor will receive a substantial
return benefit with respect to any payment, then only the portion, if
any, of the payment that exceeds the fair market value of the
substantial return benefit is a qualified sponsorship payment. However,
if the exempt organization does not establish that the payment exceeds
the fair market value of any substantial return benefit, then no portion
of the payment constitutes a qualified sponsorship payment.
(i) Treatment of payments other than qualified sponsorship payments.
The unrelated business income tax (UBIT) treatment of any payment (or
portion thereof) that is not a qualified sponsorship payment is
determined by application of sections 512, 513 and 514. For example,
payments related to an exempt organization's providing facilities,
services, or other privileges to the payor or persons designated by the
payor, advertising, exclusive provider arrangements described in
paragraph (c)(2)(vi)(B) of this section, a license to use intangible
assets of the exempt organization, or other substantial return benefits,
are evaluated separately in determining whether the exempt organization
realizes unrelated business taxable income.
(ii) Fair market value. The fair market value of any substantial
return benefit provided as part of a sponsorship arrangement is the
price at which the benefit would be provided between a willing recipient
and a willing provider of the benefit, neither being under any
compulsion to enter into the arrangement and both having reasonable
knowledge of relevant facts, and without regard to any other aspect of
the sponsorship arrangement.
(iii) Valuation date. In general, the fair market value of the
substantial return benefit is determined when the benefit is provided.
However, if the parties enter into a binding, written sponsorship
contract, the fair market value of any substantial return benefit
provided pursuant to that contract is determined on the date the parties
enter into the sponsorship contract. If the parties make a material
change to a sponsorship contract, it is treated as a new sponsorship
contract as of the date the material change is effective. A material
change includes an extension or renewal of the contract, or a more than
incidental change to any amount payable (or other consideration)
pursuant to the contract.
(iv) Examples. The following examples illustrate the provisions of
this section:
Example 1. On June 30, 2001, a national corporation and Z, a
charitable organization, enter into a five-year binding, written
contract effective for years 2002 through 2007. The contract provides
that the corporation will make an annual payment of $5,000 to Z, and in
return the corporation will receive no benefit other than advertising.
On June 30, 2001, the fair market value of the advertising to be
provided to the corporation in each year of the agreement is $75, which
is less than the disregarded benefit amount provided for in paragraph
(c)(2)(ii) of this section (2% of $5,000 is $100). In 2002, pursuant to
the sponsorship contract, the corporation makes a payment to Z of
$5,000, and receives the specified benefit (advertising). As of January
1, 2002, the fair market value of the advertising to be provided by Z
each year has increased to $110. However, for purposes of this section,
the fair market value of the advertising benefit is determined on June
30, 2001, the date the parties entered into the sponsorship contract.
Therefore, the entire $5,000 payment received in 2002 is a qualified
sponsorship payment.
Example 2. The facts are the same as Example 1, except that the
contract provides for an initial payment by the corporation to Z of
$5,000 in 2002, followed by annual payments of $1,000 during each of
years 2003-2007. In
[[Page 182]]
2003, pursuant to the sponsorship contract, the corporation makes a
payment to Z of $1,000, and receives the specified advertising benefit.
In 2003, the fair market value of the benefit provided ($75, as
determined on June 30, 2001) exceeds 2% of the total payment received
(2% of $1,000 is $20). Therefore, only $925 of the $1,000 payment
received in 2003 is a qualified sponsorship payment.
(2) Anti-abuse provision. To the extent necessary to prevent
avoidance of the rule stated in paragraphs (d)(1) and (c)(2) of this
section, where the exempt organization fails to make a reasonable and
good faith valuation of any substantial return benefit, the Commissioner
(or the Commissioner's delegate) may determine the portion of a payment
allocable to such substantial return benefit and may treat two or more
related payments as a single payment.
(e) Special rules--(1) Written agreements. The existence of a
written sponsorship agreement does not, in itself, cause a payment to
fail to be a qualified sponsorship payment. The terms of the agreement,
not its existence or degree of detail, are relevant to the determination
of whether a payment is a qualified sponsorship payment. Similarly, the
terms of the agreement and not the title or responsibilities of the
individuals negotiating the agreement determine whether a payment (or
any portion thereof) made pursuant to the agreement is a qualified
sponsorship payment.
(2) Contingent payments. The term qualified sponsorship payment does
not include any payment the amount of which is contingent, by contract
or otherwise, upon the level of attendance at one or more events,
broadcast ratings, or other factors indicating the degree of public
exposure to the sponsored activity. The fact that a payment is
contingent upon sponsored events or activities actually being conducted
does not, by itself, cause the payment to fail to be a qualified
sponsorship payment.
(3) Determining public support. Qualified sponsorship payments in
the form of money or property (but not services) are treated as
contributions received by the exempt organization for purposes of
determining public support to the organization under section
170(b)(1)(A)(vi) or 509(a)(2). See Sec. Sec. 1.509(a)-3(f)(1) and
1.170A-9(e)(6)(i). The fact that a payment is a qualified sponsorship
payment that is treated as a contribution to the payee organization does
not determine whether the payment is deductible by the payor under
section 162 or 170.
(f) Examples. The provisions of this section are illustrated by the
following examples. The tax treatment of any payment (or portion of a
payment) that does not constitute a qualified sponsorship payment is
governed by general UBIT principles. In these examples, the recipients
of the payments at issue are section 501(c) organizations. The
expectations or arrangements of the parties are those specifically
indicated in the example. The examples are as follows:
Example 1. M, a local charity, organizes a marathon and walkathon at
which it serves to participants drinks and other refreshments provided
free of charge by a national corporation. The corporation also gives M
prizes to be awarded to winners of the event. M recognizes the
assistance of the corporation by listing the corporation's name in
promotional fliers, in newspaper advertisements of the event and on T-
shirts worn by participants. M changes the name of its event to include
the name of the corporation. M's activities constitute acknowledgment of
the sponsorship. The drinks, refreshments and prizes provided by the
corporation are a qualified sponsorship payment, which is not income
from an unrelated trade or business.
Example 2. N, an art museum, organizes an exhibition and receives a
large payment from a corporation to help fund the exhibition. N
recognizes the corporation's support by using the corporate name and
established logo in materials publicizing the exhibition, which include
banners, posters, brochures and public service announcements. N also
hosts a dinner for the corporation's executives. The fair market value
of the dinner exceeds 2% of the total payment. N's use of the corporate
name and logo in connection with the exhibition constitutes
acknowledgment of the sponsorship. However, because the fair market
value of the dinner exceeds 2% of the total payment, the dinner is a
substantial return benefit. Only that portion of the payment, if any,
that N can demonstrate exceeds the fair market value of the dinner is a
qualified sponsorship payment.
Example 3. O coordinates sports tournaments for local charities. An
auto manufacturer agrees to underwrite the expenses of the tournaments.
O recognizes the auto manufacturer by including the manufacturer's name
and established logo in the title of each tournament as well as on
signs, scoreboards and other printed material. The auto
[[Page 183]]
manufacturer receives complimentary admission passes and pro-am playing
spots for each tournament that have a combined fair market value in
excess of 2% of the total payment. Additionally, O displays the latest
models of the manufacturer's premier luxury cars at each tournament. O's
use of the manufacturer's name and logo and display of cars in the
tournament area constitute acknowledgment of the sponsorship. However,
the admission passes and pro-am playing spots are a substantial return
benefit. Only that portion of the payment, if any, that O can
demonstrate exceeds the fair market value of the admission passes and
pro-am playing spots is a qualified sponsorship payment.
Example 4. P conducts an annual college football bowl game. P sells
to commercial broadcasters the right to broadcast the bowl game on
television and radio. A major corporation agrees to be the exclusive
sponsor of the bowl game. The detailed contract between P and the
corporation provides that in exchange for a $1,000,000 payment, the name
of the bowl game will include the name of the corporation. In addition,
the contract provides that the corporation's name and established logo
will appear on player's helmets and uniforms, on the scoreboard and
stadium signs, on the playing field, on cups used to serve drinks at the
game, and on all related printed material distributed in connection with
the game. P also agrees to give the corporation a block of game passes
for its employees and to provide advertising in the bowl game program
book. The fair market value of the passes is $6,000, and the fair market
value of the program advertising is $10,000. The agreement is contingent
upon the game being broadcast on television and radio, but the amount of
the payment is not contingent upon the number of people attending the
game or the television ratings. The contract provides that television
cameras will focus on the corporation's name and logo on the field at
certain intervals during the game. P's use of the corporation's name and
logo in connection with the bowl game constitutes acknowledgment of the
sponsorship. The exclusive sponsorship arrangement is not a substantial
return benefit. Because the fair market value of the game passes and
program advertising ($16,000) does not exceed 2% of the total payment
(2% of $1,000,000 is $20,000), these benefits are disregarded and the
entire payment is a qualified sponsorship payment, which is not income
from an unrelated trade or business.
Example 5. Q organizes an amateur sports team. A major pizza chain
gives uniforms to players on Q's team, and also pays some of the team's
operational expenses. The uniforms bear the name and established logo of
the pizza chain. During the final tournament series, Q distributes free
of charge souvenir flags bearing Q's name to employees of the pizza
chain who come out to support the team. The flags are valued at less
than 2% of the combined fair market value of the uniforms and
operational expenses paid. Q's use of the name and logo of the pizza
chain in connection with the tournament constitutes acknowledgment of
the sponsorship. Because the fair market value of the flags does not
exceed 2% of the total payment, the entire amount of the funding and
supplied uniforms are a qualified sponsorship payment, which is not
income from an unrelated trade or business.
Example 6. R is a liberal arts college. A soft drink manufacturer
enters into a binding, written contract with R that provides for a large
payment to be made to the college's English department in exchange for R
agreeing to name a writing competition after the soft drink
manufacturer. The contract also provides that R will allow the soft
drink manufacturer to be the exclusive provider of all soft drink sales
on campus. The fair market value of the exclusive provider component of
the contract exceeds 2% of the total payment. R's use of the
manufacturer's name in the writing competition constitutes
acknowledgment of the sponsorship. However, the exclusive provider
arrangement is a substantial return benefit. Only that portion of the
payment, if any, that R can demonstrate exceeds the fair market value of
the exclusive provider arrangement is a qualified sponsorship payment.
Example 7. S is a noncommercial broadcast station that airs a
program funded by a local music store. In exchange for the funding, S
broadcasts the following message: ``This program has been brought to you
by the Music Shop, located at 123 Main Street. For your music needs,
give them a call today at 555-1234. This station is proud to have the
Music Shop as a sponsor.'' Because this single broadcast message
contains both advertising and an acknowledgment, the entire message is
advertising. The fair market value of the advertising exceeds 2% of the
total payment. Thus, the advertising is a substantial return benefit.
Unless S establishes that the amount of the payment exceeds the fair
market value of the advertising, none of the payment is a qualified
sponsorship payment.
Example 8. T, a symphony orchestra, performs a series of concerts. A
program guide that contains notes on guest conductors and other
information concerning the evening's program is distributed by T at each
concert. The Music Shop makes a $1,000 payment to T in support of the
concert series. As a supporter of the event, the Music Shop receives
complimentary concert tickets with a fair market value of $85, and is
recognized in the program guide and on a poster in the lobby of the
concert hall. The lobby poster states that, ``The T concert is sponsored
by the Music Shop, located at 123 Main Street, telephone number 555-
1234.'' The program guide
[[Page 184]]
contains the same information and also states, ``Visit the Music Shop
today for the finest selection of music CDs and cassette tapes.'' The
fair market value of the advertisement in the program guide is $15. T's
use of the Music Shop's name, address and telephone number in the lobby
poster constitutes acknowledgment of the sponsorship. However, the
combined fair market value of the advertisement in the program guide and
complimentary tickets is $100 ($15 + $85), which exceeds 2% of the total
payment (2% of $1,000 is $20). The fair market value of the advertising
and complimentary tickets, therefore, constitutes a substantial return
benefit and only that portion of the payment, or $900, that exceeds the
fair market value of the substantial return benefit is a qualified
sponsorship payment.
Example 9. U, a national charity dedicated to promoting health,
organizes a campaign to inform the public about potential cures to fight
a serious disease. As part of the campaign, U sends representatives to
community health fairs around the country to answer questions about the
disease and inform the public about recent developments in the search
for a cure. A pharmaceutical company makes a payment to U to fund U's
booth at a health fair. U places a sign in the booth displaying the
pharmaceutical company's name and slogan, ``Better Research, Better
Health,'' which is an established part of the company's identity. In
addition, U grants the pharmaceutical company a license to use U's logo
in marketing its products to health care providers around the country.
The fair market value of the license exceeds 2% of the total payment
received from the company. U's display of the pharmaceutical company's
name and slogan constitutes acknowledgment of the sponsorship. However,
the license granted to the pharmaceutical company to use U's logo is a
substantial return benefit. Only that portion of the payment, if any,
that U can demonstrate exceeds the fair market value of the license
granted to the pharmaceutical company is a qualified sponsorship
payment.
Example 10. V, a trade association, publishes a monthly scientific
magazine for its members containing information about current issues and
developments in the field. A textbook publisher makes a large payment to
V to have its name displayed on the inside cover of the magazine each
month. Because the monthly magazine is a periodical within the meaning
of paragraph (b) of this section, the section 513(i) safe harbor does
not apply. See Sec. 1.512(a)-1(f).
Example 11. W, a symphony orchestra, maintains a Web site containing
pertinent information and its performance schedule. The Music Shop makes
a payment to W to fund a concert series, and W posts a list of its
sponsors on its Web site, including the Music Shop's name and Internet
address. W's Web site does not promote the Music Shop or advertise its
merchandise. The Music Shop's Internet address appears as a hyperlink
from W's Web site to the Music Shop's Web site. W's posting of the Music
Shop's name and Internet address on its Web site constitutes
acknowledgment of the sponsorship. The entire payment is a qualified
sponsorship payment, which is not income from an unrelated trade or
business.
Example 12. X, a health-based charity, sponsors a year-long
initiative to educate the public about a particular medical condition. A
large pharmaceutical company manufactures a drug that is used in
treating the medical condition, and provides funding for the initiative
that helps X produce educational materials for distribution and post
information on X's Web site. X's Web site contains a hyperlink to the
pharmaceutical company's Web site. On the pharmaceutical company's Web
site, the statement appears, ``X endorses the use of our drug, and
suggests that you ask your doctor for a prescription if you have this
medical condition.'' X reviewed the endorsement before it was posted on
the pharmaceutical company's Web site and gave permission for the
endorsement to appear. The endorsement is advertising. The fair market
value of the advertising exceeds 2% of the total payment received from
the pharmaceutical company. Therefore, only the portion of the payment,
if any, that X can demonstrate exceeds the fair market value of the
advertising on the pharmaceutical company's Web site is a qualified
sponsorship payment.
[T.D. 8991, 67 FR 20438, Apr. 25, 2002]
Sec. 1.513-5 Certain bingo games not unrelated trade or business.
(a) In general. Under section 513(f), and subject to the limitations
in paragraph (C) of this section, in the case of an organization subject
to the tax imposed by section 511, the term unrelated trade or business
does not include any trade or business that consists of conducting bingo
games (as defined in paragraph (d) of this section).
(b) Exception. The provisions of this section shall not apply with
respect to any bingo game otherwise excluded from the term unrelated
trade or business by reason of section 513(a)(1) and Sec. 1.513-1(e)(1)
(relating to trades or businesses in which substantially all the work is
performed without compensation).
(c) Limitations--(1) Bingo games must be legal. Paragraph (a) of
this section shall not apply with respect to any
[[Page 185]]
bingo game conducted in violation of State or local law.
(2) No commercial competition. Paragraph (a) of this section shall
not apply with respect to any bingo game conducted in a jurisdiction in
which bingo games are ordinarily carried out on a commercial basis.
Bingo games are ordinarily carried out on a commercial basis within a
jursidiction if they are regularly carried on (within the meaning of
Sec. 1.513-1(c)) by for-profit organizations in any part of that
jurisidiction. Normally, the entire State will constitute the
appropriate jurisdiction for determining whether bingo games are
ordinarily carried out on a commercial basis. However, if State law
permits local jurisdictions to determine whether bingo games may be
conducted by for-profit organizations, or if State law limits or
confines the conduct of bingo games by for-profit organizations to
specific local jurisdictions, then the local jurisdiction will
constitute the appropriate jurisdiction for determining whether bingo
games are ordinarily carried out on a commercial basis.
(3) Examples. The application of this paragraph is illustrated by
the examples that follow. In each example, it is assumed that the bingo
games referred to are operated by individuals who are compensated for
their services. Accordingly, none of the bingo games would be excluded
from the term unrelated trade or business under section 513 (a) (1).
Example 1. Church Z, a tax-exempt organization, conducts weekly
bingo games in State O. State and local laws in State O expressly
provide that bingo games may be conducted by tax-exempt organizations.
Bingo games are not conducted in State O by any for-profit businesses.
Since Z's bingo games are not conducted in violation of State or local
law and are not the type of activity ordinarily carried out on a
commercial basis in State O, Z's bingo games do not constitute unrelated
trade or business.
Example 2. Rescue Squad X, a tax-exempt organization, conducts
weekly bingo games in State M. State M has a statutory provision that
prohibits all forms of gambling including bingo games. However, that law
generally is not enforced by State officials against local charitable
organizations such as X that conduct bingo games to raise funds. Since
bingo games are illegal under State law, X's bingo games constitute
unrelated trade or business regardless of the degree to which the State
law is enforced.
Example 3. Veteran's organizations Y and X, both tax-exempt
organizations, are organized under the laws of State N. State N has a
statutory provision that permits bingo games to be conducted by tax-
exempt organizations. In addition, State N permits bingo games to be
conducted by for-profit organizations in city S, a resort community
located in county R. Several for-profit organizations conduct nightly
bingo games in city S. Y conducts weekly bingo games in city S. X
conducts weekly bingo games in county R. Since State law confines the
conduct of bingo games by for-profit organizations to city S, and since
bingo games are regularly carried on there by those organizations, Y's
bingo games conducted in city S constitute unrelated trade or business.
However, X's bingo games conducted in county R outside of city S do not
constitute unrelated trade or business.
(d) Bingo game defined. A bingo game is a game of chance played with
cards that are generally printed with five rows of five squares each.
Participants place markers over randomly called numbers on the cards in
an attempt to form a preselected pattern such as a horizontal, vertical,
or diagonal line, or all four corners. The first participant to form the
preselected pattern wins the game. As used in this section, the term
bingo game means any game of bingo of the type described above in which
wagers are placed, winners are determined, and prizes or other property
is distributed in the presence of all persons placing wagers in that
game. The term bingo game does not refer to any game of chance
(including, but not limited to, keno games, dice games, card games, and
lotteries) other than the type of game described in this paragraph.
(e) Effective date. Section 513(f) and this section apply to taxable
years beginning after December 31, 1969.
[T.D. 7699, 45 FR 33970, May 21, 1980]
Sec. 1.513-6 Certain hospital services not unrelated trade or business.
(a) In general. Under section 513(e), the furnishing of a service
listed in section 501(e)(1)(A) by a hospital to one or more other
hospitals will not constitute unrelated trade or business if--
(1) The service is provided solely to hospitals that have facilities
to serve not more than 100 inpatients,
[[Page 186]]
(2) The service would, if performed by the recipient hospital,
constitute an activity consistent with that hospital's exempt purposes,
and
(3) The service is provided at a fee not in excess of actual cost,
including straight line depreciation and a reasonable rate of return on
the capital goods used to provide the service. For purposes of this
section, a rate of return on capital goods will be considered reasonable
provided that it does not exceed, on an annual basis, the percentage
described below which is based on the average of the rates of interest
on special issues of public debt obligations issued to the Federal
Hospital Insurance Trust Fund for each of the months included in the
taxable year of the hospital duringwhich the captial goods are used in
providing the service. Determinations as to the cost of services and the
applicable rate of return should be made as prescribed by 42 U.S.C.
1395x(v)(1) (A) and (B) and the regulations thereunder (permitting a
health care facility to be reimbursed under the Medicare program for the
reasonable cost of (its) services, including, in the case of certain
proprietary facilities, a reasonable return on equity capital). For
taxable years beginning on or before May 14, 1986, the rate of return
shall be one and one-half times the average of the rates of interest on
public debt obligations described above which were in effect on or
before April 20, 1983.
(b) Hospital defined. As used in this section the word hospital
means a hospital described in section 170(b)(1)(A)(iii).
(c) Example. The provisions of this section are illustrated by the
following example:
Example. A large metropolitan hospital provides various services to
other hospitals. The hospital furnishes a purchasing service to
hosptials N and O, a data processing service to hospitals R and S, and a
food service to hospitals X and Y. All the hospitals are described in
section 170(b)(1)(A)(iii). All the hospitals have facilities to serve
not more than 100 inpatients except hospital N. The services are
furnished at cost to all hospitals except that hospital R is charged a
fee in excess of cost for its use of the data processing service. The
purchasing service constitutes unrelated trade or business because it is
not provided solely to hospitals having facilities to serve not more
than 100 inpatients.
The data processing service constitutes unrelated trade or business
because it is provided at a fee in excess of cost. The food service
satisfies all three requirements of paragraph (a) of this section and
does not constitute unrelated trade or business.
(d) Effective date. Section 513(e) and this section apply to taxable
years beginning after December 31, 1953.
[T.D. 8075, 51 FR 5322, Feb. 13, 1986; 51 FR 8490, Mar. 12, 1986]
Sec. 1.513-7 Travel and tour activities of tax exempt organizations.
(a) Travel tour activities that constitute a trade or business, as
defined in Sec. 1.513-1(b), and that are not substantially related to
the purposes for which exemption has been granted to the organization
constitute an unrelated trade or business with respect to that
organization. Whether travel tour activities conducted by an
organization are substantially related to the organization's exempt
purpose is determined by looking at all relevant facts and
circumstances, including, but not limited to, how a travel tour is
developed, promoted and operated. Section 513(c) and Sec. 1.513-1(b)
also apply to travel tour activity. Application of the rules of section
513(c) and Sec. 1.513-1(b) may result in different treatment for
individual tours within an organization's travel tour program.
(b) Examples. The provisions of this section are illustrated by the
following examples. In all of these examples, the travel tours are
priced to produce a profit for the exempt organization. The examples are
as follows:
Example 1. O, a university alumni association, is exempt from
federal income tax under section 501(a) as an educational organization
described in section 501(c)(3). As part of its activities, O operates a
travel tour program. The program is open to all current members of O and
their guests. O works with travel agencies to schedule approximately 10
tours annually to various destinations around the world. Members of O
pay $x to the organizing travel agency to participate in a tour. The
travel agency pays O a per person fee for each participant. Although the
literature advertising the tours encourages O's members to continue
their lifelong learning by joining the tours, and a faculty member of
O's related university frequently joins
[[Page 187]]
the tour as a guest of the alumni association, none of the tours
includes any scheduled instruction or curriculum related to the
destinations being visited. The travel tours made available to O's
members do not contribute importantly to the accomplishment of O's
educational purpose. Rather, O's program is designed to generate
revenues for O by regularly offering its members travel services.
Accordingly, O's tour program is an unrelated trade or business within
the meaning of section 513(a).
Example 2. N is an organization formed for the purpose of educating
individuals about the geography and culture of the United States. It is
exempt from federal income tax under section 501(a) as an educational
and cultural organization described in section 501(c)(3). N engages in a
number of activities to accomplish its purposes, including offering
courses and publishing periodicals and books. As one of its activities,
N conducts study tours to national parks and other locations within the
UnitedStates. The study tours are conducted by teachers and other
personnel certified by the Board of Education of the State of P. The
tours are directed toward students enrolled in degree programs at
educational institutions in P, as reflected in the promotional
materials, but are open to all who agree to participate in the required
study program. Each tour's study program consists of instruction on
subjects related to the location being visited on the tour. During the
tour, five or six hours per day are devoted to organized study,
preparation of reports, lectures, instruction and recitation by the
students. Each tour group brings along a library of material related to
the subject being studied on the tour. Examinations are given at the end
of each tour and the P StateBoard of Education awards academic credit
for tour participation. Because the tours offered by N include a
substantial amount of required study, lectures, report preparation,
examinations and qualify for academic credit, the tours are
substantially related to N's educational purpose. Accordingly, N's tour
program is not an unrelated trade or business within the meaning of
section 513(a).
Example 3. R is a section 501(c)(4) social welfare organization
devoted to advocacy on a particular issue. On a regular basis throughout
the year, R organizes travel tours for its members to Washington, DC.
While in Washington, the members follow a schedule according to which
they spend substantially all of their time during normal business hours
over several days attending meetings with legislators and government
officials and receiving briefings on policy developments related to the
issue that is R's focus. Members do have some time on their own in the
evenings to engage in recreational or social activities of their own
choosing. Bringing members to Washington to participate in advocacy on
behalf of the organization and learn about developments relating to the
organization's principal focus is substantially related to R's social
welfare purpose. Therefore, R's operation of the travel tours does not
constitute an unrelated trade or business within the meaning of section
513(a).
Example 4. S is a membership organization formed to foster cultural
unity and to educate X Americans about X, their country of origin. It is
exempt from federal income tax under section 501(a) and is described in
section 501(c)(3) as an educational and cultural organization.
Membership in S is open to all Americans interested in the X heritage.
As part of its activities, S sponsors a program of travel tours to X.
The tours are divided into two categories. Category A tours are trips to
X that are designed to immerse participants in the X history, culture
and language. Substantially all of the daily itinerary includes
scheduled instruction on the X language, history and cultural heritage,
and visits to destinations selected because of their historical or
cultural significance or because of instructional resources they offer.
Category B tours are also trips to X, but rather than offering scheduled
instruction, participants are given the option of taking guided tours of
various X locations included in their itinerary. Other than the optional
guided tours, Category B tours offer no instruction or curriculum.
Destinations of principally recreational interest, rather than
historical or cultural interest, are regularly included on Category B
tour itineraries. Based on the facts and circumstances, sponsoring
Category A tours is an activity substantially related to S's exempt
purposes, and does not constitute an unrelated trade or business within
the meaning of section 513(a). However, sponsoring Category B tours does
not contribute importantly to S's accomplishment of its exempt purposes
and, thus, constitutes an unrelated trade or business within the meaning
of section 513(a).
Example 5. T is a scientific organization engaged in environmental
research. T is exempt from federal income tax under section 501(a) as an
organization described in section 501(c)(3). T is engaged in a long-term
study of how agricultural pesticide and fertilizer use affects the
populations of various bird species. T collects data at several bases
located in an important agricultural region of country U. The minutes of
a meeting of T's Board of Directors state that, after study, the Board
has determined that non-scientists can reliably perform needed data
collection in the field, under supervision of T's biologists. The Board
minutes reflect that the Board approved offering one-week trips to T's
bases in U, where participants will assist T's biologists in collecting
data for the study. Tour participants collect data during the same hours
as T's biologists. Normally,
[[Page 188]]
data collection occurs during the early morning and evening hours,
although the work schedule varies by season. Each base has rustic
accommodations and few amenities, but country U is renowned for its
beautiful scenery and abundant wildlife. T promotes the trips in its
newsletter and on its Internet site and through various conservation
organizations. The promotional materials describe the work schedule and
emphasize the valuable contribution made by trip participants to T's
research activities. Based on the facts and circumstances, sponsoring
trips to T's bases in country U is an activity substantially related to
T's exempt purpose, and, thus, does not constitute an unrelated trade or
business within the meaning of section 513(a).
Example 6. V is an educational organization devoted to the study of
ancient history and cultures and is exempt from federal income tax under
section 501(a) as an organization described in section 501(c)(3). In
connection with its educational activities, V conducts archaeological
expeditions around the world, including in the Y region of country Z. In
cooperation with the National Museum of Z, V recently presented an
exhibit on ancient civilizations of the Y region of Z, including
artifacts from the collection of the Z National Museum. V instituted a
program of travel tours to V's archaeological sites located in the Y
region. The tours were initially proposed by V staff members as a means
of educating the public about ongoing field research conducted by V. V
engaged a travel agency to handle logistics such as accommodations and
transportation arrangements. In preparation for the tours, V developed
educational materials relating to each archaeological site to be visited
on the tour, describing in detail the layout of the site, the methods
used by V's researchers in exploring the site, the discoveries made at
the site, and their historical significance. V also arranged special
guided tours of its exhibit on the Y region for individuals registered
for the travel tours. Two archaeologists from V (both of whom had
participated in prior archaeological expeditions in the Y region)
accompanied the tours. These experts led guided tours of each site and
explained the significance of the sites to tour participants. At several
of the sites, tour participants also met with a working team of
archaeologists from V and the National Museum of Z, who shared their
experiences. V prepared promotional materials describing the educational
nature of the tours, including the daily trips to V's archaeological
sites and the educational background of the tour leaders, and providing
a recommended reading list. The promotional materials do not refer to
any particular recreational or sightseeing activities. Based on the
facts and circumstances, sponsoring trips to the Y region is an activity
substantially related to V's exempt purposes. The scheduled activities,
which include tours of archaeological sites led by experts, are part of
a coordinated educational program designed to educate tour participants
about the ancient history of the Y region of Z and V's ongoing field
research. Therefore, V's tour program does not constitute an unrelated
trade or business within the meaning of section 513(a).
Example 7. W is an educational organization devoted to the study of
the performing arts and is exempt from federal income tax under section
501(a) as an organization described in section 501(c)(3). In connection
with its educational activities, W presents public performances of
musical and theatrical works. Individuals become members of W by making
an annual contribution to W of $q. Each year, W offers members an
opportunity to travel as a group to one or more major cities in the
United States or abroad. In each city, tour participants are provided
tickets to attend a public performance of a play, concert or dance
program each evening. W also arranges a sightseeing tour of each city
and provides evening receptions for tour participants. W views its tour
program as an important means to develop and strengthen bonds between W
and its members, and to increase their financial and volunteer support
of W. W engaged a travel agency to handle logistics such as
accommodations and transportation arrangements. No educational materials
are prepared by W or provided to tour participants in connection with
the tours. Apart from attendance at the evening cultural events, the
tours offer no scheduled instruction, organized study or group
discussion. Although several members of W's administrative staff
accompany each tour group, their role is to facilitate member
interaction. The staff members have no special expertise in the
performing arts and play no educational role in the tours. W prepared
promotional materials describing the sightseeing opportunities on the
tours and emphasizing the opportunity for members to socialize
informally and interact with one another and with W staff members, while
pursuing shared interests. Although W's tour program may foster goodwill
among W members, it does not contribute importantly to W's educational
purposes. W's tour program is primarily social and recreational in
nature. The scheduled activities, which include sightseeing and
attendance at various cultural events, are not part of a coordinated
educational program. Therefore, W's tour program is an unrelated trade
or business within the meaning of section 513(a).
[T.D. 8874, 65 FR 5773, Feb. 7, 2000; 65 FR 16143, Mar. 27, 2000]
Sec. 1.514(a)-1 Unrelated debt-financed income and deductions.
(a) Income includible in gross income:
[[Page 189]]
(1) Percentage of income taken into account--(i) In general. For
taxable years beginning after December 31, 1969, there shall be included
with respect to each debt-financed property (as defined in section 514
and Sec. 1.514(b)-1) as an item of gross income derived from an
unrelated trade or business the amount of unrelated debt-financed income
(as defined in subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph). See paragraph
(a)(5) of Sec. 1.514(c)-1 for special rules regarding indebtedness
incurred before June 28, 1966, applicable for taxable years beginning
before January 1, 1972, and for special rules applicable to churches or
conventions or associations of churches.
(ii) Unrelated debt-financed income. The unrelated debt-financed
income with respect to each debt-financed property is an amount which is
the same percentage (but not in excess of 100 percent) of the total
gross income derived during the taxable year from or on account of such
property as:
(a) The average acquisition indebtedness (as defined in subparagraph
(3) of this paragraph) with respect to the property is of
(b) The average adjusted basis of such property (as defined in
subparagraph (2) of this paragraph).
(iii) Debt/basis percentage. The percentage determined under
subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph is hereinafter referred to as the
debt/basis percentage.
(iv) Example. Subdivisions (i), (ii), and (iii) of this subparagraph
are illustrated by the following example. For purposes of this example
it is assumed that the property is debt-financed property.
Example. X, an exempt trade association, owns an office building
which in 1971 produces $10,000 of gross rental income. The average
adjusted basis of the building for 1971 is $100,000, and the average
acquisition indebtedness with respect to the building for 1971 is
$50,000. Accordingly, the debt/basis percentage for 1971 is 50 percent
(the ratio of $50,000 to $100,000). Therefore, the unrelated debt-
financed income with respect to the building for 1971 is $5,000 (50
percent of $10,000).
(v) Gain from sale or other disposition. If debt-financed property
is sold or otherwise disposed of, there shall be included in computing
unrelated business taxable income an amount with respect to such gain
(or loss) which is the same percentage (but not in excess of 100
percent) of the total gain (or loss) derived from such sale or other
disposition as:
(a) The highest acquisition indebtedness with respect to such
property during the 12-month period, preceding the date of disposition,
is of
(b) The average adjusted basis of such property.
The tax on the amount of gain (or loss) included in unrelated business
taxable income pursuant to the preceding sentence shall be determined in
accordance with the rules set forth in subchapter P, chapter 1 of the
Code (relating to capital gains and losses). See also section 511(d) and
the regulations thereunder (relating to the minimum tax for tax
preferences).
(2) Average adjusted basis--(i) In general. The average adjusted
basis of debt-financed property is the average amount of the adjusted
basis of such property during that portion of the taxable year it is
held by the organization. This amount is the average of:
(a) The adjusted basis of such property as of the first day during
the taxable year that the organization holds the property, and
(b) The adjusted basis of such property as of the last day during
the taxable year that the organization holds the property
See section 1011 and the regulations thereunder for determination of the
adjusted basis of property.
(ii) Adjustments for prior taxable years. For purposes of
subdivision (i) of this subparagraph, the determination of the average
adjusted basis of debt-financed property is not affected by the fact
that the organization was exempt from taxation for prior taxable years.
Proper adjustment must be made under section 1011 for the entire period
since the acquisition of the property. For example, adjustment must be
made for depreciation for all prior taxable years whether or not the
organization was exempt from taxation for any such years. Similarly, the
fact that only a portion of the depreciation allowance may be taken into
account in computing the percentage of deductions allowable under
section 514(a)(2) does not affect the amount of the adjustment
[[Page 190]]
for depreciation which is used in determining average adjusted basis.
(iii) Cross reference. For the determination of the basis of debt-
financed property acquired in a complete or partial liquidation of a
corporation in exchange for its stock, see Sec. 1.514(d)-1.
(iv) Example. This subparagraph may be illustrated by the following
example. For purposes of this example it is assumed that the property is
debt-financed property.
Example. On July 10, 1970, X, an exempt educational organization,
purchased an office building for $510,000, using $300,000 of borrowed
funds. During 1970 the only adjustment to basis is $20,000 for
depreciation. As of December 31, 1970, the adjusted basis of the
building is $490,000 and the indebtedness is still $300,000. X files its
return on a calendar year basis. Under these circumstances, the debt/
basis percentage for 1970 is 60 percent, calculated in the following
manner:
Basis
As of July 10, 1970 (acquisition date)..................... $510,000
As of December 31, 1970.................................... 490,000
------------
Total.................................................. 1,000,000
Average Adjusted basis:
[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TC08OC91.000
Debt/basis percentage:
Average acquisition indebtedness ($300,000)/Average adjusted basis
($500,000)=60 percent
For an illustration of the determination of the debt/basis percentage as
changes in the acquisition indebtedness occur, see example 1 of
subparagraph (3)(iii) of this paragraph.
(3) Average acquisition indebtedness--(i) In general. The average
acquisition indebtedness with respect to debt-financed property is the
average amount of the outstanding principal indebtedness during that
portion of the taxable year the property is held by the organization.
(ii) Computation. The average acquisition indebtedness is computed
by determining the amount of the outstanding principal indebtedness on
the first day in each calendar month during the taxable year that the
organization holds the property, adding these amounts together, and then
dividing this sum by the total number of months during the taxable year
that the organization held such property. A fractional part of a month
shall be treated as a full month in computing average acquisition
indebtedness.
(iii) Examples. The application of this subparagraph may be
illustrated by the following examples. For purposes of these examples it
is assumed that the property is debt-financed property.
Example 1. Assume the facts as stated in the example in subparagraph
(2)(iv) of this paragraph, except that beginning July 20, 1970, the
organization makes payments of $21,000 a month ($20,000 of which is
attributable to principal and $1,000 to interest). In this situation,
the average acquisition indebtedness for 1970 is $250,000. Thus, the
debt/basis percentage for 1970 is 50 percent, calculated in the
following manner:
Indebtedness
on the first
day in each
calendar month
that the
property is
held
Month:
July.................................................. $300,000
August................................................ 280,000
September............................................. 260,000
October............................................... 240,000
November.............................................. 220,000
December.............................................. 200,000
---------------
Total............................................. 1,500,000
Average acquisition indebtedness:
$1,500,000/6 months=$250,000
Debt/basis percentage:
Average acquisition indebtedness ($250,000)/Average adjusted basis
($500,000)=50 percent
Example 2. Y, an exempt organization, owns stock in a corporation
which it does not control. At the beginning of the year, Y has an
outstanding principal indebtedness with respect to such stock of
$12,000. Such indebtedness is paid off at the rate of $2,000 per month
beginning January 30, so that it is retired at the end of 6 months. The
average acquisition indebtedness for the taxable year is $3,500,
calculated in the following manner:
Indebtedness
on the first
day in each
calendar month
that the
property is
held
Month:
January............................................... $12,000
February.............................................. 10,000
March................................................. 8,000
April................................................. 6,000
May................................................... 4,000
June.................................................. 2,000
July thru December.................................... 0
---------------
Total............................................. 42,000
Average acquisition indebtedness:
[[Page 191]]
[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TC08OC91.001
(4) Indeterminate price--(i) In general. If an exempt organization
acquires (or improves) property for an indeterminate price, the initial
acquisition indebtedness and the unadjusted basis shall be determined in
accordance with subdivisions (ii) and (iii) of this paragraph, unless
the organization has obtained the consent of the Commissioner to use
another method to compute such amounts.
(ii) Unadjusted basis. For purposes of this subparagraph, the
unadjusted basis of property (or of an improvement) is the fair market
value of the property (or improvement) on the date of acquisition (or
the date of completion of the improvement). The average adjusted basis
of such property shall be determined in accordance with paragraph (a)(2)
of this section.
(iii) Initial acquisition indebtedness. For purposes of this
subparagraph, the initial acquisition indebtedness is the fair market
value of the property (or improvement) on the date of acquisition (or
the date of completion of the improvement) less any down payment or
other initial payment applied to the principal indebtedness. The average
acquisition indebtednessith respect to such property shall be computed
in accordance with paragraph (a)(3) of this section.
(iv) Example. The application of this subparagraph may be
illustrated by the following example. For purposes of this example it is
assumed that the property is debt-financed property.
Example. On January 1, 1971, X, an exempt trade association,
acquires an office building for a down payment of $310,000 and an
agreement to pay 10 percent of the income generated by the building for
10 years. Neither the sales price nor the amount which X is obligated to
pay in the future is certain. The fair market value of the building on
the date of acquisition is $600,000. The depreciation allowance for 1971
is $40,000. Unless X obtains the consent of the Commissioner to use
another method, the unadjusted basis of the property is $600,000 (the
fair market value of the property on the date of acquisition), and the
initial acquisition indebtedness is $290,000 (fair market value of
$600,000 less initial payment of $310,000). Under these circumstances,
the average adjusted basis of the property for 1971 is $580,000,
calculated as follows:
[Initial fair market value+(initial fair market value less
depreciation)] /2=[$600,000+($600,000-$40,000)] /2=$580,000.
If no payment other than the initial payment is made in 1971, the
average acquisition indebtedness for 1971 is $290,000. Thus, the debt/
basis percentage for 1971 is 50 percent, calculated as follows:
Average acquisition indebtedness /average adjusted basis=$290,000 /
$580,000=50 percent
(b) Deductions--(1) Percentage of deductions taken into account.
Except as provided in subparagraphs (4) and (5) of this paragraph, there
shall be allowed as a deduction with respect to each debt-financed
property an amount determined by applying the debt/basis percentage to
the sum of the deductions allowable under subparagraph (2) of this
paragraph.
(2) Deductions allowable. The deductions allowable are those items
allowed as deductions by chapter 1 of the Code which are directly
connected with the debt-financed property or the income therefrom
(including the dividends received deductions allowed by sections 243,
244, and 245), except that:
(i) The allowable deductions are subject to the modifications
provided by section 512(b) on computation of the unrelated business
taxable income, and
(ii) If the debt-financed property is of a character which is
subject to the allowance for depreciation provided in section 167, such
allowance shall be computed only by use of the straight-line method of
depreciation.
(3) Directly connected with. To be directly connected with debt-
financed property or the income therefrom, an item of deduction must
have proximate and primary relationship to such property or the income
therefrom. Expenses, depreciation, and similar items attributable solely
to such property are proximately and primarily related to such property
or the income therefrom, and therefore qualify for deduction, to the
extent they meet the requirements of subparagraph (2) of this paragraph.
Thus, for example, if the straight-line depreciation allowance for an
office building is $10,000 a year, an organization would be allowed a
deduction for depreciation of $10,000 if the entire building were debt-
financed property. However, if only one-half of
[[Page 192]]
the building were treated as debt-financed property, then the
depreciation allowed as a deduction would be $5,000. (See example 2 of
Sec. 1.514(b)-1(b)(1)(iii).)
(4) Capital losses--(i) In general. If the sale or exchange of debt-
financed property results in a capital loss, the amount of such loss
taken into account in the taxable year in which the loss arises shall be
computed in accordance with paragraph (a)(1)(v) of this section. If,
however, any portion of such capital loss not taken into account in such
year may be carried back or carried over to another taxable year, the
debt/basis percentage is not applied to determine what portion of such
capital loss may be taken as a deduction in the year to which such
capital loss is carried.
(ii) Example. This subparagraph is illustrated by the following
example. For purposes of this example it is assumed that the property is
debt-financed property.
Example. X, an exempt educational organization, owns securities
which are capital assets and which it has held for more than 6 months.
In 1972 X sells the securities at a loss of $20,000. The debt/basis
percentage with respect to computing the gain (or loss) derived from the
sale of the securities is 40 percent. Thus, X has sustained a capital
loss of $8,000 (40 percent of $20,000) with respect to the sale of the
securities. For 1972 and the preceding three taxable years X has no
other capital transactions. Under these circumstances, the $8,000 of
capital loss may be carried over to the succeeding 5 taxable years
without further application of the debt/basis percentage.
(5) Net operating loss--(i) In general. If, after applying the debt/
basis percentage to the income derived from debt-financed property and
the deductions directly connected with such income, such deductions
exceed such income, the organization has sustained a net operating loss
for the taxable year. This amount may be carried back or carried over to
other taxable years in accordance with section 512(b)(6). However, the
debt/ basis percentage shall not be applied in such other years to
determine the amounts that may be taken as a deduction in those years.
(ii) Example. This subparagraph may be illustrated by the following
example. For purposes of this example it is assumed that the property is
debt-financed property.
Example. During 1974, Y, an exempt organization, receives $20,000 of
rent from a building which it owns. Y has no other unrelated business
taxable income for 1974. For 1974 the deductions directly connected with
this building are property taxes of $5,000, interest of $5,000 on the
acquisition indebtedness, and salary of $15,000 to the manager of the
building. The debt/basis percentage for 1974 with respect to the
building is 50 percent. Under these circumstances, Y shall take into
account in computing its unrelated business taxable income for 1974,
$10,000 of income (50 percent of $20,000) and $12,500 (50 percent of
$25,000) of the deductions directly connected with such income. Thus,
for 1974 Y has sustained a net operating loss of $2,500 ($10,000 of
income less $12,500 of deductions) which may be carried back or carried
over to other taxable years without further application of the debt/
basis percentage.
[T.D. 7229, 37 FR 28143, Dec. 21, 1972]
Sec. 1.514(a)-2 Business lease rents and deductions for taxable years
beginning before January 1, 1970.
(a) Effective date. This section applies to taxable years beginning
before January 1, 1970.
(b) In general--(1) Rents includible in gross income. There shall be
included with respect to each business lease, as an item of gross income
derived from an unrelated trade or business, an amount which is the same
percentage (but not in excess of 100 percent) of the total rents derived
during the taxable year under such lease as:
(i) The amount of the business lease indebtedness at the close of
the taxable year of the lessor tax-exempt organization, with respect to
the premises covered by such lease, is of
(ii) The adjusted basis of such premises at the close of such
taxable year
For definition of business lease as a lease for a term of more than 5
years, and for rules for determining the computation of such 5-year term
in certain specific situations, see Sec. 1.514(f)-1. For definition of
business lease indebtedness and allocation of business lease
indebtedness where only a portion of the property is subject to a
business lease, see Sec. 1.514(g)-1.
(2) Determination of basis. For purposes of the unrelated business
income tax the basis (unadjusted) of property
[[Page 193]]
is determined under section 1012, and the adjusted basis of property is
determined under section 1011. The determination of the adjusted basis
of property is not affected by the fact that the organization was exempt
from tax for prior taxable years. Proper adjustment must be made under
section 1011 for the entire period since the acquisition of the
property. Thus adjustment must be made for depreciation for all taxable
years whether or not the organization was exempt from tax for any of
such years. Similarly, for taxable years during which the organization
is subject to the tax on unrelated business taxable income the fact that
only a portion of the deduction for depreciation is taken into account
under paragraph (c)(1) of this section does not affect the amount of the
adjustment for depreciation.
(3) Examples. The application of this paragraph may be illustrated
by the following examples, in each of which it is assumed that the
taxpayer makes its returns under section 511 on the basis of the
calendar year, and that the lease is not substantially related to the
purpose for which the organization is granted exemption from tax.
Example 1. Assume that a tax-exempt educational organization
purchased property in 1952 for $600,000, using borrowed funds, and
leased the building for a period of 20 years. Assume further that the
adjusted basis of such building at the close of 1954 is $500,000 and
that, at the close of 1954, $200,000 of the indebtedness incurred to
acquire the property remains outstanding. Since the amount of the
outstanding indebtedness is two-fifths of the adjusted basis of the
building at the close of 1954, two-fifths of the gross rental received
from the building during 1954 shall be included as an item of gross
income in computing unrelated business taxable income. If, at the close
of a subsequent taxable year, the outstanding indebtedness is $100,000
and the adjusted basis of the building is $400,000, one-fourth of the
gross rental for such taxable year shall be included as an item of gross
income in computing unrelated business taxable income for such taxable
year.
Example 2. Assume that a tax-exempt organization owns a four-story
building, that in 1954 it borrows $100,000 which it uses to improve the
whole building, and that it thereafter in 1954 rents the first and
second floors of the building under six-year leases at rentals of $4,000
a year. The third and fourth floors of the building are leased on a
yearly basis during 1954. Assume, also, that the adjusted basis of the
real property at the end of 1954 (after reflecting the expenditures for
improving the building) is $200,000, allocable equally to each of the
four stories. Under these facts, only one-half of the real property is
subject to a business lease since only one-half is rented under a lease
for more than 5 years. See Sec. 1.514(f)-1. The percentage of the rent
under such lease which is taken into account is determined by the ratio
which the allocable part of the business lease indebtedness bears to the
allocable part of the adjusted basis of the real property, that is, the
ratio which one-half of the $100,000 of business lease indebtedness
outstanding at the close of 1954, or $50,000, bears to one-half of the
adjusted basis of the business lease premises at the close of 1954, or
$100,000. The percentage of rent which is business lease income for 1954
is, therefore, one-half (the ratio of $50,000 to $100,000) of $8,000, or
$4,000, and this amount of $4,000 is considered an item of gross income
derived from an unrelated trade or business.
(c) Deductions--(1) Deductions allowable against gross income. The
same percentage is used in determining both the portion of the rent and
the portion of the deductions taken into account with respect to the
business lease in computing unrelated business taxable income. Such
percentage is applicable only to the sum of the following deductions
allowable under section 161:
(i) Taxes and other expenses paid or accrued during the taxable year
upon or with respect to the real property subject to the business lease;
(ii) Interest paid or accrued during the taxable year on the
business lease indebtedness;
(iii) A reasonable allowance for exhaustion, wear and tear
(including a reasonable allowance for obsolescence) of the real property
subject to such lease.
Where only a portion of the real property is subject to the business
lease, there shall be taken into account only those amounts of the
above-listed deductions which are properly allocable to the premises
covered by such lease.
(2) Excess deductions. The deductions allowable under subparagraph
(1) of this paragraph with respect to a business lease are not limited
by the amount included in gross income with respect to the rent from
such lease. Any excess of such deductions over such gross income shall
be applied against other items of gross income in
[[Page 194]]
computing unrelated business taxable income taxable under section
511(a).
(3) Example. The application of this paragraph may be illustrated by
the following example:
Example. Assume the same facts as those in example 1 in paragraph
(b)(3) of this section. Assume, also that for 1954 the organization pays
taxes of $4,000 on the property, interest of $6,000 on its business
lease indebtedness, and that the depreciation allowable for 1954 under
section 167 is $10,000. Under the facts set forth in such example 1 and
in this example, the deductions to be taken into account for 1954 in
computing unrelated business taxable income would be two-fifths of the
total of the deductions of $20,000, that is $8,000.
[T.D. 7229, 37 FR 28145, Dec. 21, 1972]
Sec. 1.514(b)-1 Definition of debt-financed property.
(a) In general. For purposes of section 514 and the regulations
thereunder, the term debt-financed property means any property which is
held to produce income (e.g., rental real estate, tangible personal
property, and corporate stock), and with respect to which there is an
acquisition indebtedness (determined without regard to whether the
property is debt-financed property) at any time during the taxable year.
The term income is not limited to recurring income but applies as well
to gains from the disposition of property. Consequently, when any
property held to produce income by an organization which is not used in
a manner described in section 514(b)(1) (A), (B), (C), or (D) is
disposed of at a gain during the taxable year, and there was an
acquisition indebtedness outstanding with respect to such property at
any time during the 12-month period preceding the date of disposition
(even though such period covers more than 1 taxable year), such property
is debt-financed property. For example, assume that on June 1, 1972, an
organization is given mortgaged, unimproved property which it does not
use in a manner described in section 514(b)(1) (A), (B), (C), or (D) and
that the organization assumes payment ofthe mortgage on such property.
On July 15, 1972, the organization sells such property for a gain. Such
property is debt-financed property and such gain is taxable as unrelated
debt-financed income. See section 514(c) and Sec. 1.514(c)-1 for rules
relating to when there is acquisition indebtedness with respect to
property. See paragraph (a) of Sec. 1.514(a)-1 for rules determining
the amount of income or gain from debt-financed property which is
treated as unrelated debt-financed income.
(b) Exceptions--(1) Property related to certain exempt purposes. (i)
To the extent that the use of any property is substantially related
(aside from the need of the organization for income or funds or the use
it makes of the profits derived) to the exercise or performance by an
organization of its charitable, educational, or other purpose or
function constituting its basis for exemption under section 501 (or, in
the case of an organization described in section 511(a)(2)(B), to the
exercise or performance of any purpose or function designated in section
501(c)(3)) such property shall not be treated as debt-financed property.
See Sec. 1.513-1 for principles applicable in determining whether there
is a substantial relationship to the exempt purpose of the organization.
(ii) If substantially all of any property is used in a manner
described in subdivision (i) of this subparagraph, such property shall
not be treated as debt-financed property. In general the preceding
sentence shall apply if 85 percent or more of the use of such property
is devoted to the organization's exempt purpose. The extent to which
property is used for a particular purpose shall be determined on the
basis of all the facts and circumstances. These may include (where
appropriate):
(a) A comparison of the portion of time such property is used for
exempt purposes with the total time such property is used,
(b) A comparison of the portion of such property that is used for
exempt purposes with the portion of such property that is used for all
purposes, or
(c) Both the comparisons described in (a) and (b) of this
subdivision.
(iii) This subparagraph may be illustrated by the following
examples. For purposes of these examples it is assumed that the
indebtedness is acquisition indebtedness.
Example 1. W, an exempt organization, owns a computer with respect
to which there
[[Page 195]]
is an outstanding principal indebtedness and which is used by W in the
performance of its exempt purpose. W sells time for the use of the
computer to M corporation on occasions when the computer is not in full-
time use by W. W uses the computer in furtherance of its exempt purpose
more than 85 percent of the time it is in use and M uses the computer
less than 15 percent of the total operating time the computer is in use.
In this situation, substantially all the use of the computer is related
to the performance of W's exempt purpose. Therefore, no portion of the
computer is treated as debt-financed property.
Example 2. X, an exempt college, owns a four story office building
which has been purchased with borrowed funds. In 1971, the lower two
stories of the building are used to house computers which are used by X
for administrative purposes. The top two stories are rented to the
public for purposes not described in section 514(b)(1) (A), (B), (C), or
(D). The gross income derived by X from the building is $6,000, all of
which is attributable to the rents paid by tenants. There are $2,000 of
expenses, allocable equally to each use of the building. The average
adjusted basis of the building for1971 is $100,000, and the outstanding
principal indebtedness throughout 1971 is $60,000. Thus, the average
acquisition indebtedness for 1971 is $60,000. In accordance with
subdivision (i) of this subparagraph, only the upper half of the
building is debt-financed property. Consequently, only the rental income
and the deductions directly connected with such income are to be taken
into account in computing unrelated business taxable income. The portion
of such amounts to be taken into account is determined by multiplying
the $6,000 of rental income and $1,000 of deductions directly connected
with such rental income by the debt/basis percentage. The debt/basis
percentage is the ratio which the allocable part of the average
acquisition indebtedness is of the allocable part of the average
adjusted basis of the property, that is, the ratio which $30,000 (one-
half of $60,000) bears to $50,000 (one-half of $100,000). Thus, the
debt/basis percentage for 1971 is 60 percent (the ratio of $30,000 to
$50,000). Under these circumstances, X shall include net rental income
of $3,000 in its unrelated business taxable income for 1971, computed as
follows:
Total rental income......................................... $6,000
Deductions directly connected with rental income............ $1,000
Debt/basis percentage ($30,000/$50,000)..................... 60%
Rental income treated as gross income from an unrelated $3,600
trade or business (60 percent of $6,000)...................
Less the allowable portion of deductions directly connected $600
with such income (60 percent of $1,000)....................
-----------
Net rental income included by X in computing its unrelated $3,000
business taxable income pursuant to section 514............
===========
Example 3. Assume the facts as stated in example 2 except that on
December 31, 1971, X sells the building and realizes a long-term capital
gain of $10,000. This is X's only capital transaction for 1971. An
allocable portion of this gain is subject to tax. This amount is
determined by multiplying the gain related to the nonexempt use, $5,000
(one-half of $10,000), by the ratio which the debtedness for the 12-
month period preceding the date of sale, $30,000 (one-half of $60,000),
is of the allocable part of the average adjusted basis, $50,000 (one-
half of $100,000). Thus, the debt/basis percentage with respect to
computing the gain (or loss) derived from the sale of the building is 60
percent (the ratio of $30,000 to $50,000). Consequently, $3,000 (60
percent of $5,000) is a net section 1201 gain (capital gain net income
for taxable years beginning after December 31, 1976). The portion of
such gain which is taxable shall be determined in accordance with rules
contained in subchapter P, chapter 1 of the Code (relating to capital
gains and losses). See also section 511(d) and the regulations
thereunder (relating to the minimum tax for tax preferences).
(2) Property used in an unrelated trade or business--(i) In general.
To the extent that the gross income from any property is treated as
income from the conduct of an unrelated trade or business, such property
shall not be treated as debt-financed property. However, any gain on the
disposition of such property which is not included in the income of an
unrelated trade or business by reason of section 512(b)(5) is includible
as gross income derived from or on account of debt-financed property
under paragraph (a)(1) of Sec. 1.514(a)-1.
(ii) Amounts specifically taxable under other provisions of the
Code. Section 514 does not apply to amounts which are otherwise included
in the computation of unrelated business taxable income, such as rents
from personal property includible pursuant to section 512(b)(13) or
rents and interest from controlled organizations includible pursuant to
section 512(b)(3). See paragraph (1)(5) of Sec. 1. 512(b)-1 for the
rules determining the manner in which amounts are taken into account
where such amounts may be included in the computation of unrelated
business taxable income by operation of more than one provision of the
Code.
[[Page 196]]
(3) Examples. Subparagraphs (1) and (2) of this paragraph may be
illustrated by the following examples. For purposes of these examples it
is assumed that the indebtedness is acquisition indebtedness.
Example 1. X, an exempt scientific organization, owns a 10-story
office building. During 1972, four stories are occupied by X's
administrative offices, and the remaining six stories are rented to the
public for purposes not described in section 514(b)(1) (A), (B), (C), or
(D). On December 31, 1972, the building is sold and X realizes a long-
term capital gain of $100,000. This is X's only capital transaction for
1972. The debt/basis percentage with respect to computing the gain (or
loss) derived from the sale of the building is 30 percent. Since 40
percent of the building was used for X's exempt purpose, only 60 percent
of the building is debt-financed property. Thus, only $60,000 of the
gain (60 percent of $100,000) is subject to this section. Consequently,
the amount of gain treated as unrelated debt-financed income is $18,000
($60,000 multiplied by the debt/basis percentage of 30 percent). The
portion of such $18,000 which is taxable shall be determined in
accordance with the rules contained in subchapter P, chapter 1 of the
Code. See also section 511(d) and the regulations thereunder (relating
to the minimum tax for tax preferences).
Example 2. Y, an exempt organization, owns two properties, a
restaurant and an office building. In 1972, all the space in the office
building, except for the portion utilized by Y to house the
administrative offices of the restaurant, is rented to the public for
purposes not described in section 514(b)(1) (A), (B), (C), or (D). The
average adjusted basis of the office building for 1972 is $2 million.
The outstanding principal indebtedness throughout 1972 is $1 million.
Thus, the highest acquisition indebtedness in the calendar year of 1972
is $1 million. It is determined that 30 percent of the space in the
office building is used for the administrative functions engaged in by
the employees of the organization with respect to the restaurant. Since
the income attributable to the restaurant is attributable to the conduct
of an unrelated trade or business, only 70 percent of the building is
treated as debt-financed property for purposes of determining the
portion of the rental income which is unrelated debt-financed income. On
December 31, 1972, the office building is sold and Y realizes a long-
term capital gain of $250,000. This is Y's only capital transaction for
1972. In accordance with subparagraph (2)(i) of this paragraph, all the
gain derived from this sale is taken into account in computing the
amount of such gain subject to tax. The portion of such gain which is
taxable is determined by multiplying the $250,000 gain by the debt/basis
percentage. The debt/basis percentage is the ratio which the highest
acquisition indebtedness for the 12-month period preceding the date of
sale, $1 million, is of the averageadjusted basis, $2 million. Thus, the
debt/basis percentage with respect to computing the gain (or loss)
derived from the sale of the building is 50 percent (the ratio of $1
million to $2 million). Consequently, $125,000 (50 percent of $250,000)
is a net section 1201 gain (net capital gain for taxable years beginning
after December 31, 1976). The amount of such gain which is taxable shall
be determined in accordance with the rules contained in subchapter P,
chapter 1 of the Code. See also section 511(d) and the regulations
thereunder.
Example 3. (a) Z, an exempt university, owns all the stock of M, a
nonexempt corporation. During 1971 M leases from Z University a factory
unrelated to Z's exempt purpose and a dormitory for the students of Z,
for a total annual rent of $100,000: $80,000 for the factory and $20,000
for the dormitory. During 1971, M has $500,000 of taxable income,
disregarding the rent paid to Z: $150,000 from the dormitory and
$350,000 from the factory. The factory is subject to a mortgage of
$150,000. Its average adjusted basis for 1971 is determined to be
$300,000. Z's deductions for 1971 with respect to the leased property
are $4,000 for the dormitory and $16,000 for the factory. In accordance
with subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph, section 514 applies only to
that portion of the rent which is excluded from the computation of
unrelated business taxable income by operation of section 512(b)(3) and
not included in such computation pursuant to section 512(b)(13). Since
all the rent received by Z is derived from real property, section
512(b)(3) would exclude all such rent from computation of Z's unrelated
business taxable income. However, 70 percent of the rent paid to Z with
respect to the factory and 70 percent of the deductions directly
connected with such rent shall be taken into account by Z in determining
its unrelated business taxable income pursuant to section 512(b)(15),
computed as follows:
M's taxable income (disregarding rent paid to Z)............ $500,000
Less taxable income from dormitory.......................... $150,000
-----------
Excess taxable income....................................... $350,000
Ratio ($350,000/$500,000)................................... \7/10\
Total rent paid to Z........................................ $100,000
Total deductions ($4,000+$16,000)........................... $20,000
Rental income treated under section 512(b)(15) as gross $70,000
income from an unrelated trade or business (\7/10\ of
$100,000)..................................................
Less deductions directly connected with such income (\7/10\ $14,000
of $20,000)................................................
-----------
Net rental income included by Z in computing its unrelated $56,000
business taxable income pursuant to section 512(b)(15).....
[[Page 197]]
(b) Since only that portion of the rent derived from the factory and
the deductions directly connected with such rent not taken into account
pursuant to section 512(b)(15) may be included in computing unrelated
business taxable income by operation of section 514, only $10,000
($80,000 minus $70,000) of rent and $2,000 ($16,000 minus $14,000) of
deductions are so taken into account. The portion of such amounts to be
taken into account is determined by multiplying the $10,000 of income
and $2,000 of deductions by the debt/basis percentage. The debt/basis
percentage is the ratio which the average acquisition indebtedness
($150,000) is of the average adjusted basis of the property ($300,000).
Thus, the debt/basis percentage for 1971 is 50 percent (the ratio of
$150,000 to $300,000). Under these circumstances, Z shall include net
rental income of $4,000 in its unrelated business taxable income for
1971, computed as follows:
Total rents................................................. $10,000
Deductions directly connected with such rents............... $2,000
Debt/basis percentage ($150,000/$300,000)................... 50%
Rental income treated as gross income from an unrelated $5,000
trade or business (50 percent of $10,000)..................
Less the allowable portion of deductions directly connected $1,000
with such income (50 percent of $2,000)....................
Net rental income included by Z in computing its unrelated $4,000
business taxable income pursuant to section 514............
(4) Property related to research activities. To the extent that the
gross income from any property is derived from research activities
excluded from the tax on unrelated business income by paragraph (7),
(8), or (9) of section 512(b), such property shall not be treated as
debt-financed property.
(5) Property used in thrift shops, etc. To the extent that property
is used in any trade or business which is excepted from the definition
of unrelated trade or business by paragraph (1), (2), or (3) of section
513(a), such property shall not be treated as debt-financed property.
(6) Use by a related organization. For purposes of subparagraph (1),
(4), or (5) of this paragraph, use of property by a related exempt
organization (as defined in paragraph (c)(2)(ii) of this section) for a
purpose described in such subparagraphs shall be taken into account in
order to determine the extent to which such property is used for a
purpose described in such subparagraphs.
(c) Special rules--(1) Medical clinic. Property is not debt-financed
property if it is real property subject to a lease to a medical clinic,
and the lease is entered into primarily for purposes which are
substantially related (aside from the need of such organization for
income or funds or the use it makes of the rents derived) to the
exercise or performance by the lessor of its charitable, educational, or
other purpose or function constituting the basis for its exemption under
section 501. For example, assume that an exempt hospital leases all of
its clinic space to an unincorporated association of physicians and
surgeons who, by the provisions of the lease, agree to provide all of
the hospital's out-patient medical and surgical services and to train
all of the hospital's residents and interns. In this situation, the
rents received by the hospital from this clinic are not to be treated as
unrelated debt-financed income.
(2) Related exempt uses--(i) In general. Property owned by an exempt
organization and used by a related exempt organization or by an exempt
organization related to such related exempt organization shall not be
treated as debt-financed property to the extent such property is used by
either organization in furtherance of the purpose constituting the basis
for its exemption under section 501. Furthermore, property shall not be
treated as debt-financed property to the extent such property is used by
a related exempt organization for a purpose described in paragraph
(b)(4) or (5) of this section.
(ii) Related organizations. For purposes of subdivision (i) of this
subparagraph, an exempt organization is related to another exempt
organization only if:
(a) One organization is an exempt holding company described in
section 501(c)(2) and the other organization receives the profits
derived by such exempt holding company,
(b) One organization has control of the other organization within
the meaning of paragraph (1)(4) of Sec. 1.512(b)-1,
(c) More than 50 percent of the members of one organization are
members of the other organization, or
(d) Each organization is a local organization which is directly
affiliated with a common state, national, or international organization
which is also exempt.
[[Page 198]]
(iii) Examples. This subparagraph may be illustrated by the
following examples. For purposes of these examples it is assumed that
the indebtedness is acquisition indebtedness.
Example 1. M, an exempt trade association described in section
501(c)(6), leases 70 percent of the space of an office building for
furtherance of its exempt purpose. The title to such building is held by
N, an exempt holding company described in section 501(c)(2), which
acquired title to the building with borrowed funds. The other 30 percent
of the space in this office building is leased to L, a nonstock exempt
trade association described in section 501(c)(6). L uses such office
space in furtherance of its exemptpurpose. The members of L's Board of
Trustees serves for fixed terms and M's Board of Directors has the power
to select all such members. N pays over to M all the profits it derives
from the leasing of space in this building to M and L. Accordingly, M is
related to N (as such term is defined in subdivision (ii)(a) of this
subparagraph) and L is related to M (as such term is defined in
subdivision (ii)(b) of this subparagraph). Under these circumstances,
since all the available space in the building is leased to either an
exempt organization related to the exempt organization holding title to
the building or an exempt organization related to such related exempt
organization, no portion of the building is treated as debt-financed
property.
Example 2. W, an exempt labor union described in section 501(c)(5),
owns a 10-story office building which has been purchased with borrowed
funds. Five floors of the building are used by W in furtherance of its
exempt purpose. Four of the other floors are rented to X which is an
exempt voluntary employees' beneficiary association described in section
501(c)(9), operated for the benefit of W's members. X uses such office
space in furtherance of its exempt purpose. Seventy percent of the
members of W are also members of X. Accordingly, X is related to W (as
such term is defined in subdivision (ii)(c) of this subparagraph). The
remaining floor of the building is rented to the general public for
purposes not described in section 514(b)(1) (A), (B), (C), or (D). Under
thesecircumstances, no portion of this building is treated as debt-
financed property since more than 85 percent of the office space
available in this building is used either by W or X, an exempt
organization related to W, in furtherance of their respective exempt
purpose. See paragraph (b)(1) of this section for rules relating to the
use of property substantially related to an exempt purpose. See
paragraph (b)(6) of this section for rules relating to uses by related
exempt organizations.
Example 3. Assume the same facts as in example 2, except that W and
X are each exempt local labor unions described in section 501(c)(5)
having no common membership and are each affiliated with N, an exempt
international labor union described in section 501(c)(5). Under these
circumstances, no portion of this building is treated as debt-financed
property since more than 85 percent of the office space available in
this building is used either by W or X, an exempt organization related
to W, in furtherance of their respective exempt purpose.
Example 4. Assume the same facts as in example 3, except that W and
X are directly affiliated with different exempt international labor
unions and that W and X are not otherwise affiliated with, or members
of, a common exempt organization, other than an association of
international labor unions. Under these circumstances, the portions of
this building which are rented to X and to the general public are
treated as debt-financed property since X is not related to W and W uses
less than 85 percent of the building for its exempt purpose.
(3) Life income contracts. (i) Property shall not be treated as
debt-financed property when:
(a) An individual transfers property to a trust or a fund subject to
a contract providing that the income is to be paid to him or other
individuals or both for a period of time not to exceed the life of such
individual or individuals in a transaction in which the payments to the
individual or individuals do not constitute the proceeds of a sale or
exchange of the property so transferred, and
(b) The remainder interest is payable to an exempt organization
described in section 501(c)(3).
(ii) Subdivision (i) of this subparagraph is illustrated by the
following example.
Example. On January 1, 1967, A transfers property to X, an exempt
organization described in section 501(c)(3), which immediately places
the property in a fund. On January 1, 1971, A transfers additional
property to X, which property is also placed in the fund. In exchange
for each transfer, A receives income participation fund certificates
which entitle him to a proportionate part of the fund's income for his
life and for the life of another individual. None of the payments made
by X are treated by the recipients as the proceeds of a sale or exchange
of the property transferred. In this situation, none of the property
received by X from A is treated as debt-financed property.
[[Page 199]]
(d) Property acquired for prospective exempt use--(1) Neighborhood
land--(i) In general. If an organization acquires real property for the
principal purpose of using the land in the exercise or performance of
its exempt purpose, commencing within 10 years of the time of
acquisition, such property will not be treated as debt-financed
property, so long as (a) such property is in the neighborhood of other
property owned by the organization which is used in the performance of
its exempt purpose, and (b) the organization does not abandon its intent
to use the land in such a manner within the 10-year period. The rule
expressed in this subdivision is hereinafter referred to as the
neighborhood land rule.
(ii) Neighborhood defined. Property shall be considered in the
neighborhood of property owned and used by the organization in the
performance of its exempt purpose if the acquired property is contiguous
with the exempt purpose property or would be contiguous with such
property except for the interposition of a road, street, railroad,
stream, or similar property. If the acquired property is not contiguous
with exempt function property, it may still be in the neighborhood of
such property, but only if it is within 1 mile of such property and the
facts and circumstances of the particular situation make the acquisition
of contiguous property unreasonable. Some of the criteria to consider in
determining this question include the availability of land and the
intended future use of the land. For example, a university attempts to
purchase land contiguous to its present campus but cannot do so because
the owners either refuse to sell or ask unreasonable prices. The nearest
land of sufficient size and utility is a block away from the campus. The
university purchases such land. Under these circumstances, the
contiguity requirement is unreasonable and the land purchased would be
considered neighborhood land.
(iii) Exception. The neighborhood land rule shall not apply to any
property after the expiration of 10 years from the date of acquisition.
Further, the neighborhood land rule shall apply after the first 5 years
of the 10-year period only if the organization establishes to the
satisfaction of the Commissioner that future use of the acquired land in
furtherance of the organization's exempt purpose before the expiration
of the 10-year period is reasonably certain. In order to satisfy the
Commissioner, the organization does not necessarily have to show binding
contracts. However, it must at least have a definite plan detailing a
specific improvement and a completion date, and some affirmative action
toward the fulfillment of such a plan. This information shall be
forwarded to the Commissioner of Internal Revenue, Washington, DC 20224,
for a ruling at least 90 days before the end of the fifth year after
acquisition of the land.
(2) Actual use. If the neighborhood land rule is inapplicable
because:
(i) The acquired land is not in the neighborhood of other property
used by the organization in performance of its exempt purpose, or
(ii) The organization (for the period after the first 5 years of the
10-year period) is unable to establish to the satisfaction of the
Commissioner that the use of the acquired land for its exempt purposes
within the 10-year period is reasonably certain
but the land is actually used by the organization in furtherance of its
exempt purpose within the 10-year period, such property (subject to the
provisions of subparagraph (4) of this paragraph) shall not be treated
as debt-financed property for any period prior to such conversion.
(3) Limitations--(i) Demolition or removal required. (a)
Subparagraphs (1) and (2) of this paragraph shall apply with respect to
any structure on the land when acquired by the organization, or to the
land occupied by the structure, only so long as the intended future use
of the land in furtherance of the organization's exempt purpose requires
that the structure be demolished or removed in order to use the land in
such a manner. Thus, during the first 5 years after acquisition (and for
subsequent years if there is a favorable ruling in accordance with
subparagraph (1)(iii) of this paragraph) improved property is not debt-
financed so long as the organization does not abandon its intent to
demolish the existing structures and use the land in furtherance of
[[Page 200]]
its exempt purpose. Furthermore, if there is an actual demolition of
such structures, the use made of the land need not be the one originally
intended. Therefore, the actual use requirement of this subdivision may
be satisfied by using the land in any manner which furthers the exempt
purpose of the organization.
(b) Subdivision (i)(a) of this subparagraph may be illustrated by
the following examples. For purposes of the following examples it is
assumed that but for the application of the neighborhood land rule such
property would be debt-financed property.
Example 1. An exempt university acquires a contiguous tract of land
on which there is an apartment building. The university intends to
demolish the apartment building and build classrooms and does not
abandon this intent during the first 4 years after acquisition. In the
fifth year after acquisition it abandons the intent to demolish and
sells the apartment building. Under these circumstances, such property
is not debt-financed property for the first 4 years after acquisition
even though there was no eventual demolition or use made of such land in
furtherance of the university's exempt purpose. However, such property
is debt-financed property as of the time in the fifth year that the
intent to demolish the building is abandoned and any gain on the sale of
property is subject to section 514.
Example 2. Assume the facts as stated in Example 1 except that the
university did not abandon its intent to demolish the existing building
and construct a classroom building until the eighth year after
acquisition when it sells the property. Assume further that the
university did not receive a favorable ruling in accordance with
subparagraph (1)(iii) of this paragraph. Under these circumstances, the
building is debt- financed property for the sixth, seventh, and eighth
years. It is not, however, treated as debt-financed property for the
first 5 years after acquisition.
Example 3. Assume the facts as stated in Example 2 except that the
university received a favorable ruling in accordance with subparagraph
(1)(iii) of this paragraph. Under these circumstances, the building is
not debt-financed property for the first 7 years after acquisition. It
only becomes debt-financed property as of the time in the eighth year
when the university abandoned its intent to demolish the existing
structure.
Example 4. (1) Assume that a university acquires a contiguous tract
of land containing an office building for the principal purpose of
demolishing the office building and building a modern dormitory. Five
years later the dormitory has not been constructed, and the university
has failed to satisfy the Commissioner that the office building will be
demolished and the land will be used in furtherance of its exempt
purpose (and consequently has failed to obtain a favorable ruling under
subparagraph (1)(iii) of this paragraph). In the ninth taxable year
after acquisition the university converts the office building into an
administration building. Under these circumstances, during the sixth,
seventh, and eighth years after acquisition, the office building is
treated as debt-financed property because the office building was not
demolished or removed. Therefore, the income derived from such property
during these years shall be subject to the tax on unrelated business
income.
(2) Assume that instead of converting the office building to an
administration building, the university demolishes the office building
in the ninth taxable year after acquisition and then constructs a new
administration building. Under these circumstances, the land would not
be considered debt-financed property for any period following the
acquisition, and the university would be entitled to a refund of taxes
paid on the income derived from such property for the sixth through
eighth taxable years after the acquisition in accordance with
subparagraph (4) of this paragraph.
(ii) Subsequent construction. Subparagraphs (1) and (2) of this
paragraph do not apply to structures erected on the land after the
acquisition of the land.
(iii) Property subject to business lease. Subparagraphs (1) and (2)
of this paragraph do not apply to property subject to a lease which is a
business lease (as defined in Sec. 1.514(f)-1) whether the organization
acquired the property subject to the lease or whether it executed the
lease subsequent to acquisition. If only a portion of the real property
is subject to a lease, paragraph (c) of Sec. 1.514(f)-1 applies in
determining whether such lease is a business lease.
(4) Refund of taxes. (i) If an organization has not satisfied the
actual use condition of subparagraph (2) of this paragraph or paragraph
(e)(3) of this section before the date prescribed by law (including
extensions) for filing the return for the taxable year, the tax for such
year shall be computed without regard to the application of such actual
use condition. However, if:
(a) A credit or refund of any overpayment of taxes is allowable for
a prior taxable year as a result of the satisfaction of such actual use
condition, and
[[Page 201]]
(b) Such credit or refund is prevented by the operation of any law
or rule of law (other than chapter 74, relating to closing agreements
and compromises)
such credit or refund may nevertheless be allowed or made, if a claim is
filed within 1 year after the close of the taxable year in which such
actual use condition is satisfied. For a special rule with respect to
the payment of interest at the rate of 4 percent per annum, see section
514(b)(3)(D), prior to its amendment by section 7(b) of the Act of
January 3, 1975 (Pub. L. 93-625, 88 Stat. 2115).
(ii) This subparagraph may be illustrated by the following example.
For purposes of this example it is assumed that but for the neighborhood
land rule such property would be debt-financed property.
Example. Y, a calendar year exempt organization, acquires real
property in January 1970, which is contiguous with other property used
by Y in furtherance of its exempt purpose. However, Y does not satisfy
the Commissioner by January 1975, that the existing structure will be
demolished and the land will be used in furtherance of its exempt
purpose. In accordance with this subparagraph, from 1975 until the
property is converted to an exempt use, the income derived from such
property shall be subject to the tax on unrelated business income.
During July 1979, Y demolishes the existing structure on the land and
begins using the land in furtherance of its exempt purpose. At this time
Y may file claims for refund for the open years 1976 through 1978.
Further, in accordance with this subparagraph, Y may also file a claim
for refund for 1975, even though a claim for such taxable year may be
barred by the statute of limitations, provided such claim is filed
before the close of 1980.
(e) Churches--(1) In general. If a church or association or
convention of churches acquires real property, for the principal purpose
of using the land in the exercise or performance of its exempt purpose,
commencing within 15 years of the time of acquisition, such property
shall not be treated as debt-financed property so long as the
organization does not abandon its intent to use the land in such a
manner within the 15-year period.
(2) Exception. This paragraph shall not apply to any property after
the expiration of the 15-year period. Further, this paragraph shall
apply after the first 5 years of the 15-year period only if the church
or association or convention of churches establishes to the satisfaction
of the Commissioner that use of the acquired land in furtherance of the
organization's exempt purpose before the expiration of the 15-year
period is reasonably certain. For purposes of the preceding sentence,
the rules contained in paragraph (d)(1)(iii) of this section with
respect to satisfying the Commissioner that the exempt organization
intends to use the land within the prescribed time in furtherance of its
exempt purpose shall apply.
(3) Actual use. If the church or association or convention of
churches for the period after the first 5 years of the 15-year period is
unable to establish to the satisfaction of the Commissioner that the use
of the acquired land for its exempt purpose within the 15-year period is
reasonably certain, but such land is in fact converted to an exempt use
within the 15-year period, the land (subject to the provisions of
paragraph (d)(4) of this section) shall not be treated as debt-financed
property for any period prior to such conversion.
(4) Limitations. The limitations stated in paragraph (d)(3)(i) and
(ii) of this section shall similarly apply to the rules contained in
this paragraph.
[T.D. 7229, 37 FR 28146, Dec. 21, 1972; 39 FR 6607, Feb. 21, 1974, as
amended by T.D. 7384, 40 FR 49322, Oct. 22, 1975; T.D. 7632, 44 FR
42681, July 20, 1979; T.D. 7728, 45 FR 72651, Nov. 3, 1980]
Sec. 1.514(c)-1 Acquisition indebtedness.
(a) In general--(1) Definition of acquisition indebtedness. For
purposes of section 514 and the regulations thereunder, the term
acquisition indebtedness means, with respect to any debt-financed
property, the outstanding amount of:
(i) The principal indebtedness incurred by the organization in
acquiring or improving such property.
(ii) The principal indebtedness incurred before the acquisition or
improvement of such property if such indebtedness would not have been
incurred but for such acquisition or improvement; and
[[Page 202]]
(iii) The principal indebtedness incurred after the acquisition or
improvement of such property if such indebtedness would not have been
incurred but for such acquisition or improvement and the incurrence of
such indebtedness was reasonably foreseeable at the time of such
acquisition or improvement
Whether the incurrence of an indebtedness is reasonably foreseeable
depends upon the facts and circumstances of each situation. The fact
that an organization did not actually foresee the need for the
incurrence of an indebtedness prior to the acquisition or improvement
does not necessarily mean that the subsequent incurrence of indebtedness
was not reasonably foreseeable.
(2) Examples. The application of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph
may be illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. X, an exempt organization, pledges some of its investment
securities with a bank for a loan and uses the proceeds of such loan to
purchase an office building which it leases to the public for purposes
other than those described in section 514(b)(1) (A), (B), (C), or (D).
The outstanding principal indebtedness with respect to the loan
constitutes acquisition indebtedness incurred prior to the acquisition
which would not have been incurred but for such acquisition.
Example 2. Y, an exempt scientific organization, mortgages its
laboratory to replace working capital used in remodeling an office
building which Y rents to an insurance company for purposes not
described in section 514(b)(1) (A), (B), (C), or (D). The indebtedness
is acquisition indebtedness since such indebtedness, though incurred
subsequent to the improvement of the office building, would not have
been incurred but for such improvement, and the indebtedness was
reasonably foreseeable when, to make such improvement, Y reduced its
working capital below the amount necessary to continue current
operations.
Example 3. (a) U, an exempt private preparatory school, as its sole
educational facility owns a classroom building which no longer meets the
needs of U's students. In 1971, U sells this building for $3 million to
Y, a corporation which it does not control. U receives $1 million as a
down payment from Y and takes back a purchase money mortgage of $2
million which bears interest at 10 percent per annum. At the time U
became the mortgagee of the $2 million purchase money mortgage, U
realized that it would have to construct a new classroom building and
knew that it would have to incur an indebtedness in the construction of
the new classroom building. In 1972, U builds a new classroom building
for a cost of $4 million. In connection with the construction of this
building, U borrows $2.5 million from X Bank pursuant to a deed of trust
bearing interest at 6 percent perannum. Under these circumstances, $2
million of the $2.5 million borrowed to finance construction of the new
classroom building would not have been borrowed but for the retention of
the $2 million purchase money mortgage. Since such indebtedness was
reasonably foreseeable, $2 million of the $2.5 million borrowed to
finance the construction of the new classroom building is acquisition
indebtedness with respect to the purchase money mortgage and the
purchase money mortgage is debt-financed property.
(b) In 1972, U receives $200,000 in interest from Y (10 percent of
$2 million) and makes a $150,000 interest payment to X (6 percent of
$2.5 million). In addition, assume that for 1972 the debt/basis
percentage is 100 percent ($2 million/$2 million). Accordingly, all the
interest and all the deductions directly connected with such interest
income are to be taken into account in computing unrelated business
taxable income. Thus, $200,000 of interest income and $120,000
($150,000x$2 million/$2.5 million) of deductions directly connected with
such interest income are taken into account. Under these circumstances,
U shall include net interest income of $80,000 ($200,000 of income less
$120,000 of deductions directly connected with such income) in its
unrelated business taxable income for 1972.
Example 4. In 1972 X, an exempt organization, forms a partnership
with A and B. The partnership agreement provides that all three partners
shall share equally in the profits of the partnership, shall each invest
$3 million, and that X shall be a limited partner. X invests $1 million
of its own funds in the partnership and $2 million of borrowed funds.
The partnership purchases as its sole asset an office building which is
leased to the general public for purposes other than those described in
section 514(b)(1) (A), (B), (C), or (D). The office building cost the
partnership $24 million of which $15 million is borrowed from Y bank.
This loan is secured by a mortgage on the entire office building. By
agreement with Y bank, X is held not to be personally liable for payment
of such mortgage. By reason of section 702(b) the character of any item
realized by the partnership and included in the partner's distributive
share shall be determined as if the partner realized such item directly
from the source from which it was realized by the partnership and in the
same manner. Therefore, a portion of X's income from the building is
debt-financed income. Under these circumstances,
[[Page 203]]
since both the $2 million indebtedness incurred by X in acquiring its
partnership interest and $5 million, the allocable portion of the
partnership'sindebtedness incurred with respect to acquiring the office
building which is attributable to X in computing the debt/basis
percentage (one-third of $15 million), were incurred in acquiring
income-producing property, X has acquisition indebtedness of $7 million
($2 million plus $5 million). Similarly, the allocable portion of the
partnership's adjusted basis in the office building which is
attributable to X in computing the debt-basis percentage is $8 million
(one-third of $24 million). Assuming no payment with respect to either
indebtedness and no adjustments to basis in 1972, X's average
acquisition indebtedness is $7 million and X's average adjusted basis is
$8 million for such year. Therefore, X's debt/basis percentage with
respect to its share of the partnership income for 1972 is 87.5 percent
($7 million/$8 million).
(3) Changes in use of property. Since property used in a manner
described in section 514(b)(1) (A), (B), (C), or (D) is not considered
debt-financed property, indebtedness with respect to such property is
not acquisition indebtedness. However, if an organization converts such
property to a use which is not described in section 514(b)(1) (A), (B),
(C), or (D) and such property is otherwise treated as debt-financed
property, the outstanding principal indebtedness with respect to such
property will thereafter be treated as acquisition indebtedness. For
example, assume that in 1971 a university borrows funds to acquire an
apartment building as housing for married students. In 1974 the
university rents the apartment building to the public for purposes not
described in section 514(b)(1) (A), (B), (C), or (D). The outstanding
principal indebtedness is acquisition indebtedness as of the time in
1974 when the building is first rented to the public.
(4) Continued indebtedness. If:
(i) An organization sells or exchanges property, subject to an
indebtedness (incurred in a manner described in subparagraph (1) of this
paragraph),
(ii) Acquires another property without retiring the indebtedness,
and
(iii) The newly acquired property is otherwise treated as debt-
financed property
the outstanding principal indebtedness with respect to the acquired
property is acquisition indebtedness, even though the original property
was not debt-financed property. For example, to house its administrative
offices, an exempt organization purchases a building with $600,000 of
its own funds and $400,000 of borrowed funds secured by a pledge of its
securities. It later sells the building for $1,000,000 without redeeming
the pledge. It uses these proceeds to purchase an apartment building
which it rents to the public for purposes not described in section
514(b)(1) (A), (B), (C), or (D). The indebtedness of $400,000 is
acquisition indebtedness with respect to the apartment building even
though the office building was not debt-financed property.
(5) Indebtedness incurred before June 28, 1966. For taxable years
beginning before January 1, 1972, acquisition indebtedness does not
include any indebtedness incurred before June 28, 1966, unless such
indebtedness was incurred on rental real property subject to a business
lease and such indebtedness constituted business lease indebtedness.
Furthermore, in the case of a church or convention or association of
churches, the preceding sentence applies without regard to whether the
indebtedness incurred before June 28, 1966, constituted business lease
indebtedness.
(b) Property acquired subject to lien--(1) Mortgages. Except as
provided in subparagraphs (3) and (4) of this paragraph, whenever
property is acquired subject to a mortgage, the amount of the
outstanding principal indebtedness secured by such mortgage is treated
as acquisition indebtedness with respect to such property even though
the organization did not assume or agree to pay such indebtedness. The
preceding sentence applies whether property is acquired by purchase,
gift, devise, bequest, or any other means. Thus, for example, assume
that an exempt organization pays $50,000 for real property valued at
$150,000 and subject to a $100,000 mortgage. The $100,000 of outstanding
principal indebtedness is acquisition indebtedness just as though the
organization had borrowed $100,000 to buy the property.
(2) Other liens. For purposes of this paragraph, liens similar to
mortgages shall be treated as mortgages. A lien is similar to a mortgage
if title to property is encumbered by the lien for the
[[Page 204]]
benefit of a creditor. However, in the case where State law provides
that a tax lien attaches to property prior to the time when such lien
becomes due and payable, such lien shall not be treated as similar to a
mortgage until after it has become due and payable and the organization
has had an opportunity to pay such lien in accordance with State law.
Liens similar to mortgages include (but are not limited to):
(i) Deeds of trust,
(ii) Conditional sales contracts,
(iii) Chattel mortgages,
(iv) Security interests under the Uniform Commercial Code,
(v) Pledges,
(vi) Agreements to hold title in escrow, and
(vii) Tax liens (other than those described in the third sentence of
this subparagraph).
(3) Certain encumbered property acquired by gift, bequest or
devise--(i) Bequest or devise. Where property subject to a mortgage is
acquired by an organization by bequest or devise, the outstanding
principal indebtedness secured by such mortgage is not to be treated as
acquisition indebtedness during the 10-year period following the date of
acquisition. For purposes of the preceding sentence, the date of
acquisition is the date the organization receives the property.
(ii) Gifts. If an organization acquires property by gift subject to
a mortgage, the outstanding principal indebtedness secured by such
mortgage shall not be treated as acquisition indebtedness during the 10-
year period following the date of such gift, so long as:
(a) The mortgage was placed on the property more than 5 years before
the date of the gift, and
(b) The property was held by the donor for more than 5 years before
the date of the gift
For purposes of the preceding sentence, the date of the gift is the date
the organization receives the property.
(iii) Limitation. Subdivisions (i) and (ii) of this subparagraph
shall not apply if:
(a) The organization assumes and agrees to pay all or any part of
the indebtedness secured by the mortgage, or
(b) The organization makes any payment for the equity owned by the
decedent or the donor in the property (other than a payment pursuant to
an annuity excluded from the definition of acquisition indebtedness by
paragraph (e) of this section)
Whether an organization has assumed and agreed to pay all or any part of
an indebtedness in order to acquire the property shall be determined by
the facts and circumstances of each situation.
(iv) Examples. The application of this subparagraph may be
illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. A dies on January 1, 1971. His will devises an office
building subject to a mortgage to U, an exempt organization described in
section 501(c)(3). U does not at any time assume the mortgage. For the
period 1971 through 1980, the outstanding principal indebtedness secured
by the mortgage is not acquisition indebtedness. However, after December
31, 1980, the outstanding principal indebtedness secured by the mortgage
is acquisition indebtedness if the building is otherwise treated as
debt-financed property.
Example 2. Assume the facts as stated in example 1 except that on
January 1, 1975, U assumes the mortgage. After January 1, 1975, the
outstanding principal indebtedness secured by the mortgage is
acquisition indebtedness if the building is otherwise treated as debt-
financed property.
(4) Bargain sale before October 9, 1969. Where property subject to a
mortgage is acquired by an organization before October 9, 1969, the
outstanding principal indebtedness secured by such mortgage is not to be
treated as acquisition indebtedness during the 10-year period following
the date of acquisition if:
(i) The mortgage was placed on the property more than 5 years before
the purchase, and
(ii) The organization paid the seller a total amount no greater than
the amount of the seller's cost (including attorney's fees) directly
related to the transfer of such property to the organization, but in any
event no more than 10 percent of the value of the seller's equity in the
property transferred.
(c) Extension of obligations--(1) In general. An extension, renewal,
or refinancing of an obligation evidencing a preexisting indebtedness is
considered
[[Page 205]]
as a continuation of the old indebtedness to the extent the outstanding
principal amount thereof is not increased. Where the principal amount of
the modified obligation exceeds the outstanding principal amount of the
preexisting indebtedness, the excess shall be treated as a separate
indebtedness for purposes of section 514 and the regulations thereunder.
For example, if the interest rate on an obligation incurred prior to
June 28, 1966, by an exempt university is modified subsequent to such
date, the modified obligation shall be deemed to have been incurred
prior to June 28, 1966. Thus, such an indebtedness will not be treated
as acquisition indebtedness for taxable years beginning before January
1, 1972, unless the original indebtedness was business lease
indebtedness (as defined in Sec. 1.514(g)-1).
(2) Extension or renewal. In general, any modification or
substitution of the terms of an obligation by the organization shall be
an extension or renewal of the original obligation, rather than the
creation of a new indebtedness to the extent that the outstanding
principal amount of the indebtedness is not increased. The following are
examples of acts which result in the extension or renewal of an
obligation:
(i) Substitution of liens to secure the obligation;
(ii) Substitution of obligees, whether or not with the consent of
the organization;
(iii) Renewal, extension or acceleration of the payment terms of the
obligation; and
(iv) Addition, deletion, or substitution of sureties or other
primary or secondary obligors.
(3) Allocation. In cases where the outstanding principal amount of
the modified obligation exceeds the outstanding principal amount of the
unmodified obligation and only a portion of such refinanced indebtedness
is to be treated as acquisition indebtedness, payments on the amount of
the refinanced indebtedness shall be apportioned prorata between the
amount of the preexisting indebtedness and the excess amount. For
example, assume that an organization has an outstanding principal
indebtedness of $500,000 which is treated as acquisition indebtedness.
It borrows another $100,000, which is not acquisition indebtedness, from
the same lending institution and gives the lender a $600,000 note for
its total obligation. In this situation, a payment of $60,000 on the
amount of the total obligation would reduce the acquisition indebtedness
by $50,000 and the excess indebtedness by $10,000.
(d) Indebtedness incurred in performing exempt purpose. Acquisition
indebtedness does not include the incurrence of an indebtedness inherent
in the performance or exercise of the purpose or function constituting
the basis of the organization's exemption. Thus, acquisition
indebtedness does not include the indebtedness incurred by an exempt
credit union in accepting deposits from its members or the obligation
incurred by an exempt organization in accepting payments from its
members to provide such members with insurance, retirement or other
similar benefits.
(e) Annuities--(1) Requirements. The obligation to make payment of
an annuity is not acquisition indebtedness if the annuity meets all the
following requirements:
(i) It must be the sole consideration (other than a mortgage to
which paragraph (b)(3) of this section applies) issued in exchange for
the property acquired;
(ii) At the time of the exchange, the present value of the annuity
(determined in accordance with subparagraph (2) of this paragraph) must
be less than 90 percent of the value of the prior owner's equity in the
property received in the exchange;
(iii) The annuity must be payable over the life of one individual in
being at the time the annuity is issued, or over the lives of two
individuals in being at such time; and
(iv) The annuity must be payable under a contract which:
(a) Does not guarantee a minimum number of payments or specify a
maximum number of payments, and
(b) Does not provide for any adjustment of the amount of the annuity
payments by reference to the income received from the transferred
property or any other property.
(2) Valuation. For purposes of this paragraph, the value of an
annuity at the time of exchange shall be computed
[[Page 206]]
in accordance with section 1011(b), Sec. 1.1011-2(e)(1)(iii)(b)(2), and
section 3 of Rev. Rul. 62-216, C.B. 1962-2, 30.
(3) Examples. The application of this paragraph may be illustrated
by the following examples. For purposes of these examples it is assumed
that the property transferred is used for purposes other than those
described in section 514(b)(1) (A), (B), (C), or (D).
Example 1. On January 1, 1971, X, an exempt organization, receives
property valued at $100,000 from donor A, a male aged 60. In return X
promises to pay A $6,000 a year for the rest of A's life, with neither a
minimum nor maximum number of payments specified. The annuity is payble
on December 31, of each year. The amounts paid under the annuity are not
dependent on the income derived from the property transferred to X. The
present value of this annuity is $81,156, determined in accordance with
Table A of Rev. Rul. 62-216. Since the value of the annuity is less than
90 percent of A's equity in the property transferred and the annuity
meets all the other requirements of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph,
the obligation to make annuity payments is not acquisition indebtedness.
Example 2. On January 1, 1971, B transfers an office building to Y,
an exempt university, subject to a mortgage. In return Y agrees to pay B
$5,000 a year for the rest of his life, with neither a minimum nor
maximum number of payments specified. The amounts paid under the annuity
are not dependent on the income derived from the property transferred to
Y. It is determined that the actual value of the annuity is less than 90
percent of the value of B's equity in the property transferred. Y does
not assume the mortgage. For the taxable years 1971 through 1980, the
outstanding principal indebtedness secured by the mortgage is not
treated as acquisition indebtedness. Further, Y's obligation to make
annuity payments to B never constitutes acquisition indebtedness.
(f) Certain Federal financing. Acquisition indebtedness does not
include an obligation to finance the purchase, rehabilitation, or
construction of housing for low and moderate income persons to the
extent that it is insured by the Federal Housing Administration. Thus,
for example, to the extent that an obligation is insured by the Federal
Housing Administration under section 221(d)(3) (12 U.S.C. 1715(I)(d)(3))
or section 236 (12 U.S.C. 1715z-1) of title II of the National Housing
Act, as amended, the obligation is not acquisition indebtedness.
(g) Certain obligations of charitable remainder trusts. For purposes
of section 664(c) and Sec. 1.664-1(c), a charitable remainder trust (as
defined in Sec. 1.664-1(a)(1)(iii)(a) does not incur acquisition
indebtedness when the sole consideration it is required to pay in
exchange for unencumbered property is an annuity amount or a unitrust
amount (as defined in Sec. 1.664-1(a)(1)(iii)(b) and (c)).
[T.D. 7229, 37 FR 28151, Dec. 21, 1972; 38 FR 21918, Aug. 14, 1973; T.D.
7698, 45 FR 33973, May 21, 1980]
Sec. 1.514(c)-2 Permitted allocations under section 514(c)(9)(E).
(a) Table of contents. This paragraph contains a listing of the
major headings of this Sec. 1.514(c)-2.
(a) Table of contents.
(b) Application of section 514(c)(9)(E), relating to debt-financed
real property held by partnerships.
(1) In general.
(i) The fractions rule.
(ii) Substantial economic effect.
(2) Manner in which fractions rule is applied.
(i) In general.
(ii) Subsequent changes.
(c) General definitions.
(1) Overall partnership income and loss.
(i) Items taken into account in determining overall partnership
income and loss.
(ii) Guaranteed payments to qualified organizations.
(2) Fractions rule percentage.
(3) Definitions of certain terms by cross reference to partnership
regulations.
(4) Example.
(d) Exclusion of reasonable preferred returns and guaranteed
payments.
(1) Overview.
(2) Preferred returns.
(3) Guaranteed payments.
(4) Reasonable amount.
(i) In general.
(ii) Safe harbor.
(5) Unreturned capital.
(i) In general.
(ii) Return of capital.
(6) Timing rules.
(i) Limitation on allocations of income with respect to reasonable
preferred returns for capital.
(ii) Reasonable guaranteed payments may be deducted only when paid
in cash.
(7) Examples.
(e) Chargebacks and offsets.
(1) In general.
(2) Disproportionate allocations.
(i) In general.
(ii) Limitation on chargebacks of partial allocations.
[[Page 207]]
(3) Minimum gain chargebacks attributable to nonrecourse deductions.
(4) Minimum gain chargebacks attributable to distribution of
nonrecourse debt proceeds.
(i) Chargebacks disregarded until allocations made.
(ii) Certain minimum gain chargebacks related to returns of capital.
(5) Examples.
(f) Exclusion of reasonable partner-specific items of deduction or
loss.
(g) Exclusion of unlikely losses and deductions.
(h) Provisions preventing deficit capital account balances.
(i) [Reserved]
(j) Exception for partner nonrecourse deductions.
(1) Partner nonrecourse deductions disregarded until actually
allocated.
(2) Disproportionate allocation of partner nonrecourse deductions to
a qualified organization.
(k) Special rules.
(1) Changes in partnership allocations arising from a change in the
partners' interests.
(2) De minimis interest rule.
(i) In general.
(ii) Example.
(3) De minimis allocations disregarded.
(4) Anti-abuse rule.
(l) [Reserved]
(m) Tiered partnerships.
(1) In general.
(2) Examples.
(n) Effective date.
(1) In general.
(2) General effective date of the regulations.
(3) Periods after June 24, 1990, and prior to December 30, 1992.
(4) Periods prior to the issuance of Notice 90-41.
(5) Material modifications to partnership agreements.
(b) Application of section 514(c)(9)(E), relating to debt-financed
real property held by partnerships--(1) In general. This Sec. 1.514(c)-
2 provides rules governing the application of section 514(c)(9)(E). To
comply with section 514(c)(9)(E), the following two requirements must be
met:
(i) The fractions rule. The allocation of items to a partner that is
a qualified organization cannot result in that partner having a
percentage share of overall partnership income for any partnership
taxable year greater than that partner's fractions rule percentage (as
defined in paragraph (c)(2) of this section).
(ii) Substantial economic effect. Each partnership allocation must
have substantial economic effect. However, allocations that cannot have
economic effect must be deemed to be in accordance with the partners'
interests in the partnership pursuant to Sec. 1.704-1(b)(4), or (if
Sec. 1.704-1(b)(4) does not provide a method for deeming the
allocations to be in accordance with the partners' interests in the
partnership) must otherwise comply with the requirements of Sec. 1.704-
1(b)(4). Allocations attributable to nonrecourse liabilities or partner
nonrecourse debt must comply with the requirements of Sec. 1.704-2(e)
or Sec. 1.704-2(i).
(2) Manner in which fractions rule is applied--(i) In general. A
partnership must satisfy the fractions rule both on a prospective basis
and on an actual basis for each taxable year of the partnership,
commencing with the first taxable year of the partnership in which the
partnership holds debt-financed real property and has a qualified
organization as a partner. Generally, a partnership does not qualify for
the unrelated business income tax exception provided by section
514(c)(9)(A) for any taxable year of its existence unless it satisfies
the fractions rule for every year the fractions rule applies. However,
if an actual allocation described in paragraph (e)(4), (h), (j)(2), or
(m)(1)(ii) of this section (regarding certain allocations that are
disregarded or not taken into account for purposes of the fractions rule
until an actual allocation is made) causes the partnership to violate
the fractions rule, the partnership ordinarily is treated as violating
the fractions rule only for the taxable year of the actual allocation
and subsequent taxable years. For purposes of applying the fractions
rule, the term partnership agreement is defined in accordance with Sec.
1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(h), and informal understandings are considered part of
the partnership agreement in appropriate circumstances. See paragraph
(k) of this section for rules relating to changes in the partners'
interests and de minimis exceptions to the fractions rule.
(ii) Subsequent changes. A subsequent change to a partnership
agreement that causes the partnership to violate
[[Page 208]]
the fractions rule ordinarily causes the partnership's income to fail
the exception provided by section 514(c)(9)(A) only for the taxable year
of the change and subsequent taxable years.
(c) General definitions--(1) Overall partnership income and loss.
Overall partnership income is the amount by which the aggregate items of
partnership income and gain for the taxable year exceed the aggregate
items of partnership loss and deduction for the year. Overall
partnership loss is the amount by which the aggregate items of
partnership loss and deduction for the taxable year exceed the aggregate
items of partnership income and gain for the year.
(i) Items taken into account in determining overall partnership
income and loss. Except as otherwise provided in this section, the
partnership items that are included in computing overall partnership
income or loss are those items of income, gain, loss, and deduction
(including expenditures described in section 705(a)(2)(B)) that increase
or decrease the partners' capital accounts under Sec. 1.704-
1(b)(2)(iv). Tax items allocable pursuant to section 704(c) or Sec.
1.704-1(b)(2)(iv)(f)(4) are not included in computing overall
partnership income or loss. Nonetheless, allocations pursuant to section
704(c) or Sec. 1.704-1(b)(2)(iv)(f)(4) may be relevant in determining
that this section is being applied in a manner that is inconsistent with
the fractions rule. See paragraph (k)(4) of this section.
(ii) Guaranteed payments to qualified organizations. Except to the
extent otherwise provided in paragraph (d) of this section--
(A) A guaranteed payment to a qualified organization is not treated
as an item of partnership loss or deduction in computing overall
partnership income or loss; and
(B) Income that a qualified organization may receive or accrue with
respect to a guaranteed payment is treated as an allocable share of
overall partnership income or loss for purposes of the fractions rule.
(2) Fractions rule percentage. A qualified organization's fractions
rule percentage is that partner's percentage share of overall
partnership loss for the partnership taxable year for which that
partner's percentage share of overall partnership loss will be the
smallest.
(3) Definitions of certain terms by cross reference to partnership
regulations. Minimum gain chargeback, nonrecourse deduction, nonrecourse
liability, partner nonrecourse debt, partner nonrecourse debt minimum
gain, partner nonrecourse debt minimum gain chargeback, partner
nonrecourse deduction, and partnership minimum gain have the meanings
provided in Sec. 1.704-2.
(4) Example. The following example illustrates the provisions of
this paragraph (c).
Example. Computation of overall partnership income and loss for a
taxable year. (i) Taxable corporation TP and qualified organization QO
form a partnership to own and operate encumbered real property. Under
the partnership agreement, all items of income, gain, loss, deduction,
and credit are allocated 50 percent to TP and 50 percent to QO. Neither
partner is entitled to a preferred return. However, the partnership
agreement provides for a $900 guaranteed payment for services to QO in
each of the partnership's first two taxable years. No part of the
guaranteed payments qualify as a reasonable guaranteed payment under
paragraph (d) of this section.
(ii) The partnership violates the fractions rule. Due to the
existence of the guaranteed payment, QO's percentage share of any
overall partnership income in the first two years will exceed QO's
fractions rule percentage. For example, the partnership might have
bottom-line net income of $5,100 in its first taxable year that is
comprised of $10,000 of rental income, $4,000 of salary expense, and the
$900 guaranteed payment to QO. The guaranteed payment would not be
treated as an item of deduction in computing overall partnership income
or loss because it does not qualify as a reasonable guaranteed payment.
See paragraph (c)(1)(ii)(A) of this section. Accordingly, overall
partnership income for the year would be $6,000, which would consist of
$10,000 of rental income less $4,000 of salary expense. See paragraph
(c)(1)(i) of this section. The $900 QO would include in income with
respect to the guaranteed payment would be treated as an allocable share
of the $6,000 of overall partnership income. See paragraph (c)(1)(ii)(B)
of this section. Therefore, QO's allocable share of the overall
partnership income for the year would be $3,450, whichwould be comprised
of the $900 of income pertaining to QO's guaranteed payment, plus QO's
$2,550 allocable share of the partnership's net income for the year (50
percent of $5,100). QO's $3,450 allocable share of overall partnership
income would equal 58 percent of the $6,000 of
[[Page 209]]
overall partnership income and would exceed QO's fractions rule
percentage, which is less than 50 percent. (If there were no guaranteed
payment, QO's fractions rule percentage would be 50 percent. However,
the existence of the guaranteed payment to QO that is not disregarded
for purposes of the fractions rule pursuant to paragraph (d) of this
section means that QO's fractions rule percentage is less than 50
percent.)
(d) Exclusion of reasonable preferred returns and guaranteed
payments--(1) Overview. This paragraph (d) sets forth requirements for
disregarding reasonable preferred returns for capital and reasonable
guaranteed payments for capital or services for purposes of the
fractions rule. To qualify, the preferred return or guaranteed payment
must be set forth in a binding, written partnership agreement.
(2) Preferred returns. Items of income (including gross income) and
gain that may be allocated to a partner with respect to a current or
cumulative reasonable preferred return for capital (including
allocations of minimum gain attributable to nonrecourse liability (or
partner nonrecourse debt) proceeds distributed to the partner as a
reasonable preferred return) are disregarded in computing overall
partnership income or loss for purposes of the fractions rule.
Similarly, if a partnership agreement effects a reasonable preferred
return with an allocation of what would otherwise be overall partnership
income, those items comprising that allocation are disregarded in
computing overall partnership income for purposes of the fractions rule.
(3) Guaranteed payments. A current or cumulative reasonable
guaranteed payment to a qualified organization for capital or services
is treated as an item of deduction in computing overall partnership
income or loss, and the income that the qualified organization may
receive or accrue from the current or cumulative reasonable guaranteed
payment is not treated as an allocable share of overall partnership
income or loss. The treatment of a guaranteed payment as reasonable for
purposes of section 514(c)(9)(E) does not affect its possible
characterization as unrelated business taxable income under other
provisions of the Internal Revenue Code.
(4) Reasonable amount--(i) In general. A guaranteed payment for
services is reasonable only to the extent the amount of the payment is
reasonable under Sec. 1.162-7 (relating to the deduction of
compensation for personal services). A preferred return or guaranteed
payment for capital is reasonable only to the extent it is computed,
with respect to unreturned capital, at a rate that is commercially
reasonable based on the relevant facts and circumstances.
(ii) Safe harbor. For purposes of this paragraph (d)(4), a rate is
deemed to be commercially reasonable if it is no greater than four
percentage points more than, or if it is no greater than 150 percent of,
the highest long-term applicable federal rate (AFR) within the meaning
of section 1274(d), for the month the partner's right to a preferred
return or guaranteed payment is first established or for any month in
the partnership taxable year for which the return or payment on capital
is computed. A rate in excess of the rates described in the preceding
sentence may be commercially reasonable, based on the relevant facts and
circumstances.
(5) Unreturned capital--(i) In general. Unreturned capital is
computed on a weighted-average basis and equals the excess of--
(A) The amount of money and the fair market value of property
contributed by the partner to the partnership (net of liabilities
assumed, or taken subject to, by the partnership); over
(B) The amount of money and the fair market value of property (net
of liabilities assumed, or taken subject to, by the partner) distributed
by the partnership to the partner as a return of capital.
(ii) Return of capital. In determining whether a distribution
constitutes a return of capital, all relevant facts and circumstances
are taken into account. However, the designation of distributions in a
written partnership agreement generally will be respected in determining
whether a distribution constitutes a return of capital, so long as the
designation is economically reasonable.
[[Page 210]]
(6) Timing rules--(i) Limitation on allocations of income with
respect to reasonable preferred returns for capital. Items of income and
gain (or part of what would otherwise be overall partnership income)
that may be allocated to a partner in a taxable year with respect to a
reasonable preferred return for capital are disregarded for purposes of
the fractions rule only to the extent the allocable amount will not
exceed--
(A) The aggregate of the amount that has been distributed to the
partner as a reasonable preferred return for the taxable year of the
allocation and prior taxable years, on or before the due date (not
including extensions) for filing the partnership's return for the
taxable year of the allocation; minus
(B) The aggregate amount of corresponding income and gain (and what
would otherwise be overall partnership income) allocated to the partner
in all prior years.
(ii) Reasonable guaranteed payments may be deducted only when paid
in cash. If a partnership that avails itself of paragraph (d)(3) of this
section would otherwise be required (by virtue of its method of
accounting) to deduct a reasonable guaranteed payment to a qualified
organization earlier than the taxable year in which it is paid in cash,
the partnership must delay the deduction of the guaranteed payment until
the taxable year it is paid in cash. For purposes of this paragraph
(d)(6)(ii), a guaranteed payment that is paid in cash on or before the
due date (not including extensions) for filing the partnership's return
for a taxable year may be treated as paid in that prior taxable year.
(7) Examples. The following examples illustrate the provisions of
this paragraph (d).
Facts. Qualified organization QO and taxable corporation TP form a
partnership. QO contributes $9,000 to the partnership and TP contributes
$1,000. The partnership borrows $50,000 from a third party lender and
purchases an office building for $55,000. At all relevant times the safe
harbor rate described in paragraph (d)(4)(ii) of this section equals 10
percent.
Example 1. Allocations made with respect to preferred returns. (i)
The partnership agreement provides that in each taxable year the
partnership's distributable cash is first to be distributed to QO as a
10 percent preferred return on its unreturned capital. To the extent the
partnership has insufficient cash to pay QO its preferred return in any
taxable year, the preferred return is compounded (at 10 percent) and is
to be paid in future years to the extent the partnership has
distributable cash. The partnership agreement first allocates gross
income and gain 100 percent to QO, to the extent cash has been
distributed to QO as a preferred return. All remaining profit or loss is
allocated 50 percent to QO and 50 percent to TP.
(ii) The partnership satisfies the fractions rule. Items of income
and gain that may be specially allocated to QO with respect to its
preferred return are disregarded in computing overall partnership income
or loss for purposes of the fractions rule because the requirements of
paragraph (d) of this section are satisfied. After disregarding those
allocations, QO's fractions rule percentage is 50 percent (see paragraph
(c)(2) of this section), and under the partnership agreement QO may not
be allocated more than 50 percent of overall partnership income in any
taxable year.
(iii) The facts are the same as in paragraph (i) of this Example 1,
except that QO's preferred return is computed on unreturned capital at a
rate that exceeds a commercially reasonable rate. The partnership
violates the fractions rule. The income and gain that may be specially
allocated to QO with respect to the preferred return is not disregarded
in computing overall partnership income or loss to the extent it exceeds
a commercially reasonable rate. See paragraph (d) of this section. As a
result, QO's fractions rule percentage is less than 50 percent (see
paragraph (c)(2) of this section), and allocations of income and gain to
QO with respect to its preferred return could result in QO being
allocated more than 50 percent of the overall partnership income in a
taxable year.
Example 2. Guaranteed payments and the computation of overall
partnership income or loss. (i) The partnership agreement allocates all
bottom-line partnership income and loss 50 percent to QO and 50 percent
to TP throughout the life of the partnership. The partnership agreement
provides that QO is entitled each year to a 10 percent guaranteed
payment on unreturned capital. To the extent the partnership is unable
to make a guaranteed payment in any taxable year, the unpaid amount is
compounded at 10 percent and is to be paid in future years.
(ii) Assuming the requirements of paragraph (d)(6)(ii) of this
section are met, the partnership satisfies the fractions rule. The
guaranteed payment is disregarded for purposes of the fractions rule
because it is computed with respect to unreturned capital at the safe
harbor rate described in paragraph
[[Page 211]]
(d)(4)(ii) of this section. Therefore, the guaranteed payment is treated
as an item of deduction in computing overall partnership income or loss,
and the corresponding income that QO may receive or accrue with respect
to the guaranteed payment is not treated as an allocable share of
overall partnership income or loss. See paragraph (d)(3) of this
section. Accordingly, QO's fractions rule percentage is 50 percent (see
paragraph (c)(2) of this section), and under the partnership agreement
QO may not be allocated more than 50 percent of overall partnership
income in any taxable year.
(e) Chargebacks and offsets--(1) In general. The following
allocations are disregarded in computing overall partnership income or
loss for purposes of the fractions rule--
(i) Allocations of what would otherwise be overall partnership
income that may be made to chargeback (i.e., reverse) prior
disproportionately large allocations of overall partnership loss (or
part of the overall partnership loss) to a qualified organization, and
allocations of what would otherwise be overall partnership loss that may
be made to chargeback prior disproportionately small allocations of
overall partnership income (or part of the overall partnership income)
to a qualified organization;
(ii) Allocations of income or gain that may be made to a partner
pursuant to a minimum gain chargeback attributable to prior allocations
of nonrecourse deductions to the partner;
(iii) Allocations of income or gain that may be made to a partner
pursuant to a minimum gain chargeback attributable to prior allocations
of partner nonrecourse deductions to the partner and allocations of
income or gain that may be made to other partners to chargeback
compensating allocations of other losses, deductions, or section
705(a)(2)(B) expenditures to the other partners; and
(iv) Allocations of items of income or gain that may be made to a
partner pursuant to a qualified income offset, within the meaning of
Sec. 1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(d).
(v) Allocations made in taxable years beginning on or after January
1, 2002, that are mandated by statute or regulation other than
subchapter K of chapter 1 of the Internal Revenue Code and the
regulations thereunder.
(2) Disproportionate allocations--(i) In general. To qualify under
paragraph (e)(1)(i) of this section, prior disproportionate allocations
may be reversed in full or in part, and in any order, but must be
reversed in the same ratio as originally made. A prior allocation is
disproportionately large if the qualified organization's percentage
share of that allocation exceeds its fractions rule percentage. A prior
allocation is disproportionately small if the qualified organization's
percentage share of that allocation is less than its fractions rule
percentage. However, a prior allocation (or allocations) is not
considered disproportionate unless the balance of the overall
partnership income or loss for the taxable year of the allocation is
allocated in a manner that would independently satisfy the fractions
rule.
(ii) Limitation on chargebacks of partial allocations. Except in the
case of a chargeback allocation pursuant to paragraph (e)(4) of this
section, and except as otherwise provided by the Internal Revenue
Service by revenue ruling, revenue procedure, or, on a case-by-case
basis, by letter ruling, paragraph (e)(1)(i) of this section applies to
a chargeback of an allocation of part of the overall partnership income
or loss only if that part consists of a pro rata portion of each item of
partnership income, gain, loss, and deduction (other than nonrecourse
deductions, as well as partner nonrecourse deductions and compensating
allocations) that is included in computing overall partnership income or
loss.
(3) Minimum gain chargebacks attributable to nonrecourse deductions.
Commencing with the first taxable year of the partnership in which a
minimum gain chargeback (or partner nonrecourse debt minimum gain
chargeback) occurs, a chargeback to a partner is attributable to
nonrecourse deductions (or separately, on a debt-by-debt basis, to
partner nonrecourse deductions) in the same proportion that the
partner's percentage share of the partnership minimum gain (or
separately, on a debt-by-debt basis, the partner nonrecourse debt
minimum gain) at the end of the immediately preceding taxable year is
attributable to nonrecourse deductions (or partner
[[Page 212]]
nonrecoursedeductions). The partnership must determine the extent to
which a partner's percentage share of the partnership minimum gain (or
partner nonrecourse debt minimum gain) is attributable to deductions in
a reasonable and consistent manner. For example, in those cases in which
none of the exceptions contained in Sec. 1.704-2(f) (2) through (5) are
relevant, a partner's percentage share of the partnership minimum gain
generally is attributable to nonrecourse deductions in the same ratio
that--
(i) The aggregate amount of the nonrecourse deductions previously
allocated to the partner but not charged back in prior taxable years;
bears to
(ii) The sum of the amount described in paragraph (e)(3)(i) of this
section, plus the aggregate amount of distributions previously made to
the partner of proceeds of a nonrecourse liability allocable to an
increase in partnership minimum gain but not charged back in prior
taxable years.
(4) Minimum gain chargebacks attributable to distribution of
nonrecourse debt proceeds--(i) Chargebacks disregarded until allocations
made. Allocations of items of income and gain that may be made pursuant
to a provision in the partnership agreement that charges back minimum
gain attributable to the distribution of proceeds of a nonrecourse
liability (or a partner nonrecourse debt) are taken into account for
purposes of the fractions rule only to the extent an allocation is made.
(See paragraph (d)(2) of this section, pursuant to which there is
permanently excluded chargeback allocations of minimum gain that are
attributable to proceeds distributed as a reasonable preferred return.)
(ii) Certain minimum gain chargebacks related to returns of capital.
Allocations of items of income or gain that (in accordance with Sec.
1.704-2(f)(1)) may be made to a partner pursuant to a minimum gain
chargeback attributable to the distribution of proceeds of a nonrecourse
liability are disregarded in computing overall partnership income or
loss for purposes of the fractions rule to the extent that the
allocations (subject to the requirements of paragraph (e)(2) of this
section) also charge back prior disproportionately large allocations of
overall partnership loss (or part of the overall partnership loss) to a
qualified organization. This exception applies only to the extent the
disproportionately large allocation consisted of depreciation from real
property (other than items of nonrecourse deduction or partner
nonrecourse deduction) that subsequently was used to secure the
nonrecourse liability providing the distributed proceeds, and only if
those proceeds were distributed as a return of capital and in the same
proportion as the disproportionately large allocation.
(5) Examples. The following examples illustrate the provisions of
this paragraph (e).
Example 1. Chargebacks of disproportionately large allocations of
overall partnership loss. (i) Qualified organization QO and taxable
corporation TP form a partnership. QO contributes $900 to the
partnership and TP contributes $100. The partnership agreement allocates
overall partnership loss 50 percent to QO and 50 percent to TP until
TP's capital account is reduced to zero; then 100 percent to QO until
QO's capital account is reduced to zero; and thereafter 50 percent to QO
and 50 percent to TP. Overall partnership income is allocated first 100
percent to QO to chargeback overall partnership loss allocated 100
percent to QO, and thereafter 50 percent to QO and 50 percent to TP.
(ii) The partnership satisfies the fractions rule. QO's fractions
rule percentage is 50 percent. See paragraph (c)(2) of this section.
Therefore, the 100 percent allocation of overall partnership loss to QO
is disproportionately large. See paragraph (e)(2)(i) of this section.
Accordingly, the 100 percent allocation to QO of what would otherwise be
overall partnership income (if it were not disregarded), which charges
back the disproportionately large allocation of overall partnership
loss, is disregarded in computing overall partnership income and loss
for purposes of the fractions rule. The 100 percent allocation is in the
same ratio as the disproportionately large loss allocation, and the rest
of the allocations for the taxable year of the disproportionately large
loss allocation will independently satisfy the fractions rule. See
paragraph (e)(2)(i) of this section. After disregarding the chargeback
allocation of 100 percent of what would otherwise be overall partnership
income, QO will not be allocated a percentage share of overall
partnership income in excess of its fractions rule percentage for any
taxable year.
Example 2. Chargebacks of disproportionately small allocations of
overall partnership income. (i) Qualified organization QO and taxable
[[Page 213]]
corporation TP form a partnership. QO contributes $900 to the
partnership and TP contributes $100. The partnership purchases real
property with money contributed by its partners and with money borrowed
by the partnership on a recourse basis. In any year, the partnership
agreement allocates the first $500 of overall partnership income 50
percent to QO and 50 percent to TP; the next $100 of overall partnership
income 100 percent to TP (as an incentive for TP to achieve significant
profitability in managing the partnership'soperations); and all
remaining overall partnership income 50 percent to QO and 50 percent to
TP. Overall partnership loss is allocated first 100 percent to TP to
chargeback overall partnership income allocated 100 percent to TP at any
time in the prior three years and not reversed; and thereafter 50
percent to QO and 50 percent to TP.
(ii) The partnership satisfies the fractions rule. QO's fractions
rule percentage is 50 percent because qualifying chargebacks are
disregarded pursuant to paragraph (e)(1)(i) in computing overall
partnership income or loss. See paragraph (c)(2) of this section. The
zero percent allocation to QO of what would otherwise be overall
partnership loss is a qualifying chargeback that is disregarded because
it is in the same ratio as the income allocation it charges back,
because the rest of the allocations for the taxable year of that income
allocation will independently satisfy the fractions rule (see paragraph
(e)(2)(i) of this section), and because it charges back an allocation of
zero overall partnership income to QO, which is proportionately smaller
(i.e., disproportionately small) than QO's 50 percent fractions rule
percentage. After disregarding the chargeback allocation of 100 percent
of what would otherwise be overall partnership loss, QO will not be
allocated a percentage share of overall partnership income in excess of
its fractions rule percentage for any taxable year.
Example 3. Chargebacks of partner nonrecourse deductions and
compensating allocations of other items. (i) Qualified organization QO
and taxable corporation TP form a partnership to own and operate
encumbered real property. QO and TP each contribute $500 to the
partnership. In addition, QO makes a $300 nonrecourse loan to the
partnership. The partnership agreement contains a partner nonrecourse
debt minimum gain chargeback provision and a provision that allocates
partner nonrecourse deductions to the partner who bears the economic
burden of the deductions in accordance with Sec. 1.704-2. The
partnership agreement also provides that to the extent partner
nonrecourse deductions are allocated to QO in any taxable year, other
compensating items of partnership loss or deduction (and, if
appropriate, section 705(a)(2)(B) expenditures) will first be allocated
100 percent to TP. In addition, to the extent items of income or gain
are allocated to QO in any taxable year pursuant to a partner
nonrecourse debt minimum gain chargeback of deductions, items of
partnership income and gain will first be allocated 100 percent to TP.
The partnership agreement allocates all other overall partnership income
or loss 50 percent to QO and 50 percent to TP.
(ii) The partnership satisfies the fractions rule on a prospective
basis. The allocations of the partner nonrecourse deductions and the
compensating allocation of other items of loss, deduction, and
expenditure that may be made to TP (but which will not be made unless
there is an allocation of partner nonrecourse deductions to QO) are not
taken into account for purposes of the fractions rule until a taxable
year in which an allocation is made. See paragraph (j)(1) of this
section. In addition, partner nonrecourse debt minimum gain chargebacks
of deductions and allocations of income or gain to other partners that
chargeback compensating allocations of other deductions are disregarded
in computing overall partnership income or loss for purposes of the
fractions rule. See paragraph (e)(1)(iii) of this section. Since all
other overall partnership income and loss is allocated 50 percent to QO
and 50 percent to TP, QO's fractions rule percentage is 50 percent (see
paragraph (c)(2) of this section), and QO will not be allocated a
percentage share of overall partnership income in excess of its
fractions rule percentage for any taxable year.
(iii) The facts are the same as in paragraph (i) of this Example 3,
except that the partnership agreement provides that compensating
allocations of loss or deduction (and section 705(a)(2)(B) expenditures)
to TP will not be charged back until year 10. The partners expect $300
of partner nonrecourse deductions to be allocated to QO in year 1 and
$300 of income or gain to be allocated to QO in year 2 pursuant to the
partner nonrecourse debt minimum gain chargeback provision.
(iv) The partnership fails to satisfy the fractions rule on a
prospective basis under the anti-abuse rule of paragraph (k)(4) of this
section. If the partners' expectations prove correct, at the end of year
2, QO will have been allocated $300 of partner nonrecourse deductions
and an offsetting $300 of partner nonrecourse debt minimum gain.
However, the $300 of compensating deductions and losses that may be
allocated to TP will not be charged back until year 10. Thus, during the
period beginning at the end of year 2 and ending eight years later,
there may be $300 more of unreversed deductions and losses allocated to
TP than to QO, which would be inconsistent with the purpose of the
fractions rule.
[[Page 214]]
Example 4. Minimum gain chargeback attributable to distributions of
nonrecourse debt proceeds. (i) Qualified organization QO and taxable
corporation TP form a partnership. QO contributes $900 to the
partnership and TP contributes $100. The partnership agreement generally
allocates overall partnership income and loss 90 percent to QO and 10
percent to TP. However, the partnership agreement contains a minimum
gain chargeback provision, and also provides that in any partnership
taxable year in which there is a chargeback of partnership minimum gain
to QO attributable to distributions of proceeds of nonrecourse
liabilities, all other items comprising overall partnership income or
loss will be allocated in a manner such that QO is not allocated more
than 90 percent of the overall partnership income for the year.
(ii) The partnership satisfies the fractions rule on a prospective
basis. QO's fractions rule percentage is 90 percent. See paragraph
(c)(2) of this section. The chargeback that may be made to QO of minimum
gain attributable to distributions of nonrecourse liability proceeds is
taken into account for purposes of the fractions rule only to the extent
an allocation is made. See paragraph (e)(4) of this section.
Accordingly, that potential allocation to QO is disregarded in applying
the fractions rule on a prospective basis (see paragraph (b)(2) of this
section), and QO is treated as not being allocated a percentage share of
overall partnership income in excess of its fractions rule percentage in
any taxable year. (Similarly, QO is treated as not being allocated items
of income or gain in a taxable year when the partnership has an overall
partnership loss.)
(iii) In year 3, the partnership borrows $400 on a nonrecourse basis
and distributes it to QO as a return of capital. In year 8, the
partnership has $400 of gross income and cash flow and $300 of overall
partnership income, and the partnership repays the $400 nonrecourse
borrowing.
(iv) The partnership violates the fractions rule for year 8 and all
future years. Pursuant to the minimum gain chargeback provision, the
entire $400 of partnership gross income is allocated to QO. Accordingly,
notwithstanding the curative provision in the partnership agreement that
would allocate to TP the next $44 (($400/.9)x10%) of income and gain
included in computing overall partnership income, the partnership has no
other items of income and gain to allocate to QO. Because the $400 of
gross income actually allocated to QO is taken into account for purposes
of the fractions rule in the year an allocation is made (see paragraph
(e)(4) of this section), QO's percentage share of overall partnership
income in year 8 is greater than 100 percent. Since this exceeds QO's
fractions rule percentage (i.e., 90 percent), the partnership violates
the fractions rule for year 8 and all subsequent taxable years. See
paragraph (b)(2) of this section.
(f) Exclusion of reasonable partner-specific items of deduction or
loss. Provided that the expenditures are allocated to the partners to
whom they are attributable, the following partner-specific expenditures
are disregarded in computing overall partnership income or loss for
purposes of the fractions rule--
(1) Expenditures for additional record-keeping and accounting
incurred in connection with the transfer of a partnership interest
(including expenditures incurred in computing basis adjustments under
section 743(b));
(2) Additional administrative costs that result from having a
foreign partner;
(3) State and local taxes or expenditures relating to those taxes;
and
(4) Expenditures designated by the Internal Revenue Service by
revenue ruling or revenue procedure, or, on a case-by-case basis, by
letter ruling. (See Sec. 601.601(d)(2)(ii)(b) of this chapter).
(g) Exclusion of unlikely losses and deductions. Unlikely losses or
deductions (other than items of nonrecourse deduction) that may be
specially allocated to partners that bear the economic burden of those
losses or deductions are disregarded in computing overall partnership
income or loss for purposes of the fractions rule, so long as a
principal purpose of the allocation is not tax avoidance. To be excluded
under this paragraph (g), a loss or deduction must have a low likelihood
of occurring, taking into account all relevant facts, circumstances, and
information available to the partners (including bona fide financial
projections). The types of events that may give rise to unlikely losses
or deductions, depending on the facts and circumstances, include tort
and other third-party litigation that give rise to unforeseen
liabilities in excess of reasonable insurance coverage; unanticipated
labor strikes; unusual delays in securing required permits or licenses;
abnormal weather conditions (considering the season and the job site);
significant delays in leasing property due to an unanticipated severe
economic downturn in the geographic area; unanticipated cost overruns;
and the discovery of environmental conditions
[[Page 215]]
that require remediation. No inference is drawn as to whether a loss or
deduction is unlikely from the fact that the partnership agreement
includes a provision for allocating that loss or deduction.
(h) Provisions preventing deficit capital account balances. A
provision in the partnership agreement that allocates items of loss or
deduction away from a qualified organization in instances where
allocating those items to the qualified organization would cause or
increase a deficit balance in its capital account that the qualified
organization is not obligated to restore (within the meaning of Sec.
1.704-1(b)(2)(ii) (b) or (d)), is disregarded for purposes of the
fractions rule in taxable years of the partnership in which no such
allocations are made pursuant to the provision. However, this exception
applies only if, at the time the provision becomes part of the
partnership agreement, all relevant facts, circumstances, and
information (including bona fide financial projections) available to the
partners reasonably indicate that it is unlikely that an allocation will
be made pursuant to the provision during the life of the partnership.
(i) [Reserved]
(j) Exception for partner nonrecourse deductions--(1) Partner
nonrecourse deductions disregarded until actually allocated. Items of
partner nonrecourse deduction that may be allocated to a partner
pursuant to Sec. 1.704-2, and compensating allocations of other items
of loss, deduction, and section 705(a)(2)(B) expenditures that may be
allocated to other partners, are not taken into account for purposes of
the fractions rule until the taxable years in which they are allocated.
(2) Disproportionate allocation of partner nonrecourse deductions to
a qualified organization. A violation of the fractions rule will be
disregarded if it arises because an allocation of partner nonrecourse
deductions to a qualified organization that is not motivated by tax
avoidance reduces another qualified organization's fractions rule
percentage below what it would have been absent the allocation of the
partner nonrecourse deductions.
(k) Special rules--(1) Changes in partnership allocations arising
from a change in the partners' interests. A qualified organization that
acquires a partnership interest from another qualified organization is
treated as a continuation of the prior qualified organization partner
(to the extent of that acquired interest) for purposes of applying the
fractions rule. Changes in partnership allocations that result from
other transfers or shifts of partnership interests will be closely
scrutinized (to determine whether the transfer or shift stems from a
prior agreement, understanding, or plan or could otherwise be expected
given the structure of the transaction), but generally will be taken
into account only in determining whether the partnership satisfies the
fractions rule in the taxable year of the change and subsequent taxable
years.
(2) De minimis interest rule--(i) In general. Section
514(c)(9)(B)(vi) does not apply to a partnership otherwise subject to
that section if--
(A) Qualified organizations do not hold, in the aggregate, interests
of greater than five percent in the capital or profits of the
partnership; and
(B) Taxable partners own substantial interests in the partnership
through which they participate in the partnership on substantially the
same terms as the qualified organization partners.
(ii) Example. Partnership PRS has two types of limited partnership
interests that participate in partnership profits and losses on
different terms. Qualified organizations (QOs) only own one type of
limited partnership interest and own no general partnership interests.
In the aggregate, the QOs own less than five percent of the capital and
profits of PRS. Taxable partners also own the same type of limited
partnership interest that the QOs own. These limited partnership
interests owned by the taxable partners are 30 percent of the capital
and profits of PRS. Thirty percent is a substantial interest in the
partnership. Therefore, PRS satisfies paragraph (k)(2) of this section
and section 514(c)(9)(B)(vi) does not apply.
(3) De minimis allocations disregarded. A qualified organization's
fractions rule percentage of the partnership's items of loss and
deduction, other than nonrecourse and partner nonrecourse deductions,
that are allocated away from the qualified organization and to
[[Page 216]]
other partners in any taxable year are treated as having been allocated
to the qualified organization for purposes of the fractions rule if--
(i) The allocation was neither planned nor motivated by tax
avoidance; and
(ii) The total amount of those items of partnership loss or
deduction is less than both--
(A) One percent of the partnership's aggregate items of gross loss
and deduction for the taxable year; and
(B) $50,000.
(4) Anti-abuse rule. The purpose of the fractions rule is to prevent
tax avoidance by limiting the permanent or temporary transfer of tax
benefits from tax-exempt partners to taxable partners, whether by
directing income or gain to tax-exempt partners, by directing losses,
deductions, or credits to taxable partners, or by some other similar
manner. This section may not be applied in a manner that is inconsistent
with the purpose of the fractions rule.
(l) [Reserved]
(m) Tiered partnerships--(1) In general. If a qualified organization
holds an indirect interest in real property through one or more tiers of
partnerships (a chain), the fractions rule is satisfied only if--
(i) The avoidance of tax is not a principal purpose for using the
tiered-ownership structure (investing in separate real properties
through separate chains of partnerships so that section 514(c)(9)(E) is,
effectively, applied on a property-by-property basis is not, in and of
itself, a tax avoidance purpose); and
(ii) The relevant partnerships can demonstrate under any reasonable
method that the relevant chains satisfy the requirements of paragraphs
(b)(2) through (k) of this section. For purposes of applying Sec.
1.704-2(k) under the independent chain approach described in Example 3
of paragraph (m)(2) of this section, allocations of items of income or
gain that may be made pursuant to a provision in the partnership
agreement that charges back minimum gain are taken into account for
purposes of the fractions rule only to the extent an allocation is made.
(2) Examples. The following examples illustrate the provisions of
this paragraph (m).
Example 1. Tiered partnerships--collapsing approach. (i) Qualified
organization QO3 and taxable individual TP3 form upper-tier partnership
P2. The P2 partnership agreement allocates overall partnership income 20
percent to QO3 and 80 percent to TP3. Overall partnership loss is
allocated 30 percent to QO3 and 70 percent to TP3. P2 and taxable
individual TP2 form lower-tier partnership P1. The P1 partnership
agreement allocates overall partnership income 60 percent to P2 and 40
percent to TP2. Overall partnership loss is allocated 40 percent to P2
and 60 percent to TP2. The only asset of P2 (which has no outstanding
debt) is its interest in P1. P1 purchases real property with money
contributed by its partners and with borrowed money. There is no tax
avoidance purpose for the use of the tiered-ownership structure, which
is illustrated by the following diagram.
[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR13MY94.006
(ii) P2 can demonstrate that the P2/P1 chain satisfies the
requirements of paragraphs (b)(2) through (k) of this section by
collapsing the tiered-partnership structure. On a collapsed basis, QO3's
fractions rule percentage is 12 percent (30 percent of 40 percent). See
paragraph (c)(2) of this section. P2 satisfies the fractions rule
because QO3 may not be allocated more than 12 percent (20 percent of 60
percent) of overall partnership income in any taxable year.
Example 2. Tiered partnerships--entity-by-entity approach. (i)
Qualified organization QO3A is a partner with taxable individual TP3A in
upper-tier partnership P2A. Qualified organization QO3B is a partner
with taxable individual TP3B in upper-tier partnership P2B. P2A, P2B,
and taxable individual TP2 are partners in lower-tier partnership P1,
which owns encumbered real estate. None of QO3A, QO3B, TP3A, TP3B or TP2
has a direct or indirect ownership interest in each other. P2A has been
established for the purpose of investing in numerous real estate
properties independently of P2B and its partners. P2B has been
established for the purpose of investing in numerous real estate
properties independently of P2A and its partners. Neither P2A nor P2B
has outstanding debt. There is no tax avoidance purpose for the use
[[Page 217]]
of the tiered-ownership structure, which is illustrated by the following
diagram.
[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR13MY94.007
(ii) The P2A/P1 chain (Chain A) will satisfy the fractions rule if
P1 and P2A can demonstrate in a reasonable manner that they satisfy the
requirements of paragraphs (b)(2) through (k) of this section. The P2B/
P1 chain (Chain B) will satisfy the fractions rule if P1 and P2B can
demonstrate in a reasonable manner that they satisfy the requirements of
paragraphs (b)(2) through (k) of this section. To meet its burden, P1
treats P2A and P2B as qualified organizations. Provided that the
allocations that may be made by P1 would satisfy the fractions rule if
P2A and P2B were direct qualified organization partners in P1, Chain A
will satisfy the fractions rule (for the benefit of QO3A) if the
allocations that may be made by P2A satisfy the requirements of
paragraphs (b)(2) through (k) of this section. Similarly, Chain B will
satisfy the fractions rule (for the benefit of QO3B) if the allocations
that may be made by P2B satisfy the requirements of paragraphs (b)(2)
through (k) of this section. Under these facts, QO3A does not have to
know how income and loss may be allocated by P2B, and QO3B does not have
to know how income and loss may be allocated by P2A. QO3A's and QO3B's
burden would not change even if TP2 were not a partner in P1.
Example 3. Tiered partnerships--independent chain approach. (i)
Qualified organization QO3 and taxable corporation TP3 form upper-tier
partnership P2. P2 and taxable corporation TP2 form lower-tier
partnership P1A. P2 and qualified organization QO2 form lower-tier
partnership P1B. P2 has no outstanding debt. P1A and P1B each purchase
real property with money contributed by their respective partners and
with borrowed money. Each partnership's real property is completely
unrelated to the real property owned by the other partnership. P1B's
allocations do not satisfy the requirements of paragraphs (b)(2) through
(k) of this section because of allocations that may be made to QO2.
However, if P2's interest in P1B were completely disregarded, the P2/P1A
chain would satisfy the requirements of paragraphs (b)(2) through (k) of
this section. There is no tax avoidance purpose for the use of the
tiered-ownership structure, which is illustrated by the following
diagram.
[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR13MY94.008
(ii) P2 satisfies the fractions rule with respect to the P2/P1A
chain, but only if the P2 partnership agreement allocates those items
allocated to P2 by P1A separately from those items allocated to P2 by
P1B. For this purpose, allocations of items of income or gain that may
be made pursuant to a provision in the partnership agreement that
charges back minimum gain, are taken into account for purposes of the
fractions rule only to the extent an allocation is made. See paragraph
(m)(1)(ii) of this section. P2 does not satisfy the fractions rule with
respect to the P2/P1B chain.
(n) Effective date--(1) In general. Section 514(c)(9)(E), as amended
by sections 2004(h) (1) and (2) of the Technical and Miscellaneous
Revenue Act of 1988, Pub. L. 100-647, applies generally with respect to
property acquired by partnerships after October 13, 1987, and to
partnership interests acquired after October 13, 1987.
(2) General effective date of the regulations. Section 1.514(c)-2
(a) through (m) applies with respect to partnership agreements entered
into after December 30, 1992, property acquired by partnerships after
December 30, 1992, and partnership interests acquired by qualified
organizations after December 30, 1992 (other than a partnership interest
that at all times after October 13, 1987, and prior to the acquisition
was held by a qualified organization). For this purpose, paragraphs (a)
through (m) of this section will be treated as satisfied with respect to
partnership agreements entered into on or before May 13, 1994, property
acquired by partnerships on or before May 13, 1994, and partnership
interests acquired by qualified organizations on or before May 13, 1994,
if the guidance set forth in (paragraphs (a) through (m) of Sec.
1.514(c)-2 of) PS-56-90, published at 1993-5 I.R.B. 42, February 1,
1993, is satisfied. (See Sec. 601.601(d)(2)(ii)(b) of this chapter).
[[Page 218]]
(3) Periods after June 24, 1990, and prior to December 30, 1992. To
satisfy the requirements of section 514(c)(9)(E) with respect to
partnership agreements entered into after June 24, 1990, property
acquired by partnerships after June 24, 1990, and partnership interests
acquired by qualified organizations after June 24, 1990, (other than a
partnership interest that at all times after October 13, 1987, and prior
to the acquisition was held by a qualified organization) to which
paragraph (n)(2) of this section does not apply, paragraphs (a) through
(m) of this section must be satisfied as of the first day that section
514(c)(9)(E) applies with respect to the partnership, property, or
acquired interest. For this purpose, paragraphs (a) through (m) of this
section will be treated as satisfied if the guidance in sections I
through VI of Notice 90-41, 90-1 C.B. 350, (see Sec.
601.601(d)(2)(ii)(b) of this chapter) has been followed.
(4) Periods prior to the issuance of Notice 90-41. With respect to
partnerships commencing after October 13, 1987, property acquired by
partnerships after October 13, 1987, and partnership interests acquired
by qualified organizations after October 13, 1987, to which neither
paragraph (n)(2) nor (n)(3) of this section applies, the Internal
Revenue Service will not challenge an interpretation of section
514(c)(9)(E) that is reasonable in light of the underlying purposes of
section 514(c)(9)(E) (as reflected in its legislative history) and that
is consistently applied as of the first day that section 514(c)(9)(E)
applies with respect to the partnership, property, or acquired interest.
A reasonable interpretation includes an interpretation that
substantially follows the guidance in either sections I through VI of
Notice 90-41, (see Sec. 601.601(d)(2)(ii)(b) of this chapter) or
paragraphs (a) through (m) of this section.
(5) Material modifications to partnership agreements. A material
modification will cause a partnership agreement to be treated as a new
partnership agreement in appropriate circumstances for purposes of this
paragraph (n).
[T.D. 8539, 59 FR 24928, May 13, 1994, as amended by T.D. 9047, 68 FR
12825, Mar. 18, 2003]
Sec. 1.514(d)-1 Basis of debt-financed property acquired in corporate
liquidation.
(a) If debt-financed property is acquired by an exempt organization
in a complete or partial liquidation of a corporation in exchange for
its stock, the organization's basis in such property shall be the same
as it would be in the hands of the transferor corporation, increased by
the amount of gain recognized to the transferor corporation upon such
distribution and by the amount of any gain which is includible, on
account of such distribution, in the gross income of the organization as
unrelated debt-financed income.
(b) The application of this section may be illustrated by the
following example:
Example. On July 1, 1970, T, an exempt trust, exchanges $15,000 of
borrowed funds for 50 percent of the shares of M Corporation's stock. M
uses $35,000 of borrowed funds in acquiring depreciable assets which are
not used at any time for purposes described in section 514(b)(1) (A),
(B), (C), or (D). On July 1, 1978, and for the 12-month period preceding
this date, T's acquisition indebtedness with respect to M's stock has
been $3,000. On this date, there is a complete liquidation of M
Corporation to which section 331(a)(1) applies. In the liquidation T
receives a distribution in kind of depreciable assets and assumes $7,000
of M's indebtedness which remains unpaid with respect to the depreciable
assets. On this date, M's adjusted basis of these depreciable assets is
$9,000, and such assets have a fair market value of $47,000. M
recognizes gain of $6,000 with respect to this liquidation pursuant to
sections 1245 and 1250. T realizes a gain of $25,000 (the difference
between the excess of fair market value of the property received over
the indebtedness assumed, $40,000 ($47,000-$7,000) and T's basis in M's
stock, $15,000). A portion of this gain is to be treated as unrelated
debt-financed income. This amount is determined by multiplying T's gain
of $25,000 by the debt/basis percentage. The debt/basis percentage is 20
percent, the ratio which the average acquisition indebtedness ($3,000)
is of the average adjusted basis ($15,000). Thus, $5,000 (20 percent of
$25,000) is unrelated debt-financed income. This amount and the gain
recognized pursuant to sections 1245 and 1250 are added to M's basis to
determine T's basis in the property received. Consequently, T's basis in
the property received from M Corporation is $20,000, determined as
follows:
M Corporation's adjusted basis.............................. $9,000
Gain recognized by M Corporation on the distribution........ 6,000
[[Page 219]]
Unrelated debt-financed income recognized by T with respect 5,000
to the distribution........................................
-----------
T's transferred basis....................................... 20,000
[T.D. 7229, 37 FR 28153, Dec. 21, 1972]
Sec. 1.514(e)-1 Allocation rules.
Where only a portion of property is debt-financed property, proper
allocation of the basis, indebtedness, income, and deductions with
respect to such property must be made to determine the amount of income
or gain derived from such property which is to be treated as unrelated
debt-financed income. See examples 2 and 3 of paragraph (b)(1)(iii) of
Sec. 1.514(b)-1 and examples 1, (2), and (3) of paragraph (b)(3)(iii)
of Sec. 1.514(b)-1 for illustrations of proper allocation.
[T.D. 7229, 37 FR 28153, Dec. 21, 1972]
Sec. 1.514(f)-1 Definition of business lease.
(a) In general. The term business lease means any lease, with
certain exceptions discussed in paragraph (c) of this section, for a
term of more than 5 years of real property by an organization subject to
section 511 (or by a partnership of which it is a member) if at the
close of the organization's taxable year there is a business lease
indebtedness as defined in section 514(g) and Sec. 1.514(g)-1 with
respect to such property. For the purpose of this section the term real
property and the term premises include personal property of the lessor
tax-exempt organization leased by it to a lessee of its real estate if
the lease of such personal property is made under, or in connection
with, the lease of such real estate. For amounts of business lease rents
and deductions to be included in computing unrelated business taxable
income for taxable years beginning before January 1, 1970, see Sec.
1.514(a)-2.
(b) Special rules. (1) In computing the term of the lease, the
period for which a lease may be renewed or extended by reason of an
option contained therein shall be considered as part of the term. For
example, a 3-year lease with an option for renewal for another such
period is considered a lease for a term of 6 years. Another example is
the case of a 1-year lease with option of renewal for another such term,
where the parties at the end of each year renew the arrangement. In this
case, during the fifth year (but not during the first 4 years), the
lease falls within the 5-year rule, since the lease then involves 5
years and there is an option for the sixth year. In determining the term
of the lease, an option for renewal of the lease is taken into account
whether or not the exercise of the option depends upon conditions or
contingencies.
(2) If the property is acquired subject to a lease, the term of such
lease shall be considered to begin on the date of such acquisition. For
example, if an exempt organization purchases, in whole or in part with
borrowed funds, real property subject to a 10-year lease which has 3
years left to run, and such lease contains no right of renewal or
extension, the lease shall be considered a 3-year lease and hence does
not meet the definition of a business lease in section 514(f) and
paragraph (a) of this section. However, if this lease contains an option
to renew for a period of 3 years or more, it is a business lease.
(3) Under the provisions of section 514(f)(2)(B) a lease is
considered as continuing for more than 5 years if the same lessee has
occupied the premises for a total period of more than 5 years, whether
the occupancy is under one or more leases, renewals, extensions, or
continuations. Continued occupancy shall be considered to be by the same
lessee if the occupants during the period are so related that losses in
respect of sales or exchanges of property between them would be
disallowed under section 267(a). Such period shall be considered as
commencing not earlier than the date of the acquisition of the property
by the tax-exempt organization or trust. This rule is applicable only in
the sixth and succeeding years of such occupancy by the same lessee.
See, however, paragraph (c)(3) of this section.
(c) Exceptions. (1) A lease shall not be considered a business lease
if such lease is entered into primarily for a purpose which is
substantially related (aside from the need of such organization for
income or funds, or the use it makes of the rents derived) to the
exercise or performance by such organization of its charitable,
educational, or other purpose or function constituting
[[Page 220]]
the basis for its exemption. For example, where a tax-exempt hospital
leases real property owned by it to an association of doctors for use as
a clinic, the rents derived under such lease would not be included in
computing unrelated business taxable income if the clinic is
substantially related to the carrying on of hospital functions. See
Sec. 1.513-1 for principles applicable in determining whether there is
a substantial relationship to the exempt purpose of an organization.
(2) A lease is not a business lease if the lease is of premises in a
building primarily designed for occupancy and occupied by the tax-exempt
organization.
(3) If a lease for more than 5 years to a tenant is for only a
portion of the real property, and space in the real property is rented
during the taxable year under a lease for not more than 5 years to any
other tenant of the tax-exempt organization, all leases of the real
property for more than 5 years shall be considered as business leases
during the taxable year only if:
(i) The rents derived from the real property during the taxable year
under leases for more than 5 years represent 50 percent or more of the
total rents derived during the taxable year from the real property; or
the area of the premises occupied under leases for more than 5 years
represents, at any time during the taxable year, 50 percent or more of
the total area of the real property rented at such time; or
(ii) The rent derived from the real property during the taxable year
from any tenant under a lease for more than 5 years, or from a group of
tenants (under such leases) who are either members of an affiliated
group (as defined in section 1504) or are partners, represents more than
10 percent of the total rents derived during the taxable year from such
property; or the area of the premises occupied by any one such tenant,
or by any such group of tenants, represents at any time during the
taxable year more than 10 percent of the total area of the real property
rented at such time
In determining whether 50 percent or more of the total rents are derived
from leases for more than 5 years, or whether 50 percent or more of the
total area is occupied under leases for more than 5 years:
(iii) An occupancy which is considered to be a lease of more than 5
years solely by reason of the provisions of paragraph (b)(3) of this
subparagraph shall not be treated as such a lease for purposes of
subdivision (i) of this subparagraph, and
(iv) An occupancy which is considered to be a lease of more than 5
years solely by reason of the provisions of paragraph (b)(3) of this
section shall be treated as such a lease for purposes of subdivision
(ii) of this subparagraph, and
(v) If during the last half of the term of a lease a new lease is
made to take effect after the expiration of such lease, the unexpired
portion of the first lease will not be added to the second lease to
determine whether such second lease is a lease for more than 5 years for
purposes of subdivision (i) of this subparagraph.
(4) The application of subparagraph (3) of this paragraph may be
illustrated by the following example:
Example. In 1954 an educational organization, which is on the
calendar year basis, begins the erection of an 11-story apartment
building using funds borrowed for that purpose, and immediately leases
for a 10-year term the first floor to a real estate development company
to sublet for stores and shops. As fast as the new apartments are
completed, they are rented on an annual basis. At the end of 1959 all
except the 10th and 11th floors are rented. Those two floors are
completed during 1960 and rented. Assume that for 1954 and each
subsequent taxable year through 1959, and for the taxable year 1963, the
gross rental for the first floor represents more than 10 percent of the
total gross rents derived during the taxable year from the building.
Under this set of facts the 10-year lease of the first floor would be
considered to be a business lease for all except the taxable years 1961,
1962, and 1964.
[T.D. 7229, 37 FR 28154, Dec. 21, 1972]
Sec. 1.514(g)-1 Business lease indebtedness.
(a) Definition. The term business lease indebtedness means, with
respect to any real property leased by a tax-exempt organization for a
term of more than 5 years, the unpaid amount of:
(1) The indebtedness incurred by the lessor tax-exempt organization
in acquiring or improving such property;
[[Page 221]]
(2) The indebtedness incurred by the lessor tax-exempt organization
prior to the acquisition or improvement of such property if such
indebtedness would not have been incurred but for such acquisition or
improvement; and
(3) The indebtedness incurred by the lessor tax-exempt organization
subsequent to the acquisition or improvement of such property if such
indebtedness would not have been incurred but for such acquisition or
improvement and the incurrence of the indebtedness was reasonably
foreseeable at the time of such acquisition or improvement
See paragraph (i) of this section with respect to subsidiary
corporations.
(b) Examples. The rules of section 514(g) respecting business leases
also cover certain cases where the leased property itself is not subject
to an indebtedness. For example, they apply to cases such as the
following:
Example 1. A university pledges some of its investment securities
with a bank for a loan and uses the proceeds of such loan to purchase
(either directly or through a subsidiary corporation) a building, which
building is subject to a lease that then has more than 5 years to run.
This would be an example of a business lease indebtedness incurred prior
to the acquisition of the property which would not have been incurred
but for such acquisition.
Example 2. If the building itself in example 1 in this paragraph is
later mortgaged to raise funds to release the pledged securities, the
lease would continue to be a business lease.
Example 3. If a scientific organization mortgages its laboratory
building to replace working capital used in remodeling another one of
its buildings or a building held by its subsidiary corporation, which
other building is free of indebtedness and is subject to a lease that
then has more than 5 years to run, the lease would be a business lease
inasmuch as the indebtedness though incurred subsequent to the
improvement of such property would not have been incurred but for such
improvement, and the incurrence of the indebtedness was reasonably
foreseeable when, to make such improvement, the organization reduced its
working capital below the amount necessary to continue current
operations.
(c) Property acquired subject to lien. Where real property is
acquired subject to a mortgage or similar lien, whether the acquisition
be by gift, bequest, devise, or purchase, the amount of the indebtedness
secured by such mortgage or lien is a business lease indebtedness
(unless paragraph (d)(1) of this section applies) even though the lessor
does not assume or agree to pay the indebtedness. For example, a
university pays $100,000 for real estate valued at $300,000 and subject
to a $200,000 mortgage. For the purpose of the tax on unrelated business
taxable income, the result is the same as if $200,000 of borrowed funds
had been used to buy the property.
(d) Certain property acquired by gifts, etc. (1) Where real property
was acquired by gift, bequest, or devise, before July 1, 1950, subject
to a mortgage or other similar lien, the amount of such mortgage or
other similar lien shall not be considered as an indebtedness of the
lessor tax-exempt organization incurred in acquiring such property. An
indebtedness not otherwise covered by this exception is not brought
within the exception by reason of a transfer of the property between a
parent and its subsidiary corporation.
(2) Where real property was acquired by gift, bequest, or devise,
before July 1, 1950, subject to a lease requiring improvements in such
property upon the happening of stated contingencies, indebtedness
incurred in improving such property in accordance with the terms of such
lease shall not be considered as indebtedness described in section
514(g) and in this section. An indebtedness not otherwise covered by
this exception is not brought within the exception by reason of a
transfer of the property between a parent and its subsidiary
corporation.
(e) Certain corporations described in section 501(c)(2). In the case
of a title holding corporation described in section 501(c)(2), all of
the stock of which was acquired before July 1, 1950, by an organization
described in section 501(c) (3), (5), or (6) (and more than one-third of
such stock was acquired by such organization by gift or bequest), any
indebtedness incurred by such corporation before July 1, 1950, and any
indebtedness incurred by such corporation on or after such date in
improving real property in accordance with the terms of a lease entered
into before such date, shall not be considered an indebtedness described
in section 514(g) and in this
[[Page 222]]
section with respect to either such section 501(c)(2) corporation or
such section 501(c) (3), (5), or (6) organization.
(f) Certain trusts described in section 401(a). In the case of a
trust described in section 401(a), or in the case of a corporation
described in section 501(c)(2) all of the stock of which was acquired
before March 1, 1954, by such a trust, any indebtedness incurred by such
trust or such corporation before such date, in connection with real
property which is leased before such date, and any indebtedness incurred
by such trust or such corporation on or after such date necessary to
carry out the terms of such lease, shall not be considered as an
indebtedness described in section 514(g) and in this section.
(g) Business lease on portion of property. Where only a portion of
the real property is subject to a business lease, proper allocation of
the indebtedness applicable to the whole property must be made to the
premises covered by the lease. See example 2 of paragraph (b)(3) of
Sec. 1.514(a)-2.
(h) Special rule applicable to trusts described in section 401(a).
If an employees' trust described in section 401(a) lends any money to
another such employees' trust of the same employer, for the purpose of
acquiring or improving real property, such loan will not be treated as
an indebtedness of the borrowing trust except to the extent that the
loaning trust:
(1) Incurs any indebtedness in order to make such loan;
(2) Incurred indebtedness before the making of such loan which would
not have been incurred but for the making of such loan; or
(3) Incurred indebtedness after the making of such loan which would
not have been incurred but for the making of such loan and which was
reasonably foreseeable at the time of making such loan.
(i) Subsidiary corporations. The provisions of section 514(f), (g),
and (h) are applicable whether or not a subsidiary corporation of the
type described in section 501(c)(2) is availed of in making the business
lease. For example, assume a parent organization borrows funds to
purchase realty and sets up a separate section 501(c)(2) corporation as
a subsidiary to hold the property. Such subsidiary corporation leases
the property for a period of more than 5 years, collects the rents and
pays over all of the income, less expenses, to the parent organization,
the parent organization being liable for the indebtedness. Under these
assumed facts, the lease by section 501(c)(2) subsidiary corporation
would be a business lease with respect to such subsidiary corporation,
and the rental income would be subject to the tax, whether or not the
subsidiary itself assumes the indebtedness and whether or not the
property is subject to the indebtedness.
(j) Certain trusts described in section 501(c)(17). (1) In the case
of a supplemental unemployment benefit trust described in section
501(c)(17), or in the case of a corporation described in section
501(c)(2) all of the stock of which was acquired before January 1, 1960,
by such a trust, any indebtedness incurred by such trust or such
corporation before such date, in connection with real property which is
leased before such date, and any indebtedness incurred by such trust or
such corporation on or after such date necessary to carry out the terms
of such lease, shall not be considered as an indebtedness described in
section 514(g) and in this section.
(2) If a supplemental unemployment benefit trust described in
section 501(c)(17) lends any money to another such supplemental
unemployment benefit trust forming part of the same plan, for the
purpose of acquiring or improving real property, such loan will not be
treated as an indebtedness of the borrowing trust except to the extent
that the loaning trust:
(i) Incurs any indebtedness in order to make such loan;
(ii) Incurred indebtedness before the making of such loan which
would not have been incurred but for the making of such loan; or
(iii) Incurred indebtedness after the making of such loan which
would not have been incurred but for the making of such loan and which
was reasonably foreseeable at the time of making such loan.
[T.D. 7229, 37 FR 28155, Dec. 21, 1972]
[[Page 223]]
Farmers' Cooperatives
Sec. 1.521-1 Farmers' cooperative marketing and purchasing
associations; requirements for exemption under section 521.
(a)(1) Cooperative associations engaged in the marketing of farm
products for farmers, fruit growers, livestock growers, dairymen, etc.,
and turning back to the producers the proceeds of the sales of their
products, less the necessary operating expenses, on the basis of either
the quantity or the value of the products furnished by them, are exempt
from income tax except as otherwise provided in section 522, or part I,
subchapter T chapter 1 of the Code, and the regulations thereunder. For
instance, cooperative dairy companies which are engaged in collecting
milk and disposing of it or the products thereof and distributing the
proceeds, less necessary operating expenses, among the producers upon
the basis of either the quantity or the value of milk or of butterfat in
the milk furnished by such producers, are exempt from the tax. If the
proceeds of the business are distributed in anyother way than on such a
proportionate basis, the association does not meet the requirements of
the Code and is not exempt. In other words, nonmember patrons must be
treated the same as members insofar as the distribution of patronage
dividends is concerned. Thus, if products are marketed for nonmember
producers, the proceeds of the sale, less necessary operating expenses,
must be returned to the patrons from the sale of whose goods such
proceeds result, whether or not such patrons are members of the
association. In order to show its cooperative nature and to establish
compliance with the requirement of the Code that the proceeds of sales,
less necessary expenses, be turned back to all producers on the basis of
either the quantity or the value of the products furnished by them, it
is necessary for such an association to keep permanent records of the
business done both with members and nonmembers. The Code does not
require, however, that the association keep ledger accounts with each
producer selling through the association. Any permanent records which
show that the association was operating during the taxable year on a
cooperative basis in the distribution of patronage dividends to all
producers will suffice. While under the Code patronage dividends must be
paid to all producers on the same basis, this requirement is complied
with if an association instead of paying patronage dividends to
nonmember producers incash, keeps permanent records from which the
proportionate shares of the patronage dividends due to nonmember
producers can be determined, and such shares are made applicable toward
the purchase price of a share of stock or of a membership in the
association. See, however, paragraph (c)(1) of Sec. 1.1388-1 for the
meaning of payment in money for purposes of qualifying a written notice
of allocation.
(2) An association which has capital stock will not for such reason
be denied exemption (i) if the dividend rate of such stock is fixed at
not to exceed the legal rate of interest in the State of incorporation
or 8 percent per annum, whichever is greater, on the value of the
consideration for which the stock was issued, and (ii) if substantially
all of such stock (with the exception noted below) is owned by producers
who market their products or purchase their supplies and equipment
through the association. Any ownership of stock by others than such
actual producers must be satisfactorily explained in the association's
application for exemption. The association will be required to show that
the ownership of its capital stock has been restrictedas far as possible
to such actual producers. If by statutory requirement all officers of an
association must be shareholders, the ownership of a share of stock by a
nonproducer to qualify him as an officer will not destroy the
association's exemption. Likewise, if a shareholder for any reason
ceases to be a producer and the association is unable, because of a
constitutional restriction or prohibition or other reason beyond the
control of the association, to purchase or retire the stock of such
nonproducer, the fact that under such circumstances a small amount of
the outstanding capital stock is owned by shareholders who are no longer
producers will not destroy the exemption. The restriction placed
[[Page 224]]
on the ownership of capital stock of an exempt cooperative association
shall not apply to nonvoting preferred stock, provided the owners of
such stock are not entitled or permitted to participate, directly or
indirectly, in the profits of the association, upon dissolution or
otherwise, beyond the fixed dividends.
(3) The accumulation and maintenance of a reserve required by State
statute, or the accumulation and maintenance of a reasonable reserve or
surplus for any necessary purpose, such as to provide for the erection
of buildings and facilities required in business or for the purchase and
installation of machinery and equipment or to retire indebtedness
incurred for such purposes, will not destroy the exemption. An
association will not be denied exemption because it markets the products
of nonmembers, provided the value of the products marketed for
nonmembers does not exceed the value of the products marketed for
members. Anyone who shares in the profits of a farmers' cooperative
marketing association, and is entitled to participate in the management
of the association, must be regarded as a member of such association
within the meaning of section 521.
(b) Cooperative associations engaged in the purchasing of supplies
and equipment for farmers, fruit growers, livestock growers, dairymen,
etc., and turning over such supplies and equipment to them at actual
cost, plus the necessary operating expenses, are exempt. The term
supplies and equipment as used in section 521 includes groceries and all
other goods and merchandise used by farmers in the operation and
maintenance of a farm or farmer's household. The provisions of paragraph
(a) of this section relating to a reserve or surplus and to capital
stock shall apply to associations coming under this paragraph. An
association which purchases supplies and equipment for nonmembers will
not for such reason be denied exemption, provided the value of the
purchases for nonmembers does not exceed the value of the supplies and
equipment purchased for members, and provided the value of the purchases
made for nonmembers who are not producers does not exceed 15 percent of
the value of all its purchases.
(c) In order to be exempt under either paragraph (a) or (b) of this
section an association must establish that it has no taxable income for
its own account other than that reflected in a reserve or surplus
authorized in paragraph (a) of this section. An association engaged both
in marketing farm products and in purchasing supplies and equipment is
exempt if as to each of its functions it meets the requirements of the
Code. Business done for the United States or any of its agencies shall
be disregarded in determining the right to exemption under section 521
and this section. An association to be entitled to exemption must not
only be organized but actually operated in the manner and for the
purposes specified in section 521.
(d) Cooperative organizations engaged in occupations dissimilar from
those of farmers, fruit growers, and the like, are not exempt.
(e) An organization is not exempt from taxation under this section
merely because it claims that it complies with the requirements
prescribed therein. In order to establish its exemption every
organization claiming exemption under section 521 is required to file a
Form 1028. The Form 1028, executed in accordance with the instructions
on the form or issued therewith, should be filed with the district
director for the internal revenue district in which is located the
principal place of business or principal office of the organization.
However, an organization which has been granted exemption under the
provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1939 or prior law may rely on
that ruling, unless affected by substantive changes in the Internal
Revenue Code of 1954 or any changes in the character, purposes, or
methods of operation of the organization, and it is not necessary in
such case for the organization to request a new determination as to its
exempt status.
(f) A cooperative association will not be denied exemption merely
because it makes payments solely in nonqualified written notices of
allocation to those patrons who do not consent as provided in section
1388 and Sec. 1.1388-1, but makes payments of 20 percent in cash and
the remainder in qualified written notices
[[Page 225]]
of allocation to those patrons who do so consent. Nor will such an
association be denied exemption merely because, in the case of patrons
who have so consented, payments of less than $5 are made solely in
nonqualified written notices of allocation while payments of $5 or more
are made in the form of 20 percent in cash and the remainder in
qualified written notices of allocation. In addition, a cooperative
association will not be denied exemption if it pays a smaller amount of
interest or dividends on nonqualified written notices of allocation held
by persons who have not consented as provided in section 1388 and Sec.
1.1388-1 (or on per-unit retain certificates issued to patrons who are
not qualifying patrons with respect thereto within the meaning of Sec.
1.61-5(d)(2)) than it pays on qualified written notices of allocation
held by persons who have so consented (or on per-unit retain
certificates issued to patrons who are qualifying patrons with respect
thereto) provided that the amount of the interest or dividend reduction
isreasonable in relation to the fact that the association receives no
tax benefit with respect to such nonqualified written notices of
allocation (or such certificates issued to nonqualifying patrons) until
redeemed. However, such an association will be denied exemption if it
otherwise treats patrons who have not consented (or are not qualifying
patrons) differently from patrons who have consented (or are qualifying
patrons), either with regard to the original payment or allocation or
with regard to the redemption of written notices of allocation or per-
unit retain certificates. For example, if such an association pays
patronage dividends in the form of written notices of allocation
accompanied by qualified checks, and provides that any patron who does
not cash his check within a specified time will forfeit the portion of
the patronage dividend represented by such check, then the cooperative
association will be denied exemption under this section as it does not
treat all patrons alike.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6643, 28 FR
3162, Apr. 2, 1963; T.D. 6855, 30 FR 13135, Oct. 15, 1965]
Sec. 1.522-1 Tax treatment of farmers' cooperative marketing and
purchasing associations exempt under section 521.
(a) In general. (1) Section 522 is applicable to farmers', fruit
growers', or like associations organized and operated on a cooperative
basis in the manner prescribed in section 521. Although such an
association is subject to both normal tax and surtax, as in the case of
corporations generally, certain special rules for the computation of
taxable income are provided in section 522(b) and Sec. 1.522-2. For the
purpose of any law which refers to organizations exempt from income
taxes such an association shall, however, be considered as an
organization exempt under section 501. Thus, the provisions of section
243, providing a credit for dividends received from a domestic
corporation subject to taxation, are not applicable to dividends
received from a cooperative association subject to section 522. The
provisions of section 1501, relating to consolidated returns, are
likewise not applicable.
(2) Rules governing the manner in which amounts allocated as
patronage dividends, refunds, or rebates are to be taken into account in
computing the taxable income of such an association are set forth in
Sec. 1.522-3. For the tax treatment, as to patrons, of amounts received
during the taxable year as patronage dividends, rebates, or refunds, see
section 61 and Sec. 1.61-5.
(b) Meaning of terms. For purposes of Sec. Sec. 1.522-1 to 1.522-3,
inclusive, Sec. Sec. 1.6044-1 and 1.61-5, the following terms shall
have the meaning ascribed below:
(1) Cooperative association. The term cooperative association
includes any corporation operating on a cooperative basis and allocating
amounts to patrons on the basis of the business done with or for such
patrons, except that the term does not include any cooperative or
nonprofit corporation (including any cooperative or nonprofit
corporation engaged in rural electrification) exempt from taxation under
section 501(a) and described in section 501(c) (12) or (15) or any
corporation subject to a tax imposed by subchapter L, chapter 1 of the
Code (relating to insurance companies).
[[Page 226]]
(2) Patron. The term patron includes any person with whom or for
whom the cooperative association does business on a cooperative basis,
whether a member or a nonmember of the cooperative association, and
whether an individual, a trust, estate, partnership, company,
corporation, or cooperative association.
(3) Allocation. The term allocation includes distributions made by a
cooperative association to a patron in cash, merchandise, capital stock,
revolving fund certificates, retain certificates, certificates of
indebtedness, letters of advice, similar documents, or in any other
manner whereby there is disclosed to a patron the dollar amount
apportioned on the books of the association for the account of such
patron. Thus, a mere credit to the account of a patron on the books of
the cooperative association, without disclosure to the patron, is not an
allocation.
(4) Patronage dividends, rebates, and refunds. The term patronage
dividend, rebate, or refund includes any amount allocated by a
cooperative association, to the account of a patron on the basis of the
business done with or for such patron. The following are not patronage
dividends, rebates, or refunds:
(i) Amounts distributed in redemption of capital stock, or in
redemption or satisfaction of certificates of indebtedness, revolving
fund certificates, retain certificates, letters of advice, or other
similar documents;
(ii) Amounts allocated (whether in cash, merchandise, capital stock,
revolving fund certificates, retain certificates, certificates of
indebtedness, letters of advice, or in some other manner that discloses
to each patron the amount of such dividend, refund, or rebate) by the
association for products of members or other patrons to the extent such
amounts are fixed without reference to the earnings of the cooperative
association. For this purpose, the term earnings includes the excess of
amounts retained (or assessed) by the association to cover expenses or
other items over the amount of such expenses or other items.
(c) Examples. The application of paragraph (b) of this section may
be illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. Cooperative A, a marketing association operating on a
pooling basis, receives the products of patron W on January 5, 1954. On
the same day Cooperative A advances to W 45 cents per unit for the
products so delivered and allocates to him a retain certificate having a
face value calculated at the rate of 5 cents per unit. During the
operatiion of the pool, and before substantially all the products in the
pool are disposed of, Cooperative A advances to W an additional 40 cents
per unit, the amount being determined by reference to the market price
of the products sold and the anticipated price of the unsold products.
At the close of the pool on November 10, 1954, Cooperative A determines
the excess of its receipts over the sum of its expenses and its previous
advances to patrons, and allocates to W an additional 3 cents per unit
and shares of the capital stock of A having an aggregate of face value
calculated at the rate of 2 cents per unit.
The amount of patronage dividends, rebates, or refunds allocated to
W during 1954 amount to 5 cents per unit, consisting of the aggregate of
the following per-unit allocations: The amount of cash distribution (3
cents), and the face value of the capital stock of A (2 cents), which
are fixed with reference to the earnings of A. The amount of the two
distributions in cash (85 cents) and the face amount of the retain
certificate (5 cents), which are fixed without reference to the earnings
of A, do not constitute patronage dividends, rebates, or refunds.
Example 2. Cooperative B, a marketing association operating on a
pooling basis, receives the products of patron X on March 5, 1954. On
the same day Cooperative B pays to X $1.00 per unit for such products,
this amount being determined by reference to the market price of the
product when received, and issues to him a participation certificate
having no face value but which entitles X on the close of the pool to
the proceeds derived from the sale of his products less the previous
payment of $1.00 and the expenses and other charges attributable to such
products. On March 5, 1957, Cooperative B, having sold the products in
the pool, having deducted the previous payments for such products, and
having determined the expenses and other charges of the pool, redeems
the participation certificate of X in cash for 10 cents per unit. The
allocation made to X during 1957, amounting to 10 cents per unit, is a
patronage dividend, rebate, or refund. Neither the payment to X in 1954
of $1.00 nor the issuance to him of the participation certificate in
that year constitutes a patronage dividend, rebate, or refund within the
meaning of this section.
Example 3. Cooperative C, a purchasing association, obtains supplies
for patron Y on May 1, 1954, and receives in return therefor $100. On
February 1, 1955, Cooperative C, having determined the excess of its
receipts over
[[Page 227]]
its costs and expenses, allocates to Y a cash distribution of $1.00 and
a revolving fund certificate of a face amount of $1.00. The amount of
patronage dividends, rebates, or refunds allocated to Y for 1955 is
$2.00, the aggregate of the cash distribution of $1.00, and the face
amount, $1.00, of the revolving fund certificate.
Example 4. Cooperative D, a service association, sells the products
of members on a fee basis. It receives the products of patron Z under an
agreement not to pool his products with those of other members, to sell
his products, and to deliver to him the proceeds of the sale. Patron Z
makes payments to Cooperative D during 1954 aggregating $75 for service
rendered him by Cooperative D during that year. On May 15, 1955,
Cooperative D, having determined the excess of its receipts over its
costs and expenses, allocates to Z a cash distribution of $2.00. Such
amount is a patronage dividend, rebate, or refund allocated by
Cooperative D during 1955.
(d) Returns of exempt cooperative associations. For requirements of
annual returns by exempt cooperative associations, see sections 6012 and
6072(d) and paragraph (f) of Sec. 1.6012-2.
Sec. 1.522-2 Manner of taxation of cooperative associations subject
to section 522.
(a) In general. Farmers', fruit growers', or like associations,
organized and operated in compliance with the requirements of section
521 and Sec. 1.521-1 shall be subject to the taxes imposed by section
11 or section 1201, except that there shall be allowed as deductions
from gross income, in addition to the other deductions allowable under
chapter 1 of the Code, certain special deductions provided in section
522(b)(1)(A) and paragraph (c) of this section, and section 522(b)(1)(B)
and paragraph (d) of this section. Amounts allocated as patronage
dividends, refunds, or rebates, whether in cash, merchandise, capital
stock, revolving fund certificates, retain certificates, certificates of
indebtedness, letters of advice, or in some other manner that discloses
to each patron the dollar amount allocated, with respect to patronage
for the taxable year or for preceding taxable years, shall be taken into
account in the manner provided in section 522 and in Sec. 1.522-3.
(b) Cooperative association exempt from tax before January 1, 1952.
(1) For the purpose of determining the method of accounting under
section 446 in the case of a cooperative association which was exempt
from tax for taxable years beginning prior to January 1, 1952, the
method of accounting, recognized under sections 41, 42, and 43 of the
Internal Revenue Code of 1939 and the regulations prescribed thereunder
and utilized in the return of such association for its last taxable year
to which the Internal Revenue Code of 1939 was applicable, shall be
deemed to constitute the method of accounting regularly employed by the
cooperative association. Any change from this method may be made only if
permission is obtained from the Commissioner to change to another
recognized method in accordance with section 446 and the regulations
thereunder.
(2) In any case where inventories are an income-producing factor,
see sections 471 and 472 and the regulations thereunder. The elective
method of inventorying goods provided in section 472 may be adopted by
the cooperative association for any taxable year beginning after
December 31, 1953, inaccordance with the requirements of section 472 and
the regulations thereunder. However, in order to use such method for
such a taxable year the cooperative association (unless it has used such
method for a taxable year beginning after 1951 and before 1954 pursuant
to an election exercised as provided in 26 CFR (1939) 39.22(d)-3
(Regulations 118) must exercise the election provided in section 472 and
the regulations thereunder, even if it may have utilized such method for
accounting purposes for taxable years beginning before January 1, 1952.
(3) The following rules shall be applicable in computing the net
operating loss deduction provided in section 172: No net operating loss
carryover shall be allowed from a taxable year beginning prior to
January 1, 1952, for which the cooperative association was exempt from
tax under section 101(12) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1939. In the
case of a taxable year beginning prior to January 1, 1952, for which the
association was not exempt under section 101(12) of the Internal Revenue
Code of 1939 and of any taxable year beginning after December 31, 1951,
the amount of the net operating loss
[[Page 228]]
carryback or carryover from such year shall not be reduced by reference
to the income of any taxable year beginning prior to January 1, 1952,
for which the association was exempt from tax under section 101(12) of
the Internal Revenue Code of 1939. However, any taxable year beginning
prior to January 1, 1952, for which the cooperative association was
exempt under section 101(12) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1939 shall
be taken into account in determining the period for which a net
operating loss may be carried back or carried over, as the case may be.
(4) The adjustments to the cost or other basis provided in sections
1011 and 1016 and the regulations thereunder, are applicable for the
entire period since the acquisition of the property. Thus, proper
adjustment to basis must be made under section 1016 for depreciation,
obsolescence, amortization, and depletion for all taxable years
beginning prior to January 1, 1952, although the cooperative association
was exempt from tax under section 521 or corresponding provisions of
prior law for such years. However, no adjustment for percentage or
discovery depletion is to be made for any year during which the
association was exempt from tax. If a cooperative association has made a
proper election in accordance with section 1020 and the regulations
prescribed thereunder with respect to a taxable year beginning before
1952 in which the association was not exempt from tax, the adjustment to
basis for depreciation for such years shall be limited in accordance
with the provisions of section 1016(a)(2).
(5) In the case of tax exempt and partially taxable bonds purchased
at a premium and subject to amortization under section 171, proper
adjustment to basis must be made to reflect amortization with respect to
such premium from the date of acquisition of the bond. (For principles
governing the method of computation, see the example in paragraph (b) of
Sec. 1.1016-9, relating to mutual savings banks, building and loan
associations, and cooperative banks.) The basis of a fully taxable bond
purchased at a premium shall be adjusted from the date of the election
to amortize such premium in accordance with the provisions of section
171 except that no adjustment shall be allowable for such portion of the
premium attributable to the period prior to the election.
(6) In the case of a mortgage acquired at a premium where the
principal of such mortgage is payable in installments, adjustments to
the basis for the premium must be made for all taxable years (whether or
not the association was exempt from tax under section 521 during such
years) in which installment payments are received. Such adjustments may
be made on an individual mortgage basis or on a composite basis by
reference to the average period of payments of the mortgage loans of
such association. For the purpose of this adjustment, the term premium
includes the excess of the acquisition value of the mortgage over its
maturity value. The acquisition value of the mortgage is the cost
including buying commissions, attorneys' fees or brokerage fees, but
such value does not include amounts paid for accrued interest.
(c) Deduction for dividends paid. There is allowable as a deduction
from the gross income of a cooperative association operated in
compliance with the requirements of section 521 and Sec. 1.521-1,
amounts paid as dividends during the taxable year upon the capital stock
of the cooperative association. For the purpose of the preceding
sentence, the term capital stock includes common stock (whether voting
or nonvoting), preferred stock, or any other form of capital represented
by capital retain certificates, revolving fund certificates, letters of
advice, or other evidence of a proprietary interest in a cooperative
association. Such deduction is applicable only to the taxable year in
which the dividends are actually or constructively paid to the holder of
capital stock or other proprietary interest of the cooperative
association. If a dividend is paid by check and the check bearing a date
within the taxable year is deposited in the mail, in a cover properly
stamped and addressed tothe shareholder at his last known address, at
such time that in the ordinary handling of the mails the check would be
received by such holder within the taxable year, a presumption arises
that the dividend was paid to such holder in
[[Page 229]]
such year. The determination of whether a dividend has been paid to such
holder by the corporation during its taxable year is in no way dependent
upon the method of accounting regularly employed by the corporation in
keeping its books. For further rules as to the determination of the
right to a deduction for dividends paid, under certain specific
circumstances, see section 561 and the regulations thereunder.
(d) Deduction for amounts allocated from income not derived from
patronage. There is allowable as a deduction from the gross income of a
cooperative association operated in compliance with the requirements of
section 521 and Sec. 1.521-1 amounts allocated during the taxable year
to patrons with respect to its income not derived from patronage
(whether or not such income was derived during such taxable year)
whether such amounts are paid in cash, merchandise, capital stock,
revolving fund certificates, retain certificates, certificates of
indebtedness, letters of advice, or in some other manner that discloses
to each patron the dollar amount allocated to him. For this purpose,
allocations made after the close of the taxable year and on or before
the 15th day of the ninth month following the close of the taxable year
shall be considered as made on the last day of such taxable year to the
extent that such allocations are attributable toincome derived during
the taxable year or during years prior to the taxable year. As used in
this paragraph, the term income not derived from patronage means
incidental income derived from sources not directly related to the
marketing, purchasing, or service activities of the cooperative
association. For example, income derived from the lease of premises,
from investment in securities, from the sale or exchange of capital
assets, constitutes income not derived from patronage. Business done
with the United States shall constitute income not derived from
patronage. In order that the deduction for income not derived from
patronage may be applicable, it is necessary that the amount sought to
be deducted be allocated on a patronage basis in proportion, insofar as
is practicable, to the amount of business done by or for patrons during
the period to which such income is attributable. Thus, if capital gains
are realized from the sale or exchange of capital assets acquired and
disposed of during the taxable year, income realized from such gains
must be allocated to patrons of such year in proportion to theamount of
business done by such patrons during the taxable year. Similarly, if
capital gains are realized by the association from the sale or exchange
of capital assets held for a period of more than one taxable year income
realized from such gains must be allocated, in proportion insofar as is
practicable, to the patrons of the taxable years during which the asset
was owned by the association, and to the amount of business done by such
patrons during such taxable years.
Sec. 1.522-3 Patronage dividends, rebates, or refunds; treatment as
to cooperative associations entitled to tax treatment under section 522.
(a) General rule. Patronage dividends, refunds, or rebates,
allocated by a cooperative association entitled to tax treatment under
section 522 to a patron shall be taken into account in computing the
gross income of such association for the taxable year, as an increase in
its other cost of goods sold in the case of an association marketing
products for patrons, or as a reduction in its gross receipts, in the
case of an association purchasing supplies and equipment or performing
services for patrons, as the case may be, if:
(1) The allocation is made in fulfillment and satisfaction of a
valid obligation of such association to the patron, which obligation was
in existence prior to the receipt by the cooperative association of the
amount allocated, and
(2) The allocation is made on or before the 15th day of the ninth
month following the close of the taxable year in which the amounts
allocated were received by the cooperative association
For the purpose of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph, amounts allocated
by a cooperative association entitled to tax treatment under section 522
will be deemed allocated in fulfillment and satisfaction of a valid
enforceable obligation, if made pursuant to provisions of the bylaws,
articles of incorporation,
[[Page 230]]
or other contract, whereby the association is obligated to make such
allocation after the retention of reasonable reserves and after payment
of dividends on capital stock or other proprietary capital interests.
Notwithstanding the provisions of subparagraphs (1) and (2) of this
paragraph, amounts allocated as patronage dividends, refunds, or rebates
during the taxable year, on or before the 15th day of the ninth month
following the close of such year, with respect to patronage for years
preceding the taxable year, shall be taken into account as an increase
in its other cost of goods sold, or as a reduction in gross receipts,
for the taxable year, as the case may be, where retention as reasonable
reserves of the amounts so allocated beyond the year in which earned was
proper in accordance with the provisions of section 521 and where the
allocation is made to the patron on a patronage basis is proportion
insofar as is practicable, to the amount of business done by such
patrons during the taxable year or years in which the retained amounts
were received by the cooperative association.
(b) Examples. This section may be illustrated by the following
examples:
Example 1. E, a cooperative association entitled to tax treatment
under section 522, organized without capital stock, is engaged in the
business of marketing products for its patrons on a non-pool basis. The
by-laws of Cooperative E provide that there shall be allocated to
patrons as patronage dividends within a reasonable time following the
close of the year all of the gross returns from sales, less expenses of
operation for the year and amounts retained as reasonable reserves
necessary to the operation of Cooperative E. At the close of the taxable
year, 1954, it is determined that from the gross returns from sales less
operating expenses and all taxes for such year, $5,000 is to be retained
as reasonable reserves for various necessary purposes of Cooperative E.
It is assumed that the retention of such amount is proper in accordance
with the provisions of section 521. Such $5,000 is apportioned on the
books of Cooperative E to patrons of 1954 on a patronage basis, or
permanent records are kept from which an apportionment to such patrons
can be made. On March 1, 1955, pursuant tothe terms of the by-laws,
$200,000, the balance of the gross returns for the taxable year, is
allocated to patrons of 1954 on the basis of patronage. $100,000 of such
$200,000 is allocated in cash. The remaining $100,000 is allocated in
retain certificates, bearing no interest and redeemable in the
discretion of the Board of Directors of Cooperative E. There may be
added to the cost of goods sold by Cooperative E for 1954, $200,000
($100,000 in cash, $100,000 in retain certificates), the total amount
allocated as patronage dividends, rebates, or refunds in fulfillment and
satisfaction of the obligation of the by-laws, on March 1, 1955, before
the 15th day of the ninth month following the close of 1954. There may
not be added to the cost of goods sold by Cooperative E for 1954,
$5,000, the amount retained as reserves apportioned on the books, but
not allocated as patronage dividends, rebates, or refunds.
Example 2. The facts are the same as example 1, it additionally
appearing that at the close of 1955 it is determined by Cooperative E to
allocate as cash patronage dividends, rebates, or refunds to patrons of
1954, $5,000, the amount retained as reasonable reserves for 1954 in
accordance with the provisions of section 521. On March 1, 1956, such
amount is allocated. There may be added to the cost of goods sold by
Cooperative E for 1955, $5,000, the amount allocated with respect to
patronage of a preceding year, 1954, properly maintained as a reserve
under section 521.
Sec. 1.522-4 Taxable years affected.
Section 522 and Sec. Sec. 1.522-1, 1.522-2, and 1.522-3, are
applicable to taxable years beginning before January 1, 1963, and also
to amounts paid during taxable years beginning after December 31, 1962,
the tax treatment of which is not prescribed in section 1382 and the
regulations thereunder.
[T.D. 6643, 28 FR 3163, Apr. 2, 1963]
Sec. 1.527-1 Political organizations; generally.
Section 527 provides that a political organization is considered an
organization exempt from income taxes for the purpose of any law which
refers to organizations exempt from income taxes. A political
organization is subject to tax only to the extent provided in section
527. In general, a political organization is an organization that is
organized and operated primarily for an exempt function as defined in
Sec. 1.527-2(c). Section 527 provides that a political organization is
taxed on its political organization taxable income (see Sec. 1.527-4)
which, in general, does not include the exempt function income (see
Sec. 1.527-3) of the political organization. Furthermore, section 527
provides that an exempt organization, other than a political
organization, may be subject to
[[Page 231]]
tax under section 527 when it expends an amount for an exempt function,
see Sec. 1.527-6. The taxation of newsletter funds is provided under
section 527(g) and Sec. 1.527-7. A special rule for principal campaign
committees is provided under section 527(h) and Sec. 1.527-9.
[T.D. 8041, 50 FR 30817, July 30, 1985]
Sec. 1.527-2 Definitions.
For purposes of section 527 and these regulations:
(a) Political organization--(1) In general. A political organization
is a party, committee, association, fund, or other organization (whether
or not incorporated) organized and operated primarily for the purpose of
directly or indirectly accepting contributions or making expenditures
for an exempt function activity (as defined in paragraph (c) of this
section). Accordingly, a political organization may include a committee
or other group which accepts contributions or makes expenditures for the
purpose of promoting the nomination of an individual for an elective
public office in a primary election, or in a meeting or caucus of a
political party. A segregated fund (as defined in paragraph (b) of this
section) established and maintained by an individual may qualify as a
political organization.
(2) Organizational test. A political organization meets the
organizational test if its articles of organization provide that the
primary purpose of the organization is to carry on one or more exempt
functions. A political organization is not required to be formally
chartered or established as a corporation, trust, or association. If an
organization has no formal articles of organization, consideration is
given to statements of the members of the organization at the time the
organization is formed that they intend to operate the organization
primarily to carry on one or more exempt functions.
(3) Operational test. A political organization does not have to
engage exclusively in activities that are an exempt function. For
example, a political organization may:
(i) Sponsor nonpartisan educational workshops which are not intended
to influence or attempt to influence the selection, nomination,
election, or appointment of any individual for public office,
(ii) Pay an incumbent's office expenses, or
(iii) Carry on social activities which are unrelated to its exempt
function,
provided these are not the organization's primary activities. However,
expenditures for purposes described in the preceding sentence are not
for an exempt function. See Sec. 1.527-2 (c) and (d). Furthermore, it
is not necessary that a political organization operate in accordance
with normal corporate formalities as ordinarily established in bylaws or
under state law.
(b) Segregated fund--(1) General rule. A segregated fund is a fund
which is established and maintained by a political organization or an
individual separate from the assets of the organization or the personal
assets of the individual. The purpose of such a fund must be to receive
and segregate exempt function income (and earnings on such income) for
use only for an exempt function or for an activity necessary to fulfill
an exempt function. Accordingly, the amounts in the fund must be
dedicated for use only for an exempt function. Thus, expenditures for
the establishment or administration of a political organization or the
solicitation of political contributions may be made from the segregated
fund, if necessary to fulfill an exempt function. The fund must be
clearly identified and established for the pruposes intended. A savings
or checking account into which only contributions to the political
organization are placed and from which only expenditures for exempt
functions are made may be a segregated fund. If an organization that had
designated a fund to be a segregated fund for purposes of segregating
amounts referred to in section 527(c)(3) (A) through (D), expends more
than an insubstantial amount from the segregated fund for activities
that are not for an exempt function during a taxable year, the fund will
not be treated as a segregated fund for such year. In such a case
amounts referred to in section 527(c)(3)(A)-(D),segregated in such fund
will not be exempt function income. Further, if more than insubstantial
amounts segregated for an
[[Page 232]]
exempt function in prior years are expended for other than an exempt
function the facts and circumstances may indicate that the fund was
never a segregated fund as defined in this paragraph.
(2) Record keeping. The organization or individual maintaining a
segregated fund must keep records that are adequate to verify receipts
and disbursements of the fund and identify the exempt function activity
for which each expenditure is made.
(c) Exempt function--(1) Directly related expenses. An exempt
function, as defined in section 527(e)(2), includes all activities that
are directly related to and support the process of influencing or
attempting to influence the selection, nomination, election, or
appointment of any individual to public office or office in a political
organization (the selection process). Whether an expenditure is for an
exempt function depends upon all the facts and circumstances. Generally,
where an organization supports an individual's campaign for public
office, the organization's activities and expenditures in futherance of
the individual's election or appointment to that office are for an
exempt function of the organization. The individual does not have to be
an announced candidate for the office. Furthermore, the fact that an
individual never becomes a candidate is not crucial in determining
whether an organization is engaging in an exempt function. An activity
engaged in between elections which is directly related to, and supports,
the process of selection, nomination, or election of an individual in
the next applicable political campaign is an exempt function activity.
(2) Indirect expenses. Expenditures that are not directly related to
influencing or attempting to influence the selection process may also be
an expenditure for an exempt function by a political organization. These
are expenses which are necessary to support the directly related
activities of the political organization. Activities which support the
directly related activities are those which must be engaged in to allow
the political organization to carry out the activity of influencing or
attempting to influence the selection process. For example, expenses for
overhead and record keeping are necessary to allow the political
organization to be established and to engage in political activities.
Similarly, expenses incurred in soliciting contributions to the
political organization are necessary to support the activities of the
political organization.
(3) Terminating activities. An exempt function includes an activity
which is in furtherance of the process of terminating a political
organization's existence. For example, where a political organization is
established for a single campaign, payment of campaign debts after the
conclusion of the campaign is an exempt function activity.
(4) Illegal expenditures. Expenditures which are illegal or are for
a judicially determined illegal activity are not considered expenditures
in furtherance of an exempt function, even though such expenditures are
made in connection with the selection process.
(5) Examples. The following examples illustrate the principles of
paragraph (c) of this section. The term exempt function when used in the
following examples means exempt function within the meaning of section
527(e)(2).
(i) Example 1. A wants to run for election to public office in State
X. A is not a candidate. A travels throughout X in order to rally
support for A's intended candidacy. While in X, A attends a convention
of an organization for the purpose of attempting to solicit its support.
The amount expended for travel, lodging, food, and similar expenses are
for an exempt function.
(ii) Example 2. B, a member of the United States House of
Representatives, is a candidate for reelection. B travels with B's
spouse to the district B represents. B feels it is important for B's
reelection that B's spouse accompany B. While in the district, B makes
speeches and appearances for the purpose of persuading voters to reelect
B. The travel expenses of B and B's spouse are for an exempt function.
(iii) Example 3. C is a candidate for public office. In connection
with C's campaign, C takes voice and speech lessons to improve C's
skills. The expenses for these lessons are for an exempt function.
[[Page 233]]
(iv) Example 4. D, an officeholder and candidate for reelection,
purchases tickets to a testimonial dinner. D's attendance at the dinner
is intended to aid D's reelection. Such expenditures are for an exempt
function.
(v) Example 5. E, an officeholder, expends amounts for periodicals
of general circulation in order to keep informed on national and local
issues. Such expenditures are not for an exempt function.
(vi) Example 6. N is an organization described in section 501(c) and
is exempt from taxation under section 501(a). F is employed as president
of N. F, as a representative of N, testifies in response to a written
request from a Congressional committee in support of the confirmation of
an individual to a cabinet position. The expenditures by N that are
directly related to F's testimony are not for an exempt function.
(vii) Example 7. P is a political organization described in section
527(e)(2). Between elections P does not support any particular
individual for public office. However, P does train staff members for
the next election, drafts party rules, implements party reform
proposals, and sponsors a party convention. The expenditures for these
activities are for an exempt function.
(viii) Example 8. Q is a political organization described in section
527(e)(2). Q finances seminars and conferences which are intended to
influence persons who attend to support individuals to public office
whose political philosophy is in harmony with the political philosophy
of Q. The expenditures for these activities are for an exempt function.
(d) Public office. The facts and circumstances of each case will
determine whether a particular Federal, State, or local office is a
public office. Principles consistent with those found under Sec.
53.4946-1(g)(2) (relating to the definition of public office) will be
applied.
(e) Principal campaign committee. A principal campaign committee is
the political committee designated by a candidate for Congress as his or
her principal campaign committee for purposes of section 302(e) of the
Federal Election Campaign Act of 1971 (2 U.S.C. section 432(e)), as
amended, and section 527(h) and Sec. 1.527-9.
[T.D. 7744, 45 FR 85731, Dec. 30, 1980; as amended by T.D. 8041, 50 FR
30817, July 30, 1985]
Sec. 1.527-3 Exempt function income.
(a) General rule--(1) For purposes of section 527, exempt function
income consists solely of amounts received as:
(i) Contributions of money or other property,
(ii) Membership dues, fees, or assessments from a member of a
political organization, or
(iii) Proceeds from a political fund raising or entertainment event,
or proceeds from the sale of political campaign materials, which are not
received in the ordinary course of any trade or business,
but only to the extent such income is segregated for use only for exempt
functions of the political organization.
(2) Income will be considered segregated for use only for an exempt
function only if it is received into and disbursed from a segregated
fund as defined in Sec. 1.527-2(b).
(b) Contributions. The rules of section 271(b)(2) apply in
determining whether the transfer of money or other property constitutes
a contribution. Generally, money or other property, whether solicited
personally, by mail, or through advertising, qualifies as a
contribution. In addition, to the extent a political organization
receives Federal, State, or local funds under the $1 checkoff provision
(sections 9001-9013), or any other provision for financing of campaigns,
such amounts are to be treated as contributions.
(c) Dues, fees, and assessments. Amounts received as membership fees
and assessments from members of a political organization may constitute
exempt function income to the political organization. Membership fees
and assessments received in consideration for services, goods, or other
items of value do not constitute exempt function income. However, filing
fees paid by an individual directly or indirectly to a political party
in order that the individual may run as a candidate in a primary
election of the party (or run in a general election as a candidate of
that party) are to be treated as exempt
[[Page 234]]
function income. For example, some States provide that a certain
percentage of the first year's salary of the office sought must be paid
to the State as a filing (or qualifying) fee and party assessment. The
State then transfers part of this fee to the candidate's party. In such
a case, the entire amount transferred to the party is to be treated as
exempt function income. Furthermore, amounts paid by an individual
directly to the party as a qualification fee are treated similarly.
(d) Fund raising events--(1) In general. Amounts received from fund
raising and entertainment events are eligible for treatment as exempt
function income if the events are political in nature and are not
carried on in the ordinary course of a trade or business. Whether an
event is political in nature depends on all facts and circumstances. One
factor that indicates an event is a political event is the extent to
which the event is related to a political activity aside from the need
of the organization for income or funds. For example, an event that is
intended to rally and encourage support for an individual for public
office would be a political fund raising event. Examples of political
events can include dinners, breakfasts, receptions, picnics, dances, and
athletic exhibitions.
(2) Ordinary course of any trade or business. Whether an activity is
in the ordinary course of a trade or business depends on the facts and
circumstances of each case. Generally, proceeds from casual, sporadic
fund raising or entertainment events are not in the ordinary course of a
trade or business. Factors to be taken into account in determining
whether an activity is a trade or business include the frequency of the
activity, the manner in which the activity is conducted, and the span of
time over which the activity is carried on.
(e) Sale of campaign materials. Amounts received from the sale of
campaign materials are eligible for treatment as exempt function income
if the sale is not carried on in the ordinary course of a trade or
business (as defined in paragraph (d)(2) of this section), and is
related to a political activity of the organization aside from the need
of such organization for income or funds. Proceeds from the sale of
political memorabilia, bumper stickers, campaign buttons, hats, shirts,
political posters, stationery, jewelry, or cookbooks are related to such
a political acitivity where such items can be identified as relating to
distributing political literature or organizing voters to vote for a
candidate for public office.
[T.D. 7744, 45 FR 85732, Dec. 30, 1980]
Sec. 1.527-4 Special rules for computation of political organization
taxable income.
(a) In general. Political organization taxable income is determined
according to the provisions of section 527(b) and the rules set forth in
this section.
(b) Limitation on capital losses. If for any taxable year a
political organization has a net capital loss, the rules of sections
1211(a) and 1212(a) apply.
(c) Allowable deductions--(1) In general. To be deductible in
computing political organization taxable income, expenses, depreciation,
and similar items must not only qualify as deductions allowed by chapter
1 of the Code, but must also be directly connected with the production
of political organization taxable income.
(2) Directly connected with defined. To be directly connected with
the production of political organization taxable income, an item of
deduction must have a proximate and primary relationship to the
production of such income and have been incurred in the production of
such income. Items of deduction attributable solely to items of
political organization taxable income are proximately and primarily
related to such income. Whether an item of deduction is incurred in the
production of political organization taxable income is determined on the
basis of all the facts and circumstances of each case.
(3) Dual use of facilities or personnel. Expenses, depreciation, and
similar items that are attributable to the production of exempt function
income and political organization taxable income shall be allocated
between the two on a reasonable and consistent basis. For example, where
facilities are used both for an exempt function of the organization and
for the production of political organization taxable income, expenses,
[[Page 235]]
depreciation, and similar items attributable to such facilities (for
example, items of overhead) shall be allocated between the two uses of a
reasonable and consistent basis. Similarly, where personnel are employed
both for an exempt function and for the production of political
organization taxable income, expenses and similar items attributable to
such personnel (for example, items of salary) shall be allocated between
the activities on a reasonable and consistent basis. The portion of any
such item so allocated to the production of political organization
taxable income is directly connected with such income and is allowable
as a deduction in computing political organization taxable income to the
extent that it qualifies as an item of deduction allowed by chapter 1 of
the Code. Thus, for example, assume that X, a political organization,
pays its manager a salary of $10,000 a year and that it derives
political organization taxable income. If 10 percent of the manager's
time during the year is devoted to deriving X's gross income (other than
exempt function income), a deduction of $1,000 (10 percent of $10,000)
would generally be allowable for purposes of computing X's political
organization taxable income.
[T.D. 7744, 45 FR 85733, Dec. 30, 1980]
Sec. 1.527-5 Activities resulting in gross income to an individual or
political organization.
(a) In general--(1) General rule. Amounts expended by a political
organization for an exempt function are not income to the individual or
individuals on whose behalf such expenditures are made. However, where a
political organization expends any other amount for the personal use of
any individual, the individual on whose behalf the amount is expended
will be in receipt of income. Amounts are expended for the personal use
of an individual where a direct or indirect financial benefit accrues to
such individual. For example, if a political organization pays a
personal legal obligation of a candidate for public office, such as the
candidate's federal income tax liability, the amount paid is includible
in such candidate's gross income. Similarly, if a political organization
expends anyamount of its exempt function income for other than an exempt
function, and the expenditure results in a direct or indirect financial
benefit to the political organization, it must include the amount of
such expenditure in its gross income. For example, if a political
organization expends exempt function income for making an improvement or
addition to its facilities, or for equipment, which is not necessary for
or used in carrying out an exempt function, the amount of the
expenditure will be included in the political organization's gross
income. However, if a political organization expends exempt function
income to make ordinary and necessary repairs on the facilities the
political organization uses in conducting its exempt function, such
amounts will not be included in the political organization's gross
income.
(2) Expenditure for an illegal activity. Expenditures by a political
organization that are illegal or for an activity that is judicially
determined to be illegal are treated as amounts not segregated for use
only for the exempt function and shall be included in the political
organization's taxable income. However, expenses incurred in defense of
civil or criminal suits against the organization are not treated as
taxable to the organization. Similarly, voluntary reimbursement to the
participants in the illegal activity for similar expenses incurred by
them are not taxable to the organization if the organization can
demonstrate that such payments do not constitute a part of the
inducement to engage in the illegal activity or part of the agreed upon
compensation therefor. However, if the organization entered into an
agreement with the participants to defray such expenses as part of the
inducement, such payments would be treated as an expenditure for an
illegal activity. Except where necessary to prevent the period of
limitation for assessment and collection of a tax from expiring, a
notice of deficiency will not generally be issued until after there has
been a final determination of illegality by an appropriate court in a
criminal proceeding.
[[Page 236]]
(b) Certain uses not treated as income to a candidate. Except as
otherwise provided in paragraph (a) of this section, if a political
organization:
(1) Contributes any amount to or for the use of any political
organization described in section 527(e)(1) or newsletter fund described
in section 527(g),
(2) Contributes any amount to or for the use of any organization
described in paragraph (1) and (2) of section 509(a) which is exempt
from taxation under section 501(a), or
(3) Deposits any amount in the general fund of the U.S. Treasury or
in the general fund of any State or local government,
such amount shall not be treated as an amount expended for the personal
use of a candidate or other person. No deduction shall be allowed under
the Internal Revenue Code of 1954 for the contribution or deposit
described in the preceding sentence.
(c) Excess funds--(1) General rule. Generally, funds controlled by a
political organization or other person after a campaign or election are
excess funds and are treated as expended for the personal use of the
person having control over the ultimate use of such funds. However, such
funds will not be treated as excess funds to the extent they are:
(i) Transferred within a reasonable period of time by the person
controlling the funds in accordance with paragraph (b) of this section,
or
(ii) Held in reasonable anticipation of being used by the political
organization for future exempt functions.
(2) Excess funds transferred at death. Where excess funds are held
by an individual who dies, and these funds go to the individual's estate
or any other person (other than an organization or fund described in
paragraph (b) of this section), the funds are income of the decedent and
will be included in the decedent's gross estate unless the estate or
other person receiving such funds transfers the funds within a
reasonable period of time in accordance with paragraph (b) of this
section.
This paragraph (c)(2) will not apply where the individual who dies
provides that the funds be transferred to an organization or fund
described in paragraph (b) of this section.
[T.D. 7744, 45 FR 85733, Dec. 30, 1980]
Sec. 1.527-6 Inclusion of certain amounts in the gross income of an
exempt organization which is not a political organization.
(a) Exempt organizations--General rule. If an organization described
in section 501(c) which is exempt from tax under section 501(a) expends
any amount for an exempt function, it may be subject to tax. There is
included in the gross income of such organization for the taxable year
an amount equal to the lesser of:
(1) The net investment income of such organization for the taxable
year, or
(2) The aggregate amount expended during the taxable year for an
exempt function.
The amount included will be treated as political organization taxable
income.
(b) Exempt function expenditures--(1) Directly related expenses. (i)
Except as provided in this section, the term exempt function will
generally have the same meaning it has in Sec. 1.527-2(c). Thus,
expenditures which are directly related to the selection process as
defined in Sec. 1.527-2(c)(1) are expenditures for an exempt function.
Expenditures for indirect expenses as defined in Sec. 1.527-2(c)(2),
when made by a section 501(c) organization are for an exempt function
only to the extent provided in paragraph (b)(2) of this section.
Expenditures of a section 501 (c) organization which are otherwise
allowable under the Federal Election Campaign Act or similar State
statute are for an exempt function only to the extent provided in
paragraph (b)(3) of this section.
(ii) An expenditure may be made for an exempt function directly or
through another organization. A section 501(c) organization will not be
absolutely liable under section 527(f)(1) for amounts transferred to an
individual or organization. A section 501(c) organization is, however,
required to take reasonable steps to ensure that the transferee does not
use such amounts for an exempt function.
(2) Indirect expenses. [Reserved]
[[Page 237]]
(3) Expenditures allowed by Federal Election Campaign Act.
[Reserved]
(4) Appointments or confirmations. Where an organization described
in paragraph (a) of this section appears before any legislative body in
response to a written request by such body for the purpose of
influencing the appointment or confirmation of an individual to a public
office, any expenditure directly related to such appearance is not
treated as an expenditure for an exempt function.
(5) Nonpartisan activity. Expenditures for nonpartisan activities by
an organization to which paragraph (a) of this section applies are not
expenditures for an exempt function. Nonpartisan activities include
voter registration and get-out-the-vote campaigns. To be nonpartisan
voter registration and get-out-the-vote campaigns must not be
specifically identified by the organization with any candidate or
political party.
(c) Character of items included in gross income--(1) General rule.
The items of income included in the gross income of an organization
under paragraph (a) of this section retain their character as ordinary
income or capital gain.
(2) Special rule in determining character of item. If the amount
included in gross income is determined under paragraph (a)(2)(ii) of
this section, the character of the items of income is determined by
multiplying the total amount included in gross income under such
paragraph by a fraction, the numerator of which is the portion of the
organization's net investment income that is gain from the sale or
exchange of a capital asset, and the denominator of which is the
organization's net investment income. For example, if $5,000 is included
in the gross income of an organization under paragraph (a)(2) of this
section, and the organization had $100,000 of net investment income of
which $10,000 is long term capital gain, then $500 would be treated as
long term capital gain:
[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TC08OC91.002
(d) Modifications. The modifications described in section 527(c)(2)
apply in computing the tax under paragraph (a)(2) of this section. Thus,
no net operating loss is allowed under section 172 nor is any deduction
allowed under part VIII of subchapter B. However, there is allowed a
specific deduction of $100.
(e) Transfer not treated as exempt function expenditures. Provided
the provisions of this paragraph (e) are met, a transfer of political
contributions or dues collected by a section 501(c) organization to a
separate segregated fund as defined in paragraph (f) of this section is
not treated as an expenditure for an exempt function (within the meaning
of Sec. 1.527-2(c)). Such transfers must be made promptly after the
receipt of such amounts by the section 501(c) organization, and must be
made directly to the separate segregated fund. A transfer is considered
promptly and directly made if:
(1) The procedures followed by the section 501(c) organization
satisfy the requirements of applicable Federal or State campaign law and
regulations;
(2) The section 501(c) organization maintains adequate records to
demonstrate that amounts transferred in fact consist of political
contributions or dues, rather than investment income; and
(3) The political contributions or dues transferred were not used to
earn investment income for the section 501(c) organization.
(f) Separate segregated fund. An organization or fund described in
section 527(f)(3) is a separate segregated fund.
[[Page 238]]
To avoid the application of paragraph (a) of this section, an
organization described in section 501(c) that is exempt from taxation
under section 501(a) may, if it is consistent with its exempt status,
establish and maintain such a separate segregated fund to receive
contributions and make expenditures in a political campaign. If such a
fund meets the requirements of Sec. 1.527-2(a) (relating to the
definition of a political organization), it shall be treated as a
political organization subject to the provisions of section 527. A
segregated fund established under the Federal Election Campaign Act will
continue to be treated as a segregated fund when it engages in exempt
function activities as defined in Sec. 1.527-2(c), relating to State
campaigns.
(g) Effect of expenditures on exempt status. Section 527(f) and this
section do not sanction the intervention in any political campaign by an
organization described in section 501(c) if such activity is
inconsistent with its exempt status under section 501(c). For example,
an organization described in section 501(c)(3) is precluded from
engaging in any political campaign activities. The fact that section 527
imposes a tax on the exempt function (as defined in Sec. 1.527-2(c))
expenditures of section 501(c) organizations and permits such
organizations to establish separate segregated funds to engage in
campaign activities does not sanction the participation in these
activities by section 501(c)(3) organizations.
[T.D. 7744, 45 FR 85734, Dec. 30, 1980]
Sec. 1.527-7 Newsletter funds.
(a) In general. For purposes of this section, a fund established and
maintained by an individual who holds, has been elected to, or is a
candidate (within the meaning of section 41(c)(2)) for nomination or
election to, any Federal, State, or local elective public office for the
use by such individual exclusively for an exempt function, as defined in
paragraph (c) of this section, shall be a newsletter fund. If assets of
a newsletter fund are used for any purpose other than the exempt
function of the newsletter fund as defined in paragraph (c) of this
section, such amount shall be treated as expended for the personal use
of the individual who established and maintained such fund. In addition,
future contributions to such fund are treated as income to the
individual who established and maintained the fund. In such a case, the
facts and circumstances may indicate that the fund was never established
and maintained exclusively for an exempt function as defined in
paragraph (c) of this section.
(b) Determination of taxable income. A newsletter fund shall be
treated as if it were a political organization for purposes of
determining its taxable income. However, the specific $100 deduction
provided by section 527(c)(2)(A) shall not be allowed.
(c) Exempt function. For purposes of this section, the exempt
function of a newsletter fund consists solely of the preparation and
circulation of the newsletter. Among the expenditures treated as
preparation and circulation expenditures of the newsletter are:
(1) Secretarial services,
(2) Printing,
(3) Addressing, and
(4) Mailing.
(d) Nonexempt function purposes. Newsletter fund assets may not be
used for campaign activities. Therefore, an exempt function of a
newsletter fund does not include:
(1) Expenditures for an exempt function as defined in Sec. 1.527-
2(c) or
(2) Transfers of unexpended amounts to a political organization
described in section 527(e)(1).
(e) Excess funds. Excess funds held by a newsletter fund which has
ceased to engage in the preparation and circulation of the newsletter
are treated as expended for the personal use of the individual who
established and maintained such fund. However, to the extent such excess
funds are within a reasonable period of time:
(1) Contributed to or for the use of any organization described in
paragraph (1) or (2) of section 509(a) which is exempt from taxation
under section 501(a),
(2) Deposited in the general fund of the U.S. Treasury or in the
general fund of any State or local government (including the District of
Columbia), or
(3) Contributed to any other newsletter fund as described in
paragraph (a) of this section,
[[Page 239]]
the excess funds are not treated as expended for the personal use of
such individual. In such a case the individual is not allowed a
deduction under the Internal Revenue Code of 1954 for such contribution
or deposit.
[T.D. 7744, 45 FR 85735, Dec. 30, 1980]
Sec. 1.527-8 Effective date; filing requirements; and miscellaneous
provisions.
(a) Assessment and collections. Since the taxes imposed by section
527 are taxes imposed by subtitle A of the Code, all provisions of law
and of the regulations applicable to the taxes imposed by subtitle A are
applicable to the assessment and collection of the taxes imposed by
section 527. Organizations subject to the tax imposed by section 527 are
subject to the same provisions, including penalties, as are provided for
corporations, in general, except that the requirements of section 6154
concerning the payment of estimated tax do not apply. See, generally,
sections 6151, et. seq., and the regulations prescribed thereunder, for
provisions relating to payment of tax.
(b) Returns. For requirements of filing annual returns with respect
to political organization taxable income, see section 6012 (a) (6) and
the applicable regulations.
(c) Taxable years, method of accounting, etc. The taxable year
(fiscal year or calendar year, as the case may be) of a political
organization is determined without regard to the fact that such
organization may have been exempt from tax during any prior period. See
sections 441 and 446, and the regulations thereunder in this part, and
section 7701 and the regulations in Part 301 of this chapter
(Regulations on Procedure and Administration). Similarly, in computing
political organization taxable income, the determination of the taxable
year for which an item of income or expense is taken into account is
made under the provisions of sections 441, 446, 451, 461, and the
regulations thereunder, whether or not the item arose during a taxable
year beginning before, on, or after the effective date of the provisions
imposing a tax upon political organization taxable income. If a method
for treating bad debts was selected in a return of income (other than an
information return) for a previous taxable year, the taxpayer must
follow such method in its returns under section 527, unless such method
is changed inaccordance with the provisions of Sec. 1.166-1. A taxpayer
who has not previously selected a method for treating bad debts may, in
its first return under section 6012 (a) (6), exercise the option granted
in Sec. 1.166-1.
(d) Effective date. Except as provided in paragraph (b)(2) of Sec.
1.527-6 and in paragraph (a) of Sec. 1.527-9, the regulations under
section 527 apply to taxable years beginning after December 31, 1974.
[T.D. 7744, 45 FR 85735, Dec. 30, 1980; as amended by T.D. 8041, 50 FR
30817, July 30, 1985]
Sec. 1.527-9 Special rule for principal campaign committees.
(a) In general. Effective with respect to taxable years beginning
after December 31, 1981, the tax imposed by section 527(b) on the
political organization taxable income of a principal campaign committee
shall be computed by multiplying the political organization taxable
income by the appropriate rates of tax specified in section 11(b). The
political organization taxable income of a campaign committee not a
principal campaign committee is taxed at the highest rate of tax
specified in section 11(b). A candidate for Congress may designate one
political committee to serve as his or her principal campaign committee
for purposes of section 527(h)(1). If a designation is made, it shall be
made in accordance with the requirements of paragraph (b) of this
section. A candidate for Congress may have only one designation in
effect at any time. Under 11 CFR 102.12, no political committee may be
designated as the principal campaign committee of more than one
candidate for Congress. Further, no political committee that supports or
has supported more than one candidate for Congress may be designated as
a principal campaign committee. No designation need be made where there
is only one political campaign committee with respect to a candidate.
(b) Manner of designation. If a candidate for Congress elects to
make a
[[Page 240]]
designation under section 527(h) and this section, he or she shall
designate his or her principal campaign committee by appending a copy of
his or her Statement of Candidacy (that is, the Federal Election
Commission Form 2, or equivalent statement that the candidate filed with
the Federal Election Commission under 11 CFR 101.1(a)), to the Form
1120-POL filed by the principal campaign committee for each taxable year
for which the designation is effective. This designation may also be
made by appending to the Form 1120-POL statement containing the
following information: The name and address of the candidate for
Congress; his or her taxpayer identification number; his or her party
affiliation and the office sought; the district and State in which the
office is sought; and the name and address of the principal campaign
comittee. This designation shall be made on or before the due date (as
extended) for filing Form 1120-POL. Only a candidate for Congress may
make a designation in accordance with this paragraph.
(c) Manner of revoking designation. A designation of a principal
campaign committee that has been filed in accordance with this section
may be revoked only with the consent of the Commissioner. In general,
the Commissioner will grant such consent in every case where the
candidate for Congress has revoked his or her designation in compliance
with the requirements of the Federal Election Commission by filing an
amended Statement of Organization or its equivalent pursuant to 11 CFR
102.2(a)(2). In the case of the revocation of the designation of a
principal campaign committee by a candidate followed by the designation
of another principal campaign committee by such candidate, for purposes
of determining the appropriate rate of tax under section 11(b) for a
taxable year, the political organization taxable income of the first
principal campaign committee shall be treated as that of the subsequent
principal campaign committee. In a case where consent to revoke a
designation of a principal campaign committee is granted and a new
designation is filed, the Commissioner may condition his consent upon
the agreement of the candidate for Congress to insure compliance with
the preceding sentence.
[T.D. 8041, 50 FR 30817, July 30, 1985]
Homeowners Associations
Sec. 1.528-1 Homeowners associations.
(a) In general. Section 528 only applies to taxable years of
homeowners associations beginning after December 31, 1973. To qualify as
a homeowners association an organization must either be a condominium
management association or a residential real estate management
association. For the purposes of Section 528 and the regulations under
that section, the term homeowners association shall refer only to an
organization described in section 528. Cooperative housing corporations
and organizations based on a similar form of ownership are not eligible
to be taxed as homeowners associations. As a general rule, membership in
either a condominium management association or a residential real estate
management association is confined to the developers and the owners of
the units, residences, or lots. Furthermore, membership in either type
of association is normally required as a condition of such ownership.
However, if the membership of an organization consists of other
homeowners associations, the owners of units, residences, or lots who
are members of such other homeowners associations will be treated as the
members of the organization for the purposes of the regulations under
section 528.
(b) Condominium. The term condominium means an interest in real
property consisting of an undivided interest in common in a portion of a
parcel of real property (which may be a fee simple estate or an estate
for years, such as a leasehold or subleasehold) together with a separate
interest in space in a building located on such property. An interest in
property is not a condominium unless the undivided interest in the
common elements are vested in the unit holders. In addition, a
condominium must meet the requirements of applicable state or local law
relating to condominiums or horizontal property regimes.
(c) Residential real estate management association. Residential real
estate
[[Page 241]]
management associations are normally composed of owners of single-family
residential units located in a subdivision, development, or similar
area. However, they may also include as members, owners of multiple-
family dwelling units located in such areas. They are commonly formed to
administer and enforce covenants relating to the architecture and
appearance of the real estate development as well as to perform certain
maintenance duties relating to common areas.
(d) Tenants. Tenants will not be considered members for purposes of
meeting the source of income test under section 528(c)(1)(B) and Sec.
1.528-5. However, the fact that tenants of members of a homeowners
association are permitted to be members of the association will not
disqualify an association under section 528(c)(1) if it otherwise meets
the requirements of section 528(c) and these regulations.
[T.D. 7692, 45 FR 26321, Apr. 18, 1980]
Sec. 1.528-2 Organized and operated to provide for the acquisition,
construction, management, maintenance and care of association property.
(a) Organized and operated--(1) Organized. To be treated as a
homeowners association an organization must be organized and operated
primarily for the purpose of carrying on one or more of the exempt
functions of a homeowners association. For the purposes of section 528
and these regulations, the exempt functions of a homeowners association
are the acquisition, construction, management, maintenance, and care of
association property. In determining whether an organization is
organized and operated primarily to carry on one or more exempt
functions, all the facts and circumstances of each case shall be
considered. For example, when an organization provides in its articles
of organization that its sole purpose is to carry on one or more exempt
functions, in the absence of other relevant factors it will be
considered to have met the organizational test. (The term articles of
organization means the organization's corporate charter, trust
instruments, articles of association or other instrument by which it is
created.)
(2) Operated. An organization will be treated as being operated for
the purpose of carrying on one or more of the exempt functions of a
homeowners association if it meets the provisions of Sec. Sec. 1.528-5
and 1.528-6.
(b) Terms to be interpreted according to common meaning and usage.
As used in section 528 and these regulations, the terms acquisition,
construction, management, maintenance, and care are to be interpreted
according to their common meaning and usage. For example, maintenance of
association property includes the painting and repairing of such
property as well as the gardening and janitorial services associated
with its upkeep. Similarly, the term construction of association
property includes covenants or other rules for preserving the
architectural and general appearance of the area. The term also includes
regulations relating to the location, color and allowable building
materials to be used in all structures. (For the definition of
association property see Sec. 1.528-3.)
[T.D. 7692, 45 FR 26321, Apr. 18, 1980]
Sec. 1.528-3 Association property.
(a) Property owned by the organization. Association property
includes real and personal property owned by the organization or owned
as tenants in common by the members of the organization. Such property
must be available for the common benefit of all members of the
organization and must be of a nature that tends to enhance the
beneficial enjoyment of the private residences by their owners. If two
or more facilities or items of property of a similar nature are owned by
a homeowners association, and if the use of any particular facility or
item is restricted to fewer than all association members, such
facilities or items neverthelesswill be considered association property
if all association members are treated equitably and have similar rights
with respect to comparable items or facilities. Among the types of
property that ordinarily will be considered association property are
swimming pools and tennis courts. On the other hand, facilities or areas
set aside for the use of nonmembers, or in fact used primarily by
nonmembers, are not association property for the
[[Page 242]]
purposes of this section. For example, property owned by an organization
for the purpose of leasing it to groups consisting primarily of
nonmembers to be used as a meeting place or a retreat will not be
considered association property.
(b) Property normally owned by a governmental unit. Association
property also includes areas and facilities traditionally recognized and
accepted as being of direct governmental concern in the exercise of the
powers and duties entrusted to governments to regulate community health,
safety and welfare. Such areas and facilities would normally include
roadways, parklands, sidewalks, streetlights and firehouses. Property
described in this paragraph will be considered association property
regardless of whether it is owned by the organization itself, by its
members as tenants in common or by a governmental unit and used for the
benefit of the residents of such unit including the members of the
organization.
(c) Privately owned property. Association property may also include
property owned privately by members of the organization. However, to be
so included the condition of such property must affect the overall
appearance or structure of the residential units which make up the
organization. Such property may include the exterior walls and roofs of
privately owned residences as well as the lawn and shrubbery on
privately owned land and any other privately owned property the
appearance of which may directly affect the appearance of the entire
organization. However, privately owned property will not be considered
association property unless:
(1) There is a covenant or similar requirement relating to exterior
appearance or maintenance that applies on the same basis to all such
property (or to a reasonable classification of such property);
(2) There is a pro rata mandatory assessment (at least once a year)
on all members of the association for maintaining such property; and
(3) Membership in the organization is a condition of ownership of
such property.
[T.D. 7692, 45 FR 26321, Apr. 18, 1980]
Sec. 1.528-4 Substantiality test.
(a) In general. In order for an organization to be considered a
condominium management association or a residential real estate
management association (and therefore in order for it to be considered a
homeowners association), substantially all of its units, lots or
buildings must be used by individuals for residences. For the purposes
of applying paragraph (b) or (c) of this section, and organization which
has attributes of both a condominium management association and a
residential real estate management association shall be considered that
association which, based on all the facts and circumstances, it more
closely resembles. In addition, those paragraphs shall be applied based
on conditions existing on the last day of the organization's taxable
year.
(b) Condominium management associations. Substantially all of the
units of a condominium management association will be considered as used
by individuals for residences if at least 85% of the total square
footage of all units within the project is used by individuals for
residential purposes. If a completed unit has never been occupied, it
will nonetheless be considered as used for residential purposes if,
based on all the facts and circumstances, it appears to have been
constructed for use as a residence. Similarly, a unit which is not
occupied but which has been in the past will be considered as used for
residential purposes if, based on all the facts and circumstances, it
appears that it was constructed for use as a residence, and the last
individual to occupy it did in fact use it as a residence. Units which
are used for purposes auxiliary to residential use (such as laundry
areas, swimming pools, tennis courts, storage rooms and areas used by
maintenance personnel) shall be considered used for residential
purposes.
(c) Residential real estate management associations. Substantially
all of the lots or buildings of a residential real estate management
association (including unimproved lots) will be considered as used by
individuals as residences if at least 85% of the lots are zoned for
residential purposes. Lots shall be treated as zoned for residential
[[Page 243]]
purposes even if under such zoning lots may be used for parking spaces,
swimming pools, tennis courts, schools, fire stations, libraries,
churches and other similar purposes which are auxiliary to residential
use. However, commercial shopping areas (and their auxiliary parking
areas) are not lots zoned for residential purposes.
(d) Exception. Notwithstanding any other provision of this section,
a unit, or building will not be considerd used for residential purposes,
if for more than one-half the days in the association's taxable year,
such unit, or building is occupied by a person or series of persons,
each of whom so occupies such unit, or building for less than 30 days.
[T.D. 7692, 45 FR 26322, Apr. 18, 1980; T.D. 7692, 45 FR 24879, May 23,
1980]
Sec. 1.528-5 Source of income test.
An organization cannot qualify as a homeowners association under
section 528 for a taxable year unless 60 percent or more of its gross
income for such taxable year is exempt function income as defined in
Sec. 1.528-9. The determiniation of whether an organization meets the
provisions of this section shall be made after the close of the
organization's taxable year.
[T.D. 7692, 45 FR 26322, Apr. 18, 1980]
Sec. 1.528-6 Expenditure test.
(a) In general. An organization cannot qualify as a homeowners
association under section 528 for a taxable year unless 90 percent or
more of its expenditures for such taxable year are qualifying
expenditures as defined in paragraphs (b) and (c) of this section. The
determination of whether an organization meets the provisions of this
section shall be made after the close of the organization's taxable
year. Investments or transfers of funds to be held to meet future costs
shall not be taken into account as expenditures. For example, transfers
to a sinking fund account for the replacement of a roof would not be
considered an expenditure for the purposes of this section even if the
roof is association property. In addition, excess assessments which are
either rebated to members or applied against the members' following
year's assessments will not be considered an expenditure for the
purposes of this section.
(b) Qualifying expenditures. Qualifying expenditures are
expenditures by an organization for the acquisition, construction,
management, maintenance, and care of the organization's association
property. They include both current operating and capital expenditures
on association property. Qualifying expenditures include expenditures on
association property despite the fact that such property may produce
income which is not exempt function income. Thus expenditures on a
swimming pool are qualifying expenditures despite the fact that fees
from guests of members using the pool are not exempt function income.
Where expenditures by an organization are used both for association
property as well as other property, an allocation shall be made between
the two uses on a reasonable basis. Only that portion of the
expenditures which is properly allocable to the acquisition,
construction, management, maintenance or care of association property,
shall constitute qualifying expenditures.
(c) Examples of qualifying expenditures. Qualifying expenditures may
include (but are not limited to) expenditures for:
(1) Salaries of an association manager and secretary;
(2) Paving of streets;
(3) Street signs;
(4) Security personnel;
(5) Legal fees;
(6) Upkeep of tennis courts;
(7) Swimming pools;
(8) Recreation rooms and halls;
(9) Replacement of common buildings, facilities, air conditioning,
etc;
(10) Insurance premiums on association property;
(11) Accountant's fees;
(12) Improvement of private property to the extent it is association
property; and
(13) Real estate and personal property taxes imposed on association
property by a State or local government.
[T.D. 7692, 45 FR 26322, Apr. 18, 1980]
[[Page 244]]
Sec. 1.528-7 Inurement.
An organization is not a homeowners association if any part of its
net earnings inures (other than as a direct result of its engaging in
one or more exempt functions) to the benefit of any private person.
Thus, to the extent that members receive a benefit from the general
maintenance, etc., of association property, this benefit generally would
not constitute inurement. If an organization pays rebates from amounts
other than exempt function income, such rebates will constitute
inurement. In general, in determining whether an organization is in
violation of this section, the principles used in making similar
determinations under Section 501(c) will be applied.
[T.D. 7692, 45 FR 26323, Apr. 18, 1980]
Sec. 1.528-8 Election to be treated as a homeowners association.
(a) General rule. An organization wishing to be treated as a
homeowners association under section 528 and this section for a taxable
year must elect to be so treated. Except as otherwise provided in this
section such election shall be made by the filing of a properly
completed Form 1120-H (or such other form as the Secretary may
prescribe). A separate election must be made for each taxable year.
(b) Taxable years ending after December 30, 1976. For taxable years
ending after December 30, 1976, the election must be made not later than
the time, including extensions, for filing an income tax return for the
year in which the election is to apply.
(c) Taxable years ending before December 31, 1976, for which a
return was filed before January 31, 1977. For taxable years ending
before December 31, 1976, for which a return was filed before January
31, 1977, the election must be made not later than the time provided by
law for filing a claim for credit or refund of overpayment of taxes for
the year in which the election is to apply. Such an election shall be
made by filing an amended return on Form 1120-H (or such other form as
the Secretary may prescribe).
(d) Taxable years ending before December 31, 1976, for which a
return was not filed before January 31, 1977. For taxable years ending
before December 31, 1976, for which a return was not filed before
January 31, 1977, the election must be made by October 20, 1980. Instead
of making such an election in the manner described in paragraph (a) of
this section, such an election may be made by a statement attached to
the applicable income tax return or amended return for the year in which
the election is made. The statement should identify the election being
made, the period for which it applies and the taxpayer's basis for
making the election.
(e) Revocation of exempt status. If an organization is notified
after the close of a taxable year that its exemption for such taxable
year under section 501(a) is being revoked retroactively, it may make a
timely election under section 528 for such taxable year. Notwithstanding
any other provisions of this section, such an election will be
considered timely if it is made within 6 months after the date of
revocation. The preceding sentence shall apply to revocations made after
April 18, 1980. If the revocation was made on or before April 18, 1980,
the election will be considered timely if it is made before the
expiration of the period for filing a claim for credit or refund for the
taxable year for which it is to apply.
(f) Effect of election--(1) Revocation. An election to be treated as
an organization described in section 528 is binding on the organization
for the taxable year and may not be revoked without the consent of the
Commissioner.
(2) Exception. Notwithstanding paragraph (f)(1) of this section, an
election under this section may be revoked prior to July 18, 1980. Such
a revocation shall be made by filing a statement with the director of
the Internal Revenue Service Center with whom the return of the
organization for the year in which the revocation is to apply was filed.
The statement shall include the following information:
(i) The name of the organization.
(ii) The fact that it is revoking an election made under section
528.
(iii) The taxable year for which the revocation is to apply.
[T.D. 7692, 45 FR 26323, Apr. 18, 1980]
[[Page 245]]
Sec. 1.528-9 Exempt function income.
(a) General rule. For the purposes of section 528 exempt function
income consists solely of income which is attributable to membership
dues, fees, or assessments of owners of residential units or residential
lots. It is not necessary that the source of income be labeled as
membership dues, fees, or assessments. What is important is that such
income be derived from owners of residential units or residential lots
in their capacity as owner-members rather than in some other capacity
such as customers for services. Generally, for the membership dues,
fees, or assessments with respect to a residential unit or lot to be
exempt function income, the unit must be used for (or the unit or lot
must be expected to be used) for residential purposes. However, dues,
fees, or assessments paid to an organization by a developerwith respect
to unfinished or finished but unsold units or lots shall be exempt
function income even though the developer does not use the units or
lots. If an assessment is more in the nature of a fee for the provision
of services in the course of a trade or business than a fee for a common
activity undertaken by a collective group of owners for the purpose of
enhancing or maintaining the value of their residences, the assessment
will not be considered exempt function income to the organization.
Furthermore, income attributable to dues, fees, or assessments will not
be considered exempt function income unless each member's liability for
payment arises solely from membership in the association. Dues, fees, or
assessments that are based on the extent, if any, to which a member
avails him or herself of a facility or facilities are not exempt
function income. For the purposes of section 528, dues, fees, or
assessments which are based on the assessed value or size of property
will be considered as arising solely as a result of membership in the
organization. Regardless of the organization's method of accounting,
excess assessments during a taxable year which are either rebated to the
members or applied to their future assessments are not considered gross
income and therefore will not be considered exempt function income for
such taxable year. However, if such excess assessments are applied to a
future year's assessments, they will be considered gross income and
exempt function income for that future year. In addition, assessments in
a taxable year, such as an assessment for a capital improvement, which
are not treated as gross income do not enter into the determination of
whether the organization meets the source of income test for that
taxable year.
(b) Examples of exempt function income. Assessments which are
considered more in the nature of a fee for common activity than for the
providing of services and which will therefore generally be considered
exempt function income include assessments made for the purpose of:
(1) Paying the principal and interest on debts incurred for the
acquisition of association property;
(2) Paying real estate taxes on association property;
(3) Maintaining association property;
(4) Removing snow from public areas; and
(5) Removing trash.
(c) Examples of receipts which are not exempt function income.
Exempt function income does not include:
(1) Amounts which are not includible in the organization's gross
income other than by reason of section 528 (for example, tax-exempt
interest);
(2) Amounts received from persons who are not members of the
association;
(3) Amounts received from members for special use of the
organization's facilities, the use of which is not available to all
members as a result of having paid the dues, fees or assessments
required to be paid by all members;
(4) Interest earned on amounts set aside in a sinking fund;
(5) Amounts received for work done on privately owned property which
is not association property; or
(6) Amounts received from members in return for their transportation
to or from shopping areas, work location, etc.
(d) Special rule. Notwithstanding paragraphs (a) and (c)(3) of this
section, amounts received from members or tenants of residential units
owned by members (notwithstanding Sec. 1.528-1(d))
[[Page 246]]
for special use of an association's facilities will be considered exempt
function income if:
(1) The amounts paid by the members are not paid more than once in
any 12 month period; and
(2) The privilege obtained from the payment of such amounts lasts
for the entire 12 month period or portion thereof in which the facility
is commonly in use.
Thus, amounts received as the result of payments by members of a yearly
fee for use of tennis courts or a swimming pool shall be considered
exempt function income. However, amounts received for the use of a
building for an evening, weekend, week, etc., shall not be considered
exempt function income.
[T.D. 7692, 45 FR 26323, Apr. 18, 1980]
Sec. 1.528-10 Special rules for computation of homeowners association
taxable income and tax.
(a) In general. Homeowners association taxable income shall be
determined according to the provisions of section 528(d) and the rules
set forth in this section.
(b) Limitation on capital losses. If for any taxable year a
homeowners association has a net capital loss, the rules of sections
1211(a) and 1212(a) shall apply.
(c) Allowable deductions--(1) In general. To be deductible in
computing the unrelated business taxable income of a homeowners
association, expenses, depreciation and similar items must not only
qualify as items of deduction allowed by chapter 1 of the Code but must
also be directly connected with the production of gross income
(excluding exempt function income). To be directly connected with the
production of gross income (excluding exempt function income), an item
of deduction must have both proximate and primary relationship to the
production of such income and have been incurred in the production of
such income. Items of deduction attributable solely to items of gross
income (excluding exempt function income) are proximately and primarily
related to such income. Whether an item of deduction is incurred in the
production of gross income (excluding exempt function income) is
determined on the basis of all the facts and circumstances involved in
each case.
(2) Dual use of facilities or personnel. Where facilities are used
both for exempt functions of the organization and for the production of
gross income (excluding exempt function income), expenses, depreciation
and similar items attributable to such facilities (for example, items of
overhead) shall be allocated between the two uses on a reasonable basis.
Similarly where personnel are employed both for exempt functions and for
the production of gross income (excluding exempt function income),
expenses and similar items attributable to such personnel (for example,
items of salary) shall be allocated between the two activities on a
reasonable basis. The portion of any such item so allocated to the
production of gross income (excluding exempt function income) is
directly connected with such income and shall be allowable as a
deduction in computing homeowners association taxable income to the
extent that it qualifies as an item of deduction allowed by chapter 1 of
the Code. Thus, for example, assume that X, a homeowners association,
pays its manager a salary of $10,000 a year and that it derives gross
income other than exempt function income. If 10 percent of the manager's
time during the year is devoted to deriving X's gross income (other than
exempt function income), a deduction of $1,000 (10 percent of $10,000)
would generally be allowable for purposes of computing X's homeowners
association taxable income.
(d) Investment credit. A homeowners association is not entitled to
an investment credit.
(e) Cross reference. For the definition of exempt function income,
see Sec. 1.528-9.
[T.D. 7692, 45 FR 26324, Apr. 18, 1980]
[[Page 247]]
Corporations Used To Avoid Income Tax on Shareholders
Corporations Improperly Accumulating Surplus--Table of Contents
Sec. 1.531-1 Imposition of tax.
Section 531 imposes (in addition to the other taxes imposed upon
corporations by chapter 1 of the Code) a graduated tax on the
accumulated taxable income of every corporation described in section 532
and Sec. 1.532-1. In the case of an affiliated group which makes or is
required to make a consolidated return see Sec. 1.1502-43. All of the
taxes on corporations under chapter 1 of the Code are treated as one tax
for purposes of assessment, collection, payment, period of limitations,
etc. See section 535 and Sec. Sec. 1.535-1, 1.535-2, and 1.535-3 for
the definition and determination of accumulated taxable income.
(Secs. 1502 and 7805 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1954 (68A Stat.
637, 917; 26 U.S.C. 1502, 7805))
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 7244, 37 FR
28897, Dec. 30, 1972; T.D. 7937, 49 FR 3462, Jan. 27, 1984]
Sec. 1.532-1 Corporations subject to accumulated earnings tax.
(a) General rule. (1) The tax imposed by section 531 applies to any
domestic or foreign corporation (not specifically excepted under section
532(b) and paragraph (b) of this section) formed or availed of to avoid
or prevent the imposition of the individual income tax on its
shareholders, or on the shareholders of any other corporation, by
permitting earnings and profits to accumulate instead of dividing or
distributing them. See section 533 and Sec. 1.533-1, relating to
evidence of purpose to avoid income tax with respect to shareholders.
(2) The tax imposed by section 531 may apply if the avoidance is
accomplished through the formation or use of one corporation or a chain
of corporations. For example, if the capital stock of the M Corporation
is held by the N Corporation, the earnings and profits of the M
Corporation would not be returned as income subject to the individual
income tax until such earnings and profits of the M Corporation were
distributed to the N Corporation and distributed in turn by the N
Corporation to its shareholders. If either the M Corporation or the N
Corporation was formed or is availed of for the purpose of avoiding or
preventing the imposition of the individual income tax upon the
shareholders of the N Corporation, the accumulated taxable income of the
corporation so formed or availed of (M or N, as the case may be) is
subject to the tax imposed by section 531.
(b) Exceptions. The accumulated earnings tax imposed by section 531
does not apply to a personal holding company (as defined in section
542), to a foreign personal holding company (as defined in section 552),
or to a corporation exempt from tax under subchapter F, chapter 1 of the
Code.
(c) Foreign corporations. Section 531 is applicable to any foreign
corporation, whether resident or nonresident, with respect to any income
derived from sources, within the United States, if any of its
shareholders are subject to income tax on the distributions of the
corporation by reason of being (1) citizens or residents of the United
States, or (2) nonresident alien individuals to whom section 871 is
applicable, or (3) foreign corporations if a beneficial interest therein
is owned directly or indirectly by any shareholder specified in
subparagraph (1) or (2) of this paragraph.
Sec. 1.533-1 Evidence of purpose to avoid income tax.
(a) In general. (1) The Commissioner's determination that a
corporation was formed or availed of for the purpose of avoiding income
tax with respect to shareholders is subject to disproof by competent
evidence. Section 533(a) provides that the fact that earnings and
profits of a corporation are permitted to accumulate beyond the
reasonable needs of the business shall be determinative of the purpose
to avoid the income tax with respect to shareholders unless the
corporation, by the preponderance of the evidence, shall prove to the
contrary. The burden of proving that earnings and profits have been
permitted to accumulate beyond the reasonable needs of the business may
be shifted to the Commissioner
[[Page 248]]
under section 534. See Sec. Sec. 1.534-1 through 1.534-4. Section
533(b) provides that the fact that the taxpayer is a mere holding or
investment company shall be prima facie evidence of the purpose to avoid
income tax with respect to shareholders.
(2) The existence or nonexistence of the purpose to avoid income tax
with respect to shareholders may be indicated by circumstances other
than the conditions specified in section 533. Whether or not such
purpose was present depends upon the particular circumstances of each
case. All circumstances which might be construed as evidence of the
purpose to avoid income tax with respect to shareholders cannot be
outlined, but among other things, the following will be considered:
(i) Dealings between the corporation and its shareholders, such as
withdrawals by the shareholders as personal loans or the expenditure of
funds by the corporation for the personal benefit of the shareholders,
(ii) The investment by the corporation of undistributed earnings in
assets having no reasonable connection with the business of the
corporation (see Sec. 1.537-3), and
(iii) The extent to which the corporation has distributed its
earnings and profits.
The fact that a corporation is a mere holding or investment company or
has an accumulation of earnings and profits in excess of the reasonable
needs of the business is not absolutely conclusive against it if the
taxpayer satisfies the Commissioner that the corporation was neither
formed nor availed of for the purpose of avoiding income tax with
respect to shareholders.
(b) General burden of proof and statutory presumptions. The
Commissioner may determine that the taxpayer was formed or availed of to
avoid income tax with respect to shareholders through the medium of
permitting earnings and profits to accumulate. In the case of litigation
involving any such determination (except where the burden of proof is on
the Commissioner under section 534), the burden of proving such
determination wrong by a preponderance of the evidence, together with
the corresponding burden of first going forward with the evidence, is on
the taxpayer under principles applicable to income tax cases generally.
For the burden of proof in a proceeding before the Tax Court with
respect to the allegation that earnings and profits have been permitted
to accumulate beyond the reasonable needs of the business, see section
534 and Sec. Sec. 1.534-2 through 1.534-4. For a definition of a
holding or investment company, see paragraph (c) of this section. For
determination of the reasonable needs of the business, see section 537
and Sec. Sec. 1.537-1 through 1.537-3. If the taxpayer is a mere
holding or investment company, and the Commissioner therefore determines
that the corporation was formed or availed of for the purpose of
avoiding income tax with respect to shareholders, then section 533(b)
gives further weight to the presumption ofcorrectness already arising
from the Commissioner's determination by expressly providing an
additional presumption of the existence of a purpose to avoid income tax
with respect to shareholders. Further, if it is established (after
complying with section 534 where applicable) that earnings and profits
were permitted to accumulate beyond the reasonable needs of the business
and the Commissioner has therefore determined that the corporation was
formed or availed of for the purpose of avoiding income tax with respect
to shareholders, then section 533(a) adds still more weight to the
Commissioner's determination. Under such circumstances, the existence of
such an accumulation is made determinative of the purpose to avoid
income tax with respect to shareholders unless the taxpayer proves to
the contrary by the preponderance of the evidence.
(c) Holding or investment company. A corporation having practically
no activities except holding property and collecting the income
therefrom or investing therein shall be considered a holding company
within the meaning of section 533(b). If the activities further include,
or consist substantially of, buying and selling stocks, securities, real
estate, or other investment property (whether upon an outright or
marginal basis) so that the income is derived not only from the
investment
[[Page 249]]
yield but also from profits upon market fluctuations, the corporation
shall be considered an investment company within the meaning of section
533(b).
(d) Small business investment companies. A corporation which is
licensed to operate as a small business investment company under the
Small Business Investment Act of 1958 (15 U.S.C. ch. 14B) and the
regulations thereunder (13 CFR part 107) will generally be considered to
be a mere holding or investment company within the meaning of section
533(b). However, the presumption of the existence of the purpose to
avoid income tax with respect to shareholders which results from the
fact that such a company is a mere holding or investment company will be
considered overcome so long as such company:
(1) Complies with all the provisions of the Small Business
Investment Act of 1958 and the regulations thereunder; and
(2) Actively engages in the business of providing funds to small
business concerns through investment in the equity capital of, or
through the disbursement of long-term loans to, such concerns in such
manner and under such terms as the company may fix in accordance with
regulations promulgated by the Small Business Administration (see secs.
304 and 305 of the Small Business Investment Act of 1958, as amended (15
U.S.C. 684, 685)).
On the other hand, if such a company violates or fails to comply with
any of the provisions of the Small Business Investment Act of 1958, as
amended, or the regulations thereunder, or ceases to be actively engaged
in the business of providing funds to small business concerns in the
manner provided in subparagraph (2) of this paragraph, it will not be
considered to have overcome the presumption by reason of any rules
provided in this paragraph.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6652, 28 FR
4786, May 14, 1963]
Sec. 1.533-2 Statement required.
The corporation may be required to furnish a statement of its
accumulated earnings and profits, the payment of dividends, the name and
address of, and number of shares held by, each of its shareholders, the
amounts that would be payable to each of the shareholders if the income
of the corporation were distributed and other information required under
section 6042.
Sec. 1.534-1 Burden of proof as to unreasonable accumulations
generally.
For purposes of applying the presumption provided for in section
533(a) and in determining the extent of the accumulated earnings credit
under section 535(c)(1), the burden of proof with respect to an
allegation by the Commissioner that all or any part of the earnings and
profits of the corporation have been permitted to accumulate beyond the
reasonable needs of the business may vary under section 534 as between
litigation in the Tax Court and that in any other court. In case of a
proceeding in a court other than the Tax Court, see paragraph (b) of
Sec. 1.533-1.
Sec. 1.534-2 Burden of proof as to unreasonable accumulations in cases
before the Tax Court.
(a) Burden of proof on Commissioner. Under the general rule provided
in section 534(a), in any proceeding before the Tax Court involving a
notice of deficiency based in whole or in part on the allegation that
all or any part of the earnings and profits have been permitted to
accumulate beyond the reasonable needs of the business, the burden of
proof with respect to such allegation is upon the Commissioner if:
(1) A notification, as provided for in section 534(b) and paragraph
(c) of this section, has not been sent to the taxpayer; or
(2) A notification, as provided for in section 534(b) and paragraph
(c) of this section, has been sent to the taxpayer and, in response to
such notification, the taxpayer has submitted a statement, as provided
in section 534(c) and paragraph (d) of this section, setting forth the
ground or grounds (together with facts sufficient to show the basis
thereof) on which it relies to establish that all or any part of its
earnings and profits have not been permitted to accumulate beyond the
reasonable needs of the business. However, the burden of proof in the
latter case is upon the Commissioner only with respect to the relevant
ground or grounds set forth in
[[Page 250]]
the statement submitted by the taxpayer, and only if such ground or
grounds are supported by facts (contained in the statement) sufficient
to show the basis thereof.
(b) Burden of proof on the taxpayer. The burden of proof in a Tax
Court proceeding with respect to an allegation that all or any part of
the earnings and profits have been permitted to accumulate beyond the
reasonable needs of the business is upon the taxpayer if:
(1) A notification, as provided for in section 534(b) and paragraph
(c) of this section, has been sent to the taxpayer and the taxpayer has
not submitted a statement, in response to such notification, as provided
in section 534(c) and paragraph (d) of this section; or
(2) A statement has been submitted by the taxpayer in response to
such notification, but the ground or grounds on which the taxpayer
relies are not relevant to the allegation or, if relevant, the statement
does not contain facts sufficient to show the basis thereof.
(c) Notification to the taxpayer. Under section 534(b) a
notification informing the taxpayer that the proposed notice of
deficiency includes an amount with respect to the accumulated earnings
tax imposed by section 531 may be sent by registered mail (or by
certified or registered mail, if the notification is mailed after
September 2, 1958) to the taxpayer at any time before the mailing of the
notice of deficiency in the case of a taxable year beginning after
December 31, 1953, and ending after August 16, 1954. See Sec. 1.534-4
for rules relating to taxable years subject to the Internal Revenue Code
of 1939. See section 534(d) and Sec. 1.534-3 with respect to a
notification in the case of a jeopardy assessment.
(d) Statement by taxpayer. (1) A taxpayer who has received a
notification, as provided in section 534(b) and paragraph (c) of this
section, that the proposed notice of deficiency includes an amount with
respect to the accumulated earnings tax imposed by section 531, may,
under section 534(c), submit a statement that all or any part of the
earnings and profits of the corporation have not been permitted to
accumulate beyond the reasonable needs of the business. Such statement
shall set forth the ground or grounds (together with facts sufficient to
show the basis thereof) on which the taxpayer relies to establish that
there has been no accumulation of earnings and profits beyond the
reasonable needs of the business. See paragraphs (a) and (b) of this
section for rules concerning the effect of the statement with respect to
burden of proof. See Sec. Sec. 1.537-1 to 1.537-3, inclusive, relating
to reasonable needs of the business.
(2) The taxpayer's statement, under section 534(c) and this
paragraph, must be submitted to the Internal Revenue office which issued
the notification (referred to in section 534(b) and paragraph (c) of
this section) within 60 days after the mailing of such notification. If
the taxpayer is unable, for good cause, to submit the statement within
such 60-day period, an additional period not exceeding 30 days may be
granted upon receipt in the Internal Revenue office concerned (before
the expiration of the 60-day period provided herein) of a request from
the taxpayer, setting forth the reasons for such request. See section
534(d) and Sec. 1.534-3 with respect to a statement in the case of a
jeopardy assessment.
Sec. 1.534-3 Jeopardy assessments in Tax Court cases.
In the case of a jeopardy assessment, a notice of deficiency is
required to be sent to the taxpayer by registered mail (or by certified
or registered mail, if the notice is mailed after September 2, 1958)
within 60 days after the making of the assessment. See section 6861. If
a jeopardy assessment is made before the mailing of the deficiency
notice, then in the case of a proceeding in the Tax Court, if the
deficiency notice informs the taxpayer that an amount of accumulated
earnings tax is included in the deficiency, such notice shall constitute
the notification provided for in section 534(b) and paragraph (c) of
Sec. 1.534-2. Under such circumstances the statement described in
section 534(c) and paragraph (d) of Sec. 1.534-2 shall instead be
included in the taxpayer's petition to the Tax Court, if the taxpayer
desires to submit such statement. See paragraph (b) of Sec. 1.534-2,
relating to burden of proof on the taxpayer.
[[Page 251]]
Sec. 1.535-1 Definition.
(a) The accumulated earnings tax is imposed by section 531 on the
accumulated taxable income. Accumulated taxable income is the taxable
income of the corporation with the adjustments prescribed by section
535(b) and Sec. 1.535-2, minus the sum of the dividends paid deduction
and the accumulated earnings credit. See section 561 and the regulations
thereunder, relating to the definition of the deduction for dividends
paid, and section 535(c) and Sec. 1.535-3, relating to the accumulated
earnings credit.
(b) In the case of a foreign corporation, whether resident or
nonresident, which files or causes to be filed a return, the accumulated
taxable income shall be the taxable income from sources within the
United States with the adjustments prescribed by section 535(b) and
Sec. 1.535-2 minus the sum of the dividends paid deduction and the
accumulated earnings credit. In the case of a foreign corporation which
files no return, the accumulated taxable income shall be the gross
income from sources within the United States without allowance of any
deductions (including the accumulated earnings credit).
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 7244, 37 FR
28897, Dec. 30, 1972]
Sec. 1.535-2 Adjustments to taxable income.
(a) Taxes--(1) United States taxes. In computing accumulated taxable
income for any taxable year, there shall be allowed as a deduction the
amount by which Federal income and excess profits taxes accrued during
the taxable year exceed the credit provided by section 33 (relating to
taxes of foreign countries and possessions of the United States), except
that no deduction shall be allowed for (i) the accumulated earnings tax
imposed by section 531 (or a corresponding section of a prior law), (ii)
the personal holding company tax imposed by section 541 (or a
corresponding section of a prior law), and (iii) the excess profits tax
imposed by subchapter E, chapter 2 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1939,
for taxable years beginning after December 31, 1940. The deduction is
for taxes accrued during the taxable year, regardless of whether the
corporation uses an accrual method of accounting, the cash receipts and
disbursements method, or any other allowable method of accounting. In
computing the amount of taxes accrued, an unpaid tax which is being
contested is not considered accrued until the contest is resolved.
(2) Taxes of foreign countries and United States possessions. In
determining accumulated taxable income for any taxable year, if the
taxpayer chooses the benefits of section 901 for such taxable year, a
deduction shall be allowed for:
(i) The income, war profits, and excess profits taxes imposed by
foreign countries or possessions of the United States and accrued during
such taxable year, and
(ii) In the case of a domestic corporation, the foreign income taxes
deemed to be paid for such taxable year under section 902(a) in
accordance with Sec. Sec. 1.902-1 and 1.902-2 or section 960(a)(1) in
accordance with Sec. 1.960-7.
In no event shall the amount under subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph
exceed the amount includible in gross income with respect to such taxes
under section 78 and Sec. 1.78-1. The credit for such taxes provided by
section 901 shall not be allowed against the accumulated earnings tax
imposed by section 531. See section 901(a).
(b) Charitable contributions. Section 535(b)(2) provides that, in
computing the accumulated taxable income of a corporation, the deduction
for charitable contributions shall be computed without regard to section
170(b)(2). Thus, the amount of charitable contributions made during the
taxable year not allowable as a deduction under section 170 by reason of
the limitations imposed by section 170(b)(2) shall be allowed as a
deduction in computing accumulated taxable income for the taxable year.
However, any excess of the amount of the charitable contributions made
in a prior taxable year over the amount allowed as a deduction under
section 170 for such year shall not be allowed as a deduction from
taxable income in computing accumulated taxable income for the taxable
year.
[[Page 252]]
(c) Special deductions disallowed. Sections 241 through 248 provide
for the allowance of special deductions for such items as partially tax-
exempt interest, certain dividends received, dividends paid on certain
preferred stock of public utilities, and organizational expenses. Such
special deductions, except the deduction provided by section 248
(relating to organizational expenses) shall be disallowed in computing
accumulated taxable income.
(d) Net operating loss. The net operating loss deduction provided in
section 172 is not allowed for purposes of computing accumulated taxable
income.
(e) Capital losses. (1) Losses from sales or exchanges of capital
assets during the taxable year, which are disallowed as deductions under
section 1211(a) in computing taxable income, shall be allowed as
deductions in computing accumulated taxable income.
(2) The computation of the capital losses allowable as a deduction
in computing accumulated taxable income may be illustrated by the
following example:
Example. X Corporation has capital losses of $30,000 which are
disallowed under section 1211(a) for the taxable year ended December 31,
1956. This amount represents a loss of $25,000 from the sale or exchange
of capital assets during the taxable year ended December 31, 1956, plus
a $5,000 capital loss carryover resulting from the sale or exchange of
capital assets during the taxable year ended December 31, 1955. In
computing accumulated taxable income for the taxable year ended December
31, 1956, only the loss of $25,000 arising from the sale or exchange of
capital assets during that taxable year will be allowed as a deduction.
(f) Long-term capital gains. (1) There is allowed as a deduction in
computing accumulated taxable income, the excess of the net long-term
capital gain for the taxable year over the net short-term capital loss
for such year (determined without regard to the capital loss carryover
provided in section 1212) minus the taxes attributable to such excess as
provided by section 535(b)(6). The tax attributable to such excess is
the difference between:
(i) The taxes (except the accumulated earnings tax) imposed by
subtitle A of the Code for such year, and
(ii) The taxes (except the accumulated earnings tax) imposed by
subtitle A computed for such year as if taxable income were reduced by
the excess of the net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital
loss (including the capital loss carryover to such year)
Where the tax (except the accumulated earnings tax) imposed by subtitle
A includes an amount computed under section 1201(a)(2), the tax
attributable to such excess is such amount computed under section
1201(a)(2).
(2) The application of the rule in subparagraph (1) of this
paragraph may be illustrated by the following example:
Example. Assume that D Corporation, for the taxable year ended
December 31, 1956, has taxable income of $103,000 of which $8,000 is the
excess of net long-term capital gain of $12,000 over a net short-term
capital loss of $9,000. The $9,000 net short-term capital loss includes
a capital loss carryover of $5,000. The amount allowable as a deduction
under section 535(b)(6) and subparagraph (1) of this paragraph is
$7,250, computed as follows: Net long-term capital gain less net short-
term capital loss (computed without regard to the capital loss
carryover) is $8,000 (that is, $12,000 net long-term capital gain less
$4,000 net short-term capital loss computed without regard to the
capital loss carryover of $5,000). The tax attributable to the excess of
net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss (computed by
taking the capital loss carryover into account) is $750, that is, 25
percent of such excess of $3,000, computed under section 1201(a)(2). The
difference of $7,250 ($8,000 less $750) is the amount allowable as a
deduction in computing accumulated taxable income.
(3) Section 631(c) (relating to gain or loss in the case of disposal
of coal or domestic iron ore) shall have no application in determining
the amount of the deduction allowable under section 535(b)(6).
(g) Capital loss carrybacks and carryovers. Capital losses carried
to a taxable year under section 1212(a) shall have no application for
purposes of computing accumulated taxable income for such year.
(h) Bank affiliates. There is allowed the deduction provided by
section 601
[[Page 253]]
in the case of bank affiliates (as defined in section 2 of the Banking
Act of 1933; 12 U. S. C. 221a(c)).
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6805, 30 FR
3209, Mar. 9, 1965; T.D. 6841, 30 FR 9305, July 27, 1965; T.D. 7301, 39
FR 964, Jan. 4, 1974; T.D. 7649, 44 FR 60086, Oct. 18, 1979]
Sec. 1.535-3 Accumulated earnings credit.
(a) In general. As provided in section 535(a) and Sec. 1.535-1, the
accumulated earnings credit, provided by section 535(c), reduces taxable
income in computing accumulated taxable income. In the case of a
corporation, not a mere holding or investment company, the accumulated
earnings credit is determined as provided in paragraph (b) of this
section and, in the case of a holding or investment company, as provided
in paragraph (c) of this section.
(b) Corporation which is not a mere holding or investment company--
(1) General rule. (i) In the case of a corporation, not a mere holding
or investment company, the accumulated earnings credit is the amount
equal to such part of the earnings and profits of the taxable year which
is retained for the reasonable needs of the business, minus the
deduction allowed by section 535(b)(6) (see paragraph (f) of Sec.
1.535-2, relating to the deduction for long-term capital gains). In no
event shall the accumulated earnings credit be less than the minimum
credit provided for in section 535(c)(2) and subparagraph (2) of this
paragraph. The amount of the earnings and profits for the taxable year
retained is the amount by which the earnings and profits for the taxable
year exceed the dividends paid deduction for such taxable year. See
section 561 and Sec. Sec. 1.561-1 and 1.561-2, relating to the
deduction for dividends paid.
(ii) In determining whether any amount of the earnings and profits
of the taxable year has been retained for the reasonable needs of the
business, the accumulated earnings and profits of prior years will be
taken into consideration. Thus, for example, if such accumulated
earnings and profits of prior years are sufficient for the reasonable
needs of the business, then any earnings and profits of the current
taxable year which are retained will not be considered to be retained
for the reasonable needs of the business. See section 537 and Sec. Sec.
1.537-1 and 1.537-2.
(2) Minimum credit. Section 535(c)(2) provides for the allowance of
a minimum accumulated earnings credit in the case of a corporation which
is not a mere holding or investment company. Except as otherwise
provided in section 243(b)(3) and Sec. 1.243-5 (relating to effect of
100-percent dividends received deduction under section 243(b)) and
sections 1561, 1562, and 1564 (relating to limitations on certain tax
benefits in the case of certain controlled corporations), in the case of
such a corporation, this minimum credit shall in no case be less than
the amount by which $150,000 ($100,000 in the case of taxable years
beginning before January 1, 1975) exceeds the accumulated earnings and
profits of the corporation at the close of the preceding taxable year.
See paragraph (d) of this section for the effect of dividends paid after
the close of the taxable year in determining accumulated earnings and
profits at the close of the preceding taxable year. In determining the
amount of the minimum credit allowable under section 535(c)(2), the
needs of the business are not taken into consideration. If the taxpayer
has accumulated earnings and profits at the close of the preceding
taxable year equal to or in excess of $150,000 ($100,000 in the case of
taxable years beginning before January 1, 1975), thecredit, if any, is
determined without regard to section 535(c)(2). It is not intended that
the provision for the minimum credit shall in any way create an
inference that an accumulation in excess of $150,000 ($100,000 in the
case of taxable years beginning before January 1, 1975) is unreasonable.
The reasonable needs of the business may require the accumulation of
more or less than $150,000 ($100,000 in the case of taxable years
beginning before January 1, 1975), depending upon the circumstances in
the case, but such needs shall not be taken into consideration to any
extent in cases where the minimum accumulated earnings credit is
applicable. For a discussion of the reasonable needs of the business,
see section 537 and Sec. Sec. 1.537-1, 1.537-2, and 1.537-3.
(3) Illustrations of accumulated earnings credit. The computation of
the accumulated earnings credit provided by
[[Page 254]]
section 535(c) may be illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. The X Corporation, which is not a mere holding or
investment company, has accumulated earnings and profits in the amount
of $125,000 as of December 31, 1974. Thus, the minimum credit provided
by section 535(c)(2) exceeds the accumulated earnings and profits of X
by $25,000. It has earnings and profits for the taxable year ended
December 31, 1975, in the amount of $100,000 and has a dividends paid
deduction under section 561 in the amount of $30,000 so that the
earnings and profits for the taxable year which are retained in the
business amount to $70,000. Assume that it has been determined that the
earnings and profits for the taxable year which may be retained for the
reasonable needs of the business amount to $55,000 and that a deduction
has been allowed under section 535(b)(6) in the amount of $5,000. Since
the amount by which $150,000 exceeds the accumulated earnings and
profits at the close of the preceding taxable year is less than $50,000
($55,000-$5,000), the minimum credit provided by section 535(c)(2) will
not apply and the accumulated earnings credit must be computed under
section 535(c)(1) on the basis of the reasonable needs of the business.
In this case, the accumulated earnings credit for the taxable year ended
December 31, 1975, will be $50,000 computed as follows:
Earnings and profits of the taxable year determined to be $55,000
retained for the reasonable needs of the business............
Less: The deduction for long-term capital gains (less 5,000
applicable tax) allowed under sec. 535(b)(6).................
---------
Accumulated earnings credit allowable under sec. 535(c)(1) 50,000
Example 2. The Z Corporation which is not a mere holding or
investment company, has accumulated earnings and profits in the amount
of $45,000 as of December 31, 1974; it has earnings and profits for the
taxable year ended December 31, 1975, in the amount of $115,000 and has
a dividends paid deduction under section 561 in the amount of $10,000,
so that the earnings and profits for the taxable year which are retained
amount to $105,000. Assume that it has been determined that the
accumulated earnings and profits of the taxable year which may be
retained for the reasonable needs of the business amount to $20,000 and
that no deduction is allowable for long-term capital gains under section
535(b)(6). The accumulated earnings credit allowable under section
535(c)(1) on the basis of the reasonable needs of the business is
determined to be only $20,000. However, since the amount by which
$150,000 exceeds the accumulated earnings and profits at the close of
the preceding taxable year is more than $20,000, the minimum accumulated
earnings credit provided by section 535(c)(2) is applicable. The
allowable credit will be the amount by which $150,000 exceeds the
accumulated earnings and profits at the close of the preceding taxable
year (i.e., $105,000, $150,000 less $45,000 of accumulated earnings and
profits at the close of the preceding taxable year).
(c) Holding and investment companies. Section 535(c)(3) provides
that, in the case of a mere holding or investment company, the
accumulated earnings credit shall be the amount, if any, by which
$150,000 ($100,000 in the case of taxable years beginning before January
1, 1975) exceeds the accumulated earnings and profits of the corporation
at the close of the preceding taxable year. Thus, if such a corporation
has accumulated earnings equal to or in excess of $150,000 ($100,000 in
the case of taxable years beginning before January 1, 1975) at the close
of its preceding taxable year, no accumulated earnings credit is
allowable in computing the accumulated taxable income. See paragraph (c)
of Sec. 1.533-1 for a definition of a holding or investment company.
For the accumulated earnings credit of a mere holding or investment
company which is a member of an affiliated group which has elected the
100-percent dividends received deduction under section 243(b), see
section 243(b)(3) and Sec. 1.243-5. For the accumulated earnings credit
of a mere holding or investment company which is a component member of a
controlled group of corporations (as defined in section 1563), see
sections 1561, 1562, and 1564.
(Sec. 1561(a) (83 Stat. 599; 26 U.S.C. 1561(a)))
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6992, 34 FR
826, Jan. 18, 1969; T.D. 7181, 37 FR 8066, Apr. 25, 1972; T.D. 7244, 37
FR 28897, Dec. 30, 1972; T.D. 7376, 40 FR 42744, Sept. 16, 1975; T.D.
7528, 42 FR 64694, Dec. 28, 1977]
Sec. 1.536-1 Short taxable years.
Accumulated taxable income for a taxable year consisting of a period
of less than 12 months shall not be placed on an annual basis for the
purpose of the accumulated earnings tax imposed by section 531. In such
cases accumulated taxable income shall be computed on the basis of the
taxable income for such period of less than 12 months, adjusted in the
manner provided by section 535(b) and Sec. 1.535-2.
[[Page 255]]
Sec. 1.537-1 Reasonable needs of the business.
(a) In general. The term reasonable needs of the business includes
(1) the reasonably anticipated needs of the business (including product
liability loss reserves, as defined in paragraph (f) of this section),
(2) the section 303 redemption needs of the business, as defined in
paragraph (c) of this section, and (3) the excess business holdings
redemption needs of the business as described in paragraph (d) of this
section. See paragraph (e) of this section for additional rules relating
to the section 303 redemption needs and the excess business holdings
redemption needs of the business. An accumulation of the earnings and
profits (including the undistributed earnings and profits of prior
years) is in excess of the reasonable needs of the business if it
exceeds the amount that a prudent businessman would consider appropriate
for the present business purposes and for the reasonably anticipated
future needs of the business. The need to retain earnings and profits
must be directly connected with the needs of thecorporation itself and
must be for bona fide business purposes. For purposes of this paragraph
the section 303 redemption needs of the business and the excess business
holdings redemption needs of the business are deemed to be directly
connected with the needs of the business and for a bona fide business
purpose. See Sec. 1.537-3 for a discussion of what constitutes the
business of the corporation. The extent to which earnings and profits
have been distributed by the corporation may be taken into account in
determining whether or not retained earnings and profits exceed the
reasonable needs of the business. See Sec. 1.537-2, relating to grounds
for accumulation of earnings and profits.
(b) Reasonable anticipated needs. (1) In order for a corporation to
justify an accumulation of earnings and profits for reasonably
anticipated future needs, there must be an indication that the future
needs of the business require such accumulation, and the corporation
must have specific, definite, and feasible plans for the use of such
accumulation. Such an accumulation need not be used immediately, nor
must the plans for its use be consummated within a short period after
the close of the taxable year, provided that such accumulation will be
used within a reasonable time depending upon all the facts and
circumstances relating to the future needs of the business. Where the
future needs of the business are uncertain or vague, where the plans for
the future use of an accumulation are not specific, definite, and
feasible, or where the execution of such a plan is postponed
indefinitely, an accumulation cannot be justified on the grounds of
reasonably anticipated needs of the business.
(2) Consideration shall be given to reasonably anticipated needs as
they exist on the basis of the facts at the close of the taxable year.
Thus, subsequent events shall not be used for the purpose of showing
that the retention of earnings or profits was unreasonable at the close
of the taxable year if all the elements of reasonable anticipation are
present at the close of such taxable year. However, subsequent events
may be considered to determine whether the taxpayer actually intended to
consummate or has actually consummated the plans for which the earnings
and profits were accumulated. In this connection, projected expansion or
investment plans shall be reviewed in the light of the facts during each
year and as they exist as of the close of the taxable year. If a
corporation has justified an accumulation for future needs by plans
never consummated, the amount of such an accumulation shall be taken
into account in determining the reasonableness of subsequent
accumulations.
(c) Section 303 redemption needs of the business. (1) The term
section 303 redemption needs means, with respect to the taxable year of
the corporation in which a shareholder of the corporation died or any
taxable year thereafter, the amount needed (or reasonably anticipated to
be needed) to redeem stock included in the gross estate of such
shareholder but not in excess of the amount necessary to effect a
distribution to which section 303 applies. For purposes of this
paragraph, the term shareholder includes an individual in
[[Page 256]]
whose gross estate stock of the corporation is includable upon his death
for Federal estate tax purposes.
(2) This paragraph applies to a corporation to which section 303(c)
would apply if a distribution described therein were made.
(3) If stock included in the gross estate of a decedent is stock of
two or more corporations described in section 303(b)(2)(B), the amount
needed by each such corporation for section 303 redemption purposes
under this section shall, unless the particular facts and circumstances
indicate otherwise, be that amount which bears the same ratio to the
amount described in section 303(a) as the fair market value of such
corporation's stock included in the gross estate of such decedent bears
to the fair market value of all of the stock of such corporations
included in the gross estate. For example, facts and circumstances
indicating that the allocation prescribed by this subparagraph is not
required would include notice given to the corporations by the executor
or administrator of the decedent's estate that he intends to request the
redemption of stock of only one of such corporations or the redemption
of stock of such corporations in a ratio which is unrelated to the
respective fair market values of the stock of the corporations included
in the decedent's gross estate.
(4) The provisions of this paragraph apply only to taxable years
ending after May 26, 1969.
(d) Excess business holdings redemption needs. (1) The term excess
business holdings redemption needs means, with respect to taxable years
of the corporation ending after May 26, 1969, the amount needed (or
reasonably anticipated to be needed) to redeem from a private foundation
stock which:
(i) Such foundation held on May 26, 1969 (or which was received by
such foundation pursuant to a will or irrevocable trust to which section
4943(c)(5) applies), and either
(ii) Constituted excess business holdings on such date or would have
constituted excess business holdings as of that date if there were taken
into account (a) stock received pursuant to a will or trust described in
subdivision (i) of this subparagraph and (b) the reduction in the total
outstanding stock of the corporation which would have resulted solely
from the redemption of stock held by the private foundation, or
(iii) Constituted stock redemption of which before January 1, 1975,
or after October 4, 1976, and before January 1, 1977, is, by reason of
section 101(l)(2)(B) of the Tax Reform Act of 1969, as amended by
section 1309 of the Tax Reform Act of 1976, and Sec. 53.4941(d)-4(b),
permitted without imposition of tax under section 4941, but only to the
extent such stock is to be redeemed before January 1, 1975 or after
October 4, 1976, and before January 1, 1977, or is to be redeemed
thereafter pursuant to the terms of a binding contract entered into on
or before such date to redeem all of the stock of the corporation held
by the private foundation on such date.
(2) The purpose of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph is to
facilitate a private-foundation's disposition of certain excess business
holdings, in order for the private foundation not to be liable for tax
under section 4943. See section 4943(c) and the regulations thereunder
for the definition of excess business holdings. For purposes of section
537(b)(2) and this paragraph, however, any determination of the
existence of excess business holdings shall be made without taking into
account the provisions of section 4943(c)(4) which treat certain excess
business holdings as held by a disqualified person (rather than by the
private foundation), except that the periods described in section
4943(c)(4) (B), (C), and (D), if applicable, shall be taken into account
in determining the period during which an excess business holdings
redemption need may be deemed to exist. Thus, an excess business
holdings redemption need may, depending upon the facts and
circumstances, be deemed to exist for a part or all of the 20-year, 15-
year, or 10-year period specified in section 4943(c)(4)(B) during which
the interest in the corporation held by the private foundation is
treated as held by a disqualified person rather than by the private
foundation, and, if applicable, (i) any suspension of such 20-year, 15-
year, or 10-year period as provided by section 4943(c)(4)(C) and (ii)
the 15-year second phase specified in section 4943(c)(4)(D).
[[Page 257]]
The foregoing sentence is not to be construed to prevent an accumulation
of earnings and profits for the purpose of effecting a redemption of
excess business holdings at a time or times prior to expiration of the
periods described in such sentence. This subparagraph is not to be
construed to prevent an accumulation of earnings and profits for the
purpose of effecting a redemption described in subdivision (iii) of
subparagraph (1) of this paragraph.
(3) The extent of an excess business holdings redemption need cannot
exceed the total number of shares of stock so held or received by the
private foundation (i) redemption of which alone would sufficiently
reduce such private foundation's proportionate share of the
corporation's total outstanding stock in order for the private
foundation not to be liable for tax under section 4943, or (ii)
redemption of which is, by reason of Sec. 53.4941(d)-4(b), permitted
without imposition of tax under section 4941 provided that such
redemption is accomplished within the period and in the manner
prescribed in subdivision (iii) of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph.
Thus, excess business holdings of a private foundation attributable to
an increase in the private foundation's proportionate share of the
corporation's total outstanding stock by reason of a redemption of stock
after May 26, 1969, from any person other than the private foundation do
not give rise to an excess business holdings redemption need.
(4) For purposes of subdivision (ii) of subparagraph (1) of this
paragraph, an excess business holdings redemption need can arise with
respect to shares of the corporation's stock under section 537(a)(3)
only following actual acquisition by the private foundation of such
shares and their characterization as an excess business holding. Thus,
this paragraph does not apply to an accumulation of earnings and profits
in one taxable year in anticipation of redemption of excess business
holdings to be acquired by a private foundation in a subsequent year
pursuant to a will or irrevocable trust to which section 4943(c)(5)
applies or in anticipation of shares held becoming excess business
holdings of the private foundation in a subsequent year by reason of
additional shares to be received by the private foundation in such
subsequent year pursuant to a will or irrevocable trust to which section
4943(c)(5) applies. Once having arisen, however, an excess business
holdings redemption need may continue until redemption of the private
foundation's excess business holdings described in this paragraph or
other disposition of such excess business holdings by the private
foundation.
(5) Notwithstanding any other provision of this paragraph, an excess
business holdings redemption need will not be deemed to exist with
respect to stock held by a private foundation the redemption of which
would subject any person to tax under section 4941.
(6) For purposes of subdivision (ii) of subparagraph (1) of this
paragraph, the number of shares of stock held by a private foundation on
May 26, 1969 (or received pursuant to a will or irrevocable trust to
which section 4943(c)(5) applies), redemption of which alone would
sufficiently reduce such foundation's proportionate share of a
corporation's total outstanding stock in order for the foundation not to
be liable for tax under section 4943 may be determined by application of
the following formula:
[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TC14NO91.159
X=Number of shares to be redeemed.
Y=Maximum percentage of outstanding stock which private foundation can
hold without being liable for tax under section 4943.
PH=Number of shares of stock held by private foundation on May 26, 1969,
or received pursuant to a will or irrevocable trust to which
section 4943(c)(5) applies.
SO=Total number of shares of stock outstanding unreduced by any
redemption from a person other than the private foundation.
(7) The provisions of this paragraph may be illustrated by the
following example:
Example. (i) On May 26, 1969, Private Foundation A holds 60 of the
100 outstanding shares of the capital stock of corporation X, which is
not a disqualified person with respect to A. None of the remaining 40
shares is owned by a disqualified person within the meaning of section
4946(a). On June 1, 1975, X
[[Page 258]]
redeems 10 shares of its stock from individual B, thus reducing its
outstanding stock to 90 shares. On June 1, 1976, A receives 20
additional shares of X stock by bequest under a will to which section
4943(c)(5) applies. As of June 1, 1976, then, A holds 80 of the 90
outstanding shares of X. Solely for purposes of this example and to
illustrate the application of this paragraph, it will be assumed that in
order not to be liable for the initial tax under section 4943, A must,
before the close of the second phase described in section 4943(c)(4)(D),
reduce its proportionate stock interest in X to 35 percent. A requests X
to redeem from it a sufficient number of its shares to so reduce its
proportionate stock interest in X to 35 percent, and X agrees to effect
such a redemption.
(ii) As of May 26, 1969, A's excess business holdings are 25 shares
of X, the number of shares which A would be required to dispose of to a
person other than X in order to reduce its proportionate holdings in X
to no more than 35percent. If the disposition is to be by means of a
redemption, however, A's excess business holdings on May 26, 1969, for
purposes of determining X's excess business holdings redemption needs,
are 39 shares, i.e., the number of shares X would be required to redeem
in order to reduce A's proportionate stock interest to 35 percent.
Although the redemption of 10 shares from B on June 1, 1975, creates
additional excess business holdings of A because it effectively
increases A's proportionate stock interest in X, this increase does not
create an additional excess business holdings redemption need because it
resulted from a redemption from a person other than A. The bequest of 20
shares of X received by A on June 1, 1976, creates a further excess
business holdings redemption need as of that date in the amount needed
(or reasonably anticipated to be needed) to redeem an additional 31
shares from A, i.e., the number of shares which, when added to the
excess business holdings of A on May 26, 1969, would have to be redeemed
to reduce A's proportionate stock interest in X to 35 percent without
taking the earlier redemption from B into account.
(e)(1) A determination whether and to what extent an amount is
needed (or reasonably anticipated to be needed) for the purpose
described in subparagraph (1) of paragraph (c) or (d) of this section is
dependent upon the particular circumstances of the case, including the
total amount of earnings and profits accumulated in prior years which
may be available for such purpose and the existence of a reasonable
expectation that a redemption described in paragraph (c) or (d) of this
section will in fact be effected. Although paragraph (c) or (d) of this
section may apply even though no redemption of stock is in fact
effected, the failure to effect such redemption may be taken into
account in determining whether the accumulation was needed (or
reasonably anticipated to be needed) for a purpose described in
paragraph (c) or (d).
(2) In applying subparagraph (1) of paragraph (c) or (d) of this
section, the discharge of an obligation incurred to make a redemption
shall be treated as the making of the redemption.
(3) In determining whether an accumulation is in excess of the
reasonable needs of the business for a particular year, the fact that
one of the exceptions specified in paragraph (c) or (d) of this section
applies in a subsequent year is not to give rise to an inference that
the accumulation would not have been for the reasonable needs of the
business in the prior year. Also, no inference is to be drawn from the
enactment of section 537(a) (2) and (3) that accumulations in any prior
year would not have been for the reasonable needs of the business in the
absence of such provisions. Thus, the reasonableness of accumulations in
years prior to a year in which one of the exceptions specified in
paragraph (c) or (d) of this section applies is to be determined solely
upon the facts and circumstances existing at the times the accumulations
occur.
(f) Product liability loss reserves. (1) The term product liability
loss reserve means, with respect to taxable years beginning after
September 30, 1979, reasonable amounts accumulated for the payment of
reasonably anticipated product liability losses, as defined in section
172(j) and Sec. 1.172-13(b)(1).
(2) For purposes of this paragraph, whether an accumulation for
anticipated product liability losses is reasonable in amount and whether
such anticipated product liability losses are likely to occur shall be
determined in light of all facts and circumstances of the taxpayer
making such accumulation. Some of the factors to be considered in
determining the reasonableness of the accumulation include the
taxpayer's previous product liability experience, the extent of the
taxpayer's
[[Page 259]]
coverage by commercial product liability insurance, the income tax
consequences of the taxpayer's ability to deduct product liability
losses and related expenses, and the taxpayer's potential future
liability due to defective products in light of the taxpayer's plans to
expand the production of products currently being manufactured, provided
such plans are specific, definite and feasible. Additionally, a factor
to be considered in determining whether the accumulation is reasonable
in amount is whether the taxpayer, in accounting for its potential
future liability, took into account the reasonably estimated present
value of the potential future liability.
(3) Only those accumulations made with respect to products that have
been manufactured, leased, or sold shall be considered as accumulations
made under this paragraph. Thus, for example, accumulations with respect
to a product which has not progressed beyond the development stage are
not reasonable accumulations under this paragraph.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 7165, 37 FR
5022, Mar. 9, 1972, 37 FR 5703, Mar. 18, 1972; T.D. 7678, 44 FR 12416,
Feb. 26, 1980; T.D. 8096, 51 FR 30483, Aug. 27, 1986]
Sec. 1.537-2 Grounds for accumulation of earnings and profits.
(a) In general. Whether a particular ground or grounds for the
accumulation of earnings and profits indicate that the earnings and
profits have been accumulated for the reasonable needs of the business
or beyond such needs is dependent upon the particular circumstances of
the case. Listed below in paragraphs (b) and (c) of this section are
some of the grounds which may be used as guides under ordinary
circumstances.
(b) Reasonable accumulation of earnings and profits. Although the
following grounds are not exclusive, one or more of such grounds, if
supported by sufficient facts, may indicate that the earnings and
profits of a corporation are being accumulated for the reasonable needs
of the business provided the general requirements under Sec. Sec.
1.537-1 and 1.537-3 are satisfied:
(1) To provide for bona fide expansion of business or replacement of
plant;
(2) To acquire a business enterprise through purchasing stock or
assets;
(3) To provide for the retirement of bona fide indebtedness created
in connection with the trade or business, such as the establishment of a
sinking fund for the purpose of retiring bonds issued by the corporation
in accordance with contract obligations incurred on issue;
(4) To provide necessary working capital for the business, such as,
for the procurement of inventories;
(5) To provide for investments or loans to suppliers or customers if
necessary in order to maintain the business of the corporation; or
(6) To provide for the payment of reasonably anticipated product
liability losses, as defined in section 172(j), Sec. 1.172-13(b)(1),
and Sec. 1.537-1(f).
(c) Unreasonable accumulations of earnings and profits. Although the
following purposes are not exclusive, accumulations of earnings and
profits to meet any one of such objectives may indicate that the
earnings and profits of a corporation are being accumulated beyond the
reasonable needs of the business:
(1) Loans to shareholders, or the expenditure of funds of the
corporation for the personal benefit of the shareholders;
(2) Loans having no reasonable relation to the conduct of the
business made to relatives or friends of shareholders, or to other
persons;
(3) Loans to another corporation, the business of which is not that
of the taxpayer corporation, if the capital stock of such other
corporation is owned, directly or indirectly, by the shareholder or
shareholders of the taxpayer corporation and such shareholder or
shareholders are in control of both corporations;
(4) Investments in properties, or securities which are unrelated to
the activities of the business of the taxpayer corporation; or
(5) Retention of earnings and profits to provide against unrealistic
hazards.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 8096, 51 FR
30484, Aug. 27, 1986]
[[Page 260]]
Sec. 1.537-3 Business of the corporation.
(a) The business of a corporation is not merely that which it has
previously carried on but includes, in general, any line of business
which it may undertake.
(b) If one corporation owns the stock of another corporation and, in
effect, operates the other corporation, the business of the latter
corporation may be considered in substance, although not in legal form,
the business of the first corporation. However, investment by a
corporation of its earnings and profits in stock and securities of
another corporation is not, of itself, to be regarded as employment of
the earnings and profits in its business. Earnings and profits of the
first corporation put into the second corporation through the purchase
of stock or securities or otherwise, may, if a subsidiary relationship
is established, constitute employment of the earnings and profits in its
own business. Thus, the business of one corporation may be regarded as
including the business of another corporation if such other corporation
is a mere instrumentality of the first corporation; that may be
established by showing that the first corporation owns at least 80
percent of the voting stock of the second corporation. If the taxpayer's
ownership of stock is less than 80 percent in the other corporation, the
determination of whether the funds are employed in a business operated
by the taxpayer will depend upon the particular circumstances of the
case. Moreover, the business of one corporation does not include the
business of another corporation if such other corporation is a personal
holding company, an investment company, or a corporation not engaged in
the active conduct of a trade or business.
Personal Holding Companies
Sec. 1.541-1 Imposition of tax.
(a) Section 541 imposes a graduated tax upon corporations classified
as personal holding companies under section 542. This tax, if
applicable, is in addition to the tax imposed upon corporations
generally under section 11. Unless specifically excepted under section
542(c) the tax applies to domestic and foreign corporations and, to the
extent provided by section 542(b), to an affiliated group of
corporations filing a consolidated return. Corporations classified as
personal holding companies are exempt brom the accumulated earnings tax
imposed under section 531 but are not exempt from other income taxes
imposed upon corporations, generally, under any other provisions of the
Code. Unlike the accumulated earnings tax imposed under section 531, the
personal holding company tax imposed by section 541 applies to all
personal holding companies as defined in section 542, whether or not
they were formed or availed of to avoid income tax upon shareholders.
See section 6501(f) and Sec. 301.6501(f)-1 of this chapter (Regulations
on Procedure and Administration) with respect to the period of
limitation on assessment of personal holding company tax upon failure to
file a schedule of personal holding company income.
(b) A foreign corporation, whether resident or nonresident, which is
classified as a personal holding company is subject to the tax imposed
under section 541 with respect to its income from sources within the
United States, even though such income is not fixed or determinable
annual or periodical income specified in section 881. A foreign
corporation is not classified as a personal holding company subject to
tax under section 541 if it is a foreign personal holding company as
defined in section 552 or if it meets the requirements of the exception
provided in section 542(c)(10).
Sec. 1.542-1 General rule.
A personal holding company is any corporation (other than one
specifically excepted under section 542(c)) which, for the taxable year,
meets:
(a) The gross income requirement specified in section 542(a)(1) and
Sec. 1.542-2, and
(b) The stock ownership requirement specified in section 542(a)(2)
and Sec. 1.542-3
Both requirements must be satisfied with respect to each taxable year.
Sec. 1.542-2 Gross income requirement.
To meet the gross income requirement it is necessary that at least
80 percent of the total gross income of the
[[Page 261]]
corporation for the taxable year be personal holding company income as
defined in section 543 and Sec. Sec. 1.543-1 and 1.543-2. For the
definition of gross income see section 61 and Sec. Sec. 1.61-1 through
1.61-14. Under such provisions gross income is not necessarily
synonymous with gross receipts. Further, in the case of transactions in
stocks and securities and in commodities transactions, gross income for
personal holding company tax purposes shall include only the excess of
gains over losses from such transactions. See section 543(b), paragraph
(b) (5) and (6) of Sec. 1.543-1 and Sec. 1.543-2. For determining the
character of the amount includible in gross income under section 951(a),
see paragraph (a) of Sec. 1.951-1.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6795, 30 FR
934, Jan. 29, 1965]
Sec. 1.542-3 Stock ownership requirement.
(a) General rule. To meet the stock ownership requirement, it is
necessary that at some time during the last half of the taxable year
more than 50 percent in value of the outstanding stock of the
corporation be owned, directly or indirectly, by or for not more than 5
individuals. Any organization or trust to which subparagraph (1) of this
paragraph applies shall be considered as one individual for purposes of
this stock ownership requirement subject, however, to the exception in
subparagraph (2) of this paragraph which is applicable only to taxable
years beginning after December 31, 1954. Thus, if an organization or
trust which is considered as an individual owns 51 percent in value of
the outstanding stock of the corporation at any time during the last
half of the taxable year, the stock ownership requirement will be met by
ownership of the required percentage by one individual. See section 544
and Sec. Sec. 1.544-1 through 1.544-7 for the determination of stock
ownership.
(1) An organization or trust considered as an individual. Any of the
following organizations or trusts shall be considered as an individual:
(i) An organization to which section 503 applies, namely, any
organization described in section 501(c)(3) (relating to charitable,
etc., organizations) or section 401(a) (relating to employees' pension
trust, etc.) other than an organization excepted from the application of
section 503 by paragraphs (1) to (5) of section 503(b). Therefore, a
religious organization (other than a trust) excepted under section
503(b)(1) is not considered an individual for purposes of the stock
ownership requirement of section 542(a)(2).
(ii) A portion of a trust permanently set aside or to be used
exclusively for the purposes described in section 642(c), relating to
amounts set aside for charitable purposes, or described in a
corresponding provision of the prior income tax law (such as section
162(a), Internal Revenue Code of 1939).
(2) Exception. For taxable years beginning after December 31, 1954,
an organization or trust to which subparagraph (1) of this paragraph
applies shall not be considered an individual if all of the following
conditions are met:
(i) It was organized or created before July 1, 1950.
(ii) At all times on or after July 1, 1950, and before the close of
the taxable year, it owned all of the common stock and at least 80
percent of the total number of shares of all other classes of stock of
the corporation.
(iii) For the taxable year it is not denied exemption under section
504(a) or the unlimited charitable deduction under section 681(c). In
determining whether, for the purpose of section 542(a)(2), exemption is
not denied under section 504(a) or the unlimited charitable deduction is
not denied under section 681(c) all the income of the corporation which
is available for distribution as dividends to its shareholders shall be
deemed to have been distributed at the close of the taxable year whether
or not any portion of such income was in fact distributed. If the
amounts described in section 504(a) or section 681(c), increased by the
income of the corporation deemed distributed pursuant to the preceding
sentence, would be sufficient to deny exemption or the unlimited
charitable deduction, the organization or trust will be considered to be
an individual for the purpose of section 542(a)(2). For the purpose of
this subdivision the restrictions in sections 504(a)(1) and
[[Page 262]]
681(c)(1) against unreasonable accumulations will not apply to income
attributable to property of a decedent dying before January 1, 1951,
which was transferred during his lifetime to a trust or property that
was transferred under his will to such trust, and
(iv) This subparagraph is illustrated by the following example:
Example. The X Charitable Foundation (an organization described in
section 501(c)(3) to which section 503 is applicable) has owned all of
the stock of the Y Corporation since Y's organization in 1949. Both X
and Y are calendar-year corporations. At the end of the year 1955, X has
accumulated $100,000 out of income and has actually paid out only
$75,000 of this amount, leaving a balance of $25,000 on December 31,
1955. X was not denied an exemption under section 504(a) for the year
1955. Y, during the calendar year 1955, has $400,000 taxable income of
which $200,000 is available for distribution as dividends at the end of
the year. X will be considered to have accumulated out of income during
the calendar year 1955 the amount of $225,000 for the purpose of
determining whether it would have been denied an exemption under section
504(a)(1). If X would have been denied an exemption under section
504(a)(1) by reason of having been deemed to have accumulated $225,000,
the stock ownership requirement of section 542(a)(2) and this section
will have been satisfied. If Y Corporation also satisfies the gross
income requirement of section 542(a)(1) and Sec. 1.542-2 it will be a
personal holding company.
(b) Changes in stock outstanding. It is necessary to consider any
change in the stock outstanding during the last half of the taxable
year, whether in the number of shares or classes of stock, or in the
ownership thereof. Stock subscribed and paid for will be considered as
stock outstanding, whether or not such stock is evidenced by issued
certificates. Treasury stock shall not be considered as stock
outstanding.
(c) Value of stock outstanding. The value of the stock outstanding
shall be determined in the light of all the circumstances. The value may
be determined upon the basis of the company's net worth, earning and
dividend paying capacity, appreciation of assets, together with such
other factors as have a bearing upon the value of the stock. If the
value of the stock is greatly at variance with that reflected by the
corporate books, the evidence of such value should be filed with the
return. In any case where there are two or more classes of stock
outstanding, the total value of all the stock should be allocated among
the different classes according to the relative value of each class.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6739, 29 FR
7713, June 17, 1964]
Sec. 1.542-4 Corporations filing consolidated returns.
(a) General rule. A consolidated return under section 1501 shall
determine the application of the personal holding company tax to the
group and to any member thereof on the basis of the consolidated gross
income and consolidated personal holding company income of the group, as
determined under the regulations prescribed pursuant to section 1502
(relating to consolidated returns); however, this rule shall not apply
to either (1) an ineligible affiliated group as defined in section
542(b)(2) and paragraph (b) of this section, or (2) an affiliated group
of corporations a member of which is excluded from the definition of a
personal holding company under section 542(c) and paragraph (c) of this
section. Thus, in the latter two instances the gross income requirement
provided in section 542(a)(1) and Sec. 1.542-2 shall apply to each
individual member of the affiliated group of corporations.
(b) Ineligible affiliated group. (1) Except for certain affiliated
railroad corporations, as provided in subparagraph (2) of this
paragraph, an affiliated group of corporations is an ineligible
affiliated group and therefore may not use its consolidated gross income
and consolidated personal holding company income to determine the
liability of the group or any member thereof for personal holding
company tax (as provided in paragraph (a) of this section), if (i) any
member of such group, including the common parent, derived gross income
from sources outside the affiliated group for the taxable year in an
amount equal to 10 percent or more of its gross income from all sources
for that year and (ii) 80 percent or more of the gross income from
sources outside the affiliated group consists of personal holding
company income as defined in section 543 and Sec. Sec. 1.543-1 and
1.543-2.
[[Page 263]]
For purposes of subdivision (i) of this subparagraph gross income shall
not include certain dividend income receivedby a common parent from a
corporation not a member of the affiliated group which qualifies under
section 542(b)(4) and paragraph (d) of this section. See particularly
the examples contained in paragraph (d)(2) of this section.
Intercorporate dividends received by members of the affiliated group
(including the common parent) are to be included in the gross income
from all sources for purposes of the test in subdivision (i) of this
subparagraph. For purposes of subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph,
section 543 and paragraph (a) of Sec. 1.543-1 shall be applied as if
the amount of gross income derived from sources outside the affiliated
group by a corporation which is a member of such group is the gross
income of such corporation.
(2) An affiliated group of railroad corporations shall not be
considered to be an ineligible affiliated group, notwithstanding any
other provisions of section 542(b)(2) and this paragraph, if the common
parent of such group would be eligible to file a consolidated return
under section 141 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1939 prior to its
amendment by the Revenue Act of 1942 (56 Stat. 798).
(3) See section 562(d) and Sec. 1.562-3 for dividends paid
deduction in the case of a distribution by a member of an ineligible
affiliated group.
(4) The determination of whether an affiliated group of corporations
is an ineligible group under section 542(b)(2) and this paragraph, may
be illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. Corporations X, Y, and Z constitute an affiliated group
of corporations which files a consolidated return for the calendar year
1954; Corporations Y and Z are wholly-owned subsidiaries of Corporation
X and derive no gross income from sources outside the affiliated group;
Corporation X, the common parent, has gross income in the amount of
$250,000 for the taxable year 1954. $200,000 of such gross income
consists of dividends received from Corporations Y and Z. The remaining
$50,000 was derived from sources outside the affiliated group, $40,000
of which represents personal holding company income as defined in
section 543. The $50,000 included in the gross income of Corporation X
and derived from sources outside the affiliated group is more than 10
percent of X's gross income ($50,000/$250,000) and the $40,000 which
represents personal holding company income is 80 percent of $50,000 (the
amount considered to be the gross income of Corporation X). Accordingly,
Corporations X, Y, and Z would be an ineligible affiliated group and the
gross income requirement under section 542(a)(1) and Sec. 1.542-2 would
be applied to each corporation individually.
Example 2. If, in the above example, only $30,000 of the $50,000
derived from sources outside the affiliated group by Corporation X
represented personal holding company income, this group of affiliated
corporations would not be an ineligible affiliated group. Although the
$50,000 representing the gross income of Corporation X from sources
outside the affiliated group is more than 10 percent of its total gross
income, the amount of $30,000 representing personal holding company
income is not 80 percent or more of the amount considered to be gross
income for the purpose of this test. Under section 542(b)(2) and
subparagraph (1) of this paragraph both the gross income and the
personal holding company income requirements must be satisfied in
determining that an affiliated group constitutes an ineligible group.
Since both of these requirements have not been satisfied in this example
this group of affiliated corporations would not be an ineligible group.
(c) Excluded corporations. The general rule for determining
liability of an affiliated group under paragraph (a) of this section
shall not apply if any member thereof is a corporation which is
excluded, under section 542(c), from the definition of a personal
holding company.
(d) Certain dividend income received by a common parent. (1)
Dividends received by the common parent of an affiliated group from a
corporation which is not a member of the affiliated group shall not be
included in gross income or personal holding company income, for the
purpose of the test under section 542(b)(2):
(i) If such common parent owned, directly or indirectly, more than
50 percent of the outstanding voting stock of the dividend paying
corporation at the time such common parent became entitled to the
dividend, and
(ii) If the dividend paying corporation is not a personal holding
company for the taxable year in which the dividends are paid
Thus, if the tests in subdivisions (i) and (ii) of this subparagraph are
met, the
[[Page 264]]
dividend income received by the common parent from such other
corporation will not be considered gross income for purposes of the test
in section 542(b)(2)(A) (paragraph (b) of this section), that is, either
to determine gross income from sources outside the affiliated group or
to determine gross income from all sources.
(2) The application of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph may be
illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. Corporation X is the common parent of Corporation Y and
Corporation Z and together they constitute an affiliated group which
files a consolidated return under section 1501. Corporation Y and
Corporation Z derived no income from sources outside the affiliated
group. Corporation X, the common parent, had gross income of $100,000
for the calendar year 1954 of which amount $20,000 represented a
dividend received from Corporation W, and $4,000 represented interest
from Corporation T. The remaining gross income of X, $76,000, was
received from Corporations Y and Z. Corporation X, for its entire
taxable year, owned 60 percent of the voting stock of Corporation W
which was not a personal holding company for the calendar year 1954. For
the purpose of the gross income and personal holding company income test
under section 542(b)(2) and paragraph (b) of this section, the $20,000
dividend received from Corporation W would not be included in the gross
income or personal holding company income of Corporation X. The
affiliated group would not be an ineligible group under section
542(b)(2) because 10 percent or more of its gross income was not from
sources outside the affiliated group as required by section
542(b)(2)(A). Inasmuch as the $20,000 dividend from Corporation W is not
included in the gross income of Corporation X for purposes of section
542(b)(2) Corporation X only has $4,000 gross income from sources
outside the affiliated group which is only 5 percent of its gross income
from all sources, $80,000.
Example 2. If, in example 1, Corporation X owned 50 percent or less
of the voting stock of Corporation W at the time X became entitled to
the dividend, or if Corporation W had been a personal holding company
for the taxable year in which the dividends were paid, the $20,000
dividends received by Corporation X would be included in gross income
and personal holding company income of Corporation X for the purpose of
the test under section 542(b)(2) and paragraph (b) of this section.
Thus, the affiliated group would be an ineligible affiliated group under
section 542(b)(2) because 24 percent of its gross income was from
sources outside the affiliated group ($24,000/$100,000) and 100 percent
of this $24,000 was personal holding company income.
Sec. 1.543-1 Personal holding company income.
(a) General rule. The term personal holding company income means the
portion of the gross income which consists of the classes of gross
income described in paragraph (b) of this section. See section 543(b)
and Sec. 1.543-2 for special limitations on gross income and personal
holding company income in cases of gains from stocks', securities', and
commodities' transactions.
(b) Definitions--(1) Dividends. The term dividends includes
dividends as defined in section 316 and amounts required to be included
in gross income under section 551 and Sec. Sec. 1.551-1--1.551-2
(relating to foreign personal holding company income taxed to United
States shareholders).
(2) Interest. The term interest means any amounts, includible in
gross income, received for the use of money loaned. However, (i)
interest which constitutes rent shall not be classified as interest but
shall be classified as rents (see subparagraph (10) of this paragraph)
and (ii) interest on amounts set aside in a reserve fund under section
511 or 607 of the Merchant Marine Act, 1936 (46 U.S.C. 1161 or 1177),
shall not be included in personal holding company income.
(3) Royalties (other than mineral, oil, or gas royalties or certain
copyright royalties). The term royalties (other than mineral, oil, or
gas royalties or certain copyright royalties) includes amounts received
for the privilege of using patents, copyrights, secret processes and
formulas, good will, trade marks, trade brands, franchises, and other
like property. It does not, however, include rents. For rules relating
to rents see section 543(a)(7) and subparagraph (10) of this paragraph.
For rules relating to mineral, oil, or gas royalties, see section
543(a)(8) and subparagraph (11) of this paragraph. For rules relating to
certain copyright royalties for taxable years beginning after December
31, 1959, see section 543(a)(9) and subparagraph (12) of this paragraph.
[[Page 265]]
(4) Annuities. The term annuities includes annuities only to the
extent includible in the computation of gross income. See section 72 and
Sec. Sec. 1.72-1--1.72-14 for rules relating to the inclusion of
annuities in gross income.
(5) Gains from the sale or exchange of stock or securities. (i)
Except in the case of regular dealers in stock or securities as provided
in subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph, gross income and personal
holding company income include the amount by which the gains exceed the
losses from the sale or exchange of stock or securities. See section
543(b)(1) and Sec. 1.543-2 for provisions relating to this limitation.
For this purpose, there shall be taken into account all those gains
includible in gross income (including gains from liquidating dividends
and other distributions from capital) and all those losses deductible
from gross income which are considered under chapter 1 of the Code to be
gains or losses from the sale or exchange of stock or securities. The
term stock or securities as used in section 543(a)(2) and this
subparagraph includes shares or certificates of stock, stock rights or
warrants, or interest in any corporation (including any joint stock
company, insurance company, association, or other organization
classified as a corporation by the Code), certificates of interest or
participation in any profit-sharing agreement, or in any oil, gas, or
other mineral property, or lease, collateral trust certificates, voting
trust certificates, bonds, debentures, certificates of indebtedness,
notes, car trust certificates, bills of exchange, obligations issued by
or on behalf of a State, Territory, or political subdivision thereof.
(ii) In the case of regular dealers in stock or securities there
shall not be included gains or losses derived from the sale or exchange
of stock or securities made in the normal course of business. The term
regular dealer in stock or securities means a corporation with an
established place of business regularly engaged in the purchase of stock
or securities and their resale to customers. However, such corporations
shall not be considered as regular dealers with respect to stock or
securities which are held for investment. See section 1236 and Sec.
1.1236-1.
(6) Gains from futures transactions in commodities. Gross income and
personal holding company income include the amount by which the gains
exceed the losses from futures transactions in any commodity on or
subject to the rules of a board of trade or commodity exchange. See
Sec. 1.543-2 for provisions relating to this limitation. In general,
for the purpose of determining such excess, there are included all gains
and losses on futures contracts which are speculative. However, for the
purpose of determining such excess, there shall not be included gains or
losses from cash transactions, or gains or losses by a producer,
processor, merchant, or handler of the commodity, which arise out of
bona fide hedging transactions reasonably necessary to the conduct of
its business in the manner in which such business is customarily and
usually conducted by others. See section 1233 and Sec. 1.1233-1.
(7) Estates and trusts. Under section 543(a)(4) personal holding
company income includes amounts includible in computing the taxable
income of the corporation under part I, subchapter J, chapter 1 of the
Code (relating to estates, trusts, and beneficiaries); and any gain
derived by the corporation from the sale or other disposition of any
interest in an estate or trust.
(8) Personal service contracts. (i) Under section 543(a)(5) amounts
received under a contract under which the corporation is to furnish
personal services, as well as amounts received from the sale or other
disposition of such contract, shall be included as personal holding
company income if:
(a) Some person other than the corporation has the right to
designate (by name or by description) the individual who is to perform
the services, or if the individual who is to perform the services is
designated (by name or by description) in the contract; and
(b) At any time during the taxable year 25 percent or more in value
of the outstanding stock of the corporation is owned, directly or
indirectly, by or for the individual who has performed, is to perform,
or may be designated (by name or by description) as the one to perform,
such services. For this purpose, the amount of stock outstanding
[[Page 266]]
and its value shall be determined in accordance with the rules set forth
in the last two sentences of paragraph (b) and in paragraph (c) of Sec.
1.542-3. It should be noted that the stock ownership requirement of
section 543(a)(5) and this subparagraph relates to the stock ownership
at any time during the taxable year. For rules relating to the
determination of stock ownership, see section 544 and Sec. Sec. 1.544-1
through 1.544-7.
(ii) If the contract, in addition to requiring the performance of
services by a 25-percent stockholder who is designated or who could be
designated (as specified in section 543(a)(5) and subdivision (i) of
this subparagraph), requires the performance of services by other
persons which are important and essential, then only that portion of the
amount received under such contract which is attributable to the
personal services of the 25-percent stockholder shall constitute
personal holding company income. Incidental personal services of other
persons employed by the corporation to facilitate the performance of the
services by the 25-percent stockholder, however, shall not constitute
important or essential services. Under section 482 gross income,
deductions, credits, or allowances between or among organizations,
trades, or businesses may be allocated if it is determined that
allocation is necessary in order to prevent evasion of taxes or clearly
to reflect the income of any such organizations, trades, or businesses.
(iii) The application of section 543(a)(5) and this subparagraph may
be illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. A, whose profession is that of an actor, owns all of the
outstanding capital stock of the M Corporation. The M Corporation
entered into a contract with A under which A was to perform personal
services for the person or persons whom the M Corporation might
designate, in consideration of which A was to receive $10,000 a year
from the M Corporation. The M Corporation entered into a contract with
the O Corporation in which A was designated to perform personal services
for the O Corporation in consideration of which the O Corporation was to
pay the M Corporation $500,000 a year. The $500,000 received by the M
Corporation from the O Corporation constitutes personal holding company
income.
Example 2. Assume the same facts as in example 1, except that, in
addition to A's contract with the M Corporation, B, whose profession is
that of a dancer and C, whose profession is that of a singer, were also
under contract to the M Corporation to perform personal services for the
person or persons whom the M Corporation might designate, in
consideration of which they were each to receive $25,000 a year from the
M Corporation. Neither B nor C were stockholders of the M Corporation.
The contract entered into by the MCorporation with the O Corporation, in
addition to designating that A was to perform personal services for the
O Corporation, designated that B and C were also to perform personal
services for the O Corporation. Although the O Corporation particularly
desired the services of A for an entertainment program it planned, it
also desired the services of B and C, who were prominent in their
fields, to provide a good supporting cast for the program. The services
of B and C required under the contract are determined to be important
and essential; therefore, only that portion of the $500,000 received by
the M Corporation which is attributable to the personal services of A
constitutes personal holding company income. The same result would
obtain although the dancer and the singer required by the contract were
not designated by name but the contract gave the M Corporation
discretion to select and provide the services of a singer and a dancer
for the program and such services were provided.
Example 3. The N Corporation is engaged in engineering. Its entire
outstanding capital stock is owned by four individuals. The N
Corporation entered into a contract with the R Corporation to perform
engineering services in consideration of which the R Corporation was to
pay the N Corporation $50,000. The individual who was to perform the
services was not designated (by name or by description) in the contract
and no one but the N Corporation had the right to designate (by name or
by description) such individual. The $50,000 received by the N
Corporation from the R Corporation does not constitute personal holding
company income.
(9) Compensation for use of property. Under section 543(a)(6)
amounts received as compensation for the use of, or right to use,
property of the corporation shall be included as personal holding
company income if, at any time during the taxable year, 25 percent or
more in value of the outstanding stock of the corporation is owned,
directly or indirectly, by or for an individual entitled to the use of
the property. Thus, if a shareholder who meets the stock ownership
requirement of section 543(a)(6) and this subparagraph uses, or has the
right to use, a yacht, residence, or other property
[[Page 267]]
owned by the corporation, the compensation to the corporation for such
use, or right to use, the property constitutes personal holding company
income. This is true even though the shareholder may acquire the use of,
or the right to use, the property by means of a sublease or under any
other arrangement involving parties other than the corporation and the
shareholder. However, if the personal holding company income of the
corporation (after excluding any such income described in section
543(a)(6) and this subparagraph, relating to compensation for use of
property, and after excluding any such income described in section
543(a)(7) and subparagraph (10) of this paragraph, relating to rents) is
not more than 10 percent of its grossincome, compensation for the use of
property shall not constitute personalholding company income. For
purposes of the preceding sentence, in determining whether personal
holding company income is more than 10 percent of gross income,
copyright royalties constitute personal holding company income,
regardless of whether such copyright royalties are excluded from
personal holding company income under section 543(a)(9) and subparagraph
(12)(ii) of this paragraph. For purposes of applying section 543(a)(6)
and this subparagraph, the amount of stock outstanding and its value
shall be determined in accordance with the rules set forth in the last
two sentences of paragraph (b) and in paragraph (c) of Sec. 1.542-3. It
should be noted that the stock ownership requirement of section
543(a)(6) and this subparagraph relates to the stock outstanding at any
time during the entire taxable year. For rules relating to the
determination of stock ownership, see section 544 and Sec. Sec. 1.544-1
through 1.544-7.
(10) Rents (including interest constituting rents). Rents which are
to be included as personal holding company income consist of
compensation (however designated) for the use, or right to use, property
of the corporation. The term rents does not include amounts includible
in personal holding company income under section 543(a)(6) and
subparagraph (9) of this paragraph. The amounts considered as rents
include charter fees, etc., for the use of, or the right to use,
property, as well as interest on debts owed to the corporation (to the
extent such debts represent the price for which real property held
primarily for sale to customers in the ordinary course of the
corporation's trade or business was sold or exchanged by the
corporation). However, if the amount of the rents includible under
section 543(a)(7) and this subparagraph constitutes 50 percent or more
of the gross income of the corporation, such rents shall not be
considered to be personal holding company income.
(11) Mineral, oil, or gas royalties. (i) The income from mineral,
oil, or gas royalties is to be included as personal holding company
income, unless (a) the aggregate amount of such royalties constitutes 50
percent or more of the gross income of the corporation for the taxable
year and (b) the aggregate amount of deductions allowable under section
162 (other than compensation for personal services rendered by the
shareholders of the corporation) equals 15 percent or more of the gross
income of the corporation for the taxable year.
(ii) The term mineral, oil, or gas royalties means all royalties,
including overriding royalties and, to the extent not treated as loans
under section 636, mineral production payments, received from any
interest in mineral, oil, or gas properties. The term mineral includes
those minerals which are included within the meaning of the term
minerals in the regulations under section 611.
(iii) The first sentence of subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph
shall apply to overriding royalties received from the sublessee by the
operating company which originally leased and developed the natural
resource property in respect of which such overriding royalties are
paid, and to mineral, oil, or gas production payments, only with respect
to amounts received after September 30, 1958.
(12) Copyright royalties--(i) In general. The income from copyright
royalties constitutes, generally, personal holding company income.
However, for taxable years beginning after December 31, 1959, those
copyright royalties which come within the definition of copyright
royalties in section 543(a)(9) and subdivision (iv) of this subparagraph
shall
[[Page 268]]
be excluded from personal holding company income only if the conditions
set forth in subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph are satisfied.
(ii) Exclusion from personal holding company income. For taxable
years beginning after December 31, 1959, copyright royalties (as defined
in section 543(a)(9) and subdivision (iv) of this subparagraph) shall be
excluded from personal holding company income only if the conditions set
forth in (a), (b), and (c) of this subdivision are met.
(a) Such copyright royalties for the taxable year must constitute 50
percent or more of the corporation's gross income. For this purpose,
copyright royalties shall be computed by excluding royalties received
for the use of, or the right to use, copyrights or interests in
copyrights in works created, in whole or in part, by any person who, at
any time during the corporation's taxable year, is a shareholder.
(b) Personal holding company income for the taxable year must be 10
percent or less of the corporation's gross income. For this purpose,
personal holding company income shall be computed by excluding (1)
copyright royalties (except that there shall be included royalties
received for the use of, or the right to use, copyrights or interests in
copyrights in works created, in whole or in part, by any shareholder
owning, at any time during the corporation's taxable year, more than 10
percent in value of the outstanding stock of the corporation), and (2)
dividends from any corporation in which the taxpayer owns, on the date
the taxpayer becomes entitled to the dividends, at least 50 percent of
all classes of stock entitled to vote and at least 50 percent of the
total value of all classes of stock, provided the corporation which pays
the dividends meets the requirements of subparagraphs (A), (B), and (C)
of section 543(a)(9).
(c) The aggregate amount of the deductions allowable under section
162 must constitute 50 percent or more of the corporation's gross income
for the taxable year. For this purpose, the deductions allowable under
section 162 shall be computed by excluding deductions for compensation
for personal services rendered by, and deductions for copyright and
other royalties to, shareholders of the corporation.
(iii) Determination of stock value and stock ownership. For purposes
of section 543(a)(9) and this subparagraph, the following rules shall
apply:
(a) The amount and value of the outstanding stock of a corporation
shall be determined in accordance with the rules set forth in the last
two sentences of paragraph (b) and in paragraph (c) of Sec. 1.542-3.
(b) The ownership of stock shall be determined in accordance with
the rules set forth in section 544 and Sec. Sec. 1.544-1 through 1.544-
7.
(c) Any person who is considered to own stock within the meaning of
section 544 and Sec. Sec. 1.544-1 through 1.544-7 shall be a
shareholder.
(iv) Copyright royalties defined. For purposes of section 543(a)(9)
and this subparagraph, the term copyright royalties means compensation,
however designated, for the use of, or the right to use, copyrights in
works protected by copyright issued under title 17 of the United States
Code (other than by reason of section 2 or 6 thereof), and to which
copyright protection is also extended by the laws of any foreign country
as a result of any international treaty, convention, or agreement to
which the United States is a signatory. Thus, copyright royalties
includes not only royalties from sources within the United States under
protection of United States laws relating to statutory copyrights but
also royalties from sources within a foreign country with respect to
United States statutory copyrights protected in such foreign country by
any international treaty, convention, or agreement to which the United
States is a signatory. The term copyright royalties includes
compensation for the use of, or right to use, an interest in any such
copyrighted works as well as payments from any person for performing
rights in any such copyrighted works.
(v) Compensation which is rent. Section 543(a)(9) and subdivisions
(i) through (iv) of this subparagraph shall not apply to compensation
which is
[[Page 269]]
rent within the meaning of the second sentence of section 543(a)(7).
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6739, 29 FR
7713, June 17, 1964; T.D. 7261, 38 FR 5467, Mar. 1, 1973]
Sec. 1.543-2 Limitation on gross income and personal holding company
income in transactions involving stocks, securities, and commodities.
(a) Under section 543(b)(1) the gains which are to be included in
gross income, and in personal holding company income with respect to
transactions described in section 543(a)(2) and paragraph (b)(5) of
Sec. 1.543-1, shall be the net gains from the sale or exchange of stock
or securities. If there is an excess of losses over gains from such
transactions, such excess (or net loss) shall not be used to reduce
gross income or personal holding company income for purposes of the
personal holding company tax. Similarly, under section 543(b)(2) the
gains which are to be included in gross income, and in personal holding
company income with respect to transactions described in section
543(a)(3) and paragraph (b)(6) of Sec. 1.543-1, shall be the net gains
from commodity transactions which reflect personal holding company
income. Any excess of losses over gains from such transactions
(resulting in a net loss) shall not be used to reduce gross income or
personal holding company income. The capital loss carryover under
section 1212 shall not be taken into account.
(b) The application of section 543(b) may be illustrated by the
following examples:
Example 1. The P Corporation, not a regular dealer in stocks and
securities, received rentals of $250,000 for its property from a 25-
percent shareholder, and also had gains of $50,000 during the taxable
year from the sale of stocks and securities. It also had losses on the
sale of stocks and securities in the amount of $30,000. Accordingly, P
Corporation had gross income during the taxable year of $270,000
($250,000 plus $20,000 net gain from the sales of stocks and
securities). It had personal holding company income of $20,000. (The
rentals of $250,000 would not be personal holding company income under
section 543(a)(6) since the personal holding company income of the
corporation, $20,000 (after excluding any such income described in
section 543(a)(6)), is not more than 10 percent of its gross income.)
Example 2. The R Corporation, not a regular dealer in stocks or
securities, realized total gains during the taxable year of $900,000
from commodity futures transactions and $200,000 from the sales of
stocks and securities. It also sustained total losses of $1,000,000 on
such commodity futures transactions, resulting in a net gain for the
taxable year or $100,000. None of the commodity futures transactions are
hedging or other types of futures transactions excluded from the
application of section 543(a)(3). No part of the loss on commodity
futures transactions is to be taken into account in determining personal
holding company income and gross income for personal holding company tax
purposes for the taxable year. The full amount of the $200,000 in gains
from the sales of stocks and securities is to be included in personal
holding company income and in gross income for personal holding company
tax purposes for the taxable year.
Sec. 1.544-1 Constructive ownership.
(a) Rules relating to the constructive ownership of stock are
provided by section 544 for the purpose of determining whether the stock
ownership requirements of the following sections are satisfied:
(1) Section 542(a)(2), relating to ownership of stock by five or
fewer individuals.
(2) Section 543(a)(5), relating to personal holding company income
derived from personal service contracts.
(3) Section 543(a)(6), relating to personal holding company income
derived from property used by shareholders.
(4) Section 543(a)(9), relating to personal holding company income
derived from copyright royalties.
(b) Section 544 provides four general rules with respect to
constructive ownership. These rules are:
(1) Constructive ownership by reason of indirect ownership. See
section 544(a)(1) and Sec. 1.544-2.
(2) Constructive ownership by reason of family and partnership
ownership. See section 544(a) (2), (4), (5), and (6), and Sec. Sec.
1.544-3, 1.544-6, and 1.544-7.
(3) Constructive ownership by reason of ownership of options. See
section 544(a) (3), (4), (5), and (6), and Sec. Sec. 1.544-4, 1.544-6,
and 1.544-7.
(4) Constructive ownership by reason of ownership of convertible
securities. See section 544(b) and Sec. 1.544-5.
[[Page 270]]
Each of the rules referred to in subparagraphs (2), (3), and (4) of this
paragraph is applicable only if it has the effect of satisfying the
stock ownership requirement of the section to which applicable; that is,
when applied to section 542(a)(2), its effect is to make the corporation
a personal holding company, or when applied to section 543(a)(5),
section 543(a)(6), or section 543(a)(9), its effect is to make the
amounts described in such provisions includible as personal holding
company income.
(c) All forms and classes of stock, however denominated, which
represent the interests of shareholders, members, or beneficiaries in
the corporation shall be taken into consideration in applying the
constructive ownership rules of section 544.
(d) For rules applicable in treating constructive ownership,
determined by one application of section 544, as actual ownership for
purposes of a second application of section 544, see section 544(a)(5)
and Sec. 1.544-6.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6739, 29 FR
7715, June 17, 1964]
Sec. 1.544-2 Constructive ownership by reason of indirect ownership.
The following example illustrates the application of section
544(a)(1), relating to constructive ownership by reason of indirect
ownership:
Example. A and B, two individuals, are the exclusive and equal
beneficiaries of a trust or estate which owns the entire capital stock
of the M Corporation. The M Corporation in turn owns the entire capital
stock of the N Corporation. Under such circumstances the entire capital
stock of both the M Corporation and the N Corporation shall be
considered as being owned equally by A and B as the individuals owning
the beneficial interest therein.
Sec. 1.544-3 Constructive ownership by reason of family and partnership
ownership.
(a) The following example illustrates the application of section
544(a)(2), relating to constructive ownership by reason of family and
partnership ownership.
Example. The M Corporation at some time during the last half of the
taxable year, had 1,800 shares of outstanding stock, 450 of which were
held by various individuals having no relationship to one another and
none of whom were partners, and the remaining 1,350 were held by 51
shareholders as follows:
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Relationships Shares Shares Shares Shares Shares
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
An individual................... (A)100 (B)20 (C)20 (D)20 (E)20
His father...................... (AF)10 (BF)10 (CF)10 (DF)10 (EF)10
His wife........................ (AW)10 (BW)40 (CW)40 (DW)40 (EW)40
His brother..................... (AB)10 (BB)10 (CB)10 (DB)10 (EB)10
His son......................... (AS)10 (BS)40 (CS)40 (DS)40 (ES)40
His daughter by former marriage
(son's.........................
half-sister)................. (ASHS)10 (BSHS)40 (CSHS)40 (DSHS)40 (ESHS)40
His brother's wife.............. (ABW)10 (BBW)10 (CBW)10 (DBW)160 (EBW)10
His wife's father............... (AWF)10 (BWF)10 (CWF)110 (DWF)10 (EWF)10
His wife's brother.............. (AWB)10 (BWB)10 (CWB)10 (DWB)10 (EWB)10
His wife's brother's wife....... (AWBW)10 (BWBW)10 (CWBW)10 (DWBW)10 (EWBW)110
Individual's partner............ (AP)10 .............. .............. .............. ..............
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
By applying the statutory rule provided in section 544(a)(2) five
individuals own more than 50 percent of the outstanding stock as
follows:
A (including AF, AW, AB, AS, ASHS, AP).......................... 160
B (including BF, BW, BB, BS, BSHS).............................. 160
CW (including C, CS, CWF, CWB).................................. 220
DB (including D, DF, DBW)....................................... 200
EWB (including EW, EWF, EWBW)................................... 170
-------
Total, or more than 50 percent.............................. 910
Individual A represents the obvious case where the head of the family
owns the bulk of the family stock and naturally is the head of the
group. A's partner owns 10 shares of the stock. Individual B represents
the case where he is still head of the group because of the ownership of
stock by his immediate family. Individuals C and D represent cases where
the individuals fall in groups headed in C's case by his wife and in D's
case by his brother because of the preponderance of holdings on the part
of relatives by marriage. Individual E represents the case where the
preponderant holdings of others eliminate that individual from the
group.
[[Page 271]]
(b) For the restriction on the applicability of the family and
partnership ownership rules of this section, see paragraph (b) of Sec.
1.544-1. For rules relating to constructive ownership as actual
ownership, see Sec. 1.544-6.
Sec. 1.544-4 Options.
The shares of stock which may be acquired by reason of an option
shall be considered to be constructively owned by the individual having
the option to acquire such stock. For example: If C, an individual, on
March 1, 1955, purchases an option, or otherwise comes into possession
of an option, to acquire 100 shares of the capital stock of M
Corporation, such 100 shares of stock shall be considered to be
constructively owned by C as if C had actually acquired the stock on
that date. If C has an option on an option (or one of a series of
options) to acquire such stock, he shall also be considered to have
constructive ownership of the stock which may be acquired by reason of
the option (or the series of options). Under such circumstances, C shall
be considered to have acquired constructive ownership of the stock on
the date he acquired his option. For the restriction on the
applicability of the rule of this section, see paragraph (b) of Sec.
1.544-1.
Sec. 1.544-5 Convertible securities.
Under section 544(b) outstanding securities of a corporation such as
bonds, debentures, or other corporate obligations, convertible into
stock of the corporation (whether or not convertible during the taxable
year) shall be considered as outstanding stock of the corporation. The
consideration of convertible securities as outstanding stock is subject
to the exception that, if some of the outstanding securities are
convertible only after a later date than in the case of others, the
class having the earlier conversion date may be considered as
outstanding stock although the others are not so considered, but no
convertible securities shall be considered as outstanding stock unless
all outstanding securities having a prior conversion date are also so
considered. For example, if outstanding securities are convertible in
1954, 1955 and 1956, those convertible in 1954 can be properly
considered as outstanding stock without so considering those convertible
in 1955 or 1956, and those convertible in 1954 and 1955 can be properly
considered as outstanding stock without so considering those convertible
in 1956. However, the securities convertible in 1955 could not be
properly considered as outstanding stock without so considering those
convertible in 1954 and the securities convertible in 1956 could not be
properly considered as outstanding stock without so considering those
convertible in 1954 and 1955. For the restriction on the applicability
of the rule of this section, see paragraph (b) of Sec. 1.544-1.
Sec. 1.544-6 Constructive ownership as actual ownership.
(a) General rules. (1) Stock constructively owned by a person by
reason of the application of the rule provided in section 544(a)(1),
relating to stock not owned by an individual, shall be considered as
actually owned by such person for the purpose of again applying such
rule or of applying the family and partnership rule provided in section
544(a)(2), in order to make another person the constructive owner of
such stock, and
(2) Stock constructively owned by a person by reason of the
application of the option rule provided in section 544(a)(3) shall be
considered as actually owned by such person for the purpose of applying
either the rule provided in section 544(a)(1), relating to stock not
owned by an individual, or the family and partnership rule provided in
section 544(a)(2) in order to make another person the constructive owner
of such stock, but
(3) Stock constructively owned by an individual by reason of the
application of the family and partnership rule provided in section
544(a)(2) shall not be considered as actually owned by such individual
for the purpose of again applying such rule in order to make another
individual the constructive owner of such stock.
(b) Examples. The application of this section may be illustrated by
the following examples:
Example 1. A's wife, AW, owns all the stock of the M Corporation,
which in turn owns all the stock of the O Corporation. The O Corporation
in turn owns all the stock of the P
[[Page 272]]
Corporation. Under the rule provided in section 544(a)(1), relating to
stock not owned by an individual, the stock in the P Corporation owned
by the O Corporation is considered to be owned constructively by the M
Corporation, the sole shareholder of the O Corporation. Such
constructive ownership of the stock of the M Corporation is considered
as actual ownership for the purpose of again applying such rule in order
to make AW, the sole shareholder of the M Corporation, the constructive
owner of the stock of the P Corporation. Similarly, the constructive
ownership of the stock by AW is considered as actual ownership for the
purpose of applying the family and partnership rule provided in section
544(a)(2) in order to make A the constructive owner of the stock of the
P Corporation, if such application is necessary for any of the purposes
set forth in paragraph (b) of Sec. 1.544-1. But the stock thus
constructively owned by A may not be considered as actual ownership for
the purpose of again applying the family and partnership rule in order
to make another member of A's family, for example, A's father, the
constructive owner of the stock of the P Corporation.
Example 2. B, an individual, owns all the stock of the R Corporation
which has an option to acquire all the stock of the S Corporation, owned
by C, an individual, who is not related to B. Under the option rule
provided in section 544(a)(3) the R Corporation may be considered as
owning constructively the stock of the S Corporation owned by C. Such
constructive ownership of the stock by the R Corporation is considered
as actual ownership for the purpose of applying the rule provided in
section 544(a)(1), relating to stock not owned by an individual, in
order to make B, the sole shareholder of the R Corporation, the
constructive owner of the stock of the S Corporation. The stock thus
constructively owned by B by reason of the application of the rule
provided in section 544(a)(1) likewise is considered as actual ownership
for the purpose, if necessary, of applying the family and partnership
rule provided in section 544(a)(2), in order to make another member of
B's family, for example, B's wife, BW, the constructive owner of the
stock of the S Corporation. However, the family and partnership rule
could not again be applied so as to make still another individual the
constructive owner of the stock of the S Corporation, that is, the stock
constructively owned by BW could not be considered as actually owned by
her in order to make BW's father the constructive owner of such stock by
a second application of the family and partnership rule.
Sec. 1.544-7 Option rule in lieu of family and partnership rule.
(a) If, in determining the ownership of stock, such stock may be
considered as constructively owned by an individual by an application of
either the family and partnership rule (section 544(a)(2)) or the option
rule (section 544(a)(3)), such stock shall be considered as owned
constructively by the individual by reason of the application of the
option rule.
(b) The application of this section may be illustrated by the
following example:
Example. Two brothers, A and B, each own 10 percent of the stock of
the M Corporation, and A's wife, AW, also owns 10 percent of the stock
of such corporation. AW's husband, A, has an option to acquire the stock
owned by her at any time. It becomes necessary, for one of the purposes
stated in section 544(a)(4), to determine the stock ownership of B in
the M Corporation. If the family and partnership rule were the only rule
that applied in the case, B would be considered, under that rule, as
owning 20 percent of the stock of the M Corporation, namely, his own
stock plus the stock owned by his brother. In that event, B could not be
considered as owning the stock held by AW since (1) AW is not a member
of B's family and (2) the constructive ownership of such stock by A
through the application of the family and partnership rule in his case
is not considered as actual ownership so as to make B the constructive
owner by a second application of the same rule with respect to the
ownership of the stock. However, there is more than the family and
partnership rule involved in this example. As the holder of an option
upon the stock, A may be considered the constructive owner of his wife's
stock by the application of the option rule and without reference to the
family relationship between A and AW. If A is considered as owning the
stock of his wife by application of the option rule, then such
constructive ownership by A is regarded as actual ownership for the
purpose of applying the family and partnership rule so as to make
another member of A's family, for example, B, the constructive owner of
the stock. Hence, since A may be considered as owning his wife's stock
by applying either the family-partnership rule or the option rule, the
provisions of section 544(a)(6) apply and accordingly A must be
considered the constructive owner of his wife's stock under the option
rule rather than the family-partnership rule. B thus becomes the
constructive owner of 30 percent of the stock of the M corporation,
namely, his own 10 percent, A's 10 percent, and AW's 10 percent
constructively owned by A as the holder of an option on the stock.
[[Page 273]]
Sec. 1.545-1 Definition.
(a) Undistributed personal holding company income is the amount
which is subject to the personal holding company tax imposed under
section 541. Undistributed personal holding company income is the
taxable income of the corporation adjusted in the manner described in
section 545(b) and Sec. 1.545-2, and section 545(c) and Sec. 1.545-3,
less the deduction for dividends paid. See part IV (section 561 and
following), subchapter G, chapter 1 of the Code, and the regulations
thereunder, relating to the dividends paid deduction.
(b) For purposes of the imposition of the personal holding company
tax on a foreign corporation, resident or nonresident, which files or
causes to be filed a return, the undistributed personal holding company
income shall be computed on the basis of the taxable income from sources
within the United States, and such income shall be adjusted in
accordance with the principles of section 545(b) and Sec. 1.545-2, and
section 545(c) and Sec. 1.545-3. For purposes of the imposition of such
tax on a foreign corporation, resident or nonresident, which files no
return, the undistributed personal holding company income shall be
computed on the basis of the gross income from sources within the United
States without allowance of any deductions. For purposes of this
paragraph, a nonresident foreign corporation will be considered to have
filed a return for any taxable year ending before September 9, 1958, if
the return for any such taxable year is filed on or before February 5,
1960.
[T.D. 6949, 33 FR 5525, Apr. 9, 1968]
Sec. 1.545-2 Adjustments to taxable income.
(a) Taxes--(1) General rule. (i) In computing undistributed personal
holding company income for any taxable year, there shall be allowed as a
deduction the amount by which Federal income and excess profits taxes
accrued during the taxable year exceed the credit provided by section 33
(relating to taxes of foreign countries and possessions of the United
States), and the income, war profits, and excess profits taxes of
foreign countries and possessions of the United States accrued during
the taxable year (to the extent provided by subparagraph (3) of this
paragraph), except that no deduction shall be allowed for (a) the
accumulated earnings tax imposed by section 531 (or a corresponding
section of a prior law), (b) the personal holding company tax imposed by
section 541 (or a corresponding section of a prior law), and (c) the
excess profits tax imposed by subchapter E, chapter 2 of the Internal
Revenue Code of 1939, for taxable years beginning after December 31,
1940. The deduction is for taxes for the taxable year, determined under
the accrual method of accounting, regardless of whether the corporation
uses an accrual method of accounting, the cash receipts and disbursement
method, or any other allowable method of accounting. In computing the
amount of taxes accrued, an unpaid tax which is being contested is not
considered accrued until the contest is resolved.
(ii) However, the taxpayer shall deduct taxes paid, rather than
taxes accrued, if it used that method with respect to Federal taxes for
each taxable year for which it was subject to the tax imposed by section
500 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1939, unless an election is made
under subparagraph (2) of this paragraph to deduct taxes accrued.
(2) Election by taxpayer which deducted taxes paid. (i) If the
corporation was subject to the personal holding company tax imposed by
section 500 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1939 and, for the purpose of
that tax, deducted Federal taxes paid rather than such taxes accrued for
each taxable year for which it was subject to such taxes, the
corporation may elect for any taxable year ending after June 30, 1954,
to deduct taxes accrued, including taxes of foreign countries and
possessions of the United States, rather than taxes paid, for the
purposes of the tax imposed by section 541 of the Internal Revenue Code
of 1954. The election shall be made by deducting such taxes accrued on
Schedule PH, Form 1120, to be filed with the return. The schedule shall,
in addition, contain a statement that the corporation has made such
election and shall set forth the year to which such election was first
applicable. The deduction of taxes accrued in the year of election
precludes the deduction of
[[Page 274]]
taxes paid during such year. The election, if made, shall be irrevocable
and the deduction for taxes accrued shall be allowed for the year of
election and for all subsequent taxable years.
(ii) Pursuant to section 7851(a)(1)(C), the election provided for in
subdivision (i) of this subparagraph may be made with respect to a
taxable year ending after June 30, 1954, even though such taxable year
is subject to the Internal Revenue Code of 1939.
(3) Taxes of foreign countries and United States possessions. In
determining undistributed personal holding company income for any
taxable year, if the taxpayer chooses the benefits of section 901 for
such taxable year, a deduction shall be allowed for:
(i) The income, war profits, and excess profits taxes imposed by
foreign countries or possessions of the United States and accrued (or
paid, if required under subparagraph (1)(ii) of this paragraph) during
such taxable year, and
(ii) In the case of a domestic corporation, the foreign income taxes
deemed to be paid for such taxable year under section 902(a) in
accordance with Sec. Sec. 1.902-1 and 1.902-2 or section 960(a)(1) in
accordance with Sec. 1.960-7.
In no event shall the amount under subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph
exceed the amount includible in gross income with respect to such taxes
under section 78 and Sec. 1.78-1. The credit for such taxes provided by
section 901 shall not be allowed against the personal holding company
tax imposed by section 541. See section 901(a).
(b) Charitable contributions--(1) Taxable years beginning before
January 1, 1970. (i) Section 545(b)(2) provides that, in computing the
deduction for charitable contributions for purposes of determining
undistributed personal holding company income of a corporation for
taxable years beginning before January 1, 1970, the limitations in
section 170(b)(1) (A) and (B), relating to charitable contributions by
individuals, shall apply and section 170(b) (2) and (5), relating to
charitable contributions by corporations and carryover of certain excess
charitable contributions made by individuals, respectively, shall not
apply.
(ii) Although the limitations of section 170(b)(1) (A) and (B) are
10 and 20 percent, respectively, of the individual's adjusted gross
income, the limitations are applied for purposes of section 545(b)(2) by
using 10 and 20 percent, respectively, of the corporation's taxable
income as adjusted for purposes of section 170(b)(2), that is, the same
amount of taxable income to which the 5-percent limitation applied.
Thus, the term adjusted gross income when used in section 170(b)(1)
means the corporation's taxable income computed with the adjustments,
other than the 5-percent limitation, provided in the first sentence of
section 170(b)(2). However, a further adjustment for this purpose is
that the taxable income shall also be computed without the deduction of
the amount disallowed under section 545(b)(8), relating to expenses and
depreciation applicable to property of the taxpayer. The carryover of
charitable contributions made in a prior year, otherwise allowable as a
deduction in computing taxable income to the extent provided in section
170(b)(2) and, with respect to contributions paid in taxable years
beginning after December 31, 1963, in section 170(b)(5), shall not be
allowed as a deduction in computing undistributed personal holding
company income for any taxable year.
(iii) See Sec. 1.170-2 with respect to the charitable contributions
to which the 10-percent limitation is applicable and the charitable
contributions to which the 20-percent limitation is applicable.
(2) Taxable years beginning after December 31, 1969. (i) Section
545(b)(2) provides that, in computing the deduction allowable for
charitable contributions for purposes of determining undistributed
personal holding company income of a corporation for taxable years
beginning after December 31, 1969, the limitations in section 170(b)(1)
(A), (B), and (D)(i) (relating to charitable contributions by
individuals) shall apply, and section 170(b)(1)(D)(ii) (relating to
excess charitable contributions by individuals of certain capital gain
property, section 170(b)(2) (relating to the 5-percent limitation on
charitable contributions by corporations), and section 170(d) (relating
to carryovers of excess contributions of individuals and corporations)
shall not apply.
[[Page 275]]
(ii) Although the limitations of section 170(b)(1) (A), (B), and
(D)(i) are 50, 20, and 30 percent, respectively, of an individual's
contribution base, these limitations are applied for purposes of section
545(b)(2) by using 50, 20, and 30 percent, respectively, of the
corporation's taxable income as adjusted for purposes of section
170(b)(2), that is, the same amount of taxable income to which the 5-
percent limitation applies. Thus, the term contribution base when used
in section 170(b)(1) means the corporation's taxable income computed
with the adjustments, other than the 5-percent limitation, provided in
section 170(b)(2). However, a further adjustment for this purpose is
that the taxable income shall also be computed without the deduction of
the amount disallowed under section 545(b)(8), relating to expenses and
depreciation applicable to property of the taxpayer. The carryover of
charitable contributions made in a prior year, otherwise allowable as a
deduction in computing taxable income to the extent provided in section
170(b)(1)(D)(ii) and (d), shall not be allowed as a deduction in
computing undistributed personal holding company income for any taxable
year.
(iii) See Sec. 1.170A-8 for the rules with respect to the
charitable contributions to which the 50-, 20-, and 30-percent
limitations apply.
(c) Special deductions disallowed. Part VIII, subchapter B, chapter
1 of the Code, allows corporations, in computing taxable income, special
deductions for such matters as partially tax- exempt interest, certain
dividends received, dividends paid on certain preferred stock of public
utilities, organizational expenses, etc. See section 241. Such special
deductions, except the deduction provided by section 248 (relating to
organizational expenses) shall be disallowed in computing undistributed
personal holding company income.
(d) Net operating loss. The net operating loss deduction provided in
section 172 is not allowed for purposes of the computation of
undistributed personal holding company income. For purposes of such a
computation, however, there is allowed as a deduction the amount of the
net operating loss (as defined in section 172(c)) for the preceding
taxable year, except that, in computing undistributed personal holding
company income for a taxable year beginning after December 31, 1957, the
amount of such net operating loss shall be computed without the
deductions provided in part VIII (section 241 and following, except
section 248), subchapter B, chapter 1 of the Code.
(e) Long-term capital gains. (1) There is allowed as a deduction the
excess of the net long-term capital gain for the taxable year over the
net short-term capital loss for such year, minus the taxes attributable
to such excess, as provided in section 545(b)(5).
(2) Section 631(c) (relating to gain or loss in the case of disposal
of coal or domestic iron ore) shall have no application.
(f) Bank affiliates. There is allowed the deduction provided by
section 601 in the case of bank affiliates (as defined in section 2 of
the Banking Act of 1933; 12 U.S.C. 221a (c)).
(g) Payment of indebtedness incurred prior to January 1, 1934--(1)
General rule. In computing undistributed personal holding company
income, section 545(b)(7) provides that there shall be allowed as a
deduction amounts used or irrevocably set aside to pay or to retire
indebtedness of any kind incurred before January 1, 1934, if such
amounts are reasonable with reference to the size and terms of such
indebtedness. See Sec. 1.545-3 for the deduction in computing
undistributed personal holding company income of amounts used or
irrevocably set aside to pay or retire qualified indebtedness (as
defined in paragraph (d) of Sec. 1.545-3).
(2) Indebtedness. The term indebtedness means an obligation absolute
and not contingent, to pay on demand or within a given time, in cash or
other medium, a fixed amount. The term indebtedness does not include the
obligation of a corporation on its capital stock. The indebtedness must
have been incurred (or, if incurred by assumption, assumed) by the
taxpayer before January 1, 1934. An indebtedness evidenced by bonds,
notes, or other obligations issued by a corporation is ordinarily
incurred as of the date such obligations are issued and the amount
[[Page 276]]
of such indebtedness is the amount represented by the face value of the
obligations. In the case of refunding, renewal, or other change in the
form of an indebtedness, the giving of a new promise to pay by the
taxpayer will not have the effect of changing the date the indebtedness
was incurred.
(3) Amounts used or irrevocably set aside. The deduction is
allowable, in any taxable year, only for amounts used or irrevocably set
aside in that year. The use or irrevocable setting aside must be to
effect the extinguishment or discharge of indebtedness. In the case of
refunding, renewal, or other change in the form of an indebtedness, the
mere giving of a new promise to pay by the taxpayer will not result in
an allowable deduction. If amounts are set aside in one year, no
deduction is allowable for such amounts for a later year in which
actually paid. As long as all other conditions are satisfied, the
aggregate amount allowable as a deduction for any taxable year includes
all amounts (from whatever source) used and all amounts (from whatever
source) irrevocably set aside, irrespective of whether in cash or other
medium. Double deductions shall not be allowed.
(4) Reasonableness of the amounts with reference to the size and
terms of the indebtedness. (i) The reasonableness of the amounts used or
irrevocably set aside must be determined by reference to the size and
terms of the particular indebtedness. Hence, all the facts and
circumstances with respect to the nature, scope, conditions, amount,
maturity, and other terms of the particular indebtedness must be shown
in each case.
(ii) Ordinarily an amount used to pay or retire an indebtedness, in
whole or in part, at or prior to the maturity and in accordance with the
terms thereof will be considered reasonable, and may be allowable as a
deduction for the year in which so used. However, if an amount has been
set aside in a prior year for payment or retirement of the same
indebtedness, the amount so set aside shall not be allowed as a
deduction in the year of the payment.
(iii) All amounts irrevocably set aside for the payment or
retirement of an indebtedness in accordance with and pursuant to the
terms of the obligation, for example, the annual contribution to
trustees required by the provisions of a mandatory sinking fund
agreement, will be considered as complying with the requirement of
reasonableness. To be considered reasonable, it is not necessary that
the plan of retirement provide for a retroactive setting aside of
amounts for years prior to that in which the plan is adopted. However,
if a voluntary plan was adopted before 1934, no adjustment is allowable
in respect of the amounts set aside in the years prior to 1934.
(5) Burden of proof. The burden of proof will rest upon the taxpayer
to sustain the deduction claimed. Therefore, the taxpayer must furnish
the information required by the return, and such other information as
the district director may require in substantiation of the deduction
claimed.
(6) Allowance to a successor corporation. For allowance of deduction
for pre-1934 indebtedness to a successor corporation, see section
381(c)(15).
(h) Expenses and depreciation applicable to property of the
taxpayer. (1) In computing undistributed personal holding company income
in the case of a personal holding company which owns or operates
property, section 545(b)(8) provides a specific limitation with respect
to the allowance of deductions for trade or business expenses and
depreciation allocable to the operation or maintenance of such property.
Under this limitation, these deductions shall not be allowed in an
amount in excess of the aggregate amount of the rent or other
compensation received for the use of, or the right to use, the property,
unless it is established to the satisfaction of the Commissioner:
(i) That the rent or other compensation received was the highest
obtainable, or if none was received, that none was obtainable;
(ii) That the property was held in the course of a business carried
on bona fide for profit; and
(iii) Either that there was reasonable expectation that the
operation of the property would result in a profit, or that the property
was necessary to the conduct of the business.
(2) The burden of proof will rest upon the taxpayer to sustain the
deduction
[[Page 277]]
claimed. If, in computing undistributed personal holding company income,
a personal holding company claims deductions for expenses and
depreciation allocable to the operation and maintenance of property
owned or operated by the company, in an aggregate amount in excess of
the rent or other compensation received for the use of, or the right to
use, the property, it shall attach to its income tax return a statement
setting forth its claim for allowance of the additional deductions,
together with a complete statement of the facts and circumstances
pertinent to its claim and the arguments on which it relies. Such
statement shall set forth:
(i) A description of the property;
(ii) The cost or other basis to the corporation and the nature and
value of the consideration paid for the property;
(iii) The name and address of the person from whom the property was
acquired and the date the property was acquired;
(iv) The name and address of the person to whom the property is
leased or rented, or the person permitted to use the property, and the
number of shares of stock, if any, held by such person and the members
of his family;
(v) The nature and gross amount of the rent or other compensation
received for the use of, or the right to use, the property during the
taxable year and for each of the five preceding years and the amount of
the expenses incurred with respect to, and the depreciation sustained
on, the property for such years;
(vi) Evidence that the rent or other compensation was the highest
obtainable or, if none was received, a statement of the reasons
therefore;
(vii) A copy of the contract, lease or rental agreement;
(viii) The purpose for which the property was used;
(ix) The business, carried on by the corporation, with respect to
which the property was held and the gross income, expenses, and taxable
income derived from the conduct of such business for the taxable year
and for each of the five preceding years;
(x) A statement of any reasons which existed for expectation that
the operation of the property would be profitable, or a statement of the
necessity for the use of the property in the business of the
corporation, and the reasons why the property was acquired; and
(xi) Any other information pertinent to the taxpayer's claim.
(i) Amount of a lien in favor of the United States. (1) If notices
of lien are filed in the manner provided in section 6323(f), the amount
of the liability to the United States outstanding at the close of the
taxable year, and secured by such liens which are in effect at that
time, shall be allowed as a deduction in computing undistributed
personal holding company income. However, the amount of such deduction
which may be allowed for any taxable year shall not exceed the taxable
income (as adjusted for purposes of determining the undistributed
personal holding company income, but without regard to the deduction
under section 545(b)(9)) for such year. The fact that the amount of, or
any part of, the outstanding obligation to the United States was
deducted for one taxable year does not prevent its deduction for a
subsequent taxable year to the extent the obligation is still
outstanding at the close of the subsequent taxable year and is secured
by a lien, notice of which has been filed.
(2) Subparagraph (1) of this paragraph may be illustrated by the
following example:
Example. If the taxpayer (on the calendar year basis) is subject to
a lien (notice of which has been properly filed) in the amount of
$500,000 at the close of the calendar year 1954 and has taxable income
of $400,000 for such taxable year, the deduction allowable by reason of
the lien for the calendar year 1954 is $400,000. If, at the close of the
taxable year ended December 31, 1955, the taxpayer is still subject to
the same lien of $500,000 and it has taxable income of $450,000, a
deduction is allowed by reason of such lien in the amount of $450,000.
(3) When the obligation secured by the lien in favor of the United
States has been satisfied or released, the sum of the amounts which have
been allowed as deductions under section 545(b)(9) in respect of such
obligation shall be restored to taxable income for the year in which
such lien is satisfied
[[Page 278]]
or released. If only a part of the obligation secured by the lien has
been satisfied, the sum of the amounts which have been allowed as
deductions under section 545(b)(9) in respect of such part shall be
included in taxable income for the year of the satisfaction for the
purpose of determining undistributed personal holding company income. It
should be noted, however, that only the sum of the amounts which have
been allowed as deductions under section 545(b)(9) and subparagraph (1)
of this paragraph shall be included in taxable income. Thus, any amounts
which were allowed as deductions under section 504(e) of the Internal
Revenue Code of 1939 shall not be included as taxable income for any
taxable year under section 545(b)(9) and subparagraph (1) of this
paragraph.
(4) The application of subparagraph (3) of this paragraph may be
illustrated by the following example:
Example. Assume the same facts as in the example in subparagraph (2)
of this paragraph, and assume further that the corporation has $100,000
taxable income both for 1956 (before including the $400,000 described
below) and for 1957. In 1956, the corporation pays $200,000 of the
obligation, thereby reducing its liability from $500,000 to $300,000. In
such case, $400,000 is included in taxable income in computing its
undistributed personal holding company income for 1956, that is, the sum
of the $200,000 deduction for 1954 and the $200,000 deduction for 1955
in respect of the liability which is paid in 1956. In 1957, property of
the corporation is discharged from the lien by reason of the fact that
the value of the remaining property of the corporation exceeds double
the outstanding liability. (See section 6325(b)(1).) Since this was not
a release or satisfaction of the lien, no amount is added to taxable
income for 1957 with respect to the property discharged from the lien.
In 1958, the remaining property is released from the lien by reason of a
bond being accepted under section 6325(a)(2). There is added to taxable
income in computing undistributed personal holding company income for
1958, $850,000, that is, the sum of the deductions allowed for 1954,
1955, 1956, and 1957 in respect of the $300,000 liability, the lien for
which was released in 1958. This amount of $850,000, is computed as
follows:
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Amount
Deduction attributable Amount
Outstanding Taxable as limited to part attributable
Year liability income by taxable payment of to release
income $200,000 in of lien in
1956 1958
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1954........................................... $500,000 $400,000 $400,000 $200,000 $200,000
1955........................................... 500,000 450,000 450,000 200,000 250,000
1956........................................... 300,000 500,000 300,000 ............ 300,000
1957........................................... 300,000 100,000 100,000 ............ 100,000
=============
Total...................................... ........... .......... .......... ............ 850,000
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(5)(i) If an amount has been included in undistributed personal
holding company income of the personal holding company by reason of
section 545(b)(9), any shareholder of the company may elect to compute
his income tax with respect to such of his dividends as are attributable
to such amount as though such dividends were received ratably over the
period the lien was in effect.
(ii) For purposes of section 545(b)(9), the dividends paid during
the taxable year of the personal holding company (computed as of the
close of such year) shall be deemed attributable first to undistributed
personal holding company income by reason of section 545(b)(9) (computed
as of the close of the taxable year of the personal holding company). If
the period over which the lien was in effect consists of several taxable
years of the personal holding company, the dividend deemed received for
any taxable year shall be deemed received on the last day of such
taxable year of the personal holding company.
(iii) Such election shall be made in a statement showing the amount
of the deduction under section 545(b)(9) for each taxable year of the
period in which the lien was in effect, the amount of such deduction, if
any, which was added to undistributed personal holding company income in
a later year or years as a result of partial satisfaction or release of
such lien, and the details thereof, the taxable
[[Page 279]]
year or years to which such dividends are allocable, and a computation
of tax, on the basis of the election, for all taxable years affected by
such ratable allocation of the dividends. Further, the statement shall
show the district director's office in which the returns, for the years
to which the dividends are allocable, were filed, the kind of returns
which were filed (separate returns or joint returns), and the name and
address under which the returns were filed. The statement shall be
attached to the shareholder's return for the taxable year for which the
dividend would be reported but for such election.
(iv) The operation of this subparagraph may be illustrated as
follows: If, in the example under subparagraph (4) of this paragraph,
shareholder A owns 75 percent in value of the outstanding stock of the
personal holding company, and receives a dividend of $540,000 from such
company during 1958 (the total dividend distribution being $720,000) he
may elect to compute his income tax with respect to the $540,000 in
dividends for 1958 as if he had received $127,058.82 of such dividends
for 1954 ($200,000/850,000 of $540,000), $158,823.53 of such dividends
for 1955 ($250,000/850,000 of $540,000), $190,588.23 of such dividends
for 1956 ($300,000/850,000 of $540,000), and $63,529.41 of such
dividends for 1957 ($100,000/850,000 of $540,000). Accordingly, the tax
computed for 1958 with respect to such dividends shall be the aggregate
of the taxes attributable to such amounts had they been distributed in
the respective years.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6805, 30 FR
3209, Mar. 9, 1965; T.D. 6841, 30 FR 9305, July 27, 1965; T.D. 6949, 33
FR 5526, Apr. 9, 1968; T.D. 7207, 37 FR 20796, Oct. 5, 1972; T.D. 7429,
41 FR 35492, Aug. 23, 1976; T.D. 7649, 44 FR 60086, Oct. 18, 1979]
Sec. 1.545-3 Special adjustment to taxable income.
(a) In general. In computing undistributed personal holding company
income for any taxable year beginning after December 31, 1963, section
545(c) (1) provides that, except as otherwise provided in section
545(c), there shall be allowed as a deduction amounts used or amounts
irrevocably set aside (to the extent reasonable with reference to the
size and terms of the indebtedness) during such year to pay or retire
qualified indebtedness (as defined in section 545(c)(3) and paragraph
(d) of this section). The reasonableness of amounts irrevocably set
aside shall be determined under the rules of paragraph (g)(4) of Sec.
1.545-2.
(b) Amounts used or irrevocably set aside--(1) In general. The
deduction is allowable, in any taxable year, only for amounts used or
irrevocably set aside in that year to extinguish or discharge qualified
indebtedness. If amounts are set aside in 1 year, no deduction is
allowable for a later year in which such amounts are actually paid. As
long as all other conditions are satisfied, the aggregate amount
allowable as a deduction for any taxable year includes all amounts (from
whatever source) used and all amounts (from whatever source) irrevocably
set aside, irrespective of whether in cash or other medium. The same
item shall not be deducted more than once.
(2) Refunding, etc., of qualified indebtedness. (i) A refunding,
renewal or mere change in the form of a qualified indebtedness which
does not involve a substantial change in the economic terms of the
indebtedness will not result in an allowable deduction whether or not
funds are obtained from such refunding, renewal, or change in form, and
whether or not such funds are applied on the prior obligation, and will
not constitute a reduction in the amount of such qualified indebtedness.
For purposes of this section, if, in connection with a refunding,
renewal, or other change in the form of an indebtedness, the rate of
interest or principal amount of such debt, or the date when payment is
due with respect to such debt or significantly changed, or if, after the
refunding, renewal, or other change in the form of such debt, the
creditor to whom such debt is owed is neither the creditor to whom such
debt was owed before such refunding, renewal, or other change, nor a
person standing in a relationship to such creditor described in section
267(b), then a substantial change in the economic terms of such
indebtedness will normally have occurred.
[[Page 280]]
(ii) The application of this subparagraph may be illustrated by the
following examples:
Example 1. On December 31, 1963, M owes $10,000 to X represented by
a 6-percent, 90-day note payable on January 31, 1964. On January 31,
1964, M renews the debt, giving X a new 6-percent, 90-day note (payable
on Apr. 30, 1964) and paying the accrued interest on the old note. Since
the date when payment is due has been significantly changed, a
substantial change in the economic terms of the indebtedness has
occurred.
Example 2. On December 31, 1963, S owes $5,000 to T represented by a
6-percent note payable on January 1, 1965. On December 23, 1964, S
liquidates the note, giving T a new note for $5,000 due on January 2,
1965, and bearing interest at 6 percent. Since the transaction does not
involve a substantial change in the economic terms of the indebtedness,
the transaction will not result in an allowable deduction, and the
amount of the qualified indebtedness will not be reduced.
Example 3. (i) On December 31, 1963, Q owes $45,000 to R represented
by a demand note. On July 1, 1964, Q renews $30,000 of the indebtedness
by issuing a new demand note to R and liquidates $15,000 of the debt.
Since the principal amount of the debt has been significantly changed,
there has been a substantial change in the economic terms of the
indebtedness.
(ii) If Q had issued renewal notes for $44,000 and had paid only
$1,000 of the total indebtedness, then a significant change in the
principal amount of the debt would not have occurred and Q would have
been entitled to only a $1,000 deduction (the amount actually paid
during the taxable year). In addition, the amount of qualified
indebtedness would have been reduced to $44,000.
(c) Corporations to which applicable. Section 545(c)(2) describes
the corporations to which section 545(c) applies. In order to qualify
under section 545(c)(2), the corporation must be one:
(1) Which for at least one of its two most recent taxable years
ending before February 26, 1964, was not a personal holding company
under section 542, but which would have been a personal holding company
under section 542 for such taxable year if the law applicable for the
first taxable year beginning after December 31, 1963, had been
applicable to such taxable year; or
(2) Which is an acquiring corporation treated as a corporation
described in subparagraph (1) of this paragraph by reason of section
381(c)(15) (relating to the carryover of certain indebtedness in
corporate acquisitions), but only to the extent of the qualified
indebtedness to which it has succeeded under section 381(c)(15) and the
indebtedness referred to in paragraph (d)(1)(ii) of this section
incurred to replace qualified indebtedness to which it has succeeded
under section 381(c)(15)
The law applicable for the first taxable year beginning after December
31, 1963, for purposes of this paragraph means part II (section 541 and
following), subchapter G, chapter 1 of the Code as applicable to such
year but does not include amendments to other parts of the Code first
applicable with respect to such year. For an example of a corporation
described in subparagraph (1) of this paragraph see paragraph (f)(1) of
Sec. 1.333-5.
(d) Qualified indebtedness--(1) General definition. Except as
provided in subparagraphs (2), (3), and (4) of this paragraph the term
qualified indebtedness means:
(i) The outstanding indebtedness (as defined in subparagraph (6) of
this paragraph) incurred after December 31, 1933, and before January 1,
1964, by the taxpayer (or to which the taxpayer succeeded in a
transaction to which section 381(c)(15) applies), and
(ii) The outstanding indebtedness (as defined in subparagraph (6) of
this paragraph) incurred after December 31, 1963, by the taxpayer (or to
which the taxpayer succeeded in a transaction to which section
381(c)(15) applies) for the purpose of making a payment or set-aside
referred to in paragraph (a) of this section in the same taxable year of
the debtor in which such indebtedness was incurred. An indebtedness
shall be deemed not to have been incurred for the purpose of making a
payment or set-aside referred to in paragraph (a) of this section when
such indebtedness is a consequence of a refunding, renewal or mere
change in the form of a qualified indebtedness which does not involve a
substantial change in the economic terms of the qualified indebtedness.
(See paragraph (b)(2) of this section for the meaning of substantial
change in the economic terms of the indebtedness.) In the case of such a
payment or set-aside which is made on or after the first day of the
first taxable year beginning after December 31, 1963,
[[Page 281]]
such indebtedness incurred after December 31, 1963, is treated as
qualified indebtedness only to the extent that the deduction from
taxable income otherwise allowed by section 545(c)(1) with respect to
such payment or set-aside is treated as non-deductible by reason of the
election referred to in paragraph (e) of this section.
(2) Exception for indebtedness owed to certain shareholders. For
purposes of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph, qualified indebtedness
does not include any amounts which were, at any time after December 31,
1963, and before the payment or set-aside to which this section applies,
owed directly or indirectly to a person who at such time owned more than
10 percent in value of the taxpayer's outstanding stock. The rules of
section 318(a) and the regulations thereunder apply for the purpose of
determining ownership under this subparagraph. Amounts which cease to be
qualified indebtedness by reason of this subparagraph may not
subsequently become qualified indebtedness as a result of any change in
the facts (for example, a subsequent sale of stock by the person to whom
the amounts are directly or indirectly owed).
(3) Reduction for amounts irrevocably set aside. For purposes of
subparagraph (1) of this paragraph, qualified indebtedness with respect
to a particular contract is reduced when and to the extent that amounts
are irrevocably set aside to pay or retire such indebtedness. An amount
is not considered to be irrevocably set aside if any person could use
such amount for any purpose other than the retirement of the qualified
indebtedness with respect to which it was set aside. No deduction is
allowed under section 545(c)(1) and this section for payments out of
amounts previously set aside. Thus, for example, if a corporation, which
is a June 30 fiscal year taxpayer, incurs indebtedness of $1 million on
February 1, 1962, and, in accordance with its contract of indebtedness,
irrevocably sets aside $50,000 in a sinking fund on February 1, of each
of the years 1963, 1964, and 1965, then its qualified indebtedness on
January 1, 1964, is $950,000 ($1 million less one set-aside of $50,000
in 1963). The corporation is not allowed a deduction under section
545(c)(1) for the set-aside of $50,000 made during its taxable year
ending on June 30, 1964, since section 545(c) is applicable only to
taxable years beginning after December 31, 1963, but the qualified
indebtedness is nevertheless reduced by such amount. The corporation is
allowed a deduction of $50,000 for its taxable year ending June 30,
1965, as a result of the set-aside made during such taxable year, and
qualified indebtedness on July 1, 1965, is $850,000. No deduction is
allowed to the corporation for a payment in any subsequent taxable year
from the amounts so set aside.
(4) Reduction on disposition of certain property. (i) Section
545(c)(6) provides that the total amount of the taxpayer's qualified
indebtedness (as determined under subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph)
shall be reduced if property of a character subject to the allowance for
exhaustion, wear and tear, obsolescence, amortization, or depletion is
disposed of after December 31, 1963. The reduction is made pro rata (in
accordance with subdivision (iii) of this subparagraph) for the taxable
year of such disposition and is equal in total amount to the excess, if
any, of:
(a) The adjusted basis of the property disposed of (determined under
section 1011 and the regulations thereunder) immediately before such
disposition; over
(b) The amount of qualified indebtedness which ceased to be
qualified indebtedness with respect to the taxpayer by reason of the
assumption of indebtedness by the transferee of the property disposed of
(whether or not such indebtedness was incurred by the taxpayer in
connection with the property disposed of).
For purposes of (b) of this subdivision, the transferee will be treated
as having assumed qualified indebtedness if such transferee acquires
real estate of which the taxpayer is the legal or equitable owner
immediately before the transfer and which is subject to indebtedness
that, with respect to the taxpayer, is qualified indebtedness
immediately before the transfer, provided the taxpayer shows to the
satisfaction of the Commissioner that under all the facts and
circumstances it no longer bears the
[[Page 282]]
burden of discharging such indebtedness.
(ii) The indebtedness reduced under the rule of this subparagraph is
the qualified indebtedness which is outstanding with respect to the
taxpayer immediately after the disposition referred to in subdivision
(i) of this subparagraph.
(iii) The reduction with respect to any particular contract of
indebtedness under the rules of this subparagraph shall be determined by
multiplying the total reduction (determined under subdivision (i) of
this subparagraph) by the ratio which the amount of the qualified
indebtedness owed with respect to such contract by the taxpayer on the
date referred to in subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph bears to the
aggregate qualified indebtedness owed by the taxpayer with respect to
all contracts on such date.
(5) Total debt consisting of both qualified and nonqualified
indebtedness. In any case where, with respect to a particular contract
of indebtedness, a part of the total indebtedness owed with respect to
such contract is qualified indebtedness and the other part is
indebtedness which is not qualified indebtedness, then, any amount paid
or irrevocably set aside with respect to such contract shall be
allocated between both such parts pro rata unless the taxpayer clearly
indicates in its return the part of the payment or set-aside which shall
be allocated to the qualified indebtedness.
(6) Outstanding indebtedness. For purposes of determining qualified
indebtedness, the term indebtedness has the same meaning that it has
under section 545(b)(7) and paragraph (g)(2) of Sec. 1.545-2.
Indebtedness ceases to be outstanding when the taxpayer no longer has an
obligation absolute and not contingent with respect to the payment of
such debt. An indebtedness evidenced by bonds, notes, or other
obligations issued by a corporation is ordinarily incurred as of the
date such obligations are issued, and the amount of such indebtedness is
the amount represented by the face value of the obligations. However, a
refunding, renewal, or mere change in the form of an indebtedness which
does not involve a substantial change in the economic terms of the
indebtedness will not have the effect of changing the date the
indebtedness was incurred. (See paragraph (b)(2) of this section for the
meaning of substantial change in the economic terms of the
indebtedness.) For purposes of this section, the outstanding
indebtedness of a taxpayer includes a mortgage or other security
interest on real estate of which such taxpayer is the legal or equitable
owner (even though the taxpayer is not directly liable on the underlying
evidence of indebtedness secured by such mortgage or security interest)
provided such taxpayer shows to the satisfaction of the Commissioner
that under all of the facts and circumstances it bears the burden of
discharging such indebtedness. Thus, for example, if X acquires from Y
property which is subject to a mortgage (X not assuming the indebtedness
underlying such mortgage) and if X actually bears the burden of
discharging the indebtedness, then, after the date of acquisition, such
underlying indebtedness is outstanding indebtedness with respect to X,
and, since Y's obligation to pay is in fact contingent upon X failing to
discharge the indebtedness, such indebtedness is not outstanding
indebtedness with respect to Y.
(7) Examples. The application of this paragraph may be illustrated
by the following examples:
Example 1. M Corporation, a calendar year taxpayer has $600,000 of
indebtedness outstanding on December 31, 1963 (which was incurred after
1933), represented by three demand notes. Individuals A and B (who are
not shareholders) each hold one of M Corporation's notes in the amount
of $150,000 and N Corporation (which is not a shareholder) holds M
Corporation's note in the amount of $300,000. The note held by N
Corporation is secured by a mortgage on certain depreciable real estate
owned by M Corporation which has an adjusted basis to it on July 1,
1964, of $500,000. On July 1, 1964, M Corporation sells the depreciable
real estate to O Corporation in consideration for $200,000 in cash and
the assumption by O Corporation of the indebtedness on the note held by
N Corporation. M Corporation borrows $200,000 on September 30, 1964, of
which amount $150,000 is simultaneously applied to liquidate the note
held by B. M Corporation's qualified indebtedness is reduced on July 1,
1964, by $300,000, the qualified indebtedness which ceased to be
outstanding by reason of
[[Page 283]]
the transfer. In addition, the reduction (computed under section
545(c)(6) and subparagraph (4) of this paragraph) of M Corporation's
qualified indebtedness by reason of the disposition of depreciable
property on July 1, 1964, is as follows:
Outstanding qualified indebtedness after reduction of $300,000
qualified indebtedness which ceased to be outstanding by
reason of the transfer but before the sec. 545(c)(6)
reduction..................................................
Reduced by:
The excess of the adjusted basis of depreciable real 200,000
estate disposed of on July 1, 1964 ($500,000), over the
amount of qualified indebtedness assumed by O Corporation
($300,000)...............................................
-----------
Qualified indebtedness after reductions from transfer and 100,000
assumption of indebtedness.................................
The pro-rata share of the reduction with respect to each debt is
computed as follows:
Note held by A:
Qualified indebtedness owed by taxpayer on the note held $150,000
by A before the disposition of depreciable property......
Less the pro-rata share of the total reduction computed 100,000
under subparagraph (4) of this paragraph allocable to
such note $200,000x ($150,000/$300,000)..................
-----------
Qualified indebtedness owed on the note held by A after the 50,000
transfer...................................................
===========
Note held by B:
Qualified indebtedness owed by taxpayer on the note held $150,000
by B before the transfer of depreciable property.........
Less the pro-rata share of the total reduction computed 100,000
under subparagraph (4) of this paragraph allocable to
such note $200,000x ($150,000/$300,000)..................
-----------
Qualified indebtedness owed on the note held by B after 50,000
the transfer.............................................
===========
Of the $150,000 paid by M Corporation on September 30, 1964, to retire
the note held by B only $50,000 qualified as a use of an amount to pay
or retire qualified indebtedness and, thus, only $50,000 is allowable as
a deduction for purposes of computing undistributed personal holding
company income for 1964.
Example 2. The facts are the same as in example 1 except that M
Corporation elects in accordance with paragraph (e) of this section not
to deduct $25,000 of the $50,000 amount otherwise deductible. Then
$25,000 of the $200,000 of new indebtedness incurred by M Corporation is
qualified indebtedness. If the payment on the note held by B had not
been made until January 1, 1965, then the new indebtedness would not be
qualified indebtedness since the payment was not made in the taxable
year in which the new indebtedness was incurred. If M Corporation pays
$40,000 on April 1 and July 1, 1965, on the indebtedness incurred
September 30, 1964, then (unless M indicates otherwise in its return for
1965 in accordance with subparagraph (5) of this paragraph) the payments
made on such dates must be allocated between qualified and nonqualified
indebtedness in the following manner:
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Qualfied Nonqualified
------------------------------------------------------------------------
April 1 payment:
$40,000x$25,000 (qualified)/$200,000 (total $5,000
indebtedness)................................
$40,000x$175,000 (nonqualified)/$200,000 ........ $35,000
(total indebtedness).........................
July 1 payment:
$40,000x$20,000 (qualified)/$160,000 (total 5,000
indebtedness)................................
$40,000x$140,000 (nonqualified)/$160,000 ........ 35,000
(total indebtedness).........................
-----------------------
Total..................................... 10,000 70,000
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Thus, a total of $10,000 of the two payments would be considered used to
pay or retire qualified indebtedness. The results in examples 1 and 2
would be the same if O Corporation purchased the real estate subject to
the indebtedness (not assuming the indebtedness) on the note held by N
Corporation, provided M Corporation does not bear the burden of
discharging such indebtedness after July 1, 1964.
Example 3. C owns all of the 1000 shares of outstanding capital
stock of P Corporation. On December 31, 1963, P Corporation, a calendar
year taxpayer, owes $200,000 of outstanding indebtedness to D
and$500,000 of outstanding indebtedness to E. These debts were incurred
after 1933. On January 15, 1964, P Corporation pays $100,000 in partial
liquidation of the $500,000 indebtedness. On March 15, 1964, P
Corporation pays $50,000 into a sinking fund with respect to the
$200,000 indebtedness owed to D. On April 15, 1964, D purchases one-half
of the shares owned by C, constituting 50 percent in value of P
Corporation's outstanding stock. P Corporation, on June 15, 1964, pays
$50,000 into a sinking fund with respect to the indebtedness owed to D.
For purposes of the March 15, 1964, set-aside, the indebtedness owed to
D ($200,000) is qualified indebtedness. However, the indebtedness owed
to D is not qualified indebtedness for purposes of the June set-aside
with respect to such indebtedness since D is a person who after December
31, 1963, and before the June set-aside, owned more than 10 percent in
value of P Corporation's outstanding stock. Moreover, any subsequent
set-asides made with respect to the indebtedness owed to D will not be
made with respect to qualified indebtedness even if the shares owned by
D are subsequently sold. Assuming no payments or set-asides are made by
P Corporation after June 15, 1964, the P Corporation is entitled to a
deduction of
[[Page 284]]
$150,000 under section 545(c)(1) for the calendar year 1964 for amounts
paid and for amounts irrevocably set aside to pay or retire qualified
indebtedness, and the total qualified indebtedness at the end of 1964 is
$400,000. No additional deduction is allowed in subsequent taxable years
for amounts paid out of the amounts set aside in 1964.
(e) Election not to deduct--(1) In general. Section 545(c)(4)
provides that a taxpayer may elect to treat as nondeductible amounts
otherwise deductible under section 545(c)(1) for the taxable year. The
election shall be in the form of a statement of election filed on or
before the 15th day of the third month following the close of the
taxable year with respect to which the election applies. The election
shall be irrevocable after such date.
(2) Statement of election. The statement of election referred to in
subparagraph (1) of this paragraph shall be attached to the taxpayer's
Schedule PH (Form 1120) for the year with respect to which such election
applies, if such schedule is filed on or before the date referred to in
subparagraph (1) of this paragraph. If the taxpayer's Schedule PH (Form
1120) is not filed on or before such date, then the statement of
election shall clearly set forth the taxpayer's name, address, and
employer identification number, shall be signed by an officer of the
taxpayer who is authorized to sign a return of the taxpayer with respect
to income, and shall be filed with the district director for the
internal revenue district in which the taxpayer's income tax return (for
the year with respect to which the election is applicable) would be
filed. The following information shall be included in the statement of
election:
(i) A statement that the taxpayer wishes to elect in accordance with
section 545(c)(4);
(ii) The amounts paid or set aside which are to be treated as
nondeductible under section 545(c)(4) and this section;
(iii) All information necessary to identify the qualified
indebtedness with respect to which such amounts were paid or set aside;
(iv) The date on which such payments or set-asides were made; and
(v) All information necessary to identify the indebtedness (referred
to in section 545(c)(3)(A)(ii) and paragraph (d)(1)(ii) of this section)
incurred for the purpose of making the payments or set-asides which the
taxpayer elects to treat as nondeductible, including:
(a) The date on which such indebtedness was incurred;
(b) The amount of such indebtedness;
(c) The person or persons to whom such indebtedness is owed; and
(d) A statement that such person or persons do not own more than 10
percent in value of the taxpayer's outstanding stock.
(f) Limitation on deduction--(1) In general. Section 545(c)(5)
provides certain limitations on the deduction otherwise allowed by
section 545(c)(1). Such deduction is reduced by the sum of the following
amounts:
(i) The amount, if any, by which:
(a) The deductions allowed for the taxable year and all preceding
taxable years beginning after December 31, 1963, for exhaustion, wear
and tear, obsolescence, amortization, or depletion (other than such
deductions which are disallowed in computing undistributed personal
holding company income under the rule of paragraph (h) of Sec. 1.545-
2), exceed
(b) Any reduction, by reason of section 545(c)(5)(A) and this
subdivision (i), of the deductions otherwise allowed by section
545(c)(1) for such preceding years; and
(ii) The amount, if any, by which:
(a) The deductions allowed under section 545(b)(5) (relating to
long-term capital gain deduction) in computing undistributed personal
holding company income for the taxable year and all preceding taxable
years beginning after December 31, 1963, exceed
(b) Any reduction, by reason of section 545(c)(5)(B) and this
subdivision (ii), of the deductions otherwise allowed by section
545(c)(1) for such preceding years.
(2) Allocation of reduction. If the total reduction required by
subparagraph (1) of this paragraph is greater than the amount of the
payment or set-aside made in respect of qualified indebtedness in a
taxable year, then the portion of the reduction which is attributable to
either section 545(c)(5)(A) or section 545(c)(5)(B), as the case may be,
is that portion which bears the same ratio to
[[Page 285]]
the total reduction as the total reduction available under either
section 545(c)(5)(A) or section 545(c)(5)(B), respectively, bears to the
total reduction available under both such sections.
(3) Example. The provisions of this paragraph may be illustrated by
the following example:
Example. (i) Q Corporation, a calendar year taxpayer, has qualified
indebtedness of $400,000 on January 1, 1964, with respect to which
payments of $50,000 are made on April 15, 1964, and 1965, and $300,000
on April 15, 1966. In the years 1964 and 1966, Q Corporation is allowed
a deduction under section 545(b)(5) of $50,000 for the excess of its net
long-term capital gain over its net short-term capital loss, minus the
taxes attributable to such excess. Q Corporation is allowed a
depreciation deduction of $50,000 for each of its taxable years 1964
through 1966. Q Corporation is a personal holding company with taxable
income of $200,000 in each of the years 1964 and 1966.
(ii) For 1964, in computing undistributed personal holding company
income, Q Corporation's taxable income is reduced by $50,000 by reason
of the deduction under section 545(b)(5). No part of the depreciation
deduction is disallowed under the rule of paragraph (h) of Sec. 1.545-
2. Q Corporation's deduction for payment of qualified indebtedness
otherwise allowable under section 545(c)(1) and this section is reduced
to zero by reason of the depreciation deduction and the capital gains
deduction. The reduction by reason of section 545(c)(5)(A) and
subparagraph (1)(i) of this paragraph (depreciation) is $25,000
[($50,000 / $100,000)x$50,000], and the reduction by reason of section
545(c)(5)(B) and subparagraph (1) (ii) of this paragraph (capital gain)
is $25,000 [($50,000/$100,000)x$50,000].
(iii) For 1966, Q Corporation is allowed a deduction for payment of
qualified indebtedness of $100,000 computed as follows:
Amount paid in 1966 to retire .......... .......... $300,000
qualified indebtedness.............
Less the sum of:
(a) Depreciation deductions $150,000
allowed for 1964 through 1966
(3x$50,000)......................
Reduction of deductions in 25,000 $125,000
preceding taxable years
(1964).......................
-----------------------------------
(b) Deduction allowed under 100,000
section 545(b)(5) (relating to
long-term capital gains) for 1964
through 1966.....................
Reduction of deductions in 25,000 75,000 200,000
preceding taxable years
(1964).......................
-----------------------------------
Deduction after reduction..... .......... .......... 100,000
(iv) If, in the year 1966, Q Corporation's depreciation deduction had
been limited for purposes of computing undistributed personal holding
company income to $25,000 by reason of section 545(b)(8), then Q
Corporation's deduction for payment of qualified indebtedness would be
$125,000, computed as follows:
Amounts paid in 1966 to retire .......... .......... $300,000
qualified indebtedness.............
Less the sum of:
(a) Depreciation deductions $125,000
allowed for 1964 through 1966....
Reduction of deductions in 25,000
preceding taxable year (1964)
-----------------------------------
$100,000
(b) Deduction allowed under 100,000
section 545(b)(5) (relating to
long-term capital gains) for 1964
through 1966.....................
Reduction of deductions in 25,000 75,000 175,000
preceding taxable years
(1964).......................
-----------------------------------
Deduction after reduction..... .......... .......... 125,000
(g) Burden of proof. The burden of proof rests upon the taxpayer to
sustain the deduction claimed under this section. In addition to any
information required by this section, the taxpayer must furnish the
information required by the return, and such other information as the
district director may require in substantiation of the deduction
claimed.
(h) Application of section 381(c)(15). Under section 381(c)(15), if
an acquiring corporation assumes liability for qualified indebtedness in
a transaction to which section 381(a) applies, then the acquiring
corporation is considered to be the distributor or transferor
corporation for purposes of section 545(c). Paragraph (c)(2) of this
section reflects the application of section 381(c)(15) by including an
acquiring corporation within the definition of corporation to which this
section applies. Thus, the acquiring corporation is not required to meet
the requirements of paragraph (c)(1) or paragraph (d)(1) of this section
with respect to such acquired qualified indebtedness to which section
381(c)(15) is applicable. All the other provisions
[[Page 286]]
of this section apply in full to the acquiring corporation with respect
to such acquired indebtedness.
[T.D. 6949, 33 FR 5526, Apr. 9, 1968; 33 FR 6091, Apr. 20, 1968]
Sec. 1.547-1 General rule.
Section 547 provides a method under which, by virtue of dividend
distributions, a corporation may be relieved from the payment of a
deficiency in the personal holding company tax imposed by section 541
(or by a corresponding provision of a prior income tax law), or may be
entitled to a credit or refund of a part or all of any such deficiency
which has been paid. The method provided by section 547 is to allow an
additional deduction for a dividend distribution (which meets the
requirements of this section) in computing undistributed personal
holding company income for the taxable year for which a deficiency in
personal holding company tax is determined. The additional deduction for
deficiency dividends will not, however, be allowed for the purpose of
determining interest, additional amounts, or assessable penalties,
computed with respect to the personal holding company tax prior to the
allowance of the additional deduction for deficiency dividends. Such
amounts remain payable as if section 547 had not been enacted.
Sec. 1.547-2 Requirements for deficiency dividends.
(a) In general. There are certain requirements which must be
fulfilled before a deduction is allowed for a deficiency dividend under
section 547 and this section. These are:
(1) The taxpayer's liability for personal holding company tax shall
be determined only in the manner provided in section 547(c) and
paragraph (b)(1) of this section.
(2) The deficiency dividend shall be paid by the corporation on, or
within 90 days after, the date of such determination and prior to the
filing of a claim under section 547(e) and paragraph (b)(2) of this
section for deduction for deficiency dividends. This claim must be filed
within 120 days after such determination.
(3) The deficiency dividend must be of such a nature as would have
permitted its inclusion in the computation of a deduction for dividends
paid under section 561 for the taxable year with respect to which the
liability for personal holding company tax exists, if it had been
distributed during such year. See section 562 and Sec. Sec. 1.562-1
through 1.562-3. In this connection, it should be noted that under
section 316(b)(2), the term dividend means (in addition to the usual
meaning under section 316(a)) any distribution of property (whether or
not a dividend as defined in section 316(a)) made by a corporation to
its shareholders, to the extent of its undistributed personal holding
company income (determined under section 545 and Sec. Sec. 1.545-1 and
1.545-2 without regard to section 316(b)(2)) for the taxable year in
respect of which the distribution is made.
(b) Special rules--(1) Nature and details of determination. (i) A
determination of a taxpayer's liability for personal holding company tax
shall, for the purposes of section 547, be established in the manner
specified in section 547(c) and this subparagraph.
(ii) The date of determination by a decision of the Tax Court of the
United States is the date upon which such decision becomes final, as
prescribed in section 7481.
(iii) The slate upon which a judgment of a court becomes final,
which is the date of the determination in such cases, must be determined
upon the basis of the facts in the particular case. Ordinarily, a
judgment of a United States district court becomes final upon the
expiration of the time allowed for taking an appeal, if no such appeal
is duly taken within such time; and a judgment of the United States
Court of Claims becomes final upon the expiration of the time allowed
for filing a petition for certiorari if no such petition is duly filed
within such time.
(iv) The date of determination by a closing agreement, made under
section 7121, is the date such agreement is approved by the
Commissioner.
(v) A determination under section 547(c)(3) may be made by an
agreement signed by the district director or such other official to whom
authority to sign the agreement is delegated, and by or on behalf of the
taxpayer. The agreement shall set forth the total amount
[[Page 287]]
of the liability for personal holding company tax for the taxable year
or years. An agreement under this subdivision which is signed by the
district director (or such other official to whom authority to sign the
agreement is delegated) on or after July 15, 1963, shall be sent to the
taxpayer at his last known address by either registered or certified
mail. For further guidance regarding the definition of last known
address, see Sec. 301.6212-2 of this chapter. If registered mail is
used for such purpose, the date of registration shall be treated as the
date of determination; if certified mail is used for such purpose, the
date of the postmark on the sender's receipt for such mail shall be
treated as the date of determination. However, if a dividend is paid by
the corporation before such registration or postmark date but on or
after the date such agreement is signed by the district director or such
other official to whom authority to sign the agreement is delegated, the
date of determination shall be such date of signing. The date of
determination with respect to an agreement which is signed by the
district director (or such other official to whom authority to sign the
agreement is delegated) before July 15, 1963, shall be the date of the
postmark on the cover envelope in which such agreement is sent by
ordinary mail, except that if a dividend is paid by the corporation
before such postmark date but on or after the date such agreement is
signed by the district director or such other official to whom authority
to sign the agreement is delegated, the date of determination shall be
such date of signing.
(2) Claim for deduction--(i) Contents of claim. A claim for
deduction for a deficiency dividend shall be made with the requisite
declaration, on Form 976 and shall contain the following information:
(a) The name and address of the corporation;
(b) The place and date of incorporation;
(c) The amount of the deficiency determined with respect to the tax
imposed by section 541 (or a corresponding provision of a prior income
tax law) and the taxable year or years involved; the amount of the
unpaid deficiency or, if the deficiency has been paid in whole or in
part, the date of payment and the amount thereof; a statement as to how
the deficiency was established, if unpaid; or if paid in whole or in
part, how it was established that any portion of the amount paid was a
deficiency at the time when paid and, in either case whether it was by
an agreement under section 547(c)(3), by a closing agreement under
section 7121, or by a decision of the Tax Court or court judgment and
the date thereof; if established by a final judgment in a suit against
the United States for refund, the date of payment of the deficiency, the
date the claim for refund was filed, and the date the suit was brought;
if established by a Tax Court decision or court judgment, a copy thereof
shall be attached, together with an explanation of how the decision
became final; if established by an agreement under section 547(c)(3), a
copy of such agreement shall be attached;
(d) The amount and date of payment of the dividend with respect to
which the claim for the deduction for deficiency dividends is filed;
(e) A statement setting forth the various classes of stock
outstanding, the name and address of each shareholder, the class and
number of shares held by each on the date of payment of the dividend
with respect to which the claim is filed, and the amount of such
dividend paid to each shareholder;
(f) The amount claimed as a deduction for deficiency dividends; and
(g) Such other information as may be required by the claim form.
(ii) Filing of claim and corporate resolution. The claim together
with a certified copy of the resolution of the board of directors or
other authority, authorizing the payment of the dividend with respect to
which the claim is filed, shall be filed with the district director for
the internal revenue district in which the return is filed.
(iii) Carryover of deficiency dividends paid by acquiring
corporation. In the case of the acquisition of assets of a corporation
by another corporation in a distribution or transfer described in
section 381(a), the distributor or transferor corporation shall be
entitled to a deduction for any deficiency dividends
[[Page 288]]
(as defined in section 547(d)) paid by the acquiring corporation with
respect to such distributor or transferor corporation. See section
381(c)(17).
(68A Stat. 192, 917; 26 U.S.C. 547(c), 7805)
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6657, 28 FR
5720, June 12, 1963; T.D. 7604, 44 FR 18661, Mar. 29, 1979; T.D. 8939,
66 FR 2819, Jan. 12, 2001]
Sec. 1.547-3 Claim for credit or refund.
(a) If a deficiency in personal holding company tax is asserted for
any taxable year, and the corporation has paid any portion of such
asserted deficiency, it is entitled to a credit or refund of such
payment to the extent that such payment constitutes an overpayment as
the result of a deduction for a deficiency dividend as provided in
section 547 and Sec. Sec. 1.547-1 through 1.547-7. It should be noted
that a determination under section 547(c) and paragraph (b)(1) of Sec.
1.547-2, of taxpayer's liability for personal holding company tax may
take place subsequent to the time the deficiency was paid. To secure
credit or refund of such overpayment, the taxpayer must file a claim on
Form 843 in addition to the claim for the deduction for deficiency
dividends required under section 547(e) and paragraph (b)(2) of Sec.
1.547-2.
(b) No interest shall be allowed on such credit or refund.
(c) Such credit or refund will be allowed as if, on the date of the
determination under section 547(c) and paragraph (b)(1) of Sec. 1.547-
2, two years remained before the expiration of the period of limitation
on the filing of claim for refund for the taxable year to which the
overpayment relates.
Sec. 1.547-4 Effect on dividends paid deduction.
The deficiency dividends deduction shall be allowed as of the date
the claim is filed. No duplication of deductions with respect to any
deficiency dividends is permitted. If a corporation claims and receives
the benefit of the provisions of section 547 (or the corresponding
section 506 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1939, or section 407 of the
Revenue Act of 1938 (52 Stat. 447)), based upon a distribution of
deficiency dividends, that distribution does not become a part of the
dividends paid deduction under section 561. Likewise, it will not be
made the basis of a dividends paid deduction under section 561 by reason
of the application of section 563(b), relating to dividends paid after
the close of the taxable year and on or before the 15th day of the third
month following the close of such taxable year.
Sec. 1.547-5 Deduction denied in case of fraud or wilful failure to
file timely return.
No deduction for deficiency dividends shall be allowed under section
547(a) if the determination contains a finding that any part of the
deficiency is due to fraud with intent to evade tax, or to wilful
failure to file an income tax return within the time prescribed by law
or prescribed by the Secretary or his delegate in pursuance of law. See
Sec. 1.547-7 for effective date.
Sec. 1.547-6 Suspension of statute of limitations and stay of collection.
(a) Statute of limitations. If the corporation files a claim for a
deduction for deficiency dividends under section 547(e) and paragraph
(b)(2) of Sec. 1.547-2, the running of the statute of limitations upon
assessment, distraint, and collection in court in respect of the
deficiency, and all interest, additional amounts, or assessable
penalties, shall be suspended for a period of two years after the date
of the determination under section 547(c) and paragraph (b)(1) of Sec.
1.547-2.
(b) Stay of collection. If a deficiency in personal holding company
tax is established by a determination under section 547(c) and paragraph
(b)(1) of Sec. 1.547-2, collection by distraint or court proceeding
(except in case of jeopardy), of the deficiency and all interest,
additional amounts, and assessable penalties, shall be stayed for a
period of 120 days after the date of such determination, and, to the
extent any part of such deficiency remains after deduction for
deficiency dividends, for an additional period until the date the claim
is disallowed. After such claim is allowed or rejected, either in whole
or in part, the amount of the deficiency
[[Page 289]]
which was not eliminated by the application of section 547, together
with interest, additional amounts and assessable penalties, will be
assessed and collected in the usual manner.
Sec. 1.547-7 Effective date.
The deduction for deficiency dividends, in computing personal
holding company tax for any taxable year, is allowable only with respect
to determinations under section 547(c) made after November 14, 1954 (the
date falling 90 days after the date of enactment of the Internal Revenue
Code of 1954). If the taxable year with respect to which the deficiency
is asserted began before January 1, 1954, the deficiency dividends
deduction shall include only the amounts which would have been
includible in the computation of the basic surtax credit for such
taxable year under the Internal Revenue Code of 1939. Section 547(g),
relating to the denial of a deficiency dividends deduction if the
determination contains a finding that any part of the deficiency is due
to fraud, etc., shall apply only if the taxable year with respect to
which the deficiency is asserted begins after December 31, 1953.
Foreign Personal Holding Companies
Sec. 1.551-1 General rule.
Part III (section 551 and following), subchapter G, chapter 1 of the
Code, does not impose a tax on foreign personal holding companies. The
undistributed foreign personal holding company income of such companies,
however, must be included in the manner and to the extent set forth in
section 551, in the gross income of their United States shareholders,
that is, the shareholders who are individual citizens or residents of
the United States, domestic corporations, domestic partnerships, and
estates or trusts other than estates or trusts the gross income of which
under subtitle A of the Code includes only income from sources within
the United States.
Sec. 1.551-2 Amount included in gross income.
(a) The undistributed foreign personal holding company income is
included only in the gross income of the United States shareholders who
were shareholders in the company on the last day of its taxable year on
which a United States group (as defined in section 552(a)(2)) existed
with respect to the company. Such United States shareholders,
accordingly, are determined by the stock holdings as of such specified
time. This rule applies to every United States shareholder who was a
shareholder in the company at the specified time regardless of whether
the United States shareholder is included within the United States
group. For example, a domestic corporation which is a United States
shareholder at the specified time must return its distributive share in
the undistributed foreign personal holding company income even though
the domestic corporation cannot be included within the United States
group since, under section 554, the stock it owns in the foreign
corporation is considered as being owned proportionately by its
shareholders for the purpose of determining whether the foreign
corporation is a foreign personal holding company.
(b) The United States shareholders must include in their gross
income their distributive shares of that proportion of the undistributed
foreign personal holding company income for the taxable year of the
company which is equal in ratio to that which the portion of the taxable
year up to and including the last day on which the United States group
with respect to the company existed bears to the entire taxable year.
Thus, if the last day in the taxable year on which the required United
States group existed was also the end of the taxable year, the portion
of the taxable year up to and incding such last day would be equal to
100 percent and, in such case, the United States shareholders would be
required to return their distributive shares in the entire undistributed
foreign personal holding company income. But if the last day on which
the required United States group existed was September 30, and the
taxable year was a calendar year, the portion of the taxable year up to
and including such last day would be equal to nine-twelfths and, in that
case, the United States shareholders would be required to return their
distributive shares in only
[[Page 290]]
nine-twelfths of the undistributed foreign personal holding company
income.
(c) The amount which each United States shareholder must return is
that amount which he would have received as a dividend if the above-
specified portion of the undistributed foreign personal holding company
income had in fact been distributed by the foreign personal holding
company as a dividend on the last day of its taxable year on which the
required United States group existed. Such amount is determined,
therefore, by the interest of the United States shareholder in the
foreign personal holding company, that is, by the number of shares of
stock owned by the United States shareholder and the relative rights of
his class of stock, if there are several classes of stock outstanding.
Thus, if a foreign personal holding company has both common and
preferred stock outstanding and the preferred shareholders are entitled
to a specified dividend before any distribution may be made to the
common shareholders, then the assumed distribution of the stated portion
of the undistributed foreign personal holding company income must first
be treated as a payment of the specified dividend on the preferred stock
before any part may be allocated as a dividend on the common stock.
(d) The assumed distribution of the required portion of the
undistributed foreign personal holding company income must be returned
as dividend income by the United States shareholders for their
respective taxable years in which or with which the taxable year of the
foreign personal holding company ends. For example, if the M
Corporation, whose taxable year is the calendar year, is a foreign
personal holding company for 1954 and if A, one of its United States
shareholders, makes returns on a calendar year basis, while B, another
United States shareholder, makes returns on the basis of a fiscal year
ending November 30, A must return his assumed dividend as income for the
taxable year 1954 and B must return his distributive share as income for
the fiscal year ending November 30, 1955. In applying this rule, the
date as of which the United States group last existed with respect to
the company is immaterial. Thus, in the foregoing example, if September
30, 1954, was the last day on which the United States group with respect
to the M Corporation existed, B would still be required to return his
assumed dividend as income for the fiscal year ending November 30, 1955,
even though September 30, 1954, the date as of which the distribution is
assumed to have been made, does not fall within such fiscal year.
(e) For the treatment of gain on the sale of certain stock, see
section 306(f) and paragraph (h) of Sec. 1.306-3.
Sec. 1.551-3 Deduction for obligations of the United States and its
instrumentalities.
(a) Each United States shareholder required to return his
distributive share of undistributed foreign personal holding company
income for any taxable year shall take into account in computing the
credit against tax under section 35, or the deduction under section 242,
whichever is allowable to such shareholder, his proportionate share of
whatever interest on obligations of the United States or its
instrumentalities (as specified in sections 35 or 242, as the case may
be) may be included in the gross income of the company for such taxable
year, with the exception of any such interest as may be so included by
reason of the application of the provisions of section 555. For
reduction of credit for such interest on account of amortizable bond
premium, see section 171 and the regulations thereunder.
(b) The rule set forth in paragraph (a) of this section may be
illustrated by the following example:
Example. The M Corporation is a foreign personal holding company
which owns all the stock of the N Corporation, another foreign personal
holding company. Both companies receive interest on obligations of the
United States or its instrumentalities as specified in section 35. In
determining the amount of the credit allowable under section 35 (if the
shareholder is an individual) or the deduction allowable under section
242 (if the shareholder is a corporation), the United States shareholder
of the M Corporation would be entitled to a credit or a deduction, as
the case may be, only for his proportionate share of the interest
received by that Company and not for any part of the interest received
by the N Corporation, regardless of whether the interest received by the
N Corporation is included in the gross income of
[[Page 291]]
the M Corporation as an actual dividend or as a constructive dividend
under section 555.
Sec. 1.551-4 Information in return.
The information required by section 551(d) in the returns of certain
United States shareholders relates only to the taxable year of a foreign
personal holding company for which any part of such corporation's
undistributed foreign personal holding company income must be included
in gross income by the United States shareholder of whom the information
is required. The information shall be submitted as a part of the income
tax return in the form of a statement attached to the return.
Sec. 1.551-5 Effect on capital account of foreign personal holding
company and basis of stock in hands of shareholders.
(a) Sections 551(e) and 551(f) are designed to prevent double
taxation with respect to the undistributed foreign personal holding
company income.
(b) The application of sections 551(e) and 551(f) may be illustrated
by the following examples:
Example 1. The M Corporation is a foreign personal holding company.
Seventy-five percent in value of its capital stock is owned by A, a
citizen of the United States, and the remainder, or 25 percent, of its
stock is owned by B, a nonresident alien individual. For the calendar
year 1954 the M Corporation has an undistributed foreign personal
holding company income of $100,000. A is required to include $75,000 of
such income in gross income as a dividend in his return for the calendar
year 1954. The $100,000 is treated as paid-in surplus or as a
contribution to the capital of the M Corporation and its accumulated
earnings and profits as of the close of the calendar year 1954 are
correspondingly reduced. If after treating such $100,000 as paid-in
surplus or as a contribution to capital, the M Corporation has no
accumulatedearnings and profits at the close of 1954, and if for the
calendar year 1955, the M Corporation had no earnings and profits, but
distributed $40,000, the amount so distributed would be a nontaxable
distribution and would not be included in the gross income of either A
or B for the calendar year 1955. If, however, after treating the
$100,000 as paid-in surplus or as a contribution to capital, the M
Corporation had accumulated earnings and profits of $100,000 at the
close of 1954, the facts otherwise being the same, the distributions in
1955 would be taxable to A as a dividend, and the taxability of such
distributions to B would depend upon the application of section
861(a)(2), relating to the treatment of dividends from a foreign
corporation as income from sources within or without the United States.
Example 2. In example 1 assume the basis of A's stock to be
$300,000. If A includes in gross income in his return for the calendar
year 1954, $75,000 as a dividend from the M Corporation, the basis of
his stock would be $375,000. After the nontaxable distribution of
$30,000 to A by the M Corporation in 1955 (75 percent of the $40,000
distribution) the basis of A's stock, assuming no other changes, would
be $345,000. If A failed to include the $75,000 as a dividend in gross
income in his return for 1954 and his failure was not discovered until
after the 6-year period of limitations had expired, the application of
the rule would not increase the basis of A's stock. The subsequent
nontaxable distribution of $30,000 to A in 1955 would reduce his basis
of $300,000 to $270,000, thus tending to compensate for his failure to
include the amount of $75,000 as a dividend in his gross income for
1954. If the undistributed foreign personal holding company income of
the M Corporation is readjusted within the statutory period of
limitations, thus increasing or decreasing the amount A would have to
include in his gross income, proper adjustment is required to be made to
the basis of A's stock on account of such readjustment.
Sec. 1.552-1 Definition of foreign personal holding company.
(a) A foreign personal holding company is any foreign corporation,
other than a corporation exempt from taxation under subchapter F
(section 501 and following), chapter 1 of the Code, and other than
certain banking institutions which satisfy the requirements of section
552(b)(2) and paragraph (b) of Sec. 1.552-4 which for the taxable year
meets (1) the gross income requirement specified in section 552(a)(1);
and (2) the stock ownership requirement specified in section 552(a)(2).
Both requirements must be satisfied with respect to each taxable year.
(b) A foreign corporation which comes within the classification of a
foreign personal holding company is not subject to taxation either under
section 531 or section 541. See sections 532(b)(2) and 542(c)(5). The
fact that a foreign corporation is a foreign personal holding company
does not relieve the corporation from liability for the taxes imposed
generally upon foreign corporations, such as the taxes imposed by
sections 881 and 882, since
[[Page 292]]
such taxes apply regardless of the classification of the foreign
corporation as a foreign personal holding company.
Sec. 1.552-2 Gross income requirement.
(a) To meet the gross income requirement, it is necessary that
either of the following percentages of gross income of the corporation
for the taxable year (including the additions to gross income provided
in section 555(b) as required by section 555(c)(2)) be foreign personal
holding company income as defined in section 553:
(1) 60 percent or more; or
(2) 50 percent or more if the foreign corporation has been
classified as a foreign personal holding company for any taxable year
ending after August 26, 1937, unless:
(i) A taxable year has intervened since the last taxable year for
which it was so classified, during no part of which the stock ownership
requirement specified in section 552(a)(2) exists; or
(ii) Three consecutive years have intervened since the last taxable
year for which it was so classified, during each of which its foreign
personal holding company income was less than 50 percent of its gross
income.
(b) In determining whether the foreign personal holding company
income is equal to the required percentage of the total gross income,
the determination must not be made upon the basis of gross receipts,
since gross income is not synonymous with gross receipts. For meaning of
gross income in this part, see section 555 and Sec. 1.555-1.
Sec. 1.552-3 Stock ownership requirement.
(a) To meet the stock ownership requirement, it is necessary that at
some time in the taxable year more than 50 percent in value of the
outstanding stock of the foreign corporation be owned, directly or
indirectly, by or for not more than five individuals who are citizens or
residents of the United States, herein referred to as United States
group. For the purpose of the requirement under section 552(a)(2),
section 554 provides that the ownership of the stock must be determined
under the rules prescribed by section 544 (relating to rules for
determining stock ownership in the case of personal holding companies
generally). Accordingly, section 544 and Sec. Sec. 1.544-1 through
1.544-7 are applicable for purposes of section 552(a)(2) and this
section as if each reference in section 544 and Sec. Sec. 1.544-1
through 1.544-7 to a personal holding company or to part II (section 541
and following), subchapter G, chapter 1 of the Code, was a reference to
a foreign personal holding company or to part III (section 551 and
following), subchapter G, chapter 1 of the Code, as the case may be.
(b) It is necessary to consider any change in the stock outstanding
during the taxable year, whether in the number of shares or classes of
stock, or in the ownership thereof, since a corporation comes within the
classification if the statutory conditions with respect to stock
ownership are present at any time during the taxable year.
(c) In determining whether the statutory conditions with respect to
stock ownership are present at any time during the taxable year, the
phrase in value shall, in the light of all the circumstances, be deemed
the value of the corporate stock outstanding at such time (not including
treasury stock). This value may be determined upon the basis of the
company's net worth, earning and dividend paying capacity, appreciation
of assets, together with such other factors as have a bearing upon the
value of the stock. If the value of the stock which is used is greatly
at variance with that reflected by the corporate books, the evidence of
such value should be filed with the return. In any case where there are
two or more classes of stock outstanding, the total value of all the
stock should be allocated among the different classes according to the
relative value of each class therein.
Sec. 1.552-4 Certain excluded banks.
(a) A corporation is excluded from the definition of foreign
personal holding company if it is organized and doing business under the
banking and credit laws of a foreign country and if it establishes to
the satisfaction of the Commissioner that it was not formed or availed
of for the purpose of evading or avoiding United States income taxes
which would otherwise be imposed on its shareholders. If this is
established,
[[Page 293]]
the Commissioner, or such other official to whom authority may be
delegated, will certify, by letter to the corporation, that it is not a
foreign personal holding company.
(b) An application for certification under section 552(b)(2) shall
be made in writing to the Commissioner of Internal Revenue, Washington
DC 20225, Attention: Director of International Operations. A separate
application shall be filed for each taxable year for which certification
is requested, and the application shall be accompanied by a completed
Form 958 for the taxable year. See section 6035. The following
information shall be set forth in, or submitted with, the application:
(1) A complete reference to the banking or credit laws of the
foreign country under which the corporation operates;
(2) A statement as to the extent of the corporation's business in
receiving deposits and making loans and discounts and similar banking
and credit operations;
(3) A statement as to the extent of the operations of the
corporation other than such banking and credit operations;
(4) A statement as to whether the banking and credit operations of
the corporation are customary for it;
(5) A statement setting forth the degree and manner of supervision
exercised over it by the foreign government under its banking and credit
laws; a copy (in English) of the corporation's last annual financial
statement, as submitted to the Government authority having jurisdiction
over it, shall be submitted with the application;
(6) A statement setting forth the business reasons of the
corporation for not distributing the amount which would be its
undistributed foreign personal holding company income if the corporation
were not excluded under section 552(b);
(7) A statement setting forth the extent of the corporation's
profits which must be retained as reserves under the foreign law;
(8) A statement setting forth the date or dates when the corporation
reasonably expects to distribute is undistributed foreign personal
holding company income for the taxable year;
(9) A statement setting forth the name and address of each of the
individuals described in section 552(a)(2), the extent of their stock
ownership in the corporation, and the amount of distributions or other
payments to such stockholders, including, but not limited to, dividends,
compensation, interest, and rents; and
(10) Any other facts or information the corporation may wish to
submit to show that it was not formed or availed of for the purpose of
evading or avoiding United States income taxes which would otherwise be
imposed on its shareholders
The corporation shall also furnish such other information requested as
necessary by the Director of International Operations. The application
for certification, together with the information required by this
paragraph, should be filed within 60 days after the close of the taxable
year of the corporation or before November 9, 1958, whichever is later.
However, if the corporation is unable, for good cause, to submit the
application for certification within such 60-day period, additional time
may be granted by the Director of International Operations upon receipt
of a request from the corporation setting forth the reasons for such
request.
Sec. 1.552-5 United States shareholder of excluded bank.
A copy of the certification issued to an excluded bank under section
552(b)(2) and Sec. 1.552-4 shall be filed with, and made a part of, the
income tax return for the taxable year of each United States shareholder
of such foreign corporation, if he has been a shareholder of such
corporation for any part of such year. If the certificate has not been
issued at the time the return of the United States shareholder is filed,
the shareholder shall compute the tax on his return by treating the bank
as a foreign personal holding company. If a certificate is issued after
the return is filed, the United States shareholder may file a claim for
refund or an amended return, and shall attach thereto a copy of the
certification.
[[Page 294]]
Sec. 1.553-1 Foreign personal holding company income.
Foreign personal holding company income shall consist of the items
defined under section 543 and Sec. Sec. 1.543-1 and 1.543-2, relating
to personal holding company income, with the following exceptions:
(a) The entire amount received as interest, whether or not treated
as rent, shall be considered to be foreign personal holding company
income. Thus, the exception in the second sentence of section 543(a)(1)
and paragraph (b)(2) of Sec. 1.543-1 (relating to interest treated as
rent under section 543(a)(7) and paragraph (b)(10) of Sec. 1.543-1), is
inapplicable for the purpose of determining foreign personal holding
company income. Similarly, section 543(a)(7) and paragraph (b)(10) of
Sec. 1.543-1 are applied for this purpose without regard to the
interest described in that section.
(b)(1) The entire amount received as royalties, whether or not
mineral, oil, or gas royalties, or copyright royalties, shall be
considered to be foreign personal holding company income. Thus,
subparagraphs (A) and (B) of section 543(a)(8) and paragraph (b)(11)(i)
(a) and (b) of Sec. 1.543-1 (relating to mineral, oil, or gas
royalties), and subparagraphs (A), (B), and (C) of section 543(a)(9) and
paragraph (b) (12)(ii) of Sec. 1.543-1 (relating to copyright
royalties), are inapplicable for the purpose of determining foreign
personal holding company income.
(2) In computing foreign personal holding company income, the first
sentence of paragraph (b)(11)(ii) of Sec. 1.543-1 shall apply to
overriding royalties received from the sublessee by the operating
company which originally leased and developed the natural resource
property in respect of which such overriding royalties are paid, and to
mineral, oil, or gas production payments, only with respect to amounts
received after September 30, 1958.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6739, 29 FR
7715, June 17, 1964]
Sec. 1.554-1 Stock ownership.
For regulations under section 554, see Sec. 1.552-3.
Sec. 1.555-1 General rule.
The gross income of a foreign corporation which is a foreign
personal holding company is computed the same as if the foreign
corporation were a domestic corporation which is a personal holding
company. See section 542(a)(1) and Sec. 1.542-2. The gross income of a
foreign personal holding company thus includes income from all sources,
whether within or without the United States, which is not specifically
excluded from gross income under any other provisions of the Code. For
example, the gross income of a foreign personal holding company includes
all income from sources outside the United States even though the
foreign personal holding company is a foreign corporation not engaged in
trade or business within the United States. However, the gross income of
a foreign corporation which is a foreign personal holding company shall
not include, with respect to a United States shareholder described in
section 951(b), dividends received by such corporation which are
excluded under section 959(b) from the income of such corporation with
respect to such shareholder.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6795, 30 FR
934, Jan. 29, 1965]
Sec. 1.555-2 Additions to gross income.
(a) If, for any taxable year:
(1) A foreign corporation meets the stock ownership requirement
specified in section 552(a)(2) and Sec. 1.552-3, regardless of whatever
day in its taxable year is the last day on which the required United
States group exists, and
(2) Such foreign corporation is a shareholder in a foreign personal
holding company on any day of a taxable year of the second company which
ends with or within the taxable year of the first company and such day
is the last day in the taxable year of the second company in which the
United States group exists with respect to the second company, then for
the purpose of:
(i) Determining whether the first company meets the specified gross
income requirement so as to come within the classification of a foreign
personal holding company, and
[[Page 295]]
(ii) Determining the undistributed foreign personal holding company
income of the first company which (in the event the first company is a
foreign personal holding company) is to be included, in whole or in
part, in the gross income of its shareholders, whether United States
shareholders or other foreign personal holding companies
there shall be included as a dividend in the gross income of the first
company for the taxable year in which or with which the taxable year of
the second company ends, the amount the first company would have
received as a dividend, if on the last day referred to in this
subparagraph there had been distributed by the second company, and
received by the shareholders, an amount which bears the same ratio to
the undistributed foreign personal holding company income of the second
company for its taxable year as the portion of such taxable year up to
and including such last day bears to the entire taxable year. The
foregoing rules apply to any chain of foreign corporations regardless of
the number of corporations included in the chain.
(b) The application of section 555(b) may be illustrated by the
following examples:
Example 1. The X Corporation is a foreign corporation whose stock is
owned by A, a United States citizen. The X Corporation owns the entire
stock of the Y Corporation, another foreign corporation. The taxable
year of the X Corporation is the calendar year and the taxable year of
the Y Corporation is the fiscal year ending June 30. For the fiscal year
ending June 30, 1955, more than the required percentage of the Y
Corporation's gross income consists of foreign personal holding company
income and no part of the earnings for such year is distributed as
dividends. On the basis of these facts the Y Corporation is a foreign
personal holding company for the fiscal year ending June 30, 1955. The X
Corporation meets the stock ownership requirement and constitutes a
foreign personal holding company for 1955, if it also meets the gross
income requirement. For the purpose of determining whether the X
Corporation meets the gross income requirements, the entire
undistributed foreign personal holding company income of the Y
Corporation for the fiscal year ending June 30, 1955, must be included
as a dividend in the gross income of the X Corporation for 1955, since:
(1) The X Corporation was a shareholder in the Y Corporation on a
day (June 30, 1955) in the taxable year of the Y Corporation ending with
or within the taxable year of the X Corporation, which day was the last
day in the taxable year of the Y Corporation on which the United States
group required with respect to the Y Corporation existed,
(2) Such last day was also the end of the Y Corporation's taxable
year so that the portion of the taxable year of the Y Corporation up to
and including such last day is equal to 100 percent of the taxable year
of the Y Corporation, and, therefore, the portion of the undistributed
foreign personal holding company income of the Y Corporation includible
in the gross income of its shareholders is likewise equal to 100
percent, and
(3) The X Corporation being the sole shareholder of the Y
Corporation must include such portion in its gross income for 1955, the
taxable year in which or with which the taxable year of the Y
Corporation ends. If, after the inclusion of the presumptive dividend in
its gross income, the X Corporation is a foreign personal holding
company for 1955, then the undistributed foreign personal holding
company income of the Y Corporation must also be included as a dividend
in the gross income of the X Corporation in determining its
undistributed foreign personal holding company income which is to be
included in the gross income of A, the sole shareholder in the X
Corporation. On the other hand, if, after including such presumptive
dividend, the X Corporation does not constitute a foreign personal
holding company, the undistributed foreign personal holding company
income of the Y Corporation is not includible in the gross income of the
X Corporation.
Example 2. The X Corporation referred to in example 1 sold the stock
in the Y Corporation to other interests on September 30, 1955, so that
after that date no United States group existed with respect to the Y
Corporation. For the fiscal year ending June 30, 1956, more than the
required percentage of the gross income of the Y Corporation consists of
foreign personal holding company income. The taxable income of the Y
Corporation for such fiscal year amounts to $1,000,000, of which
$900,000 is distributed in dividends after September 30, 1955. The
undistributed foreign personal holding company income of the Y
Corporation for such fiscal year amounts to $100,000. Upon the basis of
these facts the Y Corporation is a foreign personal holding company for
the fiscal year ending June 30, 1956, since at one time in such fiscal
year, or from July 1 to and including September 30, 1955, it meets the
stock ownership requirement, and the gross income requirement is also
satisfied. In determining whether the X Corporation constitutes a
foreign personal holding company for 1956, a portion of the
undistributed foreign personal holding company income of the Y
Corporation for the fiscal year ending June 30, 1956 (three-
[[Page 296]]
twelfths of $100,000, or $25,000), must be included as a dividend in the
gross income of the X Corporation, since:
(1) The X Corporation was a shareholder in the Y Corporation on
September 30, 1955, or on a day in the taxable year of the Y Corporation
ending with or within the taxable year of the X Corporation which day
was the last day in the Y Corporation's taxable year on which the United
States group required with respect to the Y Corporation existed.
(2) The portion of the taxable year of the Y Corporation up to and
including such day is three-twelfths of the entire taxable year of the Y
Corporation and, therefore, the portion of the undistributed foreign
personal holding company income of the Y Corporation includible in the
gross income of its shareholders also is equal to three-twelfths, and
(3) The X Corporation, being the sole shareholder of the Y
Corporation at the time the United States group with respect to the Y
Corporation last existed, must include all of such portion in its gross
income for 1956, the taxable year of the X Corporation in which or with
which the taxable year of the Y Corporation ends
It is to be observed that three-twelfths of the undistributed foreign
personal holding company income of the Y Corporation for the entire
taxable year and not the earnings realized by the Y Corporation up to
and including September 30, 1955, the last day on which the United
States group with respect to the Y Corporation existed, must be included
in the gross income of the X Corporation.
Example 3. The X Corporation referred to in example 1 sold the stock
in the Y Corporation to other interests on September 30, 1955, so that
after that date a different United States group existed with respect to
the Y Corporation. Assuming that the Y Corporation is a foreign personal
holding company for the fiscal year ending June 30, 1956, no part of the
undistributed foreign personal holding company income of the Y
Corporation for such fiscal year would, in this instance, be includible
in the gross income of the X Corporation for the year 1956, in
determining whether the X Corporation is a foreign personal holding
company for that year. In such case, the undistributed foreign personal
holding company income of the Y Corporation is includible in the gross
income of the other foreign personal holding companies, if any, and of
the United States shareholders who are shareholders in the Y Corporation
the day after September 30, 1955, which was the last day in the taxable
year of the Y Corporation on which the United States group withrespect
to the Y Corporation existed. If, however, the X Corporation sells
90percent of its stock in the Y Corporation and thus is a minority
shareholder in the Y Corporation on the last day of the taxable year of
the Y Corporation on which the United States group with respect to the Y
Corporation exists, the portion of the undistributed foreign personal
holding company income allocable to the minority interests of the X
Corporation would be includible in the gross income of the X
Corporation, even though on such last day the United States group is not
the same with respect to both corporations.
Example 4. If the Y Corporation in example 1 owns all of the stock
of the Z Corporation, another foreign corporation, there would be a
chain of three foreign corporations. In such case, assuming that the Z
Corporation is a foreign personal holding company for a taxable year
ending with or within the taxable year of the Y Corporation, the
undistributed foreign personal holding company income of the Z
Corporation would be included in the gross income of the Y Corporation
for the purpose of determining whether the Y Corporation comes within
the classification of a foreign personal holding company. If, after the
inclusion of such presumptive dividend, the Y Corporation is a foreign
personal holding company, the undistributed foreign personal holding
company income of the Z Corporation would be included in the gross
income of the Y Corporation in determining the undistributed foreign
personal holding company income of the Y Corporationwhich is includible
in the gross income of its shareholder, the X Corporation. The same
process would be repeated with respect to determining whether the X
Corporation is a foreign personal holding company and in determining its
undistributed foreign personal holding company income. If all three
corporations are foreign personal holding companies, the undistributed
foreign personal holding company income of each would, in this manner,
be reflected as a dividend in the gross income of A, the ultimate
beneficial shareholder of the chain. In the event that after the
inclusion of the undistributed foreign personal holding company income
of the Z Corporation in the gross income of the Y Corporation, the Y
Corporation is not a foreign personal holding company, then no part of
the income of either the Z Corporation or the Y Corporation would be
includible in the gross income of the X Corporation. In that event,
whether the X Corporation is a foreign personal holding company, and its
undistributed foreign personal holding company income, would be
determined independently of the income of the Y Corporation and the Z
Corporation.
Sec. 1.556-1 Definition.
Undistributed foreign personal holding company income is the amount
which is to be included in the gross income of the United States
shareholders
[[Page 297]]
under section 551(b) and Sec. 1.551-2. Undistributed foreign personal
holding company income is the taxable income of the foreign personal
holding company, as defined in section 63(a) (computed without regard to
subchapter N, chapter 1 of the Code), and adjusted in the manner
described in section 556(b) and Sec. 1.556-2, less the deduction for
dividends paid (Sec. Sec. 1.561-1 through 1.565-6). See Sec. 1.556-3
for an illustration of the computation of undistributed foreign personal
holding company income.
Sec. 1.556-2 Adjustments to taxable income.
(a) Taxes--(1) General rule. (i) In computing undistributed foreign
personal holding company income for any taxable year, there shall be
allowed as a deduction the Federal income and excess profits taxes
accrued during the taxable year except that no deduction shall be
allowed for (a) the accumulated earnings tax imposed by section 531 (or
a corresponding section of a prior law), (b) the personal holding
company tax imposed by section 541 (or a corresponding section of a
prior law), and (c) the excess profits tax imposed by subchapter E,
chapter 2 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1939 for taxable years
beginning after December 31, 1940. The deduction is for taxes for the
taxable year determined under the accrual method of accounting,
regardless of whether the corporation uses an accrual method of
accounting, the cash receipts and disbursements method, or any other
allowable method of accounting. In computing the amount of taxes
accrued, an unpaid tax which is being contested is not considered
accrued until the contest is resolved.
(ii) However, the corporation shall deduct taxes paid, rather than
taxes accrued, if it used that method with respect to Federal taxes for
each taxable year for which it was subject to the provisions of
supplement P, subchapter C, chapter 1 of the Internal Revenue Code of
1939, unless an election is made under subparagraph (2) of this
paragraph to deduct taxes accrued.
(2) Election by corporation which deducted taxes paid. (i) If the
corporation was subject to supplement P, subchapter C, chapter 1 of the
Internal Revenue Code of 1939, and, for the purpose of computing
undistributed supplement P net income under such Code, deducted Federal
taxes paid, rather than such taxes accrued, for each taxable year for
which it was subject to supplement P of the 1939 Code, the corporation
may elect for any taxable year ending after August 16, 1954, to deduct
taxes accrued, rather than taxes paid, for the purpose of computing its
undistributed foreign personal holding company income. The election
shall be made by deducting such taxes accrued in the return (Form 958)
required to be filed for such taxable year. The return shall, in
addition, contain a statement that the corporation has made such
election and shall set forth the year to which such election was first
applicable. The deduction of taxes accrued in the year of election
precludes the deduction of taxes paid during such year. The election, if
made, shall be irrevocable and the deduction for taxes accrued shall be
allowed for the year of election and for all subsequent taxable years.
See section 6035 and the regulations thereunder for rules relative to
the filing of returns of officers, directors, and shareholders of
foreign personal holding companies.
(ii) Pursuant to section 7851(a)(1)(C), the election provided for in
subdivision (i) of this subparagraph may be made with respect to a
taxable year ending after August 16, 1954, even though such taxable year
is subject to the Internal Revenue Code of 1939.
(3) Taxes of foreign countries and United States possessions. In
computing taxable income, a foreign personal holding company is allowed
a deduction under section 164 for income, war profits, and excess-
profits taxes paid or accrued during the taxable year to foreign
countries or possessions of the United States, but is not allowed the
foreign tax credit under section 901. Therefore, in computing
undistributed foreign personal holding company income for any taxable
year, no adjustment under section 556(b)(1) is allowed for such taxes.
(b) Charitable contributions--(1) Taxable years beginning before
January 1, 1970. (i) Section 556(b)(2) provides that, in computing the
deduction for charitable contributions for purposes of determining the
undistributed foreign
[[Page 298]]
personal holding company income of a corporation for taxable years
beginning before January 1, 1970, the limitations in section
170(b)(1)(A) and (B), relating to charitable contributions by
individuals, shall apply and section 170(b)(2) and (5), relating to
charitable contributions by corporations and carryover of certain excess
charitable contributions made by individuals, respectively, shall not
apply.
(ii) Although the limitations of section 170(b)(1)(A) and (B) are 10
and 20 percent, respectively, of the individual's adjusted gross income,
the limitations are applied for purposes of section 556(b)(2) by using
10 and 20 percent, respectively, of the corporation's taxable income as
adjusted for purposes of section 170(b)(2), that is, the same amount of
taxable income to which the 5-percent limitation applied. Thus, the term
adjusted gross income when used in section 170(b)(1) means the
corporation's taxable income computed with the adjustments, other than
the 5-percent limitation, provided in the first sentence of section
170(b)(2). However, a further adjustment for this purpose is that the
taxable income shall also be computed without the deduction of the
amount disallowed under section 556(b)(5), relating to expenses and
depreciation applicable to property of the taxpayer, and section
556(b)(6), relating to taxes and contributions to pension trusts, and
without the inclusion of the amounts includible as dividends under
section 555(b), relating to the inclusion in gross income of a foreign
personal holding company of its distributive share of the undistributed
foreign personal holding company income of another company in which it
is a shareholder. The carryover of charitable contributions made in a
prior year, otherwise allowable as a deduction in computing taxable
income to the extent provided in section 170(b)(2) and, with respect to
contributions paid in taxable years beginning after December 31, 1963,
in section 170(b)(5), shall not be allowed as a deduction in computing
undistributed foreign personal holding company income for any taxable
year.
(iii) See Sec. 1.170-2 with respect to the charitable contributions
to which the 10-percent limitation is applicable and the charitable
contributions to which the 20-percent limitation is applicable.
(2) Taxable years beginning after December 31, 1969. (i) Section
556(b)(2) provides that, in computing the deduction allowable for
charitable contributions for purposes of determining the undistributed
foreign personal holding company income of a corporation for taxable
years beginning after December 31, 1969, the limitations in section
170(b)(1) (A), (B), and (D)(i) (relating to charitable contributions by
individuals) shall apply, and section 170(b)(1)(D)(ii) (relating to
excess charitable contributions by individuals of certain capital gain
property), section 170(b)(2) (relating to the 5-percent limitation on
charitable contributions by corporations), and section 170(d) (relating
to carryovers of excess contributions of individuals and corporations)
shall not apply.
(ii) Although the limitations of section 170(b)(1) (A), (B), and
(D)(i) are 50, 20, and 30 percent, respectively, of an individual's
contribution base, these limitations are applied for purposes of section
556(b)(2) by using 50, 20, and 30 percent, respectively, of the
corporation's taxable income as adjusted for purposes of section
170(b)(2), that is, the same amount of taxable income to which the 5-
percent limitation applies. Thus, the term contribution base when used
in section 170(b)(1) means the corporation's taxable income computed
with the adjustments, other than the 5-percent limitation, provided in
section 170(b)(2). However, a further adjustment for this purpose is
that the taxable income shall also be computed without the deduction of
the amount disallowed under section 556(b)(5), relating to expenses and
depreciation applicable to property of the taxpayer, and section
556(b)(6), relating to taxes and contributions to pension trusts, and
without the inclusion of the amounts includible as dividends under
section 555(b), relating to the inclusion in gross income of a foreign
personal holding company of its distributive share of the undistributed
foreign personal holding company income of another company in which it
is a shareholder. The carryover of charitable contributions made in a
prior year, otherwise allowable as a deduction in
[[Page 299]]
computing taxable income to the extent provided in section 170(b)(1) (D)
(ii) and (d), shall not be allowed as a deduction in computing
undistributed foreign personal holding company income for any taxable
year.
(iii) See Sec. 1.170A-8 for the rules with respect to the
charitable contributions to which the 50-, 20-, and 30-percent
limitations apply.
(c) Special deductions disallowed. Part VIII, subchapter B, chapter
1 of the Code allows corporations special deductions in computing
taxable income for such matters as partially tax-exempt interest,
certain dividends received, dividends paid on certain preferred stock of
public utilities, organizational expenses, etc. See section 241. For
purposes of computing undistributed foreign personal holding company
income, such special deductions, except the deduction provided by
section 248 (relating to organizational expenditures) and, with respect
to such a computation for a taxable year ending before January 1, 1958,
the deduction provided by section 242 (relating to partially tax-exempt
interest), shall be disallowed.
(d) Net operating loss. The net operating loss deduction provided in
section 172 is not allowed for purposes of the computation of
undistributed foreign personal holding company income. For purposes of
such a computation, however, there is allowed as a deduction the amount
of the net operating loss (as defined in section 172(c)) for the
preceding taxable year, except that, in computing undistributed foreign
personal holding company income for a taxable year ending after December
31, 1957, the amount of such net operating loss shall be computed
without the deductions provided in part VIII (section 241 and following)
except section 248, relating to organizational expenditures, subchapter
B, chapter 1 of the Code.
(e) Expenses and depreciation applicable to property of the
corporation. (1) Section 556(b)(5) provides a specific limitation in
computing undistributed foreign personal holding company income, with
respect to the allowance of deductions for trade or business expenses
and depreciation which are allocable to the operation and maintenance of
property owned or operated by a foreign personal holding company. Under
this limitation these deductions shall not be allowed in excess of the
aggregate amount of the rent or other compensation received for the use
of, or the right to use, the property, unless it is established to the
satisfaction of the Commissioner:
(i) That the rent or other compensation received was the highest
obtainable, or if none was received, that none was obtainable;
(ii) That the property was held in the course of a business carried
on bona fide for profit; and
(iii) Either that there was reasonable expectation that the
operation of the property would result in a profit, or that the property
was necessary to the conduct of the business.
(2) The burden of proof will rest upon the taxpayer to sustain the
deduction claimed. If a United States shareholder, in computing his
distributive share of undistributed foreign personal holding company
income to be included in gross income in his individual return (see
section 551, and Sec. Sec. 1.551-1 and 1.551-2), claims deductions for
expenses and depreciation allocable to the operation and maintenance of
property owned or operated by the company, in an aggregate amount in
excess of the rent or other compensation received for the use of, or the
right to use, the property, he shall attach to his income tax return a
statement setting forth his claim for allowance of the additional
deductions, together with a complete statement of the facts and
circumstances pertinent to his claim and the arguments on which he
relies. Such statement shall set forth:
(i) A description of the property;
(ii) The cost or other basis to the corporation and the nature and
value of the consideration paid for the property;
(iii) The name and address of the person from whom the property was
acquired and the date the property was acquired;
(iv) The name and address of the person to whom the property is
leased or rented, or the person permitted to use the property, and the
number of shares of stock, if any, held by such person and the members
of his family;
[[Page 300]]
(v) The nature and gross amount of the rent or other compensation
received for the use of, or the right to use, the property during the
taxable year and for each of the five preceding years and the amount of
the expenses incurred with respect to, and the depreciation sustained
on, the property for such years;
(vi) Evidence that the rent or other compensation was the highest
obtainable, or, if none was received, a statement of the reasons
therefor;
(vii) In the case of a return for a taxable year beginning before
January 1, 2003, a copy of the contract, lease, or rental agreement;
(viii) The purpose for which the property was used;
(ix) The business carried on by the corporation with respect to
which the property was held and the gross income, expenses, and taxable
income derived from the conduct of such business for the taxable year
and for each of the five preceding years;
(x) A statement of any reasons which existed for expectation that
the operation of the property would be profitable, or a statement of the
necessity for the use of the property in the business of the
corporation, and the reasons why the property was acquired; and
(xi) Any other information pertinent to the taxpayer's claim.
(3) If the statement described in Sec. 1.556-2(e)(2) is attached to
a taxpayer's income tax return for a taxable year beginning after
December 31, 2002, a copy of the applicable contract, lease or rental
agreement is not required to be submitted with the return, but must be
retained by the taxpayer and kept available for inspection in the manner
required by Sec. 1.6001-1(e).
(f) Taxes and contributions to pension trusts. Section 164(e)
provides for deduction by a corporation for taxes of a shareholder paid
by it; section 404 provides for deduction by an employer for its
contributions to an employees' trust, etc. For the purpose of computing
undistributed foreign personal holding company income, neither of these
deductions is allowable.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 7207, 37 FR
20796, Oct. 5, 1972; T.D. 9100, 68 FR 70704, Dec. 19, 2003; T.D. 9300,
71 FR 71042, Dec. 8, 2006]
Sec. 1.556-3 Illustration of computation of undistributed foreign
personal holding company income.
The method of computation of the undistributed foreign personal
holding company income may be illustrated by the following example:
Example. (a) The following facts exist with respect to the M
Corporation, a foreign personal holding company, for the calendar year
1954:
(1) The gross income of the corporation as defined in section 555
amounts to $300,000, of which $85,000 represents its distributive share
of the undistributed foreign personal holding company income of another
foreign personal holding company in which it is a shareholder, $200,000
consists of dividends, $10,000 consists of fully taxable interest, and
the remainder ($5,000) consists of rent received from the principal
shareholder of the corporation for the use of property owned by the
corporation.
(2) The expenses of the corporation amount to $85,000, of which
$75,000 is allocable to the maintenance and operation of the property
used by the principal shareholder and $10,000 consists of ordinary and
necessary office expenses allowable as a deduction. The claim for
deduction for the expenses of, and depreciation on, the rented property
in excess of the rent received for its use is not established as
provided in section 556(b)(5). The yearly depreciation on the rented
property amounts to $30,000.
(3) Federal income tax withheld at the source on the income of the
corporation from sources within the United States amounts to $59,125.
(4) No gain from the sale or exchange of stock or securities is
realized during the taxable year, but losses in the amount of $10,000
are sustained from the sale of stock or securities which constitute
capital assets. Such losses are not allowed as a deduction in any
amount. See section 1211(a).
(5) Contributions, payment of which is made to or for the use of
donees described in section 170(b)(1)(A) for the purposes therein
specified, amount to $15,000, of which $5,000 is deductible in computing
taxable income under section 63.
(6) Dividends paid by the corporation to its shareholders during the
taxable year amount to $50,000.
[[Page 301]]
(b) The taxable income of the corporation (including the
distributive share of the undistributed foreign personal holding company
income of the other foreign personal holding company) is $180,000,
computed as follows (assuming for the purposes of this example only that
the expenses of, and depreciation on, the rental property are deductible
under sections 162 and 167):
Income (Section 61)
Dividends................................................... $200,000
Interest.................................................... 10,000
Rent........................................................ 5,000
-----------
Gross income as defined in section 61................... 215,000
Add:
Distributive share of undistributed income of the other 85,000
foreign personal holding company (considered as a
dividend)................................................
-----------
Gross income as defined in section 555................ 300,000
===========
Deductions (Section 161)
Expenses allocable to operation of the rented property...... $75,000
Depreciation of the rented property......................... 30,000
Ordinary and necessary expenses (office).................... 10,000
Contributions (within the 5-percent limitation specified in 5,000
section 170(b) (2).........................................
120,000
===========
Taxable income for purposes of computing undistributed 180,000
foreign personal holding company income................
(c) The undistributed foreign personal holding company income of the
corporation is $160,875, computed as follows:
Taxable income for purposes of computing undistributed $180,000
foreign personal holding company income....................
===========
Add (see section 556(b)):
Contributions deductible in computing taxable income under 5,000
section 63...............................................
Excess property expenses and depreciation over amount of 100,000
rent received for use of property ($105,000-$5,000)......
-----------
Total................................................. 105,000
===========
Deduct (see section 556(b)):
Federal income taxes...................................... 59,125
Contributions (within the percentage limitations specified 15,000
in section 170(b)(1) (A) and (B), determined under the
rules provided in section 556(b)(2)).....................
-----------
Total................................................. 74,125
===========
Net additions under section 556(b).......................... 30,875
-----------
Taxable income, as adjusted under section 556(b)...... 210,875
Less: Deduction for dividends paid (see section 561)........ 50,000
-----------
Undistributed foreign personal holding company income... 160,875
Deduction for Dividends Paid
Sec. 1.561-1 Deduction for dividends paid.
(a) The deduction for dividends paid is applicable in determining
accumulated taxable income under section 535, undistributed personal
holding company income under section 545, undistributed foreign personal
holding company income under section 556, investment company taxable
income under section 852, and real estate investment trust taxable
income under section 857. The deduction for dividends paid includes:
(1) The dividends paid during the taxable year;
(2) The consent dividends for the taxable year, determined as
provided in section 565; and
(3) In the case of a personal holding company, the dividend
carryover computed as provided in section 564.
(b) For dividends for which the dividends paid deduction is
allowable, see section 562 and Sec. 1.562-1. As to when dividends are
considered paid, see Sec. 1.561-2.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6598, 27 FR
4093, Apr. 28, 1962]
Sec. 1.561-2 When dividends are considered paid.
(a) In general. (1) A dividend will be considered as paid when it is
received by the shareholder. A deduction for dividends paid during the
taxable year will not be permitted unless the shareholder receives the
dividend during the taxable year for which the deduction is claimed. See
section 563 for special rule with respect to dividends paid after the
close of the taxable year.
(2) If a dividend is paid by check and the check bearing a date
within the taxable year is deposited in the mails, in a cover properly
stamped and addressed to the shareholder at his last known address, at
such time that in the ordinary handling of the mails the check would be
received by the shareholder within the taxable year, a presumption
arises that the dividend was paid to the shareholder in such year.
(3) The payment of a dividend during the taxable year to the
authorized agent of the shareholder will be
[[Page 302]]
deemed payment of the dividend to the shareholder during such year.
(4) If a corporation, instead of paying the dividend directly to the
shareholder, credits the account of the shareholder on the books of the
corporation with the amount of the dividend, the deduction for a
dividend paid will not be permitted unless it be shown to the
satisfaction of the Commissioner that such crediting constituted payment
of the dividend to the shareholder within the taxable year.
(5) A deduction will not be permitted for the amount of a dividend
credited during the taxable year upon an obligation of the shareholder
to the corporation unless it is shown to the satisfaction of the
Commissioner that such crediting constituted payment of the dividend to
the shareholder within the taxable year.
(6) If the dividend is payable in obligations of the corporation,
they should be entered or registered in the taxable year on the books of
the corporation, in the name of the shareholder (or his nominee or
transferee), and, in the case of obligations payable to bearer, should
be received in the taxable year by the shareholder (or his nominee or
transferee) to constitute payment of the dividend within the taxable
year.
(7) In the case of a dividend from which the tax has been deducted
and withheld as required by chapter 3 (section 1441 and following), of
the Code the dividend is considered as paid when such deducting and
withholding occur.
(b) Methods of accounting. The determination of whether a dividend
has been paid to the shareholder by the corporation during its taxable
year is in no way dependent upon the method of accounting regularly
employed by the corporation in keeping its books or upon the method of
accounting upon the basis of which the taxable income of the corporation
is computed.
(c) Records. Every corporation claiming a deduction for dividends
paid shall keep such permanent records as are necessary (1) to establish
that the dividends with respect to which such deduction is claimed were
actually paid during the taxable year and (2) to supply the information
required to be filed with the income tax return of the corporation. Such
corporation shall file with its return (i) a copy of the dividend
resolution; and (ii) a concise statement of the pertinent facts relating
to the payment of the dividend, clearly specifying (a) the medium of
payment and (b) if not paid in money, the fair market value and adjusted
basis (or face value, if paid in its own obligations) on the date of
distribution of the property distributed and the manner in which such
fair market value and adjusted basis were determined. Canceled dividend
checks and receipts obtained from shareholders acknowledging payment of
dividends paid otherwise than by check need not be filed with the return
but shall be kept by the corporation as a part of its records.
Sec. 1.562-1 Dividends for which the dividends paid deduction is
allowable.
(a) General rule. Except as otherwise provided in section 562 (b)
and (d), the term dividend, for purposes of determining dividends
eligible for the dividends paid deduction, refers only to a dividend
described in section 316 (relating to definition of dividends for
purposes of corporate distributions). No distribution, however, which is
preferential within the meaning of section 562(c) and Sec. 1.562-2
shall be eligible for the dividends paid deduction. Moreover, when
computing the dividends paid deduction with respect to a U.S. person (as
defined in section 957(d)), no distribution which is excluded from the
gross income of a foreign corporation under section 959(b) with respect
to such person or from gross income of such person under section 959(a)
shall be eligible for suchdeduction. Further, for purposes of the
dividends paid deduction, the term dividend does not include a
distribution in liquidation unless the distribution is treated as a
dividend under section 316(b)(2) and paragraph (b)(2) of Sec. 1.316-1,
or under section 333(e)(1) and paragraph (c) of Sec. 1.333-4 or
paragraph (c)(2), (d)(1)(ii), or (d)(2) of Sec. 1.333-5, or qualifies
under section 562(b) and paragraph (b) of this section. If a dividend is
paid in property (other than money) the amount of the dividends paid
deduction with respect to such property shall be the adjusted basis of
the property in the hands of the distributing corporation at the
[[Page 303]]
time of the distribution. See paragraph (b)(2) of this section for
special rules with respect to liquidating distributions by personal
holding companies occurring during a taxable year of the distributing
corporation beginning after December 31, 1963. Also see section 563 for
special rules with respect to dividends paid after the close of the
taxable year.
(b) Distributions in liquidation--(1) General rule--(i) In general.
In the case of amounts distributed in liquidation by any corporation
during a taxable year of such corporation beginning before January 1,
1964, or by a corporation other than a personal holding company (as
defined in section 542) or a foreign personal holding company (as
defined in section 552) during a taxable year of such a corporation
beginning after December 31, 1963, section 562(b) makes an exception to
the general rule that a deduction for dividends paid is permitted only
with respect to dividends described in section 316. In order to qualify
under that exception, the distribution must be one either in complete or
partial liquidation of a corporation pursuant to sections 331, 332, or
333. See subparagraph (2) of this paragraph for rules relating to the
treatment of distributions in complete liquidation made by a corporation
which is a personal holding company to corporate shareholders during a
taxable year of such distributing corporation beginning after December
31, 1963. As provided by section 346(a), for the purpose of section
562(b), a partial liquidation includes a redemption of stock to which
section 302 applies. Amounts distributed in liquidation in a transaction
which is preceded, or followed, by a transfer to another corporation of
all or part of the assets of the liquidating corporation, may not be
eligible for the dividends paid deduction.
(ii) Amount of dividends paid deduction allowable--(a) General rule.
In the case of distributions in liquidation with respect to which a
deduction for dividends paid is permissible under subdivision (i) of
this subparagraph, the amount of the deduction is equal to the part of
such distribution which is properly chargeable to the earnings and
profits accumulated after February 28, 1913. To determine the amount
properly chargeable to the earnings and profits accumulated after
February 28, 1913, there must be deducted from the amount of the
distribution that part allocable to capital account. The capital
account, for the purposes of this subdivision, includes not only amounts
representing the par or stated value of the stock with respect to which
the liquidation distribution is made, but also that stock's proper share
of the paid-in surplus, and such other corporate items, if any, which,
for purposes of income taxation, are treated like capital in that they
are not taxable dividends when distributed but are applied against and
reduce the basis of the stock. The remainder of the distribution in
liquidation is, ordinarily, properly chargeable to the earnings and
profits accumulated after February 28, 1913. Thus, if there is a deficit
in earnings and profits on the first day of a taxable year, and the
earnings and profits for such taxable year do not exceed such deficit,
no dividends paid deduction would be allowed for such taxable year with
respect to a distribution in liquidation; if the earnings and profits
for such taxable year exceed the deficit in earnings and profits which
existed on the first day of such taxable year, then a dividends paid
deduction would be allowed to the extent of such excess.
(b) Special rule. Section 562(b)(1)(B) provides that in the case of
a complete liquidation occurring within 24 months after the adoption of
a plan of liquidation the amount of the deduction is equal to the
earnings and profits for each taxable year in which distributions are
made. Thus, if there is a distribution in liquidation pursuant to
section 333, or a distribution in complete liquidation pursuant to
section 331(a)(1) or 332 which occurs within a 24-month period after the
adoption of a plan of liquidation, a dividends paid deduction will be
allowable to the extent of the current earnings and profits for the
taxable year or years even though there was a deficit in earnings and
profits on the first day of such taxable year or years. In computing the
earnings and profits for the taxable year in
[[Page 304]]
which the distributions are made, computation shall be made with the
inclusion of capital gains and without any deduction for capital losses.
(c) Examples. The application of this subparagraph may be
illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. The Y Corporation, which makes its income tax returns on
the calendar year basis, was organized on January 1, 1910, with an
authorized and outstanding capital stock of 2,000 shares of common stock
of a par value of $100 each and 1,000 shares of participating preferred
stock of a par value of $100 each. The preferred stock was to receive
annual dividends of $7 per share and $100 per share on complete
liquidation of the corporation in priority to any payments on common
stock, and was to participate equally with the common stock in either
instance after the common stock had received a similar amount. However,
the preferred stock was redeemable in whole or in part at the option of
the board of directors at any time at $106 per share plus its proportion
of the earnings of the company at the time of such redemption. In 1910
the preferred stock was issued at $106 per share, for a total of
$106,000 and the common stock was issued, at $100 per share, for a total
of $200,000. On July 15, 1954, the company had a paid-in surplus of
$6,000, consisting of the premium received on the preferred stock;
earnings and profits of $30,000 accumulated prior to March 1, 1913; and
earnings and profits accumulated since February 28, 1913, of $75,000. On
July15, 1954, the option with respect to the preferred stock was
exercised and the entire amount of such stock was redeemed at $141 per
share or a total of $141,000 in a transaction upon which gain or loss to
the distributees resulting from the exchange was determined and
recognized under section 302(a). The amount of the distribution
allocable to capital account was $116,000 ($100,000 attributable to par
value, $6,000 attributable to paid-in surplus, and $10,000 attributable
to earnings and profits accumulated prior to March 1, 1913). The
remainder, $25,000 ($141,000, the amount of the distribution, less
$116,000, the amount allocable to capital account) is properly
chargeable to the earnings and profits accumulated since February 28,
1913, and is deductible as dividends paid.
Example 2. The M Corporation, a calendar year taxpayer, is
completely liquidated on November 1, 1955, pursuant to a plan of
liquidation adopted April 1, 1955. On January 1, 1955, the M Corporation
has a deficit in earnings and profits of $100,000. During the period
January 1, 1955, to the date of liquidation, November 1, 1955, it has
earnings and profits of $10,000. The M Corporation is entitled to a
dividends paid deduction in the amount of $10,000 as a result of its
distribution in complete liquidation on November 1, 1955.
Example 3. The N Corporation, a calendar year taxpayer, is
completely liquidated on July 1, 1958, pursuant to a plan of liquidation
adopted February 1, 1955. No distributions in liquidation were made
pursuant to the plan of liquidation adopted February 1, 1955, until the
distribution in complete liquidation on July 1, 1958. On January 1,
1958, N Corporation had a deficit in earnings and profits of $30,000.
During the period January 1, 1958, to the date of liquidation, July 1,
1958, the N Corporation has earnings and profits of $5,000. The N
Corporation is not entitled to any deduction for dividends paid as a
result of the distribution in complete liquidation on July 1, 1958. If
the earnings and profits for the period January 1, 1958, to July 1,
1958, had been $32,000, the N Corporation would have been entitled to a
deduction for dividends paid in the amount of $2,000.
(2) Special rule--(i) Distributions to corporate shareholders. In
the case of amounts distributed in complete liquidation of a personal
holding company (as defined in section 542) within 24 months after the
adoption of a plan of liquidation, section 562(b)(2) makes a further
exception to the general rule that a deduction for dividends paid is
permitted only with respect to dividends described in section 316. The
exception referred to in the preceding sentence applies only to
distributions made in any taxable year of the distributing corporation
beginning after December 31, 1963. Under the exception, the amount of
any distribution within the 24-month period pursuant to the plan shall
be treated as a dividend for purposes of computing the dividends paid
deduction, but:
(a) Only to the extent that such amount is distributed to corporate
distributees, and
(b) Only to the extent that such amount represents such corporate
distributees' allocable share of undistributed personal holding company
income for the taxable year of such distribution (computed without
regard to section 316(b)(2)(B) and section 562(b)(2))
Amounts distributed in liquidation in a transaction which is preceded,
or followed, by a transfer to another corporation of all or part of the
assets of the liquidating corporation, may not be eligible for the
dividends paid deduction.
[[Page 305]]
(ii) Corporate distributees' allocable share. For purposes of
subdivision (i)(b) of this subparagraph:
(a) Except as provided in (b) of this subdivision, the corporate
distributees' allocable share of undistributed personal holding company
income for the taxable year of the distribution (computed without regard
to sections 316(b)(2)(B) and 562(b)(2)) shall be determined by
multiplying such undistributed personal holding company income by the
ratio which the aggregate value of the stock held by all corporate
shareholders immediately before the record date of the last liquidating
distribution in such year bears to the total value of all stock
outstanding on such date. For rules applicable in a case where the
distributing corporation has more than one class of stock, see (c) of
this subdivision (ii).
(b) If more than one liquidating distribution was made during the
year, and if, after the record date of the first distribution but before
the record date of the last distribution, there was a change in the
relative shareholdings as between corporate shareholders and
noncorporate shareholders, then the corporate distributees' allocable
share of undistributed personal holding company income for the taxable
year of the distributions (computed without regard to sections
316(b)(2)(B) and 562(b)(2)) shall be determined as follows:
(1) First, allocate the corporation's undistributed personal holding
company income for the taxable year among the distributions made during
such year by reference to the ratio which the aggregate amount of each
distribution bears to the total amount of all distributions during such
year;
(2) Second, determine the corporate distributees' allocable share of
the corporation's undistributed personal holding company income for each
distribution by multiplying the amount determined under (1) of this
subdivision (b) for each distribution by the ratio which the aggregate
value of the stock held by all corporate shareholders immediately before
the record date of such distribution bears to the total value of all
stock outstanding on such date; and
(3) Last, determine the sum of the corporate distributees' allocable
share of the corporation's undistributed personal holding company income
for all such distributions
For rules applicable in a case where the distributing corporation has
more than one class of stock, see (c) of this subdivision (ii).
(c) Where the distributing corporation has more than one class of
stock:
(1) The undistributed personal holding company income for the
taxable year in which, or in respect of which, the distribution was made
shall be treated as a fund from which dividends may properly be paid and
shall be allocated between or among the classes of stock in a manner
consistent with the dividend rights of such classes under local law and
the pertinent governing instruments, such as, for example, the
distributing corporation's articles or certificate of incorporation and
bylaws;
(2) The corporate distributees' allocable share of the undistributed
personal holding company income for each class of stock shall be
determined separately in accordance with the rules set forth in (a) and
(b) of this subdivision (ii) as if each class of stock were the only
class of stock outstanding; and
(3) The sum of the corporate distributees' allocable share of the
undistributed personal holding company income for the taxable year in
which, or in respect of which, the distribution was made shall be the
sum of the corporate distributees' allocable share of the undistributed
personal holding company income for all classes of stock.
(d) For purposes of this subdivision (ii), in any case where the
record date of a liquidating distribution cannot be ascertained, the
record date of the distribution shall be the date on which the
liquidating distribution was actually made.
(iii) Example. The application of this subparagraph may be
illustrated by the following example:
Example. O Corporation, a calendar year taxpayer is completely
liquidated on December 31, 1964, pursuant to a plan of liquidation
adopted July 1, 1964. No distributions in liquidation were made pursuant
to the plan of liquidation adopted July 1, 1964, until the distribution
in complete liquidation on December 31, 1964. O Corporation has
undistributed personal holding company income of
[[Page 306]]
$300,000 for the year 1964 (computed without regard to section
316(b)(2)(B) and section 562(b)(2)). On December 31, 1964, immediately
before the record date of the distribution in complete liquidation, P
Corporation owns 100 shares of O Corporation's outstanding stock and
individual A owns the remaining 200 shares. All shares are equal in
value. The amount which represents P Corporation's allocable share of
undistributed personal holding company income is $100,000(100 shares/300
sharesx$300,000), and for purposes of computing the dividends paid
deduction, such amount is treated as a dividend under section 562(b)(2)
provided that the liquidating distribution to P Corporation equals or
exceeds $100,000. P Corporation does not treat the $100,000 distributed
to it as a dividend to which section 301 applies. For an example of the
treatment of the distribution to individual A see example 5 of paragraph
(e) of Sec. 1.316-1.
(iv) Distributions to noncorporate shareholders. For the rules for
determining the extent to which distributions in complete liquidation
made to noncorporate shareholders by a personal holding company are
dividends within the meaning of section 562(a), see section 316(b)(2)(B)
and paragraph (b)(2) of Sec. 1.316-1.
(c) Special definition of dividend for nonliquidating distributions
by personal holding companies. Section 316(b)(2)(A) provides that in the
case of a corporation which, under the law applicable to the taxable
year in which or in respect of which a distribution is made, is a
personal holding company, the term dividend (in addition to the general
meaning set forth in section 316(a)) also means a nonliquidating
distribution to its shareholders to the extent of the corporation's
undistributed personal holding company income (determined under section
545 without regard to such distributions) for the taxable year in which
or in respect of which the distribution is made. See paragraph (b)(1) of
Sec. 1.316-1.
[T.D. 6949, 33 FR 5529, Apr. 9, 1968, as amended by T.D. 7767, 46 FR
11265, Feb. 6, 1981]
Sec. 1.562-2 Preferential dividends.
(a) Section 562(c) imposes a limitation upon the general rule that a
corporation is entitled to a deduction for dividends paid with respect
to all dividends which it actually pays during the taxable year. Before
a corporation may be entitled to any such deduction with respect to a
distribution regardless of the medium in which the distribution is made,
every shareholder of the class of stock with respect to which the
distribution is made must betreated the same as every other shareholder
of that class, and no class of stock may be treated otherwise than in
accordance with its dividend rights as a class. The limitation imposed
by section 562(c) is unqualified, except in the case of an actual
distribution made in connection with a consent distribution (see section
565), if the entire distribution composed of such actual distribution
and consent distribution is not preferential. The existence of a
preference is sufficient to prohibit the deduction regardless of the
fact (1) that such preference is authorized by all the shareholders of
the corporation or (2) that the part of the distribution received by the
shareholder benefited by the preference is taxable to him as a dividend.
A corporation will not be entitled to a deduction for dividends paid
with respect to any distribution upon a class of stock if there is
distributed to any shareholder of such class (in proportion to the
number of shares held by him) more or less than his pro rata part of the
distribution as compared with the distribution made to any other
shareholder of the same class. Nor will a corporation be entitled to a
deduction for dividends paid in the case of any distribution upon a
class of stock if there is distributed upon such class of stock more or
less than the amount to which it is entitled as compared with any other
class of stock. A preference exists if any rights to preference inherent
in any class of stock are violated. The disallowance, where any
preference in fact exists, extends to the entire amount of the
distribution and not merely to a part of such distribution. As used in
this section, the term distribution includes a dividend as defined in
subchapter C, chapter 1 of the Code, and a distribution in liquidation
referred to in section 562(b).
(b) The application of the provisions of section 562(c) may be
illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. A, B, C, and D are the owners of all the shares of class
A common stock in the M Corporation, which makes its income tax returns
on a calendar year basis. With
[[Page 307]]
the consent of all the shareholders, the M Corporation on July 15, 1954,
declared a dividend of $5 a share payable in cash on August 1, 1954, to
A. On September 15, 1954, it declared a dividend of $5 a share payable
in cash on October 1, 1954, to B, C, and D. No allowance for dividends
paid for the taxable year 1954 is permitted to the M Corporation with
respect to any part of the dividends paid on August 1, 1954, and October
1, 1954.
Example 2. The N Corporation, which makes its income tax returns on
the calendar year basis, has a capital of $100,000 (consisting of 1,000
shares of common stock of a par value of $100) and earnings or profits
accumulated after February 28, 1913, in the amount of $50,000. In the
year 1954, the N Corporation distributes $7,500 in cancellation of 50
shares of the stock owned by three of the four shareholders of the
corporation. No deduction for dividends paid is permissible under
section 562(c) and paragraph (a) of this section with respect to such
distribution.
Example 3. The P Corporation has two classes of stock outstanding,
10 shares of cumulative preferred, owned by E, entitled to $5 per share
and on which no dividends have been paid for two years, and 10 shares of
common, owned by F. On December 31, 1954, the corporation distributes a
dividend of $125, $50 to E, and $75 to F. The corporation is entitled to
no deduction for any part of such dividend paid, since there has been a
preference to F. If, however, the corporation had distributed $100 to E
and $25 to F, it would have been entitled to include $125 as a dividend
paid deduction.
Sec. 1.562-3 Distributions by a member of an affiliated group.
A personal holding company which files or is required to file a
consolidated return with other members of an affiliated group may be
required to file a separate personal holding company schedule by reason
of the limitations and exceptions provided in section 542(b) and Sec.
1.542-4. Section 562(d) provides that in such case the dividends paid
deduction shall be allowed to the personal holding company, with respect
to a distribution made to any member of the affiliated group, if such
distribution would constitute a dividend if it were made to a
shareholder which is not a member of the affiliated group.
Sec. 1.563-1 Accumulated earnings tax.
In the determination of the dividends paid deduction for purposes of
the accumulated earnings tax imposed by section 531, a dividend paid
after the close of any taxable year and on or before the 15th day of the
third month following the close of such taxable year shall be considered
as paid during such taxable year, and shall not be included in the
computation of the dividends paid deduction for the year of payment.
However, the rule provided in section 563(a) is not applicable to
dividends paid during the first two and one-half months of the first
taxable year of the corporation subject to tax under chapter 1 of the
Internal Revenue Code of 1954.
Sec. 1.563-2 Personal holding company tax.
In the case of a personal holding company subject to the provisions
of section 541, dividends paid after the close of the taxable year and
before the 15th day of the third month thereafter shall be included in
the computation of the dividends paid deduction for the taxable year
only if the taxpayer so elects in its return for such taxable year. The
election shall be made by including such dividends in computing its
dividends paid deduction. The amount of such dividends which may be
included in computing the dividends paid deduction for the taxable year
shall not exceed either:
(a) The undistributed personal holding company income of the
corporation for the taxable year, computed without regard to this
section, or
(b) In the case of a taxable year beginning after December 31, 1969,
20 percent (10 percent, in the case of a taxable year beginning before
Jan. 1, 1970) of the sum of the dividends paid during the taxable year
(not including consent dividends), computed without regard to this
section
In computing the amount of the dividends paid deduction allowable for
any taxable year, the amount allowed by reason of section 563(b) for any
preceding taxable year is considered a dividend paid in such preceding
taxable year and not in the year of actual distribution. Thus, a double
deduction is not allowable.
[T.D. 7079, 35 FR 18587, Dec. 8, 1970]
[[Page 308]]
Sec. 1.563-3 Dividends considered as paid on last day of taxable year.
(a) General rule. Where a distribution made after the close of the
taxable year is considered as paid during such taxable year, for
purposes of applying section 562(a) the distribution shall be considered
as made on the last day of such taxable year.
(b) Personal holding company tax. In the case of a corporation which
under the law applicable to the taxable year in respect of which a
distribution is made under section 563(b) and Sec. 1.563-2 is a
personal holding company under the law applicable to such taxable year,
section 316(b)(2) provides that the term dividend means (in addition to
the general rule under section 316(a)) any distribution to the extent of
the corporation's undistributed personal holding company income
(determined under section 545 without regard to distributions under
section 316(b)(2)) for such year. See paragraph (b) of Sec. 1.316-1.
(c) Dividends paid on or before December 15, 1955. The Act of June
15, 1955 (Public Law 74, 84th Cong., 69 Stat. 136), repealed sections
452 and 462 of the Code, relating to prepaid income and reserve for
estimated expenses. Under section 4(c)(4) of that Act, dividends paid
after the 15th day of the third month following the close of the taxable
year and on or before December 15, 1955, may be treated as having been
paid on the last day of the taxable year for purposes of the accumulated
earnings tax or the personal holding company tax and in the case of
regulated investment companies, but only to the extent that such
dividends are attributable to an increase in taxable income for the
taxable year by reason of the repeal of sections 452 and 462. See
paragraph (b) of Sec. 1.9000-8, relating to treatment of certain
dividends, prescribed pursuant to section 4(c)(4) of the Act of June 15,
1955.
Sec. 1.564-1 Dividend carryover.
(a) General rule. The dividend carryover from the two preceding
years, allowable only to personal holding companies, is includible in
the dividends paid deduction under section 561. It is computed as
follows:
(1) If, for each of the preceding two years, the deduction for
dividends paid under section 561 (determined without regard to the
dividend carryover to each such year) exceeds the taxable income
(adjusted as provided in section 545 for purposes of determining
undistributed personal holding company income) then the dividend
carryover to the taxable year is the sum of both such excess amounts.
(2) If the deduction for dividends paid under section 561 for the
second preceding year (determined without regard to the dividend
carryover to such year) exceeds the taxable income for such year
(adjusted as provided in section 545), and if the taxable income for the
first preceding year (as so adjusted) exceeds the dividends paid
deduction for such first preceding year (as so determined), then the
dividend carryover to the taxable year shall be such excess amount for
the second preceding year, less such excess amount for the first
preceding year.
(3) If for the first preceding year the deduction for dividends paid
under section 561 (determined without regard to the dividend carryover
to such year) exceeds the taxable income (adjusted as provided in
section 545) for such year, and such excess is not present in the second
preceding year, then the dividend carryover to the taxable year shall be
such excess amount for the first preceding year.
(b) Dividend carryover from year in which taxpayer was not a
personal holding company. In computing the dividend carryover, the
taxable income as adjusted under section 545 of any preceding taxable
year shall be determined as if the corporation was, under the law
applicable to such taxable year, a personal holding company.
(c) Dividend carryover from year in which taxpayer was subject to
1939 Code. In a case where the first or the second preceding taxable
year began before the taxpayer's first taxable year under the Internal
Revenue Code of 1954, the amount of the dividend carryover shall be
determined under the Internal Revenue Code of 1939.
(d) Statement to be filed with return. Every corporation claiming a
dividend carryover for any taxable year shall
[[Page 309]]
file with its return for such year a concise statement setting forth the
amount of the dividend carryover claimed and all material and pertinent
facts relative thereto, including a detailed schedule showing the
computation of the dividend carryover claimed.
(e) Computation of dividend carryover. The computation of the
dividend carryover may be illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. The X Corporation, which files its income tax returns on
the calendar year basis, has taxable income, adjusted as required by
section 545, in the amount of $110,000 and has a dividends paid
deduction of $150,000 for the year 1954. For 1955, its taxable income,
adjusted as required by section 545, is $200,000 and its dividends paid
deduction is $300,000. The dividend carryover to the year 1956 is
$140,000, computed as follows:
Dividends paid deduction for 1954........................... $150,000
Taxable income for 1954..................................... 110,000
-----------
Dividend carryover from 1954................................ 40,000
===========
Dividends paid deduction for 1955........................... 300,000
Taxable income for 1955..................................... 200,000
-----------
Dividend carryover from 1955................................ 100,000
===========
Dividend carryover for 2 preceding taxable years, allowable 140,000
as a deduction for the year 1956...........................
Example 2. The Y Corporation, which files its income tax returns on
the calendar year basis, has taxable income, adjusted as required by
section 545, in the amount of $100,000 and has a dividends paid
deduction of $150,000 for the year 1954. For 1955, its taxable income,
adjusted as required by section 545, is $200,000 and its dividends paid
deduction is $170,000. The dividend carryover to the year 1956 is
$20,000 computed as follows:
Dividends paid deduction for 1954........................... $150,000
Taxable income for 1954..................................... 100,000
-----------
Dividend carryover from 1954................................ 50,000
===========
Taxable income for 1955..................................... 200,000
Dividends paid deduction for 1955........................... 170,000
-----------
Excess of taxable income over dividends paid deduction...... 30,000
===========
Dividend carryover for second preceding taxable year, 20,000
allowable as a deduction for the year 1956.................
Sec. 1.565-1 General rule.
(a) Consent dividends. The dividends paid deduction, as defined in
section 561, includes the consent dividends for the taxable year. A
consent dividend is a hypothetical distribution (as distinguished from
an actual distribution) made by:
(1) A corporation that has a reasonable basis to believe that it is
subject to the accumulated earnings tax imposed in part I of subchapter
G, chapter 1 of the Code, or
(2) A corporation described in part II (personal holding companies
or a corporation with adjusted income from rents described in section
543(a)(2)(A) which utilizes the consent dividends described in section
543(a)(2)(B)(iii) to avoid personal holding company status) or part III
(foreign personal holding companies) of subchapter G or in part I
(regulated investment companies) or part II (real estate investment
trusts) of subchapter M, chapter 1 of the Code.
A consent dividend may be made by a corporation described in this
paragraph to any person who owns consent stock on the last day of the
taxable year of such corporation and who agrees to treat the
hypothetical distribution as an actual dividend, subject to the
limitations in section 565, Sec. 1.565-2, and paragraph (c)(2) of this
section, by filing a consent at the time and in the manner specified in
paragraph (b) of this section.
(b) Making and filing of consents. (1) A consent shall be made on
Form 972 in accordance with this section and the instructions on the
form issued therewith. It may be made only by or on behalf of a person
who was the actual owner on the last day of the corporation's taxable
year of any class of consent stock, that is, the person who would have
been required to include in gross income any dividends on such stock
actually distributed on the last day of such year. Form 972 shall
contain or be verified by a written declaration that it is made under
the penalties of perjury. In the consent such person must agree to
include in gross income for his taxable year in which or with which the
taxable year of the corporation ends a specific amount as a taxable
dividend.
(2) See paragraph (c) of this section and Sec. 1.565-2 for the
rules as to when all or a portion of the amount so specified will be
disregarded for tax purposes.
[[Page 310]]
(3) A consent may be filed at any time not later than the due date
(including extensions) of the corporation's income tax return for the
taxable year for which the dividends paid deduction is claimed. With
such return, and not later than the due date (including extensions)
thereof, the corporation must file Forms 972 for each consenting
shareholder, and a return on Form 973 showing by classes the stock
outstanding on the first and last days of the taxable year, the dividend
rights of such stock, distributions made during the taxable year to
shareholders, and giving all the other information required by the form.
For taxable years beginning before January 1, 2003, the Form 973 filed
with the corporation's income tax return shall contain or be verified by
a written declaration that is made under the penalties of perjury and
the Forms 972 filed with the return must be duly executed by the
consenting shareholders. For taxable years beginning after December 31,
2002, the Form 973 filed with the corporation's income tax return shall
be verified by signing the return and the Forms 972 filed with the
return must be duly executed by the consenting shareholders or, if
unsigned, must contain the same information as the duly executed
originals. If the corporation submits unsigned Forms 972 with its return
for a taxable year beginning after December 31, 2002, the duly executed
originals are records that the corporation must retain and keep
available for inspection in the manner required by Sec. 1.6001-1(e).
(c) Taxability of amounts specified in consents. (1) The filing of a
consent is irrevocable, and except as otherwise provided in section
565(b), Sec. 1.565-2, and paragraph (c)(2) of this section, the full
amount specified in a consent filed by a shareholder of a corporation
described in paragraph (a) of this section shall be included in the
gross income of the shareholder as a taxable dividend. Where the
shareholder is taxable on a dividend only if received from sources
within the United States, the amount specified in the consent of the
shareholder shall be treated as a dividend from sources within the
United States in the same manner as if the dividend has been paid in
money to the shareholder on the last day of the corporation's taxable
year. See paragraph (b) of this section relating to the making and
filing of consents, and section 565(e) and Sec. 1.565-5, with respect
to the payment requirement in the case of nonresident aliens and foreign
corporations.
(2) To the extent that the Commissioner determines that the
corporation making a consent dividend is not a corporation described in
paragraph (a) of this section, the amount specified in the consent is
not a consent dividend and the amount specified in the consent will not
be included in the gross income of the shareholder. In addition, where a
corporation is described in paragraph (a)(1) but not paragraph (a)(2) of
this section, to the extent that the Commissioner determines that the
amount specified in a consent is larger than the amount of earnings
subject to the accumulated earnings tax imposed by part I of subchapter
G, such excess is not a consent dividend under paragraph (a) of this
section and will not be included in the gross income of the shareholder.
(3) Except as provided in section 565(b), Sec. 1.565-2 and
paragraph (c)(2) of this section, once a shareholder's consent is filed,
the full amount specified in such consent must be included in the
shareholder's gross income as a taxable dividend, and the ground upon
which a deduction for consent dividends is denied the corporation does
not affect the taxability of a shareholder whose consent has been filed
for the amount specified in the consent. For example, although described
in part I, II, or III of subchapter G, or part I or II of subchapter M,
chapter 1 of the Code, the corporation's taxable income (as adjusted
under section 535(b), 545(b), 556(b), 852(b)(2), or 857(b)(2), as
appropriate) may be less than the total of the consent dividends.
(4) A shareholder who is a nonresident alien or a foreign
corporation is taxable on the full amount of the consent dividend that
otherwise qualifies under this section even though that payment has not
been made as required by section 565(e) and Sec. 1.565-5.
(5) Income of a foreign corporation is not subject to the tax on
accumulated earnings under part I of subchapter G,
[[Page 311]]
chapter 1 of the Code except to the extent of U.S. source income,
adjusted as permitted under section 535. See section 535 (b) and (d) and
Sec. 1.535-1(b). Therefore, foreign source earnings (other than those
distributions subject to resourcing under section 535(d)) of a foreign
corporation that is not described in paragraph (a)(2) of this section
cannot qualify for consent dividend treatment. Accordingly, a consent
dividend made by a foreign corporation described in paragraph (a)(1) of
this section shall not be effective with respect to all of the
corporation's earnings, but shall relate solely to earnings which would
have been, in the absence of the consent dividend, subject to the
accumulated earnings tax.
[T.D. 8244, 54 FR 10538, Mar. 14, 1989, as amended by T.D. 9100, 68 FR
70705, Dec. 19, 2003; T.D. 9300, 71 FR 71042, Dec. 8, 2006]
Sec. 1.565-2 Limitations.
(a) General rule. Amounts specified in consents filed by
shareholders or other beneficial owners of a corporation described in
Sec. 1.565-1(a) are not treated as consent dividends to the extent
that--
(1) They would constitute a preferential dividend or
(2) They would not constitute a dividend (as defined in section
316),
if distributed in money to shareholders on the last day of the taxable
year of the corporation. If any portion of any amount specified in a
consent filed by a shareholder of a corporation described in the
preceding sentence is not treated as a consent dividend under section
565(b) and this section, it is disregarded for all tax purposes. For
example, it is not taxable to the consenting shareholder, and paragraph
(c) of Sec. 1.565-1 is not applicable to this portion of the amount
specified in the consent.
(b) Preferential Distribution. (1) A preferential distribution is an
actual distribution, or a consent distribution, or a combination of the
two, which involves a preference to one or more shares of stock as
compared with other shares of the same class or to one class of stock as
compared with any other class of stock. See section 562(c) and Sec.
1.562-2.
(2) The application of section 565 (b) (1) and Sec. 1.565-2 (b) may
be illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. The X Corporation, a personal holding company, which
makes its income tax returns on the calendar year basis, has 200 shares
of stock outstanding, owned by A and B in equal amounts. On December 15,
1987, the corporation distributes $600 to B and $100 to A. As a part of
the same distribution, A executes a consent to include $500 in his gross
income as a taxable dividend although such amount is not distributed to
him. The X Corporation, assuming the other requirements of section 565
have been complied with, is entitled to a consent dividends deduction of
$500. Although the consent dividend is deemed to have been paid on
December 31, 1987, the last day of the taxable year of the corporation,
the total amount of all distributions constitutes a single
nonpreferential distribution of $1200.
Example 2. The Y corporation, a personal holding company, which
makes its income tax returns on the calendar year basis, has one class
of consent stock outstanding, owned in equal amounts by A, B, and C. If
A and B each receive a distribution in cash of $5,000 and C consents to
include $3,000 in gross income as a taxable dividend, the combined
actual and consent distribution of $13,000 is preferential. See section
562 (c) and Sec. 1.562-2 (a). Similarly, if no one receives a
distribution in cash, but A and B each consents to include $5,000 as a
taxable dividend in gross income and C agrees to include only $3,000,
the entire consent distribution is preferential.
Example 3. The Z Corporation, which makes its income tax returns on
the calendar year basis and is subject, for the taxable year in
question, to the accumulated earnings tax, has only two classes of stock
outstanding, each class being consent stock and consisting of 500
shares. Class A, with a par value of $40 per share, is entitled to two-
thirds of any distribution of earnings and profits. Class B, with a par
value of $20 per share, is entitled to one-third of any distribution of
earnings and profits. On December 15, 1987, there is distributed on the
class B stock $2 per share, or $1,000, and shareholders of the class A
stock consent to include in gross income amounts equal to $2 per share,
or $1,000. The entire distribution of $2,000 is preferential, inasmuch
as the class B stock has received more than its pro rata share of the
combined amounts of the actual distributions and the consent
distributions.
(c) Section 316 Limitation. (1) An additional limitation under
section 565 (b) is that the amounts specified in consents which may be
treated as consent dividends cannot exceed the amounts
[[Page 312]]
which would constitute a dividend (as defined in section 316) if the
corporation had distributed the total specified amounts in money to
shareholders on the last day of the taxable year of the corporation. If
only a portion of such total would constitute a dividend, then only a
corresponding portion of each specified amount is treated as a consent
dividend.
(2) The application of section 565 (b) (2) and Sec. 1.565-2 (c) may
be illustrated by the following example:
Example. The X Corporation, a corporation described in Sec. 1.565-
(a) (1) or (2), which makes its income tax returns on the calendar year
basis, has only one class of stock outstanding, owned in equal amounts
by A and B. It makes no distributions during the taxable year 1987. Its
earnings and profits for the calendar year 1987 amount to $8,000, there
being at the beginning of such year no accumulated earnings or profits.
A and B execute proper consents to include $5,000 each in their gross
income as a dividend received by them on December 31, 1987. The sum of
the amounts specified in the consents executed by A and B is $10,000,
but if $10,000 had actually been distributed by the X corporation on
December 31, 1987, only $8,000 would have constituted a dividend under
section 316 (a). The amount which could be considered as consent
dividends in computing the dividends paid deduction for purposes of the
accumulated earnings tax is limited to $8,000, or $4,000 of the $5,000
specified in each consent. The remaining $1,000 in each consent is
disregarded for all tax purposes. (In the case of a personal holding
company, see also the example in Sec. 1.565-3(b).)
[T.D. 8244, 54 FR 10539, Mar. 14, 1989]
Sec. 1.565-3 Effect of consent.
(a) General Rule. The amount of the consent dividend that is
described in paragraph (a) of Sec. 1.565-1 shall be considered, for all
purposes of the Code, as if it were distributed in money by the
corporation to the shareholder on the last day of the taxable year of
the corporation, received by the shareholder on such day, and
immediately contributed by the shareholder as paid-in capital to
thecorporation on such day. Thus, the amount of the consent dividend
will be treated by the shareholder as a dividend. The shareholder will
be entitled to the dividends received deduction under section 243 or 245
with respect to such consent dividend. The basis of the shareholder's
consent stock in a corporation will be increased by the amount thus
treated in his hands as a dividend which he is considered as having
contributed to the corporation as paid-in capital. The amount of the
current dividend will also be treated as a dividend received from
sources within the United States in the same manner as if the dividend
had been paid in money to the shareholders. Among other effects of the
consent dividend, the earnings and profits of the corporation will be
decreased by the amount of the consent dividends. Moreover, if the
shareholder is a corporation, its accumulated earnings and profits will
be increased by the amount of the consent dividend with respect to which
it makes a consent.
(b) Example. The application of section 565 (c) may be illustrated
by the following example:
Example. Corporation A, a personal holding company and a calendar
year taxpayer, has one shareholder, individual B, whose consent to
include $10,000 in his gross income for the calendar year 1987 has been
timely filed. A has $8,000 of earnings and profits at the beginning of
1987. A has $10,000 of undistributed personal holding company income
(determined without regard to distributions under section 316(b)(2)) for
1987. B must include $10,000 in his gross income as a taxable income and
is treated as having immediately contributed $10,000 to A as paid-in
capital. See section 316(b)(2).
[T.D. 8244, 54 FR 10540, Mar. 14, 1989]
Sec. 1.565-4 Consent dividends and other distributions.
Section 565(d) provides a rule applicable where a distribution is
made in part in consent dividends and in part in money or other
property. With respect to such a distribution the entire amount
specified in the consents and the amount of such money or other property
shall be considered together. Thus, if as a part of the same
distribution consents are filed by some of the shareholders and cash is
distributed to other shareholders, for example, those who may be
unwilling to sign consents, the total amount of the cash and the amounts
specified in the consents will be viewed as a single distribution to
determine the tax effects of such distribution. For example, the total
of such amounts must be considered to
[[Page 313]]
determine whether the distribution (including the amounts specified in
the consents) is preferential and whether any part of such distribution
would not be dividends if the total amounts specified in the consents
were distributed in cash. See paragraph (b)(2) of Sec. 1.565-2 for
examples illustrating the treatment of distributions which consist in
part of consent dividends and in part of other property.
Sec. 1.565-5 Nonresident aliens and foreign corporations.
(a) Withholding. In the event that a corporation makes a consent
dividend, as described in Sec. 1.565-1 (a), to a shareholder that is
subject to a withholding tax under section 1441 or 1442 on a
distribution of cash or other property, the corporation must remit an
amount of tax equal to the withholding tax that would be imposed under
section 1441 or 1442 if an actual cash distribution equal to the consent
dividend had been paid to the shareholder on the last day of the
corporation's taxable year. Such payment must be in one of the following
forms:
(1) Cash,
(2) United States postal money order,
(3) Certified check drawn on a domestic bank, provided that the law
of the place where the bank is located does not permit the certification
to be rescinded prior to presentation,
(4) A cashier's check of a domestic bank, or
(5) A draft on a domestic bank or a foreign bank maintaining a
United States agency or branch and payable in United States funds.
The amount of such payment shall be credited against the tax imposed on
the shareholder.
[T.D. 8244, 54 FR 10540, Mar. 14, 1989]
Sec. 1.565-6 Definitions.
(a) Consent stock. (1) The term consent stock includes what is
generally known as common stock. It also includes participating
preferred stock, the participation rights of which are unlimited.
(2) The definition of consent stock may be illustrated by the
following example:
Example. If in the case of the X Corporation, a personal holding
company, there is only one class of stock outstanding, it would all be
consent stock. If, on the other hand, there were two classes of stock,
class A and class B, and class A was entitled to 6 percent before any
distribution could be made on class B, but class B was entitled to
everything distributed after class A had received its 6 percent, only
class B stock would be consent stock. Similarly, if class A, after
receiving its 6 percent, was to participate equally or in some fixed
proportion with class B until it had received a second 6 percent, after
which class B alone was entitled to any further distributions, only
class B stock would be consent stock. The same result would follow if
the order of preferences were class A 6 percent, then class B 6 percent,
then class A a second 6 percent, either alone or in conjunction with
class B, then class B the remainder. If, however, class A stock is
entitled to ultimate participation without limit as to amount, then it,
too, may be consent stock. For example, if class A is to receive 3
percent and then share equally or in some fixed proportion with class B
in the remainder of the earnings or profits distributed, both class A
stock and class B stock are consent stock.
(b) Preferred dividends. (1) The term preferred dividends includes
all fixed amounts (whether determined by percentage of par value, a
stated return expressed in a certain number of dollars per share, or
otherwise) the distribution of which on any class of stock is a
condition precedent to a further distribution of earnings or profits
(not including a distribution in partial or complete liquidation). A
distribution, though expressed in terms of a fixed amount, is not a
preferred dividend, however, unless it is preferred over a subsequent
distribution within the taxable year upon some class or classes of stock
other than one on which it is payable.
(2) The definition of preferred dividends may be illustrated by the
following example:
Example. If, in the case of the X Corporation, there are only two
classes of stock outstanding, class A and class B, and class A is
entitled to a distribution of 6 percent of par, after which the balance
of the earnings and profits are distributable on class B exclusively,
class A's 6 percent is a preferred dividend. If the order of preferences
is class A $6 per share, class B $6 per share, then class A and class B
in fixed proportions until class A receives $3 more per share, then
class B the remainder, all of class A's $9 per share and $6 per share of
the amount distributable on class B are preferred dividends. The amount
[[Page 314]]
which class B is entitled to receive in conjunction with the payment to
class A of its last $3 per share is not a preferred dividend, because
the payment of such amount is preferred over no subsequent distribution
except one made on class B itself. Finally, if a distribution must be $6
on class A, $6 on class B, then on class A and class B share and share
alike, the distribution on class A of $6 and the distribution on class B
of $6 are both preferred dividends.
[54 FR 10540, Mar. 14, 1989]
Banking Institutions
Rules of General Application to Banking Institutions--Table of Contents
Sec. 1.581-1 Banks.
(a) In order to be a bank as defined in section 581, an institution
must be a corporation for federal tax purposes. See Sec. 301.7701-2(b)
of this chapter for the definition of a corporation.
(b) This section is effective as of January 1, 1997.
[T.D. 8697, 61 FR 66588, Dec. 18, 1996]
Sec. 1.581-2 Mutual savings banks, building and loan associations, and
cooperative banks.
(a) While the general principles for determining the taxable income
of a corporation are applicable to a mutual savings bank, a building and
loan association, and a cooperative bank not having capital stock
represented by shares, there are certain exceptions and special rules
governing the computation in the case of such institutions. See section
593 for special rules concerning reserves for bad debts. See section 591
and Sec. 1.591-1, relating to dividends paid by banking corporations,
for special rules concerning deductions for amounts paid to, or credited
to the accounts of, depositors or holders of withdrawable accounts as
dividends. See also section 594 and Sec. 1.594-1 for special rules
governing the taxation of a mutual savings bank conducting a life
insurance business.
(b) For the purpose of computing the net operating loss deduction
provided in section 172, any taxable year for which a mutual savings
bank, building and loan association, or a cooperative bank not having
capital stock represented by shares was exempt from tax shall be
disregarded. Thus, no net operating loss carryover shall be allowed from
a taxable year beginning before January 1, 1952, and, in the case of any
taxable year beginning after December 31, 1951, the amount of the net
operating loss carryback or carryover from such year shall not be
reduced by reference to the income of any taxable year beginning before
January 1, 1952.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960; 25 FR 14021, Dec. 31, 1960, as
amended by T.D. 8697, 61 FR 66588, Dec. 18, 1996]
Sec. 1.581-3 Definition of bank prior to September 28, 1962.
Prior to September 28, 1962, for purposes of sections 582 and 584,
the term bank means a bank or trust company incorporated and doing
business under the laws of the United States (including laws relating to
the District of Columbia), of any State, or of any Territory, a
substantial part of the business of which consists of receiving deposits
and making loans and discounts, or of exercising fiduciary powers
similar to those permitted to national banks under section 11(k) of the
Federal Reserve Act (38 Stat. 262; 12 U.S.C. 248(k)), and which is
subject by law to supervision and examination by State, Territorial, or
Federal authority having supervision over banking institutions. Such
term also means a domestic building and loan association.
[T.D. 6651, 28 FR 4950, May 17, 1963]
Sec. 1.582-1 Bad debts, losses, and gains with respect to securities
held by financial institutions.
(a) Bad debt deduction for banks. A bank, as defined in section 581,
is allowed a deduction for bad debts to the extent and in the manner
provided by subsections (a), (b), and (c) of section 166 with respect to
a debt which has become worthless in whole or in part and which is
evidenced by a security (a bond, debenture, note, certificate, or other
evidence of indebtedness to pay a fixed or determinable sum of money)
issued by any corporation (including governments and their political
subdivisions), with interest coupons or in registered form.
[[Page 315]]
(b) Worthless stock in affiliated bank. For purposes of section
165(g)(1), relating to the deduction for losses involving worthless
securities, if the taxpayer is a bank (as defined in section 581) and
owns directly at least 80 percent of each class of stock of another
bank, stock in such other bank shall not be treated as a capital asset.
(c) Pre-1970 sales and exchanges of bonds, etc., by banks. For
taxable years beginning before July 12, 1969, with respect to the
taxation under subtitle A of the Code of a bank (as defined in section
581), if the losses of the taxable year from sales or exchanges of
bonds, debentures, notes, or certificates, or other evidences of
indebtedness, issued by any corporation (including one issued by a
government or political subdivision thereof), exceed the gains of the
taxable year from such sales or exchanges, no such sale or exchange
shall be considered a sale or exchange of a capital asset.
(d) Post-1969 sales and exchanges of securities by financial
institutions. For taxable years beginning after July 11, 1969, the sale
or exchange of a security is not considered the sale or exchange of a
capital asset if such sale or exchange is made by a financial
institution to which any of the following sections applies: Section 585
(relating to banks), 586 (relating to small business investment
companies and business development corporations), or 593 (relating to
mutual savings banks, domestic building and loan associations, and
cooperative banks). This paragraph shall apply to determine the
character of gain or loss from the sale or exchange of a security
notwithstanding any other provision of subtitle A of the Code, such as
section 1233 (relating to short sales). However, this paragraph shall
have no effect in the determination of whether a security is a capital
asset under section 1221 for purposes of applying any other provision of
the Code, such as section 1232 (relating to original issue discount).
For purposes of this paragraph, a security is a bond, debenture, note,
or certificate or other evidence of indebtedness, issued by any person.
See paragraphs (e) and (f) of this section for special transitional
rules applicable, respectively, to banks and to small business
investment companies and business development corporations.
(e) Transition rule for qualifying securities held by banks--(1) In
general. Notwithstanding the provisions of paragraph (d) of this
section, if the net long-term capital gain from sales and exchanges of
qualifying securities exceeds the net short-term capital loss from such
sales and exchanges in any taxable year beginning after July 11, 1969,
such excess shall be treated as long-term capital gain, but in an amount
not to exceed the net gain from sales and exchanges of securities in
such year. For purposes of computing such net gain, a capital loss
carried to the taxable year under section 1212 shall not be taken into
account. See section 1222 and the regulations thereunder for definitions
of the terms net long-term capital gain and net short-term capital loss.
For purposes of this paragraph:
(i) The term security means a security within the meaning of
paragraph (d) of this section.
(ii) The term qualifying security means a security which is held by
the bank on July 11, 1969, and continuously thereafter until it is first
sold or exchanged by the bank
See also subparagraph (4) of this paragraph for rules under which the
time certain securities are held is deemed to include a period of time
determined under section 1223 (1) and (2) with respect to such security.
(2) Computation of capital gain or loss. For purposes of this
paragraph, the amount of gain or loss from the sale or exchange of a
qualifying security treated as capital gain or loss is determined by
multiplying the amount of gain or loss recognized from such sale or
exchange by a fraction the numerator of which is the number of days
before July 12, 1969, that such security was held by the bank and the
denominator of which is the sum of the number of days included in the
numerator and the number of days the security was held by the bank after
July 11, 1969.
(3) Special rules. For purposes of subparagraphs (1) and (2) of this
paragraph, the following items are not taken into account:
(i) Any amount treated as original issue discount under section
1232, and
[[Page 316]]
(ii) Any amount which, without regard to section 582(c) and this
section, would be treated as gain or loss from the sale or exchange of
property which is not a capital asset, such as an amount which is
realized from the sale or exchange of a security which is held by a bank
as a dealer in securities.
(4) Holding period in certain cases. For purposes of this paragraph:
(i) The time a security received in an exchange is deemed to have
been held by a bank includes a period of time determined under section
1223(1) with respect to such security.
(ii) The time a security transferred to a bank from another bank is
deemed to have been held by the transferee bank includes a period of
time determined under section 1223(2) with respect to such security
For example, if a bank on December 3, 1972, surrendered an obligation of
the United States which it held as a capital asset on July 11, 1969, in
a transaction to which section 1037 applied, the time during which the
newly received obligation is deemed to have been held includes the time
during which the surrendered obligation was deemed to have been held by
the bank. Because the surrendered obligation was held on July 11, 1969,
the newly acquired obligation is deemed to have been held on that date
and is a qualifying security. The period during which the surrendered
obligation is deemed to have been held is taken into account in
computing the fraction determined under subparagraph (2) of this
paragraph with respect to the newly received obligation.
(5) Examples. The provisions of this paragraph may be illustrated by
the following examples:
Example 1. Bank A, a calendar year taxpayer, purchased a qualifying
security on July 14, 1968, and held it to maturity on August 20, 1970,
when it was redeemed. The redemption resulted in a taxable gain of
$10,000. The security was held by the bank for 363 days before July 12,
1969, and for a total of 768 days. During the taxable year, the bank had
no other gains and no losses from sales or exchanges of qualifying
securities, but had a net loss of $4,000 from sales of securities other
than qualifying securities. The portion of the gain from the redemption
of the qualifying security treated as capital gain under subparagraph
(2) of this paragraph is $4,726.56 (363/768x$10,000). Because the net
gain of the taxable year from sales and exchanges of securities, $6,000
($10,000-$4,000), exceeds the portion of the gain on the sale of the
qualifying security treated as capital gain under this paragraph,
$4,726.56 is treated as long-term capital gain on the sale of the
qualifying security for the taxable year.
Example 2. Assume the same facts as in example 1, except that the
bank's net loss of the taxable year from the sale of securities other
than qualifying securities was $7,000. The amount considered as long-
term capital gain under this paragraph is limited by the amount of gain
on the sale of securities to $3,000 ($10,000-$7,000).
(f) Small business investment companies and business development
corporations--(1) Election. In the case of a small business investment
company or a business development corporation, described in section
586(a), section 582(c) does not apply for taxable years beginning after
July 11, 1969, and before July 11, 1974, unless the taxpayer elects that
such section shall apply. In the case of a small business investment
company, see paragraph (a)(1) of Sec. 1.1243-1 if such an election is
made, but see paragraph (a)(2) of Sec. 1.1243-1 if such an election is
not made. Such election applies to all such taxable years and, except as
provided in subparagraph (3) of this paragraph, is irrevocable. Such
election must be made not later than (i) the time, including extensions
thereof, prescribed by law for filing the taxpayer's income tax return
for its first taxable year beginning after July 11, 1969, or (ii) June
8, 1970, whichever is later.
(2) Manner of making election. An election pursuant to the
provisions of this paragraph is made by the taxpayer by a written
statement attached to the taxpayer's income tax return (or an amended
return) for its first taxable year beginning after July 11, 1969. Such
statement shall indicate that the election is made pursuant to section
433(d) of the Tax Reform Act of 1969 (83 Stat. 624). The taxpayer shall
attach to its income tax return for each subsequent taxable year to
which such election is applicable a statement indicating that the
election has been made and the amount to which it applies for such year.
(3) Revocation of election. An election made pursuant to
subparagraph (2) of
[[Page 317]]
this paragraph shall be irrevocable unless:
(i) A written application for consent to revoke the election,
setting forth the reasons therefor, is filed with the Commissioner
within 90 days after the permanent regulations relating to section
433(d)(2) of the Tax Reform Act of 1969 (83 Stat. 624) are filed with
the Office of the Federal Register, and
(ii) The Commissioner consents to the revocation.
The revocation is effective for all taxable years to which the election
applied.
[T.D. 7171, 37 FR 5620, Mar. 17, 1972; 37 FR 6400, Mar. 29, 1972]
Sec. 1.584-1 Common trust funds.
(a) Method of taxation. A common trust fund maintained by a bank is
not subject to taxation under this chapter and is not considered a
corporation. Its participants are taxed on their proportionate share of
income from the common trust fund.
(b) Conditions for qualification. (1) For a fund to be qualified as
a common trust fund it must be maintained by a bank (as defined in
section 581) in conformity with the rules and regulations of the
Comptroller of the Currency, exclusively for the collective investment
and reinvestment of contributions to the fund by the bank. The bank may
either act alone or with one or more other fiduciaries, but it must act
solely in its capacity as one or a combination of the following: (i) As
a trustee of a trust created by will, deed, agreement, declaration of
trust, or order of court; (ii) as an executor of a will or as an
administrator of an estate; (iii) as a guardian (by whatever name known
under local law) of the estate of an infant, of an incompentent
individual, or of an absent individual; or (iv) on or after October 3,
1976, as a custodian of a UniformGifts to Minors account. A Uniform
Gifts to Minors account is an account established pursuant to a State
law substantially similar to the Uniform Gifts to Minors Act. (See the
Uniform Gifts to Minors Act of 1956 or the Uniform Gifts to Minors Act
of 1966, as published by the National Conference of Commissioners on
Uniform State Laws.) The Commissioner will publish a list of the States
whose laws he determines to be substantially similar to such uniform
acts. A bank that maintains a Uniform Gifts to Minors Act account must
establish, to the satisfaction of the Commissioner or his delegate, that
with respect to the account the bank has duties and responsibilities
similar to the duties and responsibilities of a trustee or guardian.
(2) A common trust fund may be a participant in another common trust
fund.
(c) Affiliated groups. For taxable years beginning after December
31, 1975, two or more banks that are members of the same affiliated
group (within the meaning of section 1504) are treated, for purposes of
section 584, as one bank for the period of their affiliation. A common
trust fund may be maintained by one or by more than one member of an
affiliated group. Any member of the group may, but need not, contribute
to the fund. Further, for purposes of this paragraph, members of an
affiliated group may be, but need not be, co-trustees of the common
trust fund.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 7935, 49 FR
1694, Jan. 13, 1984]
Sec. 1.584-2 Income of participants in common trust fund.
(a) Each participant in a common trust fund is required to include
in computing its taxable income for its taxable year within which or
with which the taxable year of the fund ends, whether or not distributed
and whether or not distributable:
(1) Its proportionate share of short-term capital gains and losses,
computed as provided in Sec. 1.584-3;
(2) Its proportionate share of long-term capital gains and losses,
computed as provided in Sec. 1.584-3; and
(3) Its proportionate share of the ordinary taxable income or the
ordinary net loss of the common trust fund, computed as provided in
Sec. 1.584-3.
(b) Any tax withheld at the source from income of the fund (e.g.,
under section 1441) is deemed to have been withheld proportionately from
the participants to whom such income is allocated.
(c)(1) The proportionate share of each participant's short-term
capital gains and losses, long-term capital gains and
[[Page 318]]
losses, ordinary taxable income or ordinary net loss, dividends and
interest received, and tax withheld at the source shall be determined
under the method of accounting adopted by the bank in accordance with
the written plan by which the common trust fund is established and
administered, provided such method clearly reflects the income of each
participant.
(2) Items of income and deductions shall be allocated to the periods
between valuation dates established by the plan within the taxable year
in which they were realized. Ordinary taxable income or ordinary net
loss, short-term capital gains and losses, long-term capital gains and
losses, and tax withheld at the source shall be computed for each
period. The participants' proportionate shares of income and losses for
each period shall then be determined.
(3) For taxable years beginning on or after September 22, 1980, any
amount of income or loss of the common trust fund which is included in
the computation of a participant's taxable income for the taxable year
shall be treated as income or loss from an unrelated trade or business
to the extent that such amount would have been income or loss from an
unrelated trade or business if such participant had made directly the
investments of the common trust fund.
(4) The provisions of this paragraph may be illustrated by the
following example:
Example. (i) The plan of a common trust fund provides for quarterly
valuation dates and for the computation and the distribution of the
income upon a quarterly basis, except that there shall be no
distribution of capital gains. The participants are as follows: Trusts
A, B, C, and D for the first quarter; Trusts A, B, C, and E for the
second quarter; and Trusts A, B, F, and G for the third and fourth
quarters, the participants having equal participating interests. As
computed upon the quarterly basis, the ordinary taxable income, the
short-term capital gain, and the long-term capital loss for the taxable
year were as follows:
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
First Second Third Fourth
quarter quarter quarter quarter Total
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ordinary taxable income.......................................... $200 $300 $200 $400 $1,100
Short-term capital gain.......................................... 200 100 200 100 600
Long-term capital loss........................................... 100 200 100 200 600
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(ii) The participants' shares of ordinary taxable income are as
follows:
Participants' Shares of Ordinary Taxable Income
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
First Second Third Fourth
Participant quarter quarter quarter quarter Total
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
A................................................................ $50 $75 $50 $100 $275
B................................................................ 50 75 50 100 275
C................................................................ 50 75 ....... ....... 125
D................................................................ 50 ....... ....... ....... 50
E................................................................ ....... 75 ....... ....... 75
F................................................................ ....... ....... 50 100 150
G................................................................ ....... ....... 50 100 150
----------------------------------------------
Total.......................................................... 200 300 200 400 1,100
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(iii) The participants' shares of the short-term capital gain are as
follows:
Participants' Shares of Short-Term Capital Gain
------------------------------------------------------------------------
First Second Third Fourth
Participant quarter quarter quarter quarter Total
------------------------------------------------------------------------
A............................ $50 $25 $50 $25 $150
B............................ 50 25 50 25 150
C............................ 50 25 ....... ....... 75
D............................ 50 ....... ....... ....... 50
E............................ ....... 25 ....... ....... 25
F............................ ....... ....... 50 25 75
G............................ ....... ....... 50 25 75
------------------------------------------
Total...................... 200 100 200 100 600
------------------------------------------------------------------------
(iv) The participants' shares of the long-term capital loss are as
follows:
Participants' Shares of Long-Term Capital Loss
------------------------------------------------------------------------
First Second Third Fourth
Participant quarter quarter quarter quarter Total
------------------------------------------------------------------------
A............................ $25 $50 $25 $50 $150
B............................ 25 50 25 50 150
C............................ 25 50 ....... ....... 75
D............................ 25 ....... ....... ....... 25
E............................ ....... 50 ....... ....... 50
F............................ ....... ....... 25 50 75
G............................ ....... ....... 25 50 75
------------------------------------------
Total...................... 100 200 100 200 600
------------------------------------------------------------------------
(v) If in the above example the common trust fund also had short-
term capital losses and long-term capital gains, the treatment
[[Page 319]]
of such gains or losses would be similar to that accorded to the short-
term capital gains and long-term capital losses in the above example.
(vi) Assume in the above example that participant Trust A qualified
as a trust forming part of a pension, profit sharing, or stock bonus
plan under section 401(a). Assume further that 20 percent of the
ordinary taxable income of the common trust fund would be unrelated
business taxable income (as defined under section 512(a)(1)) if received
directly by Trust A. Under paragraph (c)(3), participant Trust A, for
purposes of computing its taxable income, must treat its proportionate
share of the common trust fund's ordinary taxable income as income from
an unrelated trade or business to the extent such amount would have been
income from an unrelated trade or business if Trust A had directly made
the investments of the common trust fund. Therefore, participant Trust A
must take into account 20 percent of its proportionate share of the
common trust fund's ordinary taxable income as income from an unrelated
trade or business.
(d) The provisions of part I, subchapter J, chapter 1 of the Code,
or, as the case may be, the provisions of subchapters D, F, or H of
chapter 1 of the Code, are applicable in determining the extent to which
each participant's proportionate share of any income or loss of the
common trust fund is taxable to the participant, or to a person other
than the participant.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 7935, 49 FR
1694, Jan. 13, 1984; T.D. 8662, 61 FR 19546, May 2, 1996]
Sec. 1.584-3 Computation of common trust fund income.
The taxable income of the common trust fund shall be computed in the
same manner and on the same basis as in the case of an individual,
except that:
(a) No deduction shall be allowed under section 170 (relating to
charitable, etc., contributions and gifts);
(b) The gains and losses from sales or exchanges of capital assets
of the common trust fund are required to be segregated. A common trust
fund is not allowed the benefit of the capital loss carryover provided
by section 1212; and
(c) The ordinary taxable income (the excess of the gross income over
deductions) or the ordinary net loss (the excess of the deductions over
the gross income) shall be computed after excluding all items of gain
and loss from sales or exchanges of capital assets.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 7935, 49 FR
1694, Jan. 13, 1984]
Sec. 1.584-4 Admission and withdrawal of participants in the common
trust fund.
(a) Gain or loss. The common trust fund realizes no gain or loss by
the admission or withdrawal of a participant, and the basis of the
assets and the period for which they are deemed to have been held by the
common trust fund for the purposes of section 1202 are unaffected by
such an admission or withdrawal. For taxable years of participants
ending after April 7, 1976, and for transfers occurring after that date,
the transfer of property by a participant to a common trust fund is
treated as a sale or exchange of the property transferred. If a
participant withdraws the whole or any part of its participating
interest from the common trust fund, such withdrawal shall be treated as
a sale or exchange by the participant of the participating interest or
portion thereof which is so withdrawn. A participant is not deemed to
have withdrawn any part of its participating interest in the common
trust fund so as to have completed a closed transaction by reason of the
segregation and administration of an investment of the fund, pursuant to
the provisions of 12 CFR 9.18(b)(7) (or, for periods before September
28, 1962, 12 CFR206.17(c)(7)), for the benefit of all the then
participants in the common trust fund. Such segregated investment shall
be considered as held by, or on behalf of, the common trust fund for the
benefit ratably of all participants in the common trust fund at the time
of segregation, and any income or loss arising from its administration
and liquidation shall constitute income or loss to the common trust fund
apportionable among the participants for whose benefit the investment
was segregated. When a participating interest is transferred by a bank,
or by two or more banks that are members of the same affiliated group
(within the meaning of section 1504), as a result of the combination of
two or more common trust funds or the division of a single common trust
fund,
[[Page 320]]
the transfer to the surviving or divided fund is not considered to be an
admission or a withdrawal if the combining, dividing, and resulting
common trust funds have diversified portfolios. For purposes of this
paragraph (a), a common trust fund has a diversified portfolio if it
satisfies the 25 and 50-percent tests of section 368(a)(2)(F)(ii),
applying the relevant provisions of section 368(a)(2)(F). However,
Government securities are included in total assets for purposes of the
denominator of the 25 and 50-percent tests (unless the Government
securities are acquired to meet the 25 and 50-percent tests), but are
not treated as securities of an issuer for purposes of the numerator of
the 25 and 50-percent tests. In addition, for a transfer of a
participating interest in a division of a common trust fund not to be
considered an admission or withdrawal, each participant's pro
ratainterest in each of the resulting common trust funds must be
substantially the same as was the participant's pro rata interest in the
dividing fund. However, in the case of the division of a common trust
fund maintained by two or more banks that are members of the same
affiliated group resulting from the termination of such affiliation, the
division will be treated as meeting the requirements of the preceding
sentence if the written plans of operation of the resulting common trust
funds are substantially identical to the plan of operation of the
dividing common trust fund, each of the assets of the dividing common
trust fund are distributed substantially pro rata to each of the
resulting common trust funds, and each participant's aggregate interest
in the assets of the resulting common trust funds of which he or she is
a participant is substantially the same as was the participant's pro
rata interest in the assets of the dividing common trust fund. The plan
of operation of a resulting common trust fund will not be considered to
be substantially identical to that of the dividing common trust fund
where, for example, the plan of operation of the resulting common trust
fund contains restrictions as to the types of participants that may
invest in the common trust fund where such restrictions were not present
in the plan of operation of the dividing common trust fund.
(b) Basis for gain or loss upon withdrawal. The participant's gain
or loss upon withdrawal of its participating interest or portion thereof
shall be measured by the difference between the amount received upon
such withdrawal and the adjusted basis of the participating interest or
portion thereof withdrawn plus the additions prescribed in paragraph (c)
of this section and minus the reductions prescribed in paragraph (d) of
this section. The amount received by the participant shall be the sum of
any money plus the fair market value of property (other than money)
received upon such withdrawal. The basis of the participating interest
or portion thereof withdrawn shall be the sum of any money plus the fair
market value of any property (other than money) contributed by the
participant to the common trust fund to acquire the participating
interest or portion thereof withdrawn. Such basis shall not be reduced
on account of the segregation of any investment in the common trust fund
pursuant to the provisions of 12 CFR 9.18(b)(7) (or, for periods before
September 28, 1962, 12 CFR 206.17(c)(7)). For the purpose of making the
adjustments, additions, and reductions with respect to basis as
prescribed in this paragraph, the ward, rather than the guardian, shall
be deemed to be the participant; and the grantor, rather than the trust,
shall be deemed to be the participant, to the extent that the income of
the trust is taxable to the grantor under subpart E (section 671 and
following), part I, subchapter J, chapter 1 of the Code.
(c) Additions to basis. As prescribed in paragraph (b) of this
section, in computing the gain or loss upon the withdrawal of a
participating interest or portion thereof, there shall be added to the
basis of the participating interest or portion thereof withdrawn an
amount equal to the aggregate of the following items (to the extent that
they were properly allocated to the participant for a taxable year of
the common trust fund and were not distributed to the participant prior
to withdrawal):
[[Page 321]]
(1) Wholly exempt income of the common trust fund for any taxable
year,
(2) Net income of the common trust fund for the taxable years
beginning after December 31, 1935, and prior to January 1, 1938,
(3) Net short-term capital gain of the common trust fund for each
taxable year beginning after December 31, 1937,
(4) The excess of the gains over the losses recognized to the common
trust fund upon sales or exchanges of capital assets held (i) for more
than 18 months for taxable years beginning after December 31, 1937, and
before January 1, 1942, (ii) for more than 6 months for taxable years
beginning after December 31, 1941, and before January 1, 1977, (iii) for
more than 9 months for taxable years beginning in 1977, and (iv) for
more than 1 year for taxable years beginning after December 31, 1977,
and
(5) Ordinary net or taxable income of the common trust fund for each
taxable year beginning after December 31, 1937.
(d) Reductions in basis. As prescribed in paragraph (b) of this
section, in computing the gain or loss upon the withdrawal of a
participating interest or portion thereof, the basis of the
participating interest or portion thereof withdrawn shall be reduced by
such portions of the following items as were allocable to the
participant with respect to the participating interest or portion
thereof withdrawn:
(1) The amount of the excess of the allowable deductions of the
common trust fund over its gross income for the taxable years beginning
after December 31, 1935, and before January 1, 1938, and
(2) The amount of the net short-term capital loss, net long-term
capital loss, and ordinary net loss of the common trust fund for each
taxable year beginning after December 31, 1937.
(e) Effective date. The eighth sentence of paragraph (a) of this
section is effective for combinations and divisions of common trust
funds completed on or after May 2, 1996.
[T.D. 6500, 25 FR 11737, Nov. 26, 1960, as amended by T.D. 6651, 28 FR
4950, May 17, 1963; T.D. 7935, 49 FR 1695, Jan. 13, 1984; T.D. 8662, 61
FR 19546, May 2, 1996; 61 FR 39072, July 26, 1996]
Sec. 1.584-5 Returns of banks with respect to common trust funds.
For rules applicable to filing returns of common trust funds, see
section 6032 and the regulations thereunder.
Sec. 1.584-6 Net operating loss deduction.
The net operating loss deduction is not allowed to a common trust
fund. Each participant in a common trust fund, however, will be allowed
the benefits of such deduction. In the computation of such deduction, a
participant in a common trust fund shall take into account its pro rata
share of items of income, gain, loss, deduction, or credit of the common
trust fund. The character of any such item shall be determined as if the
participant had realized such item directly from the source from which
realized by the common trust fund, or incurred such item in the same
manner as incurred by the common trust fund.
Sec. 1.585-1 Reserve for losses on loans of banks.
(a) General rule. As an alternative to a deduction from gross income
under section 166(a) for specific debts which become worthless in whole
or in part, a financial institution to which section 585 and this
section apply shall be allowed a deduction under section 585(a) (or, for
taxable years beginning before January 1, 1987, section 166(c)), for a
reasonable addition to a reserve for bad debts provided such financial
institution has adopted or adopts the reserve method of treating bad
debts in accordance with paragraph (b) of Sec. 1.166-1. In the case of
such a taxpayer the amount of the reasonable addition to such reserve
for a taxable year beginning after July 11, 1969, shall be an amount
determined by the taxpayer which does not exceed the amount computed
under Sec. 1.585-2. Such reasonable addition for the taxable year shall
be an amount at least equal to the amount provided by Sec. 1.585-
2(a)(2). For each taxable year the taxpayer must include in its income
tax return (or amended return) for that year a computation of the amount
of the addition determined under this section showing the method used to
determine that amount. The use of a particular method in the return for
a taxable year is not a binding election by
[[Page 322]]
the taxpayer to apply such method either for such taxable year or for
subsequent taxable years. A financial institution to which section 585
and this section apply which adopts the reserve method is not entitled
to charge off any bad debts pursuant to section 166(a) with respect to a
loan (as defined in Sec. 1.585-2(e)(2). Except as provided by Sec.
1.585-3, the reserve for bad debts of a financial institution to which
section 585 and this section apply shall be established and maintained
in the same manner as is provided by section 585 (or, for taxable years
beginning before January 1, 1987, section 166(c)) and theregulations
under section 166 with respect to reserves for bad debts. Except as
provided by this section, no deduction is allowable for an addition to a
reserve for losses on loans as defined in Sec. 1.585-2(e)(2) of a
financial institution to which section 585 and this section apply. For
rules relating to deduction with respect to debts which are not loans
(as defined in Sec. 1.585-2(e)(2)), see section 166(a) and the
regulations thereunder. For rules relating to a debt evidenced by a
security (as defined in section 165(g)(2)(C), see sections 166 and
582(a) and the regulations thereunder. For the definition of certain
terms, see paragraph (e) of Sec. 1.585-2. For rules relating to a
transaction to which section 381(a) applies, see Sec. 1.585-4. For
rules relating to large banks, see Sec. Sec. 1.585-5 through 1.585-8.
(b) Application of section--(1) In general. Except as provided in
paragraph (b)(2) of this section, section 585 and this section apply to
the following financial institutions--
(i) Any bank (as defined in section 581 and the regulations
thereunder) other than a mutual savings bank, domestic building and loan
association, or cooperative bank, to which section 593 applies; and
(ii) Any corporation to which paragraph (b)(1)(i) of this section
would apply except for the fact that it is a foreign corporation and in
the case of any such foreign corporation, the rules provided by section
585(a) and (b), this section, Sec. Sec. 1.585-2, 1.585-3, and 1.585-4
apply only with respect to loans outstanding the interest on which is
effectively connected with the conduct of a banking business within the
United States.
(2) Exception. For taxable years beginning after December 31, 1986,
section 585(a) and (b) and this section do not apply to any large bank
(as defined in Sec. 1.585-5(b)). For these years, a large bank may not
deduct any amount under section 585 or any other section for an addition
to a reserve for bad debts.
(Sec. 585(b)(4), of the Internal Revenue Code of 1954 (83 Stat. 618; (26
U.S.C. 585(b)(4))))
[T.D. 7532, 43 FR 3109, Jan. 23, 1978, as amended by T.D. 8513, 58 FR
68757, Dec. 29, 1993; 59 FR 15502, Apr. 1, 1994]
Sec. 1.585-2 Addition to reserve.
(a) In general--(1) Maximum addition. For taxable years beginning
before January 1, 1988, the maximum reasonable addition to the reserve
for losses on loans as defined in paragraph (e)(2) of this section is
the amount allowable under the percentage method provided by paragraph
(b) of this section or the experience method provided by paragraph (c)
of this section, whichever is greater. For taxable years beginning after
December 31, 1987, the maximum reasonable addition to the reserve for
losses on loans is the amount determined under the experience method
provided by paragraph (c) of this section.
(2) Minimum addition. For taxable years beginning after December 31,
1976, and before January 1, 1988, a taxpayer to which this section
applies shall make a minimum addition to the reserve for losses on loans
as defined in paragraph (e)(2) of this section. For purposes of this
subparagraph, the term minimum addition means an addition to the reserve
for losses on loans in an amount equal to the lesser of (i) the amount
allowable under section 585 (b)(3)(A) and paragraph (c)(1)(ii) of this
section, or (ii) the maximum amount allowable under section 585 (b)(2)
and paragraph (b) of this section. For taxable years beginning after
December 31, 1987, a taxpayer to which this section applies shall make a
minimum addition to the reserve for losses on loans for each taxable
year in an amount equal to the amount allowable under section 585
(b)(3)(A) and paragraph (c)(1)(ii) of this section.
[[Page 323]]
(b) Percentage method--(1) In general--(i) Maximum addition. Except
as limited under subparagraph (2) of this paragraph, the maximum
reasonable addition to the reserve for losses on loans under the
percentage method for a taxable year is the amount determined under
paragraph (b)(1) (ii), (iii), or (iv) of this section, whichever is
applicable. For purposes of this paragraph, the term allowable
percentage means 1.8 percent for taxable years beginning before 1976;
1.2 percent for taxable years beginning after 1975 but before 1982; 1.0
percent for taxable years beginning in 1982; and 0.6 percent for taxable
years beginning after 1982 and before 1988. This paragraph does not
apply for taxable years beginning after 1987.
(ii) Reserve less than allowable percentage of eligible loans. (A)
If the reserve for losses on loans as of the close of the base year is
less than the allowable percentage for the taxable year multiplied by
the eligible loans outstanding at the close of the base year, the amount
determined under this subdivision for the taxable year is the amount
necessary to increase the balance of the reserve for losses on loans as
of the close of the taxable year to an amount equal to the allowable
percentage for the taxable year multiplied by the eligible loans
outstanding at the close of that year, except that the amount determined
with respect to the reserve deficiency shall not exceed one-fifth of the
reserve deficiency. For purposes of this section, the term reserve
deficiency means the excess of the allowable percentage for the taxable
year multiplied by the eligible loans outstanding at the close of the
base year over the reserve forlosses on loans as of the close of the
base year. Where a taxpayer has recoveries of bad debts for a taxable
year which exceed the bad debts sustained for such year, the taxpayer is
not required to reduce its otherwise permissible current addition by the
amount of the net recovery. A reasonable addition attributable to an
increase in eligible loans outstanding at the close of the taxable year
over eligible loans outstanding at the close of the base year may be
made only for the portion of such increase which does not exceed the
excess of eligible loans outstanding at the close of the taxable year
over the sum of the amount of eligible loans outstanding at the close of
the base year and the amount of previous increases in such loans for
which an addition was made in taxable years ending after the close of
the base year. For purposes of this subdivision, the order in which the
factors which make up the annual reserve addition shall be claimed is:
(1) An amount equal to one-fifth of the reserve deficiency;
(2) Net bad debts charged to the reserve; and
(3) An amount attributable to an increase in the amount of eligible
loans outstanding.
(B) For its first taxable year, a newly organized financial
institution to which Sec. 1.585-1 and this section apply shall be
considered to have no reserve deficiency. For example, a new financial
institution would compute its annual reserve addition by including in
such addition an amount not in excess of the sum of (1) the amount of
its net bad debts charged to the reserve for the taxable year, and (2)
the allowable percentage of the increase in its eligible loans
outstanding at the close of the taxable year over the amount of its
loans outstanding (zero) at the end of the year preceding its first
taxable year. Such amount would be subject to the 0.6 percent
limitations provided in subparagraph (2) of the paragraph.
(C) The application of the rules provided by this subdivision may be
illustrated by the following example:
Example. The X Bank is a commercial bank which has a calendar year
as its taxable year. X adopted the reserve method of accounting for bad
debts in 1950. On December 31, 1969, X has $1,000,000 of outstanding
eligible loans and a balance of $13,000 in its reserve for losses on
loans. The base year is 1969 and, consequently, X has a reserve
deficiency of $5,000 ((1.8% x $1,000,000) - $13,000).
(a) During 1970, X has net bad debts of $1,000 charged to the
reserve for losses on loans. On December 31, 1970, X has $1,050,000 of
outstanding eligible loans. The maximum reasonable addition under the
percentage method is $2,900 which consists of $1,000 of reserve
deficiency (\1/5\ x $5,000), the $1,000 in net bad debts charged to the
reserve for losses on loans, and $900 attributable to the increase in
the balance of eligible loans (1.8% x ($1,050,000 - $1,000,000)).
Assuming that X makes an addition to the reserve for losses on loans of
$2,900 for the year, the balance of
[[Page 324]]
the reserve as of December 31, 1970 is $14,900 ($13,000 - $1,000 +
$2,900).
(b) During 1971, X has net bad debts of $1,000 charged to the
reserve for losses on loans. On December 31, 1971, X has $800,000 of
outstanding eligible loans. The allowable percentage of eligible loans
is $14,400 (1.8% x $800,000). The maximum reasonable addition under the
percentage method is $500 which is a portion of one-fifth of the reserve
deficiency. Assuming that X makes an addition to the reserve for losses
on loans of $500 for the year, the balance of the reserve as of December
31, 1971, is $14,400 ($14,900 - $1,000 + $500).
(c) During 1972, X has net bad debts of $600 charged to the reserve
for losses on loans. On December 31, 1972, X has $850,000 of outstanding
eligible loans. The allowable percentage of eligible loans is $15,300
(1.8% x $850,000). The maximum reasonable addition under the percentage
method is $1,500 which consists of $1,000 of reserve deficiency (\1/5\ x
$5,000) and $500 of the net bad debts charged to the reserve for losses
on loans in 1971. Even though the full addition with respect to the
reserve deficiency in 1971 was not made, the amount of the addition that
can be made in 1972 with respect to the reserve deficiency is limited to
one-fifth of such deficiency. Assuming that X makes an addition to the
reserve for losses on loans of $1,500 for the year, the balance of the
reserve as of December 31, 1972, is $15,300 ($14,400 - $600 + $1,500).
(d) During 1973, X did not have any net bad debts charged to the
reserve for losses on loans. On December 31, 1973, X has $1,000,000 of
outstanding eligible loans. The allowable percentage of eligible loans
is $18,000 (1.8% x $1,000,000). The maximum reasonable addition under
the percentage method is $2,100 which consists of $1,000 of reserve
deficiency (\1/5\ x $5,000), $500 of net bad debts charged to the
reserve for losses in 1971, and $600 of net bad debts charged to the
reserve in 1972. Although outstanding eligible loans increased from
$850,000 in 1972 to $1,000,000 in 1973, no addition is permitted with
respect to the increase because the amount of eligible loans outstanding
at the close of 1973 ($1,000,000) does not exceed the sum of the amount
of such loans at the close of the base year ($1,000,000) and the amount
of previous increases in such loans for which an addition was made in
taxable years ending after the close of the base year ($50,000 loan
increase in 1970). Assuming that X makes an addition to the reserve for
losses on loans of $2,100, the balance of the reserve as of December 31,
1973, is $17,400 ($15,300 + $2,100).
(iii) Reserve equal to or greater than allowable percentage and
eligible loans have not declined. If the reserve for losses on loans as
of the close of the base year is equal to or greater than the allowable
percentage for the taxable year multiplied by the eligible loans
outstanding at the close of the base year and if the amount of eligible
loans outstanding at the close of the taxable year is equal to or
greater than the amount of eligible loans outstanding at the close of
the base year, the amount determined under this subdivision is the
amount necessary to increase the reserve to the greater of (A) the
allowable percentage for the taxable year multiplied by the eligible
loans outstanding at the close of the year, or (B) the balance of the
reserve as of the close of the base year. The application of the rule
provided by this subdivision may be illustrated by the following
example:
Example. The M Bank is a commercial bank which has a calendar year
as its taxable year. M adopted the reserve method of accounting for bad
debts in 1950. On December 31, 1969, M has $1,000,000 of outstanding
eligible loans and a balance of $20,000 in its reserve for losses on
loans.
(a) During 1970, M has net bad debts of $1,000 charged to the
reserve for losses on loans. On December 31, 1970, M has $1,100,000 of
outstanding eligible loans. The allowable percentage of eligible loans
is $19,800 (1.8% x $1,100,000). The maximum reasonable addition under
the percentage method is $1,000 which is the amount sufficient to
increase the balance of the reserve as of the close of the taxable year
to the balance of the reserve as of the close of the 1969 base year
($20,000). Assuming that M makes an addition to the reserve for losses
on loans of $1,000 for the year, the balance of the reserve as of
December 31, 1970, is $20,000 ($20,000 - $1,000 + $1,000).
(b) During 1971, M has net bad debts of $1,000 charged to the
reserve for losses on loans. On December 31, 1971, M has $1,300,000 of
outstanding eligible loans. The allowable percentage of eligible loans
is $23,400 (1.8% x $1,300,000). The maximum reasonable addition under
the percentage method is $4,400 which is the amount sufficient to
increase the balance of the reserve to the allowable percentage of
eligible loans outstanding at the close of the taxable year. Assuming
that M makes an addition to the reserve for losses on loans of $4,400
for the year, the balance of the reserve as of December 31, 1971, is
$23,400 ($20,000 - $1,000 + $4,400).
(c) During 1972, M has net bad debts of $1,000 charged to the
reserve for losses on loans. On December 31, 1972, M has $1,200,000 of
outstanding eligible loans. The allowable percentage of eligible loans
is $21,600 (1.8%x$1,200,000). No reasonable addition may
[[Page 325]]
be made under the percentage method because the reserve for losses on
loans ($22,400, i.e., $23,400-$1,000) is greater than the allowable
percentage of eligible loans outstanding at the close of the taxable
year ($21,600) and the balance of the reserve as of the close of the
base year ($20,000). Assuming that no amount is added under the
experience method provided by paragraph (c) of this section, the balance
of the reserve for losses on loans as of December 31, 1972, is $22,400
($23,400-$1,000).
(d) During 1973, M has net bad debts of $1,000 charged to the
reserve for losses on loans. On December 31, 1973, M has $1,200,000 of
outstanding eligible loans. The allowable percentage of eligible loans
is $21,600 (1.8%x$1,200,000). The maximum reasonable addition under the
percentage method is $200 which is the amount sufficient to increase the
reserve for losses on loans to the allowable percentage of eligible
loans outstanding at the close of the taxable year. Assuming that M
makes an addition to the reserve for losses on loans of $200 for the
year, the balance of the reserve as of December 31, 1973, is $21,600
($22,400-$1,000+$200).
(iv) Reserve greater than allowable percentage and eligible loans
have declined. If the reserve for losses on loans as of the close of the
base year is equal to or greater than the allowable percentage of
eligible loans outstanding at such time and if the amount of eligible
loans at the close of the taxable year is less than the amount of
eligible loans outstanding at the close of the base year, the amount
determined under this subdivision is the amount necessary to increase
the balance of the reserve to the amount which bears the same ratio to
eligible loans outstanding at the close of the taxable year as the
balance of the reserve as of the close of the base year bears to the
amount of eligible loans outstanding at the close of the base year. The
application of the rule provided by this subdivision may be illustrated
by the following example:
Example. The N Bank is a commercial bank which has a calendar year
as its taxable year. N adopted the reserve method of accounting for bad
debts in 1950. On December 31, 1969, N has $1,000,000 of outstanding
eligible loans and a balance of $20,000 in its reserve for losses on
loans.
(a) During 1970, N has net bad debts of $3,000 charged to the
reserve for losses on loans. On December 31, 1970, N has $900,000 of
outstanding eligible loans. The maximum reasonable addition under the
percentage method is $1,000, which is the amount necessary to increase
the balance of the reserve to the amount ($18,000) which bears the same
ratio to eligible loans outstanding at the close of the taxable year
($900,000) as the balance of the reserve as of the close of the base
year ($20,000) bears to the amount of the eligible loans outstanding at
the close of the base year ($1,000,000). Assuming that N makes an
addition to the reserve for losses on loans of $1,000 for the year, the
balance of the reserve as of December 31, 1970, is $18,000 ($20,000-
$3,000+$1,000).
(b) During 1971, N has net bad debts of $1,000 charged to the
reserve for losses on loans. On December 31, 1971, N has $1,100,000 of
outstanding eligible loans. The maximum reasonable addition under the
percentage method, determined under subdivision (iii) of this
subparagraph, is $3,000 which is the amount necessary to increase the
balance of the reserve to the greater of the allowable percentage of
eligible loans outstanding at the close of the taxable year ($19,800) or
the balance of the reserve at the close of the base year ($20,000).
Assuming that N makes an addition to the reserve for losses on loans of
$3,000 for the year, the balance of the reserve as of December 31, 1971
is $20,000 ($18,000-$1,000+$3,000).
(2) Limitations. Notwithstanding any other provision of this
paragraph, the maximum reasonable addition to the reserve for losses on
loans under the percentage method shall not exceed the greater of:
(i) Six-tenths of 1 percent of the eligible loans outstanding at the
close of the taxable year, or
(ii) An amount sufficient to increase the reserve for losses on
loans at the close of the taxable year to six-tenths of 1 percent of the
eligible loans outstanding at the close of the taxable year.
The application of the rules provided by this subparagraph may be
illustrated by the following example:
Example. The Y Bank begins business as a commercial bank on July 1,
1974. Y adopts the calendar year as its taxable year and the reserve
method of accounting for bad debts.
(a) During 1974, Y has net bad debts of $1,000. On December 31,
1974, Y has $1,000,000 of outstanding eligible loans. Under subparagraph
(1)(ii)(B) of this paragraph, because Y is a newly-organized financial
institution, there is no reserve deficiency. Except for the limitations
of this subparagraph, the maximum reasonable addition under subparagraph
(1)(ii)(A) of this paragraph would be the amount of net bad debts
charged to the reserve for losses ($1,000) plus the allowable percentage
of outstanding eligible loans at
[[Page 326]]
the close of the taxable year $18,000 (1.8%x$1,000,000). However,
because of the limitations of this subparagraph, the maximum reasonable
addition to the reserve for losses on loans under the percentage method
is an amount sufficient to increase the balance of the reserve for
losses on loans to $6,000 which is 0.6 percent of the eligible loans
outstanding at the close of the taxable year. Assuming that Y makes an
addition to the reserve for losses on loans of $7,000 for the year, the
balance of the reserve as of December 31, 1974, is $6,000 ($7,000-
$1,000). The $7,000 consists of the $1,000 in net bad debts and $6,000
attributable to the increase in eligible loans outstanding.
(b) During 1975, Y has net bad debts of $1,000 charged to the
reserve for losses on loans. On December 31, 1975, Y has $1,000,000 of
outstanding eligible loans. Except for the limitations of this
subparagraph, the maximum reasonable addition under subparagraph
(1)(ii)(A) of this paragraph would be the amount of net bad debts
charged to the reserve for losses ($1,000) plus an amount attributable
to the increase in the amount of eligible loans outstanding with respect
to which no reasonable addition was allowed in 1974 ($12,000, i.e.,
$18,000-$6,000). However, because of the limitations of this paragraph,
the maximum reasonable addition to the reserve for losses on loans under
the percentage method is $6,000 which is an amount equal to 0.6 percent
of the eligible loans outstanding at the close of the taxable year. This
amount consists of net bad debts of $1,000 and $5,000 attributable to a
portion of the increase in eligible loans in 1974 with respect to which
no reasonable addition was allowable for 1974. Assuming that Y makes an
addition to the reserve for losses on loans of $6,000 for the year, the
balance of the reserve as of December 31, 1975, is $11,000 ($6,000-
$1,000+$6,000).
(c) During 1976, Y has net bad debts charged to the reserve for
losses on loans of $1,000. On December 31, 1976, Y has $1,000,000 in
outstanding eligible loans. At the close of 1975 (Y's base year for
1976), the amount of outstanding eligible loans was also $1,000,000.
Consequently, there is a reserve deficiency of $1,000
((1.2%x$1,000,000)--$11,000). The maximum reasonable addition to the
reserve for losses under subparagraph (1)(ii)(A) of this paragraph is
$1,200 which consists of one-fifth of the reserve deficiency ($1,000x\1/
5\=$200) and the net bad debts charged to the reserve for losses on
loans for the year ($1,000). Because that amount is less than 0.6
percent of the eligible loans outstanding at the close of the taxable
year (0.6%x$1,000,000=$6,000), the limitations of this subparagraph do
not apply. Assuming that Y makes an addition to the reserve for losses
on loans of $1,200 for the year, the balance of the reserve as of
December 31, 1976, is $11,200 ($11,000-$1,000+$1,200).
(c) Experience method--(1) In general--(i) Maximum addition. The
amount determined under this paragraph for a taxable year is the amount
necessary to increase the balance of the reserve for losses on loans (as
of the close of the taxable year) to the greater of the amount
determined under subdivision (ii) or (iii) of this subparagraph. For
special rules for a new financial institution, see subparagraph (2) of
this paragraph.
(ii) Six-year moving average amount. The amount determined under
this subdivision is the amount which bears the same ratio to loans
outstanding at the close of the taxable year as (A) the total bad debts
sustained during the taxable year and the 5 preceding taxable years (or,
with the approval of the Commissioner, a shorter period), adjusted for
recoveries of bad debts during such period, bears to (B) the sum of the
loans outstanding at the close of such 6 (or fewer) taxable years. For
purposes of applying this subdivision, a period shorter than 6 years
generally would be appropriate only where there is a change in the type
of a substantial portion of the loans outstanding such that the risk of
loss is substantially increased. For example, if the major portion of a
bank's portfolio of loans changes fromagricultural loans to industrial
loans which results in a substantial increase in the risk of loss, a
period shorter than 6 years may be appropriate. Similarly, a bank which
has recently altered its lending practices to include in its portfolio
of loans consumer-installment loans, when it had previously made only
commercial loans, may also qualify to use a period shorter than six
years. A decline in the general economic conditions in the area, which
substantially increase the risk of loss, is a relevant factor which may
be considered. In any case, however, approval to use a shorter period
will not be granted unless the taxpayer supplies specific evidence that
the loans outstanding at the close of the taxable years for the shorter
period requested are not comparable in nature and risk to loans
outstanding at the close of the six taxable years. The fact that a
bank's bad debt experience has shown a substantial increase is not, by
itself, sufficient to justify use of a
[[Page 327]]
shorter period. If approval is granted to use a shorter period, the
experience for those taxable years which are excluded shall not be used
for any subsequent year. A request for approval to exclude the
experience of a prior taxable year shall not be considered unless it is
sent to the Commissioner at least 30 days before the close of the first
taxable year for which such approval is requested.
(iii) Base year amount. The amount determined under this subdivision
is the lower of (A) the balance of the reserve as of the close of the
base year, or (B) if the amount of loans outstanding at the close of the
taxable year is less than the amount of loans outstanding at the close
of the base year, the amount which bears the same ratio to loans
outstanding at the close of the taxable year as the balance of the
reserve as of the close of the base year bears to the amount of loans
outstanding at the close of the base year.
(2) Special rules for new financial institutions--(i) In general. In
the case of any taxable year preceded by less than 5 authorization years
(as defined in paragraph (e)(5) of this section), subparagraph (1) of
this paragraph shall be applied with the adjustments provided by
subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph.
(ii) Adjustments. (A) The total bad debts for the 6-year period
computed under subparagraph (1)(ii)(A) of this paragraph shall be the
sum of:
(1) The bad debts sustained by the taxpayer during its authorization
years, adjusted for recoveries of bad debts for such years, and
(2) That fraction of the total bad debts sustained by a comparable
bank (as defined in paragraph (e)(7) of this section) during the
comparison years (as defined in paragraph (e)(6) of this section),
adjusted for recoveries of bad debts for such years, which bears the
same ratio to such total as the average loans outstanding of the
taxpayer during the authorization years bears to the average loans
outstanding of the comparable bank during the comparison years.
(B) The total amount of loans outstanding during the 6-year period
computed under subparagraph (1)(ii)(B) of this paragraph shall be six
times the average loans outstanding of the taxpayer during the
authorization years.
(d) Change in accounting method from specific charge-off method to
reserve method of treating bad debts--(1) In general. If a bank is
granted permission in accordance with Sec. 1.446-1(e)(3) to change its
method of accounting for bad debts from a method under which specific
bad debt items are deducted to the reserve method of treating bad debts,
the taxpayer shall effect the change as provided in subparagraphs (2)
and (3) of this paragraph.
(2) Initial balance of the reserve. The initial balance of the
reserve at the close of the year of change shall be no less than the
minimum addition as described in paragraph (a)(2) of this section and
shall be no larger than the greater of:
(i) The allowable percentage of eligible loans outstanding at the
close of the taxable year of change, or
(ii) The amount which bears the same ratio to loans outstanding at
the close of the taxable year as the total bad debts sustained during
the taxable year and the 5 preceding taxable years (or, with the
approval of the Commissioner, a shorter period), adjusted for recoveries
of bad debts during such period, bears to the sum of the loans
outstanding at the close of such 6 or fewer taxable years.
In the case of taxable years beginning after 1987, the initial balance
of the reserve at the end of the year of change shall be the amount
specified in subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph.
(3) Deduction with respect to initial balance. The deduction with
respect to the initial balance of the reserve at the close of the
taxable year of change, determined under subparagraph (2) of this
paragraph, is allowable ratably over a period of 10 years commencing
with the taxable year of change (or a shorter period as may be approved
by the Commissioner). Thus, the bad debt deduction under section 166 for
the taxable year of change will consist of the amount of debts
determined to be wholly or partially worthless and charged-off during
such taxable year plus one-tenth (if a 10-year period is used) of the
amount of the reserve determined under subparagraph (2) of this
paragraph. For each of the 9 taxable
[[Page 328]]
years following the taxable year of change, the bad debt deduction will
consist of the reasonable addition to the reserve for bad debts for each
such year as provided by section 585, as otherwise determined, plus one-
tenth of the amount determined to be theinitial balance of the reserve
under subparagraph (2) of this paragraph. The amount established as a
bad debt reserve for the taxable year of change under subparagraph (2)
of this paragraph shall be considered as the balance of the reserve for
purposes of determining the amount of subsequent additions to such
reserve, even though the entire amount of the reserve may not have been
deducted under section 585(a)(1) or former section 166(c) because of the
requirement that it be deducted over a number of years.
(e) Definitions--(1) Base year--(i) Percentage method. For purposes
of paragraph (b) of this section (relating to the percentage method),
the term base year means: For years beginning before 1976, the last
taxable year beginning on or before July 11, 1969; for taxable years
beginning after 1975 but before 1983, the last taxable year beginning
before 1976; and, for taxable years beginning after 1982, the last
taxable year beginning before 1983. However, for purposes of section
585(b)(2)(A) the term base year means the last taxable year before the
most recent adoption of the percentage method, if later than the base
year as determined under the preceding sentence.
(ii) Experience method. For purposes of paragraph (c) of this
section (relating to the experience method), the term base year means
(A) the last taxable year before the most recent adoption of the
experience method, or (B) the last taxable year beginning on or before
July 11, 1969, which ever is later; and for taxable years beginning
after 1987, the last taxable year beginning before 1988.
(iii) Example. The application of the rules provided by this
subparagraph may be illustrated by the following example:
Example. The T Bank is a commercial bank which has a calendar year
as its taxable year. T adopted the reserve method of accounting for bad
debts in 1950. On December 31, 1969, T has $1,000,000 of outstanding
eligible loans and a balance of $19,300 in its reserve for losses on
loans.
(a) During 1970, T has net bad debts of $1,000 charged to the
reserve for losses on loans. On December 31, 1970, T has $1,050,000 of
outstanding eligible loans. T elects the percentage method. The base
year is 1969. The maximum reasonable addition under the percentage
method of $1,000 which is the amount sufficient to increase the balance
of the reserve as of the close of the taxable year to the balance of the
reserve as of the close of the base year 1969 ($19.300). Assuming that T
makes an addition to the reserve for losses on loans of $1,000 for the
year, the balance of the reserve for losses on loans as of December 31,
1970, is $19,300 ($19,300-$1,000+$1,000).
(b) During 1971, T has net bad debts of $8,000 charged to the
reserve for losses on loans. On December 31, 1971, T has $1,100,000 of
outstanding eligible loans. T elects the experience method. The base
year is 1970. The maximum reasonable addition under the experience
method is $8,000 which is the amount sufficient to increase the balance
of the reserve as of the close of the taxable year to the balance of the
reserve as of the close of the 1970 base year ($19,300). Assuming that T
makes an addition to the reserve for losses on loans of $8,000 for the
year, the balance of the reserve for losses on loans as of December 31,
1971, is $19,300, ($19,300-$8,000+$8,000).
(c) During 1972, T has net bad debts of $1,000 charged to the
reserve for losses on loans. On December 31, 1972, T has $1,200,000 of
outstanding eligible loans. T elects the percentage method. The base
year is 1971 and there is a reserve deficiency of $500
((1.8%x$1,100,000)-$19,300). The maximum reasonable addition under the
percentage method is $2,900 which consists of $100 of reserve deficiency
(\1/5\x$500), the $1,000 in net bad debts charged to the reserve for
losses on loans, and $1,800 attributable to the increase in the balance
of eligible loans (1.8%x($1,200,000-$1,100,000)). Assuming that T makes
an addition to the reserve for losses on loans of $2,900 for the year,
the balance of the reserve for losses on loans as of December 31, 1972,
is $21,200 ($19,300-$1,000+$2,900).
(2) Loan--(i) General rule. For purposes of this section and
Sec. Sec. 1.585-1, 1.585-3, and 1.585-4, the term loan means debt as
the term debt is used in section 166 and the regulations thereunder. The
term loan includes (but is not limited to) the following items:
(A) An overdraft in one or more deposit accounts by a customer in
good faith whether or not other deposit accounts of the same customer
have balances in excess of the overdraft;
(B) A bankers acceptance purchased or discounted by a bank; and
[[Page 329]]
(C) A loan participation to the extent that the taxpayer bears a
risk of loss.
For purposes of (B) of this subdivision (i), a bankers acceptance
shall be considered as a loan made by the bank which purchased or
discounted the bankers acceptance and not a loan made by the originating
bank.
(ii) Exceptions. Notwithstanding the provisions of subdivision (i)
of this subparagraph, the term loan does not include the following
items:
(A) Discount or interest receivable reflected in the face amount of
an outstanding loan, which discount or interest has not been included in
gross income;
(B) For taxable years beginning after December 31, 1976, commercial
paper, however acquired by the bank, including, for example, short-term
promissory notes which may be purchased on the open market;
(C) For taxable years beginning after December 31, 1976, a debt
evidenced by a security (as defined in section 165(g)(2)(C) and the
regulations thereunder);
(D) Any loan which is entered into or acquired for the primary
purpose of enlarging the otherwise available bad debt deduction;
(E) Loans which have been contractually committed to the extent that
funds have not been disbursed to the borrower or disbursed on behalf of
the borrower; and
(F) Any transaction which is in violation of a Federal or State
statute that governs the activities of the financial institution.
(3) Eligible loan--(i) General rule. For purposes of this section
and Sec. Sec. 1.585-3 and 1.585-4, the term eligible loan means a loan
(as defined in subparagraph (2) of this paragraph) which is incurred in
the course of the normal customer loan activities of a financial
institution and which is not a loan described in subdivision (ii) of
this subparagraph. Nothing within the preceding sentence will be
construed to exclude from the term eligible loan a bona fide loan in a
new market or under a novel repayment arrangement if the likelihood of
nonrepayment is at least as great as that of other customer loans of the
financial institution.
(ii) Exceptions. Loans which do not constitute eligible loans
include:
(A) A loan to a bank (as defined in section 581 and the regulations
thereunder) or to a domestic branch of a foreign corporation to which
Sec. 1.585-1 applies, including a repurchase transaction or other
similar transaction;
(B) Bank funds on deposit in any bank (foreign or domestic) such as
a deposit represented by a certificate of deposit or any other form of
instrument evidencing the deposit of a sum of money with the issuing
bank that will be available on or after a stated date or period of time;
(C) A sale or loan of Federal funds irrespective of the purchaser or
borrower;
(D) A loan, to the extent that it is directly or indirectly made to,
guaranteed by, or insured by the United States, a possession or
instrumentality thereof, or a State or political subdivision thereof;
and
(E) A loan which is secured by a deposit in the lending financial
institution or in a bank as defined in section 581 or a domestic branch
of a foreign corporation to which this section applies to the extent
that the financial institution has control over withdrawal of such
deposit.
(iii) Definition of loan which is secured by a deposit. For purposes
of subdivision (ii)(E) of this subparagraph:
(A) A loan is considered secured if the loan is on the security of
any instrument which makes the deposit specific security for the payment
of the loan, provided that such instrument is of such a nature that in
the event of default the deposit could be subjected to the satisfaction
of the loan;
(B) A deposit includes a guarantee deposit in the form of a
holdback, pledged collateral that has been reduced to cash, and loan
payments that are maintained in a separate account; and
(C) Control over the withdrawal of a deposit is evidenced by
possession of a passbook, certificate of deposit, note, or other similar
instrument the possession of which is normally required to permit
withdrawal. The lending financial institution does not have control over
withdrawal of the deposit if the
[[Page 330]]
deposit can be withdrawn without consent of the lending financial
institution. Thus, the lending financial institution normally does not
have control over the withdrawal of a deposit in an account merely
because the borrower agrees to maintain a minimum, average, or
compensating balance.
(4) Predecessor. For purposes of this section, the term predecessor
means (i) any taxpayer which transferred more than 50 percent of the
total amount of its assets to the taxpayer and is described in Sec.
1.585-1, or (ii) any predecessor of such predecessor.
(5) Authorization years. For purposes of this section, the term
authorization years means the number of years, containing 12 complete
months, between (i) the first day of the first full taxable year of the
taxpayer for which it (or any predecessor) was authorized to do business
as a financial institution described in Sec. 1.585-1, and (ii) the
taxable year.
(6) Comparison years. For purposes of this section, the term
comparison years means those consecutive taxable years containing 12
complete months of a comparable bank, the last of which ends within 12
months immediately preceding the beginning of the first taxable year of
the taxpayer, which are equal in number to six minus the number of
authorization years of the taxpayer.
(7) Comparable bank. For purposes of this section, the term
comparable bank means all the financial institutions described in Sec.
1.585-1 located within the same Federal Reserve district.
(8) Average loans outstanding. For purposes of this section, the
term average loans outstanding means the sum of the loans outstanding at
the close of each taxable year of a period divided by the number of
taxable years in such period.
(9) Adjusted for recoveries of bad debts. For purposes of this
section, the term adjusted for recoveries of bad debts means an
adjustment for the full amount recovered with respect to bad debts
previously charged to the reserve during any of the applicable taxable
years.
(Sec. 585(b)(4), of the Internal Revenue Code of 1954 (83 Stat. 618; (26
U.S.C. 585(b)(4))))
[T.D. 7532, 43 FR 3109, Jan. 23, 1978, as amended by T.D. 7835, 47 FR
42342, Sept. 27, 1982; T.D. 8513, 58 FR 68757, Dec. 29, 1993]
Sec. 1.585-3 Special rules.
(a) Treatment of reserve. For taxable years beginning after July 11,
1969, if a financial institution to which section 585 and Sec. 1.585-1
apply establishes a reserve pursuant to section 585(a) (or, for taxable
years beginning before January 1, 1987, section 166(c)), any bad debt in
respect of a loan (whether or not such loan is an eligible loan) must be
charged to the reserve for losses on loans provided for by Sec. 1.585-1
for the taxable year in which the bad debt occurs. For such a year, any
recovery of a bad debt previously charged to the reserve account in
respect of a loan (whether or not such loan is an eligible loan) must be
credited to such reserve in the taxable year of recovery regardless of
whether such credit causes the reserve to exceed the permissible amount.
If, as a result of net recoveries during the taxable year, the reserve
balance exceeds the permissible amount, a taxpayer is not required to
report the excess as taxable income. In such a case, the excess over the
otherwise permissible amount in the reserve account precludes current
reasonable additions to the reserve and may affect future reasonable
additions. Recoveries of bad debts which were not charged to the reserve
shall not be credited to such reserve, but shall be treated as taxable
income subject to the provisions of section 111. No item other than a
loan as defined in Sec. 1.585-2 (e)(2) shall be charged to the reserve
for losses on loans.
(b) Accounting for reserve. A financial institution to which section
585 and Sec. 1.585-1 apply which establishes a reserve pursuant to
section 585(a) (or, for taxable years beginning before January 1, 1987,
section 166(c)) shall establish and maintain a permanent record of such
reserve. Copies of Federal income tax returns and amended returns with
attached schedules satisfy the requirements of this paragraph provided
that such returns are permanently maintained by the financial
institution and the balance of the reserve for losses on loans
established pursuant to section 585(a) (or former section 166(c)) can be
readily reconciled with the reservefor losses on loans maintained by the
financial institution for financial statement purposes. The requirements
of
[[Page 331]]
this paragraph would also be satisfied if a financial institution
establishes and maintains a permanent subsidiary ledger reflecting an
account for the reserve for losses on loans established pursuant to
section 585(a) (or former section 166(c)) provided the balance in such
account can be readily reconciled with the balance of the reserve for
losses on loans for financial statement purposes maintained in any other
ledger. The permanent records maintained pursuant to this section must
reflect any changes in the amount initially added to the reserve for
losses on loans and the amount finally determined by the taxpayer to be
a reasonable addition to the reserve for losses on loans.
(Sec. 585(b)(4), of the Internal Revenue Code of 1954 (83 Stat. 618; (26
U.S.C. 585(b)(4))))
[T.D. 7532, 43 FR 3114, Jan. 23, 1978, as amended by T.D. 8513, 58 FR
68757, Dec. 29, 1993]
Sec. 1.585-4 Reorganizations and asset acquisitions.
(a) In general. In computing a reasonable addition to the reserve
for losses on loans for the first taxable year ending after a
transaction to which section 381(a) applies and for subsequent taxable
years, the separate reserves for losses on loans, the amount of loans
outstanding, the total bad debts sustained (adjusted for recoveries),
and the amount of eligible loans outstanding of the distributor or
transferor corporation and the acquiring corporation (or, in the case of
a consolidation, the transferor corporations) shall be combined for all
applicable years. Thus, for example, in applying Sec. 1.585-2(c)(1)(i)
for the first taxable year ending after the distribution or transfer,
the total bad debts sustained during the 5 preceding taxable years are
the sum of the bad debts sustained by the acquiring corporation for the
5 preceding taxable years and bad debts sustained by the distributor or
transferor corporation for the taxable year ending on the date of
distribution or transfer and the 4 preceding taxable years.
(b) Base year and base year amounts of acquiring corporation--(1)
Base year. For transactions to which section 381(a) applies, the base
year of the acquiring corporation for the first taxable year ending
after the date of distribution or transfer shall be the last taxable
year ending on or before the date of distribution or transfer. The
balance of the reserve, the amount of loans outstanding, and the amount
of eligible loans outstanding at the close of such base year shall be
determined in accordance with the provisions of subparagraph (2)(i) of
this paragraph. For taxable years subsequent to the first taxable year
ending after the date of distribution or transfer, the base year of the
acquiring corporation shall be the more recent of the base year provided
by the first sentence of this subparagraph or the base year provided by
Sec. 1.585-2(e)(1). If Sec. 1.585-2(e)(1) provides the more recent
base year, the balance of the reserve for losses on loans, the amount of
loans outstanding, and the amount of eligible loans outstanding shall be
determined at the close of such base year without regard to this
paragraph.
(2) Base year amounts--(i) Method of determination. The balance of
the reserve for losses on loans, the amount of loans outstanding, and
the amount of eligible loans outstanding at the close of the base year
provided by the first sentence of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph
shall be the total of such amounts of the distributor or transferor
corporation and the acquiring corporation (or, in the case of a
consolidation, the transferor corporations) at the close of what would
have been their respective base years determined under Sec. 1.585-
2(e)(1) if the distribution or transfer to which section 381(a) applies
had not occurred, except that the method (experience or percentage) used
or adopted by the acquiring corporation to determine its reasonable
addition to a reserve for losses on loans for the first taxable year
ending after the date of the distribution or transfer shall be
considered to be the method that the distributor or transferor
corporation (or, in the case of a consolidation, that the transferor
corporation) would have used or adopted for its first taxable year
ending after the date of distribution or transfer if the distribution or
transfer had not occurred.
(ii) Examples. The application of the rule provided by this
subparagraph may be illustrated by the following examples:
[[Page 332]]
Example 1. The X Corporation and the Y Corporation are commercial
banks both of which have a calendar year as a taxable year. Both X and Y
adopted the reserve method of accounting for bad debts prior to July 11,
1969. For the taxable year 1970 through 1973, X and Y determined their
reasonable additions to a reserve for losses on loans as defined in
Sec. 1.585-2(e)(2) under the percentage method. On June 30, 1974, the X
Bank is merged into the Y Bank; for its short taxable year ending on
June 30, 1974, X determines its reasonable addition under the percentage
method. If, for the taxable year ending on December 31, 1974 (the first
taxable year ending after the date of distribution or transfer), Y
determines its reasonable addition to a reserve for losses on loans
under the percentage method, then at the close of the base year the
reserve balance, the amount of outstanding loans, and the amount of
eligible loans outstanding are the sum of X's and Y's respective amounts
at the close of the taxable year endingDecember 31, 1969 (the base year
of both X and Y determined under Sec. 1.585-2(e)(1) as if the
distribution or transfer had not taken place). If, instead of the above,
Y adopts the experience method of determining its reasonable addition to
a reserve for losses for the taxable year 1974, than at the close of the
base year (1973) the reserve balances, the amount of loans outstanding,
and the amount of eligible loans outstanding are the sum of X's
respective amounts at the close of its short taxable year ending on June
30, 1974 (X's last taxable year before its (Y's) most recent adoption of
the experience method) and of Y's respective amounts at the close of its
taxable year 1973 (Y's last taxable year before its most recent adoption
of the experience method).
Example 2. The M Corporation and the N Corporation are commercial
banks. M has a fiscal year ending September 30, as its taxable year and
N has a calendar year as its taxable year. Both M and N adopted the
reserve method of accounting for bad debts prior to July 11, 1969. For
the taxable years ending in 1970, 1971, and 1972, M determined its
reasonable addition to a reserve for losses under the percentage method;
for the taxable year ending in 1973 M adopted the experience method. For
the taxable years 1970 through 1973 N determined its reasonable addition
under the percentage method. M is merged into N on June 30, 1974, and
for its short taxable year ending on June 30, 1974, M determines its
reasonable addition under the experience method. If, for the taxable
year ending on December 31, 1974 (thefirst taxable year ending after the
date of distribution or transfer), N determines its reasonable addition
to a reserve for losses under the percentage method, then at the close
of the base year (1973) the reserve balance, the amount of loans
outstanding, and the amount of eligible loans outstanding are the sum of
M's respective amounts at the close of (a) if M had a reserve deficiency
as of June 30, 1974, its short taxable year ending on June 30, 1974 (M's
last taxable year before its (N's) most recent adoption of the
percentage method), or (b) if M did not have a reserve deficiency, the
taxable year ending on September 30, 1969, and N's respective amounts at
the close of its taxable year 1979. If, instead of the above, N adopts
the experience method for the taxable year 1974, then at the close of
the base year the reserve balance, the amount of outstanding loans, and
the amount of eligible loans outstanding are the sum of M's respective
amounts at the close of its taxable year ending on September 30, 1972
(the last taxable year before M's most recent adoption of the experience
method), and N's respective amounts at the close of the taxable year
1973 (the last taxable year ending before N's most recent adoption of
the experience method).
(Sec. 585(b)(4), of the Internal Revenue Code of 1954 (83 Stat. 618; (26
U.S.C. 585(b)(4))))
[T.D. 7532, 43 FR 3114, Jan. 23, 1978]
Sec. 1.585-5 Denial of bad debt reserves for large banks.
(a) General rule. For taxable years beginning after December 31,
1986, a large bank (as defined in paragraph (b) of this section) may not
deduct any amount under section 585 or any other section for an addition
to a reserve for bad debts. However, for these years, except as provided
in Sec. 1.585-7, a large bank may deduct amounts allowed under section
166(a) for specific debts that become worthless in whole or in part. Any
large bank that maintained a reserve for bad debts under section 585 for
the taxable year immediately preceding its disqualification year (as
defined in paragraph (d)(1) of this section) must follow the rules
prescribed by Sec. 1.585-6 or Sec. 1.585-7 for changing from the
reserve method of accounting for bad debts that is allowed by section
585, to the specific charge-off method of accounting for bad debts, in
its disqualification year. However, except as may be provided otherwise
in regulations prescribed under section 593, the rules prescribed by
Sec. Sec. 1.585-6 and 1.585-7 do not apply to a large bank that
maintained a reserve for bad debts under section 593 for the taxable
year immediately preceding its disqualification year.
(b) Large bank--(1) General definition. For purposes of this
section, a large
[[Page 333]]
bank is any institution described in Sec. 1.585-1(b)(1) (i) or (ii) if,
for the taxable year (or for any preceding taxable year beginning after
December 31, 1986)--
(i) The average total assets of the institution (determined under
paragraph (c) of this section) exceed $500,000,000; or
ii) The institution is a member of a parent-subsidiary controlled
group (as defined in paragraph (d)(2) of this section) and the average
total assets of the group exceed $500,000,000.
(2) Large bank resulting from transfer by large bank--(i) In
general. If a corporation acquires the assets of a large bank (as
defined in this paragraph (b)) in an acquisition to which paragraph
(b)(2) (ii), (iii) or (iv) of this section applies, the acquiring
corporation (the acquiror) is treated as a large bank for any taxable
year ending after the date of the acquisition in which it is an
institution described in Sec. 1.585-1(b)(1) (i) or (ii).
(ii) Transfer of significant portion of assets where control is
retained. This paragraph (b)(2)(ii) applies to any direct or indirect
acquisition of a significant portion of a large bank's assets if, after
the acquisition, the transferor large bank owns more than 50 percent (by
vote or value) of the outstanding stock of the acquiror. For this
purpose, stock of an acquiror is considered owned by a transferor bank
if the stock is owned by any member of a parent-subsidiary controlled
group (as defined in paragraph (d)(2) of this section) of which the bank
is a member, by any related party within the meaning of section 267(b)
or 707(b), or by any person that received the stock in a transaction to
which section 355 applies.
(iii) Transfer to which section 381 applies. This paragraph
(b)(2)(iii) applies to any acquisition to which section 381(a) applies
if, immediately after the acquisition, the acquiror's principal method
of accounting for bad debts (determined under Sec. 1.381(c)(4)-1(c)(2))
with respect to its banking business is the specific charge-off method.
In applying Sec. 1.381(c)(4)-1(c)(2) for this purpose, the following
rules apply: A transferor large bank is considered to use the specific
charge-off method for all of its loans immediately before the
acquisition; an acquiror is considered to use a reserve method for all
of its loans immediately before the acquisition; and all banking
businesses of the acquiror immediately after the acquisition are treated
as one integrated business. See Sec. Sec. 1.585-6(c)(3) and 1.585-
7(d)(2) for rules on the treatment of assets acquired from large banks
in section 381(a) transactions.
(iv) Transfer of substantially all assets to related party. This
paragraph (b)(2)(iv) applies to any direct or indirect acquisition of
substantially all of a large bank's assets if the transferor large bank
and the acquiror are related parties before or after the acquisition and
a principal purpose of the acquisition is to avoid treating the acquired
assets as those of a large bank. A transferor bank and an acquiror are
considered to be related parties for this purpose if they are members of
the same parent-subsidiary controlled group (as defined in paragraph
(d)(2) of this section) or related parties within the meaning of section
267(b) or 707(b).
(3) Examples. The following examples illustrate the principles of
this paragraph (b):
Example 1. Bank M, a calendar year taxpayer, is an institution
described in Sec. 1.585-1(b)(1)(i). For its taxable year beginning on
January 1, 1987, M has average total assets of $600 million. Since M's
average total assets for 1987 exceed $500 million, M is a large bank for
that year. Pursuant to Sec. 1.585-5(d)(1), 1987 is M's disqualification
year. If M maintained a bad debt reserve under section 585 for its
immediately preceding taxable year (1986), M must change in 1987 to the
specific charge-off method of accounting for bad debts, in accordance
with Sec. 1.585-6 or Sec. 1.585-7.
Example 2. Assume the same facts as in Example 1. Also assume that
in 1988 M disposes of a portion of its assets and, as a result, M's
average total assets for taxable year 1988 fall to $400 million. M
remains a large bank for taxable year 1988 and succeeding taxable years,
since its average total assets for a preceding taxable year (1987)
beginning after December 31, 1986, exceeded $500 million.
Example 3. Bank P, a calendar year taxpayer, is an institution
described in Sec. 1.585-1(b)(1)(i). P has average total assets of $300
million for its taxable year beginning on January 1, 1988. For the same
year, P is a member of a parent-subsidiary controlled group (within the
meaning of Sec. 1.585-5(d)(2)) that has average total assets of $800
million. In February 1989, the group sells its stock in P to several
individual investors. P is a large
[[Page 334]]
bank for taxable year 1988 because it is a member of a group described
in Sec. 1.585-5(b)(1)(ii) for that year. P also is a large bank for
taxable year 1989 and succeeding taxable years because it was a member
of a group described in Sec. 1.585-5(b)(1)(ii) for a preceding taxable
year (1988) beginning after December 31, 1986.
Example 4. Assume the same facts as in Example 3, except that P's
stock is purchased by a corporation that is not a large bank under Sec.
1.585-5(b). Also assume that the purchasing corporation elects under
section 338 to treat the stock purchase as an asset acquisition. Under
section 338, P is considered to have sold all of its assets on the
purchase date and is treated as a new corporation that purchased these
assets on the next day. Since P is treated as a new corporation, its
prior membership in a group described in Sec. 1.585-5(b)(1)(ii) does
not cause it to be treated as a large bank for taxable years ending
after the date of its sale by the group. However, P may be treated as a
large bank because of new membership in such a group or pursuant to
Sec. 1.585-5(b)(1)(i) or (b)(2).
Example 5. Bank Q is a large bank, within the meaning of Sec.
1.585-5(b)(1), for its taxable year beginning on January 1, 1988, and
hence for all later years. On March 1, 1989, Q transfers $200 million of
its $600 million of assets to Bank R, a newly created subsidiary, in a
transaction to which section 351 applies; these assets are R's only
assets. On the same day, Q then spins off R in a transaction to which
section 355 applies. After these transactions, the shareholders of Q own
more than 50 percent of R's outstanding stock. Although R's average
total assets do not exceed $500 million, R becomes a large bank on March
1, 1989, pursuant to Sec. 1.585-5(b)(2)(ii). These transactions do not
affect Q's status as a large bank.
Example 6. Bank S is a large bank, within the meaning of Sec.
1.585-5(b)(1)(ii), for its taxable year beginning on January 1, 1987. As
a result, S changes to the specific charge-off method of accounting for
bad debts in that year. Bank T, which is not a large bank under Sec.
1.585-5(b), uses the reserve method of accounting for bad debts. On June
30, 1988, T acquires substantially all of S's assets in a transaction to
which section 381(a) applies. Immediately before the acquisition, S's
banking business has total assets of $200 million, and T's has total
assets of $250 million. To determine whether T is a large bank under
Sec. 1.585-5(b)(2)(iii) for taxable years ending after the acquisition,
it is necessary to determine T's principal method of accounting for bad
debts with respect to its banking business immediately after the
acquisition. This determination requires an application of Sec.
1.381(c)(4)-1(c)(2). For this purpose, T's original and acquired banking
businesses are treated as an integrated business. Applying Sec.
1.381(c)(4)-1(c)(2), it is determined that the business's principal
method of accounting for bad debts immediately after the acquisition is
the reserve method. Hence, the acquisition does not cause T to become a
large bank under Sec. 1.585-5(b)(2)(iii).
(c) Average total assets--(1) In general. For purposes of paragraph
(b)(1) of this section, and except as otherwise provided in paragraph
(c)(3)(ii) of this section, the average total assets of an institution
or group for any taxable year are determined by--
(i) Computing, for each report date (as defined in paragraph (c)(2)
of this section) within the taxable year, the amount of total assets (as
defined in paragraph (c)(3) of this section) held by the institution or
group as of the close of business on the report date;
(ii) Adding these amounts; and
(iii) Dividing the sum of these amounts by the number of report
dates within the taxable year.
(2) Report date--(i) Institutions--(A) In general. A report date for
an institution generally is the last day of the regular period for which
the institution must report to its primary Federal regulatory agency.
However, an institution that is required to report to its primary
Federal regulatory agency more frequently than quarterly may choose the
last day of the calendar quarter as its report date, and an institution
that is required to report to its primary Federal regulatory agency less
frequently than quarterly must choose the last day of the calendar
quarter as its report date. If an institution does not have a Federal
regulatory agency, its primary State regulatory agency is considered its
primary Federal regulatory agency for purposes of this paragraph
(c)(2)(i)(A). In the case of a short taxable year that does not
otherwise include a report date, the first or last day of the taxable
year is the institution's report date for the year.
(B) Alternative report date. In lieu of the report date prescribed
by paragraph (c)(2)(i)(A) of this section, for any taxable year an
institution may choose as its report date the last day of any regular
interval in the taxable year that is more frequent than quarterly (such
as bi-monthly, monthly, weekly, or daily).
(ii) Groups. If all members of a parent-subsidiary controlled group
have
[[Page 335]]
the same taxable year, a report date for the group is the report date,
determined under paragraph (c)(2)(i) of this section, for any one member
of the group that is an institution described in Sec. 1.585-1(b)(1) (i)
or (ii). The same report date must be used in applying paragraph
(b)(1)(ii) of this section to all members of the group for a taxable
year. If all members of a parent-subsidiary controlled group do not have
the same taxable year, a report date for the group must be determined
under similar principles.
(iii) Member of group for only part of taxable year. If an
institution is a member of a parent-subsidiary controlled group for only
part of a taxable year, paragraph (b)(1)(ii) of this section is applied
to the institution for that year on the basis of the group's average
total assets for the portion of the year that the institution is a
member of the group. Thus, only the group's report dates (as determined
under paragraph (c)(2)(ii) of this section) that are included in that
portion of the year are taken into account in determining the group's
average total assets for purposes of applying paragraph (b)(1)(ii) of
this section to the institution. If no report date of the group is
included in that portion of the year, the first or last day of that
portion of the year must be treated as the group's report date for
purposes of this paragraph (c)(2)(iii).
(3) Total assets--(i) All corporations. The amount of total assets
held by an institution or group is the amount of cash, plus the sum of
the adjusted bases of all other assets, held by the institution or
group. For this purpose, the adjusted basis of an asset generally is its
basis for Federal income tax purposes, determined under sections 1012,
1016 and other applicable sections of the Internal Revenue Code. In
determining the amount of total assets held by a group, any asset of a
member of the group that is an interest in another member of the group
is not to be counted.
(ii) Foreign corporations. In determining the amount of total assets
held by a foreign corporation, all of the corporation's assets are taken
into account, including those that are not effectively connected with
the conduct of a banking business within the United States. In the case
of a foreign corporation that is not engaged in a trade or business in
the United States, the adjusted basis of an asset must be determined
substantially in accordance with United States tax principles as
provided in regulations under section 964. In the case of a foreign
corporation that is engaged in a trade or business in the United States,
the amount of its average total assets for a taxable year (within the
meaning of paragraph (c)(1) of this section) is the amount of the
corporation's average worldwide assets used for purposes of computing
the interest expense deduction allowable under section 882 and Sec.
1.882-5 for the taxable year.
(4) Estimated adjusted tax bases--(i) In general. The amount of the
adjusted Federal income tax bases (tax bases) of assets held on a report
date may be estimated, for purposes of applying paragraph (c)(3) of this
section. This estimate must be based on the adjusted bases of the assets
on that date as determined by reference to the asset holder's books and
records maintained for financial reporting purposes (book bases). The
estimate must reflect any change in the ratio between the asset holder's
tax and book bases of assets that occurs during the taxable year, and
the estimate must assume that this change occurs ratably. If an
institution or group member estimates the tax bases of assets held on
any report date during a taxable year, it must do so for all assets
(other than cash) held on that report date, and it must do so for all
other report dates during the year. However, the tax bases of assets may
not be estimated for any report date that is the first or last day of
the taxable year or that is determined under paragraph (c)(2)(i)(B) of
this section.
(ii) Formulas. The estimated amount of the tax bases of assets held
on any report date during a taxable year is based on the following
variables: The total book bases of the assets on the report date (B);
the asset holder's tax/book ratio as of the close of the preceding
taxable year (R); and the result (whether positive or negative) obtained
when R is subtracted from the asset holder's tax/book ratio as of the
close of
[[Page 336]]
the current taxable year (Y). For purposes of determining R and Y, an
asset holder's tax/book ratio is the ratio of the total tax bases of all
of the holder's assets (other than cash), to the total book bases of
those assets. If an asset holder's taxable year is the calendar year and
its report date is the last day of the calendar quarter, its estimated
tax bases of assets held on the first three report dates of the year are
determined under the following formulas:
1st Report Date=Bx(R+\1/4\Y)
2nd Report Date=Bx(R+\1/2\Y)
3rd Report Date=Bx(R+\3/4\Y)
(5) Examples. The following examples illustrate the principles of
this paragraph (c):
Example 1. Bank U is a fiscal year taxpayer, and its fiscal year
ends on January 31. U reports to its primary Federal regulatory agency
as of the last day of the calendar quarter. U does not choose under
Sec. 1.585-5(c)(2)(i)(B) a report date more frequent than quarterly.
Thus, U's report dates under Sec. 1.585-5(c)(2)(i)(A) are March 31,
June 30, September 30, and December 31. For its taxable year beginning
on February 1, 1987, U has total assets (within the meaning of Sec.
1.585-5(c)(3)) of $480 million on March 31, $490 million on June 30,
$510 million on September 30, and $540 million on December 31. Thus,
pursuant to Sec. 1.585-5(c)(1), U's average total assets for its
taxable year beginning on February 1, 1987, are $505 million.
Example 2. Bank W is a calendar year taxpayer, and its report date
(within the meaning of Sec. 1.585-5(c)(2)(i)(A)) is the last day of the
calendar quarter. Pursuant to Sec. 1.585-5(c)(4), W chooses to estimate
the tax bases of its assets for 1990. Therefore, W must estimate the tax
bases of all of its assets (other than cash) for its first three report
dates in 1990. Since W's fourth report date (December 31) is the last
day of its taxable year, the tax bases of its assets may not be
estimated for this date. The adjusted tax bases ofall of W's assets
(other than cash) are $450z on December 31, 1989, and $480z on December
31, 1990. The book bases of those assets are $500z on December 31, 1989;
$520z on March 31, 1990; $540z on June 30, 1990; $560z on September 30,
1990; and $600z on December 31, 1990. Applying the formulas provided in
Sec. 1.585-5(c)(4)(ii), W's tax/book ratio as of the close of 1989 (R),
is 0.9 (450z/500z). W's tax/book ratio as of the close of 1990 is 0.8
(480z/600z). Thus, Y is -0.1. The estimated adjusted tax bases of all of
W's assets (other than cash) on the first three report dates of 1990 are
as follows:
[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TC14NO91.160
(d) Definitions. The following definitions apply for purposes of
this section and Sec. Sec. 1.585-6, 1.585-7 and 1.585-8:
(1) Disqualification year. A bank's disqualification year is its
first taxable year beginning after December 31, 1986, for which the bank
is a large bank within the meaning of paragraph (b) of this section.
(2) Parent-subsidiary controlled group. A parent-subsidiary
controlled group includes all of the members of a controlled group of
corporations described in section 1563(a)(1). The members of such a
group are determined without regard to whether any member is an excluded
member described in section 1563(b)(2), a foreign entity, or a
commercial bank.
(3) Example. The following example illustrates the principles of
this paragraph (d):
Example. Bank X is a large bank within the meaning of Sec. 1.585-
5(b)(1)(i). Bank Y is not a large bank under Sec. 1.585-5(b), and it
maintains a bad debt reserve under section 585. In 1988, X purchases all
of the stock of Y. If the acquisition causes Y to become a member of a
parent-subsidiary controlled group described in Sec. 1.585-5(b)(1)(ii),
Y is a large bank beginning in its first taxable year that ends after
the date of the acquisition. Pursuant to Sec. 1.585-5(d)(1), this year
is Y's disqualification year. Y must change in this year to the specific
charge-off method of accounting for bad debts, in accordance with Sec.
1.585-6 or Sec. 1.585-7.
[T.D. 8513, 58 FR 68757, Dec. 29, 1993; 59 FR 15502, Apr. 1, 1994]
Sec. 1.585-6 Recapture method of changing from the reserve method
of section 585.
(a) General rule. This section applies to any large bank (as defined
in Sec. 1.585-5(b)) that maintained a reserve for bad debts under
section 585 for the taxable
[[Page 337]]
year immediately preceding its disqualification year (as defined in
Sec. 1.585-5(d)(1)) and that does not elect the cut-off method set
forth in Sec. 1.585-7. Except as otherwise provided in paragraphs (c)
and (d) of this section, any bank to which this section applies must
include in income the amount of its net section 481(a) adjustment (as
defined in paragraph (b)(3) of this section) over the four-year period
beginning with the bank's disqualification year. If a bank follows the
rules prescribed by thissection, its change to the specific charge-off
method of accounting for bad debts in its disqualification year will be
treated as a change in accounting method that is made with the consent
of the Commissioner. Paragraph (b) of this section specifies the portion
of the net section 481(a) adjustment to be included in income in each
year of the recapture period; paragraph (c) of this section provides
rules on the effect of disposing of loans; and paragraph (d) of this
section provides rules on the suspension of recapture by financially
troubled banks.
(b) Four-year spread of net section 481(a) adjustment--(1) In
general. If a bank to which this section applies does not make the
election allowed by paragraph (b)(2) of this section, the bank must
include in income the following portions of its net section 481(a)
adjustment in each year of the four-year recapture period: 10 percent in
the bank's disqualification year; 20 percent in its first taxable year
after its disqualification year; 30 percent in its second taxable year
after its disqualification year; and 40 percent in its third taxable
year after its disqualification year.
(2) Election to include more than 10 percent in disqualification
year. A bank to which this section applies may elect to include in
income, in its disqualification year, any percentage of its net section
481(a) adjustment that is larger than 10 percent. Any such election must
be made at the time and in the manner prescribed by Sec. 1.585-8. If a
bank makes such an election, the bank must include in income the
remainder, if any, of its net section 481(a) adjustment in the following
portions: \2/9\ of the remainder in the bank's first taxable year after
its disqualification year; \1/3\ of the remainder in its second taxable
year after its disqualification year; and \4/9\ of the remainder in its
third taxable year after its disqualification year. For this purpose,
the remainder of a bank's net section 481(a) adjustment is any portion
of the adjustment that the bank does not elect to include in income in
its disqualification year.
(3) Net section 481(a) adjustment. For purposes of this section, the
amount of a bank's net section 481(a) adjustment is the amount of the
bank's reserve for bad debts as of the close of the taxable year
immediately preceding its disqualification year. Since the change from
the reserve method of section 585 is initiated by the taxpayer, the
amount of the bank's bad debt reserve for this purpose is not reduced by
amounts attributable to taxable years beginning before 1954.
(4) Examples. The following examples illustrate the principles of
this paragraph (b):
Example 1. Bank M is a large bank within the meaning of Sec. 1.585-
5(b). M's disqualification year is its taxable year beginning on January
1, 1989, and M maintained a bad debt reserve under section 585 for the
preceding taxable year. Pursuant to Sec. 1.585-5(a), M must change from
the reserve method of accounting for bad debts to the specific charge-
off method in its disqualification year. M does not elect the cut-off
method set forth in Sec. 1.585-7. Thus, M must follow the recapture
method set forth in this Sec. 1.585-6. M's net section 481(a)
adjustment, as defined in Sec. 1.585-6(b)(3), is $2 million. M does not
make the election allowed by Sec. 1.585-6(b)(2). Pursuant to Sec.
1.585-6(b)(1), M must include the following amounts in income: $200,000
in taxable year 1989; $400,000 in 1990; $600,000 in 1991; and $800,000
in 1992.
Example 2. Assume the same facts as in Example 1, except that M
elects under Sec. 1.585-6(b)(2) to recapture 55 percent of its net
section 481(a) adjustment in its disqualification year. Pursuant to
Sec. 1.585-6(b)(2), M must include the following amounts in income:
$1,100,000 in taxable year 1989; $200,000 in 1990; $300,000 in 1991; and
$400,000 in 1992.
(c) Effect of disposing of loans--(1) In general. Except as provided
in paragraphs (c)(2) and (c)(3) of this section, if a bank to which this
section applies sells or otherwise disposes of any of its outstanding
loans on or after the first day of its disqualification year, the
disposition does not affect the bank's obligation under this section to
include in
[[Page 338]]
income the amount of its net section 481(a) adjustment, and the
disposition does not affect the amount of this adjustment.
(2) Cessation of banking business--(i) In general. If a bank to
which this section applies ceases to engage in the business of banking
before it is otherwise required to include in income the full amount of
its net section 481(a) adjustment, the bank must include in income the
remaining amount of the adjustment in the taxable year in which it
ceases to engage in the business of banking. For this purpose, and
except as provided in paragraph (c)(2)(ii) of this section, whether a
bank ceases to engage in the business of banking is determined under the
principles of Sec. 1.446-1(e)(3)(ii) and its administrative procedures.
(ii) Transition rule. A bank that ceases to engage in the business
of banking as the result of a transaction to which section 381(a)
applies is not treated as ceasing to engage in the business of banking
if, on or before March 29, 1994, either the transaction occurs or the
bank enters into a binding written agreement to carry out the
transaction.
(3) Certain section 381 transactions. This paragraph (c)(3) applies
if a bank to which this section applies transfers outstanding loans to
another corporation on or after the first day of the bank's
disqualification year (and before it has included in income the full
amount of its net section 481(a) adjustment) in a transaction to which
section 381(a) applies, and under paragraph (c)(2) (i) or (ii) of this
section the transferor bank is not treated as ceasing to engage in the
business of banking as a result of the transaction. If this paragraph
(c)(3) applies, the acquiring corporation (the acquiror) steps into the
shoes of the transferor with respect to using the recapture method
prescribed by this section and assumes all of the transferor's rights
and obligations under paragraph (b) of this section. The unrecaptured
balance of the transferor's net section 481(a) adjustment carries over
in the transaction to the acquiror, and the acquiror must complete the
four-year recapture procedure begun by the transferor. In applying this
procedure, the transferor's taxable year that ends on or includes the
date of the acquisition and the acquiror's first taxable year ending
after the date of the acquisition represent two consecutive taxable
years within the four-year recapture period.
(4) Examples. The following examples illustrate the principles of
this paragraph (c):
Example 1. Bank P is a bank to which this Sec. 1.585-6 applies. P's
disqualification year is its taxable year beginning on January 1, 1989,
and P recaptures 10 percent of its net section 481(a) adjustment in that
year pursuant to Sec. 1.585-6(b)(1). In July 1990 P disposes of a
portion of its loan portfolio in a transaction to which section 381(a)
does not apply, and P continues to engage in the business of banking.
Pursuant to Sec. 1.585-6(c)(1), the disposition does not affect P's
obligation under Sec. 1.585-6(b)(1) to recapture the remainder of its
net section 481(a) adjustment in 1990, 1991 and 1992. Nor does the
disposition affect the amount of the adjustment.
Example 2. Assume the same facts as in Example 1, except that P
ceases to engage in the business of banking in 1990, as determined under
the principles of Sec. 1.446-1(e)(3)(ii) and its administrative
procedures. Pursuant to Sec. 1.585-6(c)(2)(i), in 1990 P must include
in income the remaining 90 percent of its net section 481(a) adjustment.
Example 3. Assume the same facts as in Example 1, except that P's
1990 disposition of loans is a transaction to which section 381(a)
applies, P ceases to engage in the business of banking as a result of
the transaction, and P's taxable year ends on the date of the
transaction. Thus, in the transaction, P transfers substantially all of
its loans to an acquiring corporation (Q). Q is a calendar year
taxpayer. Because the transaction occurred before March 29, 1994, the
transition rule of Sec. 1.585-6(c)(2)(ii) applies, and P is not treated
as ceasing to engage in the business of banking. Pursuant to Sec.
1.585-6(c)(3), Q steps into P's shoes with respect to using the
recapture method prescribed by Sec. 1.585-6. The unrecaptured balance
of P's net section 481(a) adjustment carries over to Q in the section
381(a) transaction, and Q must complete the four-year recapture
procedure begun by P. Pursuant to Sec. Sec. 1.585-6(b) and 1.585-
6(c)(3), P includes 20 percent of its net section 481(a) adjustment in
income in its taxable year ending on the date of the section 381(a)
transaction, and Q includes 30 percent of the adjustment in income in
1990 and 40 percent in 1991.
Example 4. Assume the same facts as in Example 3. Assume also that Q
becomes a large bank under Sec. 1.585-5(b) as a result of the
transaction and maintained a bad debt reserve immediately before the
transaction. Q
[[Page 339]]
must change to the specific charge-off method for all of its loans in
the first taxable year that it is a large bank. Thus, Q not only
completes the recapture procedure begun by P but also follows the rules
prescribed by Sec. 1.585-6 or Sec. 1.585-7 with respect to its own
reserve.
Example 5. Assume the same facts as in Example 3. Assume also that Q
is not a large bank after the transaction and properly establishes a bad
debt reserve for the loans it receives in the transaction. This
establishment of the reserve results in a new negative section 481(a)
adjustment. Thus, Q not only completes the recapture procedure begun by
P but also takes into account the new negative adjustment as required
under section 381.
(d) Suspension of recapture by financially troubled banks--(1) In
general. Except as provided in paragraph (d)(2) of this section, a bank
that is financially troubled (within the meaning of paragraph (d)(3) of
this section) for any taxable year must not include any amount in income
under paragraphs (a) and (b) of this section for that taxable year and
must disregard that taxable year in applying paragraphs (a) and (b) of
this section to other taxable years. See paragraph (d)(4) of this
section for rules on determining estimated tax payments of financially
troubled banks, and see paragraph (d)(5) of this section for examples
illustrating this paragraph (d).
(2) Election to recapture. A bank that is financially troubled
(within the meaning of paragraph (d)(3) of this section) for its
disqualification year may elect to include in income, in one taxable
year, any percentage of its net section 481(a) adjustment that is
greater than 10 percent. This election may be made for the bank's
disqualification year, for the first taxable year after the
disqualification year in which the bank is not financially troubled
(within the meaning of paragraph (d)(3) of this section), or for any
intervening taxable year. Any such election must be made at the time and
in the manner prescribed by Sec. 1.585-8. A bank that makes this
election must include an amount in income under paragraphs (a) and (b)
of this section in the year for which the election is made (election
year) and must not disregard this year in applying paragraphs (a) and
(b) of this section to other taxable years. Such a bank must follow the
rules of paragraph (b)(2) of this section in applying paragraph (b) of
this section to later taxable years, treating the election year as the
disqualification year for purposes of applying paragraph (b)(2) of this
section. However, if the bank is financially troubled for any year after
its election year, the bank must not include any amount in income under
paragraphs (a) and (b) of this section for the later year and must
disregard the later year in applying paragraphs (a) and (b) of this
section to other taxable years.
(3) Definition of financially troubled--(i) In general. For purposes
of this section, a bank is considered financially troubled for any
taxable year if the bank's nonperforming loan percentage for that year
exceeds 75 percent. For this purpose, a bank's nonperforming loan
percentage is the percentage determined by dividing the sum of the
outstanding balances of the bank's nonperforming loans (as defined in
paragraph (d)(3)(iii) of this section) as of the close of each quarter
of the taxable year, by the sum of the amounts of the bank's equity (as
defined in paragraph (d)(3)(iv) of this section) as of the close of each
such quarter. The quarters for a short taxable year of at least 3 months
are the same as those of the bank's annual accounting period, except
that quarters ending before or after the short year are disregarded. If
a taxable year consists of less than 3 months, the first or last day of
the taxable year is treated as the last day of its only quarter. In lieu
of determining its nonperforming loan percentageon the basis of loans
and equity as of the close of each quarter of the taxable year, a bank
may, for all years, determine this percentage on the basis of loans and
equity as of the close of each report date (as defined in Sec. 1.585-
5(c)(2), without regard to Sec. 1.585-5(c)(2)(i)(B)). In the case of a
bank that is a foreign corporation, all nonperforming loans and equity
of the bank are taken into account, including loans and equity that are
not effectively connected with the conduct of a banking business within
the United States.
(ii) Parent-subsidiary controlled groups--(A) In general. If a bank
is a member of a parent-subsidiary controlled group (as defined in Sec.
1.585-
[[Page 340]]
5(d)(2)) for the taxable year, the nonperforming loans and the equity of
all members of the bank's financial group (as determined under paragraph
(d)(3)(ii)(B) of this section) are treated as the nonperforming loans
and the equity of the bank for purposes of paragraph (d)(3)(i) of this
section. However, any equity interest that a member of a bank's
financial group holds in another member of this group is not to be
counted in determining equity. Similarly, any loan that a member of a
bank's financial group makes to another member of the group is not to be
counted in determining nonperforming loans. All banks that are members
of the same parent-subsidiary controlled group must (for all taxable
years that they are members of this group) determine their nonperforming
loan percentage on the basis of the close of each quarter of the taxable
year, or all must (for all such taxable years) determine this percentage
on the basis of the close of each report date (as determined under Sec.
1.585-5(c)(2)(ii), applied without regard to Sec. 1.585-5(c)(2)(i)(B)).
(B) Financial group--(1) In general. All banks that are members of
the same parent-subsidiary controlled group must (for all taxable years
that they are members of this group) determine their financial group
under paragraph (d)(3)(ii)(B)(2) of this section, or all must (for all
such taxable years) determine their financial group under paragraph
(d)(3)(ii)(B)(3) of this section.
(2) Financial institution members of parent-subsidiary controlled
group. A bank's financial group, determined under this paragraph
(d)(3)(ii)(B)(2), consists of all financial institutions within the
meaning of section 265(b)(5) (and comparable foreign financial
institutions) that are members of the parent-subsidiary controlled group
of which the bank is a member.
(3) All members of parent-subsidiary controlled group. A bank's
financial group, determined under this paragraph (d)(3)(ii)(B)(3),
consists of all members of the parent-subsidiary controlled group of
which the bank is a member.
(iii) Nonperforming loan--(A) In general. For purposes of this
section, a nonperforming loan is any loan (as defined in paragraph
(d)(3)(iii)(B) of this section) that is considered to be nonperforming
by the holder's primary Federal regulatory agency. Nonperforming loans
include the following types of loans as defined by the Federal Financial
Institutions Examination Council: Loans that are past due 90 days or
more and still accruing; loans that are in nonaccrual status; and loans
that are restructured troubled debt. A loan is not considered to be
nonperforming merely because it is past due, if it is past due less than
90 days. The outstanding balances of nonperforming loans are determined
on the basis of amounts that are required to be reported to the holder's
primary Federal regulatory agency. For purposes of this paragraph
(d)(3)(iii)(A), a holder that does not have a Federal regulatory agency
is treated as Federally regulated under the standards prescribed by the
Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council.
(B) Loan. For purposes of paragraph (d)(3)(iii)(A) of this section,
a loan is any extension of credit that is defined and treated as a loan
under the standards prescribed by the Federal Financial Institutions
Examination Council. (Accordingly, a troubled debt restructuring that is
in substance a foreclosure or repossession is not considered a loan.) In
addition, a debt evidenced by a security issued by a foreign government
is treated as a loan if the security is issued as an integral part of a
restructuring of one or more troubled loans to the foreign government
(or an agency or instrumentality thereof). Similarly, a deposit with the
central bank of a foreign country is treated as a loan if the deposit is
made under a deposit facility agreement that is entered into as an
integral part of a restructuring of one or more troubled loans to the
foreign country's government (or an agency or instrumentality thereof).
(iv) Equity. For purposes of this section, the equity of a bank or
other financial institution is its equity (i.e., assets minus
liabilities) as required to be reported to the institution's primary
Federal regulatory agency (or, if the institution does not have a
Federal regulatory agency, as required under the standards prescribed by
the Federal Financial Institutions Examination
[[Page 341]]
Council). The balance in a reserve for bad debts is not treated as
equity.
(4) Estimated tax payments of financially troubled banks. For
purposes of applying section 6655(e)(2)(A)(i) with respect to any
installment of estimated tax, a bank that is financially troubled as of
the due date of the installment is treated as if no amount will be
included in income under paragraphs (a) and (b) of this section for the
taxable year. For this purpose, a bank is considered financially
troubled as of the due date of an installment of estimated tax only if
its nonperforming loan percentage (computed under paragraph (d)(3) of
this section) would exceed 75 percent for a short taxable year ending on
that date. For purposes of computing this nonperforming loan percentage,
the ending of such a short taxable year would not cause the last day of
that year to be treated as the last day of a quarter of the taxable
year.
(5) Examples. The following examples illustrate the principles of
this paragraph (d):
Example 1. Bank R is a bank to which this Sec. 1.585-6 applies. R's
disqualification year is its taxable year beginning on January 1, 1987.
R is not financially troubled (within the meaning of Sec. 1.585-
6(d)(3)) for taxable year 1987 or for any taxable year after 1989, but
it is financially troubled for taxable years 1988 and 1989. Since R is
not financially troubled for its disqualification year, R must include
an amount in income under Sec. 1.585-6 (a) and (b) for that year
(taxable year 1987). R may make the election allowed by Sec. 1.585-
6(b)(2) for that year. Since R is financially troubled for taxable years
1988 and 1989, pursuant to Sec. 1.585-6(d)(1) R does not include any
amount in income under Sec. 1.585-6 (a) and (b) for these years, and it
treats taxable years 1990, 1991 and 1992 as the first, second and third
taxable years after its disqualification year for purposes of applying
Sec. 1.585-6 (a) and (b).
Example 2. Assume the same facts as in Example 1, except that R is
financially troubled for taxable year 1987 (its disqualification year).
R may make the election allowed by Sec. 1.585-6(d)(2) for 1987 (the
disqualification year), for 1990 (the first year after the
disqualification year in which R is not financially troubled), or for
1988 or 1989 (the intervening years). R elects to include 60 percent of
its net section 481(a) adjustment in income in 1987. Thus, the remainder
of the adjustment, for purposes of applying the rules of Sec. 1.585-
6(b)(2), is 40 percent. R must include in income \2/9\ of the remainder
in 1990, \1/3\ of the remainder in 1991, and \4/9\ of the remainder in
1992.
Example 3. Bank S, which is not a member of a parent-subsidiary
controlled group, is a bank to which this Sec. 1.585-6 applies. S's
disqualification year is its taxable year beginning on January 1, 1987.
S determines its nonperforming loan percentage under Sec. 1.585-6(d)(3)
on a quarterly basis. S is not financially troubled for taxable year
1987 and includes 10 percent of its net section 481(a) adjustment in
income in that year. S's outstanding balance of nonperforming loans (as
defined in Sec. 1.585-6(d)(3)(iii)) is $80 million on March 31, 1988;
$68 million on June 30, 1988; and $59 million on September 30, 1988. The
amount of S's equity (as defined in Sec. 1.585-6(d)(3)(iv)) is $100
million on each of these threedates. Thus, S's nonperforming loan
percentage, computed under Sec. 1.585-6(d)(3), would be 80 percent (80/
100) for a short taxable year ending on April 15 or June 15, 74 percent
[(80+68) / 200] for a short taxable year ending on September 15, and 69
percent [(80+68+59) / 300] for a short taxable year ending on December
15. Since S's nonperforming loan percentage for a short taxable year
ending on April 15 or June 15 would exceed 75 percent, pursuant to Sec.
1.585-6(d)(4) S is considered financially troubled as of these dates.
Thus, S is treated as if no amount will be included in income under
Sec. 1.585-6 (a) and (b) for the year for purposes of applying section
6655(e)(2)(A)(i) with respect to the installments of estimated tax that
are due on April 15, 1988, and June 15, 1988. However, since S's
nonperforming loan percentage for a short taxable year ending on
September 15 or December 15 would not exceed 75 percent, S is not
considered financially troubled as of these dates. Thus, S is treated as
if 20 percent of its net section 481(a) adjustment will be included in
income under Sec. 1.585-6 (a) and (b) for the year for purposes of
applying section 6655(e)(2)(A)(i) with respect to the installments of
estimated tax that are due on September 15, 1988, and December 15, 1988.
[T.D. 8513, 58 FR 68760, Dec. 29, 1993; 59 FR 15502, Apr. 1, 1994]
Sec. 1.585-7 Elective cut-off method of changing from the reserve
method of section 585.
(a) General rule. Any large bank (as defined in Sec. 1.585-5(b))
that maintained a reserve for bad debts under section 585 for the
taxable year immediately preceding its disqualification year (as defined
in Sec. 1.585-5(d)(1)) may elect to use the cut-off method set forth in
this section. Any such election must be made at the time and in the
manner prescribed by Sec. 1.585-8. If a bank makes this election, the
bank must maintain its bad debt reserve for its pre- disqualification
loans, as prescribed in
[[Page 342]]
paragraph (b) of this section, and the bank must include in income any
excess balance in this reserve, as required by paragraph (c) of this
section. The bank may not deduct, for its disqualification year or any
subsequent taxable year, any amount allowed under section 166(a) for
pre-disqualification loans (as defined in paragraph (b)(2) of this
section) that become worthless in whole or in part, except as allowed by
paragraph (b)(1) of this section. However, except as provided in
paragraph (d)(3) of this section, the bank may deduct, for its
disqualification year or any subsequent taxable year, amounts allowed
under section 166(a) for loans that the bank originates or acquires on
or after the first day of its disqualification year and that become
worthless in whole or in part. If a bank makes the election allowed by
this paragraph (a), its change to the specific charge-off method of
accounting for bad debts in its disqualification year does not give rise
to a section 481(a) adjustment.
(b) Maintaining reserve for pre-disqualification loans--(1) In
general. A bank that makes the election allowed by paragraph (a) of this
section must maintain its bad debt reserve for its pre-disqualification
loans (as defined in paragraph (b)(2) of this section). Except as
provided in paragraph (d)(3) of this section, the bank must charge
against the reserve the amount of any losses resulting from these loans
(including losses resulting from the sale or other disposition of these
loans), and the bank must add to the reserve the amount of recoveries
with respect to these loans. In general, the reserve must be maintained
in the manner provided by former section 166(c) of the Internal Revenue
Code and the regulations thereunder. However, after the balance in the
reserve is reduced to zero, the bank is to account for any losses and
recoveries with respect to outstanding pre-disqualification loans under
the specific charge-off method of accounting for bad debts, as if the
bank always had accounted for these loans under this method.
(2) Definition of pre-disqualification loans. For purposes of this
section, a pre-disqualification loan of a bank is any loan that the bank
held on the last day of its taxable year immediately preceding its
disqualification year (as defined in Sec. 1.585-5(d)(1)). If the amount
of a pre-disqualification loan is increased during or after the
disqualification year, the amount of the increase is not treated as a
pre-disqualification loan.
(c) Amount to be included in income when reserve balance exceeds
loan balance. If, as of the close of any taxable year, the balance in a
bank's reserve that is maintained under paragraph (b) of this section
exceeds the balance of the bank's outstanding pre-disqualification
loans, the bank must include in income the amount of the excess for the
taxable year. The balance in the reserve is then reduced by the amount
of this excess. See paragraph (d) of this section for rules on the
application of this paragraph (c) when a bank disposes of loans.
(d) Effect of disposing of loans--(1) In general. Except as provided
in paragraphs (d)(2) and (d)(3) of this section, if a bank that makes
the election allowed by paragraph (a) of this section sells or otherwise
disposes of any of its outstanding pre-disqualification loans, the bank
is to reduce the balance of its outstanding pre-disqualification loans
by the amount of the loans disposed of, for purposes of applying
paragraph (c) of this section.
(2) Section 381 transactions. If a bank that makes the election
allowed by paragraph (a) of this section transfers outstanding pre-
disqualification loans to another corporation in a transaction to which
section 381(a) applies, the acquiring corporation (the acquiror) must
follow the rules of paragraph (d)(2)(i) or (ii) of this section.
(i) Acquiror completes cut-off method of change. Except as provided
in paragraph (d)(2)(ii) of this section, the acquiror steps into the
shoes of the transferor in the section 381(a) transaction with respect
to using the cut-off method of change. Thus, the transferor's bad debt
reserve immediately before the section 381(a) transaction carries over
to the acquiror, and the acquiror must complete the cut-off method begun
by the transferor. For purposes of completing the transferor's cut-off
method, the acquiror's balance of outstanding pre-disqualification loans
immediately after the section
[[Page 343]]
381(a) transaction is the balance of these loans that it receives in the
transaction, and the acquiror assumes all of the transferor's rights and
obligations under this section.
(ii) Acquiror uses reserve method. If the acquiror is not a large
bank (within the meaning of Sec. 1.585-5(b)) immediately after the
section 381(a) transaction and uses a reserve method of accounting for
bad debts attributable to the pre-disqualification loans (and any other
loans) received in the transaction, the acquiror does not step into the
shoes of the transferor with respect to using the cut-off method of
change. The transferor's bad debt reserve immediately before the section
381(a) transaction carries over to the acquiror, but the acquiror does
not continue the cut-off method begun by the transferor. If the six-year
moving average amount (as defined in Sec. 1.585-2(c)(1)(ii)) for all of
the loans received in the transaction exceeds the balance of the reserve
that carries over to the acquiror, the acquiror increases this balance
by the amount of the excess. Any such increase in the reserve results in
a negative section 481(a) adjustment that is taken into account as
required under section 381.
(3) Dispositions intended to change the status of pre-
disqualification loans. This paragraph (d)(3) applies if a bank that
makes the election allowed by paragraph (a) of this section sells,
exchanges, or otherwise disposes of a significant amount of its pre-
disqualification loans (as defined in paragraph (b)(2) of this section)
and a principal purpose of the transaction is to avoid the provisions of
this section by increasing the amount of loans for which deductions are
allowable under the specific charge-off method. If this paragraph (d)(3)
applies, the District Director may disregard the disposition for
purposes of paragraphs (b)(1) and (d)(1) of this section or treat the
replacement loans as pre-disqualification loans. If loans are so treated
as pre-disqualification loans, no deductions are allowable under the
specific charge-off method for the loans, except as provided in
paragraph (b)(1) of this section, and the disposition that causes the
loans to be so treated may be disregarded for purposes of paragraphs
(b)(1) and (d)(1) of this section. If a bank sells pre-disqualification
loans and uses the proceeds of the sale to originate new loans, this
paragraph (d)(3) does not apply to the transaction.
(e) Examples. The following examples illustrate the principles of
this section:
Example 1. Bank M is a bank that properly elects to use the cut-off
method set forth in this Sec. 1.585-7. M's disqualification year is its
taxable year beginning on January 1, 1987. On December 31, 1986, M had
outstanding loans of $700 million (pre-disqualification loans), and the
balance in its bad debt reserve was $10 million. M must maintain its
reserve for its pre-disqualification loans in accordance with Sec.
1.585-7(b), and it may not deduct any addition to this reserve for
taxable year 1987 or any later year. For these years, M may deduct
amounts allowed under section 166(a) for loans that it originates or
acquires after December 31, 1986, and that become worthless in whole or
in part.
Example 2. Assume the same facts as in Example 1. Also assume that
in 1987 M collects $150 million of its pre- disqualification loans, M
determines that $2 million of its pre-disqualification loans are
worthless, and M recovers $1 million of pre-disqualification loans that
it had previously charged against the reserve as worthless. On December
31, 1987, the balance in M's bad debt reserve is $9 million ($10 million
- $2 million + $1 million), and the balance of its outstanding pre-
disqualification loans is $548 million ($700 million - $150 million - $2
million).
Example 3. Assume the same facts as in Examples 1 and 2. Also assume
that on December 31, 1990, the balance in M's bad debt reserve is $5
million and the balance of its outstanding pre-disqualification loans is
$25 million. In 1991 M collects $21 million of its outstanding pre-
disqualification loans and determines that $1 million of its outstanding
pre-disqualification loans are worthless. Thus, on December 31, 1991,
the balance in M's bad debt reserve is $4 million ($5 million - $1
million), and the balance of its outstanding pre-disqualification loans
is $3 million ($25 million - $21 million - $1 million). Accordingly, M
must include $1 million ($4 million - $3 million) in income in taxable
year 1991, pursuant to Sec. 1.585-7(c). On January 1, 1992, the balance
in M's reserve is $3 million ($4 million - $1 million).
Example 4. Assume the same facts as in Examples 1 through 3. Also
assume that in 1992 M transfers substantially all of its assets to
another corporation (N) in a transaction to which section 381(a)
applies, and N is treated as a large bank under Sec. 1.585-5(b)(2) for
taxable years ending after the date of the transaction. Pursuant to
Sec. 1.585-7(d)(2)(i), N steps into M's shoes with respect to using the
cut-
[[Page 344]]
off method. M's bad debt reserve immediately before the section 381(a)
transaction carries over to N, and N must complete the cut-off procedure
begun by M. For this purpose, N's balance of outstanding pre-
disqualification loans immediately after the section 381(a) transaction
is the balance of these loans that it receives from M.
Example 5. Assume the same facts as in Examples 1 through 4, except
that N is not treated as a large bank after the section 381(a)
transaction. Also assume that N uses the reserve method of section 585
and plans to use this method for all of the loans it acquires from M
(including loans that were not pre-disqualification loans). Pursuant to
Sec. 1.585-7(d)(2)(ii), M's bad debt reserve immediately before the
section 381(a) transaction carries over to N in the transaction;
however, N does not continue the cut-off procedure begun by M and does
not treat any loan as a pre-disqualification loan. If the six-year
moving average amount (as defined in Sec. 1.585-2(c)(1)(ii)) for all of
N's newly acquired loans exceeds the balance of the reserve that carries
over to N, N increases this balance by the amount of the excess. Any
such increase in the reserve results in a negative section 481(a)
adjustment that is taken into account as required under section 381.
[T.D. 8513, 58 FR 68762, Dec. 29, 1993; 59 FR 15502, Apr. 1, 1994]
Sec. 1.585-8 Rules for making and revoking elections under Sec.
Sec. 1.585-6 and 1.585-7.
(a) Time of making elections--(1) In general. Any election under
Sec. 1.585-6(b)(2), Sec. 1.585-6(d)(2) or Sec. 1.585-7(a) must be
made on or before the later of--
(i) February 28, 1994; or
(ii) The due date (taking extensions into account) of the electing
bank's original tax return for its disqualification year (as defined in
Sec. 1.585-5(d)(1)) or, for elections under Sec. 1.585-6(d)(2), the
year for which the election is made.
(2) No extension of time for payment. Payments of tax due must be
made in accordance with chapter 62 of the Internal Revenue Code.
However, if an election under Sec. 1.585-6(b)(2), Sec. 1.585-6(d)(2)
or Sec. 1.585-7(a) is made or revoked on or before February 28, 1994
and the making or revoking of the election results in an underpayment of
estimated tax (within the meaning of section 6655(a)) with respect to an
installment of estimated tax due on or before the date the election was
so made or revoked, no addition to tax will be imposed under section
6655(a) with respect to the amount of the underpayment attributable to
the making or revoking of the election.
(b) Manner of making elections--(1) In general. Except as provided
in paragraph (b)(2) of this section, an electing bank must make any
election under Sec. 1.585-6(b)(2), Sec. 1.585-6(d)(2) or Sec. 1.585-
7(a) by attaching a statement to its tax return (or amended return) for
its disqualification year or, for elections under Sec. 1.585-6(d)(2),
the year for which the election is made. This statement must contain the
following information:
(i) The name, address and taxpayer identification number of the
electing bank;
(ii) The nature of the election being made (i.e., whether the
election is to include in income more than 10 percent of the bank's net
section 481(a) adjustment under Sec. 1.585-6 (b)(2) or (d)(2) or to use
the cut-off method under Sec. 1.585-7); and
(iii) If the election is under Sec. 1.585-6(b)(2) or (d)(2), the
percentage being elected.
(2) Certain tax returns filed before December 29, 1993. A bank is
deemed to have made an election under Sec. 1.585-6(b)(2) or (d)(2) if
the bank evidences its intent to make an election under section
585(c)(3)(A)(iii)(I) or section 585(c)(3)(B)(ii) for its
disqualification year (or, for elections under Sec. 1.585-6(d)(2), the
election year), by designating a specific recapture amount on its tax
return or amended return for that year (or attaching a statement in
accordance with Sec. 301.9100-7T(a)(3)(i) of this chapter), and the
return is filed before December 29, 1993. A bank is deemed to have made
an election under Sec. 1.585-7(a) if the bank evidences its intent to
make an election under section 585(c)(4) for its disqualification year
by attaching a statement in accordance with Sec. 301.9100-7T(a)(3)(i)
of this chapter to its tax return or amended return for that year, and
the return is filed before December 29, 1993.
(c) Revocation of elections--(1) On or before final date for making
election. An election under Sec. 1.585-6(b)(2), Sec. 1.585-6(d)(2) or
Sec. 1.585-7(a) may be revoked
[[Page 345]]
without the consent of the Commissioner on or before the final date
prescribed by paragraph (a)(1) of this section for making the election.
To do so, the bank that made the election must file an amended tax
return for its disqualification year (or, for elections under Sec.
1.585-6(d)(2), the year for which the election was made) and attach a
statement that--
(i) Includes the bank's name, address and taxpayer identification
number;
(ii) Identifies and withdraws the previous election; and
(iii) If the bank is making a new election under Sec. 1.585-
6(b)(2), Sec. 1.585-6(d)(2) or Sec. 1.585-7(a), contains the
information described in paragraphs (b)(1)(ii) and (b)(1)(iii) of this
section.
(2) After final date for making election. An election under Sec.
1.585-6(b)(2), Sec. 1.585-6(d)(2) or Sec. 1.585-7(a) may be revoked
only with the consent of the Commissioner after the final date
prescribed by paragraph (a)(1) of this section for making the election.
The Commissioner will grant this consent only in extraordinary
circumstances.
(d) Elections by banks that are members of parent-subsidiary
controlled groups. In the case of a bank that is a member of a parent-
subsidiary controlled group (as defined in Sec. 1.585-5(d)(2)), any
election under Sec. 1.585-6(b)(2), Sec. 1.585-6(d)(2) or Sec. 1.585-
7(a) with respect to the bank is to be made separately by the bank. An
election made by one member of such a group is not binding on any other
member of the group.
(e) Elections made or revoked by amended return on or before
February 28, 1994. This paragraph (e) applies to any election that a
bank seeks to make under paragraph (b) of this section, or revoke under
paragraph (c) of this section, by means of an amended return that is
filed on or before February 28, 1994. To make or revoke an election to
which this paragraph (e) applies, a bank must file (before expiration of
each applicable period of limitations under section 6501) this amended
return and amended returns for all taxable years after the taxable year
for which the election is made or revoked by amended return, to any
extent necessary to report the bank's tax liability in a manner
consistent with the making or revoking of the election by amended
return.
[T.D. 8513, 58 FR 68764, Dec. 29, 1993; 59 FR 4583, Feb. 1, 1994; 59 FR
15502, Apr. 1, 1994]
Sec. 1.586-1 Reserve for losses on loans of small business investment
companies, etc.
(a) General rule. As an alternative to a deduction from gross income
under section 166(a) for specific debts which become worthless in whole
or in part, a taxpayer which is a financial institution to which section
586 and this section apply is allowed a deduction under section 166(c)
for a reasonable addition to a reserve for bad debts provided such
financial institution has adopted or adopts the reserve method of
treating bad debts in accordance with paragraph (b) of Sec. 1.166-1. In
the case of such a taxpayer, the amount of the reasonable addition to
such reserve for a taxable year beginning after July 11, 1969, shall be
an amount determined by the taxpayer which does not exceed the amount
computed under Sec. 1.586-2. A financial institution to which section
586 and this section apply which adopts the reserve method is not
entitled to charge-off any bad debts pursuant to section 166(a) with
respect to a loan (as defined in Sec. 1.586-2(c)(2)). Except as
provided by Sec. 1.586-2, regarding the manner of computation of the
addition to the reserve for bad debts, the reserve for bad debts of a
financial institution to which this section applies shall be maintained
in the same manner as is provided by section 166(c) and the regulations
thereunder with respect to reserves for bad debts. Except as provided by
this section, no deduction is allowable for an addition to a reserve for
bad debts of a financial institution to which section 586 and this
section apply. For rules relating to deduction with respect to debts
which are not loans (as defined in Sec. 1.586-2(c)(2)), see section
166(a) and the regulations thereunder.
(b) Application of section. Section 586 and this section shall apply
only to the following financial institutions:
(1) Any small business investment company operating under the Small
Business Investment Act of 1958 as amended and supplemented (72 Stat.
689), and
[[Page 346]]
(2) Any business development corporation, which for purposes of this
section, means a corporation which was created by or pursuant to an act
of a State legislature for purposes of promoting, maintaining, and
assisting the economy and industry within such State on a regional or
statewide basis by making loans which would generally not be made by
banks (as defined in section 581 and the regulations thereunder) within
such region or State in the ordinary course of their businesses (except
on the basis of a partial participation), and which is operated
primarily for such purposes.
[T.D. 7444, 41 FR 53482, Dec. 7, 1976]
Sec. 1.586-2 Addition to reserve.
(a) General rule. Except as provided by paragraph (b) of this
section, the amount computed under this section is the amount necessary
to increase the balance of the reserve for bad debts (as of the close of
the taxable year) to the greater of:
(1) The amount which bears the same ratio to loans outstanding at
the close of the taxable year as (i) the total bad debts sustained
during the taxable year and the 5 preceding taxable years (or, with the
approval of the Commissioner, a shorter period), adjusted for recoveries
of bad debts during such period, bears to (ii) the sum of the loans
outstanding at the close of such 6 or fewer taxable years, or
(2) The lower of:
(i) The balance of the reserve as of the close of the base year, or
(ii) If the amount of loans outstanding at the close of the taxable
year is less than the amount of loans outstanding at the close of the
base year, the amount which bears the same ratio to loans outstanding at
the close of the taxable year as the balance of the reserve as of the
close of the base year bears to the amount of loans outstanding at the
close of the base year.
For purposes of subparagraph (2) of this paragraph, the term base year
means the last taxable year beginning on or before July 11, 1969. For
purposes of applying this paragraph, a period shorter than the 6 years
generally would be appropriate only where there is a change in the type
of a substantial portion of the loans outstanding such that the risk of
loss is substantially increased. For example, if the major portion of a
business development corporation's portfolio of loans changes from
agricultural loans to industrial loans which results in a substantial
increase in the risk of loss, a period shorter than the 6 years may be
appropriate. If approval is granted to use a shorter period, the
experience for those taxable years which are excluded shall not be used
for any subsequent year. A request for approval to exclude the
experience of a prior taxable year shall not be considered unless it is
sent to the Commissioner at least 30 days before the close of the
current taxable year. The request shall include a statement of the
reasons such experience should be excluded.
(b) New financial institutions--(1) Small business investment
companies. In the case of a new financial institution which is a small
business investment company to which section 586 applies, the amount
computed under this section is the greater of the amount computed under
paragraph (a) of this section or the amount necessary to increase the
balance of the reserve for bad debts as of the close of the taxable year
to the amount which bears the same ratio to loans outstanding at the
close of the taxable year as:
(i) The total bad debts (as determined by the Commissioner)
sustained by all such small business investment companies during the 12-
month period ending on March 31 that ends with or within the taxpayer's
previous taxable year, and during the five 12-month periods ending on
March 31 that precede such 12-month period, adjusted for recoveries of
bad debts during such periods (as determined by the Commissioner), bears
to
(ii) The sum of the loans outstanding (as determined by the
Commissioner) by all such small business investment companies at the
close of each of such six 12-month periods ending on March 31.
(2) Business development corporations. In the case of a new
financial institution which is a business development corporation to
which section 586 applies, the amount computed under this section is the
greater of the amount
[[Page 347]]
computed under paragraph (a) of this section or the amount necessary to
increase the balance of the reserve for bad debts as of the close of the
taxable year to the amount which bears the same ratio to loans
outstanding at the close of the taxable year as:
(i) The total bad debts (as determined by the Commissioner)
sustained by all such business development corporations during the
calendar year ending with or within the taxpayer's previous taxable year
and during the 5 calendar years preceding such calendar year, adjusted
for recoveries of bad debts during such period (as determined by the
Commissioner), bears to
(ii) The sum of the loans outstanding (as determined by the
Commissioner) by all such business development corporations at the close
of each of such 6 calendar years.
(c) Definitions. For purposes of this section:
(1) New financial institution. A financial institution is a new
financial institution for any taxable year beginning less than 10 years
after the day on which it (or any predecessor) was authorized to do
business as a financial institution described in the applicable
subparagraph of Sec. 1.586-1(b). For this purpose, the term predecessor
means (i) any taxpayer which transferred more than 50 percent of the
total amount of its assets to the taxpayer and is described in the same
subparagraph of Sec. 1.586-1(b) which describes the taxpayer, or (ii)
any predecessor of such predecessor.
(2) Loan. (i) The term loan means debt, as the term debt is used in
section 166 and the regulations there-under.
(ii) The term loan does not include the following items:
(A) Discount or interest receivable reflected in the face amount of
an outstanding loan, which discount or interest has not been included in
gross income;
(B) A debt evidenced by a security (as defined in section
165(g)(2)(C) and the regulations thereunder); and
(C) Any loan which is entered into or acquired for the primary
purpose of enlarging the otherwise available bad debt deduction.
[T.D. 7444, 41 FR 53482, Dec. 7, 1976]
Mutual Savings Banks, Etc.
Sec. 1.591-1 Deduction for dividends paid on deposits.
(a) In general. (1) In the case of a taxpayer described in paragraph
(c)(1) or (2) of this section, whichever is applicable, there are
allowed as deductions from gross income amounts which during the taxable
year are paid to, or credited to the accounts of, depositors or holders
of accounts as dividends or interest on their deposits or withdrawable
accounts, if such amounts paid or credited are withdrawable on demand
subject only to customary notice of intention to withdraw.
(2) The deduction provided in section 591 is applicable to the
taxable year in which amounts credited as dividends or interest become
withdrawable by the depositor or holder of an account subject only to
customary notice of intention to withdraw. Thus, amounts which, as of
the last day of the taxable year, are credited as dividends or interest,
but which are not withdrawable by depositors or holders of accounts
until the following business day, are deductible under section 591 in
the year subsequent to the taxable year in which they were so credited.
A deduction under this section will not be denied by reason of the fact
that the amounts credited as dividends or interest, otherwise deductible
under section 591, are subject to the terms of a pledge agreement
between the taxpayer and the depositor or holder of an account. In the
case of a domestic building and loan association having nonwithdrawable
capital stock represented by shares, no deduction is allowable under
this section for amounts paid or credited as dividends on such shares.
In the case of a taxable year ending after December 31, 1962, for
special rules governing the treatment of dividends or interest paid or
credited for periods representing more than 12 months, see section
461(e).
(b) Serial associations, bonus plans, etc. If a taxpayer described
in paragraph (c)(1) or (2) of this section, whichever is applicable,
operates in whole or in part as a serial association, maintains a bonus
plan, or issues shares, or accepts deposits, subject to fines,
penalties,
[[Page 348]]
forfeitures, or other withdrawal fees, it may deduct under section 591
the total amount credited as dividends or interest upon such shares or
deposits, credited to a bonus account for such shares or deposits, or
allocated to a series of shares for the taxable year, notwithstanding
that as a customary condition of withdrawal:
(1) Amounts invested in, and earnings credited to, series shares
must be withdrawn in multiples of even shares, or
(2) Such taxpayer has the right, pursuant to bylaw, contract, or
otherwise, to retain or recover a portion of the total amount invested
in, or credited as earnings upon, such shares or deposits, such bonus
account, or series of shares, as a fine, penalty, forfeiture, or other
withdrawal fee
In any taxable year in which the right referred to in subparagraph (2)
of this paragraph is exercised, there is includible in the gross income
of such taxpayer for such taxable year amounts retained or recovered by
the taxpayer pursuant to the exercise of such right. If the provisions
of paragraph (a) of Sec. 1.163-4 (relating to deductions for original
issue discount) apply to deposits made with respect to a certificate of
deposit, time deposit, bonus plan or other deposit arrangement, the
provisions of this paragraph shall not apply.
(c) Effective date. The provisions of paragraphs (a) and (b) of this
section shall apply to:
(1) Dividends or interest paid or credited after October 16, 1962,
by any taxpayer which (at the time of such payment or credit) qualifies
as (i) a mutual savings bank not having capital stock represented by
shares, (ii) a domestic building and loan association (as defined in
section 7701(a)(19)), (iii) a cooperative bank (as defined in section
7701(a)(32)), or (iv) any other savings institution chartered and
supervised as a savings and loan or similar association under Federal or
State law; and
(2) Dividends paid or credited before October 17, 1962, by any
taxpayer which (at the time of such payment or credit) qualifies as (i)
a mutual savings bank not having capital stock represented by shares,
(ii) a cooperative bank without capital stock organized and operated for
mutual purposes and without profit, or (iii) a domestic building and
loan association (as defined in section 7701(a)(19) before amendment by
section 6(c) of the Revenue Act of 1962 (76 Stat. 982)).
[T.D. 6728, 29 FR 5855, May 5, 1964, as amended by T.D. 7154, 36 FR
24997, Dec. 28, 1971]
Sec. 1.592-1 Repayment of certain loans by mutual savings banks,
building and loan associations, and cooperative banks.
There is deductible, under section 592, from the gross income of a
mutual savings bank not having capital stock represented by shares, a
domestic building and loan association, or a cooperative bank without
capital stock organized and operated for mutual purposes and without
profit, amounts paid by such institutions during the taxable year in
repayment of loans made before September 1, 1951, by the United States
or any agency or instrumentality thereof which is wholly owned by the
United States, or by any mutual fund established under the authority of
the laws of any State. For example, amounts paid by such institution in
repayment of loans made by the Reconstruction Finance Corporation before
September 1, 1951, are deductible under this section. Section 592 is not
applicable, however, in the case of amounts paid in repayment of loans
made by an agency or instrumentality not wholly owned by the United
States.
Sec. 1.593-1 Additions to reserve for bad debts.
(a) In general. A mutual savings bank not having capital stock
represented by shares, a domestic building and loan association, and a
cooperative bank without capital stock organized and operated for mutual
purposes and without profit may, as an alternative to a deduction from
gross income under section 166(a) for specific debts which become
worthless in whole or in part, deduct amounts credited to a reserve for
bad debts in the manner and under the circumstances prescribed in this
section and Sec. 1.593-2. In the case of such an institution, the
selection of either of the alternative methods for treating bad debts
may be made by thetaxpayer in the return for its first taxable year
beginning after December 31, 1951. The method selected shall be subject
to the
[[Page 349]]
approval of the Commissioner upon examination of the return. If the
method selected is approved, it must be followed in returns for
subsequent years, unless permission is granted by the Commissioner to
change to another method. Application for permission to change the
method of treating bad debts shall be made at least 30 days prior to the
close of the taxable year for which the change is to be effective.
(b) Addition to reserve. Except as otherwise provided in Sec.
1.593-2, the reasonable addition to a reserve for bad debts shall be any
amount determined by the taxpayer which does not exceed the lesser of:
(1) The amount of its taxable income for the taxable year, computed
without regard to section 593 and without regard to any section
providing for a deduction the amount of which is dependent upon the
amount of taxable income (such as section 170, relating to charitable,
etc., contributions and gifts), or
(2) The amount by which 12 percent of the total deposits or
withdrawable accounts of its depositors at the close of such year
exceeds the sum of its surplus, undivided profits, and reserves at the
beginning of the taxable year.
(c) Adjustments to reserve. Bad debt losses sustained during the
taxable year shall be charged against the bad debt reserve. Recoveries
of debts charged against the bad debt reserve during a prior taxable
year in which the institution was subject to tax under chapter 1 of the
Internal Revenue Code of 1954 or under chapter 1 of the Internal Revenue
Code of 1939 shall be credited to the bad debt reserve. The
establishment of such reserve and all adjustments made thereto must be
reflected on the regular books of account of the institution at the
close of the taxable year, or as soon as practicable thereafter. Minimum
amounts credited in compliance with Federal or State statutes,
regulations, or supervisory orders to reserve or similar accounts, or
additional amounts credited to such reserve or similar accounts and
permissive under such statutes, regulations, or orders, against which
charges may be made for the purpose of absorbing losses sustained by an
institution, will be deemed to have been credited to the bad debt
reserve.
(d) Definitions. When used in this section and in Sec. 1.593-2:
(1) Institution. The term institution means either a mutual savings
bank not having capital stock represented by shares, a domestic building
and loan association as defined in section 7701(a)(19), or a cooperative
bank without capital stock organized and operated for mutual purposes
and without profit.
(2) Surplus, undivided profits, and reserves. (i) The phrase
surplus, undivided profits, and reserves means the amount by which the
total assets of an institution exceed the amount of the total
liabilities of such an institution.
(ii) For this purpose the term total assets means the sum of money,
plus the aggregate of the adjusted basis of the property other than
money, held by an institution. Such adjusted basis for any asset is its
adjusted basis for determining gain upon sale or exchange for Federal
income tax purposes. (See sections 1011 through 1022, and the
regulations thereunder. For special rules with respect to adjustments to
basis for prior taxable years during which the institution was exempt
from tax, see section 1016(a)(3) and the regulations thereunder.) The
determination of the total assets of any taxpayer shall conform to the
method of accounting employed by such taxpayer in determining taxable
income and to the rules applicable in determining its earnings and
profits.
(iii) The term total liabilities means all liabilities of the
taxpayer, which are fixed and determined, absolute and not contingent,
and includes those items which constitute liabilities in the sense of
debts or obligations. The total deposits or withdrawable accounts, as
defined in subparagraph (3) of this paragraph, shall be considered a
liability. In the case of a building and loan association having
permanent nonwithdrawable capital stock represented by shares, the paid-
in amount of such stock shall also be considered a liability. Reserves
for contingencies and other reserves, however, which are mere
appropriations of surplus, are not liabilities.
(3) Total deposits or withdrawable accounts. The phrase total
deposits or
[[Page 350]]
withdrawable accounts means the aggregate of (i) amounts placed with an
institution for deposit or investment and (ii) earnings outstanding on
the books of account of the institution at the close of the taxable year
which have been credited as dividends upon such accounts prior to the
close of the taxable year, except that such term, in the case of a
building and loan association, does not include permanent
nonwithdrawable capital stock represented by shares, or earnings
credited thereon.
(e) Examples. The provisions of this section may be illustrated by
the following examples:
Example 1. (i) Institution X, which keeps its books on the basis of
the calendar year, has surplus, reserves, and undivided profits of
$800,000 as of January 1, 1955, and total deposits or withdrawable
accounts of $10,000,000 as of December 31, 1955. During 1955 the
institution credits $30,000, as required by a Federal agency, to a
Federal insurance reserve for the sole purpose of absorbing losses.
Likewise, it credits $25,000, as permitted by State statute, to another
reserve fund for the purpose of absorbing losses. In 1955 Institution X
charges $5,000 against its bad debt reserve for losses sustained during
the taxable year.
(ii) The taxable income of Institution X for the taxable year 1955,
computed without regard to section 593 and without regard to any section
providing for a deduction the amount of which is dependent upon the
amount of taxable income, is $200,000.
(iii) Upon the basis of the facts as stated in subdivision (i) of
this example, the amount by which 12 percent of the total deposits or
withdrawable accounts of Institution X at the close of taxable year 1955
exceeds the sum of such institution's surplus, undivided profits, and
reserves at the beginning of the taxable year is $400,000 (12 percent of
$10,000,000, minus $800,000).
(iv) Institution X, therefore, may deduct, for the taxable year
1955, as an addition to a reserve for bad debts, any amount it may
determine that does not exceed the lesser of the amounts determined in
subdivision (ii) or (iii) of this example. That amount is $200,000 (as
determined in subdivision (ii) of this example). Since under paragraph
(c) of this section, the $30,000 credited to the reserve as required by
the Federal agency and the $25,000 credited to the reserve as permitted
by the State statute are regarded as amounts credited to a reserve for
bad debts account Institution X can credit an additional $145,000
($200,000 minus $55,000) to a general reserve for bad debts account at
any time during the taxable year.
(v) The loss of $5,000 charged to the bad debt reserve during the
taxable year does not affect the amount of the addition to the bad debt
reserve provided for in paragraph (b) of this section. It is of
significance only in determining the surplus, undivided profits, and
reserves of Institution X as of January 1, 1956.
Example 2. The taxable income of Institution Y for the taxable year
1955, computed without regard to the deduction under section 593 and
without regard to any section providing for a deduction the amount of
which is dependent upon the amount of taxable income, is determined to
be $250,000. The amount by which 12 percent of the total deposits or
withdrawable accounts of Institution Y at the close of the taxable year
exceeds the sum of such institution's surplus, undivided profits, and
reserves at the beginning of the taxable year is $500,000. Institution Y
credits $250,000 to its bad debt reserve in 1955. In 1957, it is
determined that the correct taxable income of Institution Y for 1955,
computed without regard to any deduction under section 593 and without
regard to any section providing for a deduction the amount of which is
dependent upon the amount of taxable income, is $275,000 and not
$250,000. Assuming that Institution Y credits the additional $25,000 to
its bad debt reserve, $275,000 is allowable as a deduction from gross
income for such institution for the taxable year 1955.
Sec. 1.593-2 Additions to reserve for bad debts where surplus,
reserves, and undivided profits equal or exceed 12 percent of
deposits or withdrawable accounts.
Where 12 percent of the total deposits or withdrawable accounts of
an institution at the close of the taxable year is equal to or less than
the sum of such institution's surplus, undivided profits, and reserves
at the beginning of the taxable year, a reasonable addition to the
reserve for bad debts as determined under the general provisions of
section 166(c) may be allowable as a deduction from gross income. In
making such determination, there shall be taken into account (a) surplus
or bad debt reserves existing at the close of December 31, 1951 (i.e.,
the amount of surplus, undivided profits, and reserves accumulated prior
to January 1, 1952, and in existence at the close of December 31, 1951),
and (b) changes in the surplus, undivided profits, and reserves of the
institution from December 31, 1951, until the beginning of the taxable
year. A deduction for an addition to the reserve
[[Page 351]]
for bad debts pursuant to this section will be authorized only in those
cases where the institution proves to the satisfaction of the
Commissioner that the bad debt experience of the institution warrants an
addition to the reserve for bad debts in excess of that provided in
paragraph (b) of Sec. 1.593-1. For definitions, see paragraph (d) of
Sec. 1.593-1.
Sec. 1.593-3 Taxable years affected.
Sections 1.593-1 and 1.593-2 apply only to taxable years beginning
after December 31, 1953, and ending after August 16, 1954, but before
January 1, 1963, and all references to sections of the Code are to the
Internal Revenue Code of 1954 before amendment by the Revenue Act of
1962. Sections 1.593-4 through 1.593-11 apply only to taxable years
ending after December 31, 1962, and all references to sections of the
Code are to the Internal Revenue Code of 1954 after amendment by the
Revenue Act of 1962.
[T.D. 6728, 29 FR 5857, May 5, 1964]
Sec. 1.593-4 Organizations to which section 593 applies.
The provisions of section 593 and Sec. Sec. 1.593-5 through 1.593-
11 (except subsection (f) of section 593 and Sec. 1.593-10) apply to
any mutual savings bank not having capital stock represented by shares,
any domestic building and loan association, and any cooperative bank
without capital stock organized and operated for mutual purposes and
without profit. The term thrift institution, as used in this section and
Sec. Sec. 1.593-5 through 1.593-11, refers to any such financial
institution. For definition of the terms domestic building and loan
association and cooperative bank, see paragraphs (19) and (32),
respectively, of section 7701(a).
[T.D. 549, 43 FR 21454, May 18, 1978]
Sec. 1.593-5 Addition to reserves for bad debts.
(a) Amount of addition. As an alternative to a deduction from gross
income under section 166(a) for specific debts which become worthless in
whole or in part, a thrift institution is allowed a deduction under
section 166(c) for a reasonable addition to a reserve for bad debts. In
the case of a thrift institution, the amount of the reasonable addition
to such reserve for a taxable year may not exceed:
(1) For taxable years beginning after July 11, 1969, the sum of (i)
the amount determined to be the reasonable addition to the reserve for
losses on nonqualifying loans, determined in the same manner as is
provided with respect to additions to the reserve for losses on
qualifying real property loans under paragraph (d) of Sec. 1.593-6A
(relating to the experience method), and (ii) the amount determined
under Sec. 1.593-6A to be the reasonable addition to the reserve for
losses on qualifying real property loans, or
(2) For taxable years beginning before July 12, 1969, the sum of (i)
the amount determined under Sec. 1.166-4 to be the reasonable addition
to the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans, and (ii) the amount
determined under Sec. 1.593-6 to be the reasonable addition to the
reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans.
(b) Crediting to reserves required--(1) In general. The amounts
referred to in paragraph (a) (1) and (2) of this section must be
credited, respectively, to the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans
and to the reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans by the
close of the taxable year, or as soon as practicable thereafter. For
rules with respect to accounting for such reserves see paragraph (a)(2)
of Sec. 1.593-7.
(2) Subsequent adjustments. If an adjustment with respect to the
income tax return for a taxable year is made, and if such adjustment
(whether initiated by the taxpayer or the Commissioner) has the effect
of permitting an increase, or requiring a reduction, in the amount
claimed on such return as an addition to the reserve for losses on
nonqualifying loans or to the reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans, then the amount initially credited to such reserve for
such year pursuant to subparagraph (1) of this paragraph may have to be
increased or decreased, as the case may be, to the extent necessary to
reflect such adjustment.
[[Page 352]]
(c) Transition year. For rules governing the computation of taxable
income in the case of a taxable year beginning in 1962 and ending in
1963, see Sec. 1.593-9.
[T.D. 6728, 29 FR 5857, May 5, 1964, as amended by T.D. 549, 43 FR
21455, May 18, 1978]
Sec. 1.593-6 Pre-1970 addition to reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans.
(a) In general. For purposes of paragraph (a)(2)(ii) of Sec. 1.593-
5, the amount of the addition to the reserve for losses on qualifying
real property loans for any taxable year beginning before July 12, 1969,
is the amount which the taxpayer determines to constitute a reasonable
addition to such reserve for such year. However, the amount so
determined for such year:
(1) Cannot exceed the largest of the amounts computed under one of
the three methods described in paragraph (b), (c), or (d) of this
section (relating, respectively, to the percentage of taxable income
method, the percentage of real property loans method, and the experience
method),
(2) Cannot exceed the maximum permissible addition described in
paragraph (e) of this section (if applicable), and
(3) Shall be determined without regard to any amount charged for any
taxable year against the reserve for losses on qualifying real property
loans pursuant to Sec. 1.593-10 (relating to certain distributions to
shareholders by a domestic building and loan association)
For each taxable year the taxpayer must include in its income tax return
for such year a computation of the addition under this section. The use
of a particular method in the return for a taxable year is not a binding
election by the taxpayer to apply such method either for such taxable
year or for subsequent taxable years. Thus, in the case of a subsequent
adjustment described in paragraph (b)(2) of Sec. 1.593-5 which has the
effect of permitting an increase, or requiring a reduction, in the
amount claimed in the return for a taxable year as an addition to the
reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans, the amount of such
addition may be recomputed under whichever method the taxpayer selects
for the purposes of such recomputation, irrespective of the method
initially applied for such taxable year. However, a taxpayer may not
subsequently reduce the amount claimed in the return for a taxable year
for the purpose of obtaining a larger deduction in a later year.
(b) Percentage of taxable income method--(1) In general. The amount
determined under the percentage of taxable income method for any taxable
year is an amount equal to 60 percent of the taxable income for such
year, minus the amount determined under Sec. 1.166-4 as a reasonable
addition for such year to the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans.
However, the amount determined under such method shall not exceed the
amount necessary to increase the balance (as of the close of the taxable
year) of the reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans to an
amount equal to 6 percent of such loans outstanding at such time.
(2) Taxable income defined. For purposes of this paragraph, taxable
income shall be computed:
(i) By excluding from gross income any amount included therein by
reason of the application of Sec. 1.593-10 (relating to certain
distributions to shareholders by a domestic building and loan
association);
(ii) Without regard to any deduction allowable under section 166(c)
for an addition to a reserve for bad debts;
(iii) Without regard to any section providing for a deduction the
amount of which is dependent upon the amount of taxable income (such as
section 170, relating to charitable, etc., contributions and gifts),
other than sections 243, 244, and 245 (relating to deductions for
dividends received); and
(iv) Without regard to any net operating loss carryback to such year
under section 172
In computing the deductions under sections 243, 244, and 245, section
246(b) (relating to limitation on aggregate amount of deduction) shall
not apply. For purposes of subdivision (iii) of this subparagraph, a net
operating loss deduction under section 172 is not a deduction the amount
of which is dependent upon the amount of taxable income.
[[Page 353]]
(c) Percentage of real property loans method--(1) General rule. The
amount determined under the percentage of real property loans method for
any taxable year is the amount necessary to increase the balance (as of
the close of such year) of the reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans to:
(i) An amount equal to 3 percent of such loans outstanding at such
time, plus
(ii) In the case of a taxpayer described in subparagraph (2) of this
paragraph, an amount equal to:
(a) The lesser of 2 percent of such loans outstanding at such time,
or $80,000, reduced (but not below zero) by
(b) The balance as of the close of such year, if any, of such
taxpayer's supplemental reserve for losses on loans.
(2) Certain new companies. (i) Subparagraph (1)(ii) of this
paragraph applies only in the case of a taxpayer which is a new company,
and which does not have capital stock with respect to which
distributions of property (as defined in section 317(a)) are not
allowable as a deduction under section 591.
(ii) For purposes of this subparagraph, a taxpayer is a new company
for any taxable year only if such year begins not more than 10 calendar
years after the first day on which such taxpayer, or any predecessor of
such taxpayer, was authorized by Federal or State law to do business as
(a) a mutual savings bank not having capital stock represented by
shares, (b) a domestic building and loan association, (c) a cooperative
bank without capital stock organized and operated for mutual purposes
and without profit, or (d) any other savings institution chartered and
supervised as a savings and loan or similar association under Federal or
State law.
(iii) As used in subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph, the term
calendar year has the meaning assigned to such term in section 441
(relating to the period for computation of taxable income); and the term
predecessor means any organization which transferred more than 50
percent of the total amount of its assets to the taxpayer, and which,
prior to the time of such transfer, was (a) authorized by Federal or
State law to do business as a mutual savings bank not having capital
stock represented by shares, a domestic building and loan association,
or a cooperative bank without capital stock organized and operated for
mutual purposes and without profit, or (b) any other savings institution
chartered and supervised as a savings and loan or similar association
under Federal or State law. The term predecessor also means any
predecessor of such predecessor.
(d) Experience method. The amount determined under the experience
method for any taxable year is the amount determined under Sec. 1.166-4
to be a reasonable addition for such year to the reserve for losses on
qualifying real property loans.
(e) Maximum permissible addition where percentage of taxable income
method or percentage of real property loans method is applied--(1) 12
percent of deposits limitation. If, for the taxable year, the taxpayer
uses either the percentage of taxable income method described in
paragraph (b) of this section or the percentage of real property loans
method described in paragraph (c) of this section, then (unless
subparagraph (2) of this paragraph applies) the maximum permissible
addition for such year is equal to the lesser of:
(i) The amount determined under such paragraph (b) or (c), or
(ii) An amount which, when added to the amount determined under
Sec. 1.166-4 as an addition for such year to the reserve for losses on
nonqualifying loans, equals the amount by which 12 percent of the total
deposits or withdrawable accounts of depositors of the taxpayer at the
close of such year exceeds the sum of the taxpayer's surplus, undivided
profits, and reserves at the beginning of such year (taking into account
any portion thereof which is attributable to the period before the first
taxable year beginning after December 31, 1951)
For definition of the terms surplus, undivided profits, and reserves and
total deposits or withdrawable accounts, see paragraph (f) of this
section.
(2) Special rule where a domestic building and loan association or
cooperative bank exceeds certain assets limitations. If, for the taxable
year, the taxpayer uses either the percentage of taxable income method
described in paragraph (b) of this section or the percentage of
[[Page 354]]
real property loans method described in paragraph (c) of this section,
and if for such year such taxpayer qualifies as a domestic building and
loan association under the first sentence of paragraph (19) of section
7701(a) (or as a cooperative bank under paragraph (32) thereof) solely
by reason of the application of the second sentence of such paragraph
(19) (that is, solely by reason of the fact that for such year more than
36 percent, but not more than 41 percent, of the amount of the total
assets of such association or bank consists of assets other than assets
described in section 7701(a)(19)(D)(ii)), then the maximum permissible
addition for such year is equal to the amount determined under
subparagraph (1) of this paragraph, reduced in accordance with the
following table:
------------------------------------------------------------------------
If the percentage of the The reduction shall
taxpayer's assets which be the following
are not assets described But does not exceed-- proportion of the
in section Percent amount determined
7701(a)(1()(D)(ii) under such
exceeds--Percent subparagraph (1)--
------------------------------------------------------------------------
36 37 \1/12\
37 38 \1/6\
38 39 \1/4\
39 40 \1/3\
40 41 \5/12\
------------------------------------------------------------------------
(f) Definitions. For purposes of this section:
(1) Surplus, undivided profits, and reserves. The term surplus,
undivided profits, and reserves means the amount by which the total
assets of the taxpayer exceed its total liabilities. The determination
of such total assets and total liabilities shall conform to the method
of accounting employed by the taxpayer in determining taxable income and
to the rules applicable in determining its earnings and profits. Total
deposits or withdrawable accounts (as defined in subparagraph (3) of
this paragraph but determined as of the beginning of the taxable year)
shall be considered a liability. In the case of a domestic building and
loan association having permanent nonwithdrawable capital stock
represented by shares, the paid-in amount of such stock shall also be
considered a liability. However, reserves for contingencies and other
reserves which are mere appropriations of surplus are not liabilities
for purposes of this section.
(2) Total assets. The term total assets means the sum of money
(including time or demand deposits with, or withdrawable accounts in,
any financial institution), plus the aggregate of the adjusted basis
(determined under Sec. 1.1011-1) of the property other than money held
by the taxpayer. For special rules with respect to adjustments to basis
in the case of property acquired by the taxpayer in a transaction
described in section 595(a), see section 595.
(3) Total deposits or withdrawable accounts. The term total deposits
or withdrawable amounts means the total of the amounts placed with the
taxpayer for deposit or investment. Such term also includes earnings
outstanding on the books of account of the taxpayer at the close of the
taxable year which have been credited as dividends or interest upon such
deposits or withdrawable accounts prior to the close of such taxable
year, and which are withdrawable on demand subject only to customary
notice of intention to withdraw. In the case of a domestic building and
loan association, however, such phrase does not include permanent
nonwithdrawable capital stock represented by shares, or earnings
credited thereon.
(g) Examples. The provisions of this section may be illustrated by
the following examples:
Example 1. (i) Facts. X is a domestic building and loan association
which was organized in 1947 and which makes its returns on the basis of
the calendar year and the reserve method of accounting for bad debts.
X's accounts contain the following entries:
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Balance as of--
-------------------------
Account Jan. 1, Dec. 31,
1965 1965
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total deposits or withdrawable accounts....... $1,000,000 $1,200,000
Nonqualifying loans........................... 50,000 60,000
Qualifying real property loans................ 900,000 940,000
Reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans..... 200 *160
Reserve for losses on qualifying real property 24,000 *21,000
loans........................................
Supplemental reserve for losses on loans...... 60,800 60,800
Surplus, undivided profits, and other reserves 15,000 18,040
------------------------------------------------------------------------
*Computed before any addition for 1965 under section 166(c).
[[Page 355]]
X's taxable income for 1965 (before any deductible addition to a reserve
for bad debts and without regard to charitable contributions of $200) is
$20,000, computed as follows:
Interest and other income.................................... $19,940
Dividends received from Y Corporation, a domestic corporation 400
subject to taxation under chapter 1 of the Code.............
----------
20,340
Deduction for 85 percent of dividends received computed 340
without regard to the limitation of section 246(b)..........
----------
Taxable income........................................... 20,000
It is assumed that under Sec. 1.166-4 X's addition for 1965 to its
reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans is $80.
(ii) Computation of addition to reserve for losses on qualifying
real property loans--(a) In general. X determines that the reasonable
addition for 1965 to its reserve for losses on qualifying real property
loans is $11,920. Such amount, compared under the percentage of taxable
income method, is the largest of the amounts determined under (b), (c),
and (d) of this subdivision, and does not exceed the 12 percent of
deposits limitation computed under (e) of this subdivision.
(b) Percentage of taxable income method. The amount determined under
the percentage of taxable income method is $11,920, that is, 60 percent
of the taxable income for 1965, or $12,000 (60 percent of $20,000),
minus $80, the addition for such year to the reserve for losses on
nonqualifying loans. This amount is not subject to reduction under the 6
percent of qualifying real property loans limitation described in
paragraph (b) (1) of this section since the addition of $11,920 to the
$21,000 balance of the reserve for losses on qualifying real property
loans at the close of 1965 will not increase such balance to an amount
in excess of $56,400, that is, 6 percent of such loans of $940,000
outstanding at such time.
(c) Percentage of real property loans method. Since X is not a new
company within the meaning of paragraph (c) (2) of this section, the
amount determined under the percentage of real property loans method is
$7,200, that is, the amount necessary to increase the balance of the
reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans at the close of
1965 from $21,000 to an amount equal to 3 percent of such loans
outstanding at such time, or $28,200 (3 percent of $940,000).
(d) Experience method. The amount determined under the experience
method is zero since it is assumed that the $21,000 balance of the
reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans at the close of
1965 before any addition for such year exceeds the maximum amount to
which such reserve could be increased under such method.
(e) 12 percent of deposits limitation. The amount determined under
the 12 percent of deposits limitation is $43,920, that is, $44,000 (the
excess of 12 percent of $1,200,000 of deposits at the close of 1965, or
$144,000, over the $100,000 of surplus, undivided profits, and reserves
at the beginning of such year), minus $80, the addition for such year to
the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans. Since such $43,920 is
greater than $11,920 (the amount determined under (b) of this
subdivision), the 12 percent of deposits limitation does not apply for
1965.
(iii) Computation of taxable income for 1965. X's taxable income for
1965, after deducting the additions for such year to its reserves for
losses on nonqualifying loans and on qualifying real property loans,
after deducting the charitable contributions which were not taken into
account in computing taxable income for purposes of the addition to the
reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans, after including in
taxable income dividends received from Y Corporation, and after taking
into account the deduction for dividends received under section 243
(subject to the limitation in section 246(b)), is $7,800, computed as
follows:
Interest and other income......................... $19,940
Dividends received from Y Corporation............. 400
-----------
......... $20,340
Less:
Deduction for charitable contributions.......... 200
85 percent of dividends received from Y 340
Corporation....................................
Additions to reserves for bad debts............. 12,000
-----------
......... 12,540
----------
Taxable income.................................... ......... 7,800
Example 2. Assume the same facts as in example 1, except that X
Corporation was organized in 1957, and qualifies for the taxable year
1965 as a new company within the meaning of paragraph (c) (2) of this
section. The maximum permissible addition for 1965 to X's reserve for
losses on qualifying real property loans is $18,000, the amount computed
under the percentage of real property loans method, since such amount is
greater than (i) $11,920, the amount computed under the percentage of
taxable income method, or (ii) zero, the amount computed under the
experience method. The $18,000 amount (as computed under the percentage
of real property loans method) is the amount necessary to increase the
reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans from the $21,000
closing balance to $39,000, computed as follows:
3 percent of $940,000 of qualifying real property loans at $28,200
close of 1965...............................................
Plus:
Lesser of $80,000 or $18,800 (2 percent of such $18,800
loans of $940,000).............................
[[Page 356]]
Reduced by the balance of supplemental reserve 8,000
for losses on loans............................
-----------
$10,800
----------
......... 39,000
Example 3. Assume the same facts as in example 1, except that for
1965, 38.4 percent of X's total assets consist of assets other than the
assets described in section 7701(a)(19)(D)(ii). In such case, the
maximum permissible addition of $11,920 for such year to the reserve for
losses on qualifying real property loans (as determined under
subdivision (ii) of example 1) would be reduced by $2,980 (\1/4\ of
$11,920) to $8,940.
[T.D. 6728, 29 FR 5857, May 5, 1964, as amended by T.D. 549, 43 FR
21455, May 18, 1978]
Sec. 1.593-6A Post-1969 addition to reserve for losses on qualifying
real property loans.
(a) In general--(1) Amount of addition determined for the taxable
year. For purposes of paragraph (a)(1)(ii) of Sec. 1.593-5, the amount
of the addition to the reserve for losses on qualifying real property
loans for any taxable year beginning after July 11, 1969, is the amount
which the taxpayer determines to constitute a reasonable addition to
such reserve for such year. However, the amount so determined for such
year:
(i) Cannot exceed the largest of the amount determined under section
593 (b) (2), (3), or (4) (relating, respectively, to the percentage of
taxable income method, the percentage method, and the experience
method), and
(ii) Shall be determined without regard to any amount charged for
any taxable year against the reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans pursuant to Sec. 1.593-10 (relating to certain
distributions to shareholders by a domestic building and loan
association).
For each taxable year the taxpayer must include in its income tax return
for such year a computation of the amount of the addition determined
under this section. The use of a particular method in the return for a
taxable year is not a binding election by the taxpayer to apply such
method either for such taxable year or for subsequent taxable years.
Thus, in the case of a subsequent adjustment described in paragraph
(b)(2) of Sec. 1.593-5 which has the effect of permitting an increase,
or requiring a reduction, in the amount claimed in the return for a
taxable year as an addition to the reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans, the amount of such addition may be recomputed under
whichever method the taxpayer selects for the purpose of such
recomputation, irrespective of the method initially applied for such
taxable year.
(2) Method of determination. For purposes of this section and Sec.
1.596-1 (relating to limitation on dividends received deduction), a
thrift institution is deemed to have determined the addition to its
reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans for the taxable
year under the percentage of taxable income method provided by section
593(b)(2) and paragraph (b) of this section if the amount finally
determined to be a reasonable addition for such year to such reserve
exceeds the amount determined for such year under section 593(b)(3)
(relating to the percentage method) and exceeds the amount determined
for such year under section 593(b)(4) (relating to the experience
method).
(b) Percentage of taxable income method--(1) In general. Subject to
the limitations described in subparagraph (4) of this paragraph and in
paragraph (e) of this section, the amount determined under section
593(b)(2) and this paragraph for the taxable year, if such section and
paragraph are applicable, is an amount equal to the applicable
percentage of the taxable income for such year, reduced by the amount
determined under subparagraph (3) of this paragraph. For this purpose,
taxable income is computed as provided in subparagraph (5) of this
paragraph, and the applicable percentage (except as reduced under
subparagraph (2) of this paragraph) is determined under the following
table:
------------------------------------------------------------------------
The applicable percentage
For a taxable year beginning in-- under this subparagraph is--
------------------------------------------------------------------------
1969...................................... 60 percent.
1970...................................... 57 percent.
1971...................................... 54 percent.
1972...................................... 51 percent.
1973...................................... 49 percent.
1974...................................... 47 percent.
1975...................................... 45 percent.
1976...................................... 43 percent.
[[Page 357]]
1977...................................... 42 percent.
1978...................................... 41 percent.
1979 or thereafter........................ 40 percent.
------------------------------------------------------------------------
(2) Reduction of applicable percentage in certain cases--(i) General
rules. If for the taxable year the percentage of the assets of a thrift
institution, which are assets described in section 7701(a)(19)(C)
(relating to assets of a domestic building and loan association) is less
than:
(a) 82 percent of the total assets in the case of a thrift
institution other than a mutual savings bank, the applicable percentage
for such year provided by subparagraph (1) of this paragraph is reduced
by three-fourths of 1 percentage point for each 1 percentage point of
such difference; or
(b) 72 percent of the total assets in the case of a thrift
institution which is a mutual savings bank, the applicable percentage
for such year provided by subparagraph (1) of this paragraph is reduced
by 1\1/2\ percentage points for each 1 percentage point of such
difference.
If such percentage is less than 60 percent of the total assets in the
case of any thrift institution (less than 50 percent of the total assets
for a taxable year beginning before 1973 in the case of a thrift
institution which is a mutual savings bank), section 593(b)(2) and this
paragraph are not applicable. The percentage of total assets specified
in this subparagraph is computed as of the close of the taxable year or,
at the option of the taxpayer, may be computed on the basis of the
average assets outstanding during the taxable year. Such average is
determined by computing such percentage either as of the close of each
month, as of the close of each quarter, or as of the close of each
semiannual period during the taxable year and by using the yearly
average of the monthly, quarterly, or semiannual percentages. A thrift
institution which is a mutual savings bankand which determines the
amount of the reasonable addition for the taxable year to the reserve
for losses on qualifying real property loans under this paragraph shall
file for such taxable year a statement which shall show the amount of
assets defined in paragraph (e) of Sec. 402.1-2 (Temporary Regulations
on Procedure and Administration under Tax Reform Act of 1969) as of the
close of the taxable year and a brief description and the amount of all
other assets, together with a description of the method used in
determining such amounts. If the percentage specified in this
subparagraph is computed by such thrift institution on the basis of the
average assets outstanding during the taxable year, the statement shall
also show such information as of the end of each month, each quarter, or
each semiannual period and the manner of calculating the average.
(ii) Example. The provisions of this subparagraph may be illustrated
by the following example:
Example. M is a cooperative bank to which section 593 applies. For
its taxable year beginning in 1970, 80.4 percent of M's assets (computed
as of the close of such year) constitute assets described in section
7701(a)(19)(C). M's assets which are assets described in section
7701(a)(19)(C), when computed on semiannual, quarterly, and monthly
bases, constitute 79.8, 79.6, and 79.5 percent, respectively, of its
total assets computed on the corresponding bases. M's applicable
percentage for 1970 is 56.25 percent, determined as follows:
Percent
Percentage of total assets specified in (a) of subdivision (i) 82.0
of this subparagraph..........................................
Percentage of total assets constituting assets described in 80.4
section 7701(a)(19)(C)........................................
Difference................................................. 1.6
Applicable percentage determined under table in subparagraph 57.0
(1) of this paragraph.........................................
Reduction of applicable percentage required by (a) of .75
subdivision (i) of this subparagraph (\3/4\ of 1 percentage
point for each full percentage point of difference)...........
Applicable percentage...................................... 56.25
(3) Reduction for addition to reserve for nonqualifying loans--(i)
General rule. Subparagraph (1) of this paragraph provides that, subject
to certain limitations, the amount determined under the percentage of
taxable income method provided by section 593(b)(2) and this paragraph
for the taxable year is an amount equal to the applicable percentage of
the taxable income for such year, reduced by the amount determined under
this subparagraph. In the case of a thrift institution other
[[Page 358]]
than a mutual savings bank, the amount determined under this
subparagraph is an amount equal to the amount determined under paragraph
(a)(1)(i) of Sec. 1.593-5 to be a reasonable addition for the taxable
year to the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans multiplied by a
fraction:
(a) The numerator of which is 18 percent, and
(b) The denominator of which is the percentage (in no case less than
18 percent) of the assets of the taxpayer for such year which are not
assets defined in paragraph (e) of Sec. 402.1-2 of this chapter.
In the case of a thrift institution which is a mutual savings bank, the
amount determined under this subparagraph is an amount determined in the
manner described in the preceding sentence, except that the numerator of
the fraction described therein is 28 percent, and the denominator of
such fraction shall not be less than 28 percent. For purposes of this
subparagraph, the percentage of assets for a taxable year which are not
assets defined in paragraph (e) of Sec. 402.1-2 of this chapter is
determined upon the same annual or average basis as is used in
determining the percentage specified in subparagraph (2) of this
paragraph.
(ii) Examples. The provisions of this subparagraph may be
illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. K is a domestic building and loan association to which
section 593 applies. The amount determined under subparagraph (1) of
this paragraph (before reduction by the amount determined under this
subparagraph) to be the reasonable addition for the taxable year to K's
reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans is $100,000. The
amount determined under paragraph (a)(1)(i) of Sec. 1.593-5 as the
reasonable addition for the taxable year to the association's reserve
for losses on nonqualifying loans is $10,000. The percentage of K's
assets which are not assets defined in paragraph (e) of Sec. 402.1-2 is
24 percent. The amount determined under subparagraph (1) of this
paragraph ($100,000) must be reduced by $7,500.
$10,000x18 percent/24 percent.
Therefore, subject to the limitations described in subparagraph (4) of
this paragraph and in paragraph (e) of this section, the amount
determined under this paragraph to be the reasonable addition for the
taxable year to K's reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans
is $92,500 ($100,000 less $7,500).
Example 2. The facts are the same as in example 1, except that the
percentage of K's assets which are not assets defined in paragraph (e)
of Sec. 402.1-2 is 12 percent. The amount determined under subparagraph
(1) of this paragraph (before reduction by the amount determined under
this subparagraph) to be the reasonable addition for the taxable year to
K's reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans must be reduced
by $10,000.
$10,000x18 percent/18 percent.
Because the denominator of the fraction may not be less than 18 percent,
the fraction used in determining the amount of such reduction is equal
to 1.
(4) Overall limitation. The amount determined under this paragraph
shall not exceed the amount necessary to increase the balance (as of the
close of the taxable year) of the reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans to 6 percent of such loans outstanding at such time.
(5) Computation of taxable income. For purposes of this paragraph,
taxable income is computed:
(i) By excluding from gross income any amount included therein by
reason of the application of section 593(e) and Sec. 1.593-10 (relating
to certain distributions to shareholders by a domestic building and loan
association).
(ii) Without regard to any deduction allowable under section 166(c)
(whether or not determined under section 593) and the regulations
thereunder for an addition to a reserve for bad debts.
(iii) (a) By excluding from gross income an amount equal to the
excess (if any) or (1) the total gains of the taxable year arising from
sales and exchanges at a gain of (i) obligations the interest on which
is excludable from gross income under section 103, and (ii) corporate
stock, over (2) the total losses of such year arising from sales and
exchanges at a loss of such obligations and stock.
(b) The provisions of this subdivision (iii) may be illustrated by
the following example:
Example. For its taxable year beginning in 1971, the gains and
losses of a domestic building and loan association from sales of stock
and securities (all of which were made on December 31, 1971) were as
follows:
[[Page 359]]
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Gain Loss
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Municipal bonds acquired July 1, 1969, the $25,000 .........
interest on which is excludable from income under
sec. 103.........................................
Stock of Corporation A, acquired July 14, 1971.... ......... $6,000
Stock of Corporation B, acquired Dec. 22, 1970.... $3,000 .........
------------------------------------------------------------------------
For purposes of this paragraph, the association's taxable income for
1971 is computed by excluding $22,000 ($25,000+$3,000-$6,000) from its
gross income.
(iv) By excluding from gross income an amount equal to the lesser of
(a) three-eighths of the net long-term capital gain for the taxable year
or (b) three-eighths of the net long-term capital gain for the taxable
year from the sale or exchange of property other than property described
in subdivision (iii) of this subparagraph.
(v)(a) By excluding from gross income so much of the amount of
dividends with respect to which a deduction is allowable under part
VIII, subchapter B, chapter 1, subtitle A of theCode (section 241 and
following) as is in excess of the applicable percentage (determined
under subparagraphs (1) and (2) of this paragraph) of the dividends
received deduction (determined under part VIII, subchapter B, chapter 1,
subtitle A of the Code, without regard to section 596) for the taxable
year.
(b) The provisions of this subdivision (v) may be illustrated by the
following example:
Example. For its taxable year beginning in 1977, a domestic building
and loan association receives dividends of $100 with respect to which a
dividends received deduction of $85 is allowable under section
243(a)(1). The association receives no other dividends for the taxable
year. The association's applicable percentage for the taxable year, as
determined under subparagraphs (1) and (2) of this paragraph, is 42
percent. For purposes of this paragraph, the association's taxable
income is computed by excluding from gross income the excess of the
amount of dividends received ($100) over the applicable percentage of
the allowable dividends received deduction (42 percent of $85, or
$35.70), computed without regard to section 596. Thus, for purposes of
this paragraph, $64.30 ($100 less $35.70) is excluded from gross income.
See section 596 and Sec. 1.596-1 with respect to the computation of the
dividends received deduction for purposes of determining taxable income
under section 63(a).
(vi) For taxable years beginning before January 1, 1978, without
regard to any deduction the amount of which is computed upon, or may be
subject to a limitation computed upon, the amount of taxable income, and
without regard to any net operating loss carryback to such year from a
taxable year beginning before January 1, 1979. (For purposes of this
subparagraph, a net operating loss deduction under section 172 is not a
deduction the amount of which may be subject to a limitation computed
upon the amount of taxable income.)
(vii) For taxable years beginning after December 31, 1977, by taking
into account any deduction the amount of which is computed upon or may
be subject to a limitation computed upon the amount of taxable income,
and any other deduction or loss allowed under subtitle A of the Code,
such as any deduction allowable under section 172 or any loss allowable
under section 1212 (a), unless otherwise provided in this subparagraph.
(c) Percentage method. [Reserved]
(d) Experience method. [Reserved]
(e) Percentage of deposits limitation where percentage of taxable
income method or percentage method is applied. If the amount determined
by the taxpayer to constitute a reasonable addition for the taxable year
to the reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans is greater
than the amount determined under paragraph (d) of this section (relating
to the experience method), the amount so determined cannot exceed an
amount which, when added to the amount determined under paragraph
(a)(1)(i) of Sec. 1.593-5 to be a reasonable addition for such year to
the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans, equals the amount by
which 12 percent of the total deposits or withdrawable accounts of
depositors of the taxpayer at the close of such year exceeds the sum of
the taxpayer's surplus, undivided profits, and reserves at the beginning
of such year (taking into account any portion thereof which is
attributable to the period before the first taxable year beginning after
December 31, 1951. The terms surplus, undivided profit, and reserves and
total deposits or
[[Page 360]]
withdrawable accounts have the same meanings as are assigned to them in
paragraph (f) of Sec. 1.593.6.
[T.D. 549, 43 FR 21455, May 18, 1978, as amended by T.D. 7626, 44 FR
31177, May 31, 1979]
Sec. 1.593-7 Establishment and treatment of reserves for bad debts.
(a) Establishment of reserves--(1) In general. A taxpayer described
in Sec. 1.593-4 shall establish and maintain a reserve for losses on
nonqualifying loans, a reserve for losses on qualifying real property
loans, and, if required under paragraph (b)(4) or (c)(3)(i)(c) of this
section, a supplemental reserve for losses on loans. For rules governing
the crediting of additions to the reserve for losses on nonqualifying
loans and the reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans, see
paragraph (b) of Sec. 1.593-5.
(2) Accounting for reserves. (i) The taxpayer shall establish and
maintain as a permanent part of its regular books of account an account
for each of the reserves established pursuant to subparagraph (1) of
this paragraph. For purposes of the preceding sentence, a taxpayer may
establish and maintain a permanent subsidiary ledger containing an
account for each of such reserves. If a taxpayer maintains such a
permanent subsidiary ledger, the total of the reserve accounts in such
ledger and the total of the reserve accounts in any other ledger must be
reconciled.
(ii) Any credit or charge to a reserve established pursuant to
subparagraph (1) of this paragraph must be made to such reserve
irrespective of whether the amount thereof is also credited or charged
to any surplus, reserve, or other account which the taxpayer may be
required or permitted to maintain pursuant to any Federal or State
statute, regulation, or supervisory order. Minimum amounts credited in
compliance with such Federal or State statutes, regulations, or
supervisory orders to reserve or similar accounts, or additional amounts
credited to such reserve or similar accounts and permissible under such
statutes, regulations, or orders, against which charges may be made for
the purpose of absorbing losses sustained by the taxpayer, may also be
credited to the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans or the reserve
for losses on qualifying real property loans, provided that the total of
the amounts so credited to the reserve for losses on nonqualifying
loans, or to the reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans,
for any taxable years does not exceed the amount described in
subparagraph (1) or (2) of Sec. 1.593-5(a) (whichever applies) as the
addition to such reserve for such year year.
(b) Allocation of pre-1963 reserves--(1) In general. In the case of
a taxpayer described in Sec. 1.593-4, the pre-1963 reserves, if any, of
such taxpayer shall be allocated to (and constitute the opening balance
of) the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans, the reserve for
losses on qualifying real property loans, and, if required under
subparagraph (4) of this paragraph, the supplemental reserve for losses
on loans. The term pre-1963 reserves means the net amount (determined as
of the close of December 31, 1962) accumulated for taxable years
beginning after December 31, 1951, in the taxpayer's reserve for bad
debts pursuant to section 166(c) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1954
and section 23(k) (1) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1939 (including
the amount of any bad debt reserves acquired from another taxpayer). For
purposes of the preceding sentence in the case of a taxable year
beginning before January 1, 1963, and ending after December 31, 1962,
the part of such year occurring before January 1, 1963, shall be treated
as a taxable year. Thus, the pre-1963 reserves of the taxpayer shall be
an amount equal to:
(i) The sum of the amounts allowed as deductions for additions to a
reserve for bad debts for taxable years beginning after December 31,
1951, and ending before January 1, 1963, plus
(ii) In the case of a taxable year beginning before January 1, 1963,
and ending after December 31, 1962, the amount (determined under Sec.
1.593-1 or 1.593-2) which would be allowable under section 166(c) as a
deduction for an addition to a reserve for bad debts for the part of
such year occurring before January 1, 1963, if such part year
constituted a taxable year, minus
(iii) The total amount of bad debts charged against a reserve for
bad debts during the period which begins with the opening of the first
taxable year
[[Page 361]]
beginning after December 31, 1951, and which ends at the close of
December 31, 1962 plus
(iv) The total amount of recoveries during the period described in
subdivision (iii) of this subparagraph, on bad debts charged against a
reserve for bad debts in a taxable year beginning after December 31,
1951.
(2) Allocation to opening balance of reserve for losses on
nonqualifying loans. (i) As of the close of December 31, 1962 the pre-
1963 reserves shall first be allocated to (and constitute the opening
balance of) the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans in an amount
equal to the lesser of (a) the amount of such pre-1963 reserves, or (b)
the amount determined under subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph.
(ii) The amount referred to in subdivision (i)(b) of this
subparagraph shall be the amount which would constitute a reasonable
addition to the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans under Sec.
1.166-4 for a period in which the taxpayer's nonqualifying loans
increased from zero to the amount thereof outstanding at the close of
December 31, 1962.
(3) Allocation to opening balance of reserve for losses on
qualifying real property loans. (i) Any portion of the pre-1963 reserves
remaining after the allocation provided in subparagraph (2) of this
paragraph shall, as of the close of December 31, 1962, be allocated to
(and constitute the opening balance of) the reserve for losses on
qualifying real property loans in an amount equal to the lesser of (a)
the amount of such remaining portion, or (b) the amount determined under
subdivision (ii) of this subparagraph. If the amount described in (a) of
the preceding sentence is less than the amount described in (b) thereof,
see Sec. 1.593-8 for allocation of pre-1952 surplus, if any, to the
opening balance of such reserve.
(ii) The amount referred to in subdivision (i)(b) of this
subparagraph shall be an amount equal to the greater of:
(a) 3 percent of the taxpayer's qualifying real property loans
outstanding at the close of December 31, 1962, or
(b) The amount which would constitute a reasonable addition to the
reserve for losses on such loans under Sec. 1.166-4 for a period in
which the amount of such loans increased from zero to the amount thereof
outstanding at the close of December 31, 1962.
(4) Allocation to supplemental reserve for losses on loans. Any
portion of the pre-1963 reserves remaining after the allocations
provided in subparagraphs (2) and (3) of this paragraph shall be
allocated in its entirety to the supplemental reserve for losses on
loans. (5) Examples. This paragraph may be illustrated by the following
examples:
Example 1. (i) Facts. X Corporation, a domestic building and loan
association organized on April 1, 1954, makes its returns on the basis
of a taxable year ending March 31 and the reserve method of accounting
for bad debts. For its taxable years ending March 31, 1955, through
March 31, 1962, X was allowed a total of $750,000 as deductible
additions to its reserve for bad debts under section 166(c). For its
taxable year ending March 31, 1963, X was allowed a deduction under
section 166(c) for an addition to a reserve for bad debts. Of such
deduction $46,000 was determined under Sec. 1.593-1 (relating to
additions to reserve for bad debts) by reference to Sec. 1.593-9
(relating to taxable income for taxable years beginning in 1962 and
ending in 1963) as the amount which would be allowable for the period
April 1 through December 31, 1962, if such period constituted a taxable
year. During the taxable years ending March 31, 1955, through March 31,
1963, X charged bad debts of $55,000 against its reserve for bad debts
and made recoveries on such debts of $10,000. Of suchbad debt charges
and recoveries, $50,000 was charged off and $9,000 was recovered prior
to January 1, 1963. At the close of December 31, 1962, X had outstanding
nonqualifying loans of $500,000 and outstanding qualifying real property
loans of $10 million. It is assumed that, under Sec. 1.166-4, $2,000
would constitute a reasonable addition to the reserve for losses on
nonqualifying loans for a period in which such loans increased from zero
to $500,000 and $20,000 would constitute a reasonable addition to the
reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans for a period in
which such loans increased from zero to $10 million.
(ii) Pre-1963 reserves determined. X's pre-1963 reserves are
$755,000, computed as follows:
Deductible additions to reserve for bad debts:..
Years ending March 31, 1955 through March 31, $750,000
1962.........................................
Period April 1 through December 31, 1962...... 46,000
-----------------------
.......... $796,000
[[Page 362]]
Less:
Net bad debt losses for period April 1, 1954
through December 31, 1962:
Bad debts................................... 50,000
Recoveries.................................. (9,000) 41,000
-----------------------
.......... 755,000
(iii) Allocation to opening balance of reserve for losses on
nonqualifying loans. The portion of the $755,000 of pre-1963 reserves to
be allocated to the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans as the
opening balance thereof is $2,000 since such amount would constitute a
reasonable addition to the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans
under Sec. 1.166-4 for a period in which the amount of such loans
increased from zero to $500,000.
(iv) Allocation to opening balance of reserve for losses on
qualifying real property loans. Of the $753,000 ($755,000 minus $2,000)
of pre-1963 reserves remaining after the allocation described in
subdivision (iii) of this example, $300,000 (3 percent of $10 million,
the total amount of qualifying real property loans outstanding at the
close of December 31, 1962) is allocated to the opening balance of the
reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans, since such amount
is greater than $20,000, the amount which would constitute a reasonable
addition to the reserve for losses on such loans under Sec. 1.166-4 for
a period in which the amount of such loans increased from zero to $10
million.
(v) Allocation to supplemental reserve for losses on loans. The
balance of the pre-1963 reserves, or $453,000 ($755,000 minus the sum of
$2,000 and $300,000), is allocated in its entirety to the supplemental
reserve for losses on loans.
Example 2. Assume the same facts as in example 1, except that X was
organized in 1936, and on December 31, 1962, had pre-1963 reserves of
only $15,000 (rather than $755,000). In such case, $2,000 of such pre-
1963 reserves would be allocated to, and constitute the opening balance
of, the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans, and $13,000 ($15,000
minus $2,000) would be allocated to and constitute part of the opening
balance of the reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans.
However, since such $13,000 is less than $300,000 (3 percent of $10
million), the opening balance of the reserve for losses on qualifying
real property loans must be increased by so much of the taxpayer's pre-
1952 surplus as is necessary to increase such opening balance to
$300,000. For rules on the allocation of pre-1952 surplus to the opening
balance of the reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans, see
Sec. 1.593-8.
(c) Treatment of reserves--(1) In general. Except as provided in
paragraph (d) of Sec. 1.593-8 (relating to the allocation of pre-1952
surplus), each of the reserves established pursuant to paragraph (a) of
this section shall be treated, for purposes of subtitle A of the Code,
as a reserve for bad debts, except that no deduction shall be allowed
under section 166 for any addition to the supplemental reserve for
losses on loans. Accordingly, if in any taxable year the taxpayer
charges any of the reserves established pursuant to paragraph (a) of
this section for an item other than a bad debt, gross income for such
year shall be increased by the amount of such charge. For special rules
in case of certain nondeductible distributions to shareholders by a
domestic building and loan association, see Sec. 1.593-10.
(2) Bad debt losses. Any bad debt in respect of a nonqualifying loan
shall be charged against the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans,
and any bad debt in respect of a qualifying real property loan shall be
charged against the reserve for losses on qualifying real property
loans. At the option of the taxpayer, however, any bad debt in respect
of either class of loans may be charged in whole or in part against the
supplemental reserve for losses on loans.
(3) Recoveries of bad debts. Any amount recovered after December 31,
1962, in respect of a bad debt shall be credited to the reserves
established pursuant to paragraph (a) of this section in the following
manner:
(i) If the recovery is in respect of a bad debt which was charged
prior to January 1, 1963, against a reserve for bad debts established
pursuant to section 166(c) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1954, or
section 23(k)(1) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1939, then the amount
recovered shall be credited:
(a) First, to the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans in an
amount equal to the amount, if any, by which the amount determined under
subdivision (ii) of paragraph (b)(2) of this section exceeds the opening
balance of such reserve (determined under such paragraph (b)(2)),
(b) Second, to the reserve for losses on qualifying real property
loans in an amount equal to the amount, if any, by which the amount
determined under subdivision (ii) of paragraph (b)(3) of
[[Page 363]]
this section exceeds the opening balance of such reserve (determined
under such paragraph (b)(3)), and
(c) Finally, to the supplemental reserve for losses on loans
For purposes of determining the amounts of the credits under (a) and (b)
of this subdivision, the opening balances of the reserve for losses on
nonqualifying loans and the reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans shall be deemed to include the sum of the amounts of any
prior credits made to such reserves pursuant to this subdivision.
(ii) If the recovery is in respect of a bad debt which is charged
after December 31, 1962, against only one of the reserves established
pursuant to paragraph (a) of this section, the entire amount recovered
shall be credited to the reserve so charged.
(iii) If the recovery is in respect of a bad debt which is charged
after December 31, 1962, against more than one of the reserves
established pursuant to paragraph (a) of this section, then the amount
recovered shall be credited to each of the reserves so charged in the
ratio which the amount of the bad debt charged against such reserve
bears to the total amount of such bad debt charged against both such
reserves.
(iv) Subdivision (i) of this subparagraph may be illustrated by the
following example:
Example. In 1962, the taxpayer sustained a bad debt of $10,000,
which was charged against a reserve for bad debts established pursuant
to section 166(c). As of the close of December 31, 1962, the balance of
the taxpayer's reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans was $2,000, the
amount determined under paragraph (b)(2)(ii) of this section. As of the
same time, the balance of the taxpayer's reserve for losses on
qualifying real property loans was $100,000, but the amount determined
under paragraph (b)(3)(ii) of this section was $106,000. In 1963, the
taxpayer recovers $8,000 of the $10,000 charged off in 1962. Of the
$8,000 recovered in 1963, $6,000 ($106,000 minus $100,000) is credited
to the reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans, and the
balance of $2,000 is credited to the supplemental reserve for losses on
loans.
[T.D. 6728, 29 FR 5859, May 5, 1964, as amended by T.D. 549, 43 FR
21457, May 18, 1978]
Sec. 1.593-8 Allocation of pre-1952 surplus to opening balance of
reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans.
(a) General rule. In the case of a taxpayer described in Sec.
1.593-4, if the amount of pre-1963 reserves allocated (under paragraph
(b)(3)(i) of Sec. 1.593-7) to the opening balance of the reserve for
losses on qualifying real property loans is less than an amount equal to
the greater of:
(1) The total amount of qualifying real property loans outstanding
at the close of December 31, 1962, multiplied by 3 percent, or
(2) The amount which would constitute a reasonable addition to the
reserve for losses on such loans under Sec. 1.166-4 for a period in
which the amount of such loans increased from zero to the amount thereof
outstanding at the close of December 31, 1962
then such opening balance shall be increased by an amount equal to so
much of the pre-1952 surplus of the taxpayer as is necessary to increase
such opening balance to the greater of the amounts described in
subparagraph (1) or (2) of this paragraph. The amount of such increase
shall be deemed to be included in such opening balance solely for the
limited purpose described in paragraph (d) of this section.
(b) Pre-1952 surplus defined--(1) In general. For purposes of this
section and Sec. 1.593-7, the term pre-1952 surplus means an amount
equal to:
(i) The sum of the taxpayer's surplus, undivided profits, and
reserves determined (under the principles of paragraph (d)(2) of Sec.
1.593-1) as of the close of the taxpayer's last taxable year beginning
before January 1, 1952 (including any amount acquired from another
taxpayer), minus
(ii) The amount of any impairments of such sum (as determined under
paragraph (c) of this section).
(2) Reduction for certain excludable interest. (i) The amount
otherwise determined under subparagraph (1) of this paragraph may, at
the option of the taxpayer, be reduced by the portion, if any, of such
amount which is attributable to interest which would have been
excludable from gross income of such taxpayer under section 22(b)(4) of
[[Page 364]]
the Internal Revenue Code of 1939 (relating to interest on governmental
obligations) or the corresponding provisions of prior revenue laws, had
such taxpayer been subject, when such interest was received or accrued,
to the income tax imposed by such Code or prior revenue laws.
(ii) For purposes of subdivision (i) of this subparagraph, the
portion of the amount otherwise determined under subparagraph (1) of
this paragraph which is attributable to interest which would have been
excludable from gross income shall be determined by multiplying such
amount by the ratio which:
(a) The total amount of such excludable interest for the period
before the taxpayer's first taxable year beginning after December 31,
1951, bears to
(b) The total amount of the taxpayer's gross income, plus the total
amount of such excludable interest, for such period
If the amount determined under subparagraph (1)(i) of this paragraph
includes any amount acquired from another taxpayer, then the gross
income and excludable interest of the taxpayer for the period before its
first taxable year beginning after December 31, 1951, shall include the
gross income and excludable interest (for the same period) of such other
taxpayer.
(c) Impairment of surplus, undivided profits, and reserves--(1)
General rule. In the case of a taxable year beginning after December 31,
1951, and ending before January 1, 1963, if for such year:
(i) The amount described in paragraph (b)(1)(i) of this section (as
decreased under subparagraph (3)(i) of this paragraph), exceeds
(ii) The sum of the taxpayer's surplus, undivided profits, and
reserves (excluding the amount of any pre-1963 reserves) determined as
of the close of such year under the principles of paragraph (d)(2) of
Sec. 1.593-1
then the amount described in paragraph (b)(1)(i) of this section may, at
the option of the taxpayer, be reduced by the amount of such excess.
(2) Transition year. In the case of a taxable year beginning before
January 1, 1963, and ending after December 31, 1962, the part of such
year which occurs before January 1, 1963, shall be considered to be a
taxable year for purposes of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph.
(3) Rules for applying subparagraph (1). (i) For purposes of
subparagraph (1)(i) of this paragraph, the amount described in paragraph
(b)(1)(i) of this section shall be decreased by the total of any
reductions under subparagraph (1) of this paragraph for prior taxable
years; and
(ii) For purposes of subparagraph (1)(ii) of this paragraph, the
term pre-1963 reserves means the amount determined under the principles
of paragraph (b)(1) of Sec. 1.593-7 for the period which begins with
the first day of the first taxable year beginning after December 31,
1951, and which ends at the close of the taxable year with respect to
which the computation under subparagraph (1) is being made.
(d) Treatment of pre-1952 surplus. Any portion of the taxpayer's
pre-1952 surplus which, pursuant to paragraph (a) of this section, is
deemed to be included in the opening balance of the reserve for losses
on qualifying real property loans shall not be treated as a reserve for
bad debts for any purpose other than computing for any taxable year the
amount determined under the method described in paragraph (b), (c), or
(d) of Sec. 1.593-6 (relating, respectively, to the percentage of
taxable income method, the percentage of real property loans method, and
the experience method) or paragraph (b), (c), or (d) of Sec. 1.593-6A
(relating, respectively, to the percentage of taxable income method, the
percentage method, and the experience method). For such limited purpose,
such portion shall be deemed to remain in, and constitute a part of, the
reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans. For all other
purposes, such portion will retain its character as part of the
taxpayer's pre-1952 surplus.
(e) Example. The provisions of this section may be illustrated by
the following example:
Example. (1) Facts. X Corporation, a mutual savings bank organized
in 1934, makes its returns on the basis of the calendar year and the
reserve method of accounting for bad debts. For the taxable years 1934
through 1951, X's gross income was $2.7 million, in addition to which X
received $300,000 of interest which would have been excludable from
gross income under section 22(b)(4) of the Internal
[[Page 365]]
Revenue Code of 1939, or the corresponding provisions of prior revenue
laws, if X had been subject to the income tax imposed by such Code or
prior revenue laws when such interest was received. At the close of
1951, the sum of X's surplus, undivided profits, and reserves was
$650,000. At the close of 1954, X had pre-1963 reserves of $10,000, and
surplus, undivided profits, and reserves of $630,000. At the close of
1955, X had pre-1963 reserves of $15,000, and surplus, undivided
profits, and reserves of $625,000. At the close of 1962, X had pre-1963
reserves of $55,000, nonqualifying loans of $4 million, and qualifying
real property loans of $10 million. It is assumed that, under Sec.
1.166-4, $16,000 would constitute a reasonable addition to the reserve
for losses on nonqualifying loans for a period in which such loans
increased from zero to $4 million and $20,000 would constitute a
reasonableaddition to the reserve for losses on qualifying real property
loans for a period in which such loans increased from zero to $10
million.
(2) Impairment of surplus, undivided profits, and reserves for 1954.
The sum of X's surplus, undivided profits, and reserves at the close of
1951 was impaired during 1954 by $30,000, computed as follows:
Sum of surplus, undivided profits, and reserves at close of $650,000
1951.......................................................
Less:
Sum of surplus, undivided profits, and reserves at close 620,000
of 1954, excluding pre-1963 reserves at close of such
year ($630,000 minus $10,000)............................
-----------
30,000
(3) Impairment of surplus, undivided profits, and reserves for 1955.
The sum of X's surplus, undivided profits, and reserves at the close of
1951 was further impaired during 1955 by $10,000, computed as follows:
Sum of surplus, undivided profits, and reserves at close of $620,000
1951, decreased by amount of 1954 impairment ($650,000
minus $30,000).............................................
Less:
Sum of surplus, undivided profits, and reserves at close 610,000
of 1955, excluding pre-1963 reserves at close of such
year ($625,000 minus $15,000)............................
-----------
10,000
(4) Pre-1952 surplus. X's pre-1952 surplus is $549,000, computed as
follows:
Sum of surplus, undivided profits and reserves $650,000
at close of 1951...............................
Less:
Sum of impairments for 1954 and 1955 ($30,000 40,000
plus $10,000)................................
-------------
.......... $610,000
Less:
Portion of such $610,000 which is attributable .......... 61,000
to excludable interest ($610,000 multiplied
by $300,000/$3 million)......................
-----------
.......... 549,000
(5) Allocation of pre-1963 reserves to reserve for losses on
nonqualifying loans and to reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans. Of the $55,000 of pre-1963 reserves at the close of
1962, $16,000 (the amount which would constitute a reasonable addition
to the reserve for losses on nonqualifying loans for a period in which
such loans increased from zero to $4 million) shall be allocated to, and
constitute the opening balance of, the reserve for losses on
nonqualifying loans, and the balance of $39,000 ($55,000 minus $16,000)
shall be allocated to, and constitute a part of the opening balance of,
the reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans.
(6) Allocation of pre-1952 surplus to reserve for losses on
qualifying real property loans. X's pre-1963 reserves are not sufficient
to bring the opening balance of the reserve for losses on qualifying
real property loans to $300,000, which is an amount equal to the greater
of:
(i) $300,000 (i.e., $10 million of qualifying real property loans
outstanding at the close of 1962, multiplied by 3 percent), or
(ii) $20,000 (the amount which would constitute a reasonable
addition to the reserve for losses on such loans under Sec. 1.166-4 for
a period in which the amount of such loans increased from zero to the
$10 million).
Therefore, $261,000 ($300,000 minus $39,000) of X's pre-1952 surplus of
$549,000 shall be deemed to be included in the opening balance of such
reserve in order to increase such opening balance to $300,000.
[T.D. 6728, 29 FR 5861, May 5, 1964, as amended by T.D. 549, 43 FR
21457, May 18, 1978]
Sec. 1.593-10 Certain distributions to shareholders by a domestic
building and loan association.
(a) In general. Section 593(f) provides that if a domestic building
and loan association (as defined in section 7701(a)(19) and the
regulations thereunder) distributes property after December 31, 1962, to
a shareholder with respect to its stock and if the amount of such
distribution is not allowable to the association as a deduction under
section 591 (relating to deduction for dividends paid on deposits),
then, notwithstanding any other provision of the Code, the distribution
shall be treated as provided in paragraphs (b) and (c) of this section.
For purposes of
[[Page 366]]
the preceding sentence, the term distribution includes any distribution
in redemption of stock to which section 302(a) or 303 applies, or in
partial or complete liquidation of the association, as well as any other
distribution which the association may make to a shareholder with
respect to its stock. For definition of the term property, see section
317(a). For determination of the amount of a distribution, see section
301(b). For taxable years beginning after July 11, 1969, this paragraph
is not applicable to any transaction to which section 381 (relating to
carryovers in certain corporate acquisitions) and the regulations
thereunder apply.
(b) Distributions out of certain reserves--(1) Distributions not in
exchange for stock. If the distribution is not a redemption to which
section 302(a) or 303 applies or in partial or complete liquidation of
the association, then to the extent that the distribution is not out of
earnings and profits of the taxable year (within the meaning of section
316(a)(2)) or out of earnings and profits accumulated in taxable years
beginning after December 31, 1951, the distribution shall be treated as
made out of:
(i) First, the reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans
(determined under subparagraph (3) of this paragraph), to the extent
thereof,
(ii) Second, the supplemental reserve for losses on loans, to the
extent thereof, and
(iii) Finally, such other accounts as may be proper.
(2) Distributions in redemption of stock or in liquidation. If the
distribution is a redemption to which section 302(a) or 303 applies, or
in partial or complete liquidation of the association, the distribution
shall be treated as made out of:
(i) First, the reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans
(as determined under subparagraph (3) of this paragraph), to the extent
thereof,
(ii) Second, the supplemental reserve for losses on loans, to the
extent thereof,
(iii) Third, earnings and profits of the taxable year (within the
meaning of section 316(a)(2)),
(iv) Fourth, earnings and profits accumulated in taxable years
beginning after December 31, 1951, and
(v) Finally, such other accounts as may be proper.
(3) Special rule. For purposes of subparagraphs (1)(i) and (2)(i) of
this paragraph, the reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans
shall be an amount equal to:
(i) The balance of such reserve determined as of the close of the
taxable year after all adjustments for such year have been made
(including the addition for such year determined under Sec. 1.593-6 or
Sec. 1.593-6A (whichever is applicable)), minus.
(ii) The sum of:
(a) The amount which would have constituted the opening balance of
such reserve (at the close of December 31, 1962) if such opening balance
had been determined under the experience method described in paragraph
(b)(3)(ii)(b) of Sec. 1.593-7 (relating to allocation of pre-1963
reserves to the opening balance of the reserve for losses on qualifying
real property loans), and
(b) The total amount of the annual additions which would have been
made to such reserve under section 166(c) for taxable years ending after
December 31, 1962, if each such addition had been determined under the
experience method described in paragraph (d) of Sec. 1.593-6 or
paragraph (d) of Sec. 1.593-6A, whichever is applicable for the taxable
year of such addition.
For purposes of subdivision (i) of this subparagraph, the balance of the
reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans shall include the
total amount of any pre-1963 reserves allocated thereto under paragraph
(b)(3) of Sec. 1.593-7, but shall not include any pre-1952 surplus
which is deemed to be included therein under paragraph (a) of Sec.
1.593-8 (relating to allocation of pre-1952 surplus to the opening
balance of the reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans).
(c) Amount charged against reserve and included in gross income--(1)
In general. If a distribution is treated under paragraph (b) (1) or (2)
of this section as having been made out of the reserve for losses on
qualifying real property loans or out of the supplemental reserve for
losses on loans, such reserves shall be
[[Page 367]]
charged with, and gross income for the taxable year shall be increased
by, an amount equal to the lesser of:
(i) The amount of such reserves, or
(ii) The amount which, when reduced by the amount of income tax
imposed by chapter 1 of the Code and attributable to the inclusion of
such amount in gross income, is equal to the amount of such
distribution.
(2) Special rule. For purposes of subparagraph (1)(ii) of this
paragraph, in determining the income tax attributable to the inclusion
of an amount in gross income, taxable income shall be determined without
regard to any net operating loss carryback to the taxable year under
section 172.
(d) Examples. This section may be illustrated by the following
examples:
Example 1. (i) Facts. X Corporation, a domestic building and loan
association having nonwithdrawable capital stock represented by shares,
was organized in 1946, and makes its returns on the basis of the
calendar year and the reserve method of accounting for bad debts. As of
the close of December 31, 1962, X had $6,900 of earnings and
profitsaccumulated in taxable years beginning after December 31, 1951.
X's taxable income for 1963 is $30,000 (computed prior to the inclusion
of any amount in gross income for such year under section 593(f)) and
during such year X received tax-exempt interest of $500. X's earnings
and profits for 1963 (computed at the close of the taxable year without
diminution by reason of any distributions made during the taxable year)
is $20,400. The opening balance of X's reserve for losses on qualifying
real property loans as of the close of December 31, 1962 (determined
under paragraph (b)(3)(ii)(a) of Sec. 1.593-7) was $24,500. Pre-1963
reserves of $22,500 were included in such opening balance, but it is
assumed that pre-1963 reserves of only $2,500 would have been included
in the opening balance if the opening balance had been determined under
the experience method described in paragraph (b)(3)(ii)(b) of Sec.
1.593-7. Pre-1952 surplus of $2,000 was deemed included in such opening
balance under paragraph (a) of Sec. 1.593-8. The deductible addition to
such reserve for 1963 is $47,000. It is assumed that the addition to
such reserve for 1963 would have been $2,200 if such addition had been
computed under the experience method described in paragraph (d) of Sec.
1.593-6. On each of four dates during 1963 (January 1, April 1, July 1,
and October 1), X made a $12,000 distribution (which was not a
redemption to which section 302(a) or 303 applied or in partial or
complete liquidation of X) to its shareholders with respect to its
stock.
(ii) Reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans. For
purposes of paragraph (b)(1)(i) of this section, X's reserve for losses
on qualifying real property loans is $64,800, computed as follows:
Closing balance of reserve for losses on qualifying real $71,500
property loans after addition for 1963 ($24,500 opening
balance plus $47,000 addition)..............................
Minus:
Amount of pre-1963 reserves which would have 2,500
been included in opening balance under
experience method..............................
Total additions which would have been made under 2,200
experience method................................
Pre-1952 surplus included in opening balance...... 2,000
---------------------
......... 6,700
----------
......... 64,800
(iii) Treatment of distributions. Of each $12,000 quarterly
distribution, $5,100 ($20,400) earnings and profits of the taxable year
divided by 4) is out of X's earnings and profits of the taxable year
(within the meaning of section 316(a)(2)); the remainder of the January
1 distribution, $6,900 ($12,000 minus $5,100), is out of X's earnings
andprofits accumulated in taxable years beginning after December 31,
1951. Since $20,700 ($6,900 multiplied by 3) is not out of X's earnings
and profits, such amount shall be treated as made out of X's reserve for
losses on qualifying real property loans (as determined under
subdivision (ii) of this example).
(iv) Amount charged against reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans and included in gross income. The reserve for losses on
qualifying real property loans is charged with, and X's gross income for
1963 is increased by, $43,124, which is the lesser of:
(a) $64,800 (the reserve as of December 31, 1963, as determined
under subdivision (ii) of this example), or
(b) $43,124, i.e., the amount which, when reduced by the amount of
income tax attributable to the inclusion of such amount in gross income,
$22,424 ($43,124 multiplied by a tax rate of 52 percent), is equal to
the amount of such distribution, $20,700.
Example 2. (i) Facts. Assume the same facts as in example 1 and the
following additional facts: X's taxable income for 1964 is $6,000. The
deductible addition to the reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans for 1964 is $11,000, but it is assumed that only $2,676
would have been the addition to such reserve for 1964 if such addition
had been computed under the experience method described in paragraph (d)
of Sec. 1.593-6. On December 31, 1964, X makes a $10,000 distribution
in a redemption to which section 302(a) applies.
(ii) Reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans. For
purposes of paragraph (b)(2)(i)
[[Page 368]]
of this section, X's reserve for losses on qualifying real property
loans is $30,000, computed as follows:
Closing balance of reserve for losses on qualifying real $82,500
property loans after addition for 1964 ($71,500 opening
balance plus $11,000 addition)..............................
Minus:
Amount of pre-1963 reserves which would have $2,500
been included in opening balance under the
experience method..............................
Total additions which would have been made under 4,876
the experience method ($2,200 for 1963 plus
$2,676 for 1964)...............................
Pre-1952 surplus included in opening balance.... 2,000
------------
......... 9,376
----------
......... 73,124
Less charge against reserve under subdivision (iv) ......... 43,124
of example 1 for 1963 distribution...............
---------------------
......... 30,000
(iii) Treatment of distribution. The $10,000 distribution in a
redemption to which section 302(a) applies shall be treated as made out
of X's reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans (as
determined under subdivision (ii) of this example).
(iv) Amount charged against reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans and included in gross income. The reserve for losses on
qualifying real property loans is charged with, and X's gross income for
1964 is increased by, $12,820, which is the lesser of:
(a) $30,000 (the reserve as of December 31, 1964, as determined
under subdivision (ii) of this example), or
(b) $12,820, i.e., the amount which, when reduced by the amount of
income tax attributable to the inclusion of such amount in gross income,
$2,820 ($12,820 multiplied by a tax rate of 22 percent), is equal to the
amount of such distribution, $10,000.
Example 3. (i) Facts. X Corporation, a domestic building and loan
association having nonwithdrawable capital stock represented by shares,
was organized in 1946, and makes its returns on the basis of the
calendar year and the reserve method of accounting for bad debts. As of
the close of December 31, 1962, X had $6,900 of earnings and profits
accumulated in taxable years beginning after December 31, 1951. X's
taxable income for 1963 is $30,000 (computed prior to the inclusion of
any amount in gross income for such year under section 593(f)) and
during such year X received tax-exempt interest of $500. X's earnings
and profits for 1963 (computed at the close of the taxable year without
diminution by reason of any distributions made during the taxable year)
is $20,400. The opening balance of X's reserve for losses on qualifying
real property loans as of theclose of December 31, 1962 (determined
under paragraph (b)(3)(ii)(a) of Sec. 1.593-7) was $24,500. Pre-1963
reserves of $24,500 were included in such opening balance, but it is
assumed that pre-1963 reserves of only $4,500 would have been included
in the opening balance if the opening balance had been determined under
the experience method described in paragraph (b)(3)(ii)(b) of Sec.
1.593-7. The deductible addition to such reserve for 1963 is $500. It is
assumed that the addition to such reserve for 1963 would have been $100
if such addition had been computed under the experience method described
in paragraph (d) of Sec. 1.593-6. As of December 31, 1963, the balance
of X's supplemental reserve for losses on loans is $30,000. On each of
four dates during 1963 (January 1, April 1, July 1, and October 1), X
made a $12,000 distribution (which was not a redemption to which section
302(a) or 303 applied or in partial or complete liquidation of X) to its
shareholders with respect to its stock.
(ii) Reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans. For
purposes of paragraph (b)(1)(i) of this section, X's reserve for losses
on qualifying real property loans is $20,400, computed as follows:
Closing balance of reserve for losses on qualifying real $25,000
property loans after addition for 1963 ($24,500 opening
balance plus $500 addition).................................
Minus:
Amount of pre-1963 reserves which would have $4,500
been included in opening balance under
experience method..............................
Total additions which would have been made under 100
experience method..............................
------------
......... 4,600
----------
......... 20,400
(iii) Treatment of distributions. Of each $12,000 quarterly
distribution, $5,100 ($20,400 earnings and profits of the taxable year
divided by 4) is out of X's earnings and profits of the taxable year
(within the meaning of section 316(a)(2)); the remainder of the January
1 distribution, $6,900 ($12,000 minus $5,100), is out of X's earnings
and profits accumulated in taxable years beginning after December 31,
1951. Since $20,700 ($6,900 multiplied by 3) is not out of X's earnings
and profits, $20,400 of such amount shall be treated as made outof X's
reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans (as determined
under subdivision (ii) of this example) and $300 ($20,700 minus $20,400)
shall be treated as made out of X's supplemental reserve for losses on
loans.
(iv) Amount included in gross income. X's gross income for 1963 is
increased by $43,124, which is the lesser of:
(a) $50,400 ($20,400, the reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans, as determined under subdivision (ii) of this example,
plus $30,000, the supplemental reserve for losses on loans), or
[[Page 369]]
(b) $43,124, i.e., the amount which, when reduced by the amount of
income tax attributable to the inclusion of such amount in gross income,
$22,424 ($43,124 multiplied by a tax rate of 52 percent), is equal to
the amount of such distribution, $20,700.
(v) Amount charged against reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans and supplemental reserve for losses on loans. The reserve
for losses on qualifying real property loans is charged with $20,400
(the balance of the reserve as of December 31, 1963, as determined under
subdivision (ii) of this example), and the supplemental reserve for
losses on loans is charged with $22,724 ($43,124, the amount included in
gross income under subdivision (iv) of this example, minus $20,400).
[T.D. 6728, 29 FR 5862, May 5, 1964, as amended by T.D. 549, 43 FR
21457, May 18, 1978]
Sec. 1.593-11 Qualifying real property loan and nonqualifying loan
defined.
(a) Loan defined. For purposes of this section, the term loan means
debt, as the term debt is used in section 166 and the regulations
thereunder. The term loan also includes a redeemable ground rent (as
defined in section 1055 (c)) which is owned by the taxpayer, and any
property acquired by the taxpayer in a transaction described in section
595(a). For determination of the amount of a loan, see paragraph (d) of
this section.
(b) Qualifying real property loan defined--(1) General rule. For
purposes of Sec. Sec. 1.593-4 through 1.593-10, the term qualifying
real property loan means any loan (other than a loan described in
subparagraph (5) of this paragraph) which is secured by an interest in
qualifying real property. For purposes of this section, the term real
property means any property which, under the law of the jurisdiction in
which such property is situated, constitutes real property. The term
real property also includes a mobile unit which is permanently fixed to
real property. The determination of whether a mobile unit is permanently
fixed to real property shall be made on the basis of facts and
circumstances in each particular case. For example, a mobile unit is
permanently fixed to real property during a taxable year if, except for
a brief period during which the unit is transported to a site, such unit
was placed upon a foundation at a site with wheels and axles removed,
affixed to the ground by means of straps, and connected to water, sewer,
gas, and electric facilities. See paragraph (e) of this section for the
treatment of a REMIC interest as a qualifying real property loan.
(2) Meaning of Secured. A loan will be considered as secured only if
the loan is on the security of any instrument (such as a mortgage, deed
of trust, or land contract) which makes the interest of the debtor in
the property described therein specific security for the payment of the
loan, provided that such instrument is of such a nature that, in the
event of default, the property could be subjected to the satisfaction of
the loan with the same priority as a mortgage or deed of trust in the
jurisdiction in which the property is situated.
(3) Meaning of interest. The word interest means an interest in real
property which, under the law of the jurisdiction in which such property
is situated, constitutes either (i) an interest in fee in such property,
(or in the case of a mobile unit, an ownership interest), (ii) a
leasehold interest in such property extending or renewable automatically
for a period of at least 30 years, or at least 10 years beyond the date
scheduled for the final payment on the loan secured by such interest,
(iii) a leasehold interest in improved residential real property
consisting of a structure or structures containing, in the aggregate, no
more than four family units extending for a period of at least 2 years
beyond the date scheduled for the final payment on the loan secured by
such interest, or (iv) a leasehold interest in such property held
subject to a redeemable ground rent defined in section 1055(c).
(4) Meaning of qualifying real property. The term qualifying real
property means any real property which is improved real property, or
which from the proceeds of the loan will become improved real property.
As used in the preceding sentence, the term improved real property
means:
(i) Land on which is located any building of a permanent nature
(such as a house, mobile unit, apartment house, office building,
hospital, shopping center, warehouse, garage, or other similar permanent
structure),
[[Page 370]]
provided that the value of such building is substantial in relation to
the value of such land,
(ii) Any building lot or site which, by reason of installations and
improvements that have been completed in keeping with applicable
governmental requirements and with general practice in the community, is
a building lot or site ready for the construction of any building of a
permanent nature within the meaning of paragraph (b)(4)(i) of this
section.
(iii) Real property which, because of its state of improvement,
produces sufficient income to maintain such real property and retire the
loan in accordance with the terms thereof, or
(iv) A mobile unit which is permanently fixed to real property.
(5) Loans not included. The term qualifying real property loan does
not include:
(i) Any loan evidenced by a security as defined in section
165(g)(2)(C),
(ii) Any loan (whether or not evidenced by a security as so defined)
the primary obligor on which is (a) a government or a political
subdivision or instrumentality thereof, (b) a bank (as defined in
section 581), or (c) another member of the same affiliated group,
(iii) Any loan to the extent such loan is secured by a deposit in or
share of the taxpayer (including a share of nonwithdrawable capital
stock), determined as of the close of the taxable year, and
(iv) Any loan which (within a 60-day period beginning in one taxable
year of the taxpayer and ending in the next taxable year of such
taxpayer) is made or acquired, and then repaid or disposed of, unless
both the transaction by which the loan is made or acquired and the
transaction by which the loan is repaid or disposed of are established
to the satisfaction of the district director to be for bona fide
business purposes
As used in subdivision (ii)(c) of this subparagraph, the term affiliated
group shall have the meaning assigned to such term by section 1504(a)
(relating to the definition of an affiliated group), except that the
phrase more than 50 percent shall be substituted for the phrase at least
80 percent each place the latter phrase appears in section 1504(a), and
all corporations shall be treated as includible corporations (without
regard to any of the exclusions provided in section 1504(b)).
(c) Nonqualifying loan defined. For purposes of Sec. Sec. 1.593-4
through 1.593-9, the term nonqualifying loan means any loan which is not
a qualifying real property loan.
(d) Amount of loan determined--(1) General rule. Except as provided
in subparagraph (2) of this paragraph, the amount of any qualifying real
property loan or nonqualifying loan, for purposes of section 593, is the
adjusted basis of such loan as determined under Sec. 1.1011-1. However,
the adjusted basis, determined under Sec. 1.1011-1, of any loan in
process does not include the unadvanced portion of such loan. For the
basis of a redeemable ground rent reserved or created by the taxpayer
before April 11, 1963, see section 1055(b)(3); and for the basis of a
loan represented by property acquired by the taxpayer in a transaction
described in section 595(a), see section 595(c).
(2) Limitation. If the total amount advanced on any loan exceeds the
loan value of any interest in qualifying real property which secures
such loan, then the portion of such loan which, as of the close of any
taxable year, will be considered as a qualifying real property loan
shall be determined under the principles of section 7701(a)(19) and the
regulations thereunder.
(e) Treatment of REMIC interests as qualifying real property loans--
(1) In general. For purposes of section 593 and Sec. Sec. 1.593-4
through 1.593-10, if, for any calendar quarter, at least 95 percent of a
REMIC's assets (as determined in accordance with Sec. 1.860F-
4(e)(1)(ii) or Sec. 1.6049-7(f)(3)) are qualifying real property loans
(as defined in paragraph (b) of this section), then, for that calendar
quarter, all the regular and residual interests in that REMIC are
treated as qualifying real property loans. If less than 95 percent of a
REMIC's assets are qualifying real property loans, then a percentage of
each regular or residual interest is treated as a qualifying real
property loan. The percentage equals the percentage of the REMIC's
assets that are qualifying real property loans. See Sec. 1.860F-
4(e)(1)(ii)(B) andSec. 1.6049-7(f)(3) for information required to be
[[Page 371]]
provided to regular and residual interest holders if the 95-percent test
is not met.
(2) Treatment of REMIC assets for section 593 purposes--(i)
Manufactured housing treated as qualifying real property. For purposes
of paragraph (e)(1) of this section, the term ``qualifying real
property'' includes manufactured housing treated as a single family
residence under section 25(e)(10).
(ii) Status of cash flow investments. For purposes of paragraph
(e)(1) of this section, cash flow investments (as defined in section
860G(a)(6) and Sec. 1.860G-2(g)(1)) are treated as qualifying real
property loans.
[T.D. 6728, 29 FR 5864, May 5, 1964, as amended by T.D. 549, 43 FR
21458, May 18, 1978; T.D. 8458, 57 FR 61298, Dec. 24, 1992]
Sec. 1.594-1 Mutual savings banks conducting life insurance business.
(a) Scope of application. Section 594 applies to the case of a
mutual savings bank not having capital stock represented by shares which
conducts a life insurance business, if:
(1) The conduct of the life insurance business is authorized under
State law,
(2) The life insurance business is carried on in a separate
department of the bank,
(3) The books of account of the life insurance business are
maintained separately from other departments of the bank, and
(4) The life insurance department of the bank would, if it were
treated as a separate corporation, qualify as a life insurance company
under section 801.
(b) Computation of tax. In the case of a mutual savings bank
conducting a life insurance business to which section 594 is applicable,
the tax upon such bank consists of the sum of the following:
(1) A partial tax computed under section 11 upon the taxable income
of the bank determined without regard to any items of income or
deduction properly allocable to the life insurance department, and
(2) A partial tax computed on the income (or, in the case of taxable
years beginning before January 1, 1955, the taxable income (as defined
in section 803)) of the life insurance department determined without
regard to any items of income or deduction not properly allocable to
such department, at the rates and in the manner provided in subchapter L
(section 801 and following), chapter 1 of the Code, with respect to life
insurance companies.
Sec. 1.595-1 Treatment of foreclosed property by certain creditors.
(a) Nonrecognition of gain or loss on the acquisition of security
property by certain creditors--(1) In general. Section 595(a) provides
that in the case of a creditor which is an organization described in
section 593(a) (that is, a mutual savings bank not having capital stock
represented by shares, a domestic building and loan association, or a
cooperative bank without capital stock organized and operated for mutual
purposes and without profit), no gain or loss shall be recognized, and
no debt shall be considered as becoming worthless or partially worthless
for purposes of section 166 (relating to bad debts), as the result of a
transaction by which such creditor bids in at foreclosure, or reduces to
ownership or possession by agreement or process of law, any property
(whether real or personal, tangible or intangible) which was security
for the payment of any indebtedness (whether or not a qualifying real
property loan as defined in section 593(e)(1)). The treatment provided
by section 595(a) is mandatory (regardless of whether such creditor
utilizes the specific deduction or reserve method of accounting for bad
debts) if, for the taxable year in which the property is bid in at
foreclosure, or reduced to ownership or possession by agreement or
process of law, the creditor is an organization described in section
593(a), even though the creditor subsequently becomes an organization
not described in section 593(a). For definition of the terms domestic
building and loan association and cooperative bank for taxable years
beginning after October 16, 1962, see paragraphs (19) and (32),
respectively, of section 7701(a).
(2) Effective date. Section 595 applies to any transaction
(described in subparagraph (1) of this paragraph) occurring after
December 31, 1962, except that such section does not apply to any such
transaction in which the taxable event determined without regard to
[[Page 372]]
section 595 (that is, the sale or exchange to the creditor of the
security property by reason of the default or anticipated default of the
debtor) occurred before January 1, 1963.
(b) Rules for determining when security property is reduced to
ownership or possession by agreement or process of law--(1) Ownership or
possession. For purposes of this section, security property shall be
considered as reduced to ownership or possession by agreement or process
of law on the earliest date on which the creditor, by reason of the
default or anticipated default of the debtor:
(i) Acquires, by agreement or process of law, a title to, or a right
or interest in, the security property which under local law is
indefeasible and which the creditor can validly dispose of apart from
the indebtedness which the property secures, or
(ii) Acquires, by agreement or process of law, an enforceable right
to direct the use to which the security property shall be put,
including, in the case of real property, whether or not the property
shall continue to be occupied by the debtor who has defaulted
(regardless of whether such creditor has obtained indefeasible title to
the property), or
(iii) Sells or otherwise disposes of the security property or any
interest therein.
(2) Agreement or process of law. The reduction of security property
to ownership or possession by agreement includes, where valid under
local law, such methods as voluntary conveyance from the debtor
(including a conveyance directly to the Federal Housing Commissioner)
and abandonment to the creditor. The reduction of security property to
ownership or possession by process of law includes foreclosure
proceedings in which a competitive bid is entered, such as foreclosure
by judicial sale or by power of sale contained in the loan agreement
without recourse to the courts, as well as those types of foreclosure
proceedings in which a competitive bid is not entered, such as strict
foreclosure and foreclosure by entry and possession, by writ of entry,
or by publication or notice.
(c) Examples. The provisions of paragraphs (a) and (b) of this
section may be illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. On January 31, 1963, X, a creditor which is an
organization described in section 593(a), purchases at a foreclosure
sale residential real property which was security for a debt owing to X,
and with respect to which the debtor has defaulted. Under local law,
there is a 1-year statutory redemption period (during which period the
debtor is entitled to remain in possession) so that X must wait until
February 1, 1964, to obtain indefeasible title to the property. No gain
or loss is recognized by reason of the purchase at the foreclosure sale
on January 31, 1963. However, the date on which the security property is
considered as reduced to ownership or possession by agreement or process
of law is February 1, 1964. If, under local law, there were no statutory
redemption period so that X obtained indefeasible title to the security
property at the foreclosure sale, the date on which the security
property would be considered as so reduced is January 31, 1963.
Furthermore, with respect to either of the preceding situations, if the
foreclosure sale had occurred on November 1, 1962 (instead of on January
31, 1963), section 595 would not apply to the transaction since the
taxable event in respect of such transaction occurred prior to January
1, 1963.
Example 2. The facts are the same as in example 1, except that
instead of purchasing the property at a foreclosure sale, X, pursuant to
the provisions of local law, enters upon the security property on
January 31, 1963, and acquires an enforceable right to direct whether
the property shall continue to be occupied by the debtor. X does not
obtain indefeasible title to the property until February 1, 1964. The
date on which the security property is considered as reduced to
ownership or possession by agreement or process of law is January 31,
1963.
(d) Basis of acquired property. Section 595(c) provides that the
basis of any property to which section 595(a) applies (hereinafter
referred to as acquired property) shall be the adjusted basis of the
indebtedness for which such property was security, determined as of the
date of acquisition of such property, properly increased for costs of
acquisition. The date of acquisition is the date, determined under
paragraph (b) of this section, on which the security property is reduced
to ownership or possession by agreement or process of law. Costs of
acquisition are expenditures incurred by the creditor (for example, fees
for an attorney, master, trustee, auctioneer, for publication, acquiring
title, clearing liens, filing and
[[Page 373]]
recording, and court costs) which are directly related to the
foreclosure sale or proceeding, or to the other process used to reduce
the security property to ownership or possession, or both, by agreement
or process of law. For purposes of determining the adjusted basis of the
indebtedness for which the acquired property was security, there shall
be included the amount of any unpaid interest with respect to such
indebtedness, but only to the extent that it has been included in gross
income. The basis of the acquired property, as determined under this
paragraph, shall be adjusted in accordance with the rules provided in
paragraph (e) of this section.
(e) Characteristics of acquired property--(1) Depreciation; decline
in fair market value. Section 595(b) provides, in part, that for
purposes of section 166 (relating to bad debts) acquired property shall
be considered as property having the same characteristics as the
indebtedness for which such property was security. Thus, no deduction
for exhaustion, wear and tear, obsolescence, amortization, or depletion
shall be allowed to a creditor with respect to acquired property.
However, if, at any time, the adjusted basis of the acquired property
exceeds the fair market value of such property (determined by proper
appraisal and without regard to any outstanding right of redemption),
and the creditor can establish (in the same manner as worthlessness in
whole or in part is established for purposes of section 166) that an
amount equal to any portion of such excess will not be collected with
respect to the indebtedness for which such property was security, the
creditor may treat such portion, under the provisions of section 166, as
a worthless debt. In such case, the basis of the acquired property shall
be reduced by the amount treated as a worthless debt.
(2) Example. The provisions of subparagraph (1) of this paragraph
may be illustrated by the following example:
Example. X Corporation, a creditor which is an organization
described in section 593(a), makes its returns on the basis of the
calendar year and the reserve method of accounting for bad debts. In
1963, A defaults in his payments on a debt owed to X which is secured by
residential real property. X reduces the property to ownership or
possession by agreement or process of law by bidding it in at a
foreclosure sale for $23,000. The adjusted basis of the indebtedness at
the date of acquisition of the property (increased for costs of
acquisition) is $25,000, and this amount becomes the basis of the
acquired property. X obtains a deficiency judgment against A for $2,000.
Later in 1963, a proper appraisal enables X to establish that the fair
market value of the property is $18,000. X is also able to establish
(under the rules of section 166 and the regulations thereunder) that due
to A's poor financial condition only $1,000 can be collected on the
outstanding deficiency judgment. For the year 1963, X may charge its bad
debt reserve for $6,000, computed as follows:
Basis of acquired property................................... $25,000
Less: Fair market value of acquired property................. 18,000
----------
Excess....................................................... 7,000
Less: Collectible portion of deficiency judgment............. 1,000
----------
Portion of excess treated as worthless debt.................. 6,000
(3) Capital improvements made after date of acquisition not treated
as acquired property. Except as provided in subparagraph (4) of this
paragraph, the term acquired property does not include capital
improvements made after the date of (acquisition within the meaning of
paragraph (d) of this section) of the property. Thus, the applicable
deduction for exhaustion, wear and tear, obsolescence, amortization, or
depletion shall be allowed, if otherwise allowable, for improvements
which are made by the creditor with respect to acquired property and
which are properly chargeable to the capital account. If the creditor
sells or otherwise disposes of the acquired property with such capital
improvements, any amount realized by reason of such sale or other
disposition shall be allocated in proportion to the respective fair
market values of the acquired property and such capital improvements.
The portion of the amount realized which is allocable to the acquired
property shall be treated in accordance with the rules prescribed in
subparagraph (6) of this paragraph. The portion of the amount realized
which is allocable to such capital improvements shall be treated under
the applicable rules governing the sale or other disposition of such
property and without regard to section 595.
(4) Treatment of minor capital improvements as acquired property. A
creditor
[[Page 374]]
may treat any minor capital improvements which it makes to a particular
acquired property after the date of acquisition (within the meaning of
paragraph (d) of this section) in the same manner as the acquired
property, provided such creditor treats all minor capital improvements
with respect to that particular acquired property in such manner. For
purposes of section 595, a capital improvement shall be considered as
minor only if the cost of such improvement does not exceed $3,000.
(5) Records for capital improvements. For purposes of subparagraphs
(3) and (4) of this paragraph, the creditor must maintain such records
as are necessary to clearly reflect, with respect to each particular
acquired property, the cost of each capital improvement and whether the
taxpayer treated minor capital improvements with respect to such
property in the same manner as the acquired property.
(6) Amounts realized with respect to acquired property. Section
595(b) provides, in part, that any amount realized with respect to
acquired property shall be treated as a payment on account of the
indebtedness for which such property was security, and any loss with
respect thereto shall be treated as a bad debt to which the provisions
of section 166 (relating to bad debts) apply. An amount realized with
respect to acquired property means an amount representing a recovery of
capital, such as proceeds from the sale or other disposition of the
property, payments on the original indebtedness made by or on behalf of
the debtor (including amounts received under an insurance contract with
the Federal Housing Administration or a guarantee by the Veterans'
Administration), and collections on a deficiency judgment obtained
against the debtor (other than amounts treated as interest under
applicable local law). Amounts realized with respect to acquired
property include amounts which otherwise would be treated in the manner
prescribed in section 351 (relating to transfer to a corporation
controlled by transferor), section 354 (relating to exchanges of stock
and securities in certain reorganizations), section 453 (relating to
installment method), section 1031 (relating to exchange of property held
for productive use or for investment), or section 1033 (relating to
involuntary conversions). For purposes of section 595(b), if a
corporation distributes acquired property in a distribution to which
section 311 (relating to taxability of corporation on distribution) or
section 336 (relating to nonrecognition of gain or loss to a corporation
on distribution of its property in partial or complete liquidation)
applies, the fair market value of the acquired property at the time of
the distribution shall be treated as an amount realized with respect to
such property. However, no amount shall be considered realized by reason
of the distribution or transfer of acquired property in a transaction to
which section 381(a) (relating to carryovers in certain corporate
acquisitions) applies, and in the case of such a distribution or
transfer the acquired property shall be treated by the distributee or
transferee as having the same characteristics as it had in the hands of
the distributor or transferor at the time of such distribution or
transfer. The following rules shall apply to amounts realized with
respect to acquired property:
(i) Any amount realized shall be applied against and reduce the
adjusted basis of the acquired property, and to the extent that such
amount exceeds the adjusted basis, it shall, in the case of a creditor
using the specific deduction method of accounting for bad debts, be
included in gross income as ordinary income, or, in the case of a
creditor using the reserve method of accounting for bad debts, be
credited to the appropriate bad debt reserve (that is, the reserve for
losses on qualifying real property loans or the reserve for losses on
nonqualifying loans). Any amounts credited during the taxable year to a
reserve for bad debts pursuant to this subdivision shall not be
considered as a part of the addition under section 593 for such year,
but shall be included in the balance of the reserve for purposes of
computing such addition to the reserve for such taxable year. Thus, for
example, an amount credited to the reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans during a taxable year shall not be considered as a part
of the addition to such reserve
[[Page 375]]
computed under the percentage of taxable income method. However, the
amount of such credit shall be included in the balance of such reserve
for the purpose of determining the amount necessary to increase the
balance of such reserve (as of the close of such taxable year) to an
amount equal to 3 percent of qualifying real property loans and for the
purpose of determining whether such balance exceeds 6 percent of such
loans.
(ii) If an amount realized on the sale or other disposition of the
acquired property is insufficient to restore to the creditor the
adjusted basis of the property, the difference between such adjusted
basis and such amount realized shall be treated as a bad debt to which
the provisions of section 166 apply. If the creditor subsequently
realizes an additional amount with respect to the original indebtedness
or the acquired property, such additional amount shall be treated as the
recovery of a bad debt.
(7) Treatment of rents, similar amounts, and expenses. Section 595
does not change the treatment of rents, royalties, dividends, interest,
or similar amounts received or accrued by the creditor with respect to
acquired property, nor does it change the treatment of expenses incurred
with respect to such property. (See, however, subparagraph (1) of this
paragraph for treatment of depreciation, etc.) Thus, for example, if the
acquired property is a governmental obligation within the meaning of
section 103 (relating to interest on certain governmental obligations),
interest payments received by the creditor with respect to such
obligation would not be included in gross income.
(8) Examples. The provisions of subparagraphs (6) and (7) of this
paragraph may be illustrated by the following examples:
Example 1. (i) Facts. X Corporation, a creditor which is an
organization described in section 593(a), uses the reserve method of
accounting for bad debts. On May 1, 1964, X reduces to ownership or
possession by agreement or process of law improved real property which
is security for an indebtedness of A which is in default. On the date of
acquisition there remains unpaid on the indebtedness $20,000 principal
and $700 interest. X has previously included the $700 interest in gross
income. Subsequent to acquisition, X incurs expenses totaling $500 for
maintenance, and during the period June 1 through September 30, 1964,
rents the property for a total rental of $400. Under local law, X is
accountable to A for the rents received and A is accountable to X for
the expenses incurred. There are no other receipts or expenses until
October 1, 1964, at which time X sells the acquired property for
$22,000. Under local law, A is not entitled to any portion of the sales
proceeds.
(ii) Treatment of rents, expenses, and sales proceeds. X would treat
rents, expenses, and sales proceeds in the following manner:
Basis of acquired property at acquisition (adjusted basis of $20,700
indebtedness, i.e., $20,000 principal plus $700 interest)...
Plus: Expenses charged to debtor............................. 500
----------
21,200
Less: Rents credited to debtor............................... 400
----------
Adjusted basis of acquired property at sale.................. 20,800
Less: Portion of $22,000 sales proceeds applied in reduction 20,800
of adjusted basis of acquired property......................
----------
0
==========
Portion of sales proceeds credited to reserve for losses on 1,200
qualifying real property loans ($22,000 minus $20,800)......
(iii) Creditor using specific deduction method. If instead of using
the reserve method of accounting for bad debts X used the specific
deduction method, the $1,200 portion of the sales proceeds would be
treated as ordinary income.
Example 2. (i) Facts. The facts are the same as in example 1 except
that under local law X is not accountable to A for any portion of the
rents received and A is not accountable to X for the expenses incurred
by X.
(ii) Treatment of rents and expenses. X includes in gross income the
total rent receipts of $400 and deducts (if otherwise allowable) the
expenses of $500.
(iii) Treatment of sales proceeds. As the result of the sale of the
acquired property, X credits $1,300 to the reserve for losses on
qualifying real property loans, computed as follows:
Basis of acquired property at acquisition and at date of sale $20,700
(adjusted basis of indebtedness, i.e., $20,000 principal
plus $700 interest).........................................
Less: Portion of $22,000 sales proceeds applied in reduction 20,700
of adjusted basis of acquired property......................
----------
0
==========
Portion of sales proceeds credited to reserve for losses on 1,300
qualifying real property loans ($22,000 minus $20,700)......
(iv) Creditor using specific deduction method. If instead of using
the reserve method of accounting for bad debts X used the specific
deduction method, the $1,300 portion of the
[[Page 376]]
sales proceeds would be treated as ordinary income.
Example 3. (i) Facts. The facts are the same in example 1 except
that X sells the acquired property for $15,000.
(ii) Treatment of rents, expenses, and sales proceeds. X would treat
rents, expenses, and sales proceeds in the following manner:
Basis of acquired property at acquisition (adjusted basis of $20,700
indebtedness, i.e., $20,000 principal plus $700 interest)...
Plus: Expenses charged to debtor............................. 500
----------
21,200
Less: Rents credited to debtor............................... 400
Adjusted basis of acquired property at sale.................. 20,800
Less: Portion of $15,000 sales proceeds applied in reduction 15,000
of adjusted basis of acquired property......................
----------
Amount charged to reserve for losses on qualifying real 5,800
property loans..............................................
(iii) Creditor using specific deduction method. If instead of using
the reserve method of accounting for bad debts X used the specific
deduction method, the excess of $5,800 would be allowed as a specific
bad debt deduction.
[T.D. 6814, 30 FR 4473, Apr. 7, 1965]
Sec. 1.596-1 Limitation on dividends received deduction.
(a) In general. For taxable years beginning after July 11, 1969, in
the case of mutual savings banks, domestic building and loan
associations, and cooperative banks, if the addition to the reserve for
losses on qualifying real property loans for the taxable year is
determined under section 593(b)(2) (relating to the percentage of
taxable income method), the total amount allowed as a deduction with
respect to dividends received under part VIII, subchapter B, chapter 1,
subtitle A of the Code (section 241 et seq.) (determined without regard
to section 596 and this section) for such taxable year is reduced as
provided by this section. In such case, the dividends received deduction
otherwise determined under part VIII, subchapter B, chapter 1, subtitle
A of the Code, is reduced by an amount equal to the applicable
percentage for such year (determined solely under subparagraphs (A) and
(B) of section 593(b)(2) and the regulations thereunder) of such total
amount. For the rule under which a mutual savings bank, domestic
building and loan association, or cooperative bank is deemed to have
determined the addition to its reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans for the taxable year under section 593(b)(2), see Sec.
1.593-6A(a)(2).
(b) Example. The provisions of this section may be illustrated by
the following example:
Example. X Corporation, a domestic building and loan association,
determines the addition to its reserve for losses on qualifying real
property loans under section 593(b)(2) for its taxable year beginning in
1971. During that taxable year, X Corporation received a total of
$100,000 as dividends from domestic corporations subject to tax under
chapter 1 of the Code. X Corporation received no other dividends during
the taxable year. Under part VIII, subchapter B, chapter 1, subtitle A
of the Code, a deduction, determined without regard to section 596 and
this section, of $85,000 would be allowed with respect to the dividends.
For the taxable year, the applicable percentage, determined under
subparagraphs (A) and (B) of section 593(b)(2), is 54 percent. Under
section 596 and this section, the amount allowed as a deduction under
section 243 and the regulations thereunder is reduced by $45,900 (54
percent of $85,000) to $39,100 ($85,000 less $45,900).
(c) Dividends received by members of a controlled group. If a thrift
institution that computes a deduction under section 593(b)(2) is a
member of a controlled group of corporations (within the meaning of
section 1563(a), determined by substituting 50 percent for 80 percent
each place it appears therein) and if the thrift institution, without a
bona fide business purpose, transfers stock, directly or indirectly, to
another member of the group, the Commissioner may allocate any dividends
with respect to the stock to the thrift institution. If the Commissioner
allocates a dividend to a thrifty institution under this paragraph (c),
the Commissioner will also make appropriate correlative adjustments to
the income of any other member of the group involved in the allocation,
at a time and in a manner consistent with the procedures of Sec. 1.482-
1(d)(2). This paragraph (c) applies to taxable years ending on or after
August 30, 1975.
[T.D. 7149, 36 FR 20944, Nov. 2, 1971, as amended by T.D. 7631, 44 FR
40496, July 11, 1979]
Sec. 1.597-1 Definitions.
For purposes of the regulations under section 597--
(a) Unless the context otherwise requires, the terms consolidated
group,
[[Page 377]]
member and subsidiary have the meanings provided in Sec. 1.1502-1; and
(b) The following terms have the meanings provided below--
Acquiring. The term Acquiring means a corporation that is a
transferee in a Taxable Transfer, other than a deemed transferee in a
Taxable Transfer described in Sec. 1.597-5(b).
Agency. The term Agency means the Resolution Trust Corporation, the
Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, any similar instrumentality of
the United States government, and any predecessor or successor of the
foregoing (including the Federal Savings and Loan Insurance
Corporation).
Agency Control. An Institution or entity is under Agency Control if
Agency is conservator or receiver of the Institution or entity, or if
Agency has the right to appoint any of the Institution's or entity's
directors.
Agency Obligation. The term Agency Obligation means a debt
instrument that Agency issues to an Institution or to a direct or
indirect owner of an Institution.
Bridge Bank. The term Bridge Bank means an Institution that is
organized by Agency to hold assets and liabilities of another
Institution and that continues the operation of the other Institution's
business pending its acquisition or liquidation, and that is any of the
following--
(1) A national bank chartered by the Comptroller of the Currency
under section 11(n) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act (12 U.S.C.
1821(n)) or section 21A(b)(10)(A) of the Federal Home Loan Bank Act (12
U.S.C. 1441a(b)(10)(A)) or any successor sections;
(2) A Federal savings association chartered by the Director of the
Office of Thrift Supervision under section 21A(b)(10)(A) of the Federal
Home Loan Bank Act (12 U.S.C. 1441a(b)(10)(A)) or any successor section;
or
(3) A similar Institution chartered under any other statutory
provisions.
Consolidated Subsidiary. The term Consolidated Subsidiary means a
member of the consolidated group of which an Institution is a member
that bears the same relationship to the Institution that the members of
a consolidated group bear to their common parent under section
1504(a)(1).
Continuing Equity. An Institution has Continuing Equity for any
taxable year if, on the last day of the taxable year, the Institution is
not (1) a Bridge Bank, (2) in Agency receivership, or (3) treated as a
New Entity.
Controlled Entity. The term Controlled Entity means an entity under
Agency Control.
Federal Financial Assistance (FFA). The term Federal Financial
Assistance (FFA), as defined by section 597(c), means any money or
property provided by Agency to an Institution or to a direct or indirect
owner of stock in an Institution under section 406(f) of the National
Housing Act (12 U.S.C. 1729(f)), section 21A(b)(4) of the Federal Home
Loan Bank Act (12 U.S.C. 1441a(b)(4)), section 11(f) or 13(c) of the
Federal Deposit Insurance Act (12 U.S.C. 1821(f), 1823(c)), or under any
similar provision of law. Any such money or property is FFA, regardless
of whether the Institution or any of its affiliates issues Agency a note
or other obligation, stock, warrants, or other rights to acquire stock
in connection with Agency's provision of the money or property. FFA
includes Net Worth Assistance, Loss Guarantee payments, yield
maintenance payments, cost to carry or cost of funds reimbursement
payments, expense reimbursement or indemnity payments, and interest
(including original issue discount) on an Agency Obligation.
Institution. The term Institution means an entity that is, or
immediately before being placed under Agency Control was, a bank or
domestic building and loan association within the meaning of section 597
(including a Bridge Bank). Except as otherwise provided in the
regulations under section 597, the term Institution includes a New
Entity or Acquiring that is a bank or domestic building and loan
association within the meaning of section 597.
Loss Guarantee. The term Loss Guarantee means an agreement pursuant
to which Agency or a Controlled Entity guarantees or agrees to pay an
Institution a specified amount upon the disposition or charge-off (in
whole or in part) of specific assets, an agreement pursuant to which an
Institution has a
[[Page 378]]
right to put assets to Agency or a Controlled Entity at a specified
price, or a similar arrangement.
Net Worth Assistance. The term Net Worth Assistance means money or
property (including an Agency Obligation to the extent it has a fixed
principal amount) that Agency provides as an integral part of a Taxable
Transfer, other than FFA that accrues after the date of the Taxable
Transfer. For example, Net Worth Assistance does not include Loss
Guarantee payments, yield maintenance payments, cost to carry or cost of
funds reimbursement payments, or expense reimbursement or indemnity
payments. An Agency Obligation is considered to have a fixed principal
amount notwithstanding an agreement providing for its adjustment after
issuance to reflect a more accurate determination of the condition of
the Institution at the time of the acquisition.
New Entity. The term New Entity means the new corporation that is
treated as purchasing all of the assets of an Old Entity in a Taxable
Transfer described in Sec. 1.597-5(b).
Old Entity. The term Old Entity means the Institution or
Consolidated Subsidiary that is treated as selling all of its assets in
a Taxable Transfer described in Sec. 1.597-5(b).
Residual Entity. The term Residual Entity means the entity that
remains after an Institution transfers deposit liabilities to a Bridge
Bank.
Taxable Transfer. The term Taxable Transfer has the meaning provided
in Sec. 1.597-5(a)(1).
[T.D. 8641, 60 FR 66094, Dec. 21, 1995]
Sec. 1.597-2 Taxation of Federal financial assistance.
(a) Inclusion in income--(1) In general. Except as otherwise
provided in the regulations under section 597, all FFA is includible as
ordinary income to the recipient at the time the FFA is received or
accrued in accordance with the recipient's method of accounting. The
amount of FFA received or accrued is the amount of any money, the fair
market value of any property (other than an Agency Obligation), and the
issue price of any Agency Obligation (determined under Sec. 1.597-
3(c)(2)). An Institution (and not the nominal recipient) is treated as
receiving directly any FFA that Agency provides in a taxable year to a
direct or indirect shareholder of the Institution, to the extent money
or property is transferred to the Institution pursuant to an agreement
with Agency.
(2) Cross references. See paragraph (c) of this section for rules
regarding the timing of inclusion of certain FFA. See paragraph (d) of
this section for additional rules regarding the treatment of FFA
received in connection with transfers of money or property to Agency or
a Controlled Entity, or paid pursuant to a Loss Guarantee. See Sec.
1.597-5(c)(1) for additional rules regarding the inclusion of Net Worth
Assistance in the income of an Institution.
(b) Basis of property that is FFA. If FFA consists of property, the
Institution's basis in the property equals the fair market value of the
property (other than an Agency Obligation) or the issue price of the
Agency Obligation, as determined under Sec. 1.597-3(c)(2).
(c) Timing of inclusion of certain FFA--(1) Scope. This paragraph
(c) limits the amount of FFA an Institution must include in income
currently under certain circumstances and provides rules for the
deferred inclusion in income of amounts in excess of those limits. This
paragraph (c) does not apply to a New Entity or Acquiring.
(2) Amount currently included in income by an Institution without
Continuing Equity. The amount of FFA an Institution without Continuing
Equity must include in income in a taxable year under paragraph (a)(1)
of this section is limited to the sum of--
(i) The excess at the beginning of the taxable year of the
Institution's liabilities over the adjusted bases of the Institution's
assets; and
(ii) The amount by which the excess for the taxable year of the
Institution's deductions allowed by chapter 1 of the Internal Revenue
Code (other than net operating and capital loss carryovers) over its
gross income (determined without regard to FFA) is greater than the
excess at the beginning of the taxable year of the adjusted bases of the
Institution's assets over the Institution's liabilities.
(3) Amount currently included in income by an Institution with
Continuing
[[Page 379]]
Equity. The amount of FFA an Institution with Continuing Equity must
include in income in a taxable year under paragraph (a)(1) of this
section is limited to the sum of--
(i) The excess at the beginning of the taxable year of the
Institution's liabilities over the adjusted bases of the Institution's
assets;
(ii) The greater of--
(A) The excess for the taxable year of the Institution's deductions
allowed by chapter 1 of the Internal Revenue Code (other than net
operating and capital loss carryovers) over its gross income (determined
without regard to FFA); or
(B) The excess for the taxable year of the deductions allowed by
chapter 1 of the Internal Revenue Code (other than net operating and
capital loss carryovers) of the consolidated group of which the
Institution is a member on the last day of the Institution's taxable
year over the group's gross income (determined without regard to FFA);
and
(iii) The excess of the amount of any net operating loss carryover
of the Institution (or in the case of a carryover from a consolidated
return year of the Institution's current consolidated group, the net
operating loss carryover of the group) to the taxable year over the
amount described in paragraph (c)(3)(i) of this section.
(4) Deferred FFA--(i) Maintenance of account. An Institution must
establish a deferred FFA account commencing in the first taxable year in
which it receives FFA that is not currently included in income under
paragraph (c)(2) or (c)(3) of this section, and must maintain that
account in accordance with the requirements of this paragraph (c)(4).
The Institution must add the amount of any FFA that is not currently
included in income under paragraph (c)(2) or (c)(3) of this section to
its deferred FFA account. The Institution must decrease the balance of
its deferred FFA account by the amount of deferred FFA included in
income under paragraphs (c)(4)(ii), (iv) and (v) of this section. (See
also paragraph (d)(5)(i)(B) of this section for other adjustments that
decrease the deferred FFA account.) If, under paragraph (c)(3) of this
section, FFA is not currently included in income in a taxable year, the
Institution thereafter must maintain its deferred FFA account on a FIFO
(first in, first out) basis (e.g., for purposes of the first sentence of
paragraph (c)(4)(iv) of this section).
(ii) Deferred FFA recapture. In any taxable year in which an
Institution has a balance in its deferred FFA account, it must include
in income an amount equal to the lesser of the amount described in
paragraph (c)(4)(iii) of this section or the balance in its deferred FFA
account.
(iii) Annual recapture amount--(A) Institutions without Continuing
Equity--(1) In general. In the case of an Institution without Continuing
Equity, the amount described in this paragraph (c)(4)(iii) is the amount
by which--
(i) The excess for the taxable year of the Institution's deductions
allowed by chapter 1 of the Internal Revenue Code (other than net
operating and capital loss carryovers) over its gross income (taking
into account FFA included in income under paragraph (c)(2) of this
section); is greater than
(ii) The Institution's remaining equity as of the beginning of the
taxable year.
(2) Remaining equity. The Institution's remaining equity is--
(i) The amount at the beginning of the taxable year in which the
deferred FFA account was established equal to the adjusted bases of the
Institution's assets minus the Institution's liabilities (which amount
may be positive or negative); plus
(ii) The Institution's taxable income (computed without regard to
any carryover from any other year) in any subsequent taxable year or
years; minus
(iii) The excess in any subsequent taxable year or years of the
Institution's deductions allowed by chapter 1 of the Internal Revenue
Code (other than net operating and capital loss carryovers) over its
gross income.
(B) Institutions with Continuing Equity. In the case of an
Institution with Continuing Equity, the amount described in this
paragraph (c)(4)(iii) is the amount by which the Institution's
deductions allowed by chapter 1 of the Internal Revenue Code (other than
net operating and capital loss carryovers) exceed its gross income
(taking into
[[Page 380]]
account FFA included in income under paragraph (c)(3) of this section).
(iv) Additional deferred FFA recapture by an Institution with
Continuing Equity. To the extent that, as of the end of a taxable year,
the cumulative amount of FFA deferred under paragraph (c)(3) of this
section that an Institution with Continuing Equity has recaptured under
this paragraph (c)(4) is less than the cumulative amount of FFA deferred
under paragraph (c)(3) of this section that the Institution would have
recaptured if that FFA had been included in income ratably over the six
taxable years immediately following the taxable year of deferral, the
Institution must include that difference in income for the taxable year.
An Institution with Continuing Equity must include in income the balance
of its deferred FFA account in the taxable year in which it liquidates,
ceases to do business, transfers (other than to a Bridge Bank)
substantially all of its assets and liabilities, or is deemed to
transfer all of its assets under Sec. 1.597-5(b).
(v) Optional accelerated recapture of deferred FFA. An Institution
that has a deferred FFA account may include in income the balance of its
deferred FFA account on its timely filed (including extensions) original
income tax return for any taxable year that it is not under Agency
Control. The balance of its deferred FFA account is income on the last
day of that year.
(5) Exceptions to limitations on use of losses. In computing an
Institution's taxable income or alternative minimum taxable income for a
taxable year, sections 56(d)(1), 382 and 383 and Sec. Sec. 1.1502-15,
1.1502-21, and 1.1502-22 (or Sec. Sec. 1.1502-15A, 1.1502-21A, and
1.1502-22A, as appropriate) do not limit the use of the attributes of
the Institution to the extent, if any, that the inclusion of FFA
(including recaptured FFA) in income results in taxable income or
alternative minimum taxable income (determined without regard to this
paragraph (c)(5)) for the taxable year. This paragraph (c)(5) does not
apply to any limitation under section 382 or 383 or Sec. 1.1502-15,
1.1502-21 or 1.1502-22 (or Sec. 1.1502-15A, 1.1502-21A or 1.1502-22A,
as appropriate) that arose in connection with or prior to a corporation
becoming a Consolidated Subsidiary of the Institution.
(6) Operating rules--(i) Bad debt reserves. For purposes of
paragraphs (c)(2), (c)(3) and (c)(4) of this section, the adjusted bases
of an Institution's assets are reduced by the amount of the
Institution's reserves for bad debts under section 585 or 593, other
than supplemental reserves under section 593.
(ii) Aggregation of Consolidated Subsidiaries. For purposes of this
paragraph (c), an Institution is treated as a single entity that
includes the income, expenses, assets, liabilities, and attributes of
its Consolidated Subsidiaries, with appropriate adjustments to prevent
duplication.
(iii) Alternative minimum tax. To compute the alternative minimum
taxable income attributable to FFA of an Institution for any taxable
year under section 55, the rules of this section, and related rules, are
applied by using alternative minimum tax basis, deductions, and all
other items required to be taken into account. All other alternative
minimum tax provisions continue to apply.
(7) Earnings and profits. FFA that is not currently included in
income under this paragraph (c) is included in earnings and profits for
all purposes of the Internal Revenue Code to the extent and at the time
it is included in income under this paragraph (c).
(d) Transfers of money or property to Agency, and property subject
to a Loss Guarantee--(1) Transfers of property to Agency. The transfer
of property to Agency or a Controlled Entity is a taxable sale or
exchange in which the Institution is treated as realizing an amount
equal to--
(i) The property's fair market value; or
(ii) For property subject to a Loss Guarantee, the greater of the
property's fair market value or the guaranteed value or price at which
the property can be put at the time of transfer.
(2) FFA with respect to property covered by a Loss Guarantee other
than on transfer to Agency. (i) FFA provided pursuant to a Loss
Guarantee with respect to covered property is included in the amount
realized with respect to the property to the extent the total
[[Page 381]]
amount realized does not exceed the greater of--
(A) The property's fair market value; or
(B) The guaranteed value or price at which the property can be put
at the time of transfer.
(ii) For the purposes of this paragraph (d)(2), references to an
amount realized include amounts obtained in whole or partial
satisfaction of loans, amounts obtained by virtue of charging off or
marking to market covered property, and other amounts similarly related
to property, whether or not disposed of.
(3) Treatment of FFA received in exchange for property. FFA included
in the amount realized for property under this paragraph (d) is not
includible in income under paragraph (a)(1) of this section. The amount
realized is treated in the same manner as if realized from a person
other than Agency or a Controlled Entity. For example, gain attributable
to FFA received with respect to a capital asset retains its character as
capital gain. Similarly, FFA received with respect to property that has
been charged off for income tax purposes is treated as a recovery to the
extent of the amount previously charged off. Any FFA provided in excess
of the amount realized under this paragraph (d) is includible in income
under paragraph (a)(1) of this section.
(4) Adjustment to FFA--(i) In general. If an Institution pays or
transfers money or property to Agency or a Controlled Entity, the amount
of money and fair market value of the property is an adjustment to its
FFA to the extent the amount paid and transferred exceeds the amount of
money and fair market value of property Agency or a Controlled Entity
provides in exchange.
(ii) Deposit insurance. This paragraph (d)(4) does not apply to
amounts paid to Agency with respect to deposit insurance.
(iii) Treatment of an interest held by Agency or a Controlled
Entity--(A) In general. For purposes of this paragraph (d), an interest
described in Sec. 1.597-3(b) is not treated as property when
transferred by the issuer to Agency or a Controlled Entity nor when
acquired from Agency or a Controlled Entity by the issuer.
(B) Dispositions to persons other than issuer. On the date Agency or
a Controlled Entity transfers an interest described in Sec. 1.597-3(b)
to a holder other than the issuer, Agency or a Controlled Entity, the
issuer is treated for purposes of this paragraph (d)(4) as having
transferred to Agency an amount of money equal to the sum of the amount
of money and the fair market value of property that was paid by the new
holder as consideration for the interest.
(iv) Consolidated groups. For purposes of this paragraph (d), an
Institution will be treated as having made any transfer to Agency or a
Controlled Entity that was made by any other member of its consolidated
group. The consolidated group must make appropriate investment basis
adjustments to the extent the member transferring money or other
property is not the member that received FFA.
(5) Manner of making adjustments to FFA--(i) Reduction of FFA and
deferred FFA. An Institution adjusts its FFA under paragraph (d)(4) of
this section by reducing in the following order and in an aggregate
amount not greater than the adjustment--
(A) The amount of any FFA that is otherwise includible in income for
the taxable year (before application of paragraph (c) of this section);
and
(B) The balance (but not below zero) in the deferred FFA account, if
any, maintained under paragraph (c)(4) of this section.
(ii) Deduction of excess amounts. If the amount of the adjustment
exceeds the sum of the amounts described in paragraph (d)(5)(i) of this
section, the Institution may deduct the excess to the extent the
deduction does not exceed the amount of FFA included in income for prior
taxable years reduced by the amount of deductions allowable under this
paragraph (d)(5)(ii) in prior taxable years.
(iii) Additional adjustments. Any adjustment to FFA in excess of the
sum of the amounts described in paragraphs (d)(5)(i) and (ii) of this
section is treated--
[[Page 382]]
(A) By an Institution other than a New Entity or Acquiring, as a
deduction of the amount in excess of FFA received that is required to be
transferred to Agency under section 11(g) of the Federal Deposit
Insurance Act (12 U.S.C. 1821(g)); or
(B) By a New Entity or Acquiring, as an adjustment to the purchase
price paid in the Taxable Transfer (see Sec. 1.338-7).
(e) Examples. The following examples illustrate the provisions of
this section:
Example 1. Timing of inclusion of FFA in income. (i) Institution M,
a calendar year taxpayer without Continuing Equity because it is in
Agency receivership, is not a member of a consolidated group and has not
been acquired in a Taxable Transfer. On January 1, 1997, M has assets
with a total adjusted basis of $100 million and total liabilities of
$120 million. M's deductions do not exceed its gross income (determined
without regard to FFA) for 1997. Agency provides $30 million of FFA to M
in 1997. The amount of this FFA that M must include in income in 1997 is
limited by Sec. 1.597-2(c)(2) to $20 million, the amount by which M's
liabilities ($120 million) exceed the total adjusted basis of its assets
($100 million) at the beginning of the taxable year. Pursuant to Sec.
1.597-2(c)(4)(i), M must establish a deferred FFA account for the
remaining $10 million.
(ii) If Agency instead lends M the $30 million, M's indebtedness to
Agency is disregarded and the results are the same as in paragraph (i)
of this Example 1. Section 597(c); Sec. Sec. 1.597-1(b) (defining FFA)
and 1.597-3(b).
Example 2. Transfer of property to Agency. (i) Institution M, a
calendar year taxpayer without Continuing Equity because it is in Agency
receivership, is not a member of a consolidated group and has not been
acquired in a Taxable Transfer. At the beginning of 1998, M's remaining
equity is $0 and M has a deferred FFA account of $10 million. Agency
does not provide any FFA to M in 1998. During the year, M transfers
property not covered by a Loss Guarantee to Agency and does not receive
any consideration. The property has an adjusted basis of $5 million and
a fair market value of $1 million at the time of the transfer. M has no
other taxable income or loss in 1998.
(ii) Under Sec. 1.597-2(d)(1), M is treated as selling the property
for $1 million, its fair market value, thus recognizing a $4 million
loss ($5 million-$1 million). In addition, because M did not receive any
consideration from Agency, under Sec. 1.597-2(d)(4) M has an adjustment
to FFA of $1 million, the amount by which the fair market value of the
transferred property ($1 million) exceeds the consideration M received
from Agency ($0). Because no FFA is provided to M in 1998, this
adjustment reduces the balance of M's deferred FFA account to $9 million
($10 million-$1 million). Section 1.597-2(d)(5)(i)(B). Because M's $4
million loss causes M's deductions to exceed its gross income by $4
million in 1998 and M has no remaining equity, under Sec. 1.597-
2(c)(4)(iii)(A) M must include $4 million of deferred FFA in income, and
must decrease the remaining $9 million balance of its deferred FFA
account by the same amount, leaving a balance of $5 million.
Example 3. Loss Guarantee. Institution Q, a calendar year taxpayer,
sells an asset covered by a Loss Guarantee to an unrelated third party
for $4,000. Q's adjusted basis in the asset at the time of sale and the
asset's guaranteed value are both $10,000. Pursuant to the Loss
Guarantee, Agency pays Q $6,000 ($10,000-$4,000). Q's amount realized
from the sale of the asset is $10,000 ($4,000 from the third party and
$6,000 from Agency). Section 1.597-2(d)(2). Q realizes no gain or loss
on the sale ($10,000-$10,000 = $0), and therefore includes none of the
$6,000 of FFA it receives pursuant to the Loss Guarantee in income.
Section 1.597-2(d)(3).
[T.D. 8641, 60 FR 66095, Dec. 21, 1995; 61 FR 12135, Mar. 25, 1996, as
amended by T.D. 8677, 61 FR 33322, June 27, 1996; T.D. 8823, 64 FR
36099, July 2, 1999; T.D. 8858, 65 FR 1237, Jan. 7, 2000; T.D. 8940, 66
FR 9929, Feb. 13, 2001]
Sec. 1.597-3 Other rules.
(a) Ownership of assets. For all income tax purposes, an Institution
is treated as the owner of all assets covered by a Loss Guarantee, yield
maintenance agreement, or cost to carry or cost of funds reimbursement
agreement, regardless of whether Agency (or a Controlled Entity)
otherwise would be treated as the owner under general principles of
income taxation.
(b) Debt and equity interests received by Agency. Debt instruments,
stock, warrants, or other rights to acquire stock of an Institution (or
any of its affiliates) that Agency or a Controlled Entity receives in
connection with a transaction in which FFA is provided are not treated
as debt, stock or other equity interests of or in the issuer for any
purpose of the Internal Revenue Code while held by Agency or a
Controlled Entity. On the date Agency or a Controlled Entity transfers
an interest described in this paragraph (b) to a holder other than
Agency or a Controlled Entity, the interest is treated
[[Page 383]]
as having been newly issued by the issuer to the holder with an issue
price equal to the sum of the amount of money and the fair market value
of property paid by the new holder in exchange for the interest.
(c) Agency Obligations--(1) In general. Except as otherwise provided
in this paragraph (c), the original issue discount rules of sections
1271 et seq. apply to Agency Obligations.
(2) Issue price of Agency Obligations provided as Net Worth
Assistance. The issue price of an Agency Obligation that is provided as
Net Worth Assistance and that bears interest at either a single fixed
rate or a qualified floating rate (and provides for no contingent
payments) is the lesser of the sum of the present values of all payments
due under the obligation, discounted at a rate equal to the applicable
Federal rate (within the meaning of section 1274(d) (1) and (3)) in
effect for the date of issuance, or the stated principal amount of the
obligation. The issue price of an Agency Obligation that bears a
qualified floating rate of interest (within the meaning of Sec. 1.1275-
5(b)) is determined by treating the obligation as bearing a fixed rate
of interest equal to the rate in effect on the date of issuance under
the obligation.
(3) Adjustments to principal amount. Except as provided in Sec.
1.597-5(d)(2)(iv), this paragraph (c)(3) applies if Agency modifies or
exchanges an Agency Obligation provided as Net Worth Assistance (or a
successor obligation). The issue price of the modified or new Agency
Obligation is determined under paragraphs (c) (1) and (2) of this
section. If the issue price is greater than the adjusted issue price of
the existing Agency Obligation, the difference is treated as FFA. If the
issue price is less than the adjusted issue price of the existing Agency
Obligation, the difference is treated as an adjustment to FFA under
Sec. 1.597-2(d)(4).
(d) Successors. To the extent necessary to effectuate the purposes
of the regulations under section 597, an entity's treatment under the
regulations applies to its successor. A successor includes a transferee
in a transaction to which section 381(a) applies or a Bridge Bank to
which another Bridge Bank transfers deposit liabilities.
(e) [Reserved]
(f) Losses and deductions with respect to covered assets. Prior to
the disposition of an asset covered by a Loss Guarantee, the asset
cannot be charged off, marked to a market value, depreciated, amortized,
or otherwise treated in a manner that supposes an actual or possible
diminution of value below the greater of the asset's highest guaranteed
value or the highest price at which the asset can be put.
(g) Anti-abuse rule. The regulations under section 597 must be
applied in a manner consistent with the purposes of section 597.
Accordingly, if, in structuring or engaging in any transaction, a
principal purpose is to achieve a tax result that is inconsistent with
the purposes of section 597 and the regulations thereunder, the
Commissioner can make appropriate adjustments to income, deductions and
other items that would be consistent with those purposes.
[T.D. 8641, 60 FR 66097, Dec. 21, 1995, as amended by T.D. 9048, 68 FR
12290, Mar. 14, 2003]
Sec. 1.597-4 Bridge Banks and Agency Control.
(a) Scope. This section provides rules that apply to a Bridge Bank
or other Institution under Agency Control and to transactions in which
an Institution transfers deposit liabilities (whether or not the
Institution also transfers assets) to a Bridge Bank.
(b) Status as taxpayer. A Bridge Bank or other Institution under
Agency Control is a corporation within the meaning of section 7701(a)(3)
for all purposes of the Internal Revenue Code and is subject to all
Internal Revenue Code provisions that generally apply to corporations,
including those relating to methods of accounting and to requirements
for filing returns, even if Agency owns stock of the Institution.
(c) No section 382 ownership change. The imposition of Agency
Control, the cancellation of Institution stock by Agency, a transaction
in which an Institution transfers deposit liabilities to a Bridge Bank,
and an election under paragraph (g) of this section are disregarded in
determining whether an ownership change has occurred within the meaning
of section 382(g).
[[Page 384]]
(d) Transfers to Bridge Banks--(1) In general. Except as otherwise
provided in paragraph (g) of this section, the rules of this paragraph
(d) apply to transfers to Bridge Banks. In general, a Bridge Bank and
its associated Residual Entity are together treated as the successor
entity to the transferring Institution. If an Institution transfers
deposit liabilities to a Bridge Bank (whether or not it also transfers
assets), the Institution recognizes no gain or loss on the transfer and
the Bridge Bank succeeds to the transferring Institution's basis in any
transferred assets. The associated Residual Entity retains its basis in
any assets it continues to hold. Immediately after the transfer, the
Bridge Bank succeeds to and takes into account the transferring
Institution's items described in section 381(c) (subject to the
conditions and limitations specified in section 381(c)), taxpayer
identification number (``TIN''), deferred FFA account, and account
receivable for future FFA as described in paragraph (g)(4)(ii) of this
section. The Bridge Bank also succeeds to and continues the transferring
Institution's taxable year.
(2) Transfers to a Bridge Bank from multiple Institutions. If two or
more Institutions transfer deposit liabilities to the same Bridge Bank,
the rules in paragraph (d)(1) of this section are modified to the extent
provided in this paragraph (d)(2). The Bridge Bank succeeds to the TIN
and continues the taxable year of the Institution that transfers the
largest amount of deposits. The taxable years of the other transferring
Institutions close at the time of the transfer. If all the transferor
Institutions are members of the same consolidated group, the Bridge
Bank's carryback of losses to the Institution that transfers the largest
amount of deposits is not limited by section 381(b)(3). The limitations
of section 381(b)(3) do apply to the Bridge Bank's carrybacks of losses
to all other transferor Institutions. If the transferor Institutions are
not all members of the same consolidated group, the limitations of
section 381(b)(3) apply with respect to all transferor Institutions. See
paragraph (g)(6)(ii) of this section for additional rules that apply if
two or more Institutions that are not members of the same consolidated
group transfer deposit liabilities to the same Bridge Bank.
(e) Treatment of Bridge Bank and Residual Entity as a single entity.
A Bridge Bank and its associated Residual Entity or Entities are treated
as a single entity for income tax purposes and must file a single
combined income tax return. The Bridge Bank is responsible for filing
all income tax returns and statements for this single entity and is the
agent of each associated Residual Entity to the same extent as if the
Bridge Bank were the common parent of a consolidated group including the
Residual Entity. The term Institution includes a Residual Entity that
files a combined return with its associated Bridge Bank.
(f) Rules applicable to members of consolidated groups--(1) Status
as members. Unless an election is made under paragraph (g) of this
section, Agency Control of an Institution does not terminate the
Institution's membership in a consolidated group. Stock of a subsidiary
that is canceled by Agency is treated as held by the members of the
consolidated group that held the stock prior to its cancellation. If an
Institution is a member of a consolidated group immediately before it
transfers deposit liabilities to a Bridge Bank, the Bridge Bank succeeds
to the Institution's status as the common parent or, unless an election
is made under paragraph (g) of this section, as a subsidiary of the
group. If a Bridge Bank succeeds to an Institution's status as a
subsidiary, its stock is treated as held by the shareholders of the
transferring Institution, and the stock basis or excess loss account of
the Institution carries over to the Bridge Bank. A Bridge Bank is
treated as owning stock owned by its associated Residual Entities,
including for purposes of determining membership in an affiliated group.
(2) No 30-day election to be excluded from consolidated group.
Neither an Institution nor any of its Consolidated Subsidiaries may be
excluded from a consolidated group for a taxable year under Sec.
1.1502-76(b)(5)(ii), as contained in 26 CFR part 1 edition revised April
1, 1994, if the Institution is under Agency Control at any time during
the year.
[[Page 385]]
(3) Coordination with consolidated return regulations. The
provisions of the regulations under section 597 take precedence over
conflicting provisions in the regulations under section 1502.
(g) Elective disaffiliation--(1) In general. A consolidated group of
which an Institution is a subsidiary may elect irrevocably not to
include the Institution in its affiliated group if the Institution is
placed in Agency receivership (whether or not assets or deposit
liabilities of the Institution are transferred to a Bridge Bank). See
paragraph (g)(6) of this section for circumstances under which a
consolidated group is deemed to make this election.
(2) Consequences of election. If the election under this paragraph
(g) is made with respect to an Institution, the following consequences
occur immediately before the subsidiary Institution to which the
election applies is placed in Agency receivership (or, in the case of a
deemed election under paragraph (g)(6) of this section, immediately
before the consolidated group is deemed to make the election) and in the
following order--
(i) All adjustments of the Institution and its Consolidated
Subsidiaries under section 481 are accelerated;
(ii) Deferred intercompany gains and losses with respect to the
Institution and its Consolidated Subsidiaries are taken into account and
the Institution and its Consolidated Subsidiaries take into account any
other items required under the regulations under section 1502 for
members that become nonmembers within the meaning of Sec. 1.1502-
32(d)(4);
(iii) The taxable year of the Institution and its Consolidated
Subsidiaries closes and the Institution includes the amount described in
paragraph (g)(3) of this section in income as ordinary income as its
last item for that taxable year;
(iv) The members of the consolidated group owning the common stock
of the Institution include in income any excess loss account with
respect to the Institution's stock under Sec. 1.1502-19 and any other
items required under the regulations under section 1502 for members that
own stock of corporations that become nonmembers within the meaning of
Sec. 1.1502-32(d)(4); and
(v) If the Institution's liabilities exceed the aggregate fair
market value of its assets on the date the Institution is placed in
Agency receivership (or, in the case of a deemed election under
paragraph (g)(6) of this section, on the date the consolidated group is
deemed to make the election), the members of the consolidated group
treat their stock in the Institution as worthless. (See Sec. Sec.
1.337(d)-2, 1.1502-35(f), and1.1502-36 for rules applicable when a
member of a consolidated group is entitled to a worthless stock
deduction with respect to stock of another member of the group.) In all
other cases, the consolidated group will be treated as owning stock of a
nonmember corporation until such stock is disposed of or becomes
worthless under rules otherwise applicable.
(3) Toll charge. The amount described in this paragraph (g)(3) is
the excess of the Institution's liabilities over the adjusted bases of
its assets immediately before the Institution is placed in Agency
receivership (or, in the case of a deemed election under paragraph
(g)(6) of this section, immediately before the consolidated group is
deemed to make the election). In computing this amount, the adjusted
bases of an Institution's assets are reduced by the amount of the
Institution's reserves for bad debts under section 585 or 593, other
than supplemental reserves under section 593. For purposes of this
paragraph (g)(3), an Institution is treated as a single entity that
includes the assets and liabilities of its Consolidated Subsidiaries,
with appropriate adjustments to prevent duplication. The amount
described in this paragraph (g)(3) for alternative minimum tax purposes
is determined using alternative minimum tax basis, deductions, and all
other items required to be taken into account. In computing the increase
in the group's taxable income or alternative minimum taxable income,
sections 56(d)(1), 382 and 383 and Sec. Sec. 1.1502-15, 1.1502-21 and
1.1502-22 (or Sec. Sec. 1.1502-15A, 1.1502-21A and 1.1502-22A, as
appropriate) do not limit the use of the attributes of the Institution
and its Consolidated Subsidiaries to the extent, if any, that the
inclusion of the amount described in this paragraph (g)(3) in income
would result in the
[[Page 386]]
group having taxable income or alternative minimum taxable income
(determined without regard to this sentence) for the taxable year. The
preceding sentence does not apply to any limitation under section 382 or
383 or Sec. 1.1502-15, 1.1502-21, or 1.1502-22 (or Sec. 1.1502-15A,
1.1502-21A, or 1.1502-22A, as appropriate) that arose in connection with
or prior to a corporation becoming a Consolidated Subsidiary of the
Institution.
(4) Treatment of Institutions after disaffiliation--(i) In general.
If the election under this paragraph (g) is made with respect to an
Institution, immediately after the Institution is placed in Agency
receivership (or, in the case of a deemed election under paragraph
(g)(6) of this section, immediately after the consolidated group is
deemed to make the election), the Institution and each of its
Consolidated Subsidiaries are treated for income tax purposes as new
corporations that are not members of the electing group's affiliated
group. Each new corporation retains the TIN of the corresponding
disaffiliated corporation and is treated as having received the assets
and liabilities of the corresponding disaffiliated corporation in a
transaction to which section 351 applies (and in which no gain was
recognized under section 357(c) or otherwise). Thus, the new corporation
has no net operating or capital loss carryforwards. An election under
this paragraph (g) does not terminate the single entity treatment of a
Bridge Bank and its Residual Entities provided in paragraph (e) of this
section.
(ii) FFA. A new Institution is treated as having a non-interest
bearing, nontransferable account receivable for future FFA with a basis
equal to the amount described in paragraph (g)(3) of this section. If a
disaffiliated Institution has a deferred FFA account at the time of its
disaffiliation, the corresponding new Institution succeeds to and takes
into account that deferred FFA account.
(iii) Filing of consolidated returns. If a disaffiliated Institution
has Consolidated Subsidiaries at the time of its disaffiliation, the
corresponding new Institution is required to file a consolidated income
tax return with the subsidiaries in accordance with the regulations
under section 1502.
(iv) Status as Institution. If an Institution is disaffiliated under
this paragraph (g), the resulting new corporation is treated as an
Institution for purposes of the regulations under section 597 regardless
of whether it is a bank or domestic building and loan association within
the meaning of section 597.
(v) Loss carrybacks. To the extent a carryback of losses would
result in a refund being paid to a fiduciary under section 6402(i), an
Institution or Consolidated Subsidiary with respect to which an election
under this paragraph (g) (other than under paragraph (g)(6)(ii) of this
section) applies is allowed to carry back losses as if the Institution
or Consolidated Subsidiary had continued to be a member of the
consolidated group that made the election.
(5) Affirmative election--(i) Original Institution--(A) Manner of
making election. Except as otherwise provided in paragraph (g)(6) of
this section, a consolidated group makes the election provided by this
paragraph (g) by sending a written statement by certified mail to the
affected Institution on or before the later of 120 days after its
placement in Agency receivership or May 31, 1996. The statement must
contain the following legend at the top of the page: ``THIS IS AN
ELECTION UNDER Sec. 1.597-4(g) TO EXCLUDE THE BELOW-REFERENCED
INSTITUTION AND CONSOLIDATED SUBSIDIARIES FROM THE AFFILIATED GROUP,''
and must include the names and taxpayer identification numbers of the
common parent and of the Institution and Consolidated Subsidiaries to
which the election applies, and the date on which the Institution was
placed in Agency receivership. The consolidated group must send a
similar statement to all subsidiary Institutions placed in Agency
receivership during the consistency period described in paragraph
(g)(5)(ii) of this section. (Failure to satisfy the requirement in the
preceding sentence, however, does not invalidate the election with
respect to any subsidiary Institution placed in Agency receivership
during the consistency period described in paragraph (g)(5)(ii) of
[[Page 387]]
this section.) The consolidated group must include a copy of any
election statement and accompanying certified mail receipt as part of
its first income tax return filed after the due date under this
paragraph (g)(5) for such statement. A statement must be attached to
this return indicating that the individual who signed the election was
authorized to do so on behalf of the consolidated group. Agency cannot
make this election under the authority of section 6402(i) or otherwise.
(B) Consistency limitation on affirmative elections. A consolidated
group may make an affirmative election under this paragraph (g)(5) with
respect to a subsidiary Institution placed in Agency receivership only
if the group made, or is deemed to have made, the election under this
paragraph (g) with respect to every subsidiary Institution of the group
placed in Agency receivership on or after May 10, 1989 and within five
years preceding the date the subject Institution was placed in Agency
receivership.
(ii) Effect on Institutions placed in receivership simultaneously or
subsequently. An election under this paragraph (g), other than under
paragraph (g)(6)(ii) of this section, applies to the Institution with
respect to which the election is made or deemed made (the original
Institution) and each subsidiary Institution of the group placed in
Agency receivership or deconsolidated in contemplation of Agency Control
or the receipt of FFA simultaneously with the original Institution or
within five years thereafter.
(6) Deemed Election--(i) Deconsolidations in contemplation. If one
or more members of a consolidated group deconsolidate (within the
meaning of Sec. 1.1502-19(c)(1)(ii)(B)) a subsidiary Institution in
contemplation of Agency Control or the receipt of FFA, the consolidated
group is deemed to make the election described in this paragraph (g)
with respect to the Institution on the date the deconsolidation occurs.
A subsidiary Institution is conclusively presumed to have been
deconsolidated in contemplation of Agency Control or the receipt of FFA
if either event occurs within six months after the deconsolidation.
(ii) Transfers to a Bridge Bank from multiple groups. On the day an
Institution's transfer of deposit liabilities to a Bridge Bank results
in the Bridge Bank holding deposit liabilities from both a subsidiary
Institution and an Institution not included in the subsidiary
Institution's consolidated group, each consolidated group of which a
transferring Institution or the Bridge Bank is a subsidiary is deemed to
make the election described in this paragraph (g) with respect to its
subsidiary Institution. If deposit liabilities of another Institution
that is a subsidiary member of any consolidated group subsequently are
transferred to the Bridge Bank, the consolidated group of which the
Institution is a subsidiary is deemed to make the election described in
this paragraph (g) with respect to that Institution at the time of the
subsequent transfer.
(h) Examples. The following examples illustrate the provisions of
this section:
Facts. Corporation X, the common parent of a consolidated group,
owns all the stock (with a basis of $4 million) of Institution M, an
insolvent Institution with no Consolidated Subsidiaries. At the close of
business on April 30, 1996, M has $4 million of deposit liabilities, $1
million of other liabilities, and assets with an adjusted basis of $4
million and a fair market value of $3 million.
Example 1. Effect of receivership on consolidation. On May 1, 1996,
Agency places M in receivership and begins liquidating M. X does not
make an election under Sec. 1.597-4(g). M remains a member of the X
consolidated group after May 1, 1996. Section 1.597-4(f)(1).
Example 2. Effect of Bridge Bank on consolidation--(i) Additional
facts. On May 1, 1996, Agency places M in receivership and causes M to
transfer all of its assets and deposit liabilities to Bridge Bank MB.
(ii) Consequences without an election to disaffiliate. M recognizes
no gain or loss from the transfer and MB succeeds to M's basis in the
transferred assets, M's items described in section 381(c) (subject to
the conditions and limitations specified in section 381(c)) and TIN.
Section 1.597-4(d)(1). (If M had a deferred FFA account, MB would also
succeed to that account. Section 1.597-4(d)(1).) MB continues M's
taxable year and succeeds to M's status as a member of the X
consolidated group after May 1, 1996. Section 1.597-4 (d)(1) and (f). MB
and M are treated as a single entity for income tax purposes. Section
1.597-4(e).
[[Page 388]]
(iii) Consequences with an election to disaffiliate. If, on July 1,
1996, X makes an election under Sec. 1.597-4(g) with respect to M, the
following consequences are treated as occurring immediately before M was
placed in Agency receivership. M must include $1 million ($5 million of
liabilities--$4 million of adjusted basis) in income as of May 1, 1996.
Section 1.597-4(g) (2) and (3). M is then treated as a new corporation
that is not a member of the X consolidated group and that has assets
(including a $1 million account receivable for future FFA) with a basis
of $5 million and $5 million of liabilities received from disaffiliated
corporation M in a section 351 transaction. New corporation M retains
the TIN of disaffiliated corporation M. Section 1.597-4(g)(4).
Immediately after the disaffiliation, new corporation M is treated as
transferring its assets and deposit liabilities to Bridge Bank MB. New
corporation M recognizes no gain or loss from the transfer and MB
succeeds to M's TIN and taxable year. Section 1.597-4(d)(1). Bridge Bank
MB is treated as a single entity that includes M and has $5 million of
liabilities, an account receivable for future FFA with a basis of $1
million, and other assets with a basis of $4 million. Section 1.597-
4(d)(1).
[T.D. 8641, 60 FR 66098, Dec. 21, 1995, as amended by T.D. 8677, 61 FR
33322, 33323, June 27, 1996; T.D. 8823, 64 FR 36099, July 2, 1999; T.D.
9048, 68 FR 12290, Mar. 14, 2003; T.D. 9187, 70 FR 10326, Mar. 3, 2005;
T.D. 9254, 71 FR 13018, Mar. 14, 2006; T.D. 9424, 73 FR 53986, Sept. 17,
2008]
Sec. 1.597-5 Taxable Transfers.
(a) Taxable Transfers--(1) Defined. The term Taxable Transfer
means--
(i) A transaction in which an entity transfers to a transferee other
than a Bridge Bank--
(A) Any deposit liability (whether or not the Institution also
transfers assets), if FFA is provided in connection with the
transaction; or
(B) Any asset for which Agency or a Controlled Entity has any
financial obligation (e.g., pursuant to a Loss Guarantee or Agency
Obligation); or
(ii) A deemed transfer of assets described in paragraph (b) of this
section.
(2) Scope. This section provides rules governing Taxable Transfers.
Rules applicable to both actual and deemed asset acquisitions are
provided in paragraphs (c) and (d) of this section. Special rules
applicable only to deemed asset acquisitions are provided in paragraph
(e) of this section.
(b) Deemed asset acquisitions upon stock purchase--(1) In general.
In a deemed transfer of assets under this paragraph (b), an Institution
(including a Bridge Bank or a Residual Entity) or a Consolidated
Subsidiary of the Institution (the Old Entity) is treated as selling all
of its assets in a single transaction and is treated as a new
corporation (the New Entity) that purchases all of the Old Entity's
assets at the close of the day immediately preceding the occurrence of
an event described in paragraph (b)(2) of this section. However, such an
event results in a deemed transfer of assets under this paragraph (b)
only if it occurs--
(i) In connection with a transaction in which FFA is provided;
(ii) While the Old Entity is a Bridge Bank;
(iii) While the Old Entity has a positive balance in a deferred FFA
account (see Sec. 1.597-2(c)(4)(v) regarding the optional accelerated
recapture of deferred FFA); or
(iv) With respect to a Consolidated Subsidiary, while the
Institution of which it is a Consolidated Subsidiary is under Agency
Control.
(2) Events. A deemed transfer of assets under this paragraph (b)
results if the Old Entity--
(i) Becomes a non-member within the meaning of Sec. 1.1502-32(d)(4)
of its consolidated group (other than pursuant to an election under
Sec. 1.597-4(g));
(ii) Becomes a member of an affiliated group of which it was not
previously a member (other than pursuant to an election under Sec.
1.597-4(g)); or
(iii) Issues stock such that the stock that was outstanding before
the imposition of Agency Control or the occurrence of any transaction in
connection with the provision of FFA represents 50 percent or less of
the vote or value of its outstanding stock (disregarding stock described
in section 1504(a)(4) and stock owned by Agency or a Controlled Entity).
(3) Bridge Banks and Residual Entities. If a Bridge Bank is treated
as selling all of its assets to a New Entity under this paragraph (b),
each associated Residual Entity is treated as simultaneously selling its
assets to a New Entity in a Taxable Transfer described in this paragraph
(b).
(c) Treatment of transferor--(1) FFA in connection with a Taxable
Transfer. A
[[Page 389]]
transferor in a Taxable Transfer is treated as having directly received
immediately before a Taxable Transfer any Net Worth Assistance that
Agency provides to the New Entity or Acquiring in connection with the
transfer. (See Sec. 1.597-2 (a) and (c) for rules regarding the
inclusion of FFA in income and Sec. 1.597-2(a)(1) for related rules
regarding FFA provided to shareholders.) The Net Worth Assistance is
treated as an asset of the transferor that is sold to the New Entity or
Acquiring in the Taxable Transfer.
(2) Amount realized in a Taxable Transfer. In a Taxable Transfer
described in paragraph (a)(1)(i) of this section, the amount realized is
determined under section 1001(b) by reference to the consideration paid
for the assets. In a Taxable Transfer described in paragraph (a)(1)(ii)
of this section, the amount realized is the sum of the grossed-up basis
of the stock acquired in connection with the Taxable Transfer (excluding
stock acquired from the Old or New Entity), plus the amount of
liabilities assumed or taken subject to in the deemed transfer, plus
other relevant items. The grossed-up basis of the acquired stock equals
the acquirors' basis in the acquired stock divided by the percentage of
the Old Entity's stock (by value) attributable to the acquired stock.
(3) Allocation of amount realized--(i) In general. The amount
realized under paragraph (c)(2) of this section is allocated among the
assets transferred in the Taxable Transfer in the same manner as amounts
are allocated among assets under Sec. 1.338-6(b), (c)(1) and (2).
(ii) Modifications to general rule. This paragraph (c)(3)(ii)
modifies certain of the allocation rules of paragraph (c)(3)(i) of this
section. Agency Obligations and assets covered by Loss Guarantees in the
hands of the New Entity or Acquiring are treated as Class II assets.
Stock of a Consolidated Subsidiary is treated as a Class II asset to the
extent the fair market value of the Consolidated Subsidiary's Class I
and Class II assets exceeds the amount of its liabilities. The fair
market value of an Agency Obligation is deemed to equal its adjusted
issue price immediately before the Taxable Transfer. The fair market
value of an asset covered by a Loss Guarantee immediately after the
Taxable Transfer is deemed to be not less than the greater of the
asset's highest guaranteed value or the highest price at which the asset
can be put.
(d) Treatment of a New Entity and Acquiring--(1) Purchase price. The
purchase price for assets acquired in a Taxable Transfer described in
paragraph (a)(1)(i) of this section is the cost of the assets acquired.
See Sec. 1.1060-1T(c)(1). The purchase price for assets acquired in a
Taxable Transfer described in paragraph (a)(1)(ii) of this section is
the sum of the grossed-up basis of the stock acquired in connection with
the Taxable Transfer (excluding stock acquired from the Old or New
Entity), plus the amount of liabilities assumed or taken subject to in
the deemed transfer, plus other relevant items. The grossed-up basis of
the acquired stock equals the acquirors' basis in the acquired stock
divided by the percentage of the Old Entity's stock (by value)
attributable to the acquired stock. FFA provided in connection with a
Taxable Transfer is not included in the New Entity's or Acquiring's
purchase price for the acquired assets. Any Net Worth Assistance so
provided is treated as an asset of the transferor sold to the New Entity
or Acquiring in the Taxable Transfer.
(2) Allocation of basis--(i) In general. Except as otherwise
provided in this paragraph (d)(2), the purchase price determined under
paragraph (d)(1) of this section is allocated among the assets
transferred in the Taxable Transfer in the same manner as amounts are
allocated among assets under Sec. 1.338-6(b), (c)(1) and (2).
(ii) Modifications to general rule. The allocation rules contained
in paragraph (c)(3)(ii) of this section apply to the allocation of basis
among assets acquired in a Taxable Transfer. No basis is allocable to
Agency's agreement to provide Loss Guarantees, yield maintenance
payments, cost to carry or cost of funds reimbursement payments, or
expense reimbursement or indemnity payments. A New Entity's basis in
assets it receives from its shareholders is determined under general
principles of income taxation and is not governed by this paragraph (d).
[[Page 390]]
(iii) Allowance and recapture of additional basis in certain cases.
If the fair market value of the Class I and Class II assets acquired in
a Taxable Transfer is greater than the New Entity's or Acquiring's
purchase price for the acquired assets, the basis of the Class I and
Class II assets equals their fair market value. The amount by which the
fair market value of the Class I and Class II assets exceeds the
purchase price is included ratably as ordinary income by the New Entity
or Acquiring over a period of six taxable years beginning in the year of
the Taxable Transfer. The New Entity or Acquiring must include as
ordinary income the entire amount remaining to be recaptured under the
preceding sentence in the taxable year in which an event occurs that
would accelerate inclusion of an adjustment under section 481.
(iv) Certain post-transfer adjustments--(A) Agency Obligations. If
an adjustment to the principal amount of an Agency Obligation or cash
payment to reflect a more accurate determination of the condition of the
Institution at the time of the Taxable Transfer is made before the
earlier of the date the New Entity or Acquiring files its first post-
transfer income tax return or the due date of that return (including
extensions), the New Entity or Acquiring must adjust its basis in its
acquired assets to reflect the adjustment. In making adjustments to the
New Entity's or Acquiring's basis in its acquired assets, paragraph
(c)(3)(ii) of this section is applied by treating an adjustment to the
principal amount of an Agency Obligation pursuant to the first sentence
of this paragraph (d)(2)(iv)(A) as occurring immediately before the
Taxable Transfer. (See Sec. 1.597-3(c)(3) for rules regarding other
adjustments to the principal amount of an Agency Obligation.)
(B) Assets covered by a Loss Guarantee. If, immediately after a
Taxable Transfer, an asset is not covered by a Loss Guarantee but the
New Entity or Acquiring has the right to designate specific assets that
will be covered by a Loss Guarantee, the New Entity or Acquiring must
treat any asset so designated as having been subject to the Loss
Guarantee at the time of the Taxable Transfer. The New Entity or
Acquiring must adjust its basis in the covered assets and in its other
acquired assets to reflect the designation in the manner provided by
paragraph (d)(2) of this section. The New Entity or Acquiring must make
appropriate adjustments in subsequent taxable years if the designation
is made after the New Entity or Acquiring files its first post-transfer
income tax return or the due date of that return (including extensions)
has passed.
(e) Special rules applicable to Taxable Transfers that are deemed
asset acquisitions--(1) Taxpayer identification numbers. Except as
provided in paragraph (e)(3) of this section, a New Entity succeeds to
the TIN of the transferor in a deemed sale under paragraph (b) of this
section.
(2) Consolidated Subsidiaries--(i) In general. A Consolidated
Subsidiary that is treated as selling its assets in a Taxable Transfer
under paragraph (b) of this section is treated as engaging immediately
thereafter in a complete liquidation to which section 332 applies. The
consolidated group of which the Consolidated Subsidiary is a member does
not take into account gain or loss on the sale, exchange, or
cancellation of stock of the Consolidated Subsidiary in connection with
the Taxable Transfer.
(ii) Certain minority shareholders. Shareholders of the Consolidated
Subsidiary that are not members of the consolidated group that includes
the Institution do not recognize gain or loss with respect to shares of
Consolidated Subsidiary stock retained by the shareholder. The
shareholder's basis for that stock is not affected by the Taxable
Transfer.
(3) Bridge Banks and Residual Entities--(i) In general. A Bridge
Bank or Residual Entity's sale of assets to a New Entity under paragraph
(b) of this section is treated as made by a single entity under Sec.
1.597-4(e). The New Entity deemed to acquire the assets of a Residual
Entity under paragraph (b) of this section is not treated as a single
entity with the Bridge Bank (or with the New Entity acquiring the Bridge
Bank's assets) and must obtain a new TIN.
(ii) Treatment of consolidated groups. At the time of a Taxable
Transfer described in paragraph (a)(1)(ii) of this
[[Page 391]]
section, treatment of a Bridge Bank as a subsidiary member of a
consolidated group under Sec. 1.597-4(f)(1) ceases. However, the New
Entity deemed to acquire the assets of a Residual Entity is a member of
the selling consolidated group after the deemed sale. The group's basis
or excess loss account in the stock of the New Entity that is deemed to
acquire the assets of the Residual Entity is the group's basis or excess
loss account in the stock of the Bridge Bank immediately before the
deemed sale, as adjusted for the results of the sale.
(4) Certain returns. If an Old Entity without Continuing Equity is
not a subsidiary of a consolidated group at the time of the Taxable
Transfer, the controlling Agency must file all income tax returns for
the Old Entity for periods ending on or prior to the date of the deemed
sale described in paragraph (b) of this section that are not filed as of
that date.
(5) Basis limited to fair market value. If all of the stock of the
corporation is not acquired on the date of the Taxable Transfer, the
Commissioner may make appropriate adjustments under paragraphs (c) and
(d) of this section to the extent using a grossed-up basis of the stock
of a corporation results in an aggregate amount realized for, or basis
in, the assets other than the aggregate fair market value of the assets.
(f) Examples. The following examples illustrate the provisions of
this section:
Example 1. Branch sale resulting in Taxable Transfer. (i)
Institution M is a calendar year taxpayer in Agency receivership. M is
not a member of a consolidated group. On January 1, 1997, M has $200
million of liabilities (including deposit liabilities) and assets with
an adjusted basis of $100 million. M has no income or loss for 1997 and,
except as described below, receives no FFA. On September 30, 1997,
Agency causes M to transfer six branches (with assets having an adjusted
basis of $1 million) together with $120 million of deposit liabilities
to N. In connection with the transfer, Agency provides $121 million in
cash to N.
(ii) The transaction is a Taxable Transfer in which M receives $121
million of Net Worth Assistance. Section 1.597-5(a)(1). (M is treated as
directly receiving the $121 million of Net Worth Assistance immediately
before the Taxable Transfer. Section 1.597-5(c)(1).) M transfers
branches having a basis of $1 million and is treated as transferring
$121 million in cash (the Net Worth Assistance) to N in exchange for N's
assumption of $120 million of liabilities. Thus, M realizes a loss of $2
million on the transfer. The amount of the FFA M must include in its
income in 1997 is limited by Sec. 1.597-2(c) to $102 million, which is
the sum of the $100 million excess of M's liabilities ($200 million)
over the total adjusted basis of its assets ($100 million) at the
beginning of 1997, plus the $2 million excess for the taxable year,
which results from the Taxable Transfer, of M's deductions (other than
carryovers) over its gross income other than FFA. M must establish a
deferred FFA account for the remaining $19 million of FFA. Section
1.597-2(c)(4).
(iii) N, as Acquiring, must allocate its $120 million purchase price
for the assets acquired from M among those assets. Cash is a Class I
asset. The branch assets are in Classes III and IV. N's adjusted basis
in the cash is its amount, i.e., $121 million. Section 1.597-5(d)(2).
Because this amount exceeds N's purchase price for all of the acquired
assets by $1 million, N allocates no basis to the other acquired assets
and, under Sec. 1.597-5(d)(2), must recapture the $1 million excess at
an annual rate of $166,667 in the six consecutive taxable years
beginning with 1997 (subject to acceleration for certain events).
Example 2. Stock issuance by Bridge Bank causing Taxable Transfer.
(i) On April 1, 1996, Institution P is placed in receivership and caused
to transfer assets and liabilities to Bridge Bank PB. On August 31,
1996, the assets of PB consist of $20 million in cash, loans outstanding
with an adjusted basis of $50 million and a fair market value of $40
million, and other non-financial assets (primarily branch assets and
equipment) with an adjusted basis of $5 million. PB has deposit
liabilities of $95 million and other liabilities of $5 million. P, the
Residual Entity, holds real estate with an adjusted basis of $10 million
and claims in litigation having a zero basis. P retains no deposit
liabilities and has no other liabilities (except its liability to Agency
for having caused its deposit liabilities to be satisfied).
(ii) On September 1, 1996, Agency causes PB to issue 100 percent of
its common stock for $2 million cash to X. On the same day, Agency
issues a $25 million note to PB. The note bears a fixed rate of interest
in excess of the applicable federal rate in effect for September 1,
1996. Agency provides Loss Guarantees guaranteeing PB a value of $50
million for PB's loans outstanding.
(iii) The stock issuance is a Taxable Transfer in which PB is
treated as selling all of its assets to a new corporation, New PB.
Section 1.597-5(b)(1). PB is treated as directly receiving $25 million
of Net Worth Assistance (the issue price of the Agency Obligation)
immediately before the Taxable Transfer. Section 1.597-3(c)(2); Sec.
1.597- 5(c)(1). The amount of
[[Page 392]]
FFA PB must include in income is determined under Sec. 1.597-2(a) and
(c). PB in turn is deemed to transfer the note to New PB in the Taxable
Transfer, together with $20 million of cash, all its loans outstanding
(with a basis of $50 million) and its other non-financial assets (with a
basis of $5 million). The amount realized by PB from the sale is $100
million, the amount of PB's liabilities deemed to be assumed by New PB.
This amount realized equals PB's basis in its assets and thus, PB
realizes no gain or loss on the transfer to New PB.
(iv) Residual Entity P also is treated as selling all its assets
(consisting of real estate and claims in litigation) for $0 (the amount
of consideration received by P) to a new corporation (New P) in a
Taxable Transfer. Section 1.597-5(b)(3). (P's only liability is to
Agency and a liability to Agency is not treated as a debt under Sec.
1.597-3(b).) Thus, P realizes a $10 million loss on the transfer to New
P. The combined return filed by PB and P for 1996 will reflect a total
loss on the Taxable Transfer of $10 million ($0 for PB and $10 million
for P). Section 1.597-5(e)(3). That return also will reflect FFA income
from the Net Worth Assistance, determined under Sec. 1.597-2 (a) and
(c).
(v) New PB is treated as having acquired the assets it acquired from
PB for $100 million, the amount of liabilities assumed. In allocating
basis among these assets, New PB treats the Agency note and the loans
outstanding (which are covered by Loss Guarantees) as Class II assets.
For the purpose of allocating basis, the fair market value of the Agency
note is deemed to equal its adjusted issue price immediately before the
transfer, $25 million. The fair market value of the loans is deemed not
to be less than the guaranteed value of $50 million.
(vi) New P is treated as having acquired its assets for no
consideration. Thus its basis in its assets immediately after the
transfer is zero. New PB and New P are not treated as a single entity.
Section 1.597-5(e)(3).
Example 3. Taxable Transfer of previously disaffiliated Institution.
(i) Corporation X, the common parent of a consolidated group, owns all
the stock of Institution M, an insolvent Institution with no
Consolidated Subsidiaries. On April 30, 1996, M has $4 million of
deposit liabilities, $1 million of other liabilities, and assets with an
adjusted basis of $4 million and a fair market value of $3 million. On
May 1, 1996, Agency places M in receivership. X elects under Sec.
1.597-4(g) to disaffiliate M. Accordingly, as of May 1, 1996, new
corporation M is not a member of the X consolidated group. On May 1,
1996, Agency causes M to transfer all of its assets and liabilities to
Bridge Bank MB. Under Sec. 1.597-4(e), MB and M are thereafter treated
as a single entity which has $5 million of liabilities, an account
receivable for future FFA with a basis of $1 million, and other assets
with a basis of $4 million. Section 1.597-4(g)(4).
(ii) During May 1996, MB earns $25,000 of interest income and
accrues $20,000 of interest expense on depositor accounts and there is
no net change in deposits other than the additional $20,000 of interest
expense accrued on depositor accounts. MB pays $5,000 of wage expenses
and has no other items of income or expense.
(iii) On June 1, 1996, Agency causes MB to issue 100 percent of its
stock to corporation Y. In connection with the stock issuance, Agency
provides an Agency Obligation for $2 million and no other FFA.
(iv) The stock issuance results in a Taxable Transfer. Section
1.597-5(b). MB is treated as receiving the Agency Obligation immediately
prior to the Taxable Transfer. Section 1.597-5(c)(1). MB has $1 million
of basis in its account receivable for FFA. This receivable is treated
as satisfied, offsetting $1 million of the $2 million of FFA provided by
Agency in connection with the Taxable Transfer. The status of the
remaining $1 million of FFA as includible income is determined as of the
end of the taxable year under Sec. 1.597-2(c). However, under Sec.
1.597-2(b), MB obtains a $2 million basis in the Agency Obligation
received as FFA.
(v) Under Sec. 1.597-5(c)(2), in the Taxable Transfer, Old Entity
MB is treated as selling, to New Entity MB, all of Old Entity MB's
assets, having a basis of $6,020,000 (the original $4 million of asset
basis as of April 30, 1996, plus $20,000 net cash from May 1996
activities, plus $2 million in the Agency Obligation received as FFA),
for $5,020,000, the amount of Old Entity MB's liabilities assumed by New
Entity MB pursuant to the Taxable Transfer. Therefore, Old Entity MB
recognizes, in the aggregate, a loss of $1 million from the Taxable
Transfer.
(vi) Because this $1 million loss causes Old Entity MB's deductions
to exceed its gross income (determined without regard to FFA) by $1
million, Old Entity MB must include in its income the $1 million of FFA
not offset by the FFA receivable. Section 1.597-2(c). (As of May 1,
1996, Old Entity MB's liabilities ($5,000,000) did not exceed MB's $5
million adjusted basis of its assets. For the taxable year, MB's
deductions of $1,025,000 ($1,000,000 loss from the Taxable Transfer,
$20,000 interest expense and $5,000 of wage expense) exceeded its gross
income (disregarding FFA) of $25,000 (interest income) by $1,000,000.
Thus, under Sec. 1.597-2(c), MB includes in income the entire
$1,000,000 of FFA not offset by the FFA receivable.)
(vii) Therefore, Old Entity MB's taxable income for the taxable year
ending on the date of the Taxable Transfer is $0.
(viii) Residual Entity M is also deemed to engage in a deemed sale
of its assets to New Entity M under Sec. 1.597-5(b)(3), but there are
[[Page 393]]
no tax consequences as M has no assets or liabilities at the time of the
deemed sale.
(ix) Under Sec. 1.597-5(d)(1), New Entity MB is treated as
purchasing Old Entity MB's assets for $5,020,000, the amount of New
Entity MB's liabilities. Of this, $2,000,000 is allocated to the $2
million Agency Obligation, and $3,020,000 is allocated to the other
assets New Entity MB is treated as purchasing in the Taxable Transfer.
Example 4. Loss Sharing. Institution N acquires assets and assumes
liabilities of another Institution in a Taxable Transfer. Among the
assets transferred are three parcels of real estate. In the hands of the
transferring Institution, these assets had book values of $100,000 each.
In connection with the Taxable Transfer, Agency agrees to reimburse
Institution N for 80 percent of any loss (based on the original book
value) realized on the disposition or charge-off of the three
properties. This arrangement constitutes a Loss Guarantee. Thus, in
allocating basis, Institution N treats the three parcels as Class II
assets. By virtue of the arrangement with the Agency, Institution N is
assured that the parcels will not be worth less to it than $80,000 each,
because even if the properties are worthless, Agency will reimburse 80
percent of the loss. Although Institution could obtain payments under
the Loss Guarantee if the properties are worth more, it is not
guaranteed that it will realize more than $80,000. Accordingly, $80,000
is the highest guaranteed value of the three parcels. Institution N will
allocate basis to the Class II assets up to their fair market value. For
this purpose, the fair market value of the three parcels is not less
than $80,000 each. Section 1.597-5(d)(2)(ii); Sec. 1.597-5(c)(3)(ii).
[T.D. 8641, 60 FR 66101, Dec. 21, 1995, as amended by T.D. 8858, 65 FR
1237, Jan. 7, 2000; T.D. 8940, 66 FR 9929, Feb. 13, 2001]
Sec. 1.597-6 Limitation on collection of income tax.
(a) Limitation on collection where tax is borne by Agency. If an
Institution without Continuing Equity (or any of its Consolidated
Subsidiaries) is liable for income tax that is attributable to the
inclusion in income of FFA or gain from a Taxable Transfer, the tax will
not be collected if it would be borne by Agency. The final determination
of whether the tax would be borne by Agency is within the sole
discretion of the Commissioner. In determining whether tax would be
borne by Agency, the Commissioner will disregard indemnity, tax-sharing,
or similar obligations of Agency, an Institution, or its Consolidated
Subsidiaries. Collection of the several income tax liability under Sec.
1.1502-6 from members of an Institution's consolidated group other than
the Institution or its Consolidated Subsidiaries is not affected by this
section. Income tax will continue to be subject to collection except as
specifically limited in this section. This section does not apply to
taxes other than income taxes.
(b) Amount of tax attributable to FFA or gain on a Taxable Transfer.
For purposes of paragraph (a) of this section, the amount of income tax
in a taxable year attributable to the inclusion of FFA or gain from a
Taxable Transfer in the income of an Institution (or a Consolidated
Subsidiary) is the excess of the actual income tax liability of the
Institution (or the consolidated group in which the Institution is a
member) over the income tax liability of the Institution (or the
consolidated group in which the Institution is a member) determined
without regard to FFA or gain or loss on the Taxable Transfer.
(c) Reporting of uncollected tax. A taxpayer must specify on the
front page of Form 1120 (U.S. Corporate Income Tax Return), to the left
of the space provided for ``Total Tax,'' the amount of income tax for
the taxable year that is potentially not subject to collection under
this section. If an Institution is a subsidiary member of a consolidated
group, the amount specified as not subject to collection is zero.
(d) Assessments of tax to offset refunds. Income tax that is not
collected under this section will be assessed and, thus, used to offset
any claim for refund made by or on behalf of the Institution, the
Consolidated Subsidiary or any other corporation with several liability
for the tax.
(e) Collection of taxes from Acquiring or a New Entity--(1)
Acquiring. No income tax liability (including the several liability for
taxes under Sec. 1.1502-6) of a transferor in a Taxable Transfer will
be collected from Acquiring.
(2) New Entity. Income tax liability (including the several
liability for taxes under Sec. 1.1502-6) of a transferor in a Taxable
Transfer will be collected from a New Entity only if stock that was
outstanding in the Old Entity remains outstanding as stock in the New
[[Page 394]]
Entity or is reacquired or exchanged for consideration.
(f) Effect on section 7507. This section supersedes the application
of section 7507, and the regulations thereunder, for the assessment and
collection of income tax attributable to FFA.
[T.D. 8641, 60 FR 66103, Dec. 21, 1995]